Documentos de Académico
Documentos de Profesional
Documentos de Cultura
CONTRiBUTiNG AUTHORS RUTH BAKOGiANiS | ANDREW mENTLiKOWSKi | mARK BARNES | KYLiE BOUCHER JENNY WATSON | CAROLiNE DENNEY | SONJA STAmBULiC | ELENA iAmPOLSKY ROSS ALLEN | ROBERT CAHN | RODNEY EBBAGE
First published and revised 2010 by John Wiley & Sons Australia, Ltd 42 McDougall Street, Milton, Qld 4064 Typeset in 10/12pt Times LT John Wiley & Sons Australia, Ltd 2010 The moral rights of the authors have been asserted. National Library of Australia Cataloguing-in-Publication data Title: Maths quest 12 mathematical methods CAS: TI-Nspire 2.0 edition / Brian Hodgson . . . [et al.]. ISBN: 978 1 7424 6465 7 (student pbk.) 978 1 7424 6466 4 (student ebook) 978 1 7424 6468 8 (teacher pbk.) 978 1 7424 6469 5 (teacher ebook) Notes: Includes index. Target Audience: For secondary school age. Subjects: Mathematics Textbooks. Other Authors/ Contributors: Hodgson, Brian. Dewey Number: 510
Reproduction and communication for educational purposes The Australian Copyright Act 1968 (the Act) allows a maximum of one chapter or 10% of the pages of this work, whichever is the greater, to be reproduced and/or communicated by any educational institution for its educational purposes provided that the educational institution (or the body that administers it) has given a remuneration notice to Copyright Agency Limited (CAL). Reproduction and communication for other purposes Except as permitted under the Act (for example, a fair dealing for the purposes of study, research, criticism or review), no part of this book may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system, communicated or transmitted in any form or by any means without prior written permission. All inquiries should be made to the publisher. Screenshots from TI-Nspire CAS calculator reproduced with permission of Texas Instruments Illustrated by Aptara and the Wiley Art Studio Typeset in India by Aptara Printed in Singapore by Craft Print International Ltd 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
Contents
Introduction viii About eBookPLUS x Acknowledgements xi
CHAPTER 1 2J Modelling 111
Exercise 2J 117
Summary 120 Chapter review 123 eBookPLUS activities 129
Exam Practice 1
Based on Chapters 12 130
Exercise 1A 6 Polynomials 6 Exercise 1B 10 Division of polynomials 11 Exercise 1C 15 Linear graphs 15 Exercise 1D 20 Quadratic graphs 22 Exercise 1E 28 Cubic graphs 29 Exercise 1F 34 Quartic graphs 38 Exercise 1G 45
CHAPTER 3
Exercise 3A 136
3B Logarithm laws 138
Exercise 3B 141
3C Exponential equations 142
Exercise 3C 146
3D Logarithmic equations using any base 147
Exercise 3D 149
3E Exponential equations (base e) 151
Exercise 3E 153
3F Equations with natural (base e)
CHAPTER 2
Exercise 2A 63
2B The cubic function in power form 65
Exercise 2B 69
2c The power function (the hyperbola) 71 2D 2E 2F 2G 2h 2I
logarithms 154 Exercise 3F 155 3G Inverses 156 Exercise 3G 158 3H Literal equations 159 Exercise 3H 162 3I Exponential and logarithmic modelling 162 Exercise 3I 164
Summary 167 Chapter review 168 eBookPLUS activities 171
Exercise 2C 76 The power function (the truncus) 78 Exercise 2D 84 The square root function in power form 86 Exercise 2E 91 The absolute value function 92 Exercise 2F 95 Transformations with matrices 96 Exercise 2G 101 Sum, difference and product functions 103 Exercise 2H 106 Composite functions and functional equations 108 Exercise 2I 110
CHAPTER 4
with any base 172 Exercise 4A 181 4B Logarithmic graphs to any base 182 Exercise 4B 190 4c Graphs of exponential functions with base e 191 Exercise 4C 196
4F 4G
4H
Exercise 4D 201 Finding equations for graphs of exponential and logarithmic functions 202 Exercise 4E 205 Addition of ordinates 206 Exercise 4F 211 Exponential and logarithmic functions with absolute values 212 Exercise 4G 215 Exponential and logarithmic modelling using graphs 216 Exercise 4H 217
Exam Practice 2
Based on Chapters 16 322
CHAPTER 7
Differentiation 324
7a Review gradient and rates of change 324
Exercise 7A 328
7B Limits and differentiation from
CHAPTER 5
7C 7d 7E 7F 7g
Exercise 5A 233 5b Functions and their inverses 234 Exercise 5B 239 5c Inverse functions 240 Exercise 5C 243 5d Restricting functions 245 Exercise 5D 249
Summary 252 Chapter review 253 eBookPLUS activities 257
7h 7i 7J
CHAPTER 6
first principles 332 Exercise 7B 336 The derivative of xn 338 Exercise 7C 340 The chain rule 341 Exercise 7D 343 The derivative of ex 344 Exercise 7E 347 The derivative of loge (x) 347 Exercise 7F 349 The derivatives of sin (x), cos (x) and tan (x) 351 Exercise 7G 354 The product rule 355 Exercise 7H 356 The quotient rule 357 Exercise 7I 359 Mixed problems on differentiation 360 Exercise 7J 364
6g 6h
Exercise 6A 263 Symmetry and exact values 264 Exercise 6B 271 Trigonometric equations 273 Exercise 6C 281 Trigonometric graphs 282 Exercise 6D 288 Graphs of the tangent function 291 Exercise 6E 295 Finding equations of trigonometric graphs 295 Exercise 6F 297 Trigonometric modelling 299 Exercise 6G 301 Further graphs 303 Exercise 6H 310
CHAPTER 8
Exercise 8A 375 8b Sketching curves 376 Exercise 8B 384 8c Maximum and minimum problems when the function is known 386 Exercise 8C 389 8d Maximum and minimum problems when the function is unknown 390 Exercise 8D 394
vi
Contents
Exercise 8E 398 8f Related rates 401 Exercise 8F 404 8G Linear approximation 404 Exercise 8G 406
Summary 408 Chapter review 410 eBookPLUS activities 415
CHAPTER 11
CHAPTER 9
Integration 416
9a Antidifferentiation 416
Exercise 9A 423
x, sin (x) and cos (x) 426 9b Integration of e
Exercise 9B 428
9c Integration by recognition 430
Exercise 9C 433
9d Approximating areas enclosed by
for multiple probabilities 552 Exercise 11B 557 11c Markov chains and transition matrices 559 Exercise 11C 571 11D Expected value, variance and standard deviation of the binomial distribution 573 Exercise 11D 577
Summary 581 Chapter review 583 eBookPLUS activities 588
9e
9f 9g 9H 9I 9J
functions 435 Exercise 9D 438 The fundamental theorem of integral calculus 441 Exercise 9E 446 Signed areas 448 Exercise 9F 452 Further areas 455 Exercise 9G 458 Areas between two curves 460 Exercise 9H 464 Average value of a function 466 Exercise 9I 468 Further applications of integration 468 Exercise 9J 471
CHAPTER 12
12C
Exam Practice 3
Based on Chapters 19 482
CHAPTER 10
find probabilities of continuous random variables 595 Exercise 12B 602 Measures of central tendency and spread 605 Exercise 12C 611 Applications to problem solving 613 Exercise 12D 616 The normal distribution 619 Exercise 12E 623 The standard normal distribution 626 Exercise 12F 633 The inverse cumulative normal distribution 636 Exercise 12G 640
Exercise 10A 498 10b Discrete random variables 501 Exercise 10B 507 10c Measures of centre of discrete random distributions 510 Exercise 10C 516
Exam Practice 4
Based on Chapters 112 652
Contents
vii
Introduction
Maths Quest 12 Mathematical Methods CAS is specifically designed for the VCE Mathematical Methods CAS course and based on the award-winning Maths Quest series. This resource contains: a student textbook with accompanying eBookPLUS a teacher edition with accompanying eGuidePLUS a solutions manual.
Student textbook
Full colour is used throughout to produce clearer graphs and headings, to provide bright, stimulating photos and to make navigation through the text easier. Clear, concise theory sections contain worked examples and highlighted important text and remember boxes. Icons appear for the eBookPLUS to indicate that interactivities and eLessons are available online to help with the teaching and learning of particular concepts. Worked examples in a Think/Write format provide clear explanation of key steps and suggest presentation of solutions. Many worked examples have eBookPLUS icons to indicate that a Tutorial is available to elucidate the concepts being explained. Worked examples also contain CAS calculator instructions and screens to exemplify judicious use of the calculator. Exercises contain many carefully graded skills and application problems, including multiplechoice questions. Cross references to relevant worked examples appear with the first matching question throughout the exercises. Exercises also contain questions from past VCE examination papers along with relevant exam tips. A selection of questions is tagged as technology-free to indicate to students that they should avoid using their calculators or other technologies to assist them in finding a solution. Exam practice sections contain examination-style questions, including time and mark allocations for each question. Fully worked solutions are available on the eBookPLUS for students. Each chapter concludes with a summary and chapter review exercise containing examinationstyle questions (multiple choice, short answer and extended response), which help consolidate students learning of new concepts. Also included are questions from past VCE exams along with relevant exam tips. Technology is fully integrated (in line with VCE recommendations).
viii
Introduction
WorkSHEET icons link to editable Word documents that may be completed on screen or printed and completed by hand. SkillSHEET icons link to printable pages designed to help students revise required concepts, and contain additional examples and problems. Interactivity icons link to dynamic animations which help students to understand difficult concepts. eLesson icons link to videos or animations designed to elucidate concepts in ways that are more than what the teacher can achieve in the classroom. Tutorial icons link to one-way engagement activities which explain the worked examples in detail for students to view at home or in the classroom. Test yourself tests are also available and answers are provided for students to receive instant feedback.
Introduction
ix
LOGIN Once you have created your account, you can use the same email address and password in the future to register any eBookPLUS titles you own.
eBookPLUS logos are used throughout the printed books to inform you that a multimedia resource is available for the content you are studying.
Searchlight IDs (e.g. int-0001) give you instant access to multimedia resources. Once you are logged in, simply enter the searchlight ID for that resource and it will open immediately.
Minimum requirements
Internet Explorer 7, Mozilla Firefox 1.5 or Safari 1.3 Adobe Flash Player 9 Javascript must be enabled (most browsers are enabled by default).
Troubleshooting
Go to the JacarandaPLUS help page at www.jacplus.com.au Contact John Wiley & Sons Australia, Ltd. Email: support@jacplus.com.au Phone: 1800 JAC PLUS (1800 522 7587)
About eBookPLUS
Acknowledgements
The authors and publisher would like to thank the following copyright holders, organisations and individuals for their assistance and for permission to reproduce copyright material in this book.
Images:
Banana Stock: page 494 Corbis Corporation: pages 317, 585 Digital Vision: pages 53, 219, 577 Image 100: page 127 ImageState: page 387 John Wiley & Sons Australia: page 500/Taken by Sharon Way, page 518/Taken by Kari-Ann Tapp Photodisc: pages 154, 156, 218, 222, 273, 299, 302, 472, 559, 561, 572, 578, 580, 649 Photolibrary/ Claver Carroll: page 479 PureStock: page 26 Stockbyte: pages 549, 550 Photograph courtesy and copyright Transurban Limited, page 527
Text:
VCAA: All Victorian Curriculum and Assessment Authority material has been used with permission. For more information go to www.vcaa.vic.edu.au. Every effort has been made to trace the ownership of copyright material. Information that will enable the publisher to rectify any error or omission in subsequent editions will be welcome. In such cases, please contact the Permissions Section of John Wiley & Sons Australia, Ltd.
Acknowledgements
xi
1
Graphs and polynomials
AreAS oF STudy
1A 1B 1C 1D 1E 1F 1G
The binomial theorem Polynomials Division of polynomials Linear graphs Quadratic graphs Cubic graphs Quartic graphs
Graphs of polynomial functions including axis intercepts, stationary points and points of inflection, domain (including maximal domain), range and symmetry
Review of algebra of polynomials, solution of polynomial equations with real coefficients of degree n having up to and including n real solutions
eBook plus
1A
Digital doc
10 Quick Questions
In Maths Quest 11 Mathematical Methods CAS we learned the following binomial expansions: (x + a)2 = x2 + 2xa + a2 (x + a)3 = x3 + 3x2a + 3xa2 + a3 These are called binomial expansions because the expressions in the brackets contain two terms, bi meaning 2. By continuing to multiply successively by a further (x + a), the following expansions would be obtained: (x + a)4 = (x3 + 3x2a + 3xa2 + a3)(x + a) = x4 + 4x3a + 6x2a2 + 4xa3 + a3 (x + a)5 = (x4 + 4x3a + 6x2a2 + 4xa3 + a3)(x + a) = x5 + 5x4a + 10x3a2 + 10x2a3 + 5xa4 + a5 The coefficients associated with each term can be arranged in a triangular shape as shown: (x + a)0 (x + a)1 1 1 1 1 5 4 10 3 6 10 1 2 3 4 5 (x + a)2 (x + a)3 (x + a)4 (x + a)5 1 1 1 1 1 1
Chapter 1
Notes 1. The first and last numbers of each row are 1. 2. Each other number is the sum of the two numbers immediately above it. This triangle is known as Pascals triangle. Each number can also be obtained using combinations, as follows. Row 0 1 0 2 0 3 0 4 0 4 1 3 1 4 2 2 1 3 2 4 3 0 0 1 1 2 2 3 3 4 4
n n n! Note: r = Cr = n r ! r ! ( ) n Remember that nCr is another way of writing . r For example, the expansion of (x + a)6 can be written using combinations and then evaluated: 6 6 6 6 6 6 6 ( x + a)6 = x 6 a 0 + x 5 a1 + x 4 a 2 + x 3 a3 + x 2 a 4 + x1a 5 + x 0 a6 5 2 4 1 3 0 6 = x 6 + 6 x 5 a + 15 x 4 a 2 + 20 x 3 a3 + 15 x 2 a 4 + 6 xa 5 + a6 Now the binomial theorem can be formally stated. n n n n ( ax + b) n = ( ax ) n b0 + ( ax ) n 1 b1 + . . . + ( ax )1 bn 1 + ( ax )0 bn n 1 n 1 0 Notes 1. The indices always sum to n, that is, the powers of (ax) and b sum to n. 2. The power of ax decreases from left to right while the power of b increases. 3. The number of terms in the expansion is always n + 1. n (ax)n r br. 4. The (r + 1)th term is r The binomial theorem can also be stated using summation notation: ( ax + b) n = ( ax ) n r br r
n
, where
r=0
r= 0
Worked exAMple 1
Method 1: Technology-free
1
Complete the binomial theorem expansion where ax is the 1st term, b is the 2nd term and n is the index, using the appropriate row of Pascals triangle to assist.
2 3
Method 2: Technology-enabled 1 On a Calculator page, press: MENu b 3:Algebra3 2:Expand2 Complete the entry line as: expand((2x 3)4) Then press ENTER .
Worked exAMple 2
WrITe
Complete the binomial expansion where 2 ax = 2 , b = x and n = 5, using row 5 of Pascals x triangle to assist. Evaluate the powers.
2 2 2 2 + x = 2 + 5 2 x + 10 2 x 2 x2 x x x 2 2 2 + 10 2 x 3 + 5 2 x 4 + x 5 x x 32 16 8 + 5 8 x + 10 6 x 2 x x x10 4 2 + 10 4 x 3 + 5 2 x 4 + x 5 x x 32 80 80 40 = 10 + 7 + 4 + + 10 x 2 + x 5 x x x x =
Simplify.
Chapter 1
Worked exAMple 3
eBook plus
x2
and
ii
x4
in
( 3 2 x )8
Tutorial
int-0516
Worked example 3
The powers of the 1st term decrease and the powers of the 2nd term increase 0, 1, 2, . . . use this to find which term gives a power of x2. Find the appropriate term by using the binomial theorem. Evaluate the term. State the coefficient. Find which term gives a power of x4. Evaluate the term.
i x0, x1, x2
2 3 4
Third term =
8 6 2 3 ( 2x) 2
ii
The fifth term gives a power of x4. 8 4 4 3 ( 2x) Fifth term = 4 = 70 81 16x4 = 90 720x4
Worked exAMple 4
WrITe
Find the fourth term by using the binomial theorem. Evaluate the term.
Worked exAMple 5
WrITe
Find how the powers of x are generated in the expansion from left to right.
1 Powers of x are (x3)5 = x15, (x3)4 2 = x10, x 2 3 1 1 (x3)3 = x5, (x3)2 = x0 . . . x2 x2 that is, x15, x10, x5, x0.
2 3
= 10 x 6 = 10
4
1 6 x
Worked Example 6
Write
y4 terms will result when multiplying from the first and second brackets respectively: terms 1 and 2, terms 2 and 3, terms 3 and 4 and terms 4 and 5. Write down the sum of these 4 products, using Pascals triangle to assist. Evaluate. State the solution. y4 terms = y3[5(2)4(y)] + 3y2(3)[10(2)3(y)2] + 3y(3)2[10(2)2(y)3] + 33[5(2)(y)4] = 80y4 + 720y4 1080y4 + 270y4 = 170y4 The coefficient of y4 is 170.
REMEMBER
n n n n (ax + b) n = (ax ) n b 0 + (ax ) n 1 b + .. . + (ax )b n 1 + (ax )0 b n 1 n 0 n 1 Notes 1. The powers of (ax) and b sum to n. 2. There are n + 1 terms in the expansion. n 3. The (r + 1)th term is (ax ) n r br . r
exerCISe
1A
eBook plus
Digital doc
SkillSHEET 1.1
Binomial expansions
c (x 1)8 f (2 3x)5
d 3 2 x x2
6
State the coefficient of i x2 ii x3 and iii x4 in each of the following. b (2x + 1)5 c 2 + 3x x
3
d x2 3 x
e 7x + 3 x2
5 4 MC The coefficient of x3 in 3 x 2 is: x 135 B 45 C 75 A 5 MC Which of the following does not have an A (x + 6)8 B 3x 2 1 x
5 7
E 135 E 2x 1 x2
8
C 6x + 5 x
D (8 3x)5
e f 2 6 MC If x 3 + 2 = ax15 + bx10 + cx 5 + d + 5 + 10 , then a + b + c + d + e + f equals: x x x A 15 B 31 C 63 D 243 E 127 7 MC Which one of the following expressions is not equal to (2x 3)4? A (3 2x)
4
B (2x 3)(2x
3)3
( 2 x 3)6 ( 3 2 x )2
8 We4 Find the fourth term in the expansion (x + 3y)6. 9 10 11 12 13 x , assuming ascending powers of x. 4 6 2 We5 Find and evaluate the term that is independent of x in the expansion of 3 x + 2 . x 5 2 4 Find and evaluate the term independent of x in the expansion of x 3 . x 4 3 Find and evaluate the term that is independent of x in the expansion of x 2 + 2 . x We6 Find the coefficient of p4 in the expansion of (p + 3)5 (2p 5). Find the third term in the expansion of 3
14 In the expansion of (2a 1)n, the coefficient of the second term is 192. Find the value of n.
1B
polynomials
A polynomial in x is an expression that consists of terms which have non-negative integer powers of x only. P(x) is a polynomial in x if: P(x) = an xn + an 1 xn 1 + . . . + a2 x2 + a1 x + a0
where n is the degree (or highest power) of the polynomial and is a non-negative integer. The values of an, an 1, . . ., a2, a1 and a0 are called the coefficients of their respective power of x terms.
Worked Example 7
b x 2 + x3 x2 + 6 x 5
d 8 + 2 x 3 x2 + 9 x3 x4
2 x2
Write
is not an integer.
1 2
Worked Example 8
Method 1: Technology-free
a
1 2
Add the polynomials. Collect like terms. Subtract the polynomials. Remove brackets. Collect like terms.
+ x2 5x 2
= x5 x4 + 4x2 7x + 4
b P(x) R(x) = 6 2x + 3x2 + x4 (x2 4)
1 2 3
= 6 2x + 3x2 + x4 x2 + 4 = x4 + 2x2 2x + 10
Method 2: Technology-enabled
a
1
On a Calculator page, define the polynomials P(x), Q(x) and R(x). To do this, press: Menu b 1:Actions 1 1:Define 1 Complete the entry lines as: Define p(x) = 6 - 2x + 3x2 + x4 Define q(x) = x5 - 2x4 + x2 - 5x - 2 Define r(x) = x2 - 4 Press ENTER after each entry.
To calculate P(x) + Q(x), complete the entry line as: p(x) + q(x) Press ENTER
To calculate P(x) - R(x), complete the entry line as: p(x) - r(x) Press ENTER .
Evaluating polynomials
A value for a polynomial, P(x), can be found for a particular value of x by simply substituting the given value of x into the polynomial expression and evaluating. That is, polynomial functions are evaluated in the same way as any function.
Worked Example 9
The degree of the polynomial is the highest power of x. b 1 Substitute the given value of x into the polynomial expression.
2
Evaluate. Substitute the given value of x into the polynomial expression. Evaluate.
c
1 2
Worked Example 10
Method 1: Technology-free
1 2 3 4 5
Substitute a given value of x into the polynomial and equate it to the given answer. Simplify the equation. Make b the subject of the equation and call this equation [1]. Substitute a given value of x into the polynomial and equate it to the given answer. Simplify the equation.
+ 1 + 3 b 5 = 5 a + 4 b = 0 b = 4 a [1]
P(2) = a(2)5 + (2)4 3(2)3 + b(2) 5 = 65 32a + 16 24 + 2b 5 = 65 32a + 2b 13 = 65 32a + 2b = 52 Substituting b = 4 a: 32a + 2(4 a) = 52 32a + 8 2a = 52 30a = 60 a = 2
[2]
6 7
8 9 10
Substitute the value of a into equation [1]. Find the value of b. State the solution.
and b = 6.
Method 2: Technology-enabled 1 On a Calculator page, define the polynomial P(x) by completing the entry line as: Defi nep(x) = a x5 + x4 3x3 + b x 5 Then press ENTER . To calculate the values of a and b, complete the entry line as: solve (p(1) = 5 and p(2) = 65,a) Then press ENTER .
Given p(x) = ax5 + x4 3x3 + bx 5 and solving p(1) = 5 and p(2) = 65 gives a = 2 and b = 6.
reMeMBer
1. If P(x) = a nx n + an 1xn 1 + . . . + a2x2 + a1x + a0 and n is a non-negative integer then P(x) is a polynomial of degree n and an, an 1, . . . a2, a1 are called coefficients and R. 2. A polynomial P(x) is evaluated in the same way as any function. exerCISe
1B
polynomials
1 We 7 i x3 2x iv 3x8 2x5 + x2 7 Which of the following are not polynomial expressions? ii x4 + 3x2 2x + x v 4x6 x3 + 2x 3 iii x7 + 3x6 2xy + 5x vi 2 x 5 + x 4 x 3 + x 2 + 3 x 2 x
2 We8 Given that P(x) = 8 3x + 2x2 + x4, Q(x) = x5 3x4 4x2 1 and R(x) = 8x3 + 7x2 4x then find: a P(x) + Q(x) b Q(x) R(x) c 3P(x) 2R(x) d 2P(x) Q(x) + 3R(x).
eBook plus
Digital doc
3 We9 For each of the following polynomials, find: i its degree ii P(0) iii P(2) and iv P(1). a P(x) = x6 + 2x5 x3 + x2 c P(x) = 5x6 + 3x4 2x3 6x2 + 3 b P(x) = 3x7 2x6 + x5 8 d P(x) = 7 + 2x 5x2 + 2x3 3x4 E 103
Spreadsheet 043
Evaluating polynomials
4 MC If P(x) = x8 3x6 + 2x4 x2 + 3, then P(2) is equal to: A 479 B 95 C 31 D 481 5 We 10 6 7 8 9 If P(x) = 2x7 + ax5 + 3x3 ax4
eBook plus
Digital doc
SkillSHEET 1.2
Simultaneous equations
Find a and b, given that f (x) = + bx3 3x2 4x + 7, f (1) = 2 and f (2) = 5. For Q(x) = x5 + 2x4 + ax3 6x + b, Q(2) = 45 and Q(0) = 7. Find a and b. Find a and b if P(x) = ax6 + bx4 + x3 6, 3P(1) = 24 and 3P(2) = 102.
MC
a A 1
E E
2 1
1C
division of polynomials
eBook plus
Interactivity When sketching cubic or higher order graphs, it is necessary to int-0246 factorise the polynomials in order to find the x-intercepts. As will be Division of polynomials shown later in this section, division of polynomials can be used to factorise an expression. When one polynomial, P(x), is divided by another, D(x), the result can be expressed as: P( x) R( x ) = Q( x ) + D( x ) D( x ) where Q(x) is called the quotient, R(x) is called the remainder, and D(x) is called the divisor.
Worked exAMple 11
eBook plus
Tutorial
Find the quotient, Q(x), and the remainder, R(x), when x 4 3 x 3 + 2 x 2 8 is divided by the linear expression x + 2.
ThINk WrITe
int-0517
Worked example 11
Method 1: Technology-free
1
Set out the long division with each polynomial in descending powers of x. If one of the powers of x is missing, include it with 0 as the coefficient. Dividex into x4 and write the result above. Multiply the result underneath. x3 by x + 2 and write the result
x + 2 x 4 3x3 + 2 x 2 + 0 x 8 x3 x + 2 x 3x 3 + 2 x 2 + 0 x 8
)
) )
Subtract and bring down the remaining terms to complete the expression.
x4
5 6
Dividex into 5x3 and write the result above. Continue this process to complete the long division. x+2
7 8
The polynomial x3 5x2 + 12x 24, at the top, is the quotient. The result of the final subtraction, 40, is the remainder.
(x 4 + 2x3 ) 5x3 + 2 x 2 + 0 x 8 ( 5 x 3 10 x 2 ) 12 x 2 + 0 x 8 (12 x 2 + 24 x ) 24 x 8 ( 24 x 48) 40 The quotient, Q(x), is x3 5x2 + 12x 24. The remainder, R(x), is 40.
x 3 5 x 2 + 12 x 24 x4 3x3 + 2 x 2 + 0 x 8
Chapter 1
11
Method 2: Technology-enabled
1
On a Calculator page, press: Menu b 2:Number 2 8:Fraction Tools 8 1:Proper Fraction 1 Complete the entry line as: x 4 3x3 + 2 x 2 8 propFrac ( ) x+2 Then press ENTER .
Dividing x4 - 3x3 + 2x2 - 8 by x + 2 gives a quotient, Q(x), of x 3 5 x 2 + 12 x 24 and a remainder, R(x), of 40.
Note: P(2) = (2)4 3(2)3 + 2(2)2 8 = 16 + 24 + 8 8 = 40 The remainder when P(x) is divided by (x + 2) is P(2). This leads to the remainder theorem, which states: When P(x) is divided by ( x a), the remainder is P(a) or when P(x) is divided by ( ax + b), the remainder is P b . a Furthermore, if the remainder is zero, then (x a) is a factor of P(x). This leads to the factor theorem, which states: If P( a) = 0, then ( x a) is a factor of P(x) or b if ( ax + b) is a factor of P(x), then P = 0. a Note: If (x a) is a factor of P(x) and a is an integer, then a must be a factor of the term independent of x. For example, if (x 2) is a factor of P(x), then the term independent of x must be divisible by 2. Therefore, (x 2) could be a factor of x3 2x2 x + 2, but (x + 3) could not be a factor.
Worked Example 12
Method 1: Technology-free
1
Evaluate P(3).
12
If P(3) = 0 then (x 3) is a factor of P(x), but if P(x) 0, (x 3) is not a factor of P(x). On a Calculator page, define P(x) by completing the entry lines as: Define p( x ) = 2 x 3 4 x 2 3 x 8 p(3) Press ENTER after each entry.
Method 2: Technology-enabled
1
Method 1: Technology-free
a
1
Use the factor theorem to find a value for a where P(a) = 0 and a is afactor of the numerical term. Try a = 1, 1, 2, 2, 3, 3, 6, 6 until a factor is found.
P(1) = 2(1)3 (1)2 13(1) 6 = 18 0 P(1) = 2(1)3 (1)2 13(1) 6 =4 0 P(2) = 2(2)3 (2)2 13(2) 6 = 20 0 P(2) = 2(2)3 (2)2 13(2) 6 =0 So (x + 2) is a factor. x + 2 2 x 3 x 2 13 x 6 (2 x 3 + 4 x 2 ) 5 x 2 13 x 6 ( 5 x 2 10 x ) 3x 6 ( 3 x 6) 0 P(x) = (x + 2)(2x2 5x 3) = (x + 2)(2x + 1)(x 3)
2 x 2 5x 3
3 4
Express P(x) as a product of linear and quadratic factors. Factorise the quadratic, if possible.
13
1 2
b 2x3 x2 13x 6 = 0
Use the Null Factor Law to state the solutions. Method 2: Technology-enabled
a
1
(x + 2)(2x + 1)(x 3) = 0 x = 2, 1 or 3 2
On a Calculator page, define the polynomial P(x) by completing the entry line as: Define p( x ) = 2 x 3 x 2 13 x 6 Then press ENTER . To factorise P(x), complete the entry line as: factor (p(x)) Then press ENTER .
Write the answer. To solve P(x) = 0, complete the entry line as: solve ( p( x ) = 0, x ) Then press ENTER .
b
REMEMBER
P( x) R( x ) = Q( x ) + D( x ) D( x ) where Q(x) is called the quotient, R(x) is called the remainder, D(x) is called the divisor. 2. Remainder theorem: If P(x) is divided by (x a), then the remainder is P(a). 3. Factor theorem: If P(a) = 0, then (x a) is a factor of P(x). b If (ax + b) is a factor of P(x), then P = 0. a 4. If (x a) is a factor of P(x), then a must be a factor of the term independent of x. 1.
14
exerCISe
1C
division of polynomials
1 We 11 Find the quotient, Q(x), and the remainder, R(x), when each of the following polynomials are divided by the given linear expression. a x3 2x2 + 5x 2, x 4 b x5 3x3 + 4x + 3, x + 3 c 6x4 x3 + 2x2 4x, x 3 d 3x4 6x3 + 12x, 3x + 1 2 a For each corresponding polynomial in question 1, evaluate: i P(4) ii P(3) iii P(3) 3 We 12 a b c d iv P(
1 ) 3
b Compare these values to R(x) in question 1 and comment on the result. In each of the following determine whether or not D(x) is a factor of P(x). P(x) = x3 + 9x2 + 26x 30, D(x) = x 3 P(x) = x4 x3 5x2 2x 8, D(x) = x + 2 P(x) = 4 9x + 6x2 13x3 12x4 + 3x5, D(x) = 4 x P(x) = 4x6 + 2x5 8x4 4x3 + 6x2 9x 6, D(x) = 2x + 1
eBook plus
Digital doc
4 MC Examine the equation f (x) = x4 4x3 x2 + 16x 12. a Which one of the following is a factor of f (x)? A x+1 B x C x+2 D x+3 b When factorised, f (x) is equal to: A (x + 1)(x 3)(x + 4) C (x + 2)(x 4)(x + 3)(x + 1) E x(x 1)(x + 2)(x + 3) B (x + 2)(x 2)(x 3)(x 1) D (x 1)(x + 1)(x 3)(x 4)
E x4
Spreadsheet 096
Finding factors of polynomials
5 We 13a Factorise the following polynomials. b P(x) = 3x3 13x2 32x + 12 a P(x) = x3 + 4x2 3x 18 c P(x) = x4 + 2x3 7x2 8x + 12 d P(x) = 4x4 + 12x3 24x2 32x
eBook plus
Digital doc
6 We13b Solve each of the following equations. b 2x4 + 10x3 4x2 48x = 0 a 3x3 + 3x2 18x = 0 c 2x4 + x3 14x2 4x + 24 = 0 7 If (x 2) is a factor of 8 If (x 1) is a factor of x3 x3 + + ax2 x2 d x4 2x2 + 1 = 0 6x 4, then find a.
WorkSHEET 1.1
ax + 3, then find a.
9 Find the value of a if (x + 3) is a factor of 2x4 + ax3 3x + 18. 10 Find the value of a and b if (x + 1) and (x 2) are factors of ax3 4x2 + bx 12. 11 If (2x 3) and (x + 2) are factors of 2x3 + ax2 + bx + 30, find the values of a and b.
1d
linear graphs
Linear graphs are polynomials of degree 1. Graphs of linear functions are straight lines and may be sketched by finding the intercepts.
Chapter 1
15
2. The general equation of a straight line is: y = mx + c where m is the gradient and c is the value of the y-intercept. 3. The equation of a straight line passing through the point (x1, y1) and having a gradient of m is: y y1 = m(x x1)
Gradient = m
A (x1, y1) 0 x
y (0, b)
(a, 0)
5. Parallel lines have the same gradient. 6. The product of the gradients of two lines that are perpendicular equals 1. 1 That is, m1 m2 = 1 or m1 = m2
Worked Example 14
Write/Draw
Substitute y = 0 into the equation. Solve the equation for x to find the x-intercept. Substitute x = 0 into the equation. Solve the equation for y to find the y-intercept. Draw a set of axes. Indicate the x-intercept and y-intercept and rule a line through these points.
Worked Example 15
Find the equation, in the form ax + by + c = 0, of each straight line described below. a The line with a gradient of 2 and passing through ( 3, 2 ) b The line passing through (0, 8) and ( 2, 2 ) c The line that passes through (3, 4) and is parallel to the line with equation y 2 x 5 = 0 d The line that passes through (1, 3) and is perpendicular to the line with equation y + 2 x 3 = 0
16
ThINk a
1
WrITe
Write the rule for the pointgradient form of the equation of a straight line, y y1 = m(x x1). Substitute the value of the gradient, m, and the coordinates of the point (x1, y1), into the equation. Expand the brackets. Express the equation in the form required. Write the rule for the gradient, m, of a straight line, given 2 points. Substitute the values of (x1, y1) and (x2, y2) into the rule and evaluate the gradient.
y y1 = m(x x1)
y (2) = 2(x 3)
3 4
y + 2 = 2x 6 y 2x + 8 = 0 or 2x y 8 = 0 y y1 b m= 2 x2 x1 28 0 6 = 2 =3 =
2
1 2
Substitute the values of m and (x1, y1) into the rule for the pointgradient form of the equation of a straight line. (Coordinates of either point given may be used.) Expand the brackets. Express the equation in the form required. State the gradient of the given line, which is the same as the gradient of the parallel line. Write the rule for the pointgradient form of the equation of a straight line. Substitute the values of m and the coordinates (x1, y1) = (3, 4). Simplify and write in the required form. Find the gradient of the given line. Find the gradient of the perpendicular line. Write the rule for the pointgradient form of the equation of a straight line. Substitute the values of m and the coordinates (x1, y1) = (1, 3). Simplify and write in the required form.
4 5
y 8 = 3x 3x y + 8 = 0
c y 2x 5 = 0 becomes y = 2x + 5.
2 3 4
1 2 3 4 5
d y = 2x + 3
Chapter 1
17
Interval notation
Restricted domains or ranges can be represented by interval notation in three forms. 1. The closed interval. 2. The open interval. 3. The half-open interval.
a b a b a b
[a, b] = {x : a x b}
[a, b) = {x : a x < b}
If the domain or range is unrestricted, it can be denoted as R or (, ). R+ = (0, ) R+ {0} = [0, ) R = ( , 0) R {0} = (, 0]
Worked exAMple 16
Sketch the graph of each of the following functions, stating the domain and range of each. a 4 x 2 y = 8, x [ 3, 3] b f ( x ) = 1 2 x, x ( , 1)
ThINk a
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
WrITe/drAW/dISplAy
Substitute the smallest value of x into the equation. Solve the equation for y, to find an end point of the straight line. State the coordinates of the end point. Substitute the largest value of x into the equation. Solve the equation for y, to find the other end point of the line. State the coordinates of the 2nd end point. Plot the two points on a set of axes with closed circles (since both points are included).
a When x = 3,
12
2y = 8
2y
= 20 y = 10
= 4 y=2
(3, 2) 2 3 x
4x 2y = 8, x [3, 3]
18
8 9
Draw a straight line between the two points. Find the intercepts and mark them on the graph. State the domain, which is given with the rule. State the range from the graph. When x = 0, y = 4 When y = 0, x = 2 The x-intercept is 2 and the y-intercept is 4. The domain is [3, 3]. The range is [10, 2].
b When x = 1,
10 11
Method 1: Technology-free
b
1
There is no smallest value of x, so substitute the largest value of x into the equation and find y. State the coordinates of the upper end point. Substitute another value of x within the domain into the equation (that is, a value of x < 1, since x (, 1)) and find y. State the coordinates of the point. Plot the 2 points on a set of axes and mark the point (1, 3) with an open circle. Rule a straight line from (1, 3) to (2, 5) and beyond. An arrow should be placed on the other end to indicate that the line continues. Note that there are no intercepts. State the domain, which is given with the rule. State the range by examining the graph.
y = f (1) =3
2 3
(1, 3) is an open end of the line. When x = 2, y = f (2) =5 (2, 5) is another point on the line.
f(x) = 1 2x, x (, 1) (2, 5) (1, 3) y 5 3
4 5
2 1 0
7 8 9
Method 2: Technology-enabled n a Graphs page, complete the function entry O line as: f 1( x ) = 1 2 x | < x < 1 Then press ENTER .
19
reMeMBer
Linear graphs 1. Linear equations are polynomials of degree 1. y y1 2. Gradient, m = 2 x2 x1 3. General equation is ax + by + c = 0 or y = mx + c where m = gradient and c = y-intercept. 4. Equation if a point and the gradient are known: y y1 = m(x x1) 5. Equation if the intercepts are known: x y + =1 a b 6. Parallel lines have the same gradient. 7. If m1 and m2 are the gradients of perpendicular lines, then: m1 m2 = 1 1 m1 = or m2
exerCISe
1d
linear graphs
1 We 14 Sketch the graph of each of the following linear functions by indicating the intercepts. a 2x + 3y = 12 b 2y 5x 10 = 0 c 2x y = 1 2 We 15a Find the equation, in the form ax + by + c = 0, of each straight line described below. a The line with a gradient of 3 and passing through (2, 1). b The line with a gradient of 2 and passing through (4, 3).
eBook plus
Digital doc
SkillSHEET 1.3
Gradient
3 We 15b Find the equation, in the form ax + by + c = 0, of each straight line described below. a The line passing through (3, 4) and (1, 10). b The line passing through (7, 5) and (2, 0). 4 MC Which one of the following points does not lie on the straight line with equation 2y 3x 6 = 0? A (2, 6) B (2, 0) C (0, 3) D (1, 2) E (4, 9) 5 We 15c Consider the points A(2, 5) and B(1, b). a Find b if: i the gradient of the straight line AB is 2 ii the equation of the straight line AB is y x = 7. b Find the general equation of the straight line which passes through (4, 5) and is parallel to the line with equation y 3x + 4 = 0. c We 15d Find the equation in the form ax + by + c = 0 that passes through (2, 4) and is perpendicular to the line with equation 2y x + 1 = 0.
eBook plus
Digital doc
SkillSHEET 1.4
Using gradient to nd the value of a parameter
20
6 Match each of the following graphs with the appropriate rule below. b c a y y y
2 0 1 0 y x (2, 4) x 2 0 3 x
e
4
y 0 2 x
y 3 0 x
i x + 2y + 4 = 0 iv 3y + 2x = 6
eBook plus
Digital doc
ii y = 3 v y 2x = 0 b
iii y 2x 2 = 0 vi x = 2 c
x 0 (6, 5) (4, 2) x
SkillSHEET 1.5
Interval notation
eBook plus
Digital doc
(3, 3)
(5, 6)
SkillSHEET 1.6
Domain and range for linear graphs
x (5, 2)
8 We 16 Sketch the graph of each of the following functions, stating i the domain and i i the range of each. a 4y + 3x = 24, x [12, 12] b 2x 5y = 10, x < 5 c 4x 3y 6 = 0, x [2, 5) 9 Find the equation of the straight line which passes through the point (2, 5) and is: a parallel to the line with equation y = 3 2x b perpendicular to the line with equation y = 3x 7. Write equations in the form ax + by + c = 0. 10 Find the equation of the straight line which passes through the point (3, 1) and is: a parallel to the line with equation 4x 2y = 13 b perpendicular to the line with equation 4x 2y = 13. 11 MC If the straight lines 3x y = 2 and ax + 2y = 3 are parallel then a = : A 6 B 2 C 2 D 3 E 6 12 MC If the straight lines 5x + y 3 = 0 and bx y 2 = 0 are perpendicular, then b is equal to: A 5 B
1 5
C 5
1 5
E 3
Chapter 1
21
1e
Quadratic graphs
Quadratic functions are polynomials of degree 2. Graphs of quadratic functions are parabolas and may be sketched by finding the turning point and intercepts.
The discriminant
The value of (b2 4ac), which is the value inside the square root sign in the quadratic formula, determines the number of solutions to a quadratic equation or the number of x-intercepts on a quadratic graph. This value is called the discriminant. 1. If b2 4ac > 0, there are two solutions to the equation and there are two x-intercepts on the graph. 2. If b2 4ac > 0 and is a perfect square, the solutions are rational; otherwise they are irrational. 3. If b2 4ac = 0, the two solutions are equal and there is one x-intercept on the graph; that is, the graph has a turning point on the x-axis. 4. If b2 4ac < 0, there are no real solutions and there are no x-intercepts on the graph.
Worked exAMple 17
eBook plus
Tutorial
Use the discriminant to determine the number of x-intercepts for the quadratic function f ( x ) = 2 x 2 + 3 x 10.
ThINk
1
int-0518
Worked example 17
WrITe
Find the values of the quadratic coefficients a, b and c using the general quadratic function, y = ax2 + bx + c. Evaluate the discriminant.
a = 2,
b = 3, c = 10
b2 4ac = 32 4(2)(10) = 9 + 80 = 89 b2 4ac > 0 So there are two x-intercepts, which are both irrational.
If the discriminant is greater than 0, there are two x-intercepts. If it is not a perfect square, the solutions are irrational.
22
Worked Example 18
Sketch the graph of the function f ( x ) = 12 5 x 2 x 2, showing all intercepts. Give exact answers.
Think
1 2 3 4 5
Write/draw
Evaluate f (0) to find the y-intercept (or state the value of c). State the y-intercept. Set f(x) = 0 to find the x-intercepts. Factorise the quadratic (or use the quadratic formula). Solve the equation using the Null Factor Law. State the x-intercepts. Draw a set of axes and mark the intercepts or the coordinates of the points where the graph crosses the axes. Sketch a parabola through the intercepts.
f(0) = 12 5(0) 2(0)2 = 12 The y-intercept is 12. f(x) = 12 5x 2x2 = 0 (4 + x)(3 2x) = 0 4 + x = 0 or 3 2x = 0 x = 4 or x = 3 2 The x-intercepts are 4 and 2 .
y 12 (0, 12) f(x) = 12 5x x2 (4, 0) 4
, 0) (3 2 x 0 1 2
6 7
The x-coordinate of the turning point of a quadratic function is exactly halfway between 4 + 3 5 2 = the two x-intercepts, so for worked example 18, x = (or 1 1 ). Substitute x = 5 4 4 2 4 into the original equation to find the y-coordinate of the turning point. b The x-coordinate of the turning point can also be found by using the formula x = , where 2a ax2 + bx + c = 0.
For the function y = 2( x + 3)2 4, find: a the coordinates of the turning pointb the domain and range.
Think Write
23
State the coordinates of the turning point (b, c). Write the domain of the parabola. Write the range y c (as a < 0).
b 1
2
The range is y 4.
Worked Example 20
The function graphed at right is of the form y = x 2 + bx + c. Find: a the ruleb the domainc the range. Write the answers to b and c in interval notation.
y (5, 10)
0 (1, 6) Think a
1 2 3 4 5 6
Write
Write the general rule for a quadratic in turning point form. Find the values of b and c using the given turning point. State the value of a (given). Substitute these values in the rule. Expand the brackets. Simplify. Use the graph to find the domain. Look at all the values that x can take. State the domain in interval notation. Use the graph to find the range. Look at all the values that y can take. State the range in interval notation.
a y = a(x b)2 + c
Since the turning point is (1, 6): b = 1, c = 6 a=1 So y = 1(x + 1)2 6 = x2 + 2x + 1 6 = x2 + 2x 5 The rule is y = x2 + 2x 5.
b x 5
1 2
Domain = [5, )
c y 6
1 2
Range = [6, )
Worked Example 21
Sketch the graph of y = 2 ( x 1)2 + 2, clearly showing the coordinates of the turning point and the intercepts with the axes. State its range.
Think
1 2
Write/Draw
Write the general equation of the parabola. Identify the values of the variables.
24
The graph of y = x2 is dilated in the y direction by the factor of 1 (that is, it is wider than the 2 basic curve); it is translated 1 unit to the right and 2 units up. a > 0; the parabola is positive. The turning point is (1, 2). y-intercept: x = 0 y=1 (0 1)2 + 2 2 =1 (1)2 + 2 2 =1 +2 2 = 21 2
4 5 6
State the shape of the parabola (that is, positive or negative). State the coordinates of the turning point (b, c). As both a and c are positive, only the y-intercept needs to be determined. Find the y-intercept by making x = 0.
Sketch the graph: Drawasetofaxesandlabelthem.Plottheturning point and the y-intercept. Sketch the graph of the positive parabola, so that it passes through the points previously marked.
2 2 2 0 x 1 (x 1)2 + 2 y= 1 2
Worked exAMple 22
Sketch the graph of y = 3 + 8 x 2 x 2, showing the turning point and all intercepts, rounding answers to 2 decimal places where appropriate.
ThINk WrITe/drAW
Method 1: Technology-free
1 2 3 4
Find y when x = 0. State the y-intercept. Let the quadratic equal zero. Solve for x using the quadratic formula.
82 4( 2)(3) 2( 2) 88 22 22 22 2 22 2
=2
or
2+
Chapter 1
25
5 6
State the x-intercepts, rounding to 2 decimal places. Use the formula for the x-value of the turning b point, x = . 2a To calculate the y-coordinate of the turning point, substitute x = 2 into the function. State the turning point. Draw a set of axes and mark the coordinates of the turning point and the points where the graph crosses the axes. Sketch a parabola through these points.
x=
8 9
(2, 11)
10
Method 2: Technology-enabled On a Graphs page, complete the function entry line as: f(x) = 3 + 8x - 2x2 Then press ENTER . To label the coordinates of the intercepts and turning point, press: Menu b 6:Analyze Graph 6 Select the appropriate action.
Note: Function notation includes the rule, the domain and the co-domain. For example, f(x): [2, 1] R, where f (x) = x2 3, is a parabola with rule f (x) = x2 3 and domain [2, 1]. The range is a subset of the co-domain, R.
Worked Example 23
The weight of a person t months after a gymnasium program is started is given by the 2 function: W ( t ) = t 3 t + 80, where t [0, 8] 2 and W is in kilograms. Find: a the minimum weight of the person b the maximum weight of the person.
26
Think
1
Write
W=
t2 3t + 80 2 1 = 2 [t 2 6t + 160] = 2 [t 2 6t + 9 + 160 9]
1 1 1
State the minimum turning point. Find the end point value for W when t = 0. State its coordinates. Find the end point value of W when t = 8. State its coordinates. On a set of axes, mark the end points and turning point. Sketch a parabola between the end points. Locate the maximum and minimum values of W on the graph.
The turning point is (3, 75.5). When t = 0, W = 80 One end point is (0, 80). When t = 8, W = 88 The other end point is (8, 88).
W (kg) 90 80 (0, 80) 70 Minimum (3, 75.5) 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 t (months) Maximum (8, 88)
a b
State the minimum weight from the graph. State the maximum weight from the graph.
a b
REMEMBER
Quadratic graphs 1. Quadratic equations are polynomials of degree 2. 2. The general equation is y = ax2 + bx + c. 3. The quadratic formula is given by the equation b b 2 4 ac 2a 4. The discriminant is b2 4ac and if: (a) b2 4ac > 0, there are two x-intercepts. If b2 4ac is a perfect square, the intercepts are rational. (b) b2 4ac = 0, there is one x-intercept, which is a turning point. (c) b2 4ac < 0, there are no x-intercepts. 5. The turning point form of the quadratic graph or parabola is: y = a(x b)2 + c and the turning point is (b, c). 6. The equation of the axis of symmetry of a parabola and the x-value of the turning b point is given by the expression x = . 2a 7. The axis of symmetry is halfway between the x-intercepts. x=
27
exerCISe
1e
eBook plus
Digital doc
Quadratic graphs
1 We17 use the discriminant to determine the number of x-intercepts for each of the following quadratic functions. a f (x) = x2 3x + 4 b f (x) = x2 + 5x 8 c f (x) = 3x2 5x + 9 2 2 d f (x) = 2x + 7x 11 e f (x) = 1 6x x f f (x) = 3 + 6x + 3x2 2 We18 Sketch the graphs of each of the following functions, showing all intercepts. Give exact answers. a f (x) = x2 6x + 8 c f (x) = 10 + 3x x2 b f (x) = x2 5x + 4 d f (x) = 6x2 x 12
eBook plus
Digital doc
Spreadsheet 103
Discriminant
Spreadsheet 107
Quadratic graphs
3 Find the turning point for each of the functions in question 2. Give exact answers. 4 We19 For each of the following functions find: i the coordinates of the turning point ii the domain iii the range. 2 b y = (x 6)2 a y=2x c y = (x + 2)2 d y = 2(x + 3)2 6
eBook plus
Digital doc
SkillSHEET 1.7
Domain and range for quadratic graphs
5 We20 Each of the functions graphed below is of the form y = x2 + bx + c. For each function, give: i the rule ii the domain iii the range. Write the answers to b and c in interval notation. a
y
b
(1, 6)
(1, 9) 4 x
0 (1, 2)
0 (2, 3)
0 (4, 16)
6 We21 Sketch the graphs of the following, clearly showing the coordinates of the turning point and the intercepts with the axes. a y = 2x2 + 3 b y = (2x 5)(2x 3) c y = (2x 3)2 8 Consider the function with the rule y = x2 2x 3. 7 MC a It has x-intercepts: A (1, 0) and (3, 0) B (1, 0) and (3, 0) C (1, 0) and (3, 0) 1, 0) E (0, 1) and (0, 3) D (2, 0) and ( b It has a turning point with coordinates: A (1, 0) B (2, 3)
(x
eBook plus
Digital doc
Spreadsheet 041
Function grapher
C (1, 4) 3)2
D (1, 4)
E (1, 0) E R
9 MC The range of the function y = (x 4)2, x [0, 6] is: A [0, 16] B [4, 16] C [0, 4] D (4, 12]
10 We22 Sketch the graph of each of the following functions, showing the turning point and all intercepts. Round answers to 2 decimal places where appropriate. a f (x) = (x 2)2 4 b f (x) = (x + 4)2 + 9 2 c y = x + 4x + 3 d y = 2x2 4x 6
eBook plus
Digital doc
Spreadsheet 108
Quadratic graphs turning point form
28
11 Sketch the graph of each of the functions below and state i the domain and ii the range of each function. b y = x2 + x 1, x R+ a y = x2 2x + 2, x [2, 2] c f (x) = x2 3x 2, x [10, 6] d f (x) = 5 + 6x 3x2, x [5, 3) 12 We23 The volume of water in a tank, V m3, over a 10 month period is given by the function V(t ) = 2t 2 16 t + 40, where t is in months and t [0, 10]. Find: Maximum height a the minimum volume of water in the tank b the maximum volume of water in the tank. 13 A ball thrown upwards from a tower attains a height above the ground given by the function h(t) = 12t 3t2 + 36, where t is the time in seconds and h is in metres. Find: a the maximum height above the ground that the ball reaches b the time taken for the ball to reach the ground c the domain and range of the function.
Tower Ball
Ground
eBook plus
Digital doc
WorkSHEET 1.2
14 A section of a roller-coaster at an amusement park follows the path of a parabola. The function h(t) = t2 12t + 48, t [0, 11], models the height above the ground of the front of one of the carriages, where t is the time in seconds and h is the height in metres. a Find the lowest point of this section of the ride. b Find the time taken for the carriage to reach the lowest point. c Find the highest point above the ground. d Find the domain and the range of the function. e Sketch the function.
1F
Cubic graphs
Cubic functions are polynomials of degree 3. In this section, we will look at how graphs of cubic functions may be sketched by finding intercepts and recognising basic shapes.
General form
The general form of a cubic function is y = ax3 + bx2 + cx + d If a is positive (that is, a > 0), the function is called a positive cubic. Several positive cubics appear below.
y y y
x x x
Chapter 1
29
If a is negative (that is, a < 0), the function is called a negative cubic. Several negative cubics appear below.
y y y
x x
Basic form
Some (but certainly not all) cubic functions are transformations of the form y = x3, which has a point of inflection at the origin. These may be expressed in the power form y = a(x b)3 + c where (b, c) is the point of inflection. For example, y = 2(x 3)3 + 5 is the graph of y = x3 translated +3 from the y-axis, +5 in the y direction and dilated by a factor of 2 from the x-axis. This form, called basic form or power form, works in the same way as a quadratic equation expressed in turning point form or power form: y = a(x b)2 + c where (b, c) is the turning point and a is the dilation factor. The power form and its transformations will be discussed in more detail in chapter 2.
y y = x3 y y = a(x b)3 + c
(b, c) x
Factor form
Cubic functions of the type y = a(x b)(x c)(x d) are said to be in factor form, where b, c and d are the x-intercepts. Often a cubic function in general form may be factorised to express it in factor form.
y y = a(x b)(x c)(x d) where a > 0 y = (x + 2)(x 1)(x 3) y
2 b c d x
3 x
30
repeated factors
A twice only repeated factor in a factorised cubic function indicates a turning point that just touches the x-axis.
y a b x
y = (x a)2 (x b)
Worked exAMple 24
eBook plus
Tutorial
For each of the following graphs, find the rule and express it in factorised form. Assume that a = 1 or a = 1 . a
y f(x)
int-0519
f(x)
Worked example 24
x 2 0 3 x
ThINk a
1 2 3 4
WrITe
Find a by deciding whether the graph is a positive or negative cubic. use the x-intercepts 4, 0 and 3 to find the factors. Express f(x) as a product of a and its factors. Simplify. Find a by deciding whether the graph is a positive or negative cubic. use the x-intercept 2, which is also a turning point, to find the repeated factor. use the other x-intercept, 3, to find the other factor. Express f(x) as a product of a and its factors. Simplify.
The factors are (x + 4), x and (x 3). f(x) = 1(x + 4) x(x 3) f(x) = x(x + 4)(x 3)
b The graph is a negative cubic, so a = 1.
1 2 3 4 5
(x + 2)2 is a factor. (x 3) is also a factor. f(x) = 1(x + 2)2(x 3) f(x) = (3 x)(x + 2)2
Worked exAMple 25
WrITe/drAW
Find y when x = 0.
When
x = 0, y = 8
Chapter 1
31
2 3 4
State the y-intercept. Let P(x) = y. Use the factor theorem to find a factor of the cubic P(x) = x3 x2 10x 8.
The y-intercept is 8. Let P(x) = x3 x2 10x 8 P(1) = 13 12 10(1) 8 = 18 0 P(1) = (1)3 (1)2 10(1) 8 =0 so (x + 1) is a factor. By long division: x2 2x 8 x + 1 x 3 x 2 10 x 8 (x3 + x 2 ) 2 2 10 8 x x ( 2 x 2 2 x ) 8x 8 ( 8 x 8) 0 y = (x + 1)(x2 2x 8)
6 7 8
Factorise the quadratic, if possible. Express the cubic in factorised form and let it equal 0 to find the x-intercepts. Solve for x using the Null Factor Law. Alternatively, use a CAS calculator to solve for x.
9 10
8
Exam tip When sketching graphs, ensure that they are smooth, that relevant turning points and intercepts are labelled, and that they are drawn within the correct domain (end points should be shown using or ) using [Authors advice] an appropriate scale.
32
0 (4, 3)
Worked Example 26
Sketch the graph of y = x 3 5 x, where x ( 2, 1], using the unrestricted function as a guide. State the domain and range, without the use of technology.
Think
1 2
WRITE/DRAW
Decide whether it is a positive or negative cubic by looking at the coefficient of x3. Find the x-intercept/s.
Negative cubic When y = 0, x3 5x = 0 x(x2 + 5) = 0 x = 0 (x2 + 5 0) The x-intercept is 0. When x = 0, y = (0)3 5(0) =0 The y-intercept is 0. When x = 2, y = (2)3 5(2) = 18 The open end point is (2, 18). When x = 1, y = (1)3 5(1) =6 The closed end point is (1, 6).
y
4 5 6 7 8 9
Find y when x has the value of the lower end point of the domain. State the coordinates of this end point and decide whether it is open or closed. Find y when x has the value of the upper end point. State the coordinates of this end point and decide whether it is open or closed. Mark these points on a set of axes. Sketch the part of the cubic between the end points. Verify this graph using a graphics calculator.
(2, 18)
10
(1, 6) 0 x
11 12
State the domain, which is given with the rule. From the graph, state the range. Note that the intercept is not included in the domain.
33
reMeMBer
Cubic graphs 1. The general equation is y = ax3 + bx2 + cx + d. 2. Basic shapes of cubic graphs: (a) If a > 0: Positive cubic
y
Power form
y y = a(x b)3 + c
(b, c) x
Factor form
y y = a(x b)(x c)(x d) where a > 0
Repeated factor
y a b x
c d
y = (x a)2 (x b)
(b) If a < 0, the reflections through the x-axis of the types of graph in the above figures are obtained. exerCISe
1F
eBook plus
Digital doc
Cubic graphs
1 We24 For each of the following graphs, find the rule and express it in factorised form. Assume that a = 1 or a = 1. b a y y
Spreadsheet 013
Cubic graphs factor form
0 4
2 a
Match each of the following graphs to the most appropriate rule below.
y
0 1
2 0
34
f
2
y 0 5 x
4 0 3 x
i iii v vii
ii iv vi viii
3 We25 Sketch the graph of each of the following, showing all intercepts. a y = x3 + x2 4x 4 b y = 2x3 8x2 + 2x + 12 3 c y = 24 + 26x 2x d y = 18 21x + 8x2 x3 Verify your answers by using a calculator. 4 MC a Fully factorised, x3 + 6x2 + 12x + 8 is equal to: A (x + 3)3 B (x + 2)3 3 D (x 3) E (x + 2)(x 2)2 b The graph of y = x3 + 6x2 + 12x + 8 is: B A y y
Spreadsheet 014
Cubic graphs
C (x 2)3
D
2
y x
E
2
5 MC The function graphed in the figure could have the following rule: A y = (x 2)3 + 2 y B y = (x + 2)3 + 2 C y = (2 x)3 + 2 10 D y = (x + 2)3 2 3 E y = (x 2)
(2, 2) 0 x
Chapter 1
35
eBook plus
Digital doc
Spreadsheet 015
Cubic graphs y = a( x b ) 3 + c form
(1, 3)
x (1, 3)
x (1, 3)
D
(1, 3)
y (1, 3)
7 MC A
y (0, 6)
(1, 0) 0
(3, 0)
(3, 0)
(1, 0)
y (1, 0) (3, 0) 0 x
y (3, 0) 0 x
(1, 0)
(0, 6)
(0, 6)
E
(1, 0)
y (3, 0) 0 x
(0, 6)
36
8 MC
(a, b) (0, c) 0 x
9 MC A y = B y = C y = d y = E y =
If a < 0 and b, c > 0 then the graph shown is best represented by the equation: y b ( x + a ) 2 ( x c) 2 a c b ( x + a) 2 (c x ) b a2c b ( x a ) 2 ( x + c) a2c b a c 0 ( x + a)2 ( x b)(c x ) a2c b ( x a ) 2 ( x c) a2c
10 WE26 Sketch the graph of each of the following restricted functions, using the unrestricted function as a guide. State i the domain and ii the range in each case. a f(x) = x3 + x2 10x + 8, x [2, ) b f(x) = 3x3 5x2 4x + 4, x [2, 1] c f(x) = 3x3 + 4x2 + 27x 36, x (0, 1] d f(x) = 3x x3, x [1, 2) e f(x) = x3 + 2x, x [2, 1) (0, 3] f f(x) = 2x3 x, x (1, 1) [2, 3) 11 The function f(x) = x3 + ax2 + bx 64 has x-intercepts (2, 0) and (4, 0). Find the values of a and b. 12 The functions y = x3 2x2 + ax + 10 and y = 6 + (a + b)x 4x2 x3 both have (1, 0) as an x-intercept. Find the values of a and b. 13 The cross-section of a glass vessel that is 6 cm high can be modelled by the cubic function f(x) and its reflection through the y-axis, g(x), as shown at right. y f(x) = a(x + b)3 + c a Find the values of a, b and c, and hence state the rule g(x) (4, 6) of f(x). b Find the rule for g(x) and state its domain and range. (3, 3) c What is the width of the vessel when the height is 3.375 cm?
0 (2, 0) x
14 The distance of a group of hikers, d km, from their starting point t hours after setting off on a hike can be modelled by the function with the rule: d(t) = at2 (b t) The hikers are 3 km from the start after 2 hours and return to the starting point after 5hours. a Find the values of a and b. b Hence, give the rule for d(t ) stating its domain and range.
37
c Sketch the graph of d(t ). d Find to the nearest 100 metres the maximum distance of the hikers from their starting point and the time, to the nearest minute, that it occurs.
1G
Quartic graphs
Quartic functions are polynomials of degree 4. The general form of a quartic is: y = ax4 + bx3 + cx2 + dx + e When sketching the graphs of quartic functions, all axes intercepts can be found by factorisation and a sign diagram used to check the shape. If a sign diagram is not sufficient and the basic shape is not recognised, then a graphics calculator could be used to establish the shape of the graph.
2. y = ax4 + cx2, c 0
y
3. y = ax2(x b)(x c)
y
c x b 0 c x
The repeated factor x2 shows there is a turning point at the origin. The factors (x b) (x c) show x-intercepts at x = b and x = c. 5. y = a(x b)(x c)3
y
The repeated factors (x b)2 and (x c)2 show the graph touches the x-axis at x = b and x = c. 6. y = a(x b)(x c)(x d )(x e)
y
x b c 0 d ex
y 0 x
y = x 4 y x
y = x 4 + x2 Worked exAMple 27
eBook plus
x4
x3
7 x2
Tutorial
int-0520
Worked example 27
Let y = P(x). Find two linear factors of the quartic expression, if possible, using the factor theorem.
4 5
Find the product of the two linear factors. use long division to divide the quartic by the quadratic factor x2 x 2 (or use another method).
When x = 0, y = 10 The y-intercept is 10. Let P(x) = x4 x3 7x2 + 5x + 10 P(1) = (1)4 (1)3 7(1)2 + 5(1) + 10 =8 0 P(1) = (1)4 (1)3 7(1)2 + 5(1) + 10 =0 (x + 1) is a factor. P(2) = (2)4 (2)3 7(2)2 + 5(2) + 10 =0 (x 2) is a factor. (x + 1)(x 2) = x2 x 2 x2 x2
x2 x4
4
5 + 5 x + 10
x3
7
3
x2
(x x
2x2 )
0 5 x 2 + 5 x + 10 ( 5 x 2 + 5 x + 10) 0
6 7 8 9 10
Express the quartic in factorised form. Factorise the quadratic factor, x2 5, using difference of perfect squares. To find the x-intercepts, set y equal to zero. Solve for x using the Null Factor Law. State the x-intercepts.
y = (x + 1)(x 2)(x2 5) y = (x + 1)(x 2)(x + 5)(x 5) Let y = (x + 1)(x 2)(x + 5)(x 5) = 0 x = 1, 2, 5 The x-intercepts are 1, 2, 5 and 5.
Chapter 1
39
11
Method 2: Technology-enabled
1
On a Calculator page, define the polynomial P(x) by completing the entry line as: Define p( x ) = x 4 x 3 7 x 2 + 5 x + 10 Then press ENTER . To find the y-intercept, complete the entry line as: p(0) Then press ENTER . To find the x-intercepts, complete the entry line as: solve ( p( x ) = 0, x ) Then press ENTER .
To sketch the graph of P(x), open a Graphs page. Complete the function entry line as: f 1( x ) = p( x ) Then press ENTER .
Worked exAMple 28
eBook plus
Tutorial
Sketch the graphs of each of the following equations, showing the coordinates of all intercepts. Use a CAS calculator to find the coordinates of the turning points, rounding to 2 decimal places as appropriate. a y = x 2 ( x 1)( x + 2 )
b y = ( x + 3)2 ( x 1)2 ThINk a
1 2
int-0521
Worked example 28
WrITe/drAW
a y = x2(x 1)(x + 2)
40
When y = 0, 0 = x2(x 1)(x + 2) x = 2, 0, 1 The graph touches the x-axis at x = 0. The other x-intercepts are 2 and 1. The minimum turning points are (1.44, 2.83) and (0.69, 0.40). The maximum turning point is (0, 0).
y
State the x-intercepts, noting where the graph touches and where it cuts the x-axis. State the coordinates of the turning points. Sketch the graph of the quartic, using a CAS calculator to assist.
(2, 0)
(0, 0) 0
(1.44, 2.83) b
1 2
b y = (x + 3)2(x 1)2
When x = 0, y = (3)2(1)2 = 9 The y-intercept is 9. When y = 0, 0 = (x + 3)2(x 1)2 x = 3, 1 The graph touches the x-axis at x = 3 and x = 1.
State the points where the graph touches the x-axis from the repeated factors. State the coordinates of the turning points. Sketch the graph of the quartic, using a graphics calculator to assist.
5 6
The maximum turning points are (3, 0) and (1, 0), and the minimum turning point is (1, 16).
y (3, 0) 0 (1, 0) x
(0, 9)
(1, 16)
41
Worked Example 29
Think
Write/display
Method 1: Technology-free
1 2
State the x-intercepts. Write the equation using factor form with a dilation factor of a. State the y-intercept. Substitute the coordinates of the point where the graph crosses the y-axis into the equation. Solve the equation to find a.
The x-intercepts are 3, 1, 1, 2. y = a(x + 3)(x + 1)(x 1)(x 2) The y-intercept is 3. (0, 3) 3 = a(0 + 3)(0 + 1)(0 1)(0 2)
3 4
3=a6 a=
1 2
Method 2: Technology-enabled
1
On a Calculator page, complete the entry line as: a ( x + 3) ( x + 1) ( x 1) ( x 2) y Then press ENTER . To calculate the value of a, complete the entry line as: solve(y = 3, a) | x = 0 Then press ENTER . To find the equation of y, complete the entry line as: 1 y|a = 2 Then press ENTER . Write the equation. y= ( x 2)( x 1)( x + 1)( x + 3) 2
42
Worked Example 30
Sketch the graph of y = x 4 2 x 2 , x( 1, 1] , using the unrestricted function as a guide. State the domain and the range in each case.
Think
1 2
Write/Draw
3 4 5 6 7 8
State the y-intercept. Find the x-intercepts. Factorise the quartic expression. Solve for x. State the x-intercepts. Find y when x is one end point of the domain.
+ 2) = 0
x = 0 is the only solution (as x2 + 2 0). The only x-intercept is 0. When x = 1, y = (1)4 2(1)2 = 3 (1, 3) is an open end point. When x = 1, y = (1)4 2(1)2 = 3 (1, 3) is a closed end point.
y (0, 0) 0 (1, 3) x (1, 3) y = x 4 2x2
State the coordinates and whether it is an open or closed point. Find y when x is the other end point of the domain.
10
11 12
State the coordinates and whether it is an open or closed point. Sketch the graph of the quartic, using knowledge of basic shapes or a CAS calculator to assist, over the domain.
13 14
State the domain, which is given with the rule. From the graph, state the range.
43
REMEMBER
Quartic graphs 1. General equation is y = ax4 + bx3 + cx2 + dx + e. 2. Basic shapes of quartic graphs: (a) If a > 0:
y
y = ax4
0 y
y = ax4 + cx2, c 0
0 y
y = ax2(x b)(x c)
0 y
c 0
ex
(b) If a < 0, then the reflection through the x-axis of the types of graph in the figures above is obtained.
44
exerCISe
1G
eBook plus
Digital doc
Quartic graphs
1 We27 Sketch the graph of each of the following, showing all intercepts. a y = (x 2)(x + 3)(x 4)(x + 1) b y = 2x4 + 6x3 16x2 24x + 32 c y = x4 4x2 + 4 d y = 30x 37x2 + 15x3 2x4 e y = 6x4 + 11x3 37x2 36x + 36 2 We28 Sketch the graph of each of the following equations, showing the coordinates of all intercepts. use a calculator to find the coordinates of the turning points, rounding to 2 decimal places as appropriate. a y = x2 (x 2)(x 3) b y = (x + 1)2 (x 1)2 c y = (x 1)2(x + 1)(x + 3) d y = (x + 2)3 (1 x) 3 MC Consider the function f (x) = x4 8x2 + 16. a When factorised, f (x) is equal to: A (x + 2)(x 2)(x 1)(x + 4) C (x + 3)(x 2)(x 1)(x + 1) E (x 2)2 (x + 2)2 b The graph of f (x) is best represented by: B A y
2 0 2 x
SkillSHEET 1.8
Solving quartic equations
eBook plus
Digital doc
Spreadsheet 105
Quartic graphs factor form
y 16
y 16
16
0 y 4
y 16
c If the domain of f (x) is restricted to [2, 2], then the range is:
C [2, 12]
d If the range of f (x) is restricted to (0, 25) then the maximal domain is:
D (3, 3)
E (3, 4)
e If the domain of f (x) is restricted to (1, 0), then the range is:
A (0, 16) A R
C (1, 9) C [0, )
D (9, 16)
E [9, ) E [2, )
Graphs and polynomials 45
D [0, 16)
Chapter 1
4 We29 Determinetheequationofeachofthefollowinggraphs. b a y y
6 8
2 1 0
1 0
5 We30 Sketch the graph of each of the following restricted functions, using the unrestricted function as a guide. State i the domain and ii the range in each case. a y = (2 x)(x2 4)(x + 3), x [2, 3] b y = 9x4 30x3 + 13x2 + 20x + 4, x (2,1] c y = (x 2)2(x + 1)2, x (, 2] d y = 4x2 x4, x [3, 2] 6 The function f (x) = x4 + ax3 4x2 + bx + 6 has x-intercepts (2, 0) and (3, 0). Find the values of a and b. 7 The function f (x) = x4 + ax3 + bx2 x + 6 has x-intercepts (1, 0) and (3, 0). Find the values of a and b. 8 The functions y = (a 2b)x4 3x 2 and y = x4 x3 + (a + 5b)x2 5x + 7 both have an x-intercept of 1. Find the value of a and b.
eBook plus
Digital doc
Investigation
Quartics and beyond
46
Summary
Pascals triangle
1 1 1 1 1 1
Binomial theorem
1 2 1 3 6 4 10 5 1 1 1
3 4
10
n n n n (ax + b) n = (ax ) n b 0 + (ax ) n 1 b + .. . + (ax )b n 1 + (ax )0 b n 1 n 0 n 1 Notes 1. Indices add to n. 2. There are n + 1 terms in the expansion. n 3. The (r + 1)th term is (ax ) n r br . r
Polynomials
If P(x) = an xn + an 1 xn 1 + ... + a2 x2 + a1 x + a0 and n is a non-negative integer then P(x) is a polynomial of degree n and an, an 1, ... , a2, a1 are called coefficients and R. Remainder theorem: If P(x) is divided by (x a), then the remainder is P(a). If P(x) is divided by (ax + b) then the remainder is b P . a Factor theorem: 1. If P(a) = 0, then (x a) is a factor of P(x) or if (ax + b) is a factor of P(x), then b P = 0 a 2. If (x a) is a factor of P(x) then a must be a factor of the term independent of x.
Linear graphs
Linear equations are polynomials of degree 1. General equation is ax + by + c = 0 or y = mx + c where m = gradient c = y-intercept y y1 m= 2 The gradient x2 x1 Equation if a point and the gradient is known: y y1 = m(x x1)
47
Parallel lines have the same gradient. If m1 and m2 are the gradients of perpendicular lines, then: m1 m2 = 1 1 or m1 = m2
Quadratic graphs
Quadratic equations are polynomials of degree 2. General equation is y = ax2 + bx + c Quadratic formula is x=
b
b 2 4 ac 2a
Discriminant = b2 4ac and 1. if b2 4ac > 0, there are 2 x-intercepts (and if b2 4ac is a perfect square, the intercepts are rational) 2. if b2 4ac = 0, there is 1 x-intercept 3. if b2 4ac < 0, there are no x-intercepts. The power form or turning point form of the quadratic is: y = a(x b)2 + c and the turning point is (b, c). b The equation of the axis of symmetry and the x-value of the turning point of a parabola is . 2a The axis of symmetry is halfway between the x-intercepts.
Cubic graphs
Cubic equations are polynomials of degree 3. General equation is y = ax3 + bx2 + cx + d Basic shapes of cubic graphs: 1. If a > 0: Basic form Positive cubic
y y y = a(x b)3 + c
(b, c) x
Factor form
y y = a(x b)(x c)(x d) where a > 0
Repeated factor
y a b x
c d
y = (x a)2 (x b)
2. If a < 0, then the reflections through the x-axis of the types of graph in the above figures are obtained.
Quartic graphs
Quartic equations are polynomials of degree 4. General equation is y = ax4 + bx3 + cx2 + dx + e
48
b 0 x
y=
ax4
y
b 0 x
y=
ax4
cx2,
y
c0
e x
y = ax2(x - b)(x - c)
2. If a < 0, then reflection through the x-axis of the types of graph above is obtained. Note: It is possible to translate the cubic and quartic graphs shown in the cubic graphs and quartic graphs sections above.
Functions
A function is fully defined if the rule and domain are given. The domain of a function is the set of values of x for which the function is defined. The range of a function is the set of values of y for which the function is fully defined. Restricted domains can be represented by interval notation: [a, b] = {x: a x b} (a, b) = {x: a < x < b} [a, b) = {x: a x < b}
49
chapter review
Short answer
2 If a factor of P(x) = 7 + ax + 5x2 + 15x3 + bx4 is (x2 1), find the values of a and b. 3 Factorise each of the following expressions: a x3 12x2 + 17x + 90 b 2x4 + 7x3 31x2 + 36 4 Find the equation of each of the straight lines described below. a The line which passes through the points (5, 6) and (1, 1). b The line which is perpendicular to the line with equation 2x y + 10 = 0 and passes through the point (3, 3). 5 Sketch the graph of y = 8 2x x2, by labelling the turning point and all intercepts. State its domain and range. 6 Sketch the graph of y = 3x2 + 8x 3, x [3, 0). State the range of this function. 7 a If (x + 3) is a factor of f(x) = x3 + bx2 + ax 18 and g(x) = ax2 + bx 75, then find the values of a and b. b Sketch the graph of f(x) by labelling all intercepts. 8 Sketch the graph of f(x) = x4 7x3 + 12x2 + 4x 16.
Multiple choice
3 Assuming descending powers of x, the fifth term of 10 1 the expansion of 3 x + is: x 81 2 A 153 090x B 243x4 C x2 81 E 5 D 729x2 x 4 Which of the following expressions is not a polynomial? A x3 + 3x 1 B x4 5x3 + 3x2 6x C x 21 x11 + x 3 D x 4 + 5 x 3 2 x 2 + 5 x 3 E x6 x5 + 2x4 x3 + 4x 2 5 The value of P(3) in the polynomial, P(x) = x5 4x3 3x2 + 10x + 1, is: B 139 C 191 A 31 D 6 E 1 6 The degree of the polynomial (5 6x + x3 + 7x6) (x2 3x4 + 2) when expanded is: A 24 B 8 C 10 D 16 E 21 7 The remainder when x5 + 2x4 + 4x3 5x + 3 is divided by (x + 3) is: B 51 C 171 A 271 D 3 E 108 8 For which one of the following polynomial expressions is (x 2) not a factor? A x3 + 3x2 4x 12 B x4 2x3 6x2 8x + 2 C x4 + 2x3 7x2 8x + 12 D x3 + x2 10x + 8 E 2x3 + 3x2 9x 10 9 Which one of the following is a factor of 2x4 4x3 10x2 + 12x? A (x 2) B (x + 3) C (x + 1) D (x 4) E (x 3) 10 The rule for the graph shown is: A 2x + y + 4 = 0 y B x 2y 4 = 0 2 C 2y x 4 = 0 D x + 2y 4 = 0 0 E 4x + 2y = 0
3
1 When expanded, (1 2x)5 is equal to: A 1 + 2x 4x2 8x3 + 16x4 + 32x5 B 1 2x + 4x2 8x3 + 16x4 32x5 C 5 10x + 20x2 40x3 + 80x4 160x5 D 1 + 2x 4x2 + 8x3 16x4 + 32x5 E 1 10x + 40x2 80x3 + 80x4 32x5 2 The coefficient of x5 in the expansion of 8 1 is: 4 x x2 A 4096 D 16 384 B 131 072 E 16 384 C 4096
50
Questions 11 and 12 refer to the graph below, which has a gradient of 2. 11 The value of b must be: A 5 B 3 C 1 D 1 E 4
(3, 5) y (2, b) 0 2 x
(6, 22)
1 0 2 2 y
x (2, 3.6)
E
(6, 6) 65
(2, 10)
13 If 3x2 + 4x 5 = 0, then the value of the discriminant is: A 76 B 44 C 44 D 2 3 E 76 Questions 14 and 15 refer to the function with the rule: y = 2x2 + 8x - 10 where x (6, 2).
0 12 10
15 The range of this function is: A (18, 14) B (10, 14) D [ 18, 14] E (14, 10) 16 The graph of y = 3x3 could be: B A y y
C [18, 14)
C
65 0 10 2 x
(6, 14)
(2, 14)
E
65 0 12 10 x
(2, 14)
1 (6, 14)
f(x) = 6 + 11x + 3x2 2x3 have? A ( 1 , 0), (2, 0), (3, 0) and (0, 6) 2 B (2, 0), (2, 0), (3, 0) and (0, 6) C ( 1 , 0), (2, 0), (3, 0) and (0, 6) 2
D (2, 0), (1, 0), (3, 0) and (0, 6) E ( 1 , 0), (3, 0), (2, 0) and (0, 6) 2
51
18 The rule for the graph shown below could be: A f(x) = (x 1)2(x + 3) y f(x) B f(x) = (x + 1)(x 3)2 C f(x) = (x + 1)2(3 x) x D f(x) = (x2 1)(x + 3) 3 1 0 E f(x) = (x 3)(x + 1)2
3
D 19 The rule for the graph shown below could be: A f(x) = x(x + 2)3 y f(x) B f(x) = x(x 2)2 C f(x) = x2(x 2)2 D f(x) = x(x 2)3 E f(x) = x(2 x)2
0 2
3 x
0 1
21 The graph with equation y = x2 is translated 3 units down and 2 units to the right. The resulting graph has the equation: A y = (x - 3)2 + 2 B y = (x - 2)2 + 3 C y = (x - 2)2 - 3 D y = (x + 2)2 - 3 E y = (x + 2)2 + 3 [ VCAA 2006]
Extended response
1 An empty parfait glass has been left on a table with the rim just touching a wall. Ants are marching in a line down into the parfait glass and then up the other side, following the path of a parabola. They begin their journey where the glass touches the wall, 18 cm above the table. a The stem of the glass is 4 cm long and the diameter of the top of the glass is 5 cm. Find the rule for the quadratic function that describes the shape of the glass. b State the domain and range of the function. c If there is fruit juice in the bottom of the glass to a depth of 1 cm, find the coordinates of the point where the ants first touch the juice. Round answers to the nearest whole number. d Using function notation, write the rule for the surface of the crosssection of the juice in the glass.
52
2 A rogue satellite has its distance from Earth, d thousand kilometres, modelled by a cubic function of time, t days after launch. After 1 day it reaches a maximum distance from Earth of 4000 kilometres, then after 2 days it is 2000 kilometres away. It effectively returns to Earth after 3 days, then moves further and further away. a What is the satellites initial distance from Earth? b Sketch the graph of d versus t for the first 6 days of travel. c Express d as a function of t. d The moon is approximately 240 000 kilometres from Earth. Which is closer to Earth after 8 days, the satellite or the moon? By how far? e The satellite is programmed to self-destruct. This happens when it is 490 000 kilometres from Earth. What is the life span of the satellite? f State the domain and range of d(t). 3 A bridge spans a narrow canal as shown in the diagram at right. a Find the equation of a parabola that models the shape of the archway. b Show that a barge 3 m wide and carrying cargo with a total height of 1.7 m (with a rectangular cross-section) cannot fit under the arch. c How much cargo (in height, correct to 1 decimal place) must be removed for the barge to fit under the bridge?
y 3 2 1 Barge
x 4 In the town of Newtonia there is an annual 10 m race (for the Polynomial Cup) 2 1 0 1 2 for mini robots that have been programmed with mathematical formulas by Surface of canal Professor Liebnitz. There is a lot of betting on the race as the professor keeps the formulas secret and is known to favour surprise winners. The three contestants were programmed as follows, where x is the distance from the start line in metres and t is the time in minutes: Liney x = 2.4 + 0.75t Quadder x = 0.2t(t - 5.1) Cubric x = 0.2t(t - 5.1)(t - 9.1) Using a CAS calculator, describe the motions of the three contestants, specifically: a the direction they travelled in and how fast they were moving b where and when they changed direction c where and when they passed or met each other d who won the race and by how much. Sketch the graphs of their movements on the same set of axes, labelling all relevant points. You will need an extra graph to get a close-up of the finish.
5 The diagram at right shows a main road passing through O, A, C and E. The road crosses a river at point O and 3 kilometres further along the road at point C. Between O and C, the furthest the river is from the road is 8.54 kilometres, at a point D, 2.25 kilometres east of a northsouth line through O. Point A is 1 kilometre east of point O. If point O is taken as the N origin and the road as the x-axis, then the path of the river can be modelled River W E by a quartic function, as shown in blue. S a Give the coordinates of C and D. O A C Main road b Find the rule for the quartic function, f(x). E c How far is the river from the main road along the track AB? d A canoeing race, of at least 17 kilometres in length, along the river is B being organised. It is suggested that the race could start at O and finish D at C. Is this course satisfactory? Why?
53
6 Willie Wonkie, of Willie Wonkies Construction Company, makes a sketch of the symmetrical W for a large neon sign as shown below. The x- and y-axes represent the supporting crosspieces. The width of the W along the x-axis is 6 metres and the point on the vertical support is 21 metres above the horizontal support. The W 4 can be modelled by a quartic function, with all x-intercepts exactly evenly spaced.
y
a b c d
Find the rule for the letter W. If the top of the W is 8 metres wide, find the coordinates of the highest points of the letter. State the domain of the function. Use a graphics calculator to find the coordinates of the lowest points of the W, giving values correct to 3 decimal places. Hence find the range of the function. e In order to test the strength of his design, Willie Wonkie moves the horizontal crosspiece so that it just touches the lowest points of the W. Find the new rule that describes the W now. f State the domain and range of the new function. Note: The following questions use differentiation of polynomials. 7 A plane cruising at 10 000 m is coming in to land at an airport at sea level, as can be seen in the diagram below.
y Planes flight path 50 km Airport 10 000 m x
10 km
If the plane descends smoothly and makes no changes in direction, show that a possible model would be y = ax2(x - b). a Find the equation if the plane begins its descent when 50 km horizontally from the airport. b What is the altitude of the plane when it is 2 km horizontally from the airport? c How accurate do you think this model is?
54
8 The diagram below shows a symmetrical skateboard ramp with horizontal platforms at A and B, and vertical supportingstrutsatCandD.
y A E C 2m 4m G 2m 4m F D B
x 3m
a Write an equation for a quartic function that models the ramp, assuming a smooth connection at A and B. b Show that the right half of the ramp can be modelled by a cubic equation y = a(x b) (x 4)2 and find its equation by evaluating a and b. c The right-hand side can also be modelled by two smoothly connected parabolas. i IfthestrutDFis1mlong,fi ndtheequationofthelowerparabolapassingthroughF. ii Find the equation of the upper parabola if it meets the lower one at F, and show that the connection is not smooth (that is, their gradients are not equal at the point where they meet). iii Show that the two parabolas meet smoothly at (3, 0.75) provided the lower parabola passes through F. eBook plus d Which model is the closest to the actual ramp if the strut is really 1.6 m long?
Digital doc
Test Yourself
Chapter 1
Chapter 1
55
eBook plus
ACTIvITIeS
Chapter opener
Digital doc
10 Quick Questions: Warm up with ten quick questions on graphs and polynomials. (page 1)
1A
Tutorial
Spreadsheet 043: Investigate evaluating polynomials. (page 10) SkillSHEET 1.2: Practise solving simultaneous equations. (page 10)
1C Division of polynomials
Interactivity
Divisionofpolynomialsint-0246: Consolidate your understanding of the division of polynomials and rational functions. (page 11)
Tutorial
SkillSHEET 1.7: Practise recognising domain and range for quadratic graphs. (page 28) Spreadsheet 041: Investigate graphs of functions. (page 28) Spreadsheet 108: Investigate quadratic graphs in turning point form. (page 28) WorkSHEET 1.2: Calculate gradients, axial intercepts and values of the discriminant, sketch graphs of polynomials, and determine equations for graphs. (page 29)
1F
Tutorial
Cubic graphs
We 24 int-0519: Watch a worked example on determining the rule of a cubic. (page 31)
Digital docs
Spreadsheet 096: Investigate finding factors of polynomials. (page 15) WorkSHEET 1.1: Binomial expansion, division of polynomials and solving and factorising polynomial equations (page 15)
1D Linear graphs
Digital docs
Spreadsheet 013: Investigate cubic graphs in factor form. (page 34) Spreadsheet 014: Investigate cubic graphs. (page 35) Spreadsheet 015: Investigate cubic graphs of the form y = a(x b)3 + c. (page 36)
1G Quartic graphs
Tutorials
SkillSHEET 1.3: Practise calculating the gradient of parallel and perpendicular lines. (page 20) SkillSHEET 1.4: Practise using the gradient to find the value of a parameter. (page 20) SkillSHEET 1.5: Practise using interval notation. (page 21) SkillSHEET 1.6: Practise finding the domain and range for linear graphs. (page 21)
1E
Tutorial
We 27 int-0520: Watch a worked example on sketching the graph of a quartic. (page 39) We 28 int-0521: Watch a worked example on finding the turning points of a quartic using a CAS calculator. (page 40)
Digital docs
Quadratic graphs
SkillSHEET 1.8: Practise solving quartic equations. (page 45) Spreadsheet 105: Investigate quartic graphs in factor form. (page 45) Investigation: Quartics and beyond (page 46)
Chapter review
Digital doc
Spreadsheet 103: Investigate the value of the disciminant. (page 28) Spreadsheet 107: Investigate quadratic graphs. (page 28)
56
Test Yourself Chapter 1: Take the end-of-chapter test to test your progress. (page 55)
To access eBookPLUS activities, log on to www.jacplus.com.au
2
Functions and transformations
AREAS OF STUDY
2A 2B 2C 2D 2E 2F 2G 2H 2I
Transformations and the parabola The cubic function in power form The power function (the hyperbola) The power function (the truncus) The square root function in power form The absolute value function Transformations with matrices Sum, difference and product functions Composite functions and functional equations 2J Modelling
The behaviour of functions of a single real variable, including key features of their graphs such as axis intercepts, stationary points and points of inection, domain (including maximal domain) and range, asymptotic behaviour, symmetry and the algebra of functions, including composition of functions. The behaviour of these functions is linked to applications in practical situations. Identication of key features of graphs of: power functions y = xn for n N and n = 1, 2, 1 and transformations of these to the 2 form y = a(x + b)n + c where a, b and c R the modulus function y = | x | Transformations from y = f (x) to y = Af (n(x + b)) + c (where A, n, b and c R and f is one of the functions specied above) and the relation between the original function and the graph of the transformed
function (including families of transformed functions for a single transformation parameter) Graphs of sum, difference, product and composite functions of f and g, where f and g are functions of the types above Recognition of the general form of possible models for data presented in graphical or tabular form, using polynomial and power functions Applications of simple combinations of the above functions, and interpretation of features of the graphs of these functions in modelling practical situations The relationship of f (x y), f (xy) and f to values of f (x) and f (y) for different functions f Composition of functions, where f composition g is dened by f (g(x)), given rang domf ; for 4 example x 2 + 5 , x 3 + 2 x 1
eBook plus
2A
Digital doc
10 Quick Questions
In this chapter we consider the basic graphs of the quadratic and cubic functions, the hyperbola and truncus, square root and absolute value functions. The following transformations of the above graphs are discussed: dilation, reection and translation.
Dilation
A dilation is the stretching or compressing of a graph. Let the basic graph be y = f (x).
57
Chapter 2
Dilation away from the x-axis: y = af (x) 1. Stretches or compresses the graph f (x) by a factor of a from the x-axis. 2. Each y-value of the basic graph is multiplied by a factor of a, that is (x, y) (x, ay). 3. When | a | > 1, the graph of f (x) is stretched and becomes narrower. 4. When 0 < | a | < 1, the graph of f (x) is compressed and becomes wider. Dilation away from the y-axis: y = f (nx) 1. Stretches or compresses the graph f (x) by a factor of 1 from the y-axis. n x 2. Each x-value of the basic graph is multiplied by a factor of 1 , that is (x, y) ( , y). n n 3. When |n| > 1, the graph of f (x) is compressed from the y-axis and becomes narrower. 4. When 0 < |n| < 1, the graph of f (x) is stretched from the y-axis and becomes wider. Note: For the graphs we will be looking at in this chapter a horizontal dilation can be expressed as a vertical dilation. For example, (2x + 1)3 can be written as 23 ( x + 1 )3 = 8( 8( x + 1 )3. So in this 2 2 1 case a horizontal dilation from the y-axis by a factor of 2 is the same as a vertical dilation from the x-axis by a factor of 8. This can simplify the process of describing transformations for these particular graphs. The concept of dilation is illustrated in the following diagram:
y y y
Original graph
Ref lection
Reection provides a mirror image of a graph. Reection can take place in one or both axes. Let the basic graph again be y = f (x). Ref lection in the x-axis: y = f (x) 1. The mirror image of the original graph appears across the x-axis (the mirror line). 2. Each y-value is the negative of the original, the x-value is unchanged, that is (x, y) (x, y). Reection in the y-axis: y = f (x) 1. The mirror image of the original graph appears across the y-axis (the mirror line). 2. Each x-value is the negative of the original, the y-value is unchanged, that is (x, y) (x, y). Reection in both axes: y = f (x) 1. The basic graph is reected in the x-axis and then the y-axis (or vice versa). 2. Both the x- and y-values are the negatives of the original, that is (x, y) (x, y). The concept of reection is shown in the diagram below. The red star is the original graph.
y
y
58
Translation: y = f (x b) + c
A translation slides the graph. Translation can be horizontal (to the right or left along the x-axis), or vertical (up or down along the y-axis). Consider our basic graph y = f (x). 1. If y = f (x b) the basic graph is translated b units parallel to the x-axis: (a) in the positive direction (i.e. to the right) when b > 0 (b) in the negative direction (i.e. to the left) when b < 0. Each x-value has b added to it, that is (x, y) (x + b, y). 2. If y = f (x) + c, the basic graph is translated c units parallel to the y-axis: (a) in the positive direction (i.e. up) when c > 0, (b) in the negative direction (i.e. down) when c < 0. Each y-value has c added to it, that is (x, y) (x, y + c). 3. If y = f (x b) + c the basic graph is translated both horizontally and vertically.
y y y
Combination of transformations
When describing transformations that have been applied to a basic graph f (x), it is best to put the graph into the format y = af (x b) + c. The order of transformations is important as dilations and reections are applied before translations, so ensure that you describe the transformations in this order (remember D-R-T). In this chapter we shall consider graphs, derived from basic curves, using single transformations dilations, reections or translations as well as combinations of those. Modelling of data will also be considered.
Spreadsheet 132
Transformations
Chapter 2
59
Quadratic functions are also power functions. Power functions are functions of the form f (x) = xn, n R. The value of the power, n, determines the type of function. When n = 1, f (x) = x, and the function is linear. When n = 2, f (x) = x2 and the a=2 function is quadratic. Other power functions will be discussed later. y a=1 1 a = Under a sequence of transformations of f (x) = xn, n R, the 2 general form of a power function, is f (x) = a(x b)n + c (where a, b, c and n R). All linear and quadratic polynomials are also linear and x quadratic power functions, because all linear and quadratic functions 0 are transformations of f (x) = x and f (x) = x2, respectively. When a quadratic function is written in turning point form it is written in power form. For example, the quadratic function y = ax2 y = x2 + 4x + 6 can also be represented as the power function y = (x + 2)2 + 2.
Dilation
In power form, a is the dilation factor. It dilates the graph in the y direction. The larger | a | is, the thinner the graph of the parabola. If | a | is a proper fraction, that is, 0 < | a | < 1, the graph is wider than the basic parabola.
Reection
If a is negative, the graph of the basic parabola is reected in the x-axis, that is, the graph is ipped upside down. If x is replaced with x, the graph of the basic parabola is reected in the y-axis, that is, the graph is ipped sideways. Due to its symmetry, this effect cannot be seen on the basic parabola, but it is more obvious with a parabola that has already been translated. For example, the graphs of y = (x 3)2 and y = (x 3)2 are reections of each other across the y-axis.
y = (x 3)2 y y = (x 3)2 (0, 9)
Translation
Horizontal translation If b > 0, the graph of the basic parabola is translated horizontally to the right, and if b < 0, the graph of the basic parabola is translated horizontally to the left. For example, a graph with the equation y = (x 2)2 is a basic parabola that has been translated 2 units to the right, and a graph with the equation y = (x + 3)2 is a basic parabola that has been translated 3 units to the left. If the coefcient of x is not 1, the equation must be rewritten in the form y = a(x b)2 + c in order to be able to work out the value of b. 3 of a unit to the left, since For example, y = (4x + 3)2 is translated 4 y = (4 x + 3)2 3 = [4( x + 4 )]2 = 16( x + 4 )2 Vertical translation If c > 0, the graph is translated vertically upward, and if c < 0, the graph is translated vertically downward. For example, the graph with equation y = x2 + 2 is a basic parabola that has been translated 2 units up, and the graph with equation y = x2 1 is a basic parabola that has been translated 1 unit down.
3
y b=
3
b=2
0 3 2 y = (x b)
c=2 c = 1
2 x 0 1 y = x2 + c
60
Combination of transformations
The graph of y = a(x + c shows the combination of the transformations shown above. The turning point of the graph is (b, c). The domain of the parabola is R and the range is [c, ) if a > 0 or [, c) if a < 0. b)2
y y = a(x b)2 + c
Spreadsheet 108
The quadratic function in power form
(b, c) 0 x
WORKED EXAMPLE 1
State the changes required to transform the graph of y = x2 into the graph of y = 2(x + 3)2 4.
THINK
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
WRITE
Write the general formula for the parabola. Identify the value of a. State the effect of a on the graph. Identify the value of b. State the effect of b on the graph. Identify the value of c. State the effect of c on the graph.
y = a(x b)2 + c a=2 The graph of y = x2 is dilated by the factor of 2 from the x-axis. b = 3 The graph is translated 3 units to the left. c = 4 The graph is translated 4 units down.
We can use transformations to nd the equation of the function from its graph by rst examining the new position of the turning point.
WORKED EXAMPLE 2
(4, 2)
0 THINK
1 2 3 4 5 6
WRITE
Write the general formula of the parabola. From the graph state the horizontal translation and hence the value of b. From the graph, state the vertical translation and hence the value of c. The graph of the parabola passes through the origin. Substitute x = 0 and y = 0 into the formula. Solve for a, which is the dilation factor.
Substitute the values of b and c into the general formula. y = a(x 4)2 + 2 Using (0, 0): 0 = a(0 4)2 + 2 0 = 16a + 2 16a = 2 2 a = 16 =
1 8
Chapter 2
61
Substitute the value of a into y = a(x 4)2 + 2 and write your answer.
WORKED EXAMPLE 3
Given the equation y = kx2, determine the effect on the graph y = x2, when k = {2, 3, 4}. Sketch the graphs.
THINK
1
WRITE/DISPLAY
On a Graphs page, complete the function entry line as: f 1(x) = x2 Then press ENTER .
Complete the function entry lines as: f 2(x) = 2x2 f 3(x) = 3x2 f 4(x) = 4x2 Press ENTER after each entry.
As the value of k increases the graph becomes thinner and stretches away from the x-axis.
1. The graph of y = x2 is called a basic parabola. 2. The graph of y = a(x b)2 + c is the basic parabola, dilated by the factor of a from the x-axis, translated b units horizontally (to the right if b > 0 or to the left if b < 0) and c units vertically (up if c > 0 or down if c < 0). 3. If a is negative, the graph is reected in the x-axis. 4. If x is replaced with x, the graph is reected in the y-axis. 5. The turning point of the parabola is (b, c). 6. The domain of the parabola is R. 7. The range is y c if a > 0 or y c if a < 0.
y y = a(x b)2 + c
(b, c) 0 x
62
EXERCISE
2A
1 2 MC The equation of a parabola is given by (2 x )2 + 3 . Increasing m will result in the m graph being: A translated further to the left B translated further up C thinner D wider E reected in the y-axis
3 Match the graphs of the parabolas with the following equations. a y = x2 + 2 b y = 2(x 2)2 c y = 2 (x + 2)2 d e y = (2 + x)2 + 2 y = 2 (2 x ) 2
1
iii
y 2 0 2 2 2
ii y = x2
iv
x v
y 0 (1, 2) x
(1, 3)
d
4
y 0 x
2 x
(2, 4)
5 MC The equation of the graph shown opposite is best given by: A y = (x c)2 + d B y = c (x b)2 2 C y = (x + c) + b D y = (c x)2 + d 2 E y = d (x c) 6 Find the equation of the image of y = x2 under each of the following transformations: a dilation by the factor of 1 from the x-axis 2 b a reection in the x-axis c a translation by 2 units to the right and 1 unit down
y d b a0 c x
Chapter 2
63
d a dilation by the factor of 3 from the x-axis, followed by translation of 2 units down e a reection in the x-axis, followed by translation of 3 units to the left. 7 Find the equations of these graphs. a
y
y 1 1 0 1 x
0 4
c
3
y x 1 0 4
y 2 0 2 x
y 9 6 0 x
y 8
2 2
0 x
8 WE3 Find the equation of y = x2 under the following sequential transformations (in order): a dilation by a factor of 2 from the x-axis b reection in the x-axis c translation of 1 parallel to the x-axis d translation of 3 parallel to the y-axis. 9 Find the image of the point (x, y) under each of the following transformations: a reection in the y-axis b reection in the x-axis c dilation by a factor of 3 from the x-axis d dilation by a factor of 2 from the y-axis e dilation by a factor of 1 from the y-axis 3 f translation of 2 units horizontally in the positive direction g translation of 1 unit parallel to the y-axis. 10 The parabola has a turning point at (z, 8); it intersects the y-axis at y = 10 and one of the x-intercepts is x = 5. Find: a the value of z b the equation of the parabola.
11 For the parabola whose range is y 3, whose x-coordinate of the turning point is 4 and whose 1 y-intercept is y = 2 3 , find: a the y-coordinate of the turning point b the equation of the parabola c the coordinates of the x-intercepts.
64
12 The design shown in the diagram at right can be obtained by taking the red portion of the parabola and transforming it to form each of the other 9 fragments. (One or more transformations may be used to form each fragment.) If the highlighted fragment is given by f (x), 2 x 2, define the other 9 fragments in terms of f (x) and specify their domains.
3 2 0 2 x
2B
Dilation
The value a is the dilation factor; it dilates the graph from the x-axis. The larger a is, the thinner the graph.
y = ax3
eBoo k plus eBook
Digital doc
Reection
If a is negative, the graph of the basic cubic is reected in the x-axis, that is, the graph is ipped upside down. If x is replaced with x, the graph of the basic cubic is reected in the y-axis, that is, the graph is ipped sideways. For example, the graphs y = (x 1)3 and y = (x 1)3 are reections of each other across the y-axis.
y = (x 1)3 y
y = (x 1)3
Spreadsheet 015
Cubic function y = a( x b ) 3 + c
(1, 0) 0
(1, 0) (0, 1)
Chapter 2
65
Translation
Horizontal translation If b > 0, the graph of the basic cubic is translated horizontally to the right, and if b < 0, the graph of the basic cubic is translated horizontally to the left. For example, the graph with equation y = (x 2)3 is a basic cubic translated 2 units to the right, and the graph of y = (x + 3)3 is a basic cubic, translated 3 units to the left, that is, parallel to the x-axis in the negative direction. If the coefcient of x is not 1, the equation must be rewritten in the form y = a(x b)3 + c in order to be able to work out the value of 5 units to the b. For example, the graph of y = (2x 5)3 is translated 2 3 right, since y = (2x 5)
5 3 = [2( x 2 )] 5 3 = 8( x 2 )
b = 3
b=2
y = (x b)3
Vertical translation The value of c translates the graph vertically or along the y-axis. If c > 0, the graph is translated vertically up, and if c < 0, the graph is translated vertically down. The coordinates of the stationary point of inection are (b, c). For example, if y = x3 is translated 1 unit up, the equation of the resulting graph is y = x3 + 1 and the point of inection is (0, 1); if it is translated 2 units down, the equation of the resulting graph is y = x3 2 and the point of inection is (0, 2).
y 1 0 2
c=1 c = 2 x
y = x3 + c
Combination of transformations
The graph of y = a(x b)3 + c shows the combination of the transformations described above. Finally, the domain and range of y = a(x b)3 + c are R (all real numbers).
y = a(x b)3 + c
(b, c) 0
WORKED EXAMPLE 4
State the changes necessary to transform the graph of y = x3 into the graph of y = 2(x + 1)3 4.
THINK
1 2 3
WRITE
Write the general equation of the cubic function. Identify the value of a. State the effect of a on the graph. Identify the value of b. State the effect of b on the graph. Identify the value of c. State the effect of c on the graph.
y = a(x b)3 + c a=2 The graph is dilated by the factor of 2 in the y direction. b = 1 The graph is translated 1 unit to the left. c = 4 The graph is translated 4 units down.
4 5 6 7
66
WORKED EXAMPLE 5
For each of the following graphs: i state the coordinates of the stationary point of inection ii nd the x- and y-intercepts iii sketch the graph iv state the transformations that the graph of y = x3 has undergone to form each new equation. a y = (x + 3)3 1 b y = (4 x)3 + 6
THINK a Write the equation. i Since the rule is of the form y = a(x b)3 + c, WRITE/DRAW a y = (x + 3)3 1 i b = 3, c = 1
identify the values of b and c and hence write the coordinates of the stationary point of inection (b, c). Find the x-intercept by letting y = 0.
i i y-intercept: x = 0,
iii
mark the stationary point of inection and the x- and y-intercepts, then sketch the positive cubic passing through the points marked.
(4, 0) 0 (3, 1)
horizontal translations.
There is a horizontal translation of 3 units to the left and a vertical translation of 1 unit down.
b
y = (4 x)3 + 6
i b = 4, c = 6
identify the values of b and c and hence write the coordinates of the stationary point of inection (b, c). Find the x-intercept by letting y = 0. Note: Do not round off until the very last step; for graphing purposes, round off your nal answer to 1 decimal place.
i i y-intercept: x = 0,
6
3
x=4+ 6 5.8
Chapter 2
67
iii
axes, mark the stationary point of inection and the x- and y-intercepts, then sketch the positive cubic passing through the points marked.
y (4, 6)
(5.8, 0)
There is a horizontal translation of 4 units to the right and a vertical translation of 6 units up.
To nd the equation of the curve from a given graph, we need to establish exactly what transformations were applied to the basic cubic curve. This is best done by observing the shape of the graph and the position of the stationary point of inection.
WORKED EXAMPLE 6
y 5 3 0 x
THINK
1 2
WRITE/DISPLAY
Write the general equation of the cubic function. Write the coordinates of the stationary point of inection (b, c) and hence state the values of b and c. Substitute the values of b and c into the general formula. The graph passes through the point (0, 5) (y-intercept). Substitute the coordinates of this point into the equation. On a Calculator page, press: MENU b 3:Algebra 3 1:Solve 1 Complete the entry line as: solve(5 = a (0 1)3 + 3,a) Then press ENTER .
y = a(x b)3 + c The stationary point of inection is (1, 3). So b = 1, c = 3. y = a(x 1)3 + 3 Using (0, 5): 5 = a(0 1)3 + 3
6 7
Write the solution for the equation. Substitute the value of a into y = a(x 1)3 + 3.
a = 2 y = 2(x 1)3 + 3
68
REMEMBER
1. The graph of y = x3 is a basic cubic curve. 2. The graph of y = a(x b)3 + c where a > 0 is the basic cubic, dilated by the factor of a from the x-axis, translated b units along the x-axis (to the right if b > 0, or to the left if b < 0) and c units along the y-axis (up if c > 0, or down if c < 0).
y y = a(x b)3 + c
(b, c) 0
3. If a < 0, the graph is reected in the x-axis. 4. The stationary point of inection is at (b, c). 5. Both the domain and range are R. EXERCISE
2B
x3
k y = 1 (2 x + 5)3 4 2
Which of these transformations were applied to the graph of y = x3 to obtain each of the graphs below? i reection in the x-axis i i translation to the left i i i translation to the right i v translation up v translation down a
y
y 0 x
x y
Chapter 2
69
3 WE5 For each of the following graphs: i nd the stationary point of inection ii nd the x- and y-intercepts iii state the transformation(s) that the graph y = x3 has undergone to produce the given graph iv sketch the graph. a y = 3 x3 4 c y = 2 x3 6 3 e y=
1 2
EXAM TIP Be careful when sketching graphs use appropriate scales on the axes, clearly draw the graph and use the correct domain. Show at least one scale point on each axis and two coordinate points on each curve (including intercepts).
[Authors advice]
Spreadsheet 236
Function grapher
( x 2)3
Questions 4 to 6 refer to the function y = 2(mx 4)3 3. 4 MC The coordinates of the stationary point of inflection are:
A ( 4 , 3) m
B (4m, 3)
4 3 C ( , ) m m
4 D ( , 3m3 ) m
4 E ( , 3) m
6 MC If m > 1, increasing m will cause the graph to become: A wider B thinner and translated not as far to the right C shifted further to the left D shifted further to the right E shifted further down 7 Find the equation of the graph resulting from each of the following transformations of the graph of y = x3: a a dilation by the factor of 1 from the x-axis 2 b a reection in the x-axis and a translation by 5 units to the left c a translation by 3 units to the right and 1 unit down d a dilation in the y direction by the factor of 2, followed by the vertical translation of 3 units e a reection in the x-axis, then a translation of 1 unit to the left and 1 unit down. 8 Find the equation of the graph resulting from the following sequential transformations of the graph of y = x3: a dilation by a factor of 2 from the x-axis b reection in the y-axis c translation of 2 in the positive direction parallel to the x-axis d translation of 1 in the negative direction parallel to the y-axis. 9 WE6 Find the equations of these curves, if they are of the form y = a(x b)3 + c. a
y 4
y (1, 2)
c
1
y 1 0 x 2
y 9
y
1 2 1 1 0 2
70
10 MC The graph of y = 2(x + 3)3 + 1 has been reflected in the x-axis, shifted 3 units to the right and 1 unit up. The equation of the resulting graph is: A y = 2(3 x)3 + 2 B y = 2(x + 2)3 + 2 C y = 2(2 x)3 D y = 2(x 3)3 + 1 E y = 2x3 11 The graph of a cubic function of the form y = a(x b)3 + c has a stationary point of inflection at (1, 4) and cuts the y-axis at y = 2. Find the equation of the function. 12 The graph of y = a(b x)3 + c has a stationary point of inflection at (2, 1) and passes through the point (1, 1 ). 2 a Find the equation of the curve. b State the shape of the curve (that is, whether it is positive or negative cubic).
13 The graph of y = a(x b)3 + c cuts the x-axis at x = 4 and the y-axis at y = 28. If it is known that the dilation factor is equal to 1: a nd the position of the stationary point of inection b sketch the graph.
2C
Dilation
The value a is a dilation factor. It dilates the graph from the x-axis.
y=0
y a=2 a=1 a= 1 2 x
y=a x
Reection
If a is negative, the graph of the basic hyperbola is reected in the x-axis. If x is replaced with x, the graph of the basic hyperbola is reected in the y-axis.
x=0
Chapter 2
71
1 1 and y = x3 x3 are reections of each other across the y-axis. For example, the graphs of y =
y x = 3 y=
x 3
x=3
1 y =x 3
Translation
Horizontal translation x y=0 The value b translates the graph b units horizontally, that is, parallel to the x-axis. If b > 0, the graph is translated to the right, and if b < 0, the graph is (0, 1 translated to the left. For example, the graph with 3) 1 equation y = is a basic hyperbola translated x3 3 units to the right. This graph has a vertical asymptote of x = 3 and domain R\{3} (and a horizontal asymptote y = 0). If a basic hyperbola is translated 3 units to the left, it becomes 1 y= , with a vertical asymptote of x = 3 and domain R\{3}. Hence, the equation of the x+3 vertical asymptote is x = b and the domain is R\{b}. The horizontal asymptote and the range remain the same, x = 0 and R \ {0}, respectively. Vertical translation The value c translates the graph c units vertically, that is, parallel to the y-axis. If c > 0, the graph is translated upward, and if c < 0, the graph is translated c units downward. The graph 1 with equation y = + 3 is a basic hyperbola translated 3 units up. This graph has a horizontal x asymptote of y = 3 and a range of R\{3} (and a vertical asymptote x = 0). If a basic hyperbola is 1 translated 3 units down, it becomes y = 3, with a horizontal asymptote of y = 3 and a range x of R\{3} (and a vertical asymptote x = 0). Hence the equation of the horizontal asymptote is y = c and the range is R\{c}. Always draw the asymptote as a dotted line and label it with its equation (for example, y = 3) at the end of the asymptote. Ensure that the graph continues to approach the asymptote getting closer but not touching or crossing the asymptote or bouncing away from the asymptote.
Combination of transformations
The graph of y =
eBoo k plus eBook
Digital doc
Spreadsheet 051
The hyperbola
y=c
c 0 b x=b x
Finally, if the coefcient of x is a number other than 1, to obtain the value of h the equation should be rearranged rst. For example, 4 4 y= = 3 x + 6 3( x + 2) Therefore, b = 2 (not 6 as it may seem at rst); that is, the graph is translated 2 units to the left.
72
WORKED EXAMPLE 7
1 State the changes that should be made to the graph of y = in order to obtain the graph of x y = 4 1. x+2
THINK
1 2
WRITE
Write the general equation of the hyperbola. Identify the value of a. 1 State the changes to y = , caused by a. x
y=
a +c xb
a = 4 1 The graph of y = x is dilated by the factor of 4 from the x-axis and reected in the x-axis. b = 2 The graph is translated 2 units to the left. c = 1 The graph is translated 1 unit down.
4 5 6 7
Identify the value of b. State the effect of b on the graph. Identify the value of c. State the changes to the graph, caused by c.
WORKED EXAMPLE 8
2 + 2, state: x3
b the domain
WRITE
Write the general equation of the hyperbola. Identify the values of b and c and hence write the equations of the asymptotes: Horizontal asymptote: y = c Vertical asymptote: x = b
a y=
a +c xb
b c
State the domain of the hyperbola: R\{b}. State the range of the hyperbola: R\{c}.
Sketching the graph of the hyperbola by hand can be easily done by following these steps: 1. Find the position of the asymptotes. 2. Find the values of the intercepts with the axes. 3. Decide whether the hyperbola is positive or negative. 4. On the set of axes draw the asymptotes (using dotted lines) and mark the intercepts with the axes. 5. Treating the asymptotes as the new set of axes, sketch either the positive or negative hyperbola, making sure it passes through the intercepts that have been previously marked.
Chapter 2
73
WORKED EXAMPLE 9
2 4 , clearly showing the intercepts x+2 with the axes and the position of the asymptotes. Sketch the graph of y =
THINK
1
int-0522
Worked example 9
WRITE/DRAW
a +c Compare the given equation with y = x b and state the values of a, b and c. Write a short statement about the effects 1 of a, b and c on the graph of y = . x Write the equations of the asymptotes. The horizontal asymptote is at y = c. The vertical asymptote is at x = b. Find the value of the y-intercept by letting x = 0.
a = 2,
b = 2,
c = 4
1 is dilated by the factor of x 2 from the x-axis, translated 2 units to the left and 4 units down. Asymptotes: x = 2; y = 4 The graph of y = y-intercept: x = 0 2 y= 4 0+2 = 1 4 = 3 Point (0, 3) x-intercept: y = 0 2 0= 4 x+2 2 =4 x+2 2 = 4( x + 2) = 4x + 8 4x = 2 8 = 6 x= = Point
6 4 3 2 2
,0
)
y 0 (0, 3) x y = 4
c Mark the intercepts with the axes. The d Treating the asymptotes as your new set of x = 2
axes, sketch the graph of the hyperbola (as a is positive, the graph is not reected); make sure the upper branch passes through the x- and y-intercepts previously marked. The next example shows how to nd the equation of the hyperbola from its graph.
74
WORKED EXAMPLE 10
y 6 3 0 2 4 x
THINK
1 2
WRITE
Write the general equation of the hyperbola. From the graph, identify the values of b and c Remember that the equation of the horizontal asymptote is y = c and of the vertical asymptote is x = b. Substitute the values of b and c into the formula. Substitute the coordinates of any of the 2 known points of intersection with the axes into the formula (say, x-intercept). Solve for a.
y=
a +c xb c=3
b = 2,
3 4
y=
a +3 x2
6 7
a + 3. x2
y = 3
REMEMBER
1 is called a hyperbola. x a 2. The graph of y = + c is the graph of the basic xb hyperbola, dilated by the factor of a from the x-axis, translated b units horizontally (to the right if b > 0, or to the left if b < 0) and c units vertically (up if c > 0, or down if c < 0). If a < 0, the graph is reected in the x-axis. The equations of the asymptotes are: x = b and y = c. The domain of the function is R\{b} and its range is R\{c}. 1. The graph of y =
y= a
xb
+ c y=c
0 x=b
Chapter 2
75
EXERCISE
2C
1 Which of the following transformations were applied to the graph of y = to obtain each x of the graphs shown below? i translation to the right i i translation to the left iii translation up i v translation down v reection in the x-axis a
y
i i the domain
i i i the range.
a y= d y= g y=
x 2 3 x 4 2 x+6
b y= e y= h y=
1 x+6 3 +4 x 5 +1 2 x
c y= f i y=
3 x2
1 5 x 1 y= m n+ x
76
4 For each of the following graphs, state: i the equations of the asymptotes i i the domain i i i the range. a
y
y 2
2 0
y 1 0
n 0 m x b
a 0 x
Spreadsheet 236
Function grapher
WE9 Sketch each of the following, clearly showing the position of the asymptotes and the intercepts with the axes. Check your answers, using a CAS calculator. a y= 1 b y = 1 1 c y= 3 3 x+3 x+2 x 1 4 2 6 d y= e y= f y = 3 +6 3 1 x x+5 x2 1 2 4 g y = 1 h y= + i y= 1 +4 2 x 5 1+ x 2x + 3 2 x + 3 j y= k y= l y = 4x + 3 1 x2 x 1 3 4x MC The equation of the graph shown is likely to be:
1 x4 1 C y = 3 4x A y = 3+ E 8 y = 3 1 x4
1 +4 x3 1 D y= 3 4x B y=
3 0
A B C D E
The domain is R\{1}. The range is R\{3}. The equation of the horizontal asymptote is y = 3. The equation of the vertical asymptote is x = 2. None of the above.
2 3? x +1
Chapter 2
77
9 WE10 Find the equation for each of the following hyperbolas, if they are of the form a y= + c. xb a
y
1 0 3 x
0
3 4
d
4
y 2 11 2 0
y 5
3 4
1 1
10
1 If a function is given by f ( x ) = , sketch each of the following, labelling the asymptotes x and the intercepts with the axes. a f (x + 2) b f (x) 1 c f (x) 2 d f (1 x) + 2 e f (x 1) 1 f 1 f (x 2)
11 Sketch the graph of yx 3x + 1 = 0, and state its domain and range. (Hint: First transpose the equation to make y the subject.)
EXAM TIP When you are asked to give the domain and range in a question, be sure to demonstrate clearly which answer is which. For example, for y = x2, dom f : R, ran f : [0, ].
[Authors advice]
2D
78
We can also observe that the graph approaches the x-axis very closely, but never touches it. So y = 0 is the horizontal asymptote. Since the whole graph of the truncus is above the x-axis, its range is R+ (that is, all positive real numbers). 1 Similar to the graphs of the functions, discussed in the previous sections, the graph of y = 2 x can undergo various transformations. a + c , or y = a (x b)2 + c. Consider the general formula y = ( x b) 2
Dilation
y a=3 a=2 x
a y = 2 x
The value a is the dilation factor. It dilates the graph from the x-axis. The dilation factor does not affect the domain, range or asymptotes.
y=0
x=0 y
Reection
If a is negative, the graph of a basic truncus is reected in the x-axis. The range becomes R (that is, all negative real numbers).
y=0
y= 1 2
x
y= 1 2
If x is replaced with x, the graph of the basic truncus is reected in the y-axis. The effect of this reection cannot be seen in the basic graph, but it becomes more obvious if the graph has been translated horizontally rst. For example, 1 1 the graphs of y = and y = ( x 3)2 ( x 3)2 are reections across the y-axis. The vertical asymptote changes from x = 3 to x = 3 and the domain changes from R \{3} to R \{3}.
x=0 y
1 y= ( x 3)2
y=
1 ( x 3)2
y=0
x = 3
x=3
Translation
Horizontal translation The value b translates the graph b units horizontally. If b > 0, the graph is translated to the right, and if b < 0, the graph is translated left. For example, the graph of the equation 1 results from translating a basic truncus 3 units y= ( x 3)2 to the right. The vertical asymptote is x = 3
y b = 2 y=0 2 0 3
1 y = 2 (x b)
b=3 x
Chapter 2
79
and the domain is R \{3}. If a basic truncus is translated 2 units to the left, it becomes 1 y= , where the vertical asymptote is x = 2 and the domain is R \{2}. Hence, the ( x + 2)2 equation of the vertical asymptote is x = b and the domain is R \{b}. The range is still R+ and the equation of the horizontal asymptote is y = 0. Vertical translation y 1 The value c translates the graph c units vertically. If c > 0 the graph y = +c x2 is translated upward, and if c < 0, the graph is translated c units 1 c=1 downward. For example, the graph with equation y = 2 + 1 results x y=1 1 when a basic truncus is translated 1 unit upward. The horizontal 0 c = 1 x asymptote is y = 1 and the range is (1, ). If a basic truncus is 1 1 y = 1 translated 1 unit down, it becomes y = 2 1, with y = 1 as x=0 x the horizontal asymptote and (1, ) as the range. Hence the equation of the horizontal asymptote is y = c and the range is (c, ). Note: If a is positive (see graph below), the whole graph of the truncus is above the line y = c (the horizontal asymptote) and hence its range is y > c, (c, ). If a is negative, the whole graph is below its horizontal asymptote and therefore the range is y < 0, or (, c).
y y=3 y=3 3 0 x y 3
y=
a + c (x b)2
y=c
WRITE
Write the general formula for the truncus. Identify the value of a.
y=
a +c ( x b) 2
a = 1
80
3 4 5 6 7
State the effect of a on the graph. Identify the value of b. State the effect of b on the graph. Identify the value of c. State the effect of c on the graph.
x2
WORKED EXAMPLE 12
c the range.
Write the general formula for the truncus. Write the general equations of the asymptotes. Identify the values of b and c. State the equations of the asymptotes by substituting the values of b and c into corresponding formulas.
a y=
a +c ( x b) 2
b c
Check whether a is positive or negative. Write the range (which for a > 0 is y > c).
Range: y > 4
a + c, then compare the given ( x b) 2 equation with the general formula to see what changes should be made to the basic curve (the 1 graph of y = ) to transform it to the one you want. This should give you an idea of how the x2 graph will look. To sketch the graph of a truncus, rst put it in the form y = The following algorithm can then be used: 1. Find the position of the asymptotes. 2. Find the intercepts with the axes. 3. On the set of axes, draw the asymptotes (using dotted lines), label with the equation and mark the x- and y-intercepts. a>0 4. Treating the asymptotes as the new set of axes, sketch the basic truncus curve. 5. Make sure the curve passes through the points marked on the axes.
a<0
Chapter 2
81
WORKED EXAMPLE 13
1 , clearly showing the position ( x + 1)2 of the asymptotes and the intercepts with the axes (correct to 1 decimal place). Sketch the graph of y = 2
THINK
1 2 3
WRITE/DRAW
Write the general formula for the truncus. Identify the values of a, b and c. Write a short statement about the transformations 1 the graph of y = 2 should undergo in order to be x changed into the one in question. Write the equations of the asymptotes (y = c and x = b). Find the x-intercept (round off to 1 decimal place).
y=
a +c ( x b) 2 b = 1, c=2
a = 1,
1 is reected in the x2 x-axis, translated 1 unit to the left and 2 units up. The graph of y = Asymptotes: x = 1 and y = 2 x-intercept: y = 0 0 = 2 1 = 2 ( x + 1)2 ( x + 1)2 = 1 2 x +1 = x = x =
.
1 ( x + 1)2
1 2 1 2 1 2
1 or x =
.
0.3
1.7
1 2
y-intercept: x = 0 1 y = 2 (0 + 1)2 = 2 1 =1
y (1.3, 0) (0, 1) (1.7, 0) x = 1 0 x y=2
To sketch the graph: draw the set of axes and label them; use dotted lines to draw asymptotes; mark the x- and y-intercepts; treating the asymptotes as the new set of axes, draw the basic truncus curve upside down (since a is negative); make sure it intersects the axes in the right places.
In the above example we have considered sketching the graph from the given equation. Sometimes the opposite task is required; that is, the equation of the function should be established from its graph.
82
WORKED EXAMPLE 14
y
1 2
x=2 2 x
THINK
1
WRITE
Write the general equation of the truncus. 1 , the graph is shifted 2 units to x2 the right. (There is no shift along the y-axis.) Compared to y = Substitute the values of b and c into the formula.
y=
a +c ( x b) 2
y=
Using (0, 2 ) :
1 a = 2 (0 2)2 a = 4 1 a = 4 ( 2) a = 2 y=
2
5 6
( x 2)2
REMEMBER
1. The graph of y = 2.
3. 4. 5. 6.
a + c is the basic truncus curve, The graph of y = ( x b) 2 dilated by a factor of a from the x-axis and translated b units along the x-axis (to the right if b > 0 or to the left if b < 0) and c units along the y-axis (up if c > 0 or down if c < 0). If a is negative, the graph is reected in the x-axis. The vertical asymptote is x = b. The horizontal asymptote is y = c. The domain is R\{b}. The range is y > c if a > 0, or y < c if a < 0.
x2
is called a truncus.
y=
a (x b)2 + c
c 0 b x
Chapter 2
83
EXERCISE
2D
(4 +
x )2
f i
y=
2 +6 x2 1 ( x + 2)2
y
4 +1 ( x 3)2 1 2 MC To obtain the graph shown, the graph of y = 2 was: x A reected in the x-axis and translated 2 units down B translated 2 units to the left C reected in the x-axis and translated 2 units to the left D reected in the x-axis and translated 2 units to the right E reected in the x-axis and translated 2 units up g y = 3 1 x2
y = 5
3 MC Which of the following translations took place, so that the 1 graph of y = 2 was changed into the one shown at right? x A m units to the left and p units up B m units to the right and p units up C m units to the left and n units up D m units to the right and n units up E m units to the left and n units down 4 WE12 For each of the following state: i the equations of the asymptotes ii the domain iii the range. a y= 2 b y= 4 x2 3x 2 5 2 d y= e y = ( x + 1)2 (4 + x ) 2 4 1 1 3 g y= + 2 h y= 2 5 x 2 x Questions 5 t 7 refer to the following diagrams. i
y
c y= f i y=
1 ( x 2)2
2 3 x2 2 y= +4 ( x 1)2
ii
iii
3 0 3 x 3 0 x
84
iv
y 0 3 x
vi
y 0 3 3 x
3 0 3 x
5 MC Which of the above functions has the domain R\{3}? A i i only B i i i only D i i , i i i and v i E v and vi 6 MC Which of the above functions has the range y < 3? A i , i i and i v B i i i , v and vi E i i i and vi D v only 7 MC Which of the graphs has asymptotes y = 0 and x = 3? A i B ii D iv E v
i i and i i i
i v only
iii
8 WE13 Sketch each of the following, clearly showing the position of the asymptotes and the intercepts with the axes (correct to 1 decimal place where appropriate). 1 2 a y= 2 b y= c y= 2 2 ( x 3) (4 + x ) 2 5x d y= g y= j
1
Spreadsheet 236
Function grapher
( x 1)2
e y = 1 4 x2 2 (3 + x )2 1 +3 k y= (2 x ) 2 h y = 4
f i l
2 2 ( x 1)2 3 1 y= 2 4 4( x + 1)
1 3 2x2 2 1 y= + 3 ( x 2)2 4 y= 1 (2 x 4) 2 y=
9 Find the equations for each of the following curves, if it is known that all of them are a of the form y = + c and a is ( x b) 2 + either 1 or 1. a
y
EXAM TIP Always check you have met the requirements of the answer format, for example, ensure that you have rounded correctly and show the correct number of decimal places.
[Assessment report 1 2006 VCAA]
y p
n 0 m x
t 0 x
c d a 0 b
f e
Chapter 2
85
y 0 l x
x
[ VCAA 2006]
y 1 y=1 0 x
0 2 x=0
y=
3 4
x y=0
x=2
x = 2
y 7 4 1 0 x=
1
y 0 2 1 x y = 2
y=4 x
0 3
2.5
x y = 3
7 x=1
x=4
11
The domain of a truncus is R\{2}; its range is y > 3 and its graph cuts the x-axis at 1 and x = 3. Find the equation of the function.
12 The domain of a truncus is R\{1}; its range is (2, ) and its graph cuts the y-axis at y = 5. Find the equation of the function.
2E
Thus, the function f ( x ) = x can also be expressed as the power function f ( x ) = f ( x ) = x . The function is dened for x 0; that is, the domain is R+ {0}, or [0, ).
1 2
86
As can be seen from the graph, the range of the square root function is also R+ {0}, or [0, ). Throughout this section we will refer to the graph of y = x as the basic square root curve. Let us now investigate the effects of various transformations on the basic square root curve. Consider the function y = a x b + c, or y = a( x b) + c.
1 2
Dilation
The value a is a dilation factor; it dilates the graph from the x-axis. The domain is still [0, ).
y=a x
Reection
If a is negative, the graph of a basic square root curve is reected in the x-axis. The range becomes (, 0]. The domain is still [0, ).
y y = x (1, 1) (1, 1) y = x x
(0, 0)
If x is replaced with x, the graph is reected in the y-axis. For example, the graphs with equations y = x and y = x are reected across the y-axis. The domain becomes (, 0] and the range is [0, ).
Translation
Horizontal translation The value b translates the graph horizontally. If b > 0, the graph is translated to the right, and if b < 0, the graph is translated to the left. The graph with the equation y = x 3 results when the basic curve is translated 3 units to the right. This translated graph has domain [3, ) and range [0, ). If the basic curve is translated 2 units to the left, it becomes y = x + 2 and has domain [2, ) and range [0, ). The domain of a square root function after a translation is given by [b, ). Vertical translation The value c translates the graph vertically. If c > 0, the graph is translated vertically up, and if c < 0, the graph is translated vertically down. If y = x is translated 2 units vertically up, the graph obtained is y = x + 2, with domain [0, ) and range [2, ). If the basic curve is translated 4 units down, it becomes y = x 4, with domain [0, ) and range [4, ). The range of the square root function is [c, ) for a > 0.
y b = 2 (2, 0) 0 (3, 0) b=3 x
y= xb
c = 4
y= x+c
Chapter 2
87
Combination of transformations
The graph of y = a x b + c shows the combination of these transformations. The point (b, c) is the end point of the square root curve. For example, the end point of y = x 2 + 1 is (2, 1). It is always good practice to label the end point with its coordinates. Make sure it is an open circle if the x-value is not in the required domain and a closed circle if its x-value is within the functions domain. Consider the function y = a b x + c. The graph of y = a x + b + c has (b, c) as its end point. If this function is reected in the y-axis, it becomes y = a x + b + c with end point (b, c). The equation y=a
x
y=a xb+c
(b, c) 0 x
+ 2 + 1, which has an
x
end point of (2, 1) and bends to the left. The domain is (, 2] and the range is [1, ). The equation y = x + 2 + 1 results in y = changes from [2, ) to (,
3 ) 2
2] and the range remains [1, ). The equation y = 2 x + 3 1 can 1; the domain is [ 2 , ) and the range is [1, ).
3
be rewritten as y = 2( x +
WORKED EXAMPLE 15
WRITE
Write the general formula for the square root curve. Identify the value of a. State the effect of a on the graph. Identify the value of b. State the effect of b on the graph. Identify the value of c. State the effect of c on the graph.
y=a xb +c a = 3 The graph is dilated by a factor of 3 from the x-axis and reected in the x-axis. b = 5 The graph is translated 5 units to the left. c=3 The graph is translated 3 units up.
4 5 6 7
WORKED EXAMPLE 16
y = 2 x 3 +1 y= 4 x +2
y = 4 3x + 2 4
Tutorial
int-0523
Worked example 16
88
THINK
WRITE
y=a xb +c
a y = 2 x 3 +1
Write the question. Identify the values of b and c. State the domain x b. State the range (y c for a > 0). Write the question. Factorise the expression under the square root sign. State the domain. Identify the value of c and check whether a is positive or negative. State the range. Write the question. Identify the values of b and c. Since the function is of the form y = a b x + c, the domain is x b. State the range (y c).
1 2 3 4 5
1 2 3
4 x +2
To sketch the graph of the square root function, we a>0 a>0 need to compare the given formula with y=a bx+c y=a xb+c y = a x b + c. This will give us an idea of the (b, c) a<0 a<0 changes required to transform the basic square root curve into the one we want. It will also let us know the way the curve will look. The diagram above illustrates the idea. Once the coordinates of the end point and the direction of the curve are known, the intercepts with the axes (if any) should be found before sketching.
WORKED EXAMPLE 17
Sketch the graph of y = 2 x 3 + 1 , clearly marking intercepts and the end points.
THINK
1 2 3
WRITE/DRAW
Write the equation. Write the coordinates of the end point. State the shape of the graph.
Chapter 2
89
x-intercept: y = 0 0 = 2 x 3 +1 2 x3 =1 1 x3 = 2 x 3 = ( 2 )2 =
1 4 1
x =34
5 6
Find the y-intercept if there is one. Sketch the graph by plotting the end point, marking the x-intercept, and drawing the curve so that it starts at the end point and passes through the x-intercept.
There is no y-intercept.
y 1 0 (3, 1) (3 1 4 , 0) x 3
WORKED EXAMPLE 18
Given f : [0, ) R, where f ( x ) = x and g(x) = af (x) + b, where a and b are positive real constants, consider the effect on g(x) as a and b increase individually.
THINK
1
WRITE
On a Graphs page, complete the function entry line as: f 1( x ) = v1 x + v 2 Insert a slider by pressing: MENU b 1:Actions 1 A:Insert Slider A Then press ENTER . Repeat to insert a second slider. Grab the slider for each variable and move it back and forth taking note of the effect of each variable increasing.
As a increases, the graph is dilated away from the x-axis, with the graph stretched further from the x-axis. As b increases, the graph is translated up parallel to the y-axis.
REMEMBER
1. The graph of the function y = a x b + c is the graph of y = x, dilated by the factor of a from the x-axis and translated b units along the x-axis and c units along the y-axis. If a < 0, the basic graph is reected in the x-axis. The end point of the graph is (b, c). The domain is x b. The range is y c for a > 0, or y c for a < 0.
y=a xb+c
2. 3. 4. 5.
(b, c) 0 x
90
EXERCISE
2E
c f i
y = 3 x 1 y = 23 x y=
1 2
d y = 2 4 + x g y = x 4 +3
e y = x 1 h y = 62 3+ x
2 x + 3
2 For each of the functions in question 1 write the coordinates of the end point. 3 MC The graph shown below was obtained by translating the graph of y = A 3 units up and 9 units to the right y B 3 units down and 9 units to the right C 9 units up and 3 units to the right 3 D 3 units down and 9 units to the right E none of the above x:
4 MC To obtain the graph in the diagram at right, the graph of y = x was: A translated 2 units to the right and 4 units up B translated 4 units to the right and 2 units up C translated 2 units to the right, 4 units up and reected in the x-axis D reected in the y-axis, translated 4 units up and 2 units to the right E reected in the x-axis, translated 4 units up and 2 units to the left. 5 WE16 Find the domain and range for each of the following functions. a y = x +1 b y= x3 c y = x 3 d y = 4+2 x g y = 2 + x 1 j y= 3 x 7 e y = 5 x h y = 4 2 2x + 1 k y = 6 + 4 2x f y = x 1+3 i y=
3 5
9 y
(2, 4) 0 x
3x 4 + 2
l y = 1 2 x
y
Questions 6 t 7 refer to the diagram at right. 6 MC The equation of the graph is of the form: A y = a x b + c, a > 0 C y = a b x + c, a > 0 B y = a x b + c, a < 0 D y = a b x + c, a < 0
(2, 2)
E could be either B or C 7 MC The domain and range (in that order) of the function are: A (, 2] and (, 2] B (, 2) and (, 2) C (, 2} and {2, +) D ( , 2] and ( , 2] E ( , 2] and ( , 2] 8 WE17 Sketch the graph of each of the following, clearly marking intercepts and end points. a y= x+2 b y=1 x +3 3 c y = 2 x e y= 3+ x +2 g y = 2x 3 i y = 2 x 1
[ VCAA 2007]
d y = x 6 +1 f y= 1 4+x 2 h y = 6 + 3x + 2
EXAM TIP Graphs should be drawn showing correct features, such as smoothness and end points.
[Assessment report 2 2007]
Chapter 2
91
9 WE18 A C E 10
y = 2 x 1 y = x 12 y = 22 x 1
B D
y = 2 2 1 x y = x 2 +1
0
(1, 2) 2 x
Spreadsheet 236
Function grapher
The graph of y = x was dilated by the factor of 2 from the x-axis and translated m units to the right and 4 units down. It intersects with the x-axis at x = 5. Find: a the value of m b the equation of the curve. 11 The end point of the square root curve is at (4, 3) and its y-intercept is 9. Sketch the graph of the curve and hence establish its equation. 12 The graph of y = x was dilated by the factor of 4 from the x-axis, reflected in the x-axis, translated 1 unit to the left and p units up. Find: a the value of p, if the graph cuts the y-axis at y = 4 b the equation of the curve c the x-intercept d the domain e the range. f Hence, sketch the graph, showing the coordinates of the end points and the intercepts with the axes.
2F
0 y = |x| y
0 y=x
0 y = |x|
WORKED EXAMPLE 19
WRITE/DRAW
We rst need to sketch the graph of y = x2 1. State the shape of this graph.
92
2 3
State the coordinates of the turning point (note that it is also the y-intercept). Find the x-intercept by letting y = 0.
4 5
Sketch the graph of the parabola (Figure A). Reect the portion of the parabola for < x < 1 in the x-axis; mark the new y-intercept (Figure B).
(1, 0)
1
y (0, 1)
(1, 0) x (0, 1)
(1, 0) 0 (1, 0)
y = |x2 1| Figure B
Figure A
Similar to the graphs discussed in the previous sections, the graph of the absolute value function can be transformed through dilations, translations and reections. If y = a| f (x)| + c, a is the dilation factor. It dilates the graph from the x-axis. The larger a is, the thinner the graph. If a < 0, the graph is reected in the x-axis.
a=2 a=1
a = 1
The value c translates the graph along the y-axis. If c > 0, the graph is moved c units up and if c < 0, it is moved c units down.
c=1 c = 2
1 0 2
x y = |x| + c
WORKED EXAMPLE 20
WRITE/DRAW
int-0524
Worked example 20
Compare the given function with y = a|f (x)| + c, and write a short comment. To sketch the required shape we rst need to sketch y = x 2 (a straight line). Find the y-intercept by letting x = 0. Find the x-intercept by letting y = 0.
The graph of y = |x 2| is translated 1 unit up. Let y = x 2. y-intercept: x = 0 y=02 = 2 x-intercept: y = 0 x2=0 x=2
Chapter 2
93
y 0 (0, 2) (2, 0) x
Reect the portion below the x-axis in the x-axis; mark the new y-intercept.
y (0, 2) 0 (2, 0) x
Move the graph 1 unit up; mark the new y-intercept and the coordinates of the cusp.
y (0, 3) (2, 1) 0 2 x
Express f (x) = |5x 4| as a hybrid function, dening the domain of each part and graphing the function.
THINK
1
int-0525
Worked example 21
WRITE/DRAW
Break the function into two parts: a negative and positive part. Simplify the domain and function for each.
5 x 4, wh ere 5 x 4 0 f ( x) = | 5x 4 | = (5 x 4), wh ere 5 x 4 < 0 First function: 5x 4 First domain: 5x 4 0 x 5 Second function: (5x 4) = 5x + 4 Second domain: 5 x 4 < 0 x<
4
4 5
94
Rewrite the function in hybrid form with the two rules with their respective domains.
f(x) = 5x 4 2 x
The absolute value function can easily be drawn using a CAS calculator. On a Graphs page, complete the function entry line as: f 1(x) = |5x 4| Then press ENTER .
REMEMBER
1. The symbol | x | denotes the magnitude of x. 2. | x | = x, if x 0 | x | = x, if x < 0 3. To sketch the graph of y = |f (x)|: (a) sketch the graph of y = f (x) (b) reect the portion of the graph which is below the x-axis in the x-axis. EXERCISE
0 y = |x|
2F
Sketch the graph of each of the following, showing exact values of intercepts
b y = |x 1| e y = |4 c
of axes. a y = |2x|
d y= h i
y = |3 6x|
|x2
6| 2)3 1|
x2|
f y = |(x 3)2 4|
EXAM TIP Always give answers in exact form unless the question asks for a numerical approximation (for example, give your answer to 2 decimal places).
[Assessment report 2 2007]
g y = |3x3|
y = |(x + y=
2 x 1
[ VCAA 2007]
Chapter 2
95
1)3
3 For each of the following functions state the domain and range.
y = 4 3|x| y= 2 1 x2
a y = 2|x| d y= g j l 5 y= y= |x2 1| + 1 1 3 x 4
b y = |x + 5| 6 e y=2 h k y= y= |x2 2| 2 +3 6 x 2 x 2 + 3
Spreadsheet 002
Absolute value function
1 1 x2 x +1 8
y=2
EXAM TIP
value graphs.
a rewrite the function as a hybrid function with appropriate domains b nd f (0) and f (2) c sketch the graph, labelling any signicant points.
6 Given the function f (x) = | x2 3x |+ 2: a rewrite the function as a hybrid function with appropriate domains b nd f (1) and f (2) c sketch the graph, labelling any signicant points. 7 The design shown at right is to be embroidered on the outer side of a pair of childrens socks. The total length of the design is 12 cm and its width is 8 cm. y 6 If we draw the set of axes through the centre of the design, the red section can be thought of as the absolute value function on a restricted domain. a Find the rule for the red section and specify the domain. b Using your knowledge of the transformations, and the rule for 4 4x the red section, nd the rules for the blue, green and yellow sections of the design. c Using a graphics calculator, sketch the 4 functions that were obtained in a and b . Have you obtained the right design? 6
WorkSHEET 2.2
2G
eBoo eBook k plus
Interactivity
int-0247
Transformations with matrices
96
point on a curve, or in fact used to determine the new rule for a function that has undergone one or a series of transformations. The new points or rules are termed images of the original.
x We can summarise the use of matrices to map these transformations, T , of points on a y curve as follows: (Let x' be the transformed value of x, and y' be the transformed value of y.) x x' 1 0 x x T = = = represents a reection in the y-axis. y y' 0 1 y y x x' 1 T = = y y' 0
1 y
0 x
x x' a 0 x ax T = = = represents a dilation of a factor of a from the y-axis. y y' 0 1 y y x x' 1 0 x x T = = = represents a dilation of a factor of a from the x-axis. y y' 0 a y ay These operations can be combined to represent more than one transformation, for example x x' 2 0 x 2 x T = = = y y' 0 3 y 3 y represents a reection in the y-axis, a dilation of a factor of 2 from the y-axis, and a dilation of a factor of 3 from the x-axis.
WORKED EXAMPLE 22
Using matrices, nd the location of the point (x, y) under the following transformations of the point (1, 3): dilation by a factor of 2 from the y-axis reection in the x-axis.
THINK
1
WRITE/DISPLAY
Construct the correct matrix that represents the transformations described. x x' 2 T = = y y' 0 0 x 1 y
2 0
On a Calculator page, press: Ctrl / r Select the appropriate matrix templates to construct and solve the matrix equation using the point (x, y) = (1, 3): x x' 2 T = = y y' 0
1
0 1 3
Chapter 2
97
Write the matrix equation and interpret this to answer the question.
2 0
1 3
0 1
2 = 3
Matrix operations can be done using a CAS calculator, but as the matrix multiplication required here is simple, it is recommended it be done by hand.
The difcult part is to correctly identify the transformation matrix. Once you have done that it is a matter of performing a matrix multiplication.
Translations
Translations require a slightly different process. The transformation matrix is a 2 1 matrix, and nding the new image requires addition of the matrices rather than multiplication. b Matrices describing translations are of the form . c This represents: a translation of b units in the positive direction of the x-axis and a translation of c units in the positive direction of the y-axis. Note b and c > 0: If either of the terms is negative, the translation is in the negative direction. A zero entry indicates there is no translation in a particular direction. So a translation of a point (x, y) can be described as follows: x x' x b T = = + y y' y c x + b = y + c
WORKED EXAMPLE 23
Find the location of the point (x', y') under the following transformations of the point (2, 4): translation of 3 units in the x direction translation of 5 units in the y direction.
THINK
1
WRITE
Construct the correct matrix that represents the transformations described. x x' x 3 T = = + y y' y 5
3 5
Matrix operations can be done using a CAS calculator, but as the matrix addition required here is simple, it is recommended it be done by hand.
98
Note it is very important to use the correct mathematical language, both for the size and the direction of the transformation. For example, dilations are by a factor of, in other words a multiple of the original value, as distinct from translations, which are described as of n units, which is a set distance. In terms of direction, the expression from the y-axis can also be expressed as parallel to the x-axis, in the x direction or even horizontally. The same applies for from the x-axis.
Find the location of the point (x', y') under the following transformation of the point (3,2): 1 from the y-axis 2 dilation by a factor of 3 from the x-axis reection in the x-axis translation of 3 units in the x direction. dilation by a factor of
THINK
1
WRITE
Perform the rst three transformations together. Construct the 1 correct matrix that represents these transformations described. 2 0 x x' 1 0 x T = = 2 3 y y' 0 y Construct and solve the appropriate matrix equation. x x' 1 0 3 T = = 2 3 y y' 0 2 Now perform the translation. Construct and solve the appropriate matrix equation. Note we are using the product matrix from step 2. x x' 1 T = = 2 y y' 0 0 3 3 + 3 2 0 1 2 0
0 3
0 3 3 = 2 3 2 6
3 3 9 2 + = 2 6 0 6
( , 6)
9 2
Remember that a transformation maps any point on a curve to another by the same rule. Rather than mapping a series of individual points on the same curve, we can simply nd a new rule under a transformation (or a series of them) and use this new rule to determine the location of any points from the curve described by the original rule.
Chapter 2
99
WORKED EXAMPLE 25
Write the resultant equation from the following transformations of the curve described by y = x3: dilation by a factor of 2 from the y-axis reection in the x-axis translation of 2 units in the negative y direction.
THINK
1
int-0526
Worked example 25
WRITE
Perform the rst two transformations together. Construct the correct matrix that represents these transformations described. x x' 2 T = = y y' 0
1
2 0
0 x y 2 0
1 y
Construct and solve the appropriate matrix equation. Now perform the translation. Construct the correct matrix that represents this transformation described. x x' 2 0 x 0 T = = + y y' 0 1 y 2 Construct and solve the appropriate matrix equation. Note we are using the product matrix from our rst equation in step 2. The transformed values of x and y are 2x and y 2. Express x' and y' in terms of x and y.
0 x
2x = y
0 2
x' 2 x 0 2 x = + = y' y 2 y 2 Therefore x' = 2x and y' = y 2. x' and 2 y = y' + 2 y = y' 2 x=
x y= 2 2 3
5 6
So for any point on the graph of the original function, y = x3, we can map the corresponding point under the transformations above by substituting the values into this transformed equation. Lets have a look at another example. This time we will complete reections/dilations and translations in the one step.
WORKED EXAMPLE 26
Find the image of the curve with equation y = x after a reection in the x-axis, followed by a dilation of a factor of 2 from the x-axis, and then a translation by +3 in the x direction.
THINK
1
WRITE
Construct the correct matrices that represent the transformations described. x x' 1 0 x 3 T = = + y y' 0 2 y 0
1 0
3 and 0
100
x' 1 y' 0
0 x 3 x + 3 + = y 0 2y
3 4
The transformed values of x and y are x + 3 and 2y. Express x' and y' in terms of x and y. Substitute new y- and x-terms for y = x , and drop the primes.
2
y
= x3 = 2 x3
y = 2 x 3
6
y = 2 x 3
REMEMBER
a 0 1. represents a dilation of a from the y-axis and a dilation of b from the x-axis. 0 b 1 0 1 2. represents a reection in the y-axis, and 0 0 1 the x-axis.
1
represents a reection in
2G
1 2 0 1 0
0 4
1
iii
iv
0 2
2 WE22 WE24 Find the image of the point (3, 5) under the above transformations in question 1 . 3 Find the image of the graphs of the following equations under the transformations in 1 i and 1 ii. a y= 1 x2 b y = x3 5 c y= x
3 2
ii
2 2
iii
1 5 0
Chapter 2
101
5 WE23 Find the image of the point (1, 2) under the transformations given in question 4 . 6 Find the image of the following equations under each of the transformations defined in questions 4 i and 4 ii. a y = |x| b y = x2 3x 7 The transformation T : R2 R2 which maps the curve with the equation y = x3 to the curve with the equation y = (3x 6)3 + 1, could have: A x 1 0 x 6 T = + y 0 3 y 1 x 1 0 x 2 T = 3 + y 0 1 y 1 x 3 0 x 6 T = + y 0 1 y 1 B x 1 0 x 6 T = 3 + y 0 1 y 1 x 1 0 x 3 T = + y 0 3 y 1
For the following transformations, where T : R2 R2, state what the transformation T 1 represents and determine the image of the equation f ( x ) = . x x 1 0 x 6 x 2 0 x 3 a T = b T = 1 + + y 0 2 y 1 y 0 2 y 1 x 1 c T = 3 y 0 0 x 1 + 1 y 2
9 A function g(x) is mapped to the curve h(x) = g(4(x + 1)) + 3. Create a matrix equation that will map g(x) to h(x). 10 WE25 The following transformations are applied, in order, to the graph of y = x3 4x: dilation by a factor of 2 from the x-axis reection in the y-axis translation of 1 unit in the y direction. a Use matrices to determine the image equation under these transformations. b Find the image of the point (2, 0) and check whether this point lies on the curve of the equation from a. 11 WE26
3 1 + 1 , describe, in order, the transformations and g( x ) = 2 ( x 2)2 x performed to the graph of f (x) to give g(x) and create a matrix equation which would map f (x) to g(x).
If f ( x ) =
12 If f (x) = g(2(x + 1)) + 1 and g( x ) = x , find f (x) in terms of x only, using: a an algebraic method without the use of a CAS calculator b matrices and a CAS calculator. 13 If f (x) = 2g(x 1) 2 and g(x) = x2 3x, find f (x) in terms of x only, using: a an algebraic method without the use of a CAS calculator b matrices and a CAS calculator. 14 If
x3 1 1 h( x + 2) + 1 = 3 x 2 6 x , find h(x) using matrix methods. 2 2 2
102
2H
Difference functions
A difference function is of the form y = f (x) g(x), or alternatively y = (f g)(x). It is essentially the same as a sum function except that one of the individual functions is subtracted from the 1 other. So y = x 2 could be sketched by the same method as described above but instead of x adding the y-ordinates, we would subtract one from the other. The domain of a difference function is determined in the same way as a sum function. We could extend our rule above to include difference functions. y If h(x) = f (x) g(x), then the domain h(x) = 4 y = x2 domain f (x) domain g(x). 3 y = x2 1 x 2 We can also think of a difference function as adding a 1 y= 1 1 x negative and it could be written y = x 2 + . With this x x 0 4 3 2 1 1 1 2 3 4 in mind, an alternative method of sketching the graph of a 2 difference function is to reect the graph of the second function 1 (in this example, ) in the x-axis and then add the ordinates as for a sum function. x
Chapter 2
103
When sketching graphs of sum/difference functions, there are key points that can be found on either individual function to easily identify the value of the ordinate of the sum or difference function. These are the x-intercepts and any point of intersection of the individual functions. The x-intercept is where the ordinate of that particular function is zero, so the graph of the sum or difference function is actually the ordinate of y the other function for that value of x. 2.5 At the intersection, the ordinate of the sum function 2 will be double that of the two individual functions. 1.5 For a difference function, an intersection of the two individual functions corresponds to on x-intercept 1 (y = 0) of the difference function. 0.5 Another useful y-value to look for is where the graphs of individual functions have y-values that are 1.5 1 0.5 0 0.5 1 1.5 x of the same magnitude but one is positive and one 0.5 is negative. This point is an x-intercept of the sum function.
WORKED EXAMPLE 27
int-0527
Worked example 27
Sketch the graphs of y = loge (x + 2) and y = |x| on the same set of axes over the required domain x [1, 2].
1.5 1 .5 0
2
Moving from left to right, add the y-coordinates of the two graphs for the key points and plot the resultant points. The key points are the: end points y-intercepts points of intersection. The new points on the graph are marked by an asterisk.
y 3 (1, 1) 2 y = log ( e x + 2) 1
(2, 2)
1.5 1 0.5 0
Left end points (1, 0) and (1, 1), so the new point will be at (1, 1). Right end points (2, loge (4)) and (2, 2), so the new point will be at (2, 2 + loge (4)). y-intercepts (0, 0) and (0, loge (2)). Points of intersection (0.44, 0.44) and (1.15, 1.15), so the new points will be (0.44, 0.88) and (1.15, 2.30).
104
y f(x) = loge (x + 2) +x 3 (2, 2) y = x (1, 1) 1 y = loge (x + 2) (2, loge (4)) 1.5 1 0.5 0 0.5 1 1.5 2 2.5 x 2
y 3 2 (1, 1) 1
1.5 1 0.5 0
Product functions
A product function is of the form y = f (x) g(x), or alternatively y = (fg)(x). When graphing product functions, it is useful to graph the individual functions, f and g, and for any relevant values of x, to identify the y-values, or ordinates and multiply these together to obtain the y-value of the product function. If the y-value is undened at a particular value of x for either of the individual functions, then the product function is undened for that value. We cannot multiply by an undened number. If h(x) = f (x)g(x), then the domain h(x) = domain f (x) domain g(x). When examining the graph of the two individual functions, it is useful to look at x-intercepts and points where the value of either function is 1. The product function will also have an x-intercept at a point where either individual function has an intercept (as multiplying by zero gives zero). At a point where a function = 1, the product function will have a value equal to the value of the other function, or its negative. It is also useful to observe that where the individual functions are both above the x-axis, or both below the x-axis, the value of the product function will be positive, that is, above the x-axis. This is because the product of two positive numbers or two negative numbers is positive. Alternatively, where one function is above and one below the x-axis, the value of the product function will be negative, that is, below the x-axis.
WORKED EXAMPLE 28
Chapter 2
105
2 3 4
Find the domain of f (x) and the domain of g(x). Find the domain of f (x) g(x). Find the x-intercepts of both f and g and hence nd the x-intercepts of the product fg.
Dom f = R and dom g = [1, ) Dom fg = [1, ) x-intercept for f (x) is when x = 0 and f (x) = 0 x-intercept for g(x) is when x = 1 and g(x) = 0 Hence, the x-intercepts for the product are when x = 0 and x = 1. f (x) is negative and g(x) is positive for x (1, 0), so fg is negative for x (1, 0). f (x) and g(x) are both positive for x (0, ), so fg is positive for x (0, ). The turning point is ( 32 , 0.77).
Find the values of x for which the product is negative. Find the values of x for which the product is positive. Find the turning point using a CAS calculator. Round the answer to 2 decimal places as appropriate. Sketch the graph of the product.
6 7
y = 2x x + 1
(1, 0)
2 ( , 0.77) 3
(0, 0)
REMEMBER
1. For the sum/difference function, dom(f (x) g(x)) = dom f (x) dom g (x). The graph of the sum/difference function can be obtained by using the addition of ordinates method. 2. For the product function, dom (f (x) g(x)) = dom f (x) dom g(x). Some features of the graph of the product function are as follows: (a) the x-intercepts of f (x) g(x) occur where either f (x) or g(x) have their x-intercepts (b) f (x) g(x) is above the x-axis where f (x) and g(x) are either both positive or both negative (c) f (x) g(x) is below the x-axis where one of the functions f (x) or g(x) is positive and the other is negative. EXERCISE
2H
106
Determine the equation of g(x) h(x) in each of the following cases then, using addition of ordinates, sketch the graph of g(x) h(x). x + 1, h( x ) = x a g( x ) = b g(x) = | x |, h(x) = | x + 1| 2 3 For each of the following, find the domain of f (x)g(x). a f ( x ) = x 2 , g( x ) = 3 x b f (x) = x + 2, g(x) = |2x + 1| c f ( x ) = x , g( x ) = 1 x d f (x) = | x |, g(x) = x2 1 e f ( x ) = x 3 , g( x ) = x + 2 4
WE27 Sketch the graph of f ( x ) = x +
5 Two functions are defined as f (x) = x2 and g( x ) = x . a Sketch the graph of each on the same set of axes for 2 x 2. b Find the smallest possible value of a given that the domain of the function h, where h(x) = (f + g)(x), is a x 2. c Find f (0) and g(0), and hence nd h(0). d Find f (1) and g (1), and hence nd h (1). e Find f (2) and g (2), and hence nd h (2). f Using this information, sketch the graph of h(x) (on the same set of axes as in a). Given the functions f (x) = x3, g(x) = | x | and h(x) = f (x) + g(x): a Sketch the graph of each on the same set of axes for 2 x 2. b Find f (2)and g (2), and hence nd h (2). c Find f (0) and g (0), and hence nd h (0). d Find f (1) and g (1), and hence nd h (1). e Find f (2) and g (2), and hence nd h (2). f What is the range of the function h (in exact form). g Using this information, sketch the graph of h(x) (on the same set of axes as in a). 7 WE28 Two functions are defined as f (x) = x 3 and g( x ) = x . Let h( x ) = f ( x ) g( x ). a Find the domain of h. b Sketch the graph of each on the same set of axes. c Find f (0) and g (0), and hence nd h (0). d Find f (1) and g (1), and hence nd h (1). e Find f (2) and g (2), and hence nd h (2). f What is the range of the function h (in exact form)? g Using this information, sketch the graph of h(x) (on the same set of axes as in a). 6 8 Sketch the graphs of the functions f ( x ) = x + 5 and g( x ) = 8 x and use these to find the domain of the function h(x) = f (x) + g (x). On the same axes, sketch the graph of h(x), including the coordinates of any end points. x2 4, for 9 Use a CAS calculator to view and sketch the graphs of f (x) = | x + 2 | and g( x ) = 2 2.5 x 2.5. Then, without using the calculator, use these graphs to sketch the graph of h, if h(x) = (f g)(x) on the same set of axes. Using the calculator, check the shape of the graph you have drawn and use it to identify any signicant points such as intercepts and cusp points to 2 decimal places. (You may need to adjust your window settings in order to clearly identify these points.)
Chapter 2
107
2I
Composite functions can be rather complex to graph by hand, so a CAS calculator can be used for assistance when sketching.
WORKED EXAMPLE 29
For the pair of functions f ( x ) = a show that f (g(x)) is dened c state its domain.
THINK a
1
Create a table showing the domain and range of both functions. Domain Range
g(x) R+ R+
The domain of f (g(x)) must be the same as Domain of f (g(x)) = R+ the domain of g(x). Since the domain of g(x) is R+, it is the domain of f (g(x)).
108
Functional equations
Sometimes we are required to solve or analyse equations that are in terms of unknown functions, for example, f (x) or f (y), rather than being in terms of unknown variables, for example x or y. An example of the type of problem you might encounter is to nd a function that satises f (x + y) = f (x) + f (y). Alternatively, you might be required to determine if a particular function satises the rule f (2x) = 2f (x). Equations such as f (x + y) = f (x) + f (y) are called functional equations. There are generally two ways to solve these types of problems: algebraically or using a CAS calculator.
WORKED EXAMPLE 30
WRITE
Substitute the function into the LHS and RHS of the equation separately. Simplify the LHS of the equation to determine if it equals the RHS of the equation. Answer the question.
LHS = f (x + y) = 3x + y RHS = f (x) f (y) = 3x 3y LHS = f (x + y) = 3x + y LHS = f (x + y) = 3x 3y LHS = RHS x f (x) = 3 satises the equation f (x + y) = f (x) f (y)
WORKED EXAMPLE 31
WRITE/DISPLAY
On a Calculator page, press: MENU b 1:Actions 1 1:Dene 1 Complete the entry line as: Dene g(x) = 10x Then press ENTER .
To calculate g(2x) and 2g(x), complete the entry lines as: g(2x) 2g(x) Press ENTER after each entry. Examine the solutions to determine if the expressions are equal.
Chapter 2
109
Check that the equation holds true for all values of x by completing the entry line as: g(2x) = 2g(x) Then press ENTER . As the statement is true the equation must hold for all values of x.
Write the solutions for g(2x) and 2g(x) and answer the question.
g(2x) = 20x 2g(x) = 20x g(2x) = 2g(x) When g(x) = 10x it satises the equation g(2x) = 2g(x).
If we consider the same equation f (2x) = 2f (x) for a different function, for example, f ( x ) = x , we obtain two different equations, f (2 x ) = 2 x and 2 f ( x ) = 2 x , which are not equal. However, if we dene this function on a CAS calculator and enter the statement f (2x) = 2f (x), the result is x = 0. This means this equation holds true when x = 0 but not for any other values of x.
REMEMBER
1. For the composite function f (g(x)) to be dened, the range of g must be a subset of the domain of f. Furthermore, if f (g(x)) is dened, the domain of f (g(x)) equals the domain of g(x). 2. For equations involving algebra of functions, determine if the equation is true for the particular function by considering the LHS and RHS of the equation separately to test if the equation holds true for all values of x. EXERCISE
2I
i show that f (g(x)) is dened a f (x) = 2x 1 and g( x ) = x + 3 c f (x) = 3(x 2)3 and g(x) = x2 e f (x) = (x + 1)(x + 3) and g(x) = x2 2 Show that the function f (x) = 3x satisfies x + y f ( x) + f ( y) = the equation f . 3 3 3
WE30 Show that f ( x ) =
equation
f ( x) + f ( y) = x + y. f (x xy y)
2 satisfies the x
[ VCAA 2007]
EXAM TIP Show that questions require detailed working out to be given, so provide as many steps as possible to attain full marks. Write as required at the end of your solution once you have shown the problem is correct.
[Assessment report 2 2007]
110
4 WE31 Determine which of iv hold for the following functions: f ( x) ii f ( x y ) = i f (x y) = f (x) f (y) f ( y) x f ( x) f = iii f (x) + f (y) = (x2 + y2) f (xy) iv y f ( y) v f (xy) = f (x) f (y) b f (x) = | x | a f ( x) = x 1 1 c f ( x) = d f ( x) = 2 x x e f (x) = x2 f f (x) = 2x 1 f ( x) = and g( x ) = x , determine the values of a such that f (g(x)) exists. ( x + a) 2 1 + 2, determine if f g If f: RR, where f ( x ) = x 2 and g:R {1} R, where g( x ) = x +1 and g f exist and, if so, find the composition functions. If f: RR, where f ( x ) = 3 x and g:RR, where g(x) = x2 1, show that f g is not defined. By restricting the domain of g, find a function h such that f h is defined. Given w(x) = x + 3, x > 3 and v(x) = | x | 2, x R+, state the domain and range of each function. Hence, find if w v and v w exist and, if so, state their rules including their domains. Show that the equation g(x) = x3 satisfies the equation g(x) = g(x). Show that this statement is true for all functions of the form g(x) = xn, where n is an odd natural number. Show that g(x) = x4 satisfies the equation g(xy) = g(x)g(y). Show that this equation is true for all functions of the form g(x) = xn, where n is a natural number.
5 6 7 8
10
11 Given the two functions: 1 f : [0, 6] R, f ( x ) = 4 x ( x 6)2 g: [0, 6] R, g (x) = x2 + 6x nd the maximum value of | f (x) g(x)| for 0 x 6, correct to 2 decimal places, and determine the values of x in this interval for which the maximum occurs. [ VCAA 2007]
EXAM TIP Be careful to answer all aspects of the question (this question requires the x-value and the maximum). Always re-read the question to check you have met all requirements before moving on to the next question.
[Assessment report 2 2007]
12 Consider f : [4, ] R, f ( x ) = x 4 and g: R R, g(x) = 1 x. What transformations are required to obtain f (g(x)) from f (x)?
2J
Modelling
People such as scientists, nancial advisers, business analysts, economists, statisticians and others often have to deal with large and small sets of data. Once the data are collected, we are often interested in nding the rules that link features of the data. The process of nding such a rule is called modelling and the rule itself is known as the mathematical model. When nding the model, the best way to start is to plot the data, as the shape of the graph might suggest the type of relationship between the variables.
Types of graphs
By recognising the shape of a graph, it is possible to nd the rule or mathematical model that describes it. Throughout this chapter, several types of graphs have been investigated.
Chapter 2
111
The parabola: y = x2
y
The hyperbola: y =
y
1 x
0 0 x
y=0 0
x=0
The truncus: y =
y
1 x2
y=0
0 x=0
Reections and translations can be applied to each of these graphs, but the basic shape of each graph remains the same.
WORKED EXAMPLE 32
Match each of the following graphs with the appropriate model. i y = ax2 a
y x
ii y = ax3 b
y
iii y = c
y
a x d
x
iv y =
y
a x2 e
x
y= a x
y
THINK
WRITE i is a parabola; it matches graph b . i i is a cubic; it matches graph e . i i i is a hyperbola (the graph is in opposite quadrants); it matches graph c . iv is a truncus (the graph is in adjacent quadrants); it matches graph a . v
112
WORKED EXAMPLE 33
x y
0 0
1 2.5
2 3.54
3 4.33
4 5
5 5.59
The data in the above table exactly t one of these rules: y = ax 2 , y = ax 3 , y = a Plot the values of y against x.
THINK a Plot the values of y against x. a
a a , y= or y = a x . x x2
Study the graph. It appears to be a square root curve. Write the appropriate rule. To nd the value of a: select any pair of corresponding values of x and y. (Since we need to take a square root, the best to choose is the one where x is a perfect square.) Substitute selected values into the rule and solve for a. We need to make sure that the selected rule is the right one. Replace a with 2.5 in the rule. Substitute the values of x from the table into the formula and check if you will obtain the correct values of y.
b Assume that y = a x .
2.5 = a 1 =a1 a = 2.5 Verifying: y = 2.5 x y = 2.5 0 =0 (2, 3.54): y = 2.5 2 = 3.54 (3, 4.33): y = 2.5 3 = 4.33 y = 2.5 4 (4, 5): =5 (5, 5.59): y = 2.5 5 = 5.59 (0, 0): The rule that ts the data is y = a x , where a = 2.5.
As the values of y obtained by using the rule match those in the table, the choice of model is correct.
Chapter 2
113
The process of tting a straight line to a set of points is often referred to as regression. Statistical data is easiest to deal with in linear form. If the data is not linear, then a linear relationship can still be found by transforming the x scale. A regression line can then be tted. m For example, y = x + c is a hyperbola. However, if we substitute X for 1 , the rule becomes x linear: y = mX + c. The graph of y versus X will be a straight line with a gradient of m and a y-intercept of c. These values (m and c) can then be established from the graph and thus the hyperbolic model can be determined. Note: In a quadratic relationship, X is substituted for x2; in a cubic relationship, X is substituted for x3.
WORKED EXAMPLE 34
It is believed that, for the data in the table below, the relationship between x and y can be modelled by y = a ax x2 + b bx x + c. x y 0 4 1 5.3 2 8.6 3 14.8 4 23 5 34.4
b Calculate the values of a, b and c (correct to 3 decimal places) and write the equations.
WRITE/DISPLAY
THINK a
1
On a Lists & Spreadsheet page, enter x-values into column A and y-values into column B. Label each column x and y respectively.
On a Data & Statistics page, move the pointer to the horizontal and vertical axes and select the x-values variable and y-values variable respectively.
114
Return to the Lists & Spreadsheet page, then press: MENU b 4:Statistics 4 1:Stat Calculations 1 6:Quadratic Regression 6 Change the X List to x, and the Y List to y. Select OK and press ENTER
If the relationship between the variables is not given, we have to make an assumption of a model from the graph of the data. We then have to transform the data according to our assumption. If the assumption was correct, the transformed data, when plotted, will produce a perfectly straight, or nearly straight, line. Note: In this section we will consider only the rules of the type y = ax2 + b, y = ax3 + b, a y = + b and so on (we will not allow for a horizontal translation), so that the appropriate x substitution can be made.
WORKED EXAMPLE 35
x y
1 35
2 21
3 16
4 12
5 11
6 10
WRITE/DRAW y 35 30 25 20 15 10 5 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 x
The scatterplot appears to be a hyperbola. Write the appropriate formula (remember that we do not consider horizontal translations in this section).
Assumption: y =
a +b x
Chapter 2
115
Check your assumption: prepare a new 1 table by replacing values of x with x (leave the values of y unchanged). 1 Plot y against . x
1 x y
y 35 30 25 20 15 10 5 0
1 35
0.5 21
0.33 16
0.25 12
0.2 11
0.17 10
1 x
The graph is very close to a straight line, therefore the assumption of a hyperbolic model is correct.
y 35 30 25 20 15 10 5 0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1 X
If we replace
1 with X, the rule x becomes y = aX + b, which is the equation of the straight line, where a is the gradient and b is the y-intercept. These (a and b) can be found from the graph as follows: draw in the line of best t. Write the formula for the gradient. Select any 2 points on the line. Substitute the coordinates of the points into the formula and evaluate.
7 8 9
m=
y2 y1 x2 x1
10
Write the value of a. Write the general equation of the straight line. Substitute the value of m and the coordinates of any of the 2 points, say (1, 35) into the equation. Solve for c. (Alternatively, read the y-intercept directly from the graph.) State the value of b. Substitute the values of a and b into a y = + b to obtain the rule that ts x the given data.
11
12
13
14 15
35 = 30.12 + c c = 35 30.12 = 4.88 Since b is the y-intercept, b = c = 4.88 88. The rule for the given data is: y= 30.12 + 4.8 88 x
116
REMEMBER
1. 2. 3. 4.
Modelling is the process of nding the rule that ts the given data. The rule itself is called a mathematical model. The best way to start modelling is to produce a scatterplot of the original data. Use the scatterplot of the data to make an assumption of the model of the relationship. a It should be of the type y = ax2 + b, y = ax3 + b, y = + b and so on. To test the x assumption, transform the data accordingly. If the assumption is correct, the transformed data when plotted will produce a straight, or nearly straight, line. 5. To nd the values of a and b in the model, draw a line of best t; a is the gradient of the line and b is the y-intercept. EXERCISE
2J
Modelling
1
WE32 Match each of the graphs with the appropriate model:
i y = ax2 + b a iii y = + b x
ii y = ax3 + b a iv y = 2 + b x
v y=a x +b
a y b y c y
x x
2
eBoo k plus eBook
Digital doc
WE33 The data in each of the tables below exactly fit one of these rules: y = ax2, y = ax3,
Spreadsheet 076
Modelling
a a ,y = or y = a x . For each set of data, plot the values of y against x and draw the x x2 graph. Select the most appropriate rule, and nd the value of a. y= a x y b x y
3 8.1 2 24 2 2.4 1 6 1 0.3
0 0 1
6
1 0.3 2
24
2 2.4 3
54
3 8.1
0 0
Chapter 2
117
x y
1 2 1.5 1.96 5 1 0 0
5 0.08
0.08 0 0 1 5
3
2 1 1.6 4 1.25
1
x y
x y
x y
2
12
40.5
12
1.5
ii
a + b? x2 iii y
iv
y x
y x
A i only D i , i i and i v 4
B i , i i and i i i E i , i v , and v
C i v and v
WE34 It is believed that for the data in the table below, the relationship between x and y can be modelled by y = ax2 + b.
x y
0
3.2
1
1
2 4.9
3 14.5
4 29
5 46.8
a Plot the values of y against x. b Plot the values of y against x2 and draw the line of best t. c Find the values of a and b and hence the equation describing the original data. 5 The table below shows the values of 2 variables, x and y. x y
4 28 2 13.5
0
12.5
2
10
4 4.3
6 41
Establish the mathematical model of the relationship between the variables, if it is known that it is of the form y = ax3 + b. 6 The table below shows the results, obtained from an experiment, investigating the frequency of a sound, f, and the length of the sound wave, .
0.3 1130
0.5 680
1 340
3 110
5 70
8 40
10 35
118
a Plot f against . b From the following relationships select the one which you think is suggested by the plot: a f = a2, f = , f = a . 1 c Based on your choice in part b, plot f against either 2, or , draw in the line of best t and use it to nd the rule that connects the 2 variables. 7 For her science assignment, Rachel had to find the relationship between the intensity of the light, I, and the distance between the observer and the source of light, d. From the experiments she obtained the following results. d I 1 270 1.5 120 2 68 2.5 43 3 30 3.5 22 4 17
a Use a graphics calculator to plot the values of I against d. What form of relationship does the graph suggest? b Nathan (Rachels older brother) is a physics student. He tells Rachel that from his studies a he is certain that the relationship is of the type I = 2 . Use this information to help d Rachel to nd the model for the required relationship. 8 WE35 The table below gives the values of 2 variables, x and y. Establish the rule, connecting x and y, that fits these data. x y 0 4 1 7 3 9 5 11 7 12 9 13
9 Joseph is a financial adviser. He is studying the prices of shares of a particular company over the last 10 months. Months Price, $ 1 6.00 2 6.80 3 7.45 4 8.00 5 8.50 6 8.90 7 9.30 8 9.65 9 10.00 10 10.30
a Represent the information graphically. b Establish a suitable mathematical model, which relates the share price, P, and the number of the month, m. c Use your model to help Joseph predict the share price for the next 2 months.
eBoo k plus eBook
Digital doc
Investigation
Goal accuracy
Chapter 2
119
SUMMARY
Graphs of the power functions
Name Parabola
Basic shape
y
Domain R
(b, c) 0
Cubic
y = a(x b)3 + c
y 0 (b, c) x
Hyperbola
y=
a +c xb
y c 0 b y x
R \{b}
R \{c}
or y = a( x b) 1 + c Truncus a +c ( x b) 2 or y = a( x b) 2 + c y=
R \{b}
c 0 b x
Square root
y=a xb +c or y = a( x b) + c
1 2
xb
(b, c)
If a > 0 yc If a < 0 yc
The equation for any graph y = f (x) above can be written in the general form: y = af (x b) + c. This form can be used to describe transformations of all of the functions considered. For all of the above functions: 1. a is the dilation factor: it dilates the graph from the x-axis. 2. When an equation for these types of graphs is put into its general form of y = af (x b) + c, the horizontal dilation can be described in terms of a vertical dilation. 3. If a < 0, the basic graph is reected in the x-axis. 4. f (b x) or f (x + b) is the reection of f (x + b) in the y-axis. 5. b translates the graph b units along the x-axis (to the right if b > 0, or to the left if b < 0). 6. c translates the graph c units along the y-axis (up if c > 0, or down if c < 0).
120
To put equations into general form: 7. If the coefcient of x is a number other than 1, to nd the value of b and a, the equation should be transposed to make the coefcient of x equal to 1. For example, y = (3x + 5)2 + 4 5 2 = [3( x + 3 )] + 4
5 2 = 32 ( x + 3 ) +4 5 2 = 9( x + 3 ) +4
5 . 3
y = x, if x 0 and y = x, if x < 0
y y = |x| x
Domain: R Range: R+ {0} To sketch y = | f (x)|: 1. Sketch the graph of y = f (x). 2. Reect the portion of the graph that is below the x-axis in the x-axis. Or: 1. Express the function in hybrid form with specic domains where the absolute value expression is positive and negative. 2. Sketch each rule for the specied domain. For functions of the form y = a| f (x)| + c, a and c have the same impact on the graph of the absolute value function, as on the graphs of all other functions discussed in this section.
Transformations with matrices
The use of matrices to map transformations of points and equations can be summarised as follows, where (x, y) is the image of the point (x, y) under the transformation. x T y x T y x T y x T y x' 1 = = y' 0 x' 1 = = y' 0 0 x x = represents a reection in the y-axis. 1 y y
1 y
x = represents a reection in the x-axis. y x' a 0 x ax = = = represents a dilation of a factor of a from the y-axis. y' 0 1 y y x' 1 0 x x = = = represents a dilation of a factor of a from the x-axis. y' 0 a y ay
0 x
Transformations can be combined to represent more than one transformation. For example, 4x + 2 x ' 4 0 x 2 = + = 0 1 y y' y 3 + 3 2 2
x = 4x + 2 y y = +3 2
Chapter 2
121
describes the following: dilation by a factor of 4 from the y-axis, a dilation by a factor of 2 from the x-axis, reection in the x-axis, a horizontal translation of +2 and a vertical translation of +3.
Sum and difference of functions
For the graph of the sum/difference function, dom (f (x) g(x)) = dom f (x) dom g(x). The graph of the sum/difference function can be obtained by using the addition of ordinates method. For the product function, dom (f (x)g(x)) = dom f (x) dom g(x). Some features of the graph of the product function are as follows: the x-intercepts of f (x)g(x) occur where either f (x) or g(x) have their x-intercepts f (x)g(x) is above the x-axis where f (x) and g(x) are either both positive or both negative f (x)g(x) is below the x-axis where one of the functions f (x) or g(x) is positive and the other is negative.
Composite functions and functional equations
For the composite function f (g(x)) to be dened, the range of g must be a subset of the domain of f. Furthermore, if f (g(x)) is dened, the domain of f (g(x)) equals the domain of g(x). Equations involving algebra of functions, for example f (2x) = 2f (x), are generally tested to determine if they are true for particular functions. To determine if an equation is true for a particular function, consider the LHS and RHS of the equation separately to determine if the equation holds true for all values of x. Alternatively, you may nd a particular x-value for which the equation does not work; that is, a counterexample. These types of equations can be investigated by dening the functions on the CAS calculator and then testing the algebraic function equation.
Modelling
Modelling is the process of nding the rule (mathematical model) that ts the given data. To model: 1. Plot the original data on graph paper or use a CAS calculator. 2. Make an assumption of the model. 3. Transform the data in accordance with your assumption. 4. Check the assumption by plotting the transformed data (if correct, the graph will be a straight or nearly straight line). 5. Draw in a line of best t. 6. Find the equation of the line (y = mx + c). 1 7. Replace x in the equation with the transformed variable (for example, x2, ). x
122
CHAPTER REVIEW
SHORT ANSWER
1 For the function x 3)2 4: a state the coordinates of the turning point b state the domain and range c sketch the graph. a 2 The graph of y = + c has a vertical xb asymptote at x = 2 and a horizontal asymptote at y = 1. a Find the values of b and c. This graph then undergoes the following transformations: reection in the x-axis dilation by a factor of 3 from the x-axis horizontal shift of 2 units right. b If the intersection of the two graphs is at (m, 2), nd the value of m. c Hence nd the equation of the transformed graph. 6x 5 3 Express the function f ( x ) = in the form 3x + 1 b a+ . Hence describe the transformations x+c required to produce this curve from the graph of 1 y= . x 4 The graph of a cubic function has a stationary point of inflection at (1, 1). It cuts the y-axis at y = 4. Find the equation of the graph. 1 5 The graph of y = was dilated by the factor of x 4 from the x-axis, reected in the x-axis and then translated 2 units to the left and 1 unit down. a State the equation of the asymptotes. b State the domain and range. c State the equation of the new graph. d Sketch the graph. 6 a State the changes necessary to transform the 1 y graph of y = 2 into x the one shown. b Find the equation of the graph.
2 1
3 2
7 The domain of a truncus is R \{1}, the range is (, 2) and the graph cuts the y-axis at y = 3. Find the equation of the function. 8 The basic square root curve was reflected in both axes and then translated so that its intercepts at the axes were (0, 1) and (5, 0). Find the size and the direction of the translations; hence, find the equation of the new graph. 2 2, 9 a Sketch the graph of y = 2 ( x + 2)2 clearly showing the coordinates of the cusps, the intercepts with the axes and the position of the asymptotes. b State the domain and range of the graph in a. 10 The graph of f: [5, 1] R where f (x) = x3 + 6x2 + 9x is shown.
y
a On the same set of axes sketch the graph of y = /f (x) /. b State the range of the function with the rule y = /f (x) / and domain [5, 1].
[ VCAA 2006]
11 The point (1, 3) undergoes a translation given by a the matrix to (2, 0). Find a and b and describe b the transformations involved. 12 The point (1, 2) undergoes a series of a 0 transformations given by the matrices and 0 b 1 then to (7, 4). 2 a Find the values of a and b. b Find the image under the transformations of: i y=2 x ii y = x3 + x 13 A point on a curve (x, y) undergoes a a 0 transformation descibed by to (x', y'), 0 2 where a is a real constant such that a > 0.
Chapter 2
123
a Find the values of x and y in terms of a, x' and y'. b If the point is on the curve y = 2x2 x, nd the image of the curve in terms of a under this transformation. c If the point (3, 6) is on the transformed curve, nd the value(s) of a and hence the rule of this image. 14 The graph of the function f : (2, 1) R, f (x) = x3 + 2x2 is shown below.
y 3 f(x) = x3 + 2x2 (2, 0) 2 1 0.5 1 x (1, 3)
MULTIPLE CHOICE
1 The equation of a parabola is given by y = m 2(x + 3)2, where m > 0. The increase in m will result in: A the graph being thinner B the graph being wider C the increase of the domain D the increase of the range E the graph being shifted further to the right 2 The coordinates of the turning point of the parabola y = 2(3x + 6)2 3 are: A (6, 3) B (6, 3) C (2, 3) D ( 2, 3) E ( 2, 3) (bx bx 3)3 + 1 is dilated in the 3 The graph of y = 2 3 y direction by the factor of: 3 b C 2b B 2 A 2 3 3 3 2 3 D b E 3b3 4 The graph of y = 2 (3 + 4x)3 has a stationary point of inflection at:
3 , 2) A (4
2 1.5 1 0.5 0 1
Let g(x) = f (x) + 1, and sketch this graph on the same set of axes. Hence, sketch (f + g)(x). 15 The graph of the function f:(2, 2), f (x) = /x / is shown below.
(2, 2) y f(x) =x 2 (2, 2) 1 1 2 x 2
B (
2 1 10
Let g(x) = f (x) + 1 and sketch the graph of this function on the same set of axes. Hence, sketch f (g(x)). 16 Let f (x) = x2 determine which of the following relationships are true. a f (x) f (y) = f (x) f (y) b f (x) f ( y) = f (x) + f (y) c f (x) + f (y) = f (x) + f (y) d f (x) f (y) = f (x) + f (y) 17 The data in the table below exactly fit one of these a models: y = ax3, y = 2 or y = a x . x x y 2 25 4 6.25 5 4 10 1 20 0.25 25 0.16
a Plot the values of y against x and use the scatterplot to choose a suitable model. b Plot the values of y against either x3, 1 or x x2 (depending on your choice in part a ). Did you choose the right model? Explain your answer. c Find the value of a.
C (3, 2) D ( E (3, 2) 2 5 If f ( x ) = + 1, then f (x) + 2 will have: x A the horizontal asymptote y = 2 B the horizontal asymptote y = 1 C the horizontal asymptote y = 3 D the vertical asymptote x = 2 E the vertical asymptote x = 1 6 The equation of the graph shown is likely to be: 2 y A y= 1 x2 2 B y =1 x+2 2 x 2 1 C y= 2 x +1 2 1 D y= x+2 2 E y= 1 x+2 7 If the graph of y = 1 is reflected in the y-axis, x 3 units to the right and 2 units up, the translated 4 resulting graph would have the equation: 1 3 A y= + x2 4 3 +2 B y= 4x
3 , 2) 4 3 , 2) 4
124
1 3 4x 1 +2 D y= 4x 3 1 +2 E y= 3 4x C y = 2 8 Which of the following is not true for the graph at right? y A The vertical asymptote is x = 2. B The horizontal asymptote is y = 4. x 2 C The domain is R\{2}. D The range is R\{4}. 4 E The value of the y-intercept is greater than 4. 9 To obtain the graph shown, we need to: A translate the graph of y 1 y = 2 one unit to the left x and reect in the x-axis x 1 B translate the graph of 1 y = 2 one unit to the left x and reect in the y-axis 1 C translate the graph of y = one unit to the x2 left and reect in both axes 1 D translate the graph of y = 2 one unit to the x left and dilate it in the x direction E none of the above 10 The equation of this graph is of the form: A y = a x m + n, a > 0 B y = a m x + n, a > 0 C y = a x m + n, a < 0 D y = a m x + n, a < 0 E y = a x + m + n, a < 0 11 The equation of this graph could be: A y=d ax B y= xa +d C y=d xa D y = c a x E y= a x c
c y d b a x y (m, n) x
12 The domain of the function f ( x ) = 2 x 1 + 3 is: A [1, ) B [3, ) C [0.5, ) D [2, ) E [1, ) 1 13 The range of the function y = 3 2 is: x2 A (1, ) B (, 5] C [3, ) D (, 2) E ( , 2] 14 The equation of the graph shown in the diagram below is best described by: y A y = |x + 2| + 2 2 B y = 2 |x + 2| C y = |2 x| + 2 x 2 D y = 2 |2 x| E y = |x + 2| 2 15 The value(s) of k for which |2k + 1| = k + 1 are: 2 2 B A 0 only C 0 or 3 3 1 2 E or 0 D 0 or 2 3 [ VCAA 2006] 16 Under the transformation T : R2 R2 of the plane x 2 0 x 1 dened by T = + , the y 0 1 y 3 image of the curve y = | x | has the equation: A B C D E y= y = | 2x + 1| 3 y = 2 | x + 1| 3 y = 2 | x 1| + 3 y=
1 2 1 2
x 1 + 3
x 1 3
17 If g:[2, 4] R, where g(x) = x2(x 3), and h:(0, 3] R, where h(x) = 3 x, then the function f (x) such that f (x) = g(x) h(x) is defined by the rule: A f: R R, where f (x) = x2(x 3)2 B f: (0, 3] R, where f (x) = x2(x 3)2 C f: [2, 3] R, where f (x) = x2(x 3)2 D f: (0, 4] R, where f (x) = x2(x 3)2 E f: [2, 3] R, where f (x) = x2(x 3) (3 + x) 18 Given the function f ( x ) = x 3 then f h could exist if h(x) was defined as: A h(x) = x + 2 B h(x) = x2 3 C h(x) = x3 D h(x) = x2 + 3 E h( x ) = x 2
Chapter 2
125
19 The data in the following table exactly fit one of these models: y = ax2, y = ax3 or y = a x . x y 1 0.3 2 2.4 3 8.1 4 19.2
B 1.2 D 0.9
20 For certain data the values of y were plotted against 1 and the line of best fit was drawn as seen on x the diagram below. The model that relates the variables x and y is: y A y = 20x 1 (1, 19) B y = 19x + 1 x 1 C y= 20 19 D y = 1 x (0.1, 1) 20 1 1 E y= x x
EXTENDED RESPONSE
1 The graph of y = f (x) is shown at right. a Sketch the graph of each of the following functions on the same set of axes with the original graph and give the coordinates of the points A, B, C and D. i y = f (x) ii y = f (x) iii y = f (x 2) iv y = f (x) + 3 v y = 2f (x) vi y = 1 f (x + 1) b Maya, a fabric designer, wishes to use the curve of y = f (x) (red) to create a wavy pattern as shown in the diagram at right. If she wants the waves to be 2 units apart vertically, suggest the best way she could alter the equation of y = f (x). (Remember a fabric has a xed width!) 2 Consider the function f:R R, f(x) = (x 1)2 (x 2) + 1. a The coordinates of the turning points of the graph of y = f(x) are (a, 1) 25 and (b, 27 ). Find the values of a and b.
D(4, 6)
B C(2, 3) A 2 3 2 7 x
2 units apart
b Find the real values of p for which the equation f(x) = p has exactly one solution. c For the following, k is a positive real number. x i Describe a sequence of transformations that maps the graph of y = f (x) onto the graph of y = f 1. k x y = f 1 ii Find the x-axis intercepts of the graph of in terms of k. k d Find the real values of h for which only one of EXAM TIP the solutions of the equation f (x + h) = 1 is positive. Students must ensure that they show
[ VCAA 2004]
(2, 0.5)
(0.5, 2) R,
(0.5, 4) f(x) = 12
x
their working if a question is worth more than one mark, students risk losing all available marks if only the answer is given and it is incorrect. The instructions at the beginning of the paper state that if more than one mark is available for a question, appropriate working must be shown. When students present working and develop their solutions, they should use conventional mathematical expressions, symbols, notation and terminology.
126
The graph of y = f (x) is to be transformed to become the graph of y = f (2x) + 1. a Describe these two transformations. b Create matrices to represent these transformations. c Use these matrices to nd the images of the points (1, 1) and (2, 0.25) under these transformations, and use these values to deduce the images of the points (1, 1) and (2, 0.25). d On the same axes, sketch this transformed function, showing the coordinates of the four points from c above. e Using any method, nd a rule for this transformed function. 4 A proposed section of a ride at an amusement park is to be modelled on the curve y = 1 (600 x + 25 x 2 x 3 ), 500 where y is the height (in metres) of the ride above ground level and x is the horizontal distance (in metres). The x-axis represents ground level. It will travel through a tunnel from A to C; B is the lowest point in the tunnel and D is the highest point on the ride.
y D
A B
Ex
a Find the horizontal distance from A to E. b Find the greatest depth below ground level and the maximum height above ground level that the rollercoaster will reach in this section (correct to 2 decimal places). c Describe the impact that a dilation by a factor greater than 1 from the x-axis would have on: i the maximum depth and maximum height from b ii the point at which the rollercoaster would emerge from the tunnel iii the gradient of the slope at this point. 5 Lena and Alex are planning to buy a new house. Theyve been watching the prices of 3-bedroom houses in a specific area, where they want to live, for the whole year. During each month they collected the data and then, at the end of the month, they calculated the average price for that month. The results of their calculations are shown in the table below. (The prices given are in thousands of dollars.) Month Price 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
240 248 255 261 266 271 273 274 275 274 272 270
a Plot the prices against the months. What model does the graph suggest? b If the model of the form y = a(x b)2 + c is to be used for these data, what is (judging from the graph) the most suitable value for h? c Plot the values of y (the prices) against (x b)2, where b is the value youve selected in part b . Comment on the shape of the graph. d Draw a line of best t and nd its equation. Hence, state the values of a and c in the model. e Write the equation of the model. f According to the Real Estate Institute, the property market is on a steady rise (that is, the prices are going up and are likely to rise further). Do the data collected by Lena and Alex support this theory? g Use the model to predict the average price for the next 2 months.
Chapter 2
127
h Lena and Alex were planning to spend no more than 250 000 for their new house. Several months ago the prices were in their range, but they could not nd what they wanted. If the prices are going to behave according to our model, how long do they have to wait until the prices fall back into their range? 6 An eagle soars from the top of a cliff that is 48.4 metres above the ground and then descends towards unsuspecting prey below. The eagles height, h metres above the ground, at time t seconds can be modelled by a the equation h = 50 + , where 0 t < 25 and a is a constant. t 25 a Find the value of a. b Find the eagles height above the ground after i 5 seconds ii 20 seconds. c After how many seconds will the eagle reach the ground? d Comment on the changes in speed during the eagles descent. e Sketch the graph of the equation. After 24 seconds, the eagle becomes distracted by another bird and reaches the ground exactly 2 seconds later. For this second part of the journey, the relationship between h and t can be modelled by the equation h = a(t 24)2 + c. f Find the values of a and c. g Fully dene the hybrid function that describes the descent of the eagle from the top of the cliff to the ground below.
eBoo k plus eBook
Digital doc
Test Yourself
Chapter 2
128
eBook plus
ACTIVITIES
Chapter opener
Digital doc
10 Quick Questions: Warm up with ten quick questions on functions and transformations. (page 57)
2A Transformations of the parabola
Digital docs
Spreadsheet 132: Investigate transformations. (page 59) Spreadsheet 108: Investigate the quadratic function in power form. (page 61)
2B The cubic function in power form
Digital docs Digital docs
Spreadsheet 015: Investigate the cubic function in power form. (page 65) Spreadsheet 236: Investigate graphs of functions. (page 70)
2C
Tutorial
WorkSHEET 2.2: Identify transformations, state domain and range, sketch graphs of power functions and absolute value functions. (page 96) Spreadsheet 002: Investigate graphs of absolute value functions. (page 96)
2G Transformations with matrices
Interactivity
WE 9 int-0522: Watch a worked example on sketching the graph of a hyperbola. (page 74)
Digital docs
Spreadsheet 051: Investigate the hyperbola. (page 72) Spreadsheet 236: Investigate graphs of functions. (page 71) WorkSHEET 2.1: Find the domain, range, coordinates of turning points and equations of asymptotes of various graphs. (page 78) History of Mathematics: Investigate the history of major curves. (page 78)
2D The power function (the truncus)
Digital doc
Transformations with matrices int-0247: Consolidate your understanding of using matrices to transform functions. (page 96)
Tutorial
WE 25 int-0526: Watch how to use matrices to determine the resultant equation after transformations. (page 100)
2H
Tutorial
WE 27 int-0257: Watch how to use addition of ordinates to sketch the sum of two functions. (page 104)
2J Modelling
Digital docs
WE 16 int-0523: Watch a worked example on implied domain and range. (page 88)
Digital doc
Spreadsheet 076: Investigate modelling with functions. (page 117) Investigation: Goal accuracy. (page 119)
Chapter review
Digital doc
Test Yourself Chapter 2: Take the end-of-chapter test to test your progress. (page 128)
To access eBookPLUS activities, log on to www.jacplus.com.au
WE 20 int-0524: Watch a worked example on sketching the graph of an absolute value function. (page 93) WE 21 int-0525: Watch a worked example on expressing an absolute value function as a hybrid function. (page 94)
Chapter 2
129
EXAM PRACTICE 1
SHORT ANSWER 15 minutes
CHAPTERS 1 TO 2
1 The functions f g are graphed below. On the same axes sketch a graph of f + g.
f g
1 a xb 1 C y= +b x+a 1 E y= +a x+b A y=
+b ax 1 D y= a xb
B y=
3 For y = (2x 3)2 1: a write down the y-coordinate of the turning point b determine the equation of the axis of symmetry.
2 marks
4 a Using the factor theorem, show that x + 2 is a factor of x3 7x 6. b Given x3 7x 6 = (x + 2)Q(x) where Q(x) is a quadratic factor, determine Q(x).
2 marks
A B C D E
y = (x a)(x b)2(x c)2 y = (x a)(x c)2 y = (x a)3(x c)2 y = (x a)(x c) y = (x a)(x b)(x c)
5 For what values of c does the graph of y = +c intersect the graph of y = x2 + x 2 at two distinct points?
2 marks
2x
3 The coefficient of the term in x4 in the expansion of 3 (2 x 2 )5 is: x A 240 B 72 C 60 D 72 E 720 4 What is the equation of the horizontal asymptote of the graph of y = A y = 4 3 D y= 4 3x 2 ? 4x B y = 3 E y=3
C y = 1
MULTIPLE CHOICE
10 minutus
Each question is worth 1 mark. 1 Given a, b R, this graph could have the rule:
y
5 The quadratic function f : D R, f (x) = 2(x + 1)2 5 has a domain, D, of [0, 3]. The range of f is: A [1, 3] C [5, 27] B R D [3, 27] E [5, ) 6 The simultaneous linear equations 3x + ay = 12 and ax + 3y = 4a have innitely many solutions for: A a [3,3] B a=3 C a = 3 or a = 3 D a=9 E a=0
y=b x=a 0 x
130
EXTENDED RESPONSE
40 minutes
1 Severe tropical cyclone Vance devastated the town of Exmouth in northern WA in 1999. It produced a measured wind gust of 267 km/h, which is the highest wind speed ever recorded on mainland Australia. In order for it to be first categorised as a cyclone, its wind speed needed to exceed 119 km/h. Several years later, it is a peaceful day, with no wind detectable at 1 pm. By 3 pm, however, the wind speed is gusting to 200 km/h, and the residents know they are in trouble. a Let t be the time in hours after noon and v be the wind speed. Establish a linear model of the form v = at + b to represent the relationship between the wind speed and time. 2 marks b Using this model, determine to the nearest minute when the wind speed will be high enough for classication as a cyclone. 1 mark c Predict to the nearest minute when the cyclone will break the record for the highest wind speed ever recorded. d Explain why the linear model is unsatisfactory as a model for the cyclones behaviour. e
1 mark 1 mark
i The wind speed actually peaks at 256 km/h at 5 pm. Use this data and the wind speed at 1 pm to help to create a quadratic model relating wind speed (v) to hours after noon (t). How well does this model match all the data provided? ii The wind speed actually returns to zero at 1 am the following morning, 12 hours later. Discuss how well this result matches the quadratic model.
2 marks
i Establish a second quadratic model that exactly matches the following data: Time 1 pm 5 pm 1 am Wind speed 0 km/h 256 km/h 0 km/h
1 mark
ii Evaluate how well this model represents the relationship between time and wind speed. g It has been suggested that a cubic function would be a better model for the data. Use all the data provided in order to establish a cubic model.
h The graph below shows how air pressure in hectopascals (P hPa) and wind speed (v km/h) relate to 1 distance (x) across a cyclone. It has been suggested that a truncus (general form v ( x ) 2 ) could represent x the shape of the relationship between speed and distance across the cyclone.
1020 1010 1000 990 980 970 960 950 0 km Eye 175 150 125 100 75 50 25
500 km
i What is the equation to the vertical asymptote for this relationship? ii Determine a rule for the relationship between speed (v) and distance (x). iii Determine a rule for the relationship between air pressure (P) and distance (x).
Pressure (hPa)
Solutions
Exam practice1
Exam practice 1
131
3
Exponential and logarithmic equations
arEas oF sTudy
The index laws Logarithm laws Exponential equations Logarithmic equations using any base Exponential equations (base e) Equations with natural (base e) logarithms 3G Inverses 3H Literal equations 3I Exponential and logarithmic modelling
3A 3B 3C 3D 3E 3F
Logarithm and exponent laws Identification of appropriate solution processes for solving logarithmic and exponential equations Numerical solutions of exponential and logarithmic equations Solution of literal equations such as emx + n = k
Application of algebraic and logarithmic properties to the simplification of expressions and the solution of equations Finding the rule of an inverse function involving logarithmic and exponential equations Application of logarithmic and exponential functions in modelling practical situations
eBook plus
3a
Digital doc
10 Quick Questions
A number in index form has two parts, the base and the index, power, exponent or logarithm. A number in index form is represented like this:
ax
Base
( a)
y
1 (a 0) ax
132
Worked Example 1
Simplify
Think
1 2
( 2 x 2 y3 ) 3 3( xy4 )2 . 6 x 4 2 xy4
Write
Remove the brackets by multiplying the indices. Add the indices of x and add the indices of y. Simplify 23 to 8 and multiply the whole numbers. Subtract the indices of x and y. Divide 24 by 12.
(2 x 2 y 3 )3 3( xy 4 )2 23 x 6 y 9 3 x 2 y8 = 6 x 4 2 xy 4 12 x 5 y 4 = 24 x8 y17 12 x 5 y 4
= 2x3y13
For negative indices and fractional or decimal indices, the same rules apply.
Worked Example 2
c 125
THINK a
1 2 3 4
Rewrite using the index law a y = a x . Rewrite using a x = ( y a ) x . Simplify by taking the cube root of 64. Square 4. Write as a fraction with a positive index.
4 Change 0.4 to 10 . y
2 y
a 64 3 =
64 2
= ( 3 64 )2 = 42 = 16
b 32
0.4
1 2
= = =
1 320.4 1 3210 1 32 5
2 4
4 5 6
Rewrite using the index law a y = a x . Simplify by taking the 5th root of 32. Square 2.
( 32 )2 1 = 2 2 1 = 4
1
5
133
Complete the entry line as: 125 3 . Then press ENTER . Note: If the calculator is set to Approximate, the answer will be displayed as a decimal.
125
2 3
= 25
Worked Example 3
a 2 b4 ( a 3 b 4 )
1 1 a2 b b 1 2 3 b
THINK a
1 2 3
Remove the brackets by multiplying the indices. Add the indices of a and of b. Place a5 in the denominator with a positive index. On a Calculator page, complete the entry line using the fraction template 1 2 1 a b as: 3 1 b 2
a a 2b4 (a3b 4)
- -1
1 1 2 a b 1 2 3 b
3 a
If the expression contains different numbers that do not have the same base, write each number as a product of prime factors.
134
WorkEd ExamplE 4
Simplify
Think a
1
3 n 6 n + 1 12 n 1 : 32 n 8 n
WriTE/display
3n 6 n + 1 12 n 1 32 n 8 n 3n (3 2) n + 1 (22 3) n 1 = 32 n ( 2 3 ) n 3n 3n + 1 2 n + 1 2 2 n 2 3n 1 32 n 2 3 n 3 n 3 n 1 3 2 = 2n 3 23 n = = 3n 2 1 = 3n 2 = 3n 2
-1
2 3
Remove the brackets. In the numerator, add the indices of numbers with base 3 and add indices of numbers with base 2. Subtract the indices. Write the term with a negative index in the denominator with a positive index. Simplify. On a Calculator page, complete the entry line using the fraction template as: 3n 6 n + 1 12 n 1 32 n 8 n Then press ENTER .
b
4 5 6
3n 6 n + 1 12 n 1 3n = 2 32 n 8 n
WorkEd ExamplE 5
eBook plus
Tutorial
int-0528
Worked example 5
WriTE
a x
3 x 2 1 = 2 3x 2 x
Chapter 3
135
= = =
1 x2 3x 2 2 2 x x 1 3x 4 2 x2 x
Simplify. Rewrite the question using positive indices. Find the common denominator for the terms in the brackets and simplify. Follow the process for division of fractions (change the division sign to a multiplication sign and invert the second fraction). Find the common denominator. Expand the brackets on the numerator. Simplify the numerator by adding like terms. Factorise the numerator and write the answer.
1 3x 4 x2 1 3 b + = 1 1 + 2 2 x x = = = = = 3 x + 1 + 2x 1 2x x x 3x x + 1 + 2x 1 2x 3 x (1 2 x ) + x (1 + 2 x ) (1 + 2 x ) (1 2 x ) 3x 6 x 2 + x + 2 x 2 (1 + 2 x ) (1 2 x ) 4x 4x2 (1 + 2 x ) (1 2 x ) 4 x (1 x ) (1 + 2 x ) (1 2 x )
5 6
REMEMBER
6. a y = a and a y = a x = ( a ) x Exercise
3A
d (x 3)2
( x 2 )3 x 5 ( x 5 )2
136
2 WE2 a
2 27 3 2
Simplify:
3
b 25
2 3 5
c 810.25
27 3 d 64 3 Simplify: a x4 x5 x3
1
243 e 32
3
b 16 4 e 256 81
3 4
c 361.5
d 9 2 49 4 WE3 a
3x 3y2
b
5
1 2 2x 2 y 3
3 2 9x 2 y2
2
3 1 2 x 2y2
1 1 2 9x 5 y 2
3 2 a2b c d 1 3a 2 bc 2
2 a 3 b3 3 1 2 a c
5 Simplify: a x
4y-1
(x 2y3) 1
b
1 2 12 4x 5 y 2
1 3 5x 3 y 4
1 2 1 83 x 3 y 2
2
1 16 2
1 2 1 2 x5y 4
3 3 a 2b4 d ab 2
9a 3 b 2 2 3 4a b
6 WE4 Simplify: a 2n 4n + 1 8n - 1 d 32 2
3 92
3
b 3n 9n - 1 27n + 1
c 2n 3n + 1 9n
16
7 Simplify: a 2n - 1 3n 6n + 1 b
52 3
1 2
125 9
27 5
8 WE5 Simplify, writing your answer as a single fraction with positive indices. x 1 1 + c 1 x +1 x 1 1 9 MC 3 x + 3x is equal to: A 1 B 1 + 32 x 3x C 3
x2
a x 1 +
1
1
b (x 1 + x 2) 2 d 2x(x2 - y2) 1 - (x - y)
-1
D 6
x E 1 + 3 3x
137
3B
Logarithm laws
If a > 0, then N = ax loga (N) = x. For example, an expression in index form can also be rewritten in logarithmic form. 8 = 23 log 2 (8) = 3 Since 0 then loga (0) is undefined. a0 = 1 loga (1) = 0 a1 = a loga (a) = 1 Let m = ax loga (m) = x and n = ay loga (n) = y. mn = ax ay loga (mn) = x + y = ax + y = loga (m) + loga (n) x m m a = log a = x y n n ay = ax - y = loga (m) loga (n) mp = (ax)p loga (mp) = px = axp = p loga (m) ax
Change-of-base rule
Suppose b = ax, then loga (b) = x. Consider N = by, then logb (N) = y. But N = by = (ax)y = axy. Therefore, loga (N) = xy = loga (b) logb (N). Thus, log b ( N ) = log a ( N ) . log a (b)
Worked Example 6
Log of 1 to any base is equal to zero: loga (1) = 0. If the number and base are equal the answer is 1: loga (a) = 1.
Worked Example 7
138
WorkEd ExamplE 8
d log 5
( x ).
5
Rewrite using loga (mn) = loga (m) + loga n. Simplify. Simplify using loga (a) = 1. m Rewrite using log a = log a (m) log a ( n). n Simplify. Simplify using loga (a) = 1. Rewrite 16 as a number with base 2. Rewrite using loga (mp) = p loga (m). Simplify using loga (a) = 1. Rewrite using y a = a y . Rewrite using loga (mp) = p loga (m).
1
= log10 (10) =1
b log 4 (20) log 4 (5) = log 4
1 2 3
20 5
= log 4 (4) =1
c log2 (16) = log2 (24)
1 2 3
= 4 log2 (2) =4
d log 5
1 2
( x ) = log x
5 5 1
1 5
= 5 log 5 ( x )
WorkEd ExamplE 9
WriTE/display
On a Calculator page, complete the entry line as: log3 (27) + log3 (9) + log3 (81) Then press ENTER .
WorkEd ExamplE 10
eBook plus
log 3 ( 9 ) c . log 3 ( 27 )
Tutorial
int-0529
Worked example 10
Chapter 3
139
Think a
1 2 3 4 5
Write
Write 2 as 2 log10 (10) because log10 (10) = 1. Rewrite using loga Write 102 as 100. Multiply the numbers in the brackets. Rewrite using loga (mp) = p loga (m). (mp) = p loga (m). Rewrite using loga (mn) = loga (m) + loga (n).
= log10 (102) + log10 (3) = log10 (102 3) = log10 (100 3) = log10 (300)
b 3 log3 (6) 3 log3 (18) = log3 (63) log3 (183)
1 2
Rewrite using m log a = log a (m) log a ( n). n Write 63 as 6 6 6 and 183 as 18 18 18. Simplify. Write the numbers with the base 3. Rewrite using loga (mp) = p loga (m). Simplify using loga a = 1. Write the numbers with the same base. It is not possible to cancel the 9 and the 27 because they cannot be separated from the log. Rewrite using loga (mp) = p loga (m). Cancel the logs because they are the same.
c
63 = log3 3 18 666 = log3 18 18 18 1 = log3 3 3 = log3 (3 3) = 3 log3 (3) = 3 1 = 3 log3 (9) log3 (32 ) = log3 (27) log3 (33 ) = = 2 log3 (3) 3 log3 (3)
2 3
4 5 6 7
2 3
Worked Example 11
Write/display
On a Calculator page, complete the entry line as: log2 (18) Then press ENTER . Pressing Ctrl / ENTER will give a decimal approximation.
140
REMEMBER
For a > 0: 1. loga (1) = 0 2. loga (a) = 1 3. loga (0) is undefined. 4. loga (x) does not exist when x 0. 5. loga (mn) = loga (m) + loga (n) Exercise
m 6. log a = log a (m) log a ( n) n 7. loga (mp) = p loga (m) log a ( N ) 8. log b ( N ) = log a (b)
3B
Logarithm laws
1 WE6 Evaluate the following. a log3 (1) b log5 (1) c log2 (2) d log6 (6) c log5 (125) = x 2 WE7 Write the following in index form. a log2 (16) = 4 b logx (25) = 2 d log3 (x) = 5 3
1 = 1 e log 5 5
Write the following in logarithmic form. a 23 = 8 b 34 = 81 d 5x = 125 e 2 1 = 1 2 Simplify: b log2 (10) log2 (5) e
1 log 5 5
b 3 log3 ( 3 x )
c log 2
x4 y2
6 WE9 Simplify: a log4 (10) + log4 (2) log4 (5) c 1 log10 (16) + log10 (52 )
2
b log5 (25) + log5 (125) log5 (625) d log3 (2) log3 (10) + log3 (15)
e log2 (16) + log2 (8) + log2 (4) 7 WE10 Simplify: a 4 log2 (12) 4 log2 (6) d log 2 (64) log 2 (8) b 2 + log5 (10) log5 (2) e log a ( x ) log a ( x ) c log10 (0.5) f log3 (60) b 4 log2 (x) + log2 (x3) log2 (x6) d 4 log6 (x) 5 log6 (x) + log6 (x) f 4 log10 (x) log10 (x) + log10 (x2) h log4 (x 2)3 2 log4 (x 2)
Chapter 3 Exponential and logarithmic equations 141
c 1 + log2 (5)
8 WE11 Evaluate correct to 3 decimal places. a log10 (3) b log5 (4) d log2 (0.8) 9 e log4 (20) Simplify: a 5 log3 (x) + log3 (x2) log3 (x7) c 3 log4 (x) 5 log4 (x) + 2 log4 (x) e log10 (x2) + 3 log10 (x) 2 log10 (x) g log5 (x + 1) + log5 (x + 1)2
10 MC 2 log10 (5) log10 (20) + log10 (8) is equal to: B log10 (2) C 1 A log10 (2)
D 1
E log10 (4)
11 MC If loga (b) = 2, then b is equal to: A 0 B 1 C 2 D a E a2 12 If y = a log10 (x), find x when a = 2 and y = 3. Give your answer correct to 3 decimal places.
3C
Exponential equations
The equation ax = b is an example of a general exponential (or indicial) equation and 2x = 32 is an example of a more specific exponential equation. To solve one of these equations it is necessary to write both sides of the equation with the same base if the unknown is an index or with the same index if the unknown is the base.
Worked Example 12
Write
Write 32 with base 2, the same as the left-hand side. The indices are equal because the base is 2 on each side of the equation. Write 27 with base 3.
a 2x = 32
2x = 25 x=5
b 3x =
2 3
Write 1 as a number with base 3. 33 Equate the indices. Divide both sides by 2 to leave 3x on the left-hand side. Write 81 as a number with base 3. Equate the indices. Write 16 with base 2. Equate the indices. Solve for x.
d
1 27 1 = 3 3 3x = 3 3 x = 3
1 2 3
c 2 3x = 162
3x = 81 x=4
3x = 34 21 x = 16 21 x = 24 x = 3
1 2 3
1x=4
Worked Example 13
Solve 5x 252x 3 = 625 for x: a using index laws b with a CAS calculator.
Think a
1
Write/display
142
3 4 5 6
Remove the brackets in the index. Add the indices on the left-hand side. Equate the indices. Solve the equation. On a Calculator page, press: MENU b 3:Algebra3 1:Solve1 Complete the entry line as: solve(5x 25(2x - 3) = 625,x) Then press ENTER .
Sometimes it is possible to use the methods for solving quadratic equations to help solve indicial equations. Remember that 22x = (2x)2.
WorkEd ExamplE 14
eBook plus
c 4x - 2x + 3 + 16 = 0 WriTE
Tutorial
int-0530
Worked example 14
Use the Null Factor Law to solve by making each bracket equal to zero. Solve each equation. Write 16 as a number with base 2 but -4 can not be written with base 2. Solve by equating the indices. Write 32x as (3x)2.
a (2x - 16)(2x + 4) = 0
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
b 32x - 12 3x + 27 = 0
Let 3x = a to make a simpler quadratic equation to solve. Factorise. Use the Null Factor Law by making each bracket equal to zero. Solve for a. Substitute back a = 3x. Write numbers with base 3.
Chapter 3
x = 1, x = 2 (2x)2 4x 2x + 3 + 16 = 0 2x 23 + 16 = 0
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
Rewrite 23 as 8. Let 2x = a to make a simpler quadratic equation to solve. Replace a 8 with 8a because the coefficient precedes the pronumeral. Factorise. Use the Null Factor Law. Solve for a. The two factors are equal because a2 8x + 16 = 0 is a perfect square. Substitute back a = 2x. Write 4 as a number with base 2. Solve by equating the indices.
2x = 4 2x = 22 x=2
Remember to always make the right-hand side equal to zero when solving quadratic equations. It is a good idea to substitute your answer back into the original equation to check the accuracy of your work. If the base is not the same and the numbers cannot be written with the same base, then logarithms can be used. It is possible to take the logarithm of both sides of an equation provided the same base is used.
Worked Example 15
Solve for x in the following. Give your answers in exact form using base 10 and correct to 3 decimal places. a 5x = 10 b 2(x + 1) = 12
Think a
1 2 3 4
Write
Take the logarithm of both sides to base 10. Use loga (mp) = p loga (m) and loga (a) = 1. Divide both sides by log10 (5). Use a calculator to simplify. Take the logarithm of both sides to base 10. Use loga (mp) = p loga (m) to simplify. Divide both sides by log10 (2).
5x = 10 log10 (5x) = log10 (10) x log10 (5) = 1 x= 1 (exact form) log10 (5)
1 2 3
2(x + 1) = 12 log10 (2(x + 1)) = log10 (12) (x + 1) log10 (2) = log10 (12) ( x + 1) = log10 (12) log10 (2)
144
4 5
x=
Note: Logarithms in bases other than 10 may be used. Inequalities are worked in exactly the same way except that there is a change of sign when dividing or multiplying both sides of the inequality by a negative number.
Worked Example 16
Solve the following equations for x, giving your answers both in exact form and correct to 3 decimal places. a 2x > 5 b 0.5x 1.4
Think
1
Write/display
On a Calculator page, press: Menu b 3:Algebra 3 1:Solve 1 Complete the entry lines as: solve(2x>5,x) solve(0.5x1.4,x) Press ENTER after each entry.
Write the answers in exact form. The calculator defaults to base e when solving exponential equations in exact form. Note: ln (A) loge (A). This will be discussed later in this chapter. Note: In part b , the inequality has been 1 changed to because log e 2 < 0. Press Ctrl / ENTER after solving each equation to obtain a decimal approximation. Write the answers correct to 3 decimal places.
x>
REMEMBER
1. The equations ax = y and 2x = 32 are exponential equations. 2. Write numbers with the same base to help simplify problems. The most commonly used bases are 2, 3 and 5. 3. If the base is the same, equate the indices. 4. If the indices are the same, equate the bases.
145
5. Use the Null Factor Law to solve quadratic equations. 6. A negative number cannot be expressed in index form, for example, -4 cannot be expressed with base 2. 7. a2x = (ax)2 8. Take the logarithm of both sides of an equation or inequation using the same base. 9. Change the sign of an inequality when multiplying or dividing by a negative number. 10. loga (x) > 0 if x > 1 11. loga (x) < 0 if 0 < x < 1 ExErCisE
3C
eBook plus
Digital doc
Exponential equations
1
WE12
3x
= 81
= 32
d 7x = 1 49 2
SkillSHEET 3.1
Index form
3
eBook plus
Digital doc
WE13
3x
SkillSHEET 3.2
Solving equations
c 2x 4x - 1 = 16 4
WE14
Solve for x in the following. a - 1) = 0 b 22x - 6 2x + 8 = 0 2 x x c 6 -76 +6=0 d 4x - 6 2x - 16 = 0 x x e 9 =23 +3 (3x 9)(3x b 42x - 20 4x = -64 c (1.4)2 - x = 6 f 2x 3x + 1 = 10 c (0.2)x > 3
eBook plus
Digital doc
SkillSHEET 3.3
Solving indicial equations by equating the bases
b (0.3)x - 1 = 10 e 5 7x = 1
eBook plus
Digital doc
C 897.749
SkillSHEET 3.4
Solving liner inequations
C 10x + 1, 10x - 1
E log10 (4)
146
3d
WorkEd ExamplE 17
Solve for x in the following equations. a log2 (x) = 3 b log3 (x4) = -16
Think a
1 2
c log5 (x - 1) = 2 WriTE
Rewrite using ax = y loga (y) = x. Rearrange and simplify. Rewrite using loga (mp) = p loga (m).
a log2 (x) = 3
23 = x
x=8
b
1 2 3 4
Divide both sides by 4. Rewrite using ax = y loga (y) = x. Rearrange and simplify.
1 2
c log5 (x - 1) = 2
52 = x - 1
x - 1 = 25 x = 26
The base of a logarithmic function and the base of an exponential function must be a positive real number other than 1. In the expression loga (x), a R+\{1}.
WorkEd ExamplE 18
eBook plus
without technology
b log x
1 125
Tutorial
int-0531
Worked example 18
WriTE/display
Chapter 3
147
This is the only solution. The solution x = 2 is not valid because the base of a logarithmic function must be a positive real number other than 1.
b
1
On a Calculator page, press: Menu b 3:Algebra 3 1:Solve 1 Complete the entry line as: solve(log x
1 125
= 3, x )
Solving log x
1 125
= 3 for x gives x = 5.
Worked Example 19
Think a
1 2 3
Write
Rewrite using
ax
= y loga (y) = x.
a log2 (16) = x
2x = 16 2x = 24 x=4
Write 16 with base 2. Equate the indices. Rewrite using ax = y loga (y) = x.
1 b log 3 =x 3
3x =
1 3 1 = 1 3
2 3
Write 3 with base 3. Equate the indices. Rewrite using ax = y loga (y) = x. Write 9 with base 3. Remove the brackets. Equate the indices. Solve.
3x = 3
x = 1
c log9 (3) = x
1 2 3 4 5
9x = 3
(32)x = 3 32x = 31 2x = 1 x=
1 2
148
WorkEd ExamplE 20
Solve for x in the following. a log2 (4) + log2 (x) - log2 (8) = 3
Think a
1
Simplify the left-hand side. Use loga (mn) = loga (m) + loga (n) and m log a = log a (m) log a ( n) . n
4 x log 2 =3 8 x log 2 = 3 2 23 = x 2
2 3
x = 2 23 =28 = 16
b log10 (x) + log10 (x - 3) = log10 (4)
1 2 3 4
Simplify the left-hand side by using loga (mn) = loga (m) + loga (n). Equate the logs. Expand. Solve the quadratic equation.
x > 0, x - 3 > 0 because it is not possible to take the logarithm of a negative number, x > 3.
rEmEmBEr
1. In a logarithmic equation, the unknown can be: (a) the number, log2 (x) = 5 (b) the base, logx (8) = 3 (c) the logarithm, log2 (4) = x. 2. In the expression loga (x), a is a positive real number other than 1. 3. Use laws of logarithms and indices to solve the equations. 4. Check that all solutions are valid. ExErCisE
3d
eBook plus
Digital doc
i log5 (x) = 2
WorkSHEET 3.1
Chapter 3
149
i i log x (25) =
2 3
= 2
1 i i log 5 =x 5
i v log6 (1) = x
i i log 4
1 16
=x
i v log8 (1) = x
5 Solve for x in the following. i log2 (x) + log2 (6) log2 (3) = log2 (10) i i log2 (x) + log2 (5) log2 (10) = log2 (3) a
i i i log3 (5) log3 (x) + log3 (2) = log3 (10) i v log5 (4) log5 (x)+ log5 (3) = log5 (6) v log5 (x) + log5 (x 2) = log5 (3) b i log3 (x) + log3 (x + 2) = log3 (8) i i i log5 (x) + log5 (x + 20) = 3 v log6 (x 2) + log6 (x + 3) = 1 i i log4 (x) + log4 (x 6) = 2 i v log5 (x + 1) + log5 (x 3) = 1
6 MC If loga (x) = 0.7, then loga (x2) is equal to: A 0.49 D 0.837 A (log10 (a))2 + log10 (a) 6 D (a 2)(a + 3)
150
C 0.35
7 MC If log10 (x) = (a), then (log10x)2 + log10 (x) 6 becomes: C log10 (x3) 6
8 Solve for x in the following. a (log10 (x))2 + log10 (x) 2 = 0 (Hint: Let a = log10 (x)) c (log2 (x))2 2 log2 (x) = 8 e (log3 (x))2 log3 (x4) + 3 = 0 g log2 (x4) = (log2 (x))2 i log10 (x2 + 2x 5) = 1 log10 ( x ) = 4, find x. 9 If log10 (2)
b d f h j
(log10 x)2 2 log10 (x) 3 = 0 (log2 (x))2 + 3 log2 (x) = 4 (log5 (x))2 log5 (x3) + 2 = 0 log3 (x3) = (log3 (x))2 log3 (x2 3x 7) = 1
3E
Eulers number e, named after an 18th century Swiss mathematician, is a very important number used in problems involving natural growth and natural decay. Like , it is irrational and has to be approximated: e = 2.718 281 828 459 . . . The number e can be used to find the value of an investment after a period of time, or the temperature of a liquid after it has been cooling. n 1 To find the value of e, take the expression 1 + and evaluate it for increasing values of n. n n 1 1 1 1 + = 1 + = 2 n=1 1 n n = 2 n = 3 n = 5 n = 10 n = 100 1 1 1 + = 1 + = 2.25 n 2 1 1 1 + = 1 + = 2.370 37 3 n 1 1 1 + = 1 + = 2.48832 n 5 1 1 1 + = 1 + 10 n
n n 10 n 5 n 3 n 2
= 2.59374
100
1 1 1 + = 1 + 100 n
n
= 2.70481
1000
1 1 n = 1000 1 + = 1 + 1000 n
n
= 2.716 92
10 000
1 1 n = 10 000 1 + = 1 + n 10 000
n
= 2.71815
1 As n increases, 1 + becomes closer and closer to 2.718 281 or e, or n n 1 e = lim 1 + n n An answer given in terms of e is an exact answer. The laws of indices apply in the same way if e is the base, that is: ex ey = ex + y ex ey = ex y (ex)y = exy e0 = 1 1 x e = x e
x ey
= ex
151
Worked Example 21
Write
Write the equation. Write e with a power of 1. Equate the indices. Solve for x.
e3x = e e3x = e1 3x = 1 1 x= 3
CAS calculators have an ex function, which is treated in the same way as any other number.
Worked Example 22
Solve for x, showing working and with a CAS calculator. Express your answers in exact form and correct to 3 decimal places. a ex = 3 b ex 3ex = 2
Think Write/display
Method 1: Technology-free
a
1 2 3 4
Write the equation. As loge (e) = 1, take loge of both sides of the equation. Rewrite using loga (xp) = p loga (x). Solve for x. Write the equation. 1 Write e x as . ex Multiply every term by ex. Make the right-hand side equal to zero. Let ex = a. Factorise and solve for a.
ex = 3 loge (ex) = loge (3) x loge (e) = loge (3) x = loge (3) 1.099, correct to 3 decimal places.
1 2 3 4 5 6
b ex 3e
ex
=2 3 x =2 e
(ex)2 3 = 2ex (ex)2 2ex 3 = 0 a2 2a 3 = 0 where a = ex (a 3)(a + 1) = 0 a 3 = 0 or a + 1 = 0 a = 3 or a = 1 ex = 3 or ex = 1 loge (ex) = loge (3) x 1.099, correct to 3 decimal places.
7 8
Substitute ex for a. Solve for x by taking the log of both sides to base e. ex = 3 is the only solution because ex = 1 has no real solution.
152
Method 2 : Technology-enabled
1
On a Calculator page, press: Menu b 3:Algebra 3 1:Solve 1 Complete the entry lines as: solve(ex = 3,x) solve(ex 3ex = 2,x) Press ENTER after each entry.
x = loge (3).
3 decimal places.
REMEMBER
1. Eulers number e is an irrational number, which is approximated to 2.718 (correct to 3 decimal places). 2. Evaluate e by using the ex button on the calculator. 3. The number e is an exact answer. Use the calculator to give an approximation if required. 4. The laws of indices apply in the same way if e is the base. 5. On a calculator, use the LN button to take the log of a number to base e. The LOG button defaults to base 10 if not specified. 6. loge (x) = ln (x). 7. ex > 0, that is, ex = 1 has no real solution. Exercise
3E
b e4 g ln (4)
c e 2 h ln (5)
d e 3 i loge (1.5)
2 WE21 a ex = e
h e 2 x 1 = e3
153
3 WE22 Solve for x in each of the following, giving your answer correct to 3 decimal places. a ex = 2 e ex = 1.3 b ex = 5 f ex = 2.6 c e x =
1 2
d e x =
1 4
g 2ex = 6
h 3ex = 12
4 Solve for x in each of the following, giving your answer correct to 3 decimal places. a (ex 1)(ex + 2) = 0 b (ex 2)(e2x 3) = 0 c (3ex 2)(2ex 1) = 0 d (ex)2 ex = 0 g 6 11ex + 3e2x = 0 a ex 4ex = 0 d 3ex + 6ex 11 = 0 a ex > 1 d e2x 4 g e > 0.75 7 If y = Aekt, and y = 19.6 when t = 2, and y = 19.02 when t = 5, find the value of the constants A and k. Give your answers correct to 2 decimal places. 8 For a body that has a higher temperature than its surroundings, Newtons Law of Cooling is given by the formula = 0ekt, where is the difference between the temperature of the body and its surroundings after t minutes and 0 is the difference between the original temperature of the body and its surroundings. If the temperature of a freshly poured cup of coffee is 90 C in a room with a constant temperature of 18 C, and it cools to 65 C after 10 minutes, find the value of k. Give your answer correct to 2 decimal places.
x
f (ex)2 7ex + 10 = 0
5 Solve for x in each of the following, giving your answer correct to 3 decimal places. c 5ex 12ex 11 = 0 f ex + 2ex = 3 c ex < 2 f e1 x 10
6 Solve for x in each of the following, giving your answer correct to 3 decimal places.
3F
Worked Example 23
Solve for x, giving your answer both in exact form and correct to 3 decimal places, given that loge (x) = 3.
Think
1
Write/display
loge (x) = 3 e3 = x
154
2 3
Write the answer in exact form. On a Calculator page, press: Menu b 3:Algebra 3 1:Solve 1 Complete the entry line as: solve(ln (x) = 3,x) Then press ENTER .
x = e3
Worked Example 24
Solve for x giving your answer correct to 3 decimal places where appropriate. a loge (3) = loge (x) b loge (x) + loge (3) = loge (6)
Think a Write a loge (3) = loge (x)
x=3
Rewrite using loge (mn) = loge (m) + loge (n). Equate the number parts. Solve for x.
REMEMBER
2. e log
( x)
=x
3. 10 log
10
( x)
=x
7. loge (mn) = loge (m) + loge (n) or m 8. log e = log e (m) log e ( n) n 9. loge (mp) = p loge (m) Exercise or or
3F
2 Solve for x, giving exact answers when appropriate, otherwise, correct to 3 decimal places. a ln (2x) = 2 b ln (3x) = 1 c ln (x3) = 3 d ln (x2) = 2 g ln (x - 1) = -1 e ln (x2) = 0.4 h ln (2x + 1) = -2 f ln (x3) = 0.9
3 WE24 Solve for x, giving exact answers when appropriate, otherwise, correct to 3 decimal places. a loge (x) = loge (2) b loge (x) = loge (5) c loge (x) + loge (3) = loge (9) e loge (x) - loge (5) = loge (2) 4 Solve for x, giving exact answers. a loge (x) + loge (5) - loge (10) = loge (3) c 3 loge (2) + loge (x) - loge (4) = loge (5) e loge (x) + loge (x + 1) = loge (2) d loge (x) + loge (2) = loge (8) f 1 + loge (x) = loge (6) b 2 loge (3) + loge (x) - loge (2) = loge (3) d loge (4) + loge (3) - loge (x) = loge (2) f ln (x + 1) + ln (2x - 1) = ln (5)
5 mC If ln (y) = ln (x) + ln (a), then an equation relating x and y that does not involve logarithms is: x a A y=x+a B y = ax C y=x-a D y= E y= a x 6 mC In the equation 2 loge (x) - loge (3x) = a, x = A 3ea B -a C 3a D loge (6a) E no solution
7 Write the following equation without logarithms and with y as the subject. 2 loge (x) + 1 = loge (y) 8 If loge (x) = a and y = ea, express y in terms of x. 9 Solve for x the equation eln (x) = 2.
eBook plus
Digital doc
WorkSHEET 3.2
10 Five grams of a radioactive substance is decaying so that the amount, A grams, that is left after t days, is given by the formula A = 5e-kt. a Find the value of A when the number of grams of the radioactive substance has been halved. b Rewrite the equation with the new value of A. c Rearrange the equation so that t is the subject of the equation. d If k = 0.005, find how long it will take for the number of grams of the radioactive substance to be halved. Give your answer correct to the nearest day.
3G
eBook plus
Interactivity
inverses
Inverse operations are opposite operations. Addition and subtraction are inverse operations and multiplication and division are inverse operations. Squaring and taking the square root are also inverse operations. The equation of the inverse of the function y = ex can be found by interchanging the x and y so that y = ex becomes x = ey. Using ax = y loga (y) = x, x = ey becomes loge (x) = y or y = loge (x). Therefore y = ex and y = loge (x) are the equations of inverse functions. Thus two important properties follow: aloga(x) = x, x R+ and loga a(x) = x, x R.
int-0248
Inverses
156
Worked Example 25
Calculate the inverse of y = 3ex + 1: a without the use of technology b using a CAS calculator.
Think a
1
Write/display
Interchange x and y to write the inverse equation. Divide both sides by 3. In order to make y the subject, begin by rewriting the equation using ax = y loga (y) = x. Make y the subject. Interchange x and y to write the inverse equation. On a Calculator page, press: Menu b 3:Algebra 3 1:Solve 1 Complete the entry line as: solve(x = 3ey+1,y) Then press ENTER .
2 3
x log e = y + 1 3 x y = log e 1 3 x = 3e y + 1
1 2
Worked Example 26
Calculate the inverse of f(x) = 2 log10 (x 1) + 1: a without the use of technology b using a CAS calculator.
Think a
1 2 3 4
Write
Interchange x and y to write the inverse equation. In order to make y the subject, begin by subtracting 1 from both sides. Divide both sides by 2. Rewrite using ax = y loga (y) = x.
x 1 2
= y 1
157
5 6
Add 1 to both sides. Write the answer. Interchange x and y to write the inverse equation. On a Calculator page, press: MENU b 3:Algebra3 1:Solve1 Complete the entry line as: solve(x = 2 log10 (y - 1) + 1,y) Then press ENTER .
y = 10
x 1 2
+1
x 1 2
f 1 ( x ) = 10
+1
1 2
x = 2 log10 (y - 1) + 1
3 4
Write the equation of the inverse. The solution from the CAS can be simplified to obtain the solution found in a . Rewrite the answer with a negative power. Add the powers when multiplying indices of the same base. Simplify the powers and write the answer.
10 2 y = 10 y = 10
1 2
+1
x + 1 2
10 2
x 1 + 2 2
+1
y = 10 y
1+
+1
x 1 = 10 2
+1 +1
f 1 ( x )
x 1 = 10 2
rEmEmBEr
1. The equation y = loge (x) is an inverse function of y = ex. 2. To find the inverse of a function, interchange x and y and then make y the subject. ExErCisE
3G
eBook plus
Digital doc
inverses
1
WE25 Find the inverse of the following. a y = 2ex b y = ex + 1 c y = ex - 1
d y = e2x - 1
e y = e2 - x
f y = e2 - 3x
SkillSHEET 3.5
Inverses
158
4 Find the equation of the inverse of the following. b y = 2 - loge (x) a y = 2 + loge (x) d f (x) = 2 - ln (x - 1) 5
x 1 5
e y = 3 + 2 ln (x - 1)
x 1 5
A e D 6
3 3
+2 2
B e E
3 5
2 1
C e
+2
x 1 e 5
x+2 e 3
A D 7
1 x + 1 +1 ln 5 2 1 x + 1 1 + ln 5 2 2
(2x)
B E
1 x + 1 1 ln 5 2 1 x + 1 1 ln 5 2 2
C 5 ln ( x 1) + 1 2
A x2
mC If eloge
C e2x
D 2x
3h
literal equations
An equation such as ekx = a, where k R and a R+, is called a literal equation. It does not have a numerical solution. The solution will be expressed in terms of the other pronumerals, in this case a and k, often called parameters. For this equation, the solution is: kx = ln (a) x = 1 ln (a), k 0, a R + k
WorkEd ExamplE 27
Solve ekx = 5 + 2e
Think
1 2 3 4
-kx
eBook plus
Tutorial
int-0532
Worked example 27
Rewrite the equation with positive powers. Multiply both sides by ekx. Let y = ekx and make the right-hand side zero to obtain a quadratic equation in terms of y. Solve for y using the quadratic formula.
e kx = 5 +
2 e kx
(ekx)2 = 5ekx + 2 y2 - 5y - 2 = 0
( 5)
y= y=
( 5)2 4 1 2 2 1
5 33 2 5 + 33 or 5 33 y= 2 2
y =
Chapter 3
159
5 6 7
Substitute ekx for y. Only the first solution is valid as ekx > 0. Re-write the exponential equation in logarithmic form using ax = y loga (y) = x or take logs of both sides. Divide both sides by k. Write the solution and state the restriction for k. On a Calculator page, press: Menu b 3:Algebra 3 1:Solve 1 Complete the entry line as: solve(ek x = 5 + 2e k x,x) Note: You must put in a multiplication sign between the k and the x. Then press ENTER .
e kx = e kx =
5 + 33 or kx 5 33 e = 2 2 5 + 33 2
8 9
10
x =
33 + 5 1 log e k 2
Worked Example 28
1 Solve for x, given that log 2 ( x ) 5 log 2 ( p) = log 2 ( 6 ) where p > 0, 2 a manually b with a CAS calculator.
Think a
1
Write/display
Simplify the left-hand side using p loga (m) = loga (mp) and m log a (m) log a ( n) = log a n Equate both sides. Multiply both sides by p5. Square both sides to obtain x. Write the solution and state the restriction for p.
1 log 2 x 2 log 2 ( p5 ) = log 2 (6) x log 2 5 = log 2 (6) p x =6 p5 x = 6 p5 x = (6p5)2 x = 36p10 where p > 0
2 3 4 5
160
On a Calculator page, press: Menu b 3:Algebra 3 1:Solve 1 Complete the entry line as: 1 solve log 2 ( x ) 5 log 2 ( p) = log 2 (6),x 2 Then press ENTER .
Write the answer. Note that the CAS gives the incorrect restriction p 0. The correct restriction is p > 0 for log2 (p) to be defined.
x = 36p10
Some equations can only be solved using a CAS calculator, that is, no algebraic method exists. The following example demonstrates this.
Worked Example 29
Solve the following equations using a CAS calculator. Give your answers correct to 3 decimal places. a ex = x3 b loge (x) = x 2
Think
1
Write/display
On a Calculator page, press: Menu b 3:Algebra 3 1:Solve 1 Complete the entry lines as: solve(ex = x3,x) solve(ln (x) = x 2,x) Press ENTER after each entry.
a Solving ex = x3 for x gives x = 1.857 or x = 4.536. b Solving loge (x) = x 2 for x gives x = 0.159 or
x = 3.146.
REMEMBER
1. An equation such as ekx = a, where k R and a R+, is called a literal equation. 2. Literal equations do not have numerical solutions. 3. The solution of a literal equation is expressed in terms of the other pronumerals, in this case a and k, often called parameters.
161
ExErCisE
3h
literal equations
1 Solve 5e2x = a for x, where a R+. 2 If log3 (D) = cy + log3 (Z), solve for D. 3 Solve emx + n = 3k for x, where m R\{0} and k R+. 4 Solve for q given that 2 log3 (p + 5q) = 4. x2 z2 x5 y4 y 5 Prove that log10 3 2 + log10 3 log10 3 4 log10 4 = 0. z x y z z z x 6 Consider the exponential equation 9xb 273a = 81. a Find x in terms of a and b, where a R, b R\{0}. b Hence find the value of x if a = 2 and b = -3. 7 Solve 42x - b = 20 for x, where b R. 8 Solve 2x - 1 = 3x + a for x, where a R. 9 If y = m + Rebx, solve for x. 10 Solve for a given that (log2 (5a))2 = 16b2. a 11 WE27 Solve e kx = 3 + kx for x, where a 0, k R\0. e 12 WE28 Solve for x given that 2 log 4 ( x ) 3 log 4 ( y ) = log 4 (3). 13 Solve for b given that 2 loge (a) - 5 loge (b) - 2 = 0, where a, b R+. 14 WE29 Solve the following equations using a CAS calculator. Give your answers correct to 3 decimal places. a ex = 3x b x+2=e x c x2 - 1 = e2x 15 WE29 Solve the following equations using a CAS calculator. Give your answers correct to 3 decimal places. a ln (x) = 2 - x b ln (x - 2) = x - 4 c x2 - 1 = ln (2x) 16 Solve for x given that log7 (x) = log4 (p).
1
3i
eBook plus
eLesson
eles-0091
Exponential and logarithmic modelling
162
WorkEd ExamplE 30
eBook plus
In the town of Ill Ness, the number of cases of a particular disease, Tutorial D, can be modelled by the equation D = D0ekt, where t is the time in years. int-0533 Using available medication the number of cases is being reduced Worked example 30 by 20% each year. There are 10 000 people with the disease today. a How many people will have the disease after one year? b Find the value of k correct to 3 decimal places. c Write the equation substituting values for k and D0. d Find how long it would take for the number of people with the disease to be halved. Give your answer correct to the nearest year. e How long would it take for the number of people with the disease to be reduced to 100? Give your answer correct to the nearest year.
Think a
1
WriTE
Find the percentage of people with the disease after one year. Find 80% of the original number. Write a sentence. Substitute t = 0 and D = 10 000 into the given equation.
2 3
80% of 10 000 = 8000 Therefore, 8000 people will have the disease after one year.
b
D = D0 ekt When t = 0 and D = 10 000, 10 000 = D0 ek 0 10 000 = D0 1 10 000 = D0 So D = 10 000ekt When t = 1 and D = 8000, 8000 = 10 000ek 1 8000 = ek 10 000 0.8 = ek loge 0.8 = loge (ek) -0.223 = k log (e) e -0.223 = k 1 k = -0.223
[1]
c d
c D = 10 000e d D = 10 000e
-0.223t -0.223t
2 3 4
Simplify by dividing both sides by 10 000. Take loge of both sides. Solve for t.
Write a sentence.
Chapter 3
163
1 2
Write the equation. Substitute 100 for D. Simplify by dividing by 10 000. Take loge of both sides. Solve for t. Write the answer in a sentence.
D = 10 000e
0.223t
3 4 5 6
loge (0.01) = 0.223t t 20.651 (3 decimal places) It would take about 21 years.
REMEMBER
1. Make a note of all the information that has been given. 2. Give your answers to the correct number of decimal places. 3. Continuous growth and decay is modelled by the equation A = A0ekt, A0 represents the initial value (that is, when t = 0) and k represents a constant.
Exercise
3I
Find the value of A and B correct to the nearest whole number. Write the equation relating x and y substituting values for A and B. Using your new equation, find the value of m correct to 3 decimal places. If y = 7.6, find x correct to the nearest whole number.
164
4 An amount of $1000 is invested in a building society where the 5% p.a. interest paid is compounded continuously. The amount in the account after t years can be modelled by the equation A = A0ert, where r is the continuous interest rate. a Find the value of A0 and r. b Write the equation substituting values of A0 and r. c Find the amount in the bank after i 1 year ii 10 years. Give your answer correct to the nearest dollar. d How long will it take for the investment to double in value? Give your answer to the nearest year. 5 The number of people living in Boomerville at any time, t years, after the first settlers arrived can be modelled by the equation P = P0ekt. Suppose 500 people arrived on 1 January 1850, and by 1 January 1860 there were 675 people. a What is the value of P0? b Find the value of k correct to 2 decimal places. c Write the equation substituting values for P0 and k. d What will be the population on 1 January 1900? Give your answer to the nearest 10 people. e When will the population be 2000? 6 A cup of soup cools to the temperature of the surrounding air. Newtons Law of Cooling can be written as T TS = (T0 TS)e kt, where T is the temperature of the object after t minutes, and TS is the temperature of the surrounding air. The soup cooled from 90 C to 70 C after 6 minutes in a room with an air temperature of 15 C. a Find the values of TS, T0 and k correct to 2 decimal places. b Write the equation substituting the values for TS, T0 and k. c Find the temperature of the soup after 10 minutes. Give your answer to the nearest degree. d How long would it take for the soup to be 40C? Give your answer to the nearest minute. e If the soup is placed in a refrigerator in which the temperature is 2C, how long will it take for the soup to reach 40C? Use the same value of k and give your answer to the nearest minute. 7 The diameter of a tree for a period of its growth can be modelled by the equation D = D0ekt, where t is the number of years after the beginning of the period. The diameter of the tree grew from 50 cm to 60 cm in the first 2 years that measurements were taken. a Find the values of D0 and k. b Write the equation using these values. c How much will it have grown in the first 5 years? Round to the nearest centimetre. d How long will it take for the trees diameter to double? Round to the nearest year. 8 The decay of a radioactive substance can be modelled by the equation M = M0e kt, where M grams is the mass of the substance after t years. After 10 years the mass of the substance is 98 grams and after 20 years the mass is 96 grams. a What was the mass of the substance initially? Give your answer to the nearest gram. b Find the value of k. Give your answer to 3 decimal places. c Write the equation using these values. d Find the mass of the substance after 50 years. e How long would it take for the mass to be halved? 9 The number of bacteria present in a culture at any time, t hours, can be modelled by the equation N = N0ekt. a If the original number is doubled in 3 hours, find k correct to 2 decimal places. b Write the equation substituting the value of k. c Find the original number of bacteria if there were 2500 bacteria after 4 hours. Give the answer correct to the nearest thousand.
165
d Write the equation substituting your value for the original population. e Find the number of bacteria present after 8 hours. Give your answer correct to the nearest thousand. 10 The intensity of light d metres below the surface of the sea can be modelled by the equation I = I0e kd. Divers in the Sea of Loga have found that the intensity of light is halved when a diver is 5 metres below the surface of the water. a Find the value of k correct to 4 decimal places. b Write the equation substituting the value of k. c Find the percentage of light available at a depth of 10 metres. d If artificial light is necessary when the intensity of light is less than 0.1 of the intensity at the surface (I<0.1I0), find how deep a diver can go before artificial light is necessary.
166
Summary
Index laws
loga (1) = 0 loga (a) = 1 loga (0) is undefined. loga (mn) = loga (m) + loga (n) m log a = log a (m) log a ( n) n loga (mp) = p loga (m) log a ( N ) log b ( N ) = log a (b)
Exponential equations
To solve exponential equations: 1. write all terms with the same base, write terms with the smallest possible base or take the logarithm of both sides of the equation 2. then solve the equation. A negative number cannot be expressed in index form. If 0 < x < 1, then loga (x) < 0 and if x > 1 then loga (x) > 0. It is not possible to take the logarithm of a negative number.
Exponential equations (base e)
1 Eulers number e = lim 1 + = 2.718 281 828459 ... h n The laws of indices and logarithms apply in the same way when using e.
Equations with natural (base e) logarithms
The equation y = loge (x) is an inverse function of y = ex. To find an inverse, interchange x and y. a log ( x ) = x, x R + log a (a x ) = x, x R
a
Literal equations
An equation such as ekx = a, where k R and a R+, is called a literal equation. Literal equations do not have numerical solutions. The solution of a literal equation is expressed in terms of the other pronumerals, in this case a and k, often called parameters.
167
chapter review
Short answer
3 2 4 1 Simplify 4 x 5 y 3 2 x 3 y 5 , leaving your answers with positive indices.
2
2 2 log3 (x) + 4 log3 (x) log3 (x6) is equal to: A 0 C log3 (6x - x6) E 6log3 (x - x6) 3 The solution of the equation 3e2x = 4 is closest to: B 0.405 A 0.406 C 0.143 D 0.144 E 0.575 [ VCAA 2005] 4 Evaluated to 3 decimal places, log3 (24) is: A 2.892 B 2.893 C 0.345 D 0.346 E 1.380 5 The solution set of the equation (2x 1)(22x 4) = 0 over R is: A {0, 1} B {0, 2} C {1, 2} D {1, 4} E {2, 4} 6 The solution set of the equation ex 12e x = 4 over R is: A loge (2), loge (6) B ex 2, ex + 6 C 2, 6 D loge 2 E loge 6 7 If loge (x) = a, then e2a + 3ea 2ea is equal to: A a 2 + 3a 2 a 2 B x 2 + 3 x x C 2 log e (a) + 3 log e (a) d log e ( x 2 ) + 3 log e ( x ) E (ea + 2)(e + 1) 8 If loge (2x) = a, then x is equal to: A 2ea ae D 2 B 2ae E e2a C ea 2 2 log e (a) 2 log e ( x )
6x B log3 x6 8x D log3 x6
3 Solve 3 2x 7 = 17 for x. log 2 (32) . log 2 (8) 1 5 Solve log x (2) = for x. 3 6 If 4e(2 x) = 128, find x, giving your answer in exact form. 4 Evaluate 7 Solve for x in loge (5) + loge (x) loge (2) = loge (10). 8 Find the rule of the inverse function to y=3e2xa. 9 Find the rule of the inverse function of y = loge (1 x) + 3. 10 Solve the equation loge (3x + 5) loge (2) = 2 for x.
Exam tip Common mistakes include cancelling out the logarithms, adding to obtain 3x + 7, or multiplying to get 6x + 5. [Assessment report 1 2007]
[ VCAA 2007]
11 Solve 6e3x = k for x, where k R+. 12 Solve 3eax + b 6k = 0 for x and state the necessary restrictions for the parameters a, b and k. 13 Solve for x given that 4 log2 (ax + b) = 12. 14 Solve for x given that log2 (x) = y + log2 (z). State the restrictions for the parameters.
Multiple choice
1 If a > 1, the solution of x for the equation x = a2 is: A 1 B a negative number less than 1 C a positive number less than 1 D a negative number greater than 1 E a positive number greater than 1
168
D -5
5
E e 3 10 The solution(s) to the equation 2ln (x) = ln (x + 4) + ln 2 is/are: B 2, 4 A -2, 4 C 1 D 2 E 4 11 If 2a = x 2a x2 C a 2 A E x2 , then y is equal to: y x B 2a x D 22 a
2
14 If y = loga (7x b) + 3, then x is equal to: 1 A 1 a y 3 + b B (a y 3) + b 7 7 b 1 y3 + b) D a y 3 C (a 7 7 y3 E log a (7 b) [ VCAA 2007] 15 If 2loge (x) loge (x + 2) = 1 + loge (y), then y is equal to: x2 A 10( x + 2) 2x 1 B x+2 x2 C x+2 2x D x+2 x2 E e( x + 2) [ VCAA 2003] 16 If 3log ( x + 4 ) = y , then y equals: A log (x + 4) B x + 4 C (x + 4)3 D 3 log (x + 4) E 4
3
x2 4a 12 The equation which is the inverse of y = ex 1 is: A y = loge (x) 1 B y = loge (x 1) C y = loge (x) + 1 D y = loge (x + 1) E y = e x 1 13 The air pressure P cm of mercury at h km above sea level can be modelled by the equation P=76e 0.13h. One kilometre above sea level the pressure has: A increased by approximately 9 cm B decreased by approximately 9 cm C increased by approximately 41 cm D decreased by approximately 41 cm E neither increased nor decreased significantly
Extended response
17 The solution set of the equation e4x 5e2x + 4 = 0 over R is: A {1, 4} B {4, 1} C {2, 1, 1, 2} D {loge (2), 0, loge (2)} E {0, loge (2)} [ VCAA 2007]
a 1 log e = x . If loge (a) = 0.6932, find the value of x, giving your answer correct to 2 decimal places. 3 x x 2 x3 + + ... 2 e x = 1 + + 1! 2! 3! a Write the next 3 terms. b Substitute x = 1 in the equation using the first 7 terms. c Show that e 2.7182. 3 The apparent brightness of a star can be found using the formula B = 6 - 2.5 log10A, where A is the actual brightness of that star. Find the apparent brightness of a star with actual brightness of 3.16. a 4 Earthquake magnitude is often reported on the Richter scale. The magnitude, M, is given by M = log10 + B, T where a is the amplitude of the ground motion in microns at the receiving station, T is the period of the seismic wave in seconds, and B is an empirical factor that allows for the weakening of the seismic wave with the increasing distance from the epicentre of the earthquake.
169
Find the magnitude of the earthquake if the amplitude of the ground motion is 10 microns, the period is 1 second and the empirical factor is 6.8. 5 Five grams of a radioactive substance is decaying so that the amount, A grams, that is left after t days, is given by the formula A = 5e kt. a Find the value of A when the number of grams of the radioactive substance has been halved. b Rewrite the equation with the new value of A. c Rearrange the equation so that t is the subject of the equation. d If k = 0.005, find how long it will take for the number of grams of the radioactive substance to be halved. Give your answer correct to the nearest day. 6 A school in the suburb of Bienvenue opened with 30 students in February 1995. It has been found for the first years after opening that the number of students enrolled in the school t years after opening can be modelled by the equation N = N0ekt. There were 45 students enrolled in February 1996. a Find the values of N0 and k. b Write the equation substituting the values for N0 and k. c How many students will there be 5 years after the opening? d How many years will it take for the school to have 1000 pupils? Another school in the suburb of Enbaisse has a declining student population. The number of students enrolled at any one time can be modelled by the equation E = E0e rt. There are 1000 students enrolled in February 1995 and 900 in February 1996. e Find the values of E0 and r. f Write the equation substituting the values for E0 and r. g How many students will be enrolled after 5 years? h How many years will it take for the two schools to have approximately the same number of pupils? i What will the population be then? Use the calculator value in the working and do not round off until the final answer. 7 Solve ekx = 4 + ke
eBook plus
Digital doc -kx
Test Yourself
Chapter 3
170
eBook plus
aCTiviTiEs
Chapter opener
Digital doc
10 Quick Questions: Warm up with ten quick questions on exponential and logarithmic equations. (page 132)
3A
Tutorial
WE 5 int-0528: Watch a worked example on writing expressions with positive indices. (page 135)
3B
Tutorial
Interactivity
Exponential equations
Inverses int-0248: Consolidate your understanding of inverses using the interactivity. (page 156)
Digital docs
SkillSHEET 3.1: Practise writing expressions using index form. (page 146) SkillSHEET 3.2: Practise solving equations. (page 146) SkillSHEET 3.3: Practise solving indicial equations by equating the bases. (page 146) SkillSHEET 3.4: Practise solving linear inequations. (page 146)
3D
Tutorial
Literal equations
Exponential and logarithmic modelling eles-0091: Learn about how exponential and logarithmic modelling is used. (page 162)
Tutorial
WE 18 int-0531: Watch a worked example on solving logarithmic equations using a CAS calculator. (page 147)
Digital doc
WorkSHEET 3.1: Simplify exponential and logarithmic expressions, and solve logarithmic and exponential equations. (page 149)
3F Equations with natural (base e ) logarithms
Test Yourself Chapter 3: Take the end-of-chapter test to test your progress. (page 170)
To access eBookPLUS activities, log on to www.jacplus.com.au
Digital doc
WorkSHEET 3.2: Solve logarithmic and exponential equations and application questions. (page 156)
Chapter 3
171
4
Exponential and logarithmic graphs
AREAS OF STUDY
4A Graphs of exponential functions with any base 4B Logarithmic graphs to any base 4C Graphs of exponential functions with base e 4D Logarithmic graphs to base e 4E Finding equations for graphs of exponential and logarithmic functions 4F Addition of ordinates 4G Exponential and logarithmic functions with absolute values 4H Exponential and logarithmic modelling using graphs
Graphs and identication of key features of graphs of the following functions: exponential functions: exponential equations, y = ax logarithmic functions, y = loge (x) and y = log10 (x), the relationship a = ek, where k = loge (a) Key features of functions, including: axis intercepts domain (including maximal domain) and range asymptotic behaviour symmetry Transformations for y = f (x) to y = Af (n(x + b)) + c, where A, n and c R and f is an exponential or logarithmic function and relation between the graph of the original
function and the graph of the transformed function Families of transformed functions for a single transformation parameter Graphs of sum, difference, product and composite functions of f and g, where f and g are exponential or logarithmic equations such as y = x2ekx, k R Graphical and numerical solutions of equations Recognition of the general form of possible models for data presented in graphical or tabular form using exponential and logarithmic functions Applications of simple combinations of exponential or logarithmic functions and interpretation of features of the graphs of these functions in modelling practical situations
eBook plus
4A
Digital doc
10 Quick Questions
The function f (x) = ax is an exponential function where a is a positive, real number which is not 1 (that is, a R+\{1}). In this chapter, a will take the values of 2, 10 and Eulers number e. An exponential function f (x) can be written f: R R where f (x) = ax and a R+\{1}. In the previous chapter it was seen that if x has a positive coefcient, f (x) is an increasing function and may be used to describe physical growth. Examples of this include population and bacterial growth, and increases in investment values, light intensity and temperature. If x has a negative coefcient, f (x) is a decreasing function and may be used to describe physical decay. Examples of this include population and bacterial decline, radioactive decay, temperature cooling and decreases in light intensity and vehicle values. Graphs with a positive coefcient of x are considered rst.
172
f (x) = 2x f (x) = 10x These graphs have a number of common features: 1. They both cross the y-axis at the point (0, 1) because a0 = 1. 2. The graph does not cross the x-axis; therefore, there are no x-intercepts. 3. There is a horizontal asymptote along the x-axis (y = 0). 4. For f (x) = a x, another point on the graphs is (1, a). 5. The maximal domain is R. 6. The range is R+. 7. They are both increasing functions. That is, as x , y . 8. It can be seen that the greater the value of a, the steeper the graph.
Dilation
A dilation changes the shape of the graph, making it wider or narrower.
Chapter 4
173
If A is a real number between 0 and 1, the y-values are multiplied by a constant which is less than 1 and the graph becomes less steep. A comparison can be made more easily if the graphs are drawn on the same axes. The graphs of f (x) = 2x, g(x) = 1 2x and h(x) = 1 2x are drawn below. 2 4
y 2 (0, 1) Asymptote y= 0
) (0, 1 2
(1, 2) (1, 1)
f(x) = 2x g(x) =
1 2
2x
2x h(x) = 1 4
(1, 2 ) ) (0, 1 4 x 0 1
1 2
and
1 4
f (x) = 2x x-intercept y-intercept Domain Range Horizontal asymptote Dilation factor from the x-axis A point on the graph Mapping R+ (0, 1) R = (0, ) y=0 1 (1, 2)
h( x ) = 1 2x 4 1 0, 4 R R+ = (0, ) y=0
1 4
(1, 1) (x, y) x, 1 y 2
(1, )
1 2
(x, y) x, 1 y 4
For any positive real value of A, as A increases, the graph of f (x) = A 2x becomes steeper and closer to the y-axis. Similarly, as A decreases the graph becomes less steep and further from the y-axis. The domain, range and horizontal asymptote stay the same as for f (x) = 2x. The mapping is (x, y) (x, Ay).
f (x) = 2x x-intercept y-intercept Domain Range Horizontal asymptote Dilation factor from the y-axis A point on the graph Mapping (0, 1) R R+ = (0, ) y=0 1 (2, 4)
(1, 4) (x, y)
1 2
x, y
(x, y) (2x, y)
For all the graphs discussed so far (that is, of the form f (x) = A akx, a R+\{1}, k > 0), the maximal domain is R, the range is R+, the x-axis is the horizontal asymptote and they are all increasing functions. The dilations have affected the steepness of the graphs. The mapping is (x, y) ( 1 x, Ay). k
WORKED EXAMPLE 1
Sketch the graph of f (x) = 2 2 2 , showing the intercepts and the asymptote, and stating the domain and the range.
THINK
1 2 3
WRITE/DRAW
Write the rule. State the basic shape and transformations. Find the y-intercept. Either let x = 0 or use the fact that the y-intercept is A in the function f (x) = A a k .
x
f (x) = 2 2 2 An exponential curve with basic shape f (x) = 2x. Dilation of 2 units from the x-axis and 2 units from the y-axis. If x = 0, then y = 2 22 = 2 20 =21 =2 so the y-intercept is 2. The horizontal asymptote is the x-axis. There are no x-intercepts. If x = 2, y = 2 2 2 = 4.
y 4 (0, 2) x 3 2 1 0 1 2 3 (2, 4)
2 0
4 5 6
Find the horizontal asymptote. Find another point on the graph. Sketch the graph.
f (x) = 2 2 2 Asymptote y = 0
Chapter 4
175
Translation
Vertical translation
If a constant is added to the function, the graph is moved up or down and is said to be translated vertically. In mapping notation, a vertical translation of B units is given by (x, y) (x, y + B). The graph of g(x) = 2x + 1 is shown below with the graph of f (x) = 2x. The graph of f (x) = 2x has been moved up 1 unit. Every y-value has been increased by 1. The line y = 1 is the horizontal asymptote. f (x) = 2x x-intercept y-intercept Domain Range Horizontal asymptote A point on the graph Mapping (0, 1) R (0, ) y=0 (1, 2) g(x) = 2x + 1 (0, 2) R (1, ) y=1 (1, 3) (x, y) (x, y + 1) The graph of g(x) = 2x 1 is the graph of f (x) = 2x translated 1 unit down. This means that the horizontal asymptote is now the line y = 1 and the graph crosses the x-axis. Therefore, there is an x-intercept. Every y-value has been decreased by 1. The graph of y = 2x 1 is shown with the graph of y = 2x. f (x) = 2x x-intercept y-intercept Domain Range Horizontal asymptote A point on the graph Mapping (0, 1) R (0, ) y=0 (1, 2) g(x) = 2x 1 (0, 0) (0, 0) R (1, ) y = 1 (1, 1) (x, y) (x, y 1)
y 4 2 (0, 1) 3 2 1 (1, 2) f(x) = 2x g(x) = 2x 1 y 4 3 (0, 2) (1, 3) (1, 2) Asymptote y=1 2 x g(x) = 2x + 1 f(x) = 2x
(0, 1) 0 1
(1, 1) x 0 1 2 3 Asymptote y = 1
Horizontal translation
In mapping notation, a horizontal translation of b units is given by (x, y) (x + b, y). The graph of g(x) = 2x 1 is the graph of f (x) = 2x translated 1 unit to the right. The graph of h(x) = 2x + 1 is the graph of f (x) = 2x translated 1 unit to the left. The graph of g(x) = 2x 1 is shown at right with the graph of f (x) = 2x.
176 y 4 2 (0, 1) 3 2 1
01 2 3
f (x) = 2x x-intercept y-intercept Domain Range Horizontal asymptote A point on the graph Mapping (0, 1) R R+ = (0, ) y=0 (1, 2)
g(x) = 2x 1
(0, )
1 2
Horizontal and vertical translations have the same effect regardless of the base. g(x) = 2 + 10x + 1 is f (x) = 10 x translated 1 unit to the left and 2 units up. Horizontal translations keep the same asymptote, domain and range as the original function; vertical translations keep the same domain, but the range changes. It is interesting to note that f (x) = 0.5 2x can be written as f (x) = 2x 1 because f (x) = 0.5 2x = 2 2x = 2 1 2x = 2x 1 A dilation of 0.5 from the x-axis has the same effect on f (x) = 2x as a translation of 1 unit to the right.
WORKED EXAMPLE 2
eBoo k plus eBook
Tutorial 1
Sketch the graph of f (x) = 2x 1 2, showing intercepts and asymptotes, and stating the domain and range.
THINK
1 2
int-0534
Worked example 2
WRITE/DRAW
Write the rule. State the basic shape. State the translations. Find the horizontal asymptote by translating y = 0 down 2 units. Find the y-intercept. Make x = 0.
f (x) = 2x 1 2 An exponential curve with the same shape as f (x) = 2x Horizontal translation of 1 unit to the right Vertical translation of 2 units down The horizontal asymptote is y = 2. y-intercept: If x = 0, then
y=2 12 =1 2 2 = 1 1 2
6 7 8
x-intercept: If y = 0, then
2x 1 2 = 0 2x 1 = 21 x1=1 x=2
Chapter 4
177
y 1 3 2 1 1 2 (2, 0) 0 1 2 3 x
1 Asymptote (0, 1 2) y = 2
f (x) = 2x 1 2
10
For all the graphs of the form f (x) = ax + b + B, where b, B R and a R+\{1}, the maximal domain is R, the range is (B, ), the horizontal asymptote is y = B and they are all increasing functions. The graph remains exactly the same shape as f (x) = ax. The mapping is (x, y) (x b, y + B).
Reections
If a negative sign is in front of the a the graph is reected in the x-axis. (Remember a > 0.) The mapping is (x, y) (x, y). The graph of g(x) = 2x is shown with the graph of f (x) = 2x. f (x) = 2x x-intercept y-intercept Domain Range Horizontal asymptote A point on the graph Mapping (0, 1) R R+ = (0, ) y=0 (1, 2) g(x) = 2x (0, 1) R R = (, 0) y=0 (1, 2) (x, y) (x, y) If there is a negative sign before the x term, the graph is reected in the y-axis. The graph of g(x) = 2x is shown with the graph of f (x) = 2x. f (x) = 2x x-intercept y-intercept Domain Range Horizontal asymptote A point on the graph Mapping (0, 1) R R+ = (0, ) y=0 (1, 2) g(x) = 2 x (0, 1) R R+ = (0, ) y=0 (1, 2) (x, y) (x, y) For all the graphs of the form g(x) = ax, where a R+\{1}, the maximal domain is R and the range is R. The horizontal asymptote is y = 0 and the functions are all decreasing. It is the reection of f (x) = ax in the x-axis. The mapping is (x, y) (x, y).
178 3 2 1 g(x) = 2x y 3 (1, 2) 2 1 (1, 2) (0, 1) 0 Asymptote y= 0 x 1 2 3 f(x) = 2x (0, 1) y 4 Asymptote (1, 2) y = 0 3 2 1 0 1 2 3 x (1, 2) 2 (0, 1) g(x) = 2x 2 f(x) = 2x
For all the graphs of the form g(x) = ax, where a R+\{1}, the maximal domain is R and the range is R+. The horizontal asymptote is y = 0 and the functions are all decreasing. It is the reection of f (x) = ax in the y-axis. The mapping is (x, y) (x, y).
WORKED EXAMPLE 3
Sketch the graph of f (x) = 2 2x 1, showing intercepts and asymptotes, and stating the domain and the range: a showing all working b with a CAS calculator.
THINK a
1 2 3
WRITE/DRAW
Write the rule. State the basic shape. State the transformations.
f (x) = 2 2x 1 An exponential curve with basic shape f (x) = 2x Horizontal translation of 1 unit to the right Vertical translation of 2 units up Reection in the x-axis
4 5
Find the horizontal asymptote by translating The horizontal asymptote is y = 2. y = 0 up 2 units. If x = 0, f (x) = 2 2 1 Find the y-intercept by making x = 0. =2 = 11 2 The y-intercept is 1 1 . 2
1 2
f (x) = 2 2x 1
State the domain and the range. To graph y = 2 2x 1 on a Graphs page, complete the function entry line as: f1(x) = 2 2x 1 Press ENTER . Note: The horizontal asymptote at y = 2 is not displayed.
Chapter 4
179
To locate the x-intercept on a Calculator page, press: MENU b 3:Algebra 3 1:Solve 1 Complete the entry line as: solve(f 1(x) = 0, x) Press ENTER .
3 4
Write the x-intercept in coordinate form. To calculate the y-intercept, complete the entry line as: f1(0) and press ENTER . Write the y-intercept in coordinate form.
REMEMBER
1. Graphs of the form f (x) = ax, where a R+\{1} (a) The maximal domain is R. (b) The range is R+. (c) The x-axis is the horizontal asymptote. (d) The y-intercept is 1. (e) They are all increasing functions. 2. Dilation (a) Graphs of the form f (x) = Aax, where a, A R+\{1}, have a y-intercept of A. A changes the steepness and proximity of the graph to the y-axis when compared with the graph of f (x) = ax. As A increases, the graph becomes steeper. So f (x) = ax is dilated by a factor of A from the x-axis. (b) Graphs of the form f (x) = akx, where a R+\{1} and k > 0, have a different steepness than graphs of the form f (x) = ax. As k increases, the graph becomes more steep (that is, it gets closer to the y-axis). The y-intercept remains the same. So f (x) = akx is dilated by a factor of 1 from the y-axis. k 3. Translation (a) Graphs of the form f (x) = ax + B, where a R+\{1}, B R, have a y-intercept of 1 + B, a horizontal asymptote of y = B and a range of (B, ). If B < 0 there is one x-intercept. If B > 0 there are no x-intercepts. (b) Graphs of the form f (x) = ax + b, where a R+\{1}, b R, have a y-intercept of ab. They are the same shape as f (x) = ax but have been translated b units to the left if b > 0 and to the right if b < 0. 4. Reection (a) Graphs of the form f (x) = ax, where a R+\{1}, have a y-intercept of 1, a range of R and they are decreasing functions. They are the same shape as f (x) = ax but have been reected in the x-axis. (b) Graphs of the form f (x) = ax, where a R+\{1}, have the same key features as f (x) = ax but are decreasing functions; they have been reected in the y-axis. 5. Combinations of transformations For all the graphs of the form f (x) = A ax + b + B, where b, B, A R and a R+\{1}, the maximal domain is R, the range is (B, ), the horizontal asymptote is y = B and they are all increasing functions.
180
EXERCISE
4A
eBoo k plus eBook
Digital doc
Spreadsheet 034
Exponential graphs
y 6
Chapter 4
181
y 2 y=1 3 2 1 0 2 1 2 x
y 6 4 (0, 4) y=2 3 2 1 2 0 1 2 3 x
10 If the graph of f (x) = 2x is translated 1 unit up and reflected in the x-axis, what is the new equation? 11 If the graph of f (x) = 1 2x + 3 is translated 2 units to the right and dilated by factor 3 from the x-axis, what is the new equation? 12 MC The domain and range of the graph of f (x) = 102x 1 + 3 are respectively: A R, R B R, [1, ) C [3, ), R D [1, ), R E R, (3, ) 13 MC The y-intercept of the graph of f (x) = 10x + 1 is: A 1 B 2 C 1 2x 1 D 2 E 11
14 MC When the graph of f (x) = 4 is translated 3 units down and 2 units to the left, it becomes: A f (x) = 2x 3 7 B f (x) = 2x 3 1 x + 1 C f (x) = 2 7 D f (x) = 2x + 1 1 x 2 E f (x) = 2 6 15 Under certain conditions a mathobacillus bacterial colony doubles its numbers every minute. The population can be modelled by: P = 50 2t where P is the number of bacteria t minutes after counting has begun. a Find the number of bacteria when t = 0. b Find the number of bacteria after 3 minutes. c Sketch the graph of the population as a function of time.
4B
These graphs have a number of common features: 1. They are both increasing functions; that is, as x , y . 2. Both graphs cross the x-axis at the point (1, 0), as loga (1) = 0 3. The y-axis is a vertical asymptote, so there is no y-intercept. This is because loga (0) is undened. 4. There are no negative values of x because the log of a negative number does not exist. 5. Another point on the graph is (a, 1), where a is the base because loga (a) = (1). 6. The domain is R+. 7. The range is R. 8. It can be seen that the smaller the value of a, the steeper the graph or the more rapidly the graph rises.
Dilation
Dilation from the x-axis
If the coefcient of loga (x) is changed to a positive real number greater than 1, the graph is stretched along the y-axis and is said to be dilated from the x-axis. This could be written f (x) = A loga (x) where A is the dilation factor. The graph is stretched along the y-axis because each y-value is being multiplied by the constant, A. In mapping notation, a dilation factor of A from the x-axis, where A > 0, is given by Asymptote (x, y) (x, Ay). y x= 0 (10, 2) g(x) = 2 log10 (x) The asymptote, x-intercept, domain and range are the same for all graphs of the form f (x) = A loga (x). Graphs with different values of A can be more easily compared by drawing them on the same axes. The graphs of g(x) = 2 log10 (x), f (x) = log10 (x) and h(x) = 1 log10 (x) are drawn at right. Notice that, as 2 A increases, the graph becomes steeper.
1 0 1 (10, 1) f(x) = log10 (x) log (x) h(x) = 1 2 10 1 (10, ) 2 x 2 4 6 8 10
f (x) = log10 (x) x-intercept y-intercept Domain Range Vertical asymptote Dilation factor from the x-axis A point on the graph Mapping (1, 0) R+ = (0, ) R x=0 1 (10, 1)
g(x) = 2 log10 (x) (1, 0) R+ = (0, ) R x=0 2 (10, 2) (x, y) (x, 2y)
1 2
(10, )
1 2
(x, y) x, 1 y 2
Note: h(x) = 1 log10 (x) can be written as h(x) = log10 ( x ) and is drawn in the same way. 2
Chapter 4
183
2 (2, 0) (1, 0)
f (x) = log10 (x) x-intercept y-intercept Domain Range Horizontal asymptote Dilation factor from the y-axis Another point on the graph Mapping R+ (1, 0) = (0, ) R x=0 1 (10, 1)
( x)
1 2
( , 0)
1 2
R+ = (0, ) R x=0
1 2
= (0, ) R x=0 2
(5, 1) (x, y)
( x, y )
1 2
For all graphs discussed so far (that is, of the form y = A loga (kx), A R+\{1}, k > 0), the maximal domain is R+, the range is R, the y-axis is the vertical asymptote and they are all increasing functions. The graphs have varied in their x-intercepts. The dilation factor from the x-axis is A and the dilation factor from the y-axis is 1 . In mapping notation, k Asymptote (x, y) 1 x, A Ay . y x=0 k f(x) = 2 log2 (3x) If the base is 2, the graph is steeper than when the base is 10 but the vertical asymptote, intercept, domain and range 2 stay the same as for f (x) = A log10 (kx). f(x) = 2 log10 (3x) 1 The graphs of f (x) = 2 log10 (3x) and f (x) = 2 log2 (3x) are ( , 0) 3 x shown at right. 0 1 2 3 1. The vertical asymptote is the y-axis. 2 2. The x-intercept is 1 . 3 3. The domain is R+ and the range is R. 4. The basic graph is dilated by factor 2 from the x-axis and factor 1 from the y-axis. 3
184
WORKED EXAMPLE 4
Sketch the graph of f (x) = 3 log10 (2x), showing the intercepts and the asymptote, and state the domain, range and the kind of transformation.
THINK
1 2 3 4
WRITE/DRAW
f (x) = 3 log10 (2x) A logarithmic graph with basic shape f (x) = log10 (x) x-intercept: Let y = 0, 3 log10 (2x) = 0 2x = 1 x=1 2 The x-intercept is 1 . 2 There are no y-intercepts. Let x = 5, y = 3 log10 (10) =31 =3 Coordinates are (5, 3).
Asymptote y x=0 3 ( , 0) 2 1 2 3 4 5
1
Find the vertical asymptote (log10 (0) is undened). The vertical asymptote is the y-axis. Find the x-intercept. Remember that log10 (1) = 0.
5 6
Find the y-intercept. Mark another point on the graph. Choose one which makes 2x equal the base.
0 3
8 9
The domain is R+ and the range is R. The dilations are of factor 3 from the x-axis and factor 1 from the y-axis. 2
Translation
Translations may be either vertical or horizontal.
Vertical translation
If a constant is added to the function, the graph is moved up or down and is said to be translated vertically. The graphs of f (x) = log10 (x), g(x) = log10 (x) + 1 and h(x) = log10 (x) 1 are drawn and compared.
y Asymptote x=0 2 1 0 1 2 3 2 4 6 g(x) = log10 (x) + 1 f(x) = log10 (x) h(x) = log10 (x) 1 8 10 12 x
Chapter 4
185
f (x) = log10 (x) x-intercept y-intercept Domain Range Vertical asymptote Vertical translation A point on the graph Mapping (1, 0) R+ = (0, ) R x=0 (1, 0)
h(x) = log10 (x) 1 (10, 0) R+ = (0, ) R x=0 1 unit down (1, 1) (x, y) (x, y 1)
1 , 10
Horizontal translation
If a constant is added to x, the graph of f (x) = log10 (x) is translated horizontally. The graphs of f (x) = log10 (x), g(x) = log10 (x + 1) and h(x) = log10 (x 1) are drawn. f (x) = log10 (x) x-intercept y-intercept Domain Range Vertical asymptote Horizontal translation A point on the graph Mapping
y 2 1 2 1 0 1 g(x) = log10 (x + 1) 2 3 4 5 x
1 2
x = 1
For all graphs of the form f (x) = loga (x + b) + B, where b and B R and a R+\{1}, the maximal domain is (b, ), the range is R, the vertical asymptote is x = b and they are all increasing functions. The graph has exactly the same shape as f (x) = loga (x). The horizontal translation is b and the vertical translation is B. In mapping notation, (x, y) (x b, y + B).
186
WORKED EXAMPLE 5
Sketch the graph of f (x) = 1 + log10 (x + 2), showing intercepts and asymptotes, and stating the domain, range and transformations. Give intercepts to 1 decimal place.
THINK
1 2
int-0535
Worked example 5
WRITE/DRAW
Find the vertical asymptote (log10 (0) is undened). x + 2 = 0 x = 2 is the vertical asymptote. Find the x-intercept. Use the law ax = y loga(y) = x. If y = 0, 1 + log10 (x + 2) = 0 log10 (x + 2) = 1
x + 2 = 10 1 x = 0.1 2 = 1.9 The x-intercept is 1.9. If x = 0, y = 1 + log10 (0 + 2) (exact answer) 1 + 0.301 03 1.3, correct to 1 decimal place The y-intercept is 1.3.
Asymptote y x = 2 2 (1.9, 0) 2 0 (0, 1.3) 2 x 4 6 8 f(x) = 1 + log10 (x + 2)
The domain is (2, ) and the range is R. The horizontal translation is 2 units to the left and the vertical translation is 1 unit up.
Reections
If there is a negative sign in front of the loga (x) term, the graph is reected in the x-axis. The mapping is (x, y) (x, y). The graphs of f (x) = log10 (x) and g(x) = log10 (x) are shown at right.
g(x) =
(10, 1) 10 (x)
Chapter 4
187
f (x) = log10 (x) x-intercept y-intercept Domain Range Vertical asymptote A point on the graph Mapping R+ (1, 0) = (0, ) R x=0 (10, 1)
If there is a negative sign in front of the x term, the graph is reected in the y-axis. The mapping is (x, y) (x, y). The graphs of f (x) = log10 (x) and g(x) = log10 (x) are shown below right. f (x) = log10 (x) x-intercept y-intercept Domain Range Vertical asymptote A point on the graph Mapping R+ (1, 0) = (0, ) R x=0 (10, 1) R g(x) = log10 (x) (1, 0) = (, 0) R x=0 (10, 1) (x, y) (x, y)
Asymptote y x=0 g(x) = log10 (x) f(x) = log10 (x) 1 (10, 1) (10, 1) (1, 0) 10 2 1 (1, 0) 2 10 x
WORKED EXAMPLE 6 a Sketch the graph of f (x) = 2 log10 (3 x) 2, showing intercepts and asymptotes, and stating
the domain, range and transformations. Give exact values or round to 3 decimal places.
WRITE/DRAW
Write the rule. State the basic shape. Find the vertical asymptote (log10 (0) undened). Find the x-intercept.
f (x) = 2 log10 (3 x) 2 Logarithmic graph, f (x) = log10 (x) For the vertical asymptote, 3x=0 x = 3 is the vertical asymptote. If y = 0, 2 log10 (3 x) 2 = 0 2 log10 (3 x) = 2 log10 (3 x) = 1 3 x = 101 x = 7 The x-intercept is 7.
188
f (x) = 2 log10 (3 x) 2
7 8
State the domain and the range. State the transformations. To graph y = 2 log10 (3 x) 2 on a Graphs page, complete the function entry line as: f1(x) = 2 log10 (3 x) 2 Press ENTER . Note: The vertical asymptote at x = 3 is not displayed.
The domain is 3) and the range is R. Reection in the y-axis, dilation 2 units from the x-axis, vertical translation 2 units down, horizontal translation 3 units to the right
(,
To locate the x-intercept on a Calculator page, press: MENU b 3:Algebra 3 1:Solve 1 Complete the entry line as: solve (f 1(x) = 0, x) Press ENTER .
3 4
Write the x-intercept in coordinate form. To calculate the y-intercept, complete the entry line as: f1(0) and press ENTER . Write the y-intercept in coordinate form.
REMEMBER
The coordinates of the x-intercept are (7, 0). The coordinates of the y-intercept are (0, 1.046) (correct to 3 decimal places).
1. The function f (x) = loga (x) is a logarithmic function where a R+\{1}. (a) The vertical asymptote is the y-axis, so there are no y-intercepts. (b) The graph crosses the x-axis at (1, 0) because loga (1) = 0. (c) The domain is R+; that is, there are no negative values of x. (d) The range is R.
Chapter 4
189
2. Dilation (a) The function f (x) = A loga (x) dilates the graph of f (x) = loga (x) by a factor of A units from the x-axis. The vertical asymptote, x-intercept, domain and range remain the same. As A increases, the graph becomes steeper. (b) The function f (x) = loga (kx) dilates the graph of f (x) = loga (x) by a factor of 1 k from the y-axis. The vertical asymptote, domain and range stay the same, but the x-intercept is 1 . As k increases, the graph becomes steeper and the x-intercept k becomes smaller. 3. Translation (a) The function f (x) = loga (x) + B translates the graph of f (x) = loga (x) vertically B units. The vertical axis, domain and range remain the same but the x-intercept changes. There is no change in the shape of the graph. (b) The function f (x) = loga (x + b) translates the graph of f (x) = loga (x) horizontally b units. The shape and the range remain the same but the vertical asymptote, the x-intercept and the domain change: (i) The vertical asymptote becomes x = b. (ii) The graph crosses the x-axis at (1 b, 0). (iii) The domain is (b, ). 4. Reection (a) The function f (x) = loga (x) reects the graph of f (x) = loga (x) in the x-axis. All key features remain the same but the graph is a decreasing function instead of an increasing function. (b) The function f (x) = loga (x) reects the graph of f (x) = loga (x) in the y-axis. The vertical asymptote and the range remain the same but the x-intercept and the domain change. (i) The graph crosses the x-axis at (1, 0). (ii) The domain is (, 0).
EXERCISE
4B
2 WE4 Sketch the graph of each of the functions in question 1, showing the intercepts and asymptotes, and stating the domain and range of each one. 3 State the horizontal and vertical translations required to transform f (x) = log2 (x) into the following functions. a f (x) = log2 (x + 2) b f (x) = log2 (x + 1) c f (x) = log2 (x 3) d f (x) = log2 (x 4) e f (x) = 1 + log2 (x 5) f f (x) = log2 (x 3) + 2 g f (x) = 2 + log2 (x + 1) h f (x) = 3 + log2 (x + 1) i f (x) = log2 (x + 3) 2 j f (x) = log2 (x + 1) 2
4 WE5 Sketch the graph of each of the functions in question 3, showing the intercepts and asymptotes, and stating the domain and the range of each one.
190
Spreadsheet 069
Logarithmic graphs
5 Sketch the graph of each of the following functions showing intercepts and asymptotes, and stating the domain, range and the transformation of f (x) = log10 (x). a f (x) = log10 (x) b f (x) = 2 log10 (x) c f (x) = log10 (x) d f (x) = 3 log10 (x) e f (x) = 1 log10 (x) f f (x) = 1 + log10 (x) g f (x) = 2 + log10 (x) h f (x) = 2 log10 (x) 6 Sketch the graph of f (x) = log2 (2x 1), showing intercepts and asymptotes, and stating the domain, range and transformations of the graph f (x) = log2 (x). 7 WE6 Sketch the graph of each of the following functions, showing intercepts and asymptotes, and stating the domain and range of each one. Give exact values or round to 1 decimal place. a f (x) = 2 log2 (x) + 3 b f (x) = 3 log10 (x) + 1 c f (x) = log10 (1 x) d f (x) = log10 (3 x) e f (x) = 1 2 log2 (x) f f (x) = 2 5 log10 (x) g f (x) = 3 log10 (x + 1) 2 h f (x) = 4 log2 (x 2) 1 i f (x) = 1 + 2 log10 (3x) j f (x) = 3 4 log10 (2x) 8 Each graph in question 7 is a transformation of the graph of f (x) = loga (x), a = 2, 10. State the base of each graph and the kinds of transformation that have taken place. 9 Sketch the graph of f: R R where f (x) = 3 log2 (2 x) + 1, showing all key features and stating the domain and range. 10 Sketch the graph of f: [0, 10] R where f (x) = 3 log10 (x + 1) 2, showing key features. 11 MC When the function f (x) = log2 (x + 2) is translated 2 units up and 3 units to the left, the function becomes: A f (x) = log2 (x + 4) + 3 B f (x) = log2 (x + 5) + 2 C f (x) = log2 (x 1) + 2 D f (x) = log2 (x + 5) 3 E f (x) = log2 (x 1) + 2
WorkSHEET 4.1
4C
WORKED EXAMPLE 7
State the transformations of f (x) = ex needed to form the graph of f (x) = 2 e3x 1.
THINK
1
WRITE/DRAW
f (x) = 2e3x 1
Chapter 4
191
State the dilation. The coefcient of ex gives the dilation from the x-axis. The reciprocal of the coefcient of x gives the dilation from the y-axis. State the translation. The vertical translation is given by the constant added to the ex term.
WORKED EXAMPLE 8
Sketch the graph of f (x) = ex. On the same set of axes sketch the graph of f (x) = ex 2, marking the asymptote and y-intercept, and state the transformation, the domain and the range. Give exact answers.
THINK
1 2 3 4 5
WRITE/DRAW
Write the rule for the rst graph. State the basic shape. State the horizontal asymptote. Find the y-intercept by making x = 0. Draw the graph.
f (x) = ex Exponential curve The horizontal asymptote is the x-axis. If x = 0, y = e0 y = 1 is the y-intercept.
y 2 (0, 1) 3 2 1 0 1 2 3 x f(x) = ex
Asymptote y = 0
6 7
Write the rule for the second graph. State the transformation. The horizontal translation is given by the constant added to the x term. State the horizontal asymptote, which is the same as for f (x) = ex. Find the y-intercept by making x = 0.
8 9
10
y 2 (0, 1) 3 2 1 0
11
Check the accuracy of your graph by transforming the point (0, 1) and marking it on your graph. State the domain and the range which are the same for both graphs.
(0, 1) (2, 1)
12
192
For graphs of y = Aekx, k > 0 the coefcient of the ex term shows the dilation of A from the x-axis and the reciprocal of the coefcient of the x term shows the dilation of 1 from the y-axis. k The mapping is (x, y) ( 1 x, Ay). k
WORKED EXAMPLE 9
Sketch the graph of y = 3e2x, marking the asymptote and intercept, and state the transformations, domain and range.
THINK
1 2 3 4 5
WRITE/DRAW
Write the rule. State the basic shape. State the transformations. Find the asymptote, recognising that it is unchanged by dilation. Find the y-intercept by making x = 0 or by multiplying y-values of f (x) = ex by 3. (0, 1) (0, 3) Sketch the graph.
f (x) = 3e2x Exponential curve Dilation by a factor of 3 units from the x-axis and dilation by a factor of 1 unit from the y-axis 2 The horizontal asymptote is the x-axis. y = 3e2 0 =31 =3 so y-intercept is 3. If x = 0,
y 4 2 (0, 3) x
3 2 1 0 1 2 3
7
The vertical translation is given by the constant added to the ex term. The horizontal translation is given by the constant added to the x term.
WORKED EXAMPLE 10
eBoo k plus eBook
Tutorial
Sketch the graph of f (x) = ex 2 + 1, marking the asymptote and intercept, and state the transformations, domain and range. Find the y-intercept correct to 2 decimal places.
THINK
1 2 3 4 5 6
int-0536
Worked example 10
WRITE/DRAW
Write the rule. State the basic shape. State the transformations. Find the asymptote by translating the asymptote of f (x) = ex up one unit. Find the y-intercept.
f (x) = ex 2 + 1 Exponential curve The horizontal translation is 2 units to the right and the vertical translation is 1 unit up. The horizontal asymptote is y = 1. If x = 0, y 1.14 (to 2 decimal places) so the y-intercept is 1.14.
Find another point by translating the y-intercept of (0, 1) (2, 2) f (x) = ex to the right by 2 units and up by 1 unit.
Chapter 4
193
f (x) = ex 2 + 1
A reection in the x-axis is shown by a negative sign before the ex term. A reection in the y-axis is shown by a negative sign before the x term.
WORKED EXAMPLE 11
Sketch the graph of f (x) = 2 ex, marking the asymptote and intercepts. State the transformations, domain and range. Give exact answers. Check using a CAS calculator.
THINK
1 2 3 4 5
WRITE/DRAW
State the rule. State the basic shape. State the transformations. Find the horizontal asymptote by translating the asymptote of f (x) = ex up 2 units. Find the y-intercept by making x = 0 or by reecting (0, 1) in the x-axis and translating it up 2 units.
f (x) = 2 ex Exponential curve A reection in the x-axis and a reection in the y-axis. The vertical translation is 2 units up. The horizontal asymptote is y = 2. If x = 0, y=2e 0 =21 =1 or (0, 1) (0, 1) (0, 1) The y-intercept is 1. If y = 0, 2 ex = 0 ex = 2 1 =2 ex ex = 1 2
1 loge (ex) = loge 2
Find the x-intercept by making y = 0 and solving the equation. 1 ex = x e loge (ex) = x loge (e) =x1
x=
1 loge 2 2
y 2
f (x) = 2 ex
x
1 2
8
194
To graph y = 2 ex, on a Graphs page, complete the function entry line as: f1(x) = 2 ex Then press ENTER . Note: The horizontal asymptote at y = 2 is not displayed.
The graphs of f (x) = e2x, g(x) = e2x 1 and h(x) = e2x 2 are drawn at right.
f(x) = e 2x g(x) = e 2x 1
h(x) = e 2x 2
(1, 1) 1 ( , 1) 2 Asymptote 2 (0, e ) y = 0 x 1
f (x) = e2x x-intercept y-intercept Domain Range Horizontal asymptote Horizontal translation A point on the graph (0, 1) (0, 1) R R+ = (0, ) y=0
g(x) = e2x 1 x = e2
1 2
1 0, = 0, e 1 e
1 0, 2 = 0, e 2 e
R R+ = (0, ) y=0
1 2
unit to right
( , 1)
1 2
In summary: Transformations can be represented in the following way: 1. Dilation by factor A from the x-axis can be written as y = Af (x), A > 0. 2. (a) Dilation by factor 1 from the y-axis can be written as y = f (kx), k > 0. k (b) Dilation by factor k from the y-axis can be written as y = f 1 x , k > 0. k 3. (a) Translation of B units up can be written as y = f (x) + B, B > 0. (b) Translation of B units down can be written as y = f (x) B, B > 0. 4. (a) Translation of b units to the right can be written as y = f (x b), b > 0. (b) Translation of b units to the left can be written as y = f (x + b), b > 0. 5. (a) Reection in the x-axis can be written as y = f (x). (b) Reection in the y-axis can be written as y = f (x).
( )
Chapter 4
195
REMEMBER
For all the graphs of the form f (x) = Aex + b + B, where A R+, b, B R, the maximal domain is R, the range is (B, ), the horizontal asymptote is y = B. When A R the range changes to (, B). 1. A is the dilation factor from the x-axis. As A increases, the graph becomes steeper. 2. B is the vertical translation. When B > 0 the graph is translated up B units. When B < 0 the graph is translated down B units. 3. b is the horizontal translation. When b > 0 the translation is to the left. When b < 0 the translation is to the right. 4. When A < 0 the graph is reected in the x-axis. 5. When f (x) = ex the graph is reected in the y-axis. 6. When f (x) = ekx the graph is dilated by factor 1 from the y-axis. k 7. Consider transformations in the following order: reection, dilation, translation. EXERCISE
4C
Spreadsheet 034
Exponential functions
2 WE8 For each of the following examples sketch the graph of f (x) = ex. On the same set of axes, sketch the graph of the given functions, marking the asymptote and y-intercept, and state the transformation, the domain and the range. Give exact answers. a f (x) = ex 1 b f (x) = ex 3 c f (x) = 2ex d f (x) = 3ex e f (x) = 1 + ex f f (x) = ex 2 g f (x) = e2 x h f (x) = e1 x i f (x) = 3 ex 3 WE9 Sketch the graph of each of the following functions, marking the asymptote and intercept, and stating the transformations, domain and range. For the intercepts give exact answers or correct to 1 decimal place where appropriate. a f (x) = e3x b f (x) = e2x c f (x) = 4ex 1 1 4x x d f (x) = 2e e f (x) = 2 e f f (x) = 4 e 2 x g f (x) = 2e3x h f (x) = 3e4x 4 WE10 Sketch the graph of each of the following, marking the asymptote and intercepts, and stating the transformations, domain and range. Mark the y-intercepts as exact values. a f (x) = ex + 3 b f (x) = ex 3 c f (x) = ex + 1 x x + 1 d f (x) = e + 2 e f (x) = e +2 f f (x) = ex + 2 + 1 x 1 x 2 g f (x) = e +3 h f (x) = e +5 i f (x) = ex + 2 1 5 WE11 Sketch the graph of each of the following functions, marking the asymptote and intercepts, and stating the transformations, domain and range. For intercepts, give exact answers or correct to 1 decimal place where appropriate. a f (x) = ex b f (x) = ex c f (x) = 1 ex x x d f (x) = 2 + e e f (x) = 1 + e f f (x) = 1 + ex x x g f (x) = 3 e h f (x) = 5 e i f (x) = 2ex
196
6 Sketch f: R R where f (x) = e2x 3 1, marking all the key features and stating the domain and range. Write answers correct to 2 decimal places where appropriate. 7 Sketch f: [0, ) R where f (x) = ex 2 1, marking all the key features and stating the domain and range, giving answers correct to 2 decimal places where appropriate. 8 If f (x) = ex, sketch the following functions. a y = f (x) + 1 b y = f (x) 2 1 d y = 2 f (x) e y = 1 f (x) g y = f (x + 1) h y = f (x 2) j y = 1 + f (x) c y = 2f (x) f y = 2 f (x) i y = f (x)
9 MC The graph with equation y = e2x + 3 is translated so that the new graph has a horizontal asymptote of y = 1. The new graph has undergone a translation of: A 1 unit down B 2 units down C 3 units down D 4 units down E 5 units down 10 MC An increasing exponential function has a horizontal asymptote of y = 2 and a y-intercept of 4. A possible equation for this exponential is: A y = e2x + 4 B y = e4x + 2 C y = e2x 4 x x y D y = 2e + 4 E y = 2e + 2 11 The graph shown is modelled by the equation y = 2ex b + B. a Find the values of B and b. b If the graph was translated down 1 unit, translated 3 units to the left and dilated by factor 1 from the x-axis, write the 2 equation of the new graph.
4 3 2 2 1
4D
Common features
1. The graphs all cross the x-axis at (1, 0) because loga (1) = 0. 2. The vertical asymptote is the y-axis (x = 0) because loga (0) is undened. 3. The domain is R+. 4. The range is R. 5. They are all increasing functions.
WORKED EXAMPLE 12
State the transformations of f (x) needed to form the graph of f (x) = 2 loge (x 3) + 1.
THINK
1 2
WRITE
State the rule. State the dilation. The coefcient of loge (x) gives the dilation from the x-axis.
Chapter 4
197
State the translations. (a) Horizontal translation is given by the constant added to the x term. (b) Vertical translation is given by the constant added to the log term.
Dilations do not change the vertical asymptote, the domain or the range of a logarithmic graph. The x-intercept does change, however.
WORKED EXAMPLE 13
Sketch the graph of f (x) = 3 loge (2x), marking all key features and stating the domain and range.
THINK
1 2 3 4
WRITE/DRAW
Write the rule. State the basic shape of the curve. Find the x-intercept by letting y equal 0. Solve for x. Divide both sides by 3. Use loge (x) = a ea = x. Use e0 = 1. Divide both sides by 2. Sketch the graph of f (x) = 3 loge (2x).
f (x) = 3 loge (2x) A log graph with basic shape f (x) = loge (x). If y = 0, 3 loge (2x) = 0 loge (2x) = 0 e0 = 2x 2x = 1 x= 1 2 The x-intercept is 1 . 2
y Asymptote x=0 6 4 2 1 0 2
, 0) (1 2
State the vertical asymptote, which occurs at loge (0). Vertical asymptote is the y-axis.
Translations do not change the shape of the basic graph, only the position. The asymptotes, intercepts and domain may change but the range stays the same.
WORKED EXAMPLE 14
Sketch the graph of f (x) = ln (x + 1) 2, marking the vertical asymptote and the intercepts.
THINK
1 2 3 4
WRITE/DRAW
State the rule. State the basic shape. Find the vertical asymptote by making (x + 1) = 0. Find the y-intercept by making x equal to 0. Remember that ln (1) = 0.
f (x) = ln (x + 1) 2 Log graph with shape f (x) = ln (x). x + 1 = 0 for asymptote so x = 1 is the vertical asymptote. If x = 0, y = ln (0 + 1) 2 = ln (1) 2 = 2 y-intercept = 2.
198
If y = 0,
f (x) = ln (x + 1) 2
A reection of f (x) = loge (x) in the x-axis does not change the graphs asymptote, x-intercept, domain or range. If there is a y-intercept, the sign changes. A reection in the y-axis does not change the vertical asymptote or the range, but the x-intercept and the domain change.
WORKED EXAMPLE 15
Sketch the graph of f (x) = 2 3 loge (1 x), marking the asymptote and intercepts. State the domain and range and check using a CAS calculator.
THINK
1 2
int-0537
WRITE/DRAW
Worked example 15
State the rule. Find the vertical asymptote by translating the line x = 0 one unit to the right or by making 1 x = 0. Find the y-intercept by making x equal to 0 and solving the equation. Find the x-intercept by making y equal to 0.
3 4
Sketch the graph, remembering that there is a reection in both the x- and the y-axes.
f (x) = 2 3 loge (1 x)
Chapter 4
199
To graph f (x) = 2 3 loge (1 x) on a Graphs page, complete the function entry line as: f1(x) = 2 3 ln (1 x) Then press ENTER . Note: The vertical asymptote at x = 1 is not displayed.
To sketch a graph by using transformations it is necessary to dilate, reect and then translate.
REMEMBER
1. The function f (x) = loge (x) is an increasing logarithmic Asymptote y x=0 function: y = loge (x) (a) The vertical asymptote is the y-axis so there are no y-intercepts. (b) The graph crosses the x-axis at (1, 0) because loga (1) = 0. x 0 (1, 0) (c) The domain is R+; that is, there are no negative values of x. (d) The range is R. (e) After transformations, the function becomes f (x) = A loga k(x + b) + B. 2. Dilation (a) Dilations from the x-axis are given by the coefcient of loge (x). Then, y = f (x) becomes y = Af (x). (b) Dilations from the y-axis are given by the reciprocal of the coefcient of x. Then, y = f (x) becomes y = f (kx). (c) Dilations do not change the vertical asymptote, the domain or the range of a logarithmic graph. Dilations from the y-axis change the x-intercept. 3. Translation (a) Vertical translation is given by the term added to loge (x). Then, y = f (x) becomes y = f (x) + B. If B > 0 the graph is moved up, and if B < 0 the graph is moved down. (b) Horizontal translation is given by the term that is added to x. y = f (x) becomes y = f (x + b). If b > 0 the graph is translated to the left, and if b < 0 the graph is translated to the right. (c) Translations do not change the shape of the basic graph, only the position. The asymptotes, intercepts and domain may change but the range stays the same. 4. Reection (a) Reection in the x-axis occurs if the coefcient A is negative. Then, y = f (x) becomes y = f (x). (b) Reection in the y-axis occurs if the coefcient of x is negative. Then, y = f (x) becomes y = f (x). (c) When following a sequence of transformations to sketch a graph, it is necessary to dilate, reect and then translate.
200
EXERCISE
4D
Spreadsheet 069
Logarithmic graphs
2 WE13 Sketch the graph of the following functions, marking all key features and stating the domain and range. Give exact values. a f (x) = loge (2x) b f (x) = loge (3x) c f (x) = 3 loge (x) x d f (x) = 2 loge (x) e f (x) = 2 loge f f (x) = 3 loge (2x) 3 WE14 Sketch the graph of the following functions, marking the vertical asymptote and the intercepts. Give exact answers for a f, otherwise round to 1 decimal place. a f (x) = 1 + loge (x) b f (x) = 2 + loge (x) c f (x) = loge (x 1) d f (x) = loge (x 2) e f (x) = loge (x + 2) f f (x) = loge (x + 3) g f (x) = loge (x 3) + 2 h f (x) = loge (x 1) + 1 i f (x) = loge (x + 3) 2 j f (x) = loge (x + 1) 2 4 WE15 Sketch the graph of the following functions, marking the asymptote and intercepts, and stating the domain and range. Give intercepts correct to 2 decimal places where appropriate. a f (x) = loge (x) b f (x) = loge (x) c f (x) = 2 loge (x) d f (x) = loge (2x) e f (x) = 3 loge ( 2x) f f (x) = 2 loge ( 4x) g f (x) = loge (1 x) h f (x) = loge (2 x) i f (x) = loge (2 x) j f (x) = loge (3 x) 5 The graph of f (x) = loge (x) undergoes the following transformations. Find the equation of the image of f (x) in each case. a Translation of 1 unit to the right. b Translation of 2 units down. c Dilation of 5 units from the x-axis. d Dilation of 3 units from the y-axis. e Reection in the x-axis. f Reection in the y-axis. g Reection in the x-axis and translation of 3 units to the left. h Dilation of 4 units from the y-axis and translation 1 unit up. i Reection in the x-axis, dilation of 2 units from the x-axis and translation of 3 units down. 6 Sketch the graphs of the equations found in question 5, showing the asymptote and intercepts, and stating the domain and the range. Give intercepts correct to 2 decimal places where appropriate. 7 State the transformations of f (x) needed to form the graph of f (x) = 2 loge (3x + 6) 1 and sketch the graph, showing the asymptote and intercepts. Give intercepts correct to 2 decimal places. 8 Sketch the graph of f: ( , 1] R where f (x) = 3 loge (2 x), showing key features. 9 MC The graph of y = loge (x) is transformed into the graph of y = 5 loge (2x) by: A A dilation of factor 5 from the x-axis and a dilation of factor 2 from the y-axis B A dilation of factor 2 from the x-axis and a dilation of factor 5 from the y-axis C A dilation of factor 1 from the x-axis and a dilation of factor 2 from the y-axis 5 D A dilation of factor 5 from the x-axis and a dilation of factor 1 from the y-axis 2 E A dilation of factor 1 from the x -axis and a dilation of factor 5 from the y-axis. 2
Chapter 4 Exponential and logarithmic graphs 201
(3)
10 MC For the function f (x) = 3 loge (x 2), the vertical asymptote and the coordinates of the x-intercept are respectively: A x = 3, (2, 0) B x = 2, (3, 0) C y = 3, (2, 0) D y = 2, (3, 0) E x = 3, (3, 0) a 11 MC The function f: [0.5, 6] R where f (x) = is undened when x is equal to: log g e ( x) A 0 B 0.5 C 1 D 6 E a 12 a When the function f (x) = a + b loge (x) is reflected in the x-axis and translated 2 units to the right, find g(x), the equation of the image of f (x). b State the domain and range of g(x) and write it using correct function notation. c If g(x) is reected in the y-axis and dilated by factor 4 from the x-axis, write in correct function notation the equation of h(x), the image of g(x).
eBoo k plus eBook
Digital doc
WorkSHEET 4.2
4E
WORKED EXAMPLE 16
The equation of the graph shown is of the form f (x) = Aex + B. Find the values of A and B correct to 2 decimal places and hence nd the equation of the function.
y 4 (0, 2) (2.44, 0) 4 3 2 1
0 1 x
THINK
1
WRITE
Use the point on the y-axis and substitute values into the given equation. Substitute the coordinates of another point into the given equation. Solve simultaneous equations by subtracting [1] from [2].
2 3
[2] [1]:
202
A=
Substitute in [1]: 2 =
2.4 44
Rewrite the original equation, substituting values for A and B. Note: You can use a CAS calculator to solve equations [1] and [2]. 1 On a Calculator page, press: MENU b 3:Algebra 3 1:Solve 1 Press /r to obtain the expression template and choose the simultaneous equation template for two unknowns. Complete the entry line as: a + b = 2 solve , a 2.44 +b=0 a e Press ENTER .
2
B=2
1 2
2.4 44
+B 1
The horizontal asymptote of an exponential equation gives the vertical translation and hence the value of B in the general equation f (x) = Aex + B.
WORKED EXAMPLE 17
The equation of the graph shown is of the form f (x) = aex + b. Find the values of a and b and hence nd the equation of the function.
THINK
1 2 3
WRITE
Use the horizontal asymptote to nd the value of b. Substitute the value of b in the equation. Use the y-intercept to nd a by substituting in the given equation.
The graph of ex has been translated up 2 units, so b = 2. f (x) = aex + 2 For (0, 5): 5 = ae0 + 2 ae0 = 3 a=3 f (x) = 3ex + 2
If there are three unknowns, three pieces of information are necessary to solve the equation.
Chapter 4
203
The vertical asymptote of a logarithmic graph gives the horizontal translation and hence the value of b in the equation y = A loge (x + b) + B. A translation to the left gives a positive value of b and a translation to the right gives a negative value of b.
WORKED EXAMPLE 18
eBoo k plus eBook
The equation of the graph shown is of the form y = A loge (x + b) + B. Find the values of A, b and B and hence nd the equation.
x = 1 5 (0, 5) (2, 0) 1 2 3 4
Tutorial
int-0538
Worked example 18
0 THINK
1 2 3 4 5 6
WRITE
Use the vertical asymptote to nd the value of b. Substitute the value of b into the equation. Use the y-intercept to nd an equation. Simplify using loge (1) = 0. Substitute the value of B in the equation. Use the x-intercept to nd A.
The graph of f (x) = loge (x) is translated 1 unit to the left, so b = 1. f (x) = A loge (x + 1) + B. For (0, 5): A loge (0 + 1) + B = 5 A loge (1) + B = 5 =5 f (x) = A loge (x + 1) + 5 For (2, 0): A loge (2 + 1) + 5 = 0 A loge (3) + 5 = 0 A loge (3) = 5 5 log e (3) A 4.55 (to 2 decimal places) f (x) = 4.55 loge (x + 1) + 5 A=
1. The general equation for an exponential graph is f (x) = Aek(x + b) + B, where A is the dilation factor from the x-axis, 1 is the dilation factor from the y-axis, b is the k horizontal translation and B is the vertical translation. 2. The general equation for a logarithmic graph is f (x) = A loge k(x + b) + B, where A is the dilation factor from the x-axis, 1 is the dilation factor from the y-axis, b is the k horizontal translation and B is the vertical translation. 3. The coordinates of points on the curve can be substituted into the general equation to nd the values of unknowns in the equation. 4. One piece of information is required for each unknown in the general equation. 5. The horizontal asymptote of an exponential graph gives the vertical translation and hence the value of B. If the asymptote is above the x-axis B is positive and if it is below the x-axis the value of B is negative. 6. The vertical asymptote of a logarithmic graph gives the horizontal translation and hence the value of b. If the asymptote is to the left of the y-axis b is positive and if it is to the right of the y-axis b is negative.
204
EXERCISE
4E
2 Find the values of b and B if the general equation of the graph shown is y = ex + b + B. Give your answers correct to 2 decimal places.
y 6 4 2 (0, 2)
(1, 6)
3 Find the values of A and k if the general equation of the graph shown is y = Aekx. Give your answers correct to 2 decimal places.
4 Find the values of A and B if the general equation of the graph shown is y = A 2x + B. Give exact answers.
5 WE17 The equation of the graph shown is of the form f (x) = a 2x + b. Find the values of a and b and hence find the equation of the function. Give exact answers.
4
) (0, 11 2 1 Asymptote y=1 0 1 2 x 3 2 1
6 MC If the horizontal asymptote is y = 1 and the y-intercept is 2, the equation for the exponential function of the form y = e x + b + B is: A y = ex + 1 2 B y = ex + 2 + 1 x + 1 C y= e 2 D y = ex 1 2 x + 1.1 E y= e +1
Chapter 4
205
7 Find the values of b and B if the general equation of the graph shown is y = e x + b + B. Give exact answers.
8 Find the values of A and B if the general equation of the graph shown is y = Aex + B . Give exact answers.
9 WE18 The equation of the graph shown is of the form y = A loge (x + b) + B. Find the values of A, b and B and hence find the equation. Give answers correct to 1 decimal place. 10 Find the values of A and k, given that the graph of y = A log10 kx passes through the points (1, 1) and (3, 2). Give your answers correct to 4 decimal places where appropriate. 11 If the horizontal translation is 2 units to the left, the vertical translation is 3, the graph passes through the point (2, 6), and the equation is of the form y = A log2 (x + b) + B, find the values of A, b and B.
y Asymptote 6 x= 2 4 2 3 2 1 0 1
(2, 6)
4F
Addition of ordinates
Sometimes we need to sketch the graph of a function that can be thought int-0249 of as the sum of two functions. For example, the function y = x2 + ex can Addition of ordinates be thought of as the sum of the functions y = x2 and y = ex. Such a graph can be drawn by sketching the two individual functions on the same set of axes, then adding the y-values (ordinates) for each x-value and plotting the resulting points. This method is convenient to use when we know the basic shape of the individual functions but cannot recognise the basic shape of the given function. We can sketch both graphs on the same set of axes, then plot the resulting points by adding the y-values for each x-value, and hence sketch the new curve. For example, the graph of y = x2 + ex can be sketched using the addition of ordinates technique, since the basic shape of the function is not known, but the two individual functions are a basic positive parabola and a basic exponential curve. The graph of y = ex + 1 can also be thought of as the sum of two functions, but since we can recognise its shape as the basic exponential curve translated 1 unit up, there is no need to use the addition of ordinates method. Note that the sum function can only be dened for the domain over which both of the individual functions are dened. So the domain of the sum function is obtained by nding the intersection of the domains of the individual functions. That is, if h(x) = f (x) + g(x), domain h(x) = domain f (x) domain g(x). Sometimes a function is dened as the difference between two individual functions. We can still use the method of addition of ordinates to graph such a function, because the second function can be expressed as the addition of a negative function. That is, h(x) = f (x) g(x) can be written as h(x) = f (x) + (g(x)).
206
So if, for example, we need to graph y = x2 ex, we could think of it as y = x2 + (ex). We then would sketch the basic parabola and the basic negative exponential curves on the same set of axes and use the addition of ordinates technique to obtain the graph of the original function.
WORKED EXAMPLE 19
WRITE
Write f (x) as the sum of the two individual functions g(x) and p(x). State the domain of g(x). State the domain of p(x). State the domain of f (x) by nding the intersection of the domains of individual functions.
Let f (x) = g(x) + p(x), where g(x) = 3x2 and p(x) = loge (x). Domain g(x) = R Domain p(x) = R+ Domain f (x) = domain g(x) domain p(x) = R R+ = R+
When sketching the graph by hand, it is important to select wisely the values of x for which the ordinates should be added. As a guide, good points to select are: 1. the end points of the graph 2. the points of intersection of the graphs 3. the x-intercepts of either of the graphs.
WORKED EXAMPLE 20
Using the same scale and axes, sketch the graphs of y1 = ex and y2 = ex over the domain [2, 2). Hence, sketch the graph of y = ex + ex, rounding coordinates to 1 decimal place.
THINK
1
WRITE/DRAW
Sketch y1 = ex by nding the horizontal asymptote, the y-intercept, and the end points.
The horizontal asymptote is the x-axis. x = 0, y = e0, y = 1 x = 2, y = e2, y = 7.4 x = 2, y = e 2, y = 0.1 The y-intercept is 1.
y 8 6 4 (2, 0.1) 2 1 2 0 (0, 1) 1 2 x (2, 7.4)
y1 = ex
On the same axes, sketch y2 = ex by reecting y1 in the y-axis and nding the horizontal asymptote, the y-intercept, and the end points.
Chapter 4
207
Add ordinates at the end point with the lowest x-value (y = y1 + y2 = ex + ex). Add ordinates when the graphs intersect.
When x = 2, y = e 2 + e2 7.5 Point (2, 7.5) When x = 0, Point (0, 2) y=1+1 =2 y 7.5
y 8 6 4 2 2 1
y1 = ex
5 6
Add ordinates at the other end point. Plot the points (which were obtained by adding ordinates), and join them to sketch the graph. It is necessary to label only end points and intercepts.
y = ex + e x
0 1
WORKED EXAMPLE 21
Given the graphs of f (x) and g(x), sketch the graph of h(x) = f (x) + g(x).
y f(x) g(x) 0 x
THINK
1
WRITE/DRAW
1
Add the ordinates at the LHS end points of the graph: a large positive value plus a smaller negative value should give a smaller positive value. Mark this point on the axes. Add the ordinates at the point where g(x) has the x-intercept and mark the resulting point on the set of axes. Note that g(x) = 0 at this point; therefore f (x) + 0 = f (x) (that is, if one of the functions cuts the x-axis, the sum is equal to the y-value of the other function). Add the ordinates at the rst point of intersection of the 2 functions. Note that at the point of intersection the value of y is the same for both functions, so the resulting point is double the y-value. Mark the point on the set of axes. Add the ordinates at the point where f (x) has the x-intercept and mark the result on the set of axes.
y f(x) g(x) 0 x
y f(x) g(x) 0 x
y f(x) g(x) 0 x
y f(x) g(x) 0 x
208
Add the ordinates at the second point of intersection of the 2 graphs and mark the resulting point on the set of axes. Add the ordinates at the RHS end points of the graph: 2 positive values together give an even larger positive value.
y f(x) g(x) 0 x
y f(x) g(x) 0 x
Join the points with a smooth curve to produce the graph of h(x). Note that the turning point of h(x) is between the y-axis and the point with the same y-value. The graph begins to turn at the left end point because the graph of g(x) turns there.
WORKED EXAMPLE 22
WRITE/DRAW
State the two individual functions. State the domain of f (x) by nding the intersection of the domains of individual functions.
Let f (x) = g(x) + p(x), where g(x) = x and p(x) = x Domain g(x) = R Domain p(x) = R+ {0} Domain f (x) = domain g(x) domain p(x) Domain= R R+ {0} Domain= R+ {0}
1
On the set of axes sketch the graph of g(x) (a straight line, passing through the origin and bisecting the rst quadrant) and p(x) (a basic square root curve). Note that only the rst quadrant is needed, since the domain is R+ {0}.
y g(x) p(x) x
3
0
4
The rst point of intersection of g(x) and p(x) is at the origin, f (x) = 0 + 0 = 0 (that is, f (x) will also start at the origin). Mark this point on the set of axes. Add the ordinates at the second point of intersection of the two graphs and mark the resulting point on the set of axes. Add the ordinates at the RHS end points of the graph and mark the resulting point on the set of axes.
y g(x) p(x) x
y g(x) p(x) x
Chapter 4
209
Sketch the graph of f (x) by joining the points. Note, as x increases, f (x) approaches g(x) because p(x) is increasing slowly.
Further graphs
The example below shows how to draw the graph of a product function.
WORKED EXAMPLE 23
Sketch the graph of y = x2ex using a CAS calculator. Show all axis intercepts and any asymptotes.
THINK
1
WRITE/DISPLAY
To graph y = x2ex on a Graphs page, complete the function entry line as: f1(x) = x2ex Then press ENTER . Note: y = x2ex is asymptotic to the negative x-axis, as when x , x2ex 0.
Substitute x = 0 to locate the y-intercept. Write the y-intercept in coordinate form (which is also the x-intercept).
REMEMBER
1. A graph of the sum of 2 functions can be drawn by sketching the 2 functions on the same set of axes and adding the y-values for each value of x. 2. The domain of the sum function is obtained by nding the intersection of the domains of individual functions: if h(x) = f (x) + g(x), domain h(x) = domain f (x) g(x). 3. Suitable points at which to add ordinates are: (a) left end points and right end points (b) the points of intersection of the 2 graphs (c) the x-intercepts of either of the 2 functions. 4. Exact values of y can be obtained by substituting the required x-values into the given function. 5. The difference function can be rewritten as the sum function as follows: h(x) = f (x) g(x) = f (x) + [g(x)], so that addition of ordinates can be used.
210
EXERCISE
4F
Addition of ordinates
1 WE19 State the domain of each of the following functions. 1 a y=x+ b y=3 x x x d y= x+2 x g y= 2 x2 ( x + 1)2 e y = x2 3x3 h y = 3x 2 1 x c y = x2 + 1 x 1 2 1 f y = 2x3 x 3 2 i y = 3(2 x)2 + 3x
j y = 2 3 x 3 x +1 2 MC If f (x) = g(x) + p(x), and if f (x) is dened over the domain [2, 7] and g(x) is dened for x 7, the domain of p(x) could not be: A [2, 7] B [2, ) C [2, 7) D [2, 7.5) E [2, 15] 3 WE20 Using the same scale and axes, sketch the graphs of y1 and y2 over the given domain. Hence, sketch the graph of y = y1 + y2, rounding coordinates to 1 decimal place as this is accurate enough for most sketch graphs. Check all graphs using a CAS calculator. a y1 = 2ex, y2 = 2ex, [1, 1] b y1 = 3ex, y2 = 3ex, [1, 1] x c y1 = e , y2 = x, ( 2, 2] d y1 = ex, y2 = x, (2, 2] x 2 e y1 = e , y2 = x , ( 2, 2) f y1 = ex, y2 = x2, (2, 3) 4 Using the same scale and axes, sketch the graphs of f (x) and g(x). Hence, sketch the graph of h(x) = f (x) + g(x), rounding coordinates to 1 decimal place as this is accurate enough for most sketch graphs. State the domain and range of h(x). Check all graphs using a CAS calculator. a f (x) = 2 loge (x), g(x) = x b f (x) = 3 loge (x), g(x) = x c f (x) = loge (x), g(x) = 2x d f (x) = loge (x), g(x) = 1 2x e f (x) = loge (x), g(x) = x f f (x) = 2 loge (x), g(x) = x 5 Using the addition of ordinates, sketch the graph of f: [2, 2] R, where f (x) = 1 ex + 1 ex. 2 2 State the domain and the range, giving answers to 1 decimal place where rounding is necessary. 6 MC If the domain of y1 is (2, 2] and the domain of y2 is (0, ), the domain of y1 + y2 is: A (2, ) B [2, ) C (0, ) D (2, 0) E (0, 2] 7 WE21 Given the graphs of f (x) and g(x), sketch the graph of h(x) = f (x) + g(x). y y y a b c f(x)
g(x) 0 x
0 f(x) g(x)
x f(x) g(x)
g(x)
y f(x)
f(x)
x 0
g(x) x
x f(x) g(x)
8 On the same set of axes sketch the graphs of f (x) = x2 and g(x) = 5x + 6. Use the addition-ofordinates method to sketch the graph of y = x2 + 5x + 6.
Chapter 4
211
9 On the same set of axes sketch the graphs of f (x) = x3 and g(x) = x2 1 and hence sketch the graph of y = x3 + x2 1, using the addition-of-ordinates technique. 10 WE22 Sketch the graph of each of the following functions, using addition of ordinates. Check your answers using a CAS calculator. a y= x + 2 x c y = x 3 x2 b y = 2x x d y= x+5 + 5 x
y
B
x
y 0 x
12 Sketch the graph of y = loge x + x by sketching the 2 individual functions on the same set of axes and then adding the ordinates. State the domain of the function. Verify your answer with a CAS calculator. 13 If f (x) = 3x 3 and g(x) = loge x, sketch the graph of h( x ) = f ( x ) + g( x ), using addition of ordinates. Check your answer using a CAS calculator. 14 WE23 For each of the following, sketch the graph using a CAS calculator. Show all axis intercepts and any asymptotes. State the domain and range. a y = x2e2x b y = x2ex c y = ex
2
15 For each of the following, sketch the graph using a CAS calculator. Show all axis intercepts and any asymptotes. State the domain and range. a y = x2 loge (x) b y = x2 loge (3x) c y = x loge (x)
4G
212
The rule of the composite function y = f x , where f (x) = loge (x), x > 0, can be written as: g e ( x) log y = log e x = g e ( x) log for x > 0 for x < 0
2 1
y 2 1 0 1 2 3 1 2 x
To obtain the graph of y = f ( x ) , negative y-values of y = f (x) are reected in the x-axis. The rule of the composite function y = f ( x ) , where f (x) = loge (x), x > 0, can be written as: g e ( x) log y = log e ( x ) = g e ( x) log for 0 < x < 1 for x 1
y 4 3 2 1 0 1 2 y 3 4 x
The rule of the composite function y = f x , where f (x) = ex, can be written as: e x for x 0 y = ex = e x for x < 0
2
The rule of the composite function y = f ( x ) , where f ( x ) = e x k, k R+, can be written as: y= ex (e x k ) for x < log e k k = x for x log e k e k
2
WRITE/DRAW
3 Sketch the graph of y = 2 log e x + 2 3, x > 2. The graph is not dened when x = 2, so there is a vertical asymptote at x = 2.
y 2 1 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 1 2 3 Asymptote x = 2 1 2 3 4 5 x
Chapter 4
213
y 2 1 0 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 1 2 3 Asymptote x = 2 1 2 3 4 5 x
To graph y = 2 log e ( x + 2) 3 with a CAS calculator, open a Graphs page and complete the function entry line as: f1(x) = 2 log e x + 2 3 Then press ENTER . Press /r and select the absolute value template.
To locate the x-intercepts, express y = 2 log e x + 2 3 as a hybrid function. Substitute y = 0 and solve each equation.
2 log e ( x + 2) 3 y= )) )3 2 log e ( ( x + 2) 2 loge (x + 2) 3 = 0 3 log g e ( x + 2) = 2 x + 2 = e2 x = e2 2 x = 2.481 69 2 loge ((x + 2)) 3 = 0 3 log g e ( ( x + 2)) 2)) = 2
( x + 2) 3 3 3
= e2
x = e2 2 x = 6.481 69
5
Write down the coordinates of the x-intercepts in exact form and correct to 2 decimal places. Substitute x = 0 to obtain the y-intercept and simplify.
Write down the coordinates of the y-intercept (0, 2 loge (2) 3) in exact form and correct to 2 decimal places. (0, 1.61)
214
1 2
x R\{2} yR
WORKED EXAMPLE 25 a Sketch the graph of y = e 1 showing all axis intercepts and asymptotes. b State the domain and range.
x
int-0539
Worked example 25
THINK a
1
WRITE/DRAW
Sketch the graph of y = e x 1 . The graph has a horizontal asymptote at y = 1. Reect the negative part (below the x-axis) of y = e x 1 and the asymptote about the x-axis. Note that the graph of y = 1 now has a horizontal asymptote at y = 1. ex Substitute x = 0 to obtain the y-intercept and simplify.
y = e0 1 = 11 =0
2 3 4
Write the coordinates of the y-intercept (which is also the x-intercept). State the domain. State the range.
REMEMBER
x for x 0 1. The modulus, or absolute value, function is dened as f ( x ) = x = . x for x < 0 2. For y = f x , the graph of y = f (x), where x 0, is reected in the y-axis. 3. For y = f ( x ) , negative y-values of y = f (x) are reected in the x-axis. EXERCISE
4G
b y = log e ( x + 1) 2 c y = log10 3 x + 1 y = 3 log e x 2 + 3 2 Sketch the graphs of the following showing all axis intercepts and asymptotes in exact form. For each graph, state the maximal domain and the range of the function. y = log e ( x 2) b y=
log e (1
x ) 2)
c y = log10 ( x + 3) + 1
Chapter 4
215
3 Sketch the graphs of the following showing all axis intercepts in exact form. For each graph, state the maximal domain and the range of the function. a 4 y = e x 1 + 4
x 1
b y = e 4 x 3
c y = e
+2
WE25 Sketch the graphs of the following showing all axis intercepts and asymptotes in exact form. For each graph, state the maximal domain and the range of the function.
y = ex 3 c y= e
x
b y = ex 2 + 4
1 + 2
4H
WORKED EXAMPLE 26
The population of wombats in Snubnose Gully is increasing according to the equation: W = 100e0.03t where W is the number of wombats t years after 1 January 1998. a Find the initial size of the population. b Find the population 2 years and 10 years after the number of wombats was rst recorded. Give answers to the nearest whole wombat. c Graph W against t for 0 t 30. d Find the expected size of the population in the year 2020. e Find the year in which the wombat population reaches 250.
THINK a
1 2 3
WRITE/DRAW
State the rule. Find W when t = 0. Write the answer in a sentence. Find W when t = 2.
a W = 100e0.03t
2 3
After 2 years there are 106 wombats. When t = 10, W = 100e0.03 10 = 100 1.3499 135 (nearest whole number) After 10 years there are 135 wombats.
216
To graph f (x) = 100e0.03x on a Graphs page, complete the function entry line as: f1(x) = 100e0.03x Then press ENTER . Note the viewing window settings: Xmin:0, Xmax:30, Ymin:0 and Ymax:250 When drawing your graph, label the axes with the given variables.
1 2
Convert the year 2020 to the correct number of years. Find W by substituting t = 22 into the equation. Write the answer as a sentence. Let W = 250. Divide both sides by 100. Take natural logs of both sides. Divide both sides by 0.03. Evaluate the answer using a CAS calculator. Express t = 31 as a year and write the answer as a sentence.
REMEMBER
d t = 2020 1998
= 22 years When t = 22, W = 100e0.03 22 = 193.479 = 193 (nearest whole number) In the year 2020, there are approximately 193 wombats.
t
1 2 3
e 250 = 100e0.03
2.5 = e0.03
loge (2.5) = loge (e0.03 t) 0.03t = loge (2.5) t= 1 log g ( 2.5) 0.0 03 e
4 5 6
t = 30.543 t = 31 (nearest year) There will be 250 wombats in the year 2029.
1. In general the number of unknowns indicates the number of points required to substitute into the equation. 2. The equation for exponential growth is A = A0ekt, where A0 represents the initial value, t represents the time taken and k represents the rate constant. This is a rapidly increasing function. 3. The equation for exponential decay is A = A0ekt, where A0 represents the initial value, t represents the time taken and k represents the rate constant. This is a rapidly decreasing function. EXERCISE
4H
Chapter 4
217
Spreadsheet 041
Function grapher
a Find the initial size of the population. b Find the population 2 years and 10 years after the number of koalas was rst recorded. Give answers to the nearest whole number. c Plot a graph of K against t. d Use the graph to nd the size of the population after 15 years. 2 The population of a species of wallaby found on a reserve is increasing according to the equation W = 150 1.08t, where W is the number of wallabies t years after records were first kept. a Find the initial size of the population. b Find the population 1 year and 5 years after records were rst kept. Give answers to the nearest whole number. c Plot a graph of W against t. d Use the graph to nd the size of the population after 15 years. e Use the graph to nd how long it would take for the population to double. 3 A student invests $500 with a company that pays interest of 6% compounded continuously. (Interest paid according to the formula A = A0ert is said to be compounded continuously and r is called the continuous interest rate.) a How much money made up the initial investment? b How much did the student have with the company after 1 year? Give your answer correct to the nearest 5 cents. c How much interest did the student have after 5 years? Give your answer correct to the nearest 5 cents. d Plot a graph of A against t. e Use your graph to nd how much the student would have in the account after 8 years. 4 The decay of a radioactive element, E, is given by the equation E = E0 ekt, where E is the number of radioactive nuclei present t days after the experiment begins. a If 200 radioactive nuclei are present in the element at the beginning of the experiment and there are 33 radioactive nuclei present after 10 days, nd the value of k correct to 2 decimal places. Use this rounded value for all working in the other parts of this question. b Find the number of radioactive nuclei, E, present after 1 day and after 5 days. c Plot a graph of E against t. d Use the graph to nd how long it would take before 50 radioactive nuclei are left. e Would there ever be no radioactive nuclei left? Give reasons for your answer. f The half-life of a radioactive element is the time taken for half of the radioactive nuclei to decay. Use your graph to nd the half-life of this element. 5 A hard-boiled egg is placed in water to cool. The cooling process can be modelled by the equation T T1 = (T0 T1)ekt, where T is the temperature of the egg t minutes after it was placed in the water and T1 is the temperature of the water. Assume that the temperature of the egg is 98 C when it is first placed in the 18 C water and it takes 5 minutes for it to cool to 38 C. a Substitute the values of T0 and T1 into the equation and simplify, making T the subject. b Find the value of k to 3 decimal places. c Substitute it into the equation. d Find how long it would take to reach a temperature of 25 C. Give your answer to the nearest minute. e Draw a graph of T against t, marking in asymptotes. f Use the graph to nd the temperature after 15 minutes. g Assuming that the water does not become signicantly warmer, use your graph to determine whether the egg will ever reach the temperature of the water.
218
6 The population of a species of fish in Lake Underwater is declining due to an unknown cause. The number of fish t weeks after the first dead fish was found on the surface of the water can be modelled by the equation P = A loge (t) + B. One week after the first dead fish was discovered, the population was 10 000. The population was 8000 after 5 weeks. a Find the values of A and B. Give answers correct to 2 decimal places where appropriate. b Find how many sh there are after 10 weeks. c Find how long it would take for the population to be 3000. Give your answer to the nearest week. d Sketch a graph of P against t, clearly indicating the asymptote. e Use the graph to nd how many sh there would be after 20 weeks. 7
MC The relationship between m and n is modelled by the equation m = log10 (an + b). The graph is shown at right. The values of a and b are: A 3 and 2 B 2 and 3 C 3 and 2 D 1 and 2 E 1 and 3
m 2 1 1 (1, 0) 0 1 2 3 (4, 1) 4 n
8 It costs a clothing company $20 to produce a jacket. Production costs are proportional to the number of jackets produced. a If the company produces n jackets, write an equation for the companys production costs for the jackets, $C. As the company produces more jackets they nd that they have to sell them at a lower price. The companys revenue, $R, is modelled by the equation R(n) = 2000(1 e 0.1n) b Show that R(0) = 0. c According to this model, revenues plateau as costs increase. What is the value that the revenue approaches? d On the same axes, sketch the graphs of the cost equation and the revenue equation for 0 n 55. e Use addition of ordinates to sketch the graph of the prot the company can expect to make from selling the jackets (prot = revenue cost). f Write an equation for this prot. g Use a CAS calculator to nd the number of jackets that must be sold in order to maximise the prots and what that prot would be. h Use a CAS calculator to nd how many jackets the company could make before they began to make a loss. i Is this a reasonable model for a company to use? Explain your reasons.
Chapter 4
219
SUMMARY
Exponential functions y For graphs of the form f (x) = ax, where a R+\{1}: 1. The maximal domain is R. 4 2. The range is R+. 3. The x-axis is the horizontal asymptote. 2 4. The y-intercept is 1. (0, 1) 5. They are all increasing functions. x 0 1 2 2 1 Reection: 1. If f (x) = ax is reected in the x-axis the result is the graph of f (x) = ax. The graph is a decreasing function instead of an increasing function. The y-intercept changes to (0, 1) and the range becomes R. 2. If f (x) = ax is reected in the y-axis the result is the graph of f (x) = ax. All key features stay the same but the graph is a decreasing function instead of an increasing function. Translation: For all of the graphs of the form f (x) = ax + b + B, where b, B R, and a R+\{1}, the maximal domain is R, the range is (B, ), the horizontal asymptote is y = B and they are all increasing functions. b translates the graph horizontally, B translates the graph vertically. Dilation: If f (x) = Aakx, where A, k R+, the graph of f (x) = ax is dilated by factor A from the x-axis and by factor 1 k from the y-axis. Combinations of transformations: For all the graphs of the form f (x) = A ak(x + b) + B, where b, B R, A, k R+ and a R+\{1}, the maximal domain is R, the range is (B, ), the horizontal asymptote is y = B and they are all increasing functions. b translates the graph horizontally, B translates the graph vertically and A dilates the graph by factor A from the x-axis, k dilates the graph by factor 1 from the y-axis. If A, k < 0 the graphs are reected in the x- and k y-axes, respectively. Logarithmic functions
For graphs of the form f (x) = loga (x), where a R+\{1}: y 1. The maximal domain is R+; that is, there are no negative values of x. 2. The range is R. 3. The vertical asymptote is the y-axis so there are no x 0 (1, 0) y-intercepts. 4. The graph crosses the x-axis at (1, 0) because loga (1) = 0. 5. They are all increasing functions. Reection: 1. If f (x) = loga (x) is reected in the x-axis the result is the graph of f (x) = loga (x). All key features remain the same but the graph is a decreasing function instead of an increasing function. 2. If f (x) = loga (x) is reected in the y-axis the result is the graph of f (x) = loga (x). The vertical asymptote and the range remain the same but the x-intercept and the domain change. (a) The graph crosses the x-axis at (1, 0). (b) The domain is (, 0). Dilation: 1. The function f (x) = A loga (x) dilates the graph of f (x) = loga (x) by a factor of A from the x-axis. The vertical asymptote, x-intercept, domain and range remain the same. As A increases, the graph becomes steeper.
220
2. The function f (x) = loga (kx) dilates the graph of f (x) = loga (x) by a factor 1 from the y-axis. The vertical k asymptote, domain and range stay the same, but the x-intercept is 1 . As k increases, the graph becomes k steeper and the x-intercept becomes smaller. Translation: 1. The function f (x) = loga(x) + B translates the graph of f (x) = loga (x) vertically, B units. The vertical axis, domain and range remain the same but the x-intercept changes. There is no change in the shape of the graph. 2. The function f (x) = loga (x + b) translates the graph of f (x) = loga (x) horizontally b units. The shape and the range remain the same but the vertical asymptote, the x-intercept and the domain change: (a) The vertical asymptote becomes x = b. (b) The graph crosses the x-axis at (1 b, 0). (c) The domain is (b, ). Combinations of transformations: The function f (x) = A loga (x + b) + B has dilation factor A from the x-axis and is translated b units horizontally and B units vertically. If A < 0 there is a reection in the x-axis and if x is used there is a reection in the y-axis.
Addition of ordinates
A graph of the sum of two functions can be drawn by sketching the two functions on the same set of axes and then adding the y-values for each value of x. If h(x) = f (x) + g(x), domain h(x) = domain f (x) domain g(x). Suitable points at which to add ordinates are: 1. the end points of the graph 2. the points of intersection of the two graphs 3. the x-intercepts of the two graphs. The technique can be used for the difference of the two functions, if it is rewritten as a sum: h(x) = f (x) g(x) = f (x) + [g(x)].
Further graphs
Use a CAS calculator to graph the product of two functions or composite functions. Obtain the equation of any asymptote of the function by considering asymptotic behaviour of the individual functions. On your graph, clearly label: 1. asymptotes 2. axis intercepts.
Absolute value graphs
x for x 0 The modulus, or absolute value, function is dened as f ( x ) = x = . x for x < 0 For y = f x , the graph of y = f (x), where x 0, is reected in the y-axis. For y = f ( x ) , negative y-values of y = f (x) are reected in the x-axis.
Chapter 4
221
CHAPTER REVIEW
SHORT ANSWER
1 Sketch the graph of x) = 2(x + 1) 4, showing intercepts and asymptotes, and stating the domain and range. 2 Sketch the graph of f (x) = 3 log10 (2x), showing intercepts and asymptotes, and stating the domain and range. 3 Find the equation of the graph below, given that it is of the form f (x) = Aex + B.
y 4 2 x 4 3 2 1 0 1 2 (0, 1) 2 y = 4 4 5
b determine the rule for g 1(x), and hence state the domain and range of g 1(x). 8 If h(x) = f (x) + g(x) where f (x) = x2 + 1 and g(x) = loge (x), sketch the graph of h(x) = f (x) + g(x). State the domain and range of h(x). 9 Describe a sequence of transformations that maps the graph of y = f (x) on to the graph of y = 2f (3 x) + 5. 10 After a protection program for tigers was introduced in a province of India on 1 January 2006, the population of the tigers is modelled by T(t) = 50 20.4t, where t is the number of months after the start of the program. At the same time, the number of elephants in the province is modelled by E(t) = 400 4 0.1t. Find: a the number of tigers and elephants in the province on 1 January 2006 b which of the two animals has the highest numbers in the province on 1 April 2007 c the date when the population of the tigers will equal the population of elephants in the province. If the number of elephants falls below 25, they are at risk of extinction in this province. d According to the model, will this happen? If so, when will it happen?
4 The graphs of f (x) and g(x) are shown below. Sketch the graph of (f + g)(x), using the additionof-ordinates technique. y a g(x)
f(x) x
g(x) f(x)
5 a Use the law loga (mp) = p loga (m) to simplify f (x) = log10 (x2) and hence sketch the graph of the function f: (0, ) R where f (x) = log10 (x2). b Sketch the graph over the domain, R, noting that it is now possible to take negative values of x. 6 P = P0et. If P = 120 when t = 0, find the exact value of P when t = 20. 7 For the function g(x) = 2ex + 1 4: a sketch the graph of g(x) by nding the equation of any asymptotes and the coordinates of all intercepts 11 Sketch the graph of y = log e ( x + 3) , showing all intercepts and asymptotes in exact form. State the maximal domain and the range.
222
12 Let f : D R, f ( x ) = 2 log log e x + 3 + 1, where D is the maximal domain of f. a State D. b Find the exact coordinates of the points where the graph of y = f (x) intersects the x- and y-axes. c Sketch the graph of y = f (x). Indicate any asymptote with its equation.
EXAM TIP
6 Which of the following graphs best represents the function f (x) = log10 (x 2) + 1? A y
x=2 2 6 4 2 0 2 4 2 4 6 x
a Some students wrote instead of Some also wrote R3, or just 3, which are insufcient when specifying the domain. b Some students did not give exact values and some missed the second x-intercept, because they were not aware of the absolute value function inside the natural logarithm. Instead of writing loge (3), some students appeared to write 3. c Some students only drew the right-hand branch of the function. Some did not show asymptotic behaviour correctly, particularly by having branches suddenly stop at a circle somewhere on the asymptote. The function should not curve away from the asymptote, nor touch it.
[Assessment report 1 2003]
R/{3}
R\{3}.
x = 2 y 2 6 4 2 0 2 4 2 4 6 x
x = 2 y 2 6 4 2 0 2 4 2 4 6 x
[ VCAA 2003]
MULTIPLE CHOICE
1 The horizontal asymptote for the graph of f (x) = 2x 1 is: A x=2 B x=1 C y=0 D y = 1 E y = 2 2 The domain and range of the graph of f (x) = 3 10x + 1 are respectively: A R, [1, ) B R, (1, ) C R, [3, ) D R, (3, ) E R, R 3 The y-intercept for the graph of f (x) = 1 2x is: A 0 B 1 C 2 D 3 E 4 4 When the function f (x) = log10 (x 1) is translated 2 units up and 1 unit to the left the function becomes: A log10 (x 2) + 2 B log10 (x 3) + 3 C log10 (x) + 2 D log10 (x + 1) + 2 E log10 (x + 2) + 1 5 The function f (x) = log2 (x + 1) has as its domain: A (1, ) B [1, ) C (1, ) D [ 1, ) E R
y 2
x=2
0 2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
x = 2 y
2 0 1 2 3 x
3 2 1
7 The graph of f (x) = 2ex + 1 is obtained from the graph of f (x) = ex by: A a dilation of 2 units from the y-axis and a translation of 1 unit to the left
Chapter 4
223
B a dilation of 2 units from the y-axis and a translation of 1 unit to the right C a dilation of 2 units from the x-axis and a translation of 1 unit to the left D a dilation of 2 units from the x-axis and a translation of 1 unit to the right E a dilation of 1 unit from the x-axis and a translation of 2 units to the right 8 If f (x) = ex, the function in the graph below is:
y 2 (0, 1) x 3 2 1 0 1 2 3 Asymptote 2 y = 2
14 If f (x) = loge (x + 2) + 1, then f (1) and f (0) are respectively (correct to 2 decimal places): A 2.10, 1.69 B 2.09, 0.69 C 2.098, 1.693 D 1.10, 1.69 E 2.10, 0.69 15 The domain of {f (x) + g(x)} is: A dom f dom g B dom f dom g C dom f D dom g E R 16 If f (x) = g(x) + p(x), and dom g(x) = ( , 5] and dom p(x) = ( 2, ), then the domain of f (x) is: A ( 2, 5] B [ 2, 5) C [ 2, 5] D ( 2, 5) E none of the above 17 Which of the following shows the graph of y= x+4 +
y 4 4 4 x y 2 4 4 x y 4 2 2 x 4 4
4x ? B
y 4 4 x y 4 4 x
B 3f (x) 2 D 2 3f (x)
9 If the horizontal asymptote is y = 2 and the y-intercept is 1, a possible equation for the graph is: A y = ex + 2 B y = 2ex + 1 C y = 2ex 1 D y = ex 2 x E y=2e 10 The vertical asymptote for the graph of f (x) = 3 loge (x 2) + 1 is: A x= 1 B x=0 C x=1 D x=2 E x=3 11 For the function f: [ 1, ] R where f (x) = 3 loge (x + 2), the domain and range are respectively: A ( 2, ), (0, ) B (2, ), R D [ 1, ), [0, ) C ( 1, ), R+ E R+, R 12 If f (x) = loge (x + 1), the y-intercept of 2f (x) + 3 is: A 0 B 1 C 2 D 3 E 4 13 The general equation of the graph shown y is y = Aex + B. The values of 4 A and B are: (0, 3) A 3, 1 B 2, 1 2 C 4, 1 D 1, 3 E 4, 1
6 4 2
18 The decay of uranium-235 is modelled by the equation U = U0ekt, where U is the number of grams of uranium-235 after t million years. If a 1000 g mass of uranium-235 decays to 907 g in 100 million years, the values of U0 and k are respectively: A 100, 0.000 976 B 1000, 0.000 976 C 10 000, 0.000 907 D 1000, 0.000 907 E 100, 907
2 y = 1
19 The function g has the rule g(x) = logex b, where b is a real constant. The maximal domain of g is: A R+ B R\{b} 0 2 x C R D (b, b) Asymptote [ VCAA 2006] E (b, )
224
20 The maximal domain D of the function f: D R with rule f (x) = loge (x 3) + 6 is: B (3, ) A R\{3} D (3, ) C R [ VCAA 2007] E ( , 3) 21 The function f satisfies the functional equation x + y f ( x) + f ( y) f = 2 where x and y are any 2 non-zero real numbers. A possible rule for the function is: A f ( x ) = log e x B f ( x) = 1 x C f ( x) = 2 x D f ( x) = 2 x n (2 x ) E f ( x ) = sin
EXTENDED RESPONSE
[ VCAA 2006]
22 The function f has the property that f (x) + f (y) = (x + y) f (xy) for all non-zero real numbers x and y. A possible rule for f is: A f (x) = 2x B f (x) = 5 2x C f ( x) = 1 x D f (x) = ex E f ( x ) = log e x
[ VCAA 2005]
23 Let f (x) = ex. For all positive real numbers x and y, f (x + y) is equal to: A f (x) + f (y) B f (x) f (y) C f (xy) D (f (x)) y y [ VCAA 2003] E f (x )
1 Sketch the graph of f (x) = 2ex 1 + 1, showing all key features. State the domain and the range. 2 Sketch the graph of f (x) = 1 loge (2 x), clearly showing intercepts and asymptotes, and state the domain and range. 3 By adding ordinates, sketch the graph of f (x) = log10 (2x) + log10 (x). State the domain and the range. 4 N is the number of bacteria in a culture where N = 10 000e0.04t is the formula for the number of bacteria in the culture after t hours. Find: a the initial number of bacteria b the number of bacteria after 10 hours. Give your answer to the nearest thousand. 5 Sketch the graph of y = 4 e x 1 showing all axis intercepts in exact form and any asymptotes. State the maximal domain and the range of the function. 6 Part of the graph of the function f : R R, f (x) = a + bex is shown at right. The line with equation y =1 is an asymptote and the graph passes through the origin. a Explain why a = 1 and b = 1. Let h be the function h:[0, 2] R, h(x) = f (x). b State the range of h using exact values. c Find the inverse function h 1.
y y=1 0 x
EXAM TIP
a Most students were able to explain why a = 1 by discussing the asymptote; however, many of them were unable to explain why b = 1. The most common error occurred when students tried to discuss reections and translations but failed to indicate which graph they were transforming. b This question was generally well done. Some students were unable to obtain full marks because they rounded up 1 e 2 to 0.8647. Others used round brackets instead of square brackets. c When the inverse function is asked for, the domain must be given. Students will be penalised if the domain is left out. If only the rule for the inverse function is asked for, the domain does not have to be given. Some students gave the incorrect
answer h 1 ( x ) = log e 1 x .
[ VCAA 2007]
Chapter 4
225
log e (5 (5 x ) + 1. 7 A function f is defined by the rule f ( x ) = log a Sketch the graph of f over its maximal domain. Clearly label any intersections with the axes with their exact coordinates and any asymptotes with their equations. b Find the rule for the inverse function f 1.
EXAM TIP
The graph on a calculator screen is of limited use. Many students did not give exact intercepts. Some tried to cheat by nding numerical approximations and then writing these as fractions (which were incorrect). Many students failed to identify the vertical asymptote at all, while some identied a horizontal asymptote. If they failed to identify the vertical asymptote, the right-hand end of the graph frequently ended abruptly on or close to the x-axis. Many students were also unable to represent asymptotic behaviour correctly. A few students still wrote a circle where their graph ended on the asymptote this should not be encouraged, as students will lose marks for doing it.
[Assessment report 1 2005]
[ VCAA 2005]
8 Kerri invested $5000 with a company that pays interest of 5% compounded continuously. To answer the questions below, use the formula A = A0ert, where A is the amount of the investment, A0 is the original investment, r is the continuous interest rate and t is the number of years since the money was originally invested. Round the answer to the nearest 5c. a How much money did Kerri rst invest with the company? b How much money did Kerri have with the company after 1 year? c How much did she have after 5 years? If the company had been paying interest compounded quarterly, the formula used would have been A = A0 1 + r . 4 d Using this system, how much would Kerri have after 5 years of the investment? e How long would it take to double the investment? Give your answer in years. f Which is the better investment? Give reasons. g What is the difference in the amount of interest after 5 years? h What would be the difference in 5 years if Kerri had invested $10 000? 9 A local council decided to build a new road along the coast. To make it safer it was decided to design the road so that it followed the curve represented by the equation y = 2 log10 (2x a) + 3 where a > 0.
y The grid at right shows the road. In each direction, 1 unit represents Bridge 1 kilometre. Ship a If the new section of road goes 4 over the bridge marked on the graph, nd the value of a. b Find the x-coordinate of the point where the road begins. Give the answer correct to 2 2 decimal places. How far would this be from the vertical axis to the nearest metre? c What is the shortest distance x 0 2 4 from the beginning of the road 6 8 1 3 5 7 9 to the coastline if the coastline is on the vertical asymptote at that point? Give the answer correct to the nearest metre. d The main highway is along the x-axis. How far is the road from the main highway when it is in line with the ship marked on the grid? Give the answer in kilometres, correct to 1 decimal place.
( )
4t
226
10 The air pressure P in kilopascals (kPa) at a height of x kilometres (km) above sea level may be modelled by the equation P = aebx. A mountain climber uses an altimeter to record air pressures at known heights on a climb of Mount Kosciuszko (height 2.228 km). These pressures are shown in the table below. x P 0 101.3 0.5 95.2
1.0 89.4
1.5 84.0
2.0 78.9
a If b is between 0.1 and 0.2, nd the value for b (to 3 decimal places) which produces the best tting model of the form P = aebx for the above data. b Use your model to predict the air pressure at the top of Mount Kosciuszko. 11 The graph of the function f (x) = e2x bex + c is shown below.
y y=6
(0, 2) 0 x
a b c d e f g h
Find the values of b and c. Show that the exact values of the x-intercepts are x = loge (2) and x = loge (3). Use a CAS calculator to nd the coordinates of the turning point. Round answers to 2 decimal places. Find the exact values of the coordinates of the point of intersection of the function and the horizontal asymptote. eBoo k plus eBook If the function is reected in the x-axis, fully dene the new function g(x) = f (x). If the function is reected in the y-axis, fully dene the new function, h(x). Digital doc If the function is reected in both the x- and the y-axis, sketch the graph of Test Yourself the new function, k(x), write its equation and state the domain and the range. Chapter 4 Find the equation of f (2 x) + 1. State the domain and range, rounding to 2 decimal places where appropriate.
Chapter 4
227
eBook plus
ACTIVITIES
Chapter opener
Digital doc
10 Quick Questions: Warm up with ten quick questions on exponential and logarithmic graphs. (page 172)
4A
Tutorial
4E
Tutorial
WE 5 int-0535: Watch how to sketch the graph of a logarithmic function. (page 187)
Digital docs
WE 18 int-0538: Watch how to nd the equation of an exponential given the graph. (page 204)
4F Addition of ordinates
Interactivity int-0249:
Spreadsheet 069: Investigate logarithmic graphs. (page 191) WorkSHEET 4.1: Sketch graphs of exponentials and logarithms, identify transformations and determine rules for graphs. (page 191)
4C
Tutorial
Addition of ordinates: Consolidate your understanding of addition of ordinates using the interactivity. (page 206)
4G
Tutorial
WE 10 int-0536: Watch how to sketch the graph of an exponential function and state the transformations. (page 193)
Digital doc
WE 25 int-0539: Watch a worked example on how to sketch the graph of an absolute function. (page 215)
4H Exponential and logarithmic modelling using graphs
Digital doc
WE 15 int-0537: Sketch the graph of a logarithmic function stating the domain and range using a CAS calculator to check. (page 199)
Digital docs
Test Yourself: Take the end-of-chapter test to test your progress. (page 227)
To access eBookPLUS activities, log on to www.jacplus.com.au
Spreadsheet 069: Investigate logarithmic graphs. (page 201) WorkSHEET 4.2: Sketch graphs of exponentials and logarithms and determine points of intersection between graphs. (page 202)
228
5
inverse functions
AREAS oF STuDy
5A 5B 5C 5D
Relations and their inverses Functions and their inverses Inverse functions Restricting functions
Graphs and identification of key features of graphs of functions studied Graphs of inverse functions Functions and their inverses, including conditions for the existence of an inverse function, and use of inverse functions to solve equations involving exponential, logarithmic and power functions
The concept of an inverse function, connection between the domain and range of the original function and its inverse and the conditions for the existence of an inverse function, including the form of the graph of the inverse function for specified functions Finding the rule of an inverse function and giving its domain and range
eBook plus
5A
eBook plus
Interactivity
Digital doc
10 Quick Questions
int-0248
Relations and their inverses
You will recall from Maths Quest 11 Mathematical Methods CAS that a relation is a set of ordered pairs that can be graphed or may be described by a rule. As we have seen, the inverse of a relation can be found by: 1. interchanging the x- and y-coordinates of an ordered pair; for example, (1, 2) becomes (2, 1) 2. reflecting the relation in the line y = x y 3. interchanging x and y in the rule and rearranging y=x 3 the equation to make y the subject; for example, (1, 2) y = x 1 becomes x = y 1, giving y = x + 1. 2 (2, 1) (0, 1) The domain of a relation becomes the range of its inverse 1 and the range of a relation becomes the domain of its inverse. (1, 0) (1, 0) x 0 1 2 3 The diagram at right shows a set of ordered pairs 3 2 1 1 (0, 1) (2, 1) A = {( 1, 2), (0, 1), (1, 0), (2, 1)}, the line y = x and the 2 inverse B = {(2, 1), (1, 0), (0, 1), (1, 2)}. (1, 2) 3 The domain of A is { 1, 0, 1, 2} and the range of A is {2, 1, 0, 1}. The domain of B is {2, 1, 0, 1} and the range of B is {1, 0, 1, 2}.
Chapter 5
inverse functions
229
As the graph of an inverse is the reflection in the line y = x of the original, we can use a matrix to describe this transformation and find the image of a point on f (x), or the rule of the inverse f 1(x) given f (x). 0 1 x The matrix operation that produces a reflection in the line y = x is . 1 0 y Finding the image of a point using this method is trivial, as we know that the points on the graph of an inverse are found by interchanging the (x, y) values of any point on the original. This can be shown as follows: The graph of a relation passes through the point (3, 4). Find the image of this point on the graph of the inverse. 0 1 3 4 = 1 0 4 3 That is, (3, 4) maps to (4, 3). A more general application will be to find the rule of the inverse of a relation. This can be done using matrices but in practice this is unnecessary as it simply involves swapping the variables and rearranging the new equation. Again, it is not time effective to employ this method, but it is shown as a demonstration of the relationship of the inverse graph to its original. x x 0 1 x y T = = = y y 1 0 y x That is, (x, y) maps to ( y', x' ). Therefore, we can write y' = x and x' = y, which relates to the practice of reversing the variables to find the rule of the inverse.
WoRkED ExAMplE 1
Sketch the graph of each of the following relations. State the domain and range of each. a {(3, 1), (1, 1), (1, 3), (3, 5)} b y = x2 + 2
Think a
1 2 3
WRiTE/DRAW
Plot each coordinate pair on a set of axes. The domain is the set of first elements of the ordered pairs. The range is the set of second elements of the ordered pairs.
y 5 4 3 2 1 321 0 1 1 2 3 x
1 2 3 4
The relation is a parabola with a minimum turning point (0, 2). Sketch the parabola. The domain is the set of real numbers. The range is any real number greater than or equal to 2.
y = x2 + 2
(0, 2) 0 x
WoRkED ExAMplE 2
Find the inverse of each relation in worked example 1. Sketch the graph of each inverse relation, stating its domain and range.
230
Think a
1 2 3
WRiTE/DRAW
Write the original relation. Interchange the x and y elements to obtain the inverse. Plot these points on a set of axes.
The inverse is {(1, 3), (1, 1), (3, 1), (5, 3)}
y 3 2 1
1 0 1 2 3 4 5 x 1 2 3
4 5
1 2 3 4 5
State the domain, which is the set of first elements of the ordered pair. State the range, which is the set of second elements of the ordered pair. Write the original relation. Interchange x and y in the rule. Subtract 2 from both sides. Take the square root of both sides to make y the subject. The graph of y = x 2 is a sideways parabola with a turning point (2, 0). (use a CAS calculator to verify this graph.)
6 7 8
Sketch the graph of the relation. State the domain. State the range.
Note that the domain of the original relation is the range of its inverse, and the range of the original relation is the domain of its inverse.
WoRkED ExAMplE 3
eBook plus
Tutorial
For each relation graphed below, sketch the graph and its inverse on the same axes. Draw in the line y = x.
a y b y 4 (2, 2) (2, 2) c (2, 4) y 4
int-0540
Worked example 3
(1, 4)
(2, 0) x
(0, 5)
(3, 0) 0
Chapter 5
inverse functions
231
Think a
1 2
DRAW
Copy the graph shown. Interchange the points (2, 0) and (0, 5) to (0, 2) and (5, 0), respectively, and mark them on a set of axes. Draw a straight line through each pair of points. Draw the line y = x, noting that the inverseis a reflection of the original function in y = x. Copy the graph shown. Interchange the points (2, 2), (0, 0), (0, 4) and (2, 2) to (2, 2), (0, 0), (4, 0) and (2, 2) and mark on a set of axes. Draw a circle through the second set of 4 points. Draw the line y = x, noting that the inverse is a reflection of the original relation in y = x. Copy the graph shown. Interchange the points (3, 0), (2, 4), (0, 0) and (1, 4) to (0, 3), (4, 2), (0, 0) and (4, 1) and mark them on the same set of axes. Draw a sideways cubic through the second set of points. Draw the line y = x, noting that the inverse is a reflection of the original function in y = x.
3 4
y=x b
1 2
3 4
(2, 2)
0 2 c (2, 4) y 4 2 (2, 2)
(4, 0) x
1 2
(1, 4)
y=x
Note: This example shows that the graph of the inverse relation can be obtained by reflecting the graph of the original relation in the line y = x. Some specific points can be marked and used as a guide; intercepts are particularly useful. Note also that a relation and its inverse intersect on the line y = x.
232
REMEMbER
1. 2. 3. 4.
A relation is a set of ordered pairs which may be described by a rule. The inverse of a relation can be found by interchanging the x and y elements. The graph of a relation and its inverse are reflected in the line y = x. If the rule for a relation is known, then the rule for its inverse is obtained by interchanging x and y in the rule and then making y the subject. 5. The domain of a relation is the same as the range of its inverse and the range of a relation is the same as the domain of its inverse. ExERCiSE
5A
eBook plus
Digital doc
SkillSHEET 5.1
Domain and range
eBook plus
Digital doc
Spreadsheet 041
Function grapher
3 MC The graph of a relation passes through the points (0, 1), (1, 2) and (3, 3). The graph of the inverse of this relation must pass through the points: A (2, 1) and (3, 3) B (0, 1) and (3, 3) C (0, 1) only D (1, 2) and (3, 3) E (3, 3) and (4, 10)
Chapter 5
inverse functions
233
4 MC A relation has x-intercepts 2 and 3. The y-intercepts of the inverse of this relation are: B 2 and 3 C 2 and 3 A 2 and 3 D 2 and 3 E cannot be determined 5 WE3 For each relation, sketch the graph and its inverse on the same axes. Draw in the line y= x. a
y 0 2 x 0 3 x 0
y (1, 3) x
y 2 4 0 x
f
2
y 0 2 x
y 1 0 2 x
0 0 x 6
y (1, 1) 0 (1, 1) x
y 4
y 3
0 4
x 3 0 y 2 4 0 2 x (1, 2) 4 2 0 x x 0 (2, 3) y x
y 2
y 0 3 x
5b
234
2. The graph of the inverse of a function is obtained by either: (a) interchanging the x- and y-values of its ordered pairs, or (b) reflecting the graph of the function through the line y = x, or (c) finding the rule of the inverse and graphing the new function. The domain of a function is the range of its inverse. The range of a function is the domain of its inverse.
WoRkED ExAMplE 4
State whether or not each of the following is a function by using the vertical line test. a y = (x + 1)2 3 b x2 + y2 = 1 4 +1 c y= x2
Think a
1 2 3
WRiTE/DRAW
Write the equation. State the type of graph. Do a rough sketch and use the vertical line test to determine if the relation is a function.
a y = (x + 1)2 3
0 (1, 3)
4
x (0, 2)
State whether or not it is a function. Write the equation. State the type of graph. Do a rough sketch and use the vertical line test to determine if the relation is a function.
y = (x + 1)2 3 is a function.
b x2 + y2 = 1
1 2 3
State whether or not it is a function. Write the equation. State the type of graph.
x2 + y2 = 1 is not a function.
c y=
1 2
4 +1 x2
Chapter 5
inverse functions
235
Do a rough sketch and use the vertical test to determine if the relation is a function.
y (x = 2)
(2, 0) 0 (0, 1)
(y = 1)
y=
4 + 1 is a function. x2
WoRkED ExAMplE 5
eBook plus
Tutorial
For each of the following functions, sketch, on the same set of axes, the graph of the function, its inverse and the line y = x. State the domain and range for the function and its inverse. a y = x2 2x b y = loge (x + 1)
Think a
1 2
int-0541
Worked example 5
WRiTE/DRAW
Write the original function. Change it to turning point form by completing the square. Determine the turning point of the parabola. Find the y-intercept by letting x equal 0 and substituting in the original equation. Find the x-intercepts by letting y equal 0. Solve the equation by factorising the left-hand side. Sketch the graph of the function.
a y = x2 2x
= x2 2x + 12 12 = (x2 2x + 1) 1 = (x 1)2 1 This is a parabola with turning point (1, 1). If x = 0, y = 02 2(0) y=0 The y-intercept is 0. If y = 0, x2 2x = 0 x(x 2) = 0 x = 0 and x = 2 The x-intercepts are 0 and 2.
y
3 4
5 6
0 1
x 1 2 (1, 1) y = x2 2x
8 9
Interchange x and y to find the equation of the inverse. Rearrange to make y the subject.
236
10
Interchange the x- and y-coordinates of the turning point and intercepts in the original equation to find the turning point and intercepts of the inverse. On the original axes, sketch the graph of the inverse and the line y = x.
(1, 1) becomes (1, 1), (2, 0) becomes (0, 2) and the origin remains the same.
y
11
y=x y = x2 2x
x y=1 x+1
12
State the domain and range of the function. State the domain and range of the inverse. Write the function. Find the vertical asymptote using the fact that loge (0) is undefined.
The domain is R and the range is [1, ). The domain of the inverse is [1, ) and the range is R.
b y = loge (x + 1)
13
1 2
Vertical asymptote occurs where x+1=0 x = 1 is the vertical asymptote. x-intercept occurs where y = 0 or x+1=1 x = 0 so the x-intercept is 0.
x = 1
x y = loge (x + 1)
Interchange x and y to find the equation of the inverse. Rearrange to make y the subject.
x = loge (y + 1) ex = y + 1 y = ex 1 x = 1 is the original vertical asymptote, so y = 1 is the horizontal asymptote for the inverse. (0, 0) is on both graphs.
Find the horizontal asymptote and intercepts from the original function.
237
On the original axes, sketch the graph of the inverse and the line y = x.
x=
y = ex 1
y=x
y = loge (x + 1) x y = 1
9
State the domain and range of the function. State the domain and range of the inverse.
The domain is (1, ) and the range is R. The domain of the inverse is R and the range is (1, ).
10
Worked Example 6
If f(x) = ln (x + 1) + 1, use a CAS calculator to: a find f 1(x) b draw the graph of f(x) and its inverse f 1(x).
Think a
1 2 3
WRITE
Let y = f(x). Interchange x and y. To make y the subject, press: Menu b 3:Algebra 3 1:Solve 1 Complete the entry line as: solve(ln(y + 1) + 1 = x,y) (This means to solve the equation with respect to y). Then press ENTER .
a y = ln (x + 1) + 1
x = ln (y + 1) + 1
f 1(x) = ex - 1 - 1
b
To draw the graphs of f(x) and f 1(x), open a Graphs page. Complete the function entry line as: f1(x) = ln(x + 1) + 1 Then press ENTER . Complete the function entry line as: f2(x) = ex - 1 - 1 Then press ENTER .
238
REMEMbER
1. A function is a relation which has only one y-value for each x-value. The graph of a function can be crossed only once by a vertical line. 2. The graph of the inverse is obtained by: (a) interchanging the x- and y-coordinates in the ordered pairs (b) reflecting the graph in the line y = x (c) finding the rule of the inverse and then graphing the inverse. 3. A horizontal asymptote y = a is the vertical asymptote x = a of the inverse, and vice versa. 4. The domain of a function is the same as the range of its inverse. The range of a function is the same as the domain of its inverse. ExERCiSE
5b
b y = 3(x 1)2 + 2 e x2 + y2 = 4 h y= x +2
c y=
4 1 x+3
f y = 3e(x 2) + 1
g y = loge (x + 1) 2
eBook plus
Digital doc
2 Sketch the graph of each of the following functions and state the domain and range of each. (Verify that it is correct using a CAS calculator.) a (4, 2), (2, 0), (0, 1), (2, 4), (3, 6)} c f (x) = 5 2x d f (x) = x2 9 4 f f ( x) = g f (x) = x2 + 8x x i f (x) = 2ex j f (x) = loge (2x) b 3x + 4y = 12 e f (x) = (x + 2)2 x3 h f ( x) = 2 k f ( x) = 4 x 2
ExAM Tip When the inverse function is asked for, the domain must be given. Students will be penalised in the future if the domain is left out. If only the rule for the inverse function is asked for, the domain does not have to be given.
[Assessment report 2007]
SkillSHEET 5.2
Matching graphs with equations
3 WE 5 Find the inverse of each function in question 2. Sketch the graph and state the domain and range of each inverse. (Verify using a CAS calculator.) 4 For each function graphed below: i copy the graph of each function and sketch its inverse on the same axes ii state the domain and range of f (x) iii state the domain and range of the inverse of f (x).
eBook plus
Digital doc
a
f(x)
y y=x 1 0 2 x
b
f(x)
f(x)
Spreadsheet 059
Inverse graphs
4 0 y=x x 0 y=x x
Chapter 5
inverse functions
239
y f(x) 3
y 3 f(x)
0 y=x
3 y=x
3 x
y 3
f(x) y=x
f(x)
i
y=x
y y=x f(x) 5
(4, 1) 3 0 x 4
1 0 x
5x
y=x
k
x = 3 f(x) 6
y=x f(x)
y 4 3
(3, 4)
2 x 3 2 0
0 2
x 2 y=x 0 3
x D R D [0, ) D (, 0] E (, 0] E (, 0] E R+ C y = x2 where x R
C [0, )
6 MC The domain of the inverse of f (x) is: A R B R C R+ 7 MC The range of the inverse of f (x) is: C [0, ) B R A R
WorkSHEET 5.1
8 MC The inverse of f (x) can be defined by: A y = x2, where x [0, ) B y = x2, where x R 2 + D y = x , where x R E y = x , where x [0, ) 9 WE 6 For each of the following functions, fully define the inverse. a f : [2, ) R, f (x) = (x 2)2 3 b f : R R, f (x) = 3e x 1 + 2
5C
inverse functions
A one-to-one function is a function where for each x-value there is only one y-value and vice versa. The graph of a one-to-one function can be crossed only once by any vertical or horizontal line. A function that is not one-to-one is many-to-one.
240
A function will have an inverse that is also a function if and only if it is a one-to-one function. If a function, f , is one-to-one, then its inverse function is denoted by f 1. Furthermore: dom f 1 = ran f 1 ran f = dom f 1 The graph of f is obtained by reflecting the graph of f through the line y = x. (Note that if f crosses the line y = x at any point, f and f 1 will intersect at that point.) The maximal domain of a y function is the largest domain y = f(x) for which its rule is defined. If a function is given without its domain specified, then it is understood that the maximal or implied domain is Horizontal lines x 0 intended. cross the curve
only once.
1 . x+2 State whether or not it is a one-to-one function, and hence determine if the inverse function exists. If the inverse function exists: on the same set of axes, sketch f(x), its inverse and the line y = x use a CAS calculator to find the points of intersection of f(x) and f 1(x) find the maximal domain and range of the original function find the domain and range of the inverse function.
WRiTE/DRAW
int-0542
Worked example 7
Think a
1
Write the function. Find the vertical asymptote by making the denominator of the fraction equal to 0. Find the horizontal asymptote remembering there is no vertical translation. Sketch the graph of f (x) and use vertical and horizontal line tests to decide whether or not f (x) is a one-to-one function.
1 , a basic hyperbola x+2 translated 2 units to the left. f ( x) = Vertical asymptote occurs where x+2=0 x = 2 Horizontal asymptote occurs where y = 0.
x = 2 y
) (0, 1 2
3 4
x 1 f(x) = x + 2
Chapter 5
inverse functions
241
(x) and y = x.
( )
The equation is y = 1 x 2.
x = 2
1) (0, 2 1 y = x+2
( )
2
y=x
0
1 , 0) ( 2
1 x 2 y= x y = 2
and (0.414, 0.414). Note that these points both lie on the line y = x.
d Find the domain and range of f (x). e The domain of the inverse is the range of the original
R \{0}.
function. The range of the inverse is the domain of the original function.
Functions are either one-to-one or many-to-one. If a function, f, is not one-to-one but is many-to-one, it is possible to restrict its domain so that the limited domain is one-to-one and hence the inverse function exists.
WoRkED ExAMplE 8
State the largest negative domain of f(x), shown in the figure, so that f 1(x) exists.
y f(x) (0, 9)
Think
1 2
WRiTE/DRAW
Decide whether f (x) is a one-to-one function. The parabola can be divided through its axis of symmetry, x = 3, so that 2 one-to-one functions are formed.
f (x) is not one-to-one, because horizontal lines cut the parabola in 2 places.
242
3 4 5
State the domain of the left part of the parabola that is one-to-one. State the domain of the right part of the parabola that is one-to-one. State the largest negative domain of f (x) so that f 1(x) exists.
f (x) is one-to-one if the domain is restricted to (, 3]. f (x) is also one-to-one if the domain is restricted to [3, ). The largest negative domain for f 1(x) to exist is (, 3].
REMEMbER
1. 2. 3. 4. 5.
A function f (x) has an inverse function f 1(x) if and only if the function is one-to-one. The domain of a function f (x) is the range of its inverse f 1(x). The range of a function f (x) is the domain of its inverse f 1(x). 1 The graph of f (x) is obtained by reflecting f (x) in the line y = x. The maximal or implied domain is used when the domain of a function is not specified. It is the largest domain for which the rule can be defined. 6. If a one-to-one function intersects with its inverse, the points of intersection lie on the line y = x. 7. If a function is not one-to-one it is possible to restrict the domain so that the new function is one-to-one and hence an inverse function exists.
ExERCiSE
5C
inverse functions
1
WE 7 Consider the following functions. For each function: i state whether or not it is a one-to-one function and hence determine if the inverse function exists. If the inverse function exists: ii on the same set of axes, sketch f (x), its inverse and the line y = x iii use a CAS calculator to find the points of intersection of f (x) and f 1(x) iv find the maximal domain and range of the original function v find the domain and range of the inverse function. a f (x) = 4x + 1 b f (x) = 6x c f (x) = 5 d f (x) = x2 + 2 e f (x) = (x 3)2 f f (x) = (x + 1)3 2 g f ( x) = i f (x) = x2 6x + 3 h f ( x ) = 16 x 2 x 4x 2 k f (x) = 2 loge (x 1) j f (x) = e
ExAM Tip When asked for the domain of an inverse, simply stating that the domain of f 1 is the same as the range of f was not sufficient to gain the mark. Students were expected to explicitly state the domain as a set.
[Assessment report 2006]
2 Find: i which of the functions below has an inverse function f 1(x) 1 ii f (x), if it exists.
b f ( x) = e f ( x) =
1 2 x2 x3 2
Chapter 5
inverse functions
243
Inverse of the function Range R R [0, 3] R+ [10, ) (0, ) [5, 5] R R Domain Range
R [1, ) [3, 3]
4 MC Consider the function in the figure shown at right. a The function would be one-to-one if the domain were restricted to: A [3, 5] B [2, 10] C [1, 3] D [0, 4] E [0, 2.2] b The largest domain that restricts it to a one-to-one function is: B [0, ) A (, 4] C R+ E ( , 2] D R 2 + 1. 5 MC Consider the function f ( x ) = ( x 3)2 a The function would be one-to-one if the domain were restricted to: A (3, ] B [3, ) C (3, ) D (1, ) E [3, ) b The inverse would be a function if the domain of f (x) were: A [0, 4] B (1, 4] C [2, 4] D [0, 3) E [1, ) 6 MC Consider the function f : S R, f (x) = x2 + 1. a The maximal domain, S, for f 1(x) to exist is: + C [1, ) A R B R + E (, 1] D R {0} or R {0} b For f 1 to exist, the largest possible positive set, S, is: C [0, ) D R+ A R B R 7 WE8 exists. a
y 0 x
E [1, )
1
For each function graphed below, state the largest possible domain of f so that f b
f(x) y
(3, 3)
y f(x)
f(x)
1 0
244
y 0 2
f(x) x
f(x)
y 9 f(x) 9x x=5 5 x
1 0 x 9 0
y 0 1 3 7 5 9 x f(x)
h
f(x)
y 0
f(x)
5D
Restricting functions
As we have seen in the previous exercise, functions which are not one-to-one can have their domains restricted so that they become one-to-one. As a result their inverses will then be functions, that is, f 1 will exist.
WoRkED ExAMplE 9
eBook plus
Tutorial
Consider the function fully defined as follows: f : [ 3, 3] R, f ( x ) = 9 x 2 a Find the largest possible positive domain so that f 1 exists. 1 b Use this restricted domain to fully define f (x).
Think a
1
int-0543
Worked example 9
WRiTE
Write the function. Square both sides. Add x2 to both sides. State the shape and key features of the graph. Describe f (x), remembering that a positive square root implies the upper part of a semicircle. Sketch the graph of f (x).
a Let y = f (x)
y = 9 x2
2 3 4
y2 = 9 x2 x2 + y2 = 9 This is the equation of a circle with centre (0, 0) and radius 3. The graph of f ( x ) = 9 x 2 is an upper semicircle.
y 3
5 6
3
7 8
State the possible domains if f (x) is one-to-one. State the largest positive domain for f 1(x) to exist.
f (x) is one-to-one if the domain is [3, 0] or [0, 3]. The largest positive domain for f exist is [0, 3].
1
to
Chapter 5
inverse functions
245
1 2 3 4 5 6
Find the range of f (x). Find the domain of f Find the range of f Write the function. Find the inverse by interchanging x and y. Make y the subject.
1 1
using dom f
1
= ran f.
dom f ran f
using ran f
= dom f.
7 8
Therefore the inverse of f with the largest positive domain is: f 1: [0, 3] R, f 1 ( x ) = 9 x 2
WoRkED ExAMplE 10
If f: S R, f(x) = 3(x 1)2 2: a find the largest positive set, S, for which f 1(x) exists 1 b fully define f and sketch its graph.
Think a
1 2
WRiTE/DRAW
Write the function. State the shape and key features of the graph.
a y = 3(x 1)2 2
A parabola with turning point (1, 2), y-intercept (0, 1) and x-intercepts (0.184, 0) and (1.816, 0)
y
4 5 6
State whether or not it is a one-to-one function. State the possible domains if f (x) is to be one-to-one. State the largest positive domain, set S, for f to exist. Find the range of f (x). Find the domain of f Write the function.
1 1
The parabola is not one-to-one so the domain must be restricted. The domain could be (, 1] or [1, ). S = [1, )
b The range is [2, ).
1 2 3
using dom f
= ran f.
246
x = 3(y 1)2 2 x + 2 = 3(y 1)2 x+2 = ( y 1)2 3 x+2 Reject the negative 3 solution because the domain is [2, ) x+2 y = 1+ 3 y 1=
f 1:[2, ) R, f 1 ( x ) = 1 +
x+2 3
For f : R R, f(x) = x3: a find f 1(x) and state its range b find f [ f 1(x)] and f 1[f(x)] and show that f [ f 1(x)] = f 1[ f(x)] = x.
Think a
1 2 3
int-0544
Worked example 11
WRiTE
Write the function. Interchange x and y. Make y the subject by writing both sides to the power of 1 and simplifying. 3 Write the rule for f 1(x). Find the range of f 1(x), remembering that ran f 1 is the same as dom f. Write your answer in the same form as the question. Find f [ f 1(x)] by rewriting f 1(x) as x 3 . Find f ( x 3 ) by replacing x by x 3 in f(x) = x3. Simplify. Find f Find f
1 1 1 1 1
a f(x) = y = x3
4 5
: R R, f 1 ( x ) = x 3
1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
f [ f 1 ( x )] = f ( x 3 ) 1 = x3 =x
f 1[ f ( x )] = 3
x3.
1
f 1 (x3 )
1
(x3) by replacing x by x3 in f 1 ( x ) = x 3.
1 1
= (x3 ) 3 =x
f [ f 1 ( x )] =
f 1[ f ( x )] = x
Chapter 5
inverse functions
247
WoRkED ExAMplE 12
eBook plus
a Sketch the graph of f(x) = x2 3x + 3, showing the turning point and relevant Tutorial intercept(s). int-0545 b Find the rule of the inverse by an algebraic method and sketch this graph Worked example 12 on the same set of axes together with the line y = x. c Is the inverse a function? d The inverse is a reection in the line y = x of the original function f(x). Use this information to find any points of intersection between the original curve and its inverse. e Find the maximum value of a for f: (, a] R, f(x) = x2 3x + 3 so that f 1(x) exists.
Think a WRiTE/DRAW a y 4 3 2 1 0 b
1
use a CAS calculator to help in drawing a graph of f (x) including the relevant points.
f(x) = x2 3x + 3
(1.5, 0.75)
1 2 3 4
To find the equation of f 1(x), let y = x2 3x + 3. Interchange x and y. To make y the subject, on a Calculator page, press: MeNu b 3:Algebra3 1:Solve1 Complete the entry line as: solve(y2 3y + 3 = x,y) Then press eNTeR .
b x = y2 3y + 3
3 4
Write the answer in the form of f 1(x). use the calculator to draw the graphs of f(x), f 1(x) and y = x.
f 1 ( x) =
4x 3 + 3 2
y 4 3 2 1 0
f(x) = x2 3x + 3 y=x
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
the vertical line test, as it is a one-tomany relation, and therefore it is not a function.
248
The points of intersection between f (x) and f 1(x) will occur at the intersections of the graph of f (x) and y = x. To locate these points on a Calculator page, press: MeNu b 3:Algebra3 1:Solve1 Complete the entry line as: solve(x2 3x + 3 = x, x) Then press eNTeR . The points of intersection are at (1, 1) and (3, 3). Draw the graphs of f(x) and y = x. For the left-hand branch of the parabola, we need f (x) = x2 3x + 3, since the domain is (, a). It is a one-to-one function. Locate the turning point of the graph and the x-coordinate will be the value of a. To locate the minimum of f (x) = x2 3x + 3 on a Calculator page, press: Menub 4:Calculus4 7:FunctionMinimum7 Complete the entry line as: f Min(x2 3x + 3, x) Then press eNTeR . 3 The x-value of the turning point is 2 , which 3 implies that a = 2 .
y 4 3 2 1 0
f(x) = x2 3x + 3 y=x
(1.5, 0.75)
1 2 3 4
f : ( , 2 ) R, f ( x ) = x 2 3 x + 3 a=
3 2
REMEMbER
1. Functions that are not one-to-one can have the domain restricted so that they become one-to-one. Then their inverses will be functions. 2. A fully defined function is written in the form f : [domain] R, f (x) = rule. 3. The graph of f 1(x) is a reflection of f (x) in the line y = x. 4. The points of intersection of f (x) and f 1(x) lie on the line y = x. 5. By taking the inverse function of a function or vice versa, the independent variable (x) is always obtained: f 1[f (x)] = f [f 1(x)] = x. ExERCiSE
5D
eBook plus
Digital doc
Restricting functions
1 WE 9a Find the largest possible domain(s) of the following functions so that the inverse function exists. (use a CAS calculator to sketch the graph if necessary.) a f : R R, f (x) = x2 + 3 b f : R R, f (x) = 3x2 1 1 c f : R R, f (x) = (x + 3)2 2 d f : R \{0} R, f ( x ) = 2 3 x 1 1 f f : R \ {2} R, f ( x ) = e f : R \{4} R, f ( x ) = +1 2 x2 ( x 4)
SkillSHEET 5.3
Function notation
Chapter 5
inverse functions
249
g f : [ 5, 5] R, f ( x ) = i k f : R R, f (x) = e x + 2
25 x 2
f : [4, ) R, f ( x ) = x 4
2 WE 9b For each function in question 1 use the restricted domain to fully define f 1(x). (If there are two possible domains, use the one which is to the right.) 3 MC use the function f : [0, ) R, f (x) = x2 to answer the following questions. a Any points of intersection of f (x) and f 1(x) must lie on the line: A y=0 B y=x C y = 2x D y=x+1 E x=0 b f 1(x) is correctly defined by: A f 1 : [0, ) R, f 1(x) = x B f 1 : [0, ) R, f 1(x) = x D f 1 : [0, ) R, f 1 ( x ) = x C f 1 : [0, ) R, f 1 ( x ) = x 1 E f 1 : (0, ] R, f 1 ( x ) = 2 x c The range of f 1(x) is: , 0] D [0, ) A ( B R C R+ E R 1 d The graphs of f and f intersect at the point(s): A (0, 0) and (1, 1) B (1, 1) only C (0, 0) and (1, 1) 1 D (0, 0) and (3, 3) E (1, 1) and (2, 4 ) 4 Copy each of the following graphs, then on the same set of axes sketch the graphs of y = x and y = f 1(x). b a y y
f(x) 3 5 f(x)
6 y
f(x)
y 3 f(x)
3 y 0 f(x)
e
f(x)
y 1
(2, 5)
250
y 2
4 f(x)
3 f(x)
5 WE 10 If f : S R, f ( x ) = 3 + x 1, find: a the largest set, S, for which f 1(x) exists 1 b f and sketch its graph. 6 If f : [2, a] R, f (x) = (x 4)2 5, find: a the largest possible value of a so that f will have an inverse which is a function b f 1 and sketch its graph. 1 7 WE 11 For f : R+ R, f ( x ) = x a find f 1 and state its range 1 b find f [ f (x)] c find f 1[ f (x)] d show that f [ f 1(x)] = f 1[ f (x)] = x. 1 : 8 For f : R R, f ( x ) = 2 x +2 a sketch the graph of f (x) b state the largest positive domain for f (x) so that f 1(x) exists 1 c sketch the graph f (x) on the same set of axes as f (x), using the positive domain d show that f [ f 1(x)] = f 1[ f (x)] = x. 9 WE 12 If g : [b, 8] R, g(x) = 9 x2, find: a the smallest value of b so that g(x) has an inverse that is a function b g1 c the range of g 1(x). 10 Given that g( x ) = 3 + 4 x 2 , fully define two inverse functions, g 1, using maximal domains.
eBook plus
Digital doc
WorkSHEET 5.2
Chapter 5
inverse functions
251
Summary
Functions and their inverses
A function is a relation which has only one y-value for each x-value. The graph of a function can be crossed only once by a vertical line. A one-to-one function is a function which has only one x-value for each y-value. The graph of a one-to-one function can be crossed only once by any vertical or horizontal line. A function which is not one-to-one is many-to-one. The rule for the inverse of a relation, or a function, can be obtained by either: 1. interchanging the first and second elements of the ordered pairs, or 2. interchanging x and y in the rule and making y the subject. Graphing the inverse The graph of the inverse of a relation, or a function, can y be obtained by either: 1(x) f 1. interchanging the first and second elements of the ordered pairs of the relation or function, or 2 (5, 2) 2. reflecting the graph of the relation or function through the line y = x, or x 0 3. using the rule of the relation or function to find the rule of the inverse and 5 f(x) then graphing the inverse. y=x The domain and range of a function and its inverse are interchanged. (2, 5) The graphs of a function and its inverse intersect on the line y = x.
Inverse functions
The inverse of a one-to-one function, f(x), is also a function and is denoted by f 1(x). dom f 1 = ran f 1 ran f = dom f f 1[f(x)] = f[f 1(x)] = x The implied (or maximal) domain of a function is the largest domain for which the function has meaning. When the domain is not mentioned, use the maximal domain.
Restricting functions
A function, f(x), which is not one-to-one can have its domain restricted so that f 1(x) exists. The points of intersection of f(x) and f 1(x) lie on the line y = x. A function is fully described using the notation f: X Y, f(x) = rule where X is the domain and Y is the co-domain. The graph of f 1(x) is a reflection of f(x) in the line y = x. 1 f [f(x)] = f[f 1(x)] = x
252
ChApTER REViEW
ShoRT AnSWER
8 x f(x) (4, 4)
0 3
y (4, 4)
2 6 2 0 x
2 Sketch the graph of each of the following functions and state its domain and range. a y = 36 x 2 b f (x) = 2e x 2 3 using the graph of the functions given below sketch the graph of the inverse of each function. y a x = 2
1 2 1 0 f(x)
4 State the largest possible domain for each of the following functions to be one-to-one. a f (x) = 3 loge (x + 4) b g(x) = (x 2)2 1 c f ( x) = 5 x2 5 For the following functions: i Sketch their graphs and, by inspection, define them as one-to-one or many-to-one functions. ii For the functions defined in i as many-to-one, define the maximal domain for which the inverse is a function, stating their domains in formal function notation. If there is more than one option, choose the right-hand option. iii Find the rules of their inverses. iv For all of the one-to-one functions from i and the redefined functions from iii, sketch all these inverse functions. a f (x) = 2x 1 b f (x) = 2(x 1)3 + 1 c f (x) = x2 + x d f ( x) = 2 x 3 e f (x) = 3ex + 1 2 1 f f ( x) = 3( x 2) 1 +1 g f ( x) = ( x + 3)2 6 a Sketch the graph of f (x) = loge (x 2) + 1, marking the intercepts and asymptotes and stating the domain and the range. b Find the rule for the inverse function. c If f 1(m) = 3, find the value of m. d Draw the graphs of y = x and f 1(x) on the same axes as f (x) = loge (x 2) + 1, marking the point (m, 3) and checking that it is on f 1(x). State the domain and the range. e Mark the image of (m, 3) on the original graph.
b
f(x)
(1, 4)
Chapter 5
inverse functions
253
7 If g : (, b) R, g(x) = x2 + 5x 1, find the largest value of b for g 1 to exist. 8 Part of the graph of the function f : R R, f (x) = a + be x is shown below.
y y=1 0 1 x
0 1
1 0 x
The line with the equation y = 1 is an asymptote and the graph passes through the origin. a explain why a = 1 and b = 1. Let h be the function h: [0, 2] R, h(x) = f (x). b State the range of h using exact values. c Find the inverse function h 1. d Sketch and label the graph of the inverse function h 1 on the graph axes shown above.
[ VCAA 2007]
y 0 1 x
3 The graph of the function with the equation y = f (x) is shown below.
y 1 0
9 Let f : R R, f (x) = e2x 1. a Find the rule and domain of the inverse function f 1. b Sketch the graph of y = f (f 1(x)) for its maximal domain. ax c Find f (f 1(2x)) in the form where a, b bx +c and c are real constants.
[ VCAA 2008]
is most likely to
y 1 0
MulTiplE ChoiCE
B
x
1 A relation has an x-intercept of 4 and y-intercept of 2. The inverse of this relation has an x-intercept and y-intercept, respectively, of: A B C D E
4,
1 0
2, 4, 2 2, 4 0, 0
D
1 x
1 0
2 The graph that best represents the inverse of the relation shown in the figure below is:
y
x
[ VCAA 2005]
254
4 The relation x2 + (y + 1)2 = 16 has an inverse that is: A a one-to-one function B a many-to-one relation C a many-to-many relation D a one-to-many function E a one-to-one relation 5 The x-intercept of the inverse function f 1(x), where f ( x ) = 3 x 3 , is closest to: A 1.27 B 6 C 3 D 1.27 E 6 6 The y-intercept of the inverse function f 2 + 3, is closest to: where f ( x ) = ( x 2) 4 A 3 B no x-intercept 4 C 3 D 2 E 2
1 (x),
Questions 11 to 13 can be answered by considering the function f (x) = 4 ln (x + 3) 2. 11 The maximal domain for f (x) is: A [3, ) B (, 3) D (3, ) C R \{ 3} E R+ 12 dom f 1 is equal to: A R+ C R E (3, ) 13 The rule for f
1 x
B [0, ) D (, 3)
A f 1 : R R, f 1 ( x ) = e 4 3
1 1 B f : R R, f ( x ) = e x+2 4
3
x+4 2
1 1 C f : ( , 3) R, f ( x ) = e 1 1 D f : R R, f ( x ) = e x+4 3
2 3
f 1 : R + R, f 1 ( x ) =
x4 e 2
7 Asymptotes exist on the graph of the inverse 2 + 3, at: function f 1(x), where f ( x ) = ( x 2) A x = 1 only B y = 1 only C x = 3, y = 2 D x = 2, y = 1 E x = 3, y = 2 4 8 The inverse of the relation y = 2 is: x 2 2 B y= A y= x x 2 2 D y= C y= x x 2 E y= x 9 A function has a domain of [0, ) and a range of R+. The domain of its inverse must be: A R+ B R D [0, ) C R+ E (, 0] 1 10 The implied domain of the function, f ( x ) = 2 x 1 is: A R C R \{0} E R+ B R \{1} D R \{1, 1}
14 At which one of the following points is it possible for a function and its inverse to intersect? A (2, 2) B (1, 2) C (2, 1) D (0, 1) E ( 1, 2) )] is equal to: 15 The value of f [ f 1 ( 1 3 A 3 1 B 3 C x 1 D 3 E 3
16 The function shown in the figure is one-to-one if the domain is restricted to: A B C D E [2, ) [3, ) [3, 2] (, 2] [0, )
y f(x) 3 0 2 x
17 If f : S R, f (x) = x2 10x + 18, then the largest possible set, S, for f 1 to exist is: A B C D E (, 0] [0, ) [0, 5] [5, 100] (, 5]
255
Chapter 5
inverse functions
ExTEnDED RESponSE
1 using a CAS calculator: a Find the rule for the inverse of the function f (x) = 0.213x2 + 1.127x 2.124. b explain why this inverse is not a function. c Find the value of a, correct to 2 decimal points, for [a, ), the maximal domain of f (x) so that the inverse is a function. Let this new function be g(x). d Find the domain and range of f 1(x). 1 e Solve g(x) = g (x) for x, correct to 2 decimal places. 2 The function, f (x), in the figure is a parabola with a turning point at (0, 4). a Find the function which describes f (x). b Find the coordinates of the point, A. c State the domain and range of f (x). d Sketch the graph of f (x) and its inverse on the same set of axes. e What shape is enclosed between f (x) and its inverse? f i State the domain for which the inverse of f (x) is a function. ii Give the rule for the inverse of f (x) over this domain. g i State the domain for which the inverse of f (x) is not a function. ii Give the rule for the inverse of f (x) over this domain. 3 The graph of f (x) = exx2 is shown at right. a use a calculator to find the turning points, rounding answers to 2 decimal places as appropriate. b State the domain and range of f (x). c On the same set of axes, sketch f (x), its inverse and the line y = x. Mark all turning points and asymptotes. d State the domain and range of the inverse of f (x). e use a CAS calculator to solve exx2 = x to find the points of intersection of f (x) and its inverse. f Find the largest possible negative domain of f (x) so that f 1(x) exists (that is, the inverse is a function). g Find the domain of the inverse function.
y 4 y=x
A 2 0 2 2 x
f(x) = exx2 x
4 a use a CAS calculator to draw the graph of f (x) = 6 loge |x 3|. b Find the value of a for (a, ), the maximal domain of f (x), such that f 1(x) exists. Let this new function be g(x). c Solve g(x) = g 1(x) for x, correct to 2 decimal places. d Consider the function f (x) = a loge (x 3), where a > 0. Let f 1(x) = h(x). Given that x a 1 a f ( x ) = and h ( x ) = e , find the value of a (correct to 2 decimal places) for which the graph of a x3 f (x) and its inverse intersect only once.
eBook plus
Digital doc
Test Yourself
Chapter 5
256
eBook plus
ACTiViTiES
Chapter opener
Digital doc
10 Quick Questions: Warm up with ten quick questions on inverse functions. (page 229)
5A Relations and their inverses
Interactivity int-0248:
Inverses: use the interactivity to consolidate your understanding of graphs of the inverses of relations. (page 229)
Tutorial
WE 3 int-0540: Watch a worked example on how to sketch relations and their inverses. (page 231)
Digital docs
5D
Restricting functions
SkillSHeeT 5.1: Practise identifying domain and range. (page 233) Spreadsheet 041: Investigate graphs of functions. (page 233)
5B
Tutorial
Tutorials
WE 5 int-0541: Watch a worked example on sketching functions and their relations. (page 236)
Digital docs
WE 9 int-0543: Watch a worked example on defining inverse functions. (page 245) WE 11 int-0544: Watch a worked example on identifying that the composite functions f [ f 1(x)] = f 1[ f (x)] = x. (page 247) WE 12 int-0545: Watch a worked example on restricting a function to define an inverse function. (page 248)
Digital docs
SkillSHeeT 5.2: Practise making graphs with equations. (page 239) Spreadsheet 059: Investigate inverse graphs. (page 239) WorkSHeeT 5.1: Sketch relations, functions and their inverses. (page 240)
5C
Tutorial
SkillSHeeT 5.3: Practise using function notation. (page 249) WorkSHeeT 5.2: Recognise types of functions and sketch polynomials and power functions. (page 251)
Chapter review
Digital doc
Inverse functions
WE 7 int-0542: Watch a worked example on sketching graphs of inverse functions. (page 241)
Test Yourself: Take the end-of-chapter test to test your progress. (page 256)
To access eBookPLUS activities, log on to www.jacplus.com.au
Chapter 5
inverse functions
257
6
Circular (trigonometric) functions
areaS oF STudy
Revision of radians and the unit circle Symmetry and exact values Trigonometric equations Trigonometric graphs Graphs of the tangent function Finding equations of trigonometric graphs 6G Trigonometric modelling 6H Further graphs 6I Trigonometric functions with an increasing trend
6a 6b 6c 6D 6E 6F
Graphs and identification of key features of graphs of the circular functions: y = sin (x), y = cos (x), y = tan (x) Transformation from y = f (x) to y = Af (n(x + b)) + c, where A, n, b and c R, and f is one of the circular functions specified above and the relation between the graphs of the original and transformed functions for functions such as: y = 10 sin ((x c)) 5, c R Graphs of sum, difference, product and composite functions of f and g, where f and g are functions such as y = sin (x) + 2x and y = |cos (2x)| Graphical and numerical solutions of trigonometric equations
Recognition of the general form of possible models for data presented in graphical or tabular form, using circular functions General solutions of equations such as 1 cos ( x ) + cos cos (3 x ) = 2 , x R and the specification of exact solutions or numerical solutions, as appropriate, within a restricted domain Applications of simple combinations of functions and interpretation of features of the graphs of these functions in modelling practical situations, for example, y = ax + b + m sin (nx) as a possible pattern for economic growth cycles
eBook plus
Digital doc
6a
nit 1u
1
c
10 Quick Questions
y P
Angles are measured in degrees or radians. O S x To define a radian we can use a circle which has a radius of one unit. This circle is called the unit circle. If we take a piece of string which is the same length as the radius and place it along the circumference of the circle from S to P to form an arc, then A unit circle the angle formed by joining S and P to O, the centre of the circle, measures one radian. The radius of the circle can be any length and can still be regarded as a unit. As long as the arc is the same length as the radius, the angle will always measure one radian. In general, therefore, a radian is the angle formed at the centre of any circle by radii meeting an arc which is the same length as the radius of the circle. Note the following.
1u nit
258
y 1. One radian is written as 1c (or 1 radian can be written as 1). A 2. The circumference of a circle is 2 r units in length. P 3. If the radius is one unit, as in the case of the unit circle, then the r r circumference is 2 units, and the angle at the centre of the circle c is 2 radians. 1 r 4. 2 radians = 360 B S x 5. The length of the semicircle from S through A to B is half the circumference and is units. 6. radians = 180 7. An arc length of r units subtends an angle of 1 radian. A radian 8. An arc length of 2 r units subtends an angle of 2 radians. r 2 r 9. An arc length of a quarter of a circle is units that is, and subtends an angle of 2 4 radians. 2
Convert the following to degrees, giving the answer correct to 2 decimal places.
a 2c b 6.3c c 9
10
Think a
1 2 3
Write
180 Multiply the number of radians by . Simplify where possible. Write the answer correct to 2 decimal places.
a 2c = 2
b On a Calculator page, type: 6.3 Note: The radian sign does not need to be entered if the calculator is already in radian mode. To convert 6.3c to degrees, press Catalog k, press D to get to the items beginning with the letter D. Then select DD. Then press ENTER .
259
c c 9 = 9 180
10
10
= 162
c 180
Write
On a Calculator page, type: 2 The calculator is in radian mode so you will need to type the degree symbol before converting to radians. You will find the degree symbol in the Maths expression template by pressing Ctrl / Catalog k.
260
Complete the entry line as: 2 Then press ENTER . Then write the answer.
Note: In this example it is not appropriate to leave your answer in exact form.
c
1
Multiply the number of degrees by . 180 Simplify, leaving your answer in exact form.
180
Divide both sides by 2. Divide both sides by 3. Divide both sides by 4. Divide both sides by 6.
y P (cos ( ), sin ( )) sin () x O cos () R
261
cos (0) = 1 cos = 0 2 cos () = 1 3 cos = 0 2 cos (2) = 1 cos (0) = 1 cos (90) = 0 cos (180) = 1 cos (270) = 0 cos (360) = 1
y T tan ( ) S x
Special cases
Tangent
Using the unit circle, the vertical distance TS is defined as tan . TS is the tangent to the circle which intersects with the x-axis and TOS = . Using Pythagoras theorem in triangle OPR (figure below), PR2 + OR2 = OP2. 2 So, sin () + cos2 () = 1 From the diagram below, OPR is similar to OTS (angle, angle, angle). TS PR Therefore: = OS OR tan ( ) sin ( ) = 1 cos ( ) sin ( ) tan ( ) = cos ( )
y
3 tan is undefined 2
tan (2) = 0
tan (270) is undefined tan (360) = 0 sin (90o ) 1 = , which is undefined. It can be seen that tan (90) is undefined because tan (90o ) = cos (90o ) 0
REMEMBER
1. Radians: (a) 1c = the size of the angle formed where the length of an arc is equal to the radius of the circle. (b) c = 180 (c) Angles are in radians unless a degree symbol is shown.
262
180 . 3. To change degrees to radians, multiply by . 180 4. Identities: (a) sin2 ( ) + cos2 ( ) = 1 (b) tan ( ) = sin ( ) cos ( )
exerCiSe
6a
eBook plus
Digital doc
Spreadsheet 142
Unit circle
a 3c 7 c e 20
eBook plus
Digital doc
SkillSHEET 6.1
Changing degrees to radians
e 63.9 j 350 d cos (1.7) h sin (68) l tan (240) d cos () h sin (360) l tan (240)
g 235 h 260 i 310 f 78.82 3 Evaluate using a calculator. Give answers correct to 3 decimal places.
a sin (0.4) e tan (2.9) i cos (160) 4 a sin (0) 3 e tan 2 i cos (180) 5 a sin2 (20) + cos2 (20) d sin2 (2.5) + cos2 (2.5) g 2 sin2 () + 2 cos2 ()
b sin (0.8) f tan (2.4) j cos (185) b sin () f tan 2 j cos (0)
c cos (1.4) g sin (75) k tan (265) c cos (2) g sin (90) k tan (270)
Evaluate without using your calculator. b cos2 (50) + sin2 (50) e sin 2 + cos 2 2 2 h 5 sin2 () + 5 cos2 () c sin2 () + cos2 () f sin 2 + cos 2 2 2
6 Write the following in order from smallest to largest. a sin (35), sin (70), sin (120), sin (150), sin (240) b cos (0.2), cos (1.5), cos (3.34), cos (5.3), cos (6.3) 7 If sin ( ) = 17 and cos ( ) = 17 , find tan (). 8 If sin (A) = 0.6 and cos (A) = 0.8, find tan (A). Draw a triangle marking in the position of angle A and possible lengths of the sides. 9 mC
eBook plus
Digital doc 8 15
SkillSHEET 6.2
Tangent ratios
D 60
E 90
263
Chapter 6
E tan2 ()
11 The temperature T C inside a shop t hours after 2 am is given by T = 15 3 cos t 12 Calculate the exact temperature after 4 hours and the temperature to the nearest tenth of a degree at 9.00 am.
6B
2
3 2 1 2
30 3
Using the right isosceles triangle shown, the following exact values can be found. sin (45) = sin = 4 cos (45) = cos = 4 tan (45) = tan = 1 4
1 2 1 2
45 1 2
= =
2 2 2 2
Symmetrical properties
In the first quadrant sin, cos and tan are all positive. In the second quadrant only sin is positive.
264
In the third quadrant only tan is positive. In the fourth quadrant only cos is positive. This can be remembered as All Students To Class (ASTC). 1st quadrant sin () cos () tan () 2nd quadrant sin ( ) = sin () cos ( ) = cos () tan ( ) =
tan
()
Worked example 3
eBook plus
5 b cos . 4
WriTe
Tutorial
int-0546
Worked example 3
Find the equivalent first quadrant angle. As 150 is in the 2nd quadrant, sine is positive. Write the exact value. Find the equivalent first quadrant angle using 5 4 = + . 4 4 4 Decide on the sign required. As it is in the 3rd quadrant, cosine is negative. Write the exact value.
= sin (30) =
b cos
1 2
5 = cos + 4 4 = cos 4 =
2 2
Angles are not restricted to values between 0 and 2; that is, the domain is not restricted to [0, 2]. If an angle is greater than 2 radians, it is necessary to subtract multiples of 2 so that the angle is within one turn of the unit circle. Each 2 radians is a complete turn of the circle.
Worked example 4
If sin (x) = 0.6, cos (x) = 0.8, and x is in the first quadrant, find: a sin (3 x) b cos (4 + x).
Think a
1
WriTe
Write 3 as 2+ that is, one complete cycle and then the angle x.
a sin (3 x) = sin (2 + x)
= sin ( x)
= sin (x)
Chapter 6
265
Substitute the given value. 4 = 2 2 that is, two complete cycles and then the angle x.
b cos (4 + x)
= 0.6
y x
2 3
Worked example 5
eBook plus
Tutorial
If sin ( ) = 12 and 13
Think
int-0547
Worked example 5
Method 1
1
2 3 4 5
In the given triangle, find the length of the third 132 = 52 + 122 side by using Pythagoras theorem. Let be the first quadrant angle corresponding to . adjacent 5 cos ( ) = cos ( ) = 13 hypotenuse
13
'
12 5
is in the second quadrant, therefore cos ( ) is negative. opposite tan ( ) = adjacent is in the second quadrant, therefore tan ( ) is negative.
Use the rule sin2 ( ) + cos2 ( ) = 1. Rearrange. Substitute Evaluate. Take the square root of both sides, remembering that the answer could be positive or negative. cos is negative in the 2nd quadrant. Use tan ( ) = tan ( ). sin ( ) to find the value of cos ( )
12 13
5 13 12 5 12 5
Method 2
1 2 3 4 5
for sin ( ).
as
< < 2
266
Method 3
1
On a Calculator page, press: MENU b 3:Algebra 3 1:Solve 1 Complete the entry line as: 12 solve (sin ( ) = , ) | < < 13 2 Then press ENTER .
Complete the entry lines as: 12 cos = sin 1 13 12 tan = sin 1 13 Press ENTER after each entry. Write the answers.
< < , 2
Negative angles
For negative angles, move in a clockwise direction. In the diagram,RQ = PR, and OR = OR, so T1S = TS An alternative way to find tan () is: tan ( ) () sin ( ) = = = tan ( ) cos ( ) cos ( )
sin
y P
O
( )
sin
sin (150) = sin (150) cos (190) = cos (190) tan (280) = tan (280)
267
Worked Example 6
Find the exact value of: a sin (135) b cos (240) c tan (330).
Think a
1 2 3
Write
sin (135) = sin (135) 135 is in the 2nd quadrant. Sine is positive in the 2nd quadrant. Give the exact value. cos (240) = cos (240) 240 is in the 3rd quadrant. Cosine is negative in the 3rd quadrant. Give the exact value. tan (330) = tan (30) Give the exact value.
y 135 135 x
1 2 3
1 2
1 2
y T 330 S x
= =
1 3 3 3
Worked Example 7
Method 1: Technology-free
a
1
sin () = sin () 4 is in the 3rd quadrant. 3 Sine is negative in the 3rd quadrant.
a sin = 3
sin
4 3
= sin + 3
= sin 3 = sin 3
268
Give the exact value. tan () = tan () 5 is in the 2nd quadrant. 6 Tangent is negative in the 2nd quadrant. 5
=
b tan = 6
3 2 tan
1 2
5 6
= tan 6
= tan 6 = tan 6 = =
1 3 3 3
Method 2: Technology-enabled
1
4 sin = 3 5 tan = 6
3 2
3 3
Complementary angles add to 90 or radians. Therefore, 30 and 60 are complementary angles. 2 In other words and are complementary angles, and and are also complementary 2 6 3 angles.
Complementary angles
The sine of an angle is equal to the cosine of its complement. Therefore, sin (60) = cos (30). We say that sine and cosine are complementary functions. The complement of the tangent of an angle is the cotangent or cot that is, tangent and cotangent are complementary functions (as well as reciprocal functions). 1 cot ( ) = tan ( )
269
1st quadrant
2nd quadrant
3rd quadrant
4th quadrant
3 3 cos = sin ( ) cos + = sin ( ) cos = sin ( ) cos + = sin ( ) 2 2 2 2 3 tan = cot ( ) tan + = cot ( ) tan = cot ( ) 2 2 2 3 tan + = cot ( ) 2
Worked example 8
eBook plus
Tutorial
int-0548
Worked example 8
WriTe
Cosine and sine are complementary functions and cosine is negative in the second quadrant. Substitute the given value for sin ( ). Tangent and cotangent are complementary functions and tangent is negative in the 4th quadrant.
a cos
+ = sin ( ) 2
= 0.4 3
+ = b tan 2 =
cot ( 1
tan ( )
1
0.6
rememBer
1. Exact values can be determined by using an equilateral triangle and a right isosceles triangle as shown.
45 2 60 1 1
30 3
45
270
0 0 1 0
30 6
1 2
45 4
2 2 2 2
60 3
3 2 1 2
90 2 1 0 Undef.
180
0
1
270 3 2
1
360 2 0 1 0
3 2 3 3
0 Undef.
2. All angles in the unit circle are positive in the 1st quadrant, sine is positive in the 2nd quadrant, tangent is positive in the 3rd quadrant and cosine is positive in the 4th quadrant. Symmetry properties: sin ( ) = sin ( ) cos ( ) = cos ( ) tan ( ) =
tan
( )
3. Negative angles sin ()=sin ( ), cos () = cos ( ), tan ()=tan ( ) 4. Complementary angles (a) Complementary angles add to 90o or radians. 2 (b) The sine of an angle is equal to the cosine of its complement. (c) The complement of the tangent of an angle is the cotangent. sin 2 = cos ( ) cos 2 = sin ( ) tan 2 = cot ( ) sin + 2 = cos ( ) cos + 2 =sin ( ) tan + 2 =cot ( ) 3 sin 2 = cos ( ) 3 cos 2 =sin ( ) 3 tan 2 = cot ( ) 3 sin + 2 = cos ( ) 3 cos + 2 =sin ( ) 3 tan + 2 =cot ( )
exerCiSe
6B
eBook plus
Digital doc
SkillSHEET 6.3
Rationalising the denominator
j cos (390)
Chapter 6
271
2 We3b
eBook plus
Digital doc
Find the exact values of the following. 5 b cos 6 7 f tan 6 9 j cos 4 2 c tan 3
g sin d cos
4 3
Spreadsheet 142
Unit circle
11 6
5 h cos 3 7 l tan 6
13 k sin 6
3 We4 If sin (x) = 0.3, cos (a) = 0.5, tan (b) = 2.4 and x, a and b are in the first quadrant, find the value of the following. b cos ( a) c tan (2 b) d cos ( x) a sin ( x) e sin ( a) f tan ( + b) g sin (2 x) h cos (2 a) i tan ( b) j cos (2 + x) k sin (2 + a) l tan (2 + b) n cos (3 + a) o tan (3 b) m sin (3 x) 4 If sin ( ) =
7 25
and cos( ) =
24 , 25
5 a We5
< x < , find cos (x) and hence find tan (x). 2 1 3 , find sin (x) and tan (x). b If cos ( x ) = , and < x < 2 2
If sin ( x ) = 1 , and 2
c If sin ( x ) =
3 2
, and
d If tan ( x ) = 3 , and < x < 6 We6 a e i m 7 8 We7 sin (30) sin (120) tan (240) sin (420) b f j n
3 , find sin (x) and cos (x). 2 Find the exact value of the following. cos (45) tan (135) cos (330) cos (390) c g k o tan (60) sin (225) sin (315) tan (405) d cos (150) h cos (210) l tan (300)
Evaluate (sin + cos )2 + (sin cos )2. Find the exact values of: a sin b cos 3 6
c tan 4
g sin
d cos 4
2 e sin 3 4 i tan 3 9
5 f tan 6 5 j cos 3
7 6
5 h cos 4 9 l tan 4
13 k sin 6
Show that cos2 + sin 2 = 1. 4 4 If sin ( ) = 0.3, cos (x) = 0.7 and tan () = 0.4, find the value of the following. 3 + b cos 2 c tan 2
d cos
10 We8
a sin x 2
+ 2
272
3 x e sin f tan + 2 2 3 3 + i tan j cos 2 2 11 mC If x = , 3 sin (2x) is equal to: 12 3 3 3 3 2 c a b 2 2 2 12 mC The expression 1 sin 2 is equal to: 2 a cos 2 D cos2 2 13 b sin 2 E 0
g sin + x 2
3 x k sin 2
3 h cos 2 3 + l tan 2
1 2
c sin 2 2
A weight on a spring moves so that its speed, v cm per second, is given by the formula t v = 10 + 2 sin 6 a Find the initial speed. b Find the speed of the weight after 5 seconds. c What is the greatest speed that the weight can reach?
eBook plus
Digital doc
SkillSHEET 6.4
Problem solving using trigonometry
14 The height, H, in metres, that sea water reaches up a particular tree trunk at a Caribbean resort is governed t by the equation H = 0.4 cos + 0.5, 12 where t is the number of hours past midnight. Find the height of water up the trunk at: a midnight b 8 am c 8 pm.
6C
Trigonometric equations
From the general equation sin (x) = a, we can find an infinite number of solutions. An example of this general equation is: 3 sin ( x ) = . 2 3 One of the solutions is x = , because sin = . 3 2 3 3 However, we also know that sin = because sine 3 2 is positive in the second quadrant.
y
sin ( 3) 3 3 sin ( 3)
2 and . 3 3 (There are no solutions in the third and fourth quadrants because here, sine is negative.)
For this equation there are two solutions between 0 and 2. They are
273
Chapter 6
To find a greater number of solutions we can go around the unit circle as many times as we wish, finding new solutions each time. Since
sin 2 + = 3
in the domain [0, 4] there are 4 solutions:
3 2
and sin 3 = 3
3 2
2 7 8 , , . and 3 3 3 3 We can also go in a negative direction. In the domain [, ] there are only 2 2 solutions: and . 3 3
Worked Example 9
2 2
Method 1: Technology-free
1 2 3
Write the question. Find the equivalent angle in the first quadrant, ignoring the sign. In the 2nd and 3rd quadrants cos (x) is negative. So write the appropriate values of x in these quadrants.
cos ( x ) =
2 2
. 4
3 4
x
5 4
Simplify.
Method 2: Technology-enabled
1
On a Calculator page, press: MENU b 3:Algebra 3 1:Solve 1 Complete the entry line as: , x ) | 0 x 2 2 Then press ENTER . solve(cos( x ) =
x=
3 5 , 4 4
274
Worked Example 10
Find all solutions to the equation sin () = 0.7 in the domain [0, 4]. Give your answers correct to 4 decimal places.
Think Write
Method 1: Technology-free
1 2 3 4
Find the equivalent angle in the 1st quadrant, ignoring the sign. Find in which quadrants sin () is positive. Find the values of in the 1st and 2nd quadrants. Since the domain is [0, 4], we need to go around the circle twice, so add 2 to each of the first two solutions. Simplify giving answers correct to 4 decimal places. On a Calculator page, press: MENU b 3:Algebra 3 1:Solve 1 Complete the entry line as: solve(sin (a) = 0.7,a) | 0 a 4p Then press ENTER .
The basic angle is 0.7754. sin () is positive in the 1st and 2nd quadrants.
= 0.7754, 0.7754 = 0.7754, 2.3662 = 0.7754, 2.3662, 0.7754 + 2, 2.3662 + 2 = 0.7754, 2.3662, 7.0586, 8.6494, correct to 4 decimal places.
Method 2: Technology-enabled
1
If sin (a) = 0.7, 0 a 4p, then a = 0.7754 or 2.3662 or 7.0586 or 8.6494, correct to 4 decimal places.
Worked Example 11
Since the equation contains 2 rather than , multiply both end points of the domain by 2. Simplify the trigonometric equation.
275
3 4
Find the first quadrant (basic) angle, ignoring the negative sign. Sine is negative in the 3rd and 4th quadrants. Find the angles in these quadrants equivalent to the basic angle. As the domain has been extended to 720, we need to go around the circle two times, so add 360 to each of the two initial values. Simplify.
Basic angle = 60 2 = 180 + 60, 360 60 2 = 240, 300 2 = 240, 300, 240 + 360, 300 + 360 2 = 240, 300, 600, 660
Worked Example 12
Calculate the sum of the solutions between 0 and 2 for the equation sin (3x) = cos (3x).
Think
1 2 3 4
Write
Adjust the domain as shown. Divide both sides by cos (3x). Find the basic angle. Solve for x between 0 and 6. Note that tan is positive in the 1st and 3rd quadrants.
5 6
Cancel where possible. Check that all answers are between 0 and 24 8 . They are. 2 (2 = = ) 12 4 Calculate the sum of the solutions.
where x [0, 2] is x =
276
becomes x = 2 n + , where n Z. 4 4 3 3 The general solution for the second quadrant solution x = becomes x = 2 n + , 4 4 where n Z. 3 Note that the general solution x = 2 n + can be expressed as 4 x = 2 n + = (2 n + 1) . 4 4 Substituting different integer values of n will give specific solutions, as shown in the table below. 3 n x = 2 n + , n Z x = 2 n + , n Z 4 4 3 5 7 1 x = 2 + = x = 2 + = 4 4 4 4 3 3 0 x=0+ = x=0+ = 4 4 4 4 9 3 11 1 x = 2 + = x = 2 + = 4 4 4 4 17 3 19 2 and so on x = 4 + = x = 4 + = and so on 4 4 4 4
The general solution for the first quadrant solution x = In general: If sin (x) = a, then x = 2n + sin 1 (a) and x = (2n + 1) sin 1 (a), where a [1, 1] and n Z. If cos (x) = a, then x = 2n cos 1 (a), where a [1, 1] and n Z. 1 If tan (x) = a, then x = n + tan (a), where a R and n Z.
Worked example 13
eBook plus
Tutorial
Find the general solution of the equation 2 cos ( x ) 1 = 0. Hence, find all the solutions for x [2, 2].
Think
1 2
int-0549
Worked example 13
WriTe
3 4
Write the two separate solutions and specify n Z. Note the answer from step 2 could be further simplified by combining the two terms. A CAS calculator will give the answer in this form. Substitute n = 1, n = 0 and n = 1 into each of the general solutions.
( )
1 2
n = 1 : x =
Chapter 6
277
Worked Example 14
Write
On a Calculator page, press: MENU b 3:Algebra 3 1:Solve 1 Complete the entry line as: solve(2 sin (2 x ) = 3 , x ) Then press ENTER .
Solving 2 sin (2x) = 3 gives (6 n 1) (3n + 2) x= and x = , n Z. 6 3 n = 0: x = 2 6 3 5 5 n = 1: x = and x = 6 3 11 8 n = 2: x = and x = 6 3 2 5 5 11 , , , For 0 x 2p, x = 3 3 6 6 and x =
Substitute n = 0 and n = 1 and n = 2 into each of the general solutions, to find the solutions in the domain 0 x 2p.
This answer can be verified using a CAS calculator. Complete the entry line as: solve(2 sin (2 x ) = 3 , x ) | 0 x 2 Then press ENTER .
278
Worked Example 15
Find the general solution of the equation sin (3x) = cos (3x) and hence find all solutions for x in the domain 0 x 2.
Think
1
Write
2 3
Write down the general solution for tan (3x) = a. 3x = np + tan 1 (a) Substitute a = 1 into the general equation and evaluate tan 1 (1), recognising that it is an exact angle. Divide each side by 3 to solve for x. 3x = np + tan 1 (1) 3 x = n + 4 x= (4 n + 1) , n Z 12
-
To find the solutions in the domain 0 x 2p, substitute n = 0, 1, 2 . . . into each of the general solutions.
n= 0: x = n = 1: x = n = 2: x = n = 3: x = n= 4: x = n = 5: x =
12
5 12 9 12 13 12 17 12 21 12
Write down the simplified solutions for 0 x 2p. This answer can be verified using a CAS calculator. Note: 1. The general formula here is found using 3 the basic angle of , which means 4 that values of n start at 1 rather than 0. 2. Remember to scroll to the right to view the full set of solutions over the given domain.
x=
5 3 13 17 7 , , , , , 12 12 4 12 12 4
279
Worked Example 16
Write
On a Calculator page, press: MENU b 3:Algebra 3 1:Solve 1 Complete the entry line as: 1 solve(cos ( x ) + cos (3 x ) = , x ) 2 x 2 2 Then press ENTER . An exact solution is not available.
A numerical solution will be appropriate and can be found by pressing Ctrl / ENTER .
Solving cos( x ) + cos(3 x ) = x [-2p, 2p] gives x= 5.654 87, -2.0944, -0.628 319, 0.628 319, 2.0944, 5.654 87
1 2
for
REMEMBER
1. Given a general equation such as sin (x) = a, there can be an infinite number of solutions. The domain is usually restricted and it is important to find all values for x within this domain. 2. If the domain is given in radians, then the solution(s) to x should be in radians. If the domain is given in degrees, then the solution(s) to x should be in degrees. 3. Adjust the domain to match what has been done to the angle in the question.
280
4. Sine is positive in the 1st and 2nd quadrants, cosine is positive in the 1st and 4th quadrants and tangent is positive in the 1st and 3rd quadrants. 5. If sin (x) = a, then the general solution is x = sin1 (a) + 2n, n Z. 6. If cos (x) = a, then the general solution is x = cos1 (a) + 2n, n Z. 7. If tan (x) = a, then the general solution is x = tan1 (a) + n, n Z. 8. Find all the solutions within the specified domain, by substituting integer values for n into the general solution. 9. If given cos2 (x) = a, then you will need to find values in all 4 quadrants (as x will have both positive and negative values). 10. If the equation is of the form sin (ax) = k cos (ax), divide both sides by cos (ax) to change the equation to tan (ax) = k.
exerCiSe
6C
Trigonometric equations
1 We9 Find all solutions to the equations below in the domain [0, 2].
b sin ( ) = e cos ( ) =
1 2 3 2
a cos ( ) = 0 d sin ( ) = 1
cos ( ) =
1 2
sin ( ) =
3 2
eBook plus
Digital doc
d cos ( ) = 1
Spreadsheet 135
Trig equations
3 We10 For each equation below, find all the values of x between 0 and 4. Give answers correct to 4 decimal places. a cos (x) = 0.6591 b sin (x) = 0.9104 c cos (x) = 0.48 d sin (x) = 0.371 4 Find all the values of x between 0 and 360 for which: a sin (x) = 0.2686 b cos (x) = 0.7421 c sin (x) = 0.5432 d cos (x) = 0.1937 Give answers correct to 2 decimal places. 5 Find the solutions to the following equations in the domain 0 x 2. a 2 sin (x) = 1 c 2 sin ( x ) =
6 We11 Find the solutions to the following equations in the domain 0 x 360. Give exact answers where possible, otherwise give answers correct to 2 decimal places. a cos (2x) = 1 b 2 sin (2x) = 1 c 2 cos (3 x ) = e sin (3x) = g 4 sin
1 2
( x ) = 0.913
0.1254
Chapter 6
281
7 Find all the solutions between 0 and 2 to the following equations. Give exact answers where possible, otherwise give answers correct to 4 decimal places. a 4 sin (x) + 2 = 6 x d sin + 5 = 5.32 3 g 2 cos (2 x ) + 3 = 0 b 3 cos (x) 3 = 0 e 2 sin (3x) 5 = 4 h
1 3 sin 2 x 1 = 0.8039 1
c cos f
x 2
+ 4 = 4.21
2 cos (3 x ) + 2 = 3
8 We12 Calculate the sum of the solutions between 0 and 2for each of the following equations. Give exact answers for questions a to d. Otherwise give answers correct to 4 decimal places. a sin (x) =cos (x) b sin (2x) =cos (2x) c sin (2 x ) = 3 cos (2 x ) f sin (x) +3 cos (x) =0 e sin (3x) +2 cos (3x) =0 d 3 sin (3 x ) = cos(3 x ) 9 A particle moves in a straight line so that its distance, x metres, from a point O is given by the equation x = 3 + 4 sin (2t), where t is the time in seconds after the particle begins to move. a Find the distance from O when the particle begins to move. b Find the time when the particle first reaches O. Give your answer correct to 2 decimal places. 10 We13 Find the general solution of the following equations. Hence, find all solutions for 2 x 2 for each equation. a 2 cos ( x ) 3 = 0 b tan ( x ) =
1 3
eBook plus
Digital doc
WorkSHEET 6.1
2 sin ( x ) 1 = 0
11 We14 Find the general solution of the equation 2 sin (2x) 1 = 0. Hence, find all solutions for x . 12 Find the general solution of the equation 2 cos (3x) 1 = 0. Hence, find all solutions for x . 13 We15 Find the general solutions for each of the following equations. Hence, find all solutions for x [0, 2]. a 3 sin ( x ) = cos ( x ) b sin (2x) =cos (2x) c
3 ,x 2
3 sin (3 x ) = cos (3 x )
[ , ] .
6d
Trigonometric graphs
Graphs of the sine and cosine functions
The graph of the function f (x) = sin (x) is drawn below. It is drawn over the domain [2, 2]. The graph repeats itself every 2 radians. We say that it has a period of 2. Half the distance between the maximum and minimum values is 1 so we say y that the amplitude is 1. 1 It is possible to take any value of x for the function 0.5 f (x) = sin (x), so the domain of the whole function is R. The range is [1, 1]. The graph is shown at right. 0 3 3 2 2 x
2
0.5 1
x 2
282
The graph of the function f(x) = cos (x) is the same shape as the sine graph, but the graph has been translated to a different position. The period is also 2. The amplitude is 1, the domain is R and the range is [1, 1]. The graph is shown at right.
y 1 0.5
3 0 2 2 2 0.5
3 2
2 x
Dilation
If we change the amplitude, the distance between the maximum value and the minimum value also changes. y The graph of f(x) = 2 sin (x) is shown at right. The amplitude is 2 2. The period is still 2. The domain is R and the range is [2,2]. 1 This graph is a dilation of the basic graph of f(x) = sin (x) by a factor of 2 from the x-axis. It has been stretched vertically. 0 3 2 x 2 2 Generally, if f(x) = a sin (x) or f(x) = a cos (x), a is the dilation 1 factor in the direction of the y-axis. The amplitude of the 2 graph is a . f(x) = 2 sin (x), 0 x 2p If we change the coefficient of x, the period of the graph changes. The graph of f(x) = cos (2x) from 0 to 2 is shown at right. The amplitude is 1 and the period is . This can be y found by dividing 2 by the coefficient of x. 1 2 In this case = . The domain is R. The range is [1, 1]. 0.5 2 The x-intercepts can be found by solving the equation 0 3 5 3 7 2 x 4 2 2 4 4 4 cos(2x) = 0. 0.5 3 5 7 2 x = , , , 1 2 2 2 2 f(x) = cos (2x), 0 x 2p 3 5 7 so x = , , , 4 4 4 4 1 This graph is a dilation of the basic graph of f(x) = cos (x) by a factor of 2 from the y-axis. The period has been halved or the graph has been squashed up. The decimal approximation for these solutions can be found using a graphics calculator. The graphics calculator can also be used to check the number and approximate value of the solutions when solving trigonometric equations. 1 Generally, if f(x) = sin (nx) or f(x) = cos (nx), the graph is dilated by a factor of from the n 2 y y-axis. The period of the graph is . n 4 The graph of f(x) = 4 sin (3x) is shown at right. 3 It is drawn from 0 to 2. The amplitude is 4 and the 1 2 4 5 3 3 3 3 2 3 0 period is . The domain is R. The range is [ 4, 4]. 2 x 2 2 1 3 2 The x-intercepts are found by solving 4 sin (3x) = 0. 3 So sin (3x) = 0 4 3x = 0, , 2, 3, 4, 5, 6 f(x) = 4 sin (3x), 0 x 2p 4 5 2 x = 0, , , , , , 2 3 3 3 3 This is an example of a sine graph dilated in both x and y directions. It has a dilation factor of 1 4 from the x-axis, and of 3 from the y-axis.
2
283
Worked Example 17
State the period and the amplitude of the graphs of each of the following functions.
a y = 2 sin Think a
1
( x)
1 4
b y =
1 cos 3
(2 x ) .
Write
Write the equation. Find the period of the graph, using the formula.
a y = 2 sin
( x)
1 4
State the amplitude it is the coefficient in front of the sine function. Write the equation. Find the period of the graph.
Period = So period =
2 , n=2 n 2 = 2
1 3
State the amplitude. Remember that the amplitude is always positive, so we need only the magnitude of the coefficient.
Amplitude =
Worked Example 18
1 Sketch the graph of y = 2 sin (3 ) for one complete cycle stating the amplitude, period and range.
Think
Write/draw
Method 1: Technology-free
1
284
Sketch the basic sine shape (one full cycle) 2 1 with the period of and the amplitude of 2 . 3 1 The scale on the x-axis should be 4 of a period (to reflect the 4 quadrants), 2 2 so it is 4= = . 3 12 6
1 2
y
1 2
0
1 2
2 3
and
Range : [ 2 , 2 ]
the maximum value is 2 , so state the range. Method 2: Technology-enabled On a Graphs page, complete the function entry line as: 1 2 f 1( x ) = sin (3 x) | 0 x 2 3 Then press ENTER .
Reflection
If the coefficient of the function is negative, the graph is turned upside down, that is, reflected in the x-axis. This does not alter the amplitude, which is always positive. y = -f(x) is the image of f(x) when reflected in the x-axis. y y = f(-x) is the image of f(x) when reflected in the y-axis. 4 3 The graph of f(x) = 4 sin (3x) is shown at right. You 2 will notice that it is the graph of f(x) = 4 sin (3x) turned 1 3 upside down. (The graph of f(x) = 4 sin (3x) is shown 2 2 2 5 4 0 on page 283.) 2 x 3 3 3 3
1 2 3 4
2 . The domain is R. The range is [4, 4]. 3 4 5 2 The x-intercepts are 0, , , , , , 2 . 3 3 3 3 1 This graph has a dilation factor of 4 from the x-axis and of 3 from the y-axis. If the function f(x) = 4 sin (3x) is reflected in the x-axis, the result is f(x) = 4 sin (3x). If we reflected the graph of f(x) = 4 sin (3x) in the y-axis, the result would still be f(x) = 4 sin (3x). The amplitude is 4 and the period is
285
If we reflect f(x) = 2 cos (3x) in the x-axis, the result is f(x) = 2 cos (3x), but if we reflect it in the y-axis, the graph does not change. This is because f(x) = 2 cos (3x) is symmetrical about the y-axis. Check this on a CAS calculator.
Translation
If we add a constant to the function, the graph is moved up or down and is said to be translated parallel to the y-axis. The number that is being added becomes the median value of the function. The graph of f(x) = 3 cos (2x) + 1 is shown at right. Compared to f(x) = 3 cos (2x), the graph is shifted 1 unit up. The amplitude is 3, the period is , the domain is R and the range is [2, 4]. The x-intercepts are found by solving 3 cos (2x) + 1 = 0. So cos 2 x =
1 3
y 4 3 2 1 1 0
2
3 2
2 x
= 1.231c .
2x = 1.231, + 1.231, 3 1.231, 3 + 1.231 2x = 1.911, 4.373, 8.194, 10.656 x = 0.955, 2.186, 4.097, 5.328 If we add a constant to x, the graph is translated parallel to the x-axis, that is, left or right. The graph of f ( x ) = sin x is the graph of 4 f(x) = sin (x) translated
y 1 0.5
0 5 2 x 4 4 units to the right. 0.5 4 1 The graph of f ( x ) = sin x + is the graph of 4 f ( x ) = sin x + , x 2 4 f(x) = sin (x) translated units to the left. 4 This graph is a translation of the basic graph of the function The graph of f ( x ) = sin x + is shown at right. 4 f ( x ) = sin( x ) units parallel to It is drawn between [, 2]. 4 The amplitude is 1, the period is 2, the domain is R and the x-axis in a negative direction. the range is [1, 1]. The y-intercept occurs when x = 0. 2 . So y = sin 0 + = 4 2 The x-intercepts occur when sin x + = 0. 4 3 7 So x + = 0, , 2 x = , , 4 4 4 4 3 Note: The graph of sin (x) is the same as the graph of cos ( x ) or cos ( x + ). That is, the 2 2 3 sine graph can be turned into the cosine graph by a translation of units left or units 2 2 right. The cosine graph can be turned into the sine graph by the opposite translations.
If we take a general trigonometric function f(x) = a sin n(x b) + c, it has an amplitude 2 of a , a period of , a horizontal translation of b units and a vertical translation of n cunits.
286
The graph of f ( x ) = 2 cos 3 x 1 is shown at right for 3 0 x 2. 2 The amplitude is 2, the period is , the domain is R and the 3 range is [3, 1].
This graph is a dilation of the basic graph of f(x) = cos (x) by a 1 factor of 2 from the x-axis and a factor of 3 from the y-axis, along with a translation of units to the right and 1 unit down. 3
Worked Example 19
y 1 0 1 2 3
3
2 3
4 3
5 3
2 x
Sketch the graph of y = 5 cos x + + 5 for 0 x 2, and state the period and amplitude. 4
Think
1
Write/draw
Write the equation. Determine the period. (The coefficient of x is 1.) State the amplitude. Using a pencil, sketch a basic cosine shape with the period and amplitude above.
y = 5 cos x + + 5 4
Period = 2 = 2 1
2 3 4
Amplitude = 5
y 5 y = 5 cos (x)
0 5
5
3 2
2 x
Apply the horizontal translation of + means to the left). Again, use pencil.
(the + sign 4
y
4
5 y = 5 cos (x + 4 )
y = 5 cos (x)
4
4
0
4
4 2
3 4
5 3 7 4 2 4 2
5
6
y
+5
10
y = 5 cos (x + 4) + 5
+5
5
+5 +5 4 3 4
y = 5 cos (x + 4)
+5
3 7 2 4
2 x
287
y 10
y = 5 cos (x + 4) + 5
3 4
2 x
rememBer
1. Graphs of the form y = a sin n(x b) + c and y = a cos n(x b) + c are transformations of y = sin (x) and y = cos (x). 2. a is the amplitude and is a dilation from the x-axis. If a is negative, the amplitude is still positive but the graph is reflected in the x-axis. 3. c is the vertical translation (the translation parallel to the y-axis). If c is positive, the graph is translated c units up, and if c is negative, the graph is translated c units down. 4. The range is [c |a|, c + |a|]. 2 . 5. The period is n 6. The factor n is the horizontal dilation where the graph has been dilated by a 1 factor of from the y-axis. n 7. The value b is the horizontal translation (the translation parallel to the x-axis). If b is positive, the graph is translated b units to the right, and if b is negative, the graph is translated b units to the left.
exerCiSe
6d
eBook plus
Digital doc
Trigonometric graphs
1 We17
1 3
State the period and amplitude of the graphs of each of the following. b y = sin (x) e y = 2 cos (3x) h y = 2 cos c y = 4 sin (x) f y = 3 sin (2x) i y=
1 3
SkillSHEET 6.5
Period and amplitude of sine and cosine graphs
( x)
1 2
( x)
1 3
cos (2 x )
j y = 4 sin (3x) 2 We18 Sketch the graphs of each of the following for one complete cycle and state the amplitude, the period and the range. a y = 3 cos( ) d y = 2 cos (3 ) g y = 4 sin
1 2 2
eBook plus
Digital doc
c y = 3 sin (2 ) f y=
1 3
Spreadsheet 124
Sine graphs
( )
( )
sin (2 )
288
eBook plus
Digital doc
3 4 5
Sketch the graph of the function f:R R where f (x) = 4 cos (3 ) for 0 2. State the amplitude, period and range. Sketch the graph of the function f:R R where y = 2 sin (2x) for x . State the amplitude, period and range. From the basic graphs of y = sin (x) and y = cos (x), state the horizontal translation and the vertical translation for each of the following. a y = sin x + + 3 b y = cos x + 1 3 2
Spreadsheet 012
Cosine graphs
c y = 3 cos x 2 4
d y = 2 sin x + 1 3
6 Sketch the graphs of the following for one complete cycle stating the amplitude, the period and the range. a y = sin (x) + 1 b y = cos (x) 1 c y = 2 cos (x) 2 d y = 2 sin (x) + 3 e y = sin (3x) 1 f y = cos (2x) + 1 g y = 3 cos (3x) 2 j y = 2 cos
( x) 1
1 3
h y = 2 sin (2 x ) + 3
y = 3 sin
( x) + 4
1 2
7 We19 Sketch the graphs of the following for 0 2. State the period and amplitude. a y = sin b y = cos + c y = 3 cos 3 4 2
d y = 2 sin 4 g y = cos 3 + 1 6
j y = cos 2 ( ) + 1 8 a
1
e y = 2 sin 2 + 2 h y = 2 sin 2 2 2
f y = 3 cos 3 + 3 i y = 2 sin 1 4
Write down the amplitude, period and range of the following graphs.
y 4 2
3 0 4 2 4 4 2
b
4 2
2
3 4
x 2 4
4 x
y 2 1 0 1 2
2
y 1 0.5
3 2
5 2
3 x
0.5 1
0 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 x
Chapter 6
289
y 4 3 2 1
1 0 2 2
y 3 0
3 2
x 7
y 1 0.5
3 2
2 x
0 0.5 1
3 2
5 2
3 x
State the maximum and minimum values for each of the following. a y = cos (x) b y = sin (x) c y = 3 sin (x) d y = 2 cos (x) e y = 2 cos (3x) f y = 3 sin (2x) g y = 4 sin (2x) + 1 h y = cos (4x) 2 i y = 2 cos (x ) 3 j y = 4 sin 3 (x + ) + 1 k y = 2 sin 3 ( x + 2 ) + 2
1
l y = 3 cos 2 ( x 2 ) 4
10 Sketch the graphs of the following over the domain [0, 2] and state the period, amplitude and range. a y = cos (x) b y = sin (x) c y = 2 sin (x) d y = 3 cos (x) e y = 3 cos (2x) f y = sin (3x) g y = 1 4 sin (x) j y = 2 sin (x 2) h y = 2 cos (2x) 2 i y =
1 2
cos 3 ( x + ) + 1
to the left, what is the new equation? 3 12 If the graph of y = 2 cos (3x) 2 is translated to the right and 3 units up, what is the new 4 equation? 13 If the graph of y = 3 sin (x ) + 1 is translated to the left and 3 units down, what is the new 3 equation?
11 If the graph of y = sin (x) + 1 is translated 14 The level of the water in the Banksia River was measured at hourly intervals from midnight and the results recorded. The graph below shows the results. Find: y a the amplitude 3 b the period 2 c the maximum height of the river d the minimum height of the river 1 e at what times the river has maximum height 0 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 x f at what times the river has a minimum Hours height g the equation of the curve which is of the form y = A sin a(x) + B.
Water level
290
6E
Dilation
Compared to f(x) = tan (x), the graph of f(x) = a tan (x) is dilated by a factor of a from the x-axis. Vertical dilation does not affect the period, domain or range, or the position of the asymptotes or the x-intercepts. In fact, its effect can be seen only when two graphs are sketched on the same set of axes. The diagram at right shows the graphs of f(x) = tan (x) and f(x) = 2 tan (x) over the domain [0, 2]. The graph of f(x) = 2 tan (x) is the dilation of the basic tangent graph by a factor of 2 from the x-axis. It has been stretched vertically. Compared to f(x) = tan (x), the graph of f(x) = tan (nx) is dilated 1 by a factor of from the y-axis. Horizontal dilation y n x= 4 3 affects the period and domain of the graph, as well as the position of the asymptotes and x-intercepts. 2 The period of f(x) = tan (nx) is and the general equation 1 n of the asymptotes is x = (2k + 1) ,where k Z. 0 2n 1 4 2 The domain changes to R \ {x : x = (2k + 1) , k Z} 2 2n accordingly. (The range is not affected by the value of n.) 3 At right is the graph of f(x) = tan (2x). This graph is a dilation of the basic f(x) = tan (x) graph by a factor of 1 2 from the y-axis; its period is . As the period has been 2 halved, the resultant graph is compressed horizontally.
y 3 2 1 0 1 2 3
2
3 2
x= x=3 2 2
3 4
5 4
3 7 2 4
2 x
y 3 2 1 0 1 2 3
2
x=3 x= 2 2
Reflection
If the coefficient a in f(x) = a tan (x) is negative, the graph is reflected in the x-axis. Reflecting the graph does not affect its period, domain or range, or the position of the asymptotes. At right is the graph of f(x) = 2 tan (x). This graph is a reflection in the x-axis of the graph f(x) = 2 tan (x), shown previously.
3 2
291
Translation
y If a constant is added to the function, the graph is translated x=3 x= 2 2 vertically, that is, up or down, parallel to the y-axis. Thus, the 3 graph of f(x) = tan (x) + c represents a translation of the graph 2 f(x) = tan (x) by c units in the y direction. If c > 0, the graph is 1 shifted up, and if c < 0, it is shifted down. Vertical translation does not affect the period, domain or range, or the position of 0 2 x 3 2 2 the asymptotes. The axial intercepts, however, will change. 1 The diagram at right shows the graph of y = tan (x) + 2. It is 2 translated 2 units up, compared to the basic graph of y = tan (x). 3 If a constant is added to x, the graph is translated horizontally, that is, right or left, parallel to the x-axis. Thus, the graph of f(x) = tan (x b), y x= x=5 represents a translation of the graph f(x) = tan (x) 4 4 3 by b units in the x direction. If b > 0, the graph is 2 shifted to the right, and if b < 0, it is shifted to the left. Horizontal translation has no effect on the 1 period or range, but it does affect the domain and 3 5 7 0 3 the position of the asymptotes and the axial 2 x 4 4 2 4 4 2 4 1 intercepts. 2 The diagram at right shows the graph of y = tan ( x + ). 4 translated units to the left, compared to the basic 4 graph of y = tan (x). Having considered each transformation individually, we can now summarise them as follows. Compared to the basic graph of y = tan (x), the graph of y = a tan [n(x b)] + c is: dilated by a factor of a from the x-axis 1 dilated by a factor of from the y-axis (and hence has a period of ) n n reflected in the x-axis if a < 0 translated c units vertically (up if c > 0 and down if c < 0) translated b units horizontally (to the right if b > 0 and to the left if b < 0).
Worked Example 20
x State the period and sketch the graph of y = 2 tan , showing one full cycle. 4
Think
1
Write/draw
x y = 2 tan 4 Period =
; n= n
1 4
1 4
So, period =
4 = 4 1
292
Sketch the tangent shape with a period of 4. The graph is dilated by a factor of 2 parallel to the y-axis, so in comparison to the graph of y = tan (x), each y-coordinate will be doubled. The vertical asymptote goes through half of the period, so it is at x = 2.
y 3 2 1 0 1 2 3
x = 2
Worked example 21
eBook plus
Tutorial
int-0550
Worked example 21
WriTe/draW
Write the equation. Find the period. Using pencil, sketch the basic tangent shape with a period of . 2 (Since 0 x , we need to show two cycles.) Remember that the asymptotes are at the middle of each cycle (that is, halfway through the period).
y = tan 2 x + 1 4
Period =
y 3 2 1 0 1 2 3
4 2
3 4
2 3
; n = 2. so period = n 2
3 x= x= 4 4
Since we need a negative tangent graph, reflect the graph in the x-axis.
y 3 2 1 0 1 2 3
4
3 x= x= 4 4
3 4
Chapter 6
293
y 3 2 1 0 1 2 3
x= x= 4 2
x=3 4
3 4
y 3 2 1 0 1 2 3
4
x = x= 2
3 4
y 3 2 1 0 1 2 3
4
x = x= 2
3 4
REMEMBER
1. The graph of y = tan (x) has a period of and does y x= x= 3 x=3 x= 2 2 not have an amplitude. 2 2 3 2. The equations of the vertical asymptotes of 2 y = tan (x) are given by x = (2k + 1) , where 1 2 k Z, that is, k = 0, 1, 2 . . . 0 3 2 3 2 x 2 2 2 2 3. The domain of the tangent function is 1 R \ {x : x = (2k + 1) , k Z} and its range is R. 2 2
294
4. Compared to the basic graph of y = tan (x), the graph of y = a tan [n(x b)] + c is: dilated by a factor of a from the x-axis 1 dilated by a factor of from the y-axis (and hence has period of ) n n reflected in the x-axis if a < 0 translated c units vertically (up if c > 0 and down if c < 0) translated b units horizontally (to the right if b > 0 and to the left if b < 0). exerCiSe
6e
( )
y=1 tan 3
( x)
1 2
2 For each of the following, state: i the period ii the transformations, compared to the basic graph y = tan (x). a y = 2 tan (3x) d y = tan
1 2
( x) 2
1 g y = 4 tan 3 x + 6 j y = 2 tan x + + 5 3
3
1 i y = tan 4 x 3 12
We21 State the period and sketch the graphs of each of the following for 0 x .
a y = tan (x) +2
b y = tan (2x) 3
1 e y = tan 4 ( x ) h y = 2 tan 2 x + 8
c y = tan x + 4
x 1 f y = 3 tan + 1 2 6 3 tan 4 x + + 1 i y= 4 12
d y = 2 tan x 2 x 1 g y = 2 tan 1 2
j y=
1 3
1 tan 2 x 2 2
6F
eBook plus
Interactivity
int-0251
Finding equations of trigonometric graphs
Chapter 6
295
Worked Example 22
The equation of the following graph is in the form y = a sin (nx). Find the values of a and n. Hence, find the equation of the function.
y 2 1 0 1 2
Think
1 2 3 4
Write
State the amplitude of the graph. The coefficient a represents the amplitude. Since the graph is not reflected in the x-axis, a is positive. State the period of the graph (it is the length of one full curve). Use the formula for the period to find the value ofn.
2 = 4
Substitute the values of a and n into y = a sin (nx) to find the equation of the function.
( x)
1 2
Worked Example 23
The graph shown is a trigonometric function of the form y = a sin (nx) + c. Find the values of a, n and c. Hence, find the equation of the function.
y 2 1
1 0 4 2 3 4
3 4
5 4
7 4
2 x
Think
1
Write
The amplitude (a) is half the distance between the maximum and minimum values. The period is the interval from one point on the graph to the next point where the graph begins to 2 repeat itself. The period is . n The line through the centre of the graph is y = 1, so the graph has been translated down 1 unit.
296
Worked Example 24
This graph is a trigonometric function of the form y = c + a cos (nx). Find the values of a, n and c. Hence, write the equation of the function.
y 3 2 1 0 1 Think
1
6 x
Write
The amplitude (a) is half the distance between the maximum and minimum values. We know that the graph is a cosine graph so it must be inverted; that is, a is negative. The period is the amount of time taken to complete the pattern once.
2 3
4 5
c represents the vertical translation. This graph has been translated up one unit. The equation of this trigonometric function is in the form y = c + a cos (nx).
2 =n 6 so n = 3 c=1
3 y = 1 2 cos x 3
c = 1, a = 2, n =
y = c + a cos ( nx )
REMEMBER
1. Trigonometric functions can be expressed in the form of y = a sin [n(x b)] + c ory=a cos [n(x b)] + c. 2. The amplitude a can be found by halving the distance between the maximum and minimum values. 3. The period is the interval from one point on the graph to the next point where the 2 graph begins to repeat itself. The period is . n 4. The vertical shift is c. 5. The horizontal shift is b. Exercise
6F
297
eBook plus
Digital doc
Spreadsheet 124
Sine graphs
y 3 2 1 1 2 3 0
4 2
y 2 1
eBook plus
Digital doc
3 4
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 x 1 2
Spreadsheet 012
Cosine graphs
2 The equations of the following graphs are of the form y = a cos (nx). Find the values of a and n. Hence, find the equation of each function. b a y y
2 1 0 1 2
8 4
2 1
3 8
2
We23 The equations of the following graphs are of the form y = a sin (nx) + c. Find the values of a, n, and c and hence write the equation of the function. b a y y
1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8x 1 2 2 x 3 4 5
3 2
4 The equations of the following graphs are of the form y = a cos [n(x )]. Find the values of a, n and . Hence, write the equation of the function. b a y y
4 2 0 2 4
4 2
3 4
x
5
3 4
5 The equations of the following graphs are of the form y = a sin [n(x + )] + c. Find the values of a, n, and c. Hence, write the equation of the function. b a y y
1 0 1 2 3
6 3 2
2 5 3 6
7 4 3 5 11 6 3 2 3 6
2 x
5 4 3 2 1
0 1
3 2
298
We24 The equations of the following graphs are of the form y = c + a cos (nx). Find the values of a, n and c. Hence, write the equation of the function.
y 4 3 2 1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 x 1
y 4 3 2 1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12x 1
mC If the amplitude is 2, the period is 6 and there is a vertical translation of 2, then the
c y = 2 2 sin x 3
Digital doc , the equation for the trigonometric function of the WorkSHEET 6.2 4 form y = a cos [n(x + )] + b is: a y = 3 2 cos x + + 1 b y = 3 cos 2 x + 1 c y = 2 cos 3 x + + 1 4 4 4
translation is D y = 2 cos 3 x + + 1 4 E y = 3 cos 2 x + 1 4
eBook plus
eLesson
eBook plus
6G
Trigonometric modelling
In real life there are many examples of periodic behaviour. Sine and cosine functions such as y = a sin [n(x b)] + c and y = a cos [n(x b)] + c are often used to model this behaviour.
eles-0092
Trigonometric modelling
Worked example 25
While out in his trawler John North, a fisherman, notes that the height of the tide in the harbour can be found by using the equation: h = 5 + 2 cos t , 6 where h metres is the height of the tide and t is the number of hours after midnight. a What is the height of the high tide and when does it occur in the first 24 hours? b What is the difference in height between high and low tides? c Sketch the graph of h for 0 t 24. d John North knows that his trawler needs a depth of at least 6 metres to enter the harbour. Between what hours is he able to bring his boat back into the harbour?
Chapter 6
299
Think
Write
Method 1: Technology-free
a
1 2
Write the given equation. For high tide, find the maximum value of h.
a h = 5 + 2 cos
t 6
cos t = 1, so 6 t = 0, 2 , 4 , . . . 6 t = 0, 12, 24, . . . A high tide of height 7 m occurs at midnight, noon the next day, and midnight the next night.
b For minimum h,
cos t = 1 6 So h = 5 + 2 1 = 3 Alternatively, min. value = median amplitude so h = 5 2 = 3. The difference between high and low tides is 7 3 = 4 metres.
c h 6 4 2 0 2 4 6 8 1012 14 16 18 202224 t d
1
Use the information from the previous page to sketch the graph.
d When h = 6,
5 + 2 cos t = 6 6 2 cos t = 1 6 1 cos t = 2 6 5 7 11 t= , , , .... 6 3 3 3 3 t = 2, 10, 14, 22, . . . From the graph we can see that John North can bring his boat back into harbour before 2 am, between 10 am and 2 pm and between 10 pm and 2 am the next morning.
300
Method 2: Technology-enabled
1
On a Graphs page, complete the function entry lines as: f 1( x ) = 5 + 2 cos x 6 f 2( x ) = 6 Press ENTER after each entry. Select an appropriate window.
To find the points of intersection, press: MENUb 7:Points&Lines7 3:IntersectionPoint(s)3 Use the NavPad to move the cursor to the first point of intersection and press Click x twice and the points of intersection will appear.
1. Read the question carefully to find out what is being asked. 2. Answer the questions in words where appropriate. 3. Ensure that graphs are sketched over the given domain. exerCiSe
6G
eBook plus
Digital doc
Trigonometric modelling
1
We25 Competition is severe, so Fred Greenseas decides that he will catch more fish in an inlet several kilometres east of the place where John North fishes. There is a sandbar at the entrance to the inlet and the depth of water in metres on the sandbar is modelled by the t function d (t ) = 6 + 2.5 sin where t is the number of hours after 12 noon. 6 a What is the greatest depth of the water on the sandbar and when does it first occur? b How many hours pass before there is once again the maximum depth of water on the sandbar? c What is the least amount of water on the sandbar? d Sketch the graph of d for 0 t 24. e Fred Greenseas needs a depth of 7.25 metres to cross the sandbar. Between what hours is he able to enter and leave the inlet?
Spreadsheet 041
Function grapher
Chapter 6
301
2 A student wanting to catch fish to sell at a local market on Sunday has discovered that more fish are in the water at the end of the pier when the depth of water is greater than 8.5 metres. The depth of the water (in metres) is given by d = 7 + 3 sin t , where t hours is the 6 number of hours after midnight on Friday. a b c d e What is the maximum and minimum depth of the water at the end of the pier? Sketch a graph of d against t from midnight on Friday until midday on Sunday. When does the water first reach maximum depth? Between what hours should the student be on the pier in order to catch the most fish? If the student can fish for only two hours at a time, when should she fish in order to sell the freshest fish at the market from 10.00 am on Sunday morning?
3 The mean daily maximum temperature in Tarabon, an experimental town in a glass dome, is modelled by the function T (m) = 18 + 7 cos m , where T is in degrees Celsius and m is the 6 number of months after 1 January 2007. a What was the mean daily maximum temperature in March 2007, and in August 2007? b What is the highest mean daily maximum temperature in Tarabon? In which months does it occur? c What would the mean daily maximum temperature be in February 2008? d If the pattern continued, how many months would pass before the mean daily maximum temperature would be the same again as it was in February 2008? 4 The height above the ground of the middle of a skipping rope as it is being turned in a childs game is found by using the equation h = a sin (nt) + c, where t is the number of seconds after the rope has begun to turn. During the game, the maximum height the rope reaches is 1.8metres and it takes 2 seconds for the rope to complete a full turn. a Find the values of a, n and c and hence write the equation of h in terms of t. b Sketch the graph of h against t for 0 t 5. c After how much time from the beginning of the turn will the rope be 25 cm above the ground? Give your answer correct to the nearest tenth of a second. 5 The graph at right shows the path of a small lizard as it runs over a hill. a Calculate the height of the hill, in metres, and hence find the amplitude of the trigonometric function. b If the ground was flat, how far would the lizard run to reach the same spot on the other side of the hill? Hence, find the period of the function. 6 When Sloane and Michael were riding on a Ferris wheel, they realised that as the wheel turned clockwise, the height of their seat in metres after t minutes could be modelled by the function h(t) = a b cos (nt). The graph of h against t is shown for the whole ride. a State the values of a, b and n. b Write down the rule for h(t). c How many times do Sloane and Michael reach the highest point during their ride and how far above the ground is it? d How high are they when the ride begins to move? e How many minutes pass before they are at this point again?
h 30 25 20 15 10 5 0 3 6 h = 34
y = 1 cos ( x) 4
h=2 9 12 15 t
302
f How far above the ground are they after 1 minute? g If the ride began when the boys were at the height found in part f , what would the function become? h Draw a graph of the new function for the first 6 minutes of the ride. 7 On a summer day the hourly temperature, which can be approximated to a cosine curve, was recorded. The maximum temperature was 30C and occurred at 3.00 pm. The minimum temperature was 10C and occurred at 3.00 am. The temperature was first recorded at 12midnight, then every hour for 24 hours. a What is the amplitude of the function? b What is the period of the function? c What is the middle value of the function? d How far has this middle value been translated upwards from the x-axis? e When do the maximum and minimum temperatures occur? f Using the above, write an equation that will model this function. g Check the accuracy of your work by using your equation to find the temperature after 3, 9, 15 and 21 hours. h What is the temperature at midnight? Give your answer correct to the nearest degree. Check that your answer makes sense.
6H
Further graphs
Earlier in the book we discussed in detail how to graph the sum and difference offunctions. In this section we will further apply these techniques to trigonometric functions.
Worked Example 26
Using addition of ordinates, sketch the graph of y = sin (x) + cos (x) for the domain [0, 2].
Think Draw
Method 1: Technology-free
1
Sketch the graphs of y = sin (x) and y = cos (x) on the same set of axes over the required domain. (Note that both y = sin (x) and y = cos (x) are defined over [0, 2], so the sum function is defined over the same domain.)
y 2 1 0 1 2
4 2
3 4
5 4
3 2
7 4
2 x
303
Moving from left to right, add the y-coordinates of the two graphs and plot the resultant points. The 3 5 3 7 , , , keypoints are at x = 0, , , 4 2 4 4 2 4 and 2.
y 2 1 0 1 2
4 2
3 4
5 4
3 2
7 4
2 x
y 2 1 0 1 2
4 2
3 4
5 4
3 2
7 4
Erase y = sin (x) and (y) = cos (x) to see the final graph.
y 2 1 0 1 2
4 2
3 4
5 4
3 2
7 4
2 x
Method 2: Technology-enabled On a Graphs page, complete the function entry lines as: f1(x) = sin (x) f2(x) = cos (x) f3(x) = f1(x) + f2(x) Press ENTER after each entry. Select an appropriate window.
Note that a difference function can be treated as a sum function where the second additive is negative. For instance, the function y = sin (x) cos (x) can be viewed as y = sin (x) + (cos (x)). So to obtain the graph of y = sin (x) cos (x), we can sketch the graphs of y = sin (x) and y = cos (x) on the same set of axes and add their respective y-coordinates.
304
Worked Example 27
Sketch the graph of y = |3 cos (2x)| over the domain [0, 2].
Think Draw
Method 1: Technology-free
1
First sketch the graph of y = 3 cos (2x). The amplitude of this graph is 3 and its period is 2 = . Since the domain is [0, 2], we need 2 to sketch two full cycles.
y 3 2 1 0 1 2 3
4
2
3 4
5 4
3 2
7 4
2 x
Reflect all sections of the graph that are below the x-axis in the x-axis.
y 3 2 1 0 1 2 3
4
2
3 4
5 4
3 2
7 4
2 x
Erase the sections below the x-axis to see the final graph.
y 3 2 1 0 1 2 3
4
2
3 4
5 4
3 2
7 4
2 x
Method 2: Technology-enabled On a Graphs page, complete the function entry line as: f1(x) = |3 cos (2x)| Then press ENTER . Select an appropriate window.
305
Find the domain and sketch the graph of the product function y = x sin (x). Use a CAS calculator for assistance.
Think
1
write/Draw
The required function can be viewed as a product of two functions: f(x) = x and g(x) = sin (x). The domain of the product function is equal to the intersection of the domains of the two individual functions. On a Graphs page, complete the function entry line as: f1(x) = x sin (x) Then press ENTER . Select an appropriate window.
Let f(x) = x, dom f(x) = R Let g(x) = sin (x), dom g(x) = R dom (f(x) g(x)) = dom f(x) dom g(x) =R So the domain of y = x sin (x) is R.
To locate the maximums and minimums, press: MENU b 5:Trace 5 1:Graph Trace 1 Trace along the graph to find a local maximum. Press ENTER to lock in the point. This method can also be used to locate minimums and intercepts.
306
Of course the graphs of product functions are not limited to those involving trigonometric functions.
Worked Example 29
2 3 4
Find the domain of f(x) and the domain of g(x). Find the domain of f(x)g(x). Find the x-intercepts of both f and g and hence find the x-intercepts of the product fg.
Dom f = R and dom g = [1, ) Dom fg = [1, ) x-intercept for f(x) is when x = 0 and f(x) = 0 x-intercept for g(x) is when x = 1 and g(x) = 0 Hence, the x-intercepts for the product are when x = 0 and x = 1. f(x) is negative and g(x) is positive for x (1, 0), so fg is negative for x (1, 0). f(x) and g(x) are both positive for x (0, ), so fg is positive for x (0, ). The turning point is (
2 3
5 6
Find the values of x for which the product is negative. Find the values of x for which the product is positive. Find the turning point using a graphics calculator. Round the answer to 2 decimal places as appropriate. Sketch the graph of the product.
, 0.77).
y = 2x x + 1
(1, 0)
3 ( , 3
(0, 0)
0.77)
The composite function reads g of f and can be written g f. Another composite function is f (g(x)) = g(x) + 5 = 2x + 5. In this case, g(x) replaces x in f (x). This composite function reads f of g and can be written f g. For the composite function f (g(x)) to be defined, the range of g must be a subset of the domain of f. Furthermore, if f (g(x)) is defined, the domain of f (g(x)) equals the domain of g(x). Composite functions can be rather complex to graph by hand, so a CAS calculator can be used for assistance when sketching.
Worked example 30
eBook plus
Tutorial
For the pair of functions f(x) =cos (x) and g( x ) = x : a show that f(g(x)) is defined b find f(g(x)) and state its domain c sketch the graph of f(g(x)), using a CAS calculator for assistance.
Think a WriTe/draW
int-0551
Worked example 30
For f(g(x)) to exist, the range of g must be a subset of the domain of f. So find both the range of g and the domain of f to show that this condition is observed.
1 2
Form the composite function f (g(x)) by substituting g(x) into f (x). The domain of f (g(x)) must be the same as the domain of g(x). Since the domain of g(x) is R+{0},so is the domain of f (g(x)).
b f ( g( x )) = cos ( x )
On a Graphs page, complete the function entry line as: f 1( x ) = cos( x ) Then press ENTER . Select an appropriate window.
The graphs of composite functions are not limited to those involving trigonometric functions. This is demonstrated in the following example.
Worked example 31
For f(x) =x2 2 and g(x) =x4: a show that both f(g(x)) and g(f(x)) are defined b find both f(g(x)) and g(f(x)), stating the domain and range of each one c on separate axes, sketch the graphs of f(g(x)) and g(f(x)).
308
Think a
Dom g = R; ran g = [0, ]. Range of f domain of g, so g(f(x)) exists. Range of g domain of f, so f(g(x)) exists.
1 2 3 4 5
Write f(x). Form the composite function f(g(x)) by substituting g(x) into f(x). Simplify. State the domain and range of f(g(x)). Form the composite function g(f(x)) by substituting f(x) into g(x). State the domain and range of g(f(x)). Sketch f(g(x)), rounding x-intercepts to 2decimal places.
b f(x) = x2 2
f(g(x)) = (x4)2 2 = x8 2 Domain = R, range = [2, ). g(f(x)) = (x2 2)4 Domain = R, range = [0, ) are 1.09 and 1.09.
y y = x8 2 (1.09, 0) 0 (1.09, 0) x (0, 2)
Sketch g(f(x)).
(2, 0) x
REMEMBER
1. For the sum/difference function, dom (f(x) g(x)) = dom f(x) dom g(x). The graph of the sum/difference function can be obtained by using the addition of ordinates method. 2. The graph of the modulus function, y = | f(x)|, can be obtained by sketching the graph of y = f(x) and then reflecting all of the sections of the graph that are below the x-axis in the x-axis. 3. For the product function, dom (f(x) g(x)) = dom f(x) dom g(x). Some features of the graph of the product function are as follows: (i) the x-intercepts of f(x) g(x) occur where either f(x) or g(x) have their x-intercepts
309
(ii) f (x) g(x) is above the x-axis where f (x) and g(x) are either both positive or both negative (iii) f (x) g(x) is below the x-axis where one of the functions f (x) or g(x) is positive and the other is negative. 4. For the composite function f (g(x)) to be defined, the range of g must be a subset of the domain of f. Furthermore, if f (g(x)) is defined, the domain of f (g(x)) equals the domain of g(x). exerCiSe
6h
eBook plus
Digital doc
Further graphs
1
We26 Using addition of ordinates, sketch the following graphs for the domain [0, 2]. a y = sin (x) + cos (2x) b y = cos (x) + sin (2x) c y = 2 sin (x) + cos (x) d y = 2 cos (x) + sin (x) e y = 2 sin (x) + cos (2x) f y = 2 cos (x) + sin (2x) g y = 2 sin (2x) + cos (x) h y = 2 cos (2x) + sin (x)
SkillSHEET 6.6
Addition of ordinates
2 Apply the addition of ordinates method to sketch each of the following graphs over the domain [0, 2]. Use a CAS calculator to check your answers. a y = sin (x) +x b y = cos (x) x c y = 3 sin (x) 2x d y = cos (2 x ) + 4 x 2 g y = 4 sin (x) 5 loge (x +1) 3
1
We27 Sketch each of the following graphs over the domain [0, 2].
4 Sketch each of the following graphs over the domain [0, 2]. Remember to observe the appropriate order of transformations. x a y =3|sin (x)| b y = |2cos (2x)|+ 1 c y = 2 cos + 3 2 5
We28 Find the domain and sketch the graph of each of the following product functions. Use a CAS calculator for assistance.
2 x
We29 For each of the following functions f (x) and g(x), sketch the graph of f (x)g(x).
x+2
i show that f (g(x)) is defined ii find f (g(x)) and state its domain iii sketch the graph of f (g(x)), using a CAS calculator for assistance.
310
a f(x) = cos (x) and g(x) = loge (x) x2 c f ( x ) = 2 sin ( x ) and g( x ) = 4 e f(x) = x2 and g(x) = sin (x) g f ( x ) = cos
x 4
b f ( x ) = sin (2 x ) and g( x ) = x d f ( x ) = x + 2 and g( x ) = 2 cos ( x ) f f(x) = 2x and g(x) = cos (2x) h f ( x ) = 2 sin ( x ) + 1 and g( x ) = x 3
and g( x ) = 2 x 2
8 WE31 For each of the following pairs of functions f(x) and g(x): i state whether f(g(x)) and g(f(x)) are defined ii for the composite functions that are defined, find f(g(x)) and g(f(x)), stating the domain and range of each one iii on separate axes, sketch the graphs of f(g(x)) and g(f(x)) that are defined. a f(x) = x 2, g(x) = ex d f ( x ) = x , g( x ) = sin ( x ) b f(x) = | x| g(x) = x2 1 e f(x) = ex, g(x) = cos (x) c f(x) = 1 x2, g(x) = ex f f(x) = loge x, g(x) = sin (x)
6I
Worked Example 32
Consider a remote island where global warming has caused the temperature to increase by 0.1degree each month. The mean daily temperature is modelled by the function T ( m) = 16 + 0.1 m + 6 cos m , where T is the temperature in degrees Celsius and m is the number 6 of months after January 2008. a Sketch a graph of the function for a five year period from January 2008, using a CAS calculator for assistance. b Find the mean daily temperature for March 2009 c When will the mean daily temperature first reach 23 degrees?
Think a On a Graphs page, complete the function entry Write
line as: f 1( x ) = 16 + 0.1x + 6 cos x 6 Then press ENTER . Select an appropriate window: XMin: 0 XMax: 60 YMin: 10 YMax: 30
311
March 2009 occurs when m = 14. On a Calculator page, complete the entry line as: f1(14) Then press ENTER .
The mean daily temperature in March 2009 would be 20.4 degrees Celsius.
c
1
To solve 23 = 16 + 0.1m + 6 cos m , 6 for m, return to the Graphs page. Complete the function entry line as: f2(x) = 23 Then press ENTER .
Press: MENU b 7:Points & Lines 7 3:Intersection Point(s) 3 Select each function and then press ENTER . The points of intersection will appear.
m = 11.5631 Hence, the first time the temperature reaches 23 degrees Celsius will be during the 12th month after January 2008. That is, during January 2009.
REMEMBER
Trigonometric functions with an increasing trend can be modelled by a function of the form y = ax + b + m sin (nx) where ax + b represents the increasing trend line and m sin (nx) represents the seasonal variation.
312
Exercise
6I
313
Summary
Revision of radians and the unit circle
1c = the size of the angle formed where the length of an arc is equal to the radius of the circle. c = 180 Angles are in radians unless a degree symbol is shown. 180 To change radians to degrees, multiply by . To change degrees to radians, multiply by . 180 Identities 1. sin2 () + cos2 () = 1 sin ( ) 2. tan ( ) = cos ( )
Exact values can be determined by using the equilateral triangle and the right isosceles triangle shown at right.
3 30
2 60 1
45
45 1
3 2
0 (0) 0 1 0
30 6
1 2 3 2 3 3
45 4
2 2 2 2
60 3
3 2 1 2
90 2 1 0 Undef.
180 () 0
1
270
1
360 (2) 0 1 0
0 Undef.
The unit circle is symmetrical so that the magnitude of sine, cosine and tangent are the same in each quadrant but the sign varies. All functions (sine, cosine and tangent) are positive in the 1st quadrant, sine is positive in the 2nd quadrant, tangent is positive in the 3rd quadrant and cosine is positive in the 4th quadrant. sin ( ) = sin () cos ( ) = cos () tan ( ) =
tan
()
Negative angles sin () = sin (), cos () = cos (), tan () = tan () Complementary angles add to 90o or radians. 2 The sine of an angle is equal to the cosine of its complement. The complement of the tangent of an angle is the cotangent.
( cos ( tan (
sin
3 2 3 2 3 2
= cos ( )
) ) = sin ( ) ) = cot ( )
sin
( tan (
cos
3 2
+ = cos ( ) + = sin ( )
3 2
3 2
+ = cot ( )
314
Trigonometric equations
Given a general equation such as sin x = a, there can be an infinite number of solutions. The domain is usually restricted and it is important to find all values for x within this domain. If the domain is given in radians, then the solution(s) to x should be in radians. If the domain is given in degrees, then the solution(s) to x should be in degrees. Adjust the domain to match what has been done to the angle in the question. Sine is positive in the 1st and 2nd quadrants, cosine is positive in the 1st and 4th quadrants and tangent is positive in the 1st and 3rd quadrants. If sin (x) = a then the general solution is x = sin 1(a) + 2np, n Z. If cos (x) = a then the general solution is x = cos 1(a) + 2np, n Z. -1 If tan (x) = a then the general solution is x = tan (a) + np, n Z. Find all the solutions within the specified domain by substituting integer values for n into the general solution. If the equation is of the form sin (ax) = k cos (ax), divide both sides by cos (ax) to change the equation to tan (ax) = k.
Trigonometric graphs
Sine and cosine graphs Graphs of the form y = a sin [n(x b)] + c and y = a cos [n(x b)] + c are transformations of y = sin (x) and y = cos (x). The amplitude a is a dilation from the x-axis. If a is negative, the amplitude is still positive but the graph is a reflection in the x-axis. The vertical translation c is a translation parallel to the y-axis. If c is positive, the graph is translated c units up, and if c is negative, the graph is translated c units down. c represents the median value of the function. The range is [c | a |, c + | a |]. 2 The period is . n 1 The factor n is the horizontal dilation where the graph has been dilated by a factor of from the y-axis. n The value b is the horizontal translation or a translation parallel to the x-axis. If b is positive, the graph is translated b units to the right and if b is negative, the graph is translated b units to the left. Tangent graphs y x= x= 3 x=3 x= 2 2 2 2 The graph of y = tan (x) has the following properties. 3 It has no amplitude. 2 The period is . 1 There are x-intercepts at x = . . ., 2, , 0, , 2, . . . 3 3 , , , ,... There are vertical asymptotes at x = . . ., 0 3 2 3 2 x 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 2 1 The range is R. 2 The graph of y = tan (nx) has the following properties. It has no amplitude. 3 The period is . n k There are x-intercepts at x = where k = 0, 1, 2, . . . n (2k + 1) There are vertical asymptotes at x = where k = 0, 1, 2, . . . 2n The range is R. Compared to the basic graph of y = tan (x), the graph of y = a tan [n(x b)] + c is: dilated by the factor of a from the x-axis 1 dilated by the factor of from the y-axis (and hence has period of ) n n
315
reflected in the x-axis if a < 0 translated b units horizontally (to the right if b > 0 and to the left if b < 0) translated c units vertically (up if c > 0 and down if c < 0).
Further graphs
For the graph of the sum/difference function, dom(f(x) g(x)) = dom f(x) dom g(x). The graph of the sum/ difference function can be obtained by using the addition of ordinates method. The graph of the modulus function y = | f(x)| can be obtained by sketching the graph of y = f(x) and then reflecting all of the sections of the graph that are below the x-axis in the x-axis. For the product function, dom(f(x)g(x)) = dom f(x) dom g(x). Some features of the graph of the product function are as follows: the x-intercepts of f(x)g(x) occur where either f(x) or g(x) have their x-intercepts f(x)g(x) is above the x-axis where f(x) and g(x) are either both positive or both negative f(x)g(x) is below the x-axis where one of the functions f(x) or g(x) is positive and the other is negative. For the composite function f(g(x)) to be defined, the range of g must be a subset of the domain of f. Furthermore, if f(g(x)) is defined, the domain of f(g(x)) equals the domain of g(x).
Trigonometric functions with an increasing trend
These situations can be modelled by a function of the form y = ax + b + msin (nx), where ax + b represents the increasing trend line and msin (nx) is the seasonal variation.
316
chapter review
Short answer
1 Convert the following into radians. a 60 b 30 d 90 e 360 g 150 h 300 j 120 k 210 2 Find the value of: 2 a cos 3 5 d sin 4 g cos (135) j tan (225) b sin 4 e tan (2) h tan (30)
c f i l
9 The depth, d metres, of water in a shallow bay at t thours after 9 am is given by d = 5 + 3 sin , 6 for 0 t 24 hours. a Sketch the graph of d for 0 t 24 hours. b At what times will the depth of water in the bay be 6.5 metres? c Particular water sports cannot run in the bay when the depth of water is less than 6.5 metres. At what times of the day (not night) will the water sports be able to run?
3 If sin (x) = 0.85 and x is in the first quadrant, find: b sin ( + x) a sin ( x) c sin (2 + x) d sin (4 x) 4 Find the general solution to the equation 2 cos ( x ) 2 = 0. 5 Find the general solution for 3 sin (2 x ) = cos(2 x ) and hence all solutions for x between 0 and 2. 6 Consider the graph of y = 3 sin x + 2. 4 a State the translations required to form this graph from y = sin (x). b State the amplitude and period of the transformed trigonometric function. c Sketch the graph of the transformed function over the domain 0 x 2. 7 State the period and sketch the graph of y = tan (2x) + 2. 8 The equation of the following graph is of the form y = a sin (nx) + b. Find the values of a, n and b, and hence find the equation of the function.
y 3 2 1
10 Sketch the graph of y = |2 sin (2x)| over the domain [0, 2]. 11 On the same set of axes and over the domain [0, 2], sketch the graphs of: a y = 2x b y = sin (x) c y = sin (x) + 2x. 12 On the same set of axes and over the domain [0, 2], sketch the graphs of: a y = x b y = sin (x) c y = x sin (x). 13 For the pair of functions f(x) = sin (x) and g(x) = x2 + 2: a show that f(g(x)) is defined b find f(g(x)) c state the domain and range of f(g(x)). 14 For the function f : [ , ] R, f ( x ) = 5 cos (2( x + )): 3 a Write down the amplitude and period of the function.
1 2 3 4
317
b Sketch the graph of the function f. Label intercepts with their coordinates. Label end points of the graph with their coordinates.
amplitude found in part a to help sketch the graph. The graph should be a smooth symmetrical curve with all intercepts (x and y) clearly labelled with coordinates.
[Assessment report 1 2006]
Exam tip Make sure that you use the period and
[ VCAA 2006]
Multiple choice
1 What is 320 expressed in radians? A 2 B 5 C 8 D 4 9 18 9 9 c 13 2 What is expressed in degrees? 6 A 390 B 420 C 150 D 120 5 3 The expression sin equals: 3 A
1 2
B [0, ], [2, 6] C R, R A [0, ], R D [ , 2 ] [ 4, 4] E [0, ], [2, 4] 3 9 Using addition of ordinates for the graph of the difference function y = 2 cos (x) 3 sin (x), the value of y at x = is: 3 1 1+ 3 3 2+3 3 A B C 3 2 2 D 1 3 3 2 E 23 3 2
E 16 9 E 330
E 6
1 2
3 2
3 2
E 1
11 The graph of the function f : [1.5, 1.5] R, f(x) = a + b cos ( nx) is shown below. The values of a, b, and n are respectively:
y 3 2 1 1.5 1.0 0.5 0 1 2 0.5 1.0 1.5 min = 1.5 x max = 3.5
4 A trigonometric function is given by f : R R, f(x) = 3 cos (2x + ) 1 The amplitude, period, and range of f are respectively: C 3, , [4, 2] B 2, , R A 3, , [ 4, 2] 2 E 3, D 2, , [ 1, 3] 2 5 When f(x) = 0 the following function f : [0, 2] R, f(x) = 2 sin 2 ( x + ) + 1 has: A 0 solutions B 1 solution C 2 solutions D 3 solutions E 4 solutions
1
A 1, D 1,
5 2 5 3
,3 ,3
B 1, 3 , 2 E
1, 5 3
C 1, 5, 3
,2
6 The function f : [, ] R, f (x) = sin (2x) + cos (2x) has the following x-intercepts: 5 3 7 3 3 , , , A , B , C 4 4 4 4 2 4 8 8 5 3 7 , , , , D E 8 8 8 8 4 4 7 The solution of the equation 4 sin ( x ) = 2 3 3 between and is: 2 A B C 4 6 3 3 7 2 D E 3 3
12 If 0 c , the x-intercepts of the function f : [0, 2] R, f (x) = b sin (x c) are: B , 2 C c, c A c, 2 c D + c, 2 c E c, + c 13 The position of a particle from a fixed point O is given by the equation x = 2 2 sin ( t). If 0 t 2, the particle is at the point O when t equals: E 6 A 0 B 2 C 0.5 E 6 14 The smallest positive value of x for which tan (2x) = 1 is: A 0 B C D 8 4 2
E p
[ VCAA 2006]
318
Extended response
1 At the South Pole in midsummer on the planet Marus, the red sun of its solar system does not set. It dips towards the horizon until its lower rim just touches it, then rises until its lowest point is at an angle of D(t) to the horizontal before sinking again. It continues in this pattern. The angle above the horizontal can be modelled by the following relation: D(t) = a b sin n(t + c) where t is the time in hours after midnight and a, b, c and n are positive constants. The graph of D(t) for 24 hours is shown on the axes in the figure below.
D(t) 10 8 6 4 2 0 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 t
a State the values of a, b, c and n and hence write the rule for D(t). b What would be the angle above the horizon at 6.00 am and at 9.00 pm? Give an exact answer where possible, otherwise give your answer correct to 2 decimal places. c Use your graph to find at what times the angle to the horizontal is 8. When does the rim of the sun reach this angle again? d By using an appropriate equation, check your answer and account for any difference in your two solutions. e If a spot on the surface of the sun is 5 above the horizon at midnight, what would be the relation G(t) that models its path? 2 Nathan and Rachel are competing in the National Ballroom Dancing Championships. The judges are evenly spaced around the circular dance floor, standing just outside the edge. As Nathan and Rachel waltz around the circular floor, their distance (in metres) from judge Maya can be described by the function d = 10.5 9 cos t , where t is time (in seconds) from the beginning of the dance. 30 a How far is the couple from judge Maya when they start dancing? b What is the couples maximum distance from the judge? c Assuming that, while dancing, Rachel and Nathan trace a perfect circle, what is its diameter? d How long does it take for the couple to complete one full circle around the dance floor? e What is the couples average speed (in m/s)? Give your answer i in exact form and ii correct to 2 decimal places. f If the duration of the waltz is 2.5 minutes, draw the graph of d = 10.5 9 cos t over the domain, 30 showing the full length of this dance. g Judge Joseph is positioned further down the dance floor, so that Nathan and Rachel are closest to him 6seconds after the waltz begins. Write the equation describing the couples distance from judge Joseph at any time, t, from the beginning of the dance. h How far is the couple from judge Joseph when they finish the waltz? 3 Tasmania Jones is attempting to recover the lost Zambeji diamond. The diamond is buried at a point 4 km into Death Gorge, which is infested with savage insects. In order to recover the diamond, Tasmania will need to run into the gorge, dig up the diamond and return the same way that he came. The concentration of insects in the gorge is a continuous function of time. The concentration, C, of insects per square metre is given by (t 8) + 2)2 1000, 8 t 16 1000 (cos C (t ) = 2 m 0 t < 8 or 16 < t 24 where t is the number of hours after midnight and m is a real constant.
319
a What is the value of m? b Sketch the graph of C for 0 t 24. c What is the minimum concentration of insects and at what value(s) of t does that occur? The insects infecting the gorge are known to be deadly if their concentration is more than 1250 insects per square metre. d At what time after midnight does the concentration of insects first stop being deadly? e During a 24-hour period, what is the total length of time for which the concentration of insects is less than 1250 insects per square metre?
exam Tip
eBook plus
Digital doc
Test Yourself
Chapter 6
Be aware of the word continuous when working out what value(s) to substitute to find m. When drawing the graph, clearly show minimum turning points and be aware of the domain stated in the question.
[Assessment report 2 2007]
[ Vcaa 2007]
320
eBook plus
aCTiviTieS
chapter opener
Digital doc
10 Quick Questions: Warm up with ten quick questions on circular functions. (page 258)
6a Revision of radians and the unit circle
Digital docs
Spreadsheet 142: Investigate the unit circle. (page 263) SkillSHEET 6.1: Practise changing degrees to radians. (page 263) SkillSHEET 6.2 : Practise working with tangent ratios. (page 263)
6b Symmetry and exact values 6F Finding equations of trigonometric graphs
Tutorials Interactivity int-0251
We 3 int-0546: Watch a worked example on exact values using degrees and radians. (page 265) We 5 int-0547: Watch a worked example on determining trigonometric ratios. (page 266) We 8 int-0548: Watch a worked example on complementary angle formulas. (page 270)
Digital docs
Finding equations of trigonometric graphs: Use the interactivity to consolidate your understanding of trigonometric graphs. (page 295)
Digital docs
SkillSHEET 6.3: Practise rationalising the denominator. (page 271) Spreadsheet 142: Investigate the unit circle. (page 272) SkillSHEET 6.4: Practise problem solving using trigonometry. (page 273)
6c
Tutorial
Spreadsheet 124: Investigate sine graphs. (page 298) Spreadsheet 012: Investigate cosine graphs. (page 298) WorkSHEET 6.2: Sketch trigonometric graphs over given domains, including composite and absolute value graphs, and determine the equations of trigonometric graphs. (page 299)
6G Trigonometric modelling
eLesson eles-0092
Trigonometric equations
We 13 int-0549: Watch a worked example on determining the general solution to a trigonometric equation. (page 277)
Digital docs
Trigonometric modelling: Learn how trigonometry can be used to model sinusoidal patterns. (page 299)
Digital doc
Spreadsheet 135: Practise solving trigonometric equations. (page 281) WorkSHEET 6.1: Use exact values, solve trigonometric equations and application questions. (page 282)
6D Trigonometric graphs
Digital docs
Further graphs
We 30 int-0551: Watch how to sketch a composite function using a CAS calculator. (page 308)
Digital doc
SkillSHEET 6.6: Practise using addition of ordinates to sketch graphs. (page 310)
chapter review
Digital doc
SkillSHEET 6.5: Practise identifying the period and amplitude of sine and cosine graphs. (page 288) Spreadsheet 124: Investigate sine graphs. (page 288) Spreadsheet 012: Investigate cosine graphs. (page 289)
6E
Tutorial
Test Yourself: Take the end-of-chapter test to test your progress. (page 320)
To access eBookPLUS activities, log on to www.jacplus.com.au
We 21 int-0550: Watch a worked example on calculating the period of trigonometric functions. (page 293)
Chapter 6
321
EXAM PRACTICE 2
Short answer
30 minutes
Chapters 1 TO 6
Multiple choice
12 minutes
1 Solve the equation log2 (2x - 3) - log2 (3) = 1 for x. 1 mark 2 Solve the equation 32x + 3 33 = 9 for x. [-2,0]
1 mark
Each question is worth 1 mark. 1 If y = 2abx - 1 + 5, then x is equal to: y5 y log a ( 5) + 1 a 2 +1 2 B A b b y5 +1 y5 2 +b C D 2b b y5 log a ( ) +1 2 E b
x = 4 over 2 The solution set of the equation e2x - 3e R is: A {1, 4} B {4} C {loge (4)} D {loge (-1), loge (4)} E {loge (1), loge (4)}
3 The graph of the function f : R where x is reflected in the y-axis, translated 2 units f(x) = e to the left then translated 3 units up. (Note the change to the domain.) a Specify the rule of the transformed graph. b Determine its exact range. 2 marks 4 The diagram below shows the graph of y = sin (x) and a second graph formed by transforming sin (x) by carrying out dilation(s) followed by translation(s).
y 1 x
0 /6
y = sin (x)
a Write down the transformations (type, direction and quantity) necessary to create the second graph. b Write down the equation of the second graph.
4 marks
3 The graph of the function f :[2, 5] R, f(x) = loge (x) is reflected in the y-axis, translated 2 units to the left then translated 3 units up. The domain of the new graph is: A [7, 1] B [4, 1] 7, 4] C [ D [loge (-7), loge (- 4)] E not defined 4 The function f : [1, ) R, where f(x) = x2 + 1 has as its inverse function: A f-1: R R, where f 1( x ) = x 1 B f-1: [2, ] R, where f 1( x ) = x 1 1 C f-1: [-1, ] R, where f 1 ( x ) = 2 x +1 D f1: R+ {0} R, where f 1( x ) = x 1 1 1 E f 1: [ , ) R, where f 1( x ) = 2 2 x +1 5 The equation a sin (3) - b = 0 has = 2 as one solution. Which of the following could also be a solution? A 3 + 6 B + 2 2 C -2 D +2 3 2 E +6 3
5 Find the exact solutions of the equation sin (3x) - cos (3x) = 0 for 0 x 6 Specify the range of the function f :[
2 marks
) R, f ( x ) = 2 tan(2 x ) + 1. 4 8 4
,
x e2x - e
2 marks 2 marks
= 2 exactly for x.
8 For f : [ 3] R, where f(x) = x sin (x): a sketch f b determine the minimum value of f(x) c estimate the maximum value of f(x) to 1 decimal place.
4 marks
322
7 The graph of y = 3 cos (2x) 1 is shown below. If a and b are two adjacent x-intercepts, b a is equal to:
y
0 a
b x
T +a a 2a cos 2 2 c a (cos + 1) T
2a
2 cos +a T 2 ( )) + a T 2
D 2a sin (
T E a (sin ( ) + 1) 2 2
exTended reSponSe
2 c 3a E 2a
a
b D 2 a
20 minutes
An extensive study has been made of the population of silver-banded lorikeets in an area proposed for a wind farm. The variation in estimated numbers over a number of months is recorded in the graph below. It is suggested that the relationship could be modelled by a sine function of the form P(t) = a sin (b(t + c)) + d, where P is the bird population and t is the time in months since estimates commenced.
Bird population y 500 400 300 200 100 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 Months 7 8 9 x
a b c d e f g
What is the amplitude of the sine model (to the nearest 10 birds)? 1 mark What is the period (to the nearest month)? 1 mark What is the mean population (to the nearest 10 birds)? 1 mark After how many months is the population a minimum? 1 mark Determine the values of a, b, c and d in the model P(t) = a sin b(t + c) + d. 4 marks What was the initial bird population when the observations commenced? 1 mark A second researcher conducts observations over a 10-year period at the same time each year and records the following estimates for the population. Time (months) 0 60 120 Population 500 370 274
She believes that the population can be modelled by an exponential function of the form Q(t) = Aekt, where t is the time in months since the first estimate was calculated. Determine the values of A and k. 2 marks h Explain how both researchers results are consistent with the model eBook plus P( x )Q( x ) Population = . 3 marks Digital doc 500 Solutions
Exam practice 2
exam practice 2
323
7
Differentiation
AREAS OF STUDY
7a Review gradient and rates of change 7b Limits and differentiation from rst principles 7c The derivative of xn 7d The chain rule 7e The derivative of e x 7F The derivative of loge (x) 7G The derivatives of sin (x), cos (x) and tan (x) 7H The product rule 7I The quotient rule 7J Mixed problems on differentiation
Graphical treatment of limits, continuity and differentiation of functions of a single real variable Deducing the graph of a derivative function from the graph of a function Derivatives of xn, n Q, ex, ln (x), sin (x), cos (x), tan (x) Properties of derivatives (af (x) bg(x)) = af (x) bg(x), a, b R
f ( x) , and g( x ) f (g(x)) where f and g are polynomial functions, exponential, circular, logarithmic or power functions (or combinations of these functions) such as x 5 + 1 x 2 , x sin (2 x ), e cos ( x ) 2 and ln ( x + 4) x
7A
Digital doc
10 Quick Questions
Gradient is a measure of how one quantity changes with respect to another quantity; in other words, the rate of change of one quantity with respect to another quantity. The gradient (or slope) is the measure of how the vertical distance (the rise) changes with respect to the horizontal distance (the run). Speed is the measure of how distance travelled changes with respect to the time taken; another way of saying this is that speed is the rate of change of distance with respect to time.
Constant rates
When the rate of change of one quantity with respect to another quantity does not change, the rate is constant. If the rate of pay for babysitting is fixed at $15 an hour, this is a constant rate. This means that a babysitter would be paid $15 for 1 hour and $150 for 10 hours. A constant rate can be represented graphically by a straight line.
y (1, 15)
(0, 0) x
324
Average rates
An average rate of change is the rate of change over a period of time. A car travelling at 60 km/h is probably not actually registering that speed at every moment of the distance travelled; more likely, its speed varies above and below 60 km/h. The average rate of change between two points can be represented by the gradient of a straight line joining the two points.
(0, 0)
(1, 0) x
_, 33 _) (1 2 4
Instantaneous rates
If the police want to find how fast a car is travelling, they measure the speed at a particular instant. This is known as instantaneous (1, 0) (1, 0) rate of change. Graphically, thisis found by drawing a tangent x 0 to the curve at a particular point and finding the gradient of the (3, 0) tangent. If a section of the graph is increasing, the gradient of the tangent is positive, and if a section of the graph is decreasing, the (0.15, 3.08) gradient of the tangent is negative. For example, for the curve y = (x 1)(x + 1)(x + 3), the gradient is positive when x<2 and when x > 0.15; the gradient is negative when 2 < x < 0.15; and the gradient is zero when x = 2 and x = 0.15.
(2, 3)
The gradient of a function exists wherever the function is smooth and continuous. That is, the gradient of a function exists at a point providing only one tangent can be drawn at that point. An example is shown at right. A function is not differentiable where there is a gap, hole or asymptote, a sharp corner or an end point.
2
y f (x) The gradient of f (x) exists for x R as f (x) is smooth and continuous. x
2 0
Chapter 7 Differentiation
325
For the straight line function shown, sketch the graph of its gradient function.
1
f (x)
2 THINK
1 2
WRITE/DRAW
rise . run
m=
1 2
y
1 2
to represent the
f'(x) x
WORKED EXAMPLE 2
Sketch the graph of the gradient function for the quadratic function shown and state its domain.
y f (x)
0 THINK
1 2 3
WRITE/DRAW
Find when f (x) = 0. Find when f (x) > 0. Find when f (x) < 0.
f (x) = 0 when x = 1. f (x) > 0 when x > 1. f (x) < 0 when x < 1.
326
Sketch f (x).
f'(x)
Find where f (x) is smooth and continuous and hence find the domain of f (x).
The domain is R.
For the cubic function shown, sketch the gradient function and state its domain.
y f (x)
Tutorial
int-0552
Worked example 3
3 THINK
1 2 3 4
0 1
WRITE/DRAW
Find when f (x) = 0. Find when f (x) > 0. Find when f (x) < 0. Sketch the graph of the gradient function.
f (x) = 0 when x = 3 and x = 1. f (x) > 0 when x < 3 and x > 1. f (x) < 0 when 3 < x < 1.
y f'(x)
The domain is R.
WORKED EXAMPLE 4
For the function f (x) shown, state the domain of the gradient function f (x).
1 0 2
x f (x)
Chapter 7
Differentiation
327
THINK
WRITE
The function is smooth and continuous everywhere except at x = 1 (discontinuous) and x = 2 (not smooth).
REMEMBER
1. 2. 3. 4. 5.
6. 7. 8. 9. 10.
A function is smooth if there are no sharp points on its graph. A function is continuous if the graph can be drawn without lifting pen from paper. The gradient of a function exists where the function is smooth and continuous. The graph of the gradient function is a graph of the gradients of all the points of the original function. The gradient function of a polynomial function is also a polynomial function but the degree is reduced by 1. For example, the gradient function of f (x) = ax2 + bx + c is of the form y = mx + c. Wherever the gradient of a function is zero, its gradient function will have an x-intercept. Wherever the gradient of a function is positive (sloping /), the gradient function graph is above the x-axis. Wherever the gradient of a function is negative (sloping \), the gradient function graph is below the x-axis. The gradient of a horizontal line is 0. The gradient of a vertical line is undefined.
EXERCISE
7A
eBook plus
Digital doc
SkillSHEET 7.1
Gradient positive, negative and zero
eBook plus
Digital doc
y 0 2
f (x) x
y f (x) 3 0 x
SkillSHEET 7.2
Gradient function
328
f (x) 2
0 1
b The graph of the gradient function in the graph above is represented by which of the diagrams below? b c a y y y
2 f' (x) f' (x) 1 0 1 x 0 2 x 0 2 f' (x)
y
1 2
e
f' (x) x
y 0 f' (x) 2 x
3 WE 2 a
Sketch the graph of the gradient function for each quadratic function shown below. b c y y y
g (x) g (x) 0 x 0 0 x g (x) 2 g (x) x
e
2
y 0 1 x
g (x) y
4 MC a The gradient of the function shown in the graph at right is: a always increasing b always decreasing c decreasing then increasing d increasing then decreasing e constant
x f (x)
Chapter 7
Differentiation
329
b The gradient function for the graph in question 4a is shown by which of the graphs shown below? a
y
f' (x)
f' (x)
x f' (x)
y x
f' (x)
0 f' (x)
5 WE3 a
For each cubic function f(x) graphed below, sketch the gradient function. y b y c y
f (x)
x f (x)
x f (x)
y Gradient = 0 0 f (x) x
e
f (x)
y Gradient = 0 0 x
x f (x)
y Gradient = 0 2 0
f (x)
6 MC a The figure at right has a positive gradient where: A 1 < x < 2 B x < 1 only C x > 2 only D x < 1 and x > 2 E x > 0 b The figure above has a negative gradient where: A x > 1 B x < 2 C 1 < x < 2 D x < 1 and x > 2 E x < 0
330 Maths Quest 12 Mathematical Methods CAS for the TI-Nspire
y f (x) 0 x
c The graph of the gradient function for the figure on the previous page is: b c a y y y
f ' (x) f ' (x) 1 0 2 x 1 0 2x 1 0 x
f ' (x)
y f ' (x) 1 0 2 x
f ' (x)
1 0
7 For the functions graphed below, state the domain (where applicable) where the gradient: i is equal to zero ii is positive iii is negative iv does not exist. a
y 1 0 x
b
f (x)
y 6
y 5
x f (x)
1 0
g (x)
g (x)
g (x) y 0 x Gradient = 0
0 4
2 0
x f (x)
f(x)
f(x)
1 0 2
Gradient = 0 x
g(x) 1 0 x 0 x
y 4 2 2 0 4 x f(x)
Chapter 7 Differentiation
9 WE 4 For each function f (x) graphed below, state the domain of the gradient function f (x). (Do not sketch the graph of f (x).) b c a y y y
f(x) f(x) 2 0 3 2 8 x 0 4 y 2 x 0 f(x) x
y f(x)
f(x)
1 f(x)
y f(x)
i
f(x)
y f(x)
y f(x) 5 0 4 x
7B
eBook plus
eLesson
eles-0093
Limits and differentiation from rst principles
y 4
f(x) Continuous
1 0 1 x
lim (3 x + 1) = 3(1) + 1 = 4
332
If the function is discontinuous at the point in question, then the limit exists if the function is approaching the same value from the left as it is from the right. For example: For example:
y Discontinuous 3 f(x) Discontinuous at x = 2 y f(x) 5 3 0 x
2 0 2 x
The limit exists at x = 2, as the function is approaching 3 from the left and from the right. Therefore: lim f ( x ) = 3
x2
The limit does not exist at x = 2, as the function is approaching 3 from the left and 5 from the right. That is, if the left-hand limit is not equal to the right-hand limit, then the limit does not exist.
eBook plus
WORKED EXAMPLE 5
b lim
x2 + 5 x + 6 x 0 x+3
WRITE a
Tutorial
int-0053
Worked example 5
THINK a
1 2
Decide whether f (x) is continuous at x = 5. If so, substitute x = 5 into f (x). Evaluate. Decide whether f (x) is continuous at x = 0. If so, substitute x = 0 into f (x). Evaluate.
x5
lim ( x 2 3 x ) = 52 3(5) = 10
1 2
x0
lim
x2
If direct substitution makes the denominator zero, the limit of a rational expression can be evaluated by first simplifying the expressions and then using direct substitution.
WORKED EXAMPLE 6
Evaluate
THINK
1
x 3
lim
x2 + 5 x + 6 . x+3
WRITE
x
If the limit cant be found because the denominator becomes zero, factorise the numerator. Simplify by cancelling. Substitute x = 3. Evaluate.
lim
2 3 4
= lim ( x + 2), x 3 x 3
= 3 + 2 = 1
Chapter 7
Differentiation
333
rise run f ( x + h) f ( x ) = h As Q moves along the curve towards P, the value of h gets smaller and smaller. Or as Q gets as close as possible to P, h 0, and PQ becomes a tangent at P. The gradient of the curve at a point P is the gradient of the tangent at that point. f ( x + h) f ( x ) That is, gradient at point P is f ( x ) = lim , h 0. h0 h Finding the gradient this way is known as differentiation from first principles. Differentiating f (x) gives f (x) or f (x) is the derivative of f (x). dy dy Differentiating y gives , or is the derivative of y with respect to x. dx dx The gradient of PQ =
WORKED EXAMPLE 7
Find the gradient of the chord PQ drawn to the curve f (x) = x2 + 2 in the diagram.
y Q [1 + h, f(1 + h)]
334
WORKED EXAMPLE 8
Find the gradient of f (x) = x2 1 at the point where x = 2 by: a sketching a graph and nding the gradient of the tangent at x = 2 b differentiating using rst principles.
THINK a
1 2
WRITE
Sketch the graph of f (x) over a domain which includes the given value of x. Construct a tangent at the given point on the curve. (It is difficult to be accurate.)
Find the gradient of this tangent by evaluating rise . run Find f (x) using first principles.
Evaluate f (2) to find the gradient at x = 2. ) is very close to Note: Answer a (3 2 3 answer b (4).
f (2) = 2(2) = 4
Chapter 7
Differentiation
335
WORKED EXAMPLE 9
WRITE
g(x + h) = (x + h)2 (x + h) = x2 + 2xh + h2 x h g( x + h) g( x ) g ( x ) = lim , h 0, h0 h x2 + 2x xh h + h 2 x h ( x 2 x) h0 h 2 2 x + 2x xh h + h x h x2 + x = lim h0 h 2 2 xh + h h = lim h0 h h(2 x + h 1) = lim h0 h = lim (2 x + h 1) = lim
h0
= 2x 1
REMEMBER
1. The limit of a function is the value that y approaches as x approaches a given value. 2. If a function is continuous at a point then a limit exists at that point and can be found by direct substitution. 3. If a function is discontinuous at a point then the limit exists only if the function is approaching the same value from both left and right. If there is a break in the curve and the point lies within the break then the limit does not exist. 4. The limit of expressions with a denominator can be found. (a) If direct substitution makes the denominator equal to zero then factorise the numerator, cancel and then use direct substitution. (b) If direct substitution does not make the denominator equal to zero then use direct substitution. f ( x + h) f ( x ) 5. The gradient of a chord or secant is found using . h f ( x + h) f ( x ) , h 0. 6. The gradient at a point P on a curve is f ( x ) = lim h0 h 7. The gradient at a point P on a curve is the gradient of the tangent to the curve at that point. EXERCISE
7B
c f i
h0 x3
lim (8 3h)
x 1
lim ( x 2 + 4 x 3)
lim ( x 3 5 x + 2)
x 2
lim (10 x + x 2 x 3 )
h lim
x 2 + 5x + 6 x0 x+2
x2 2x 3 x 1 x3 lim
336
2 WE 6 By first simplifying the rational expression, evaluate the following limits. 2x2 + 2x x 2 + 3x 3x 2 3x a lim c lim b lim x 1 x +1 x0 x 1 x 1 x 2 4 2 + 3x + 2 x x x 2 5x 6 d lim e lim f lim x2 x 2 x 1 x6 x +1 x6 h3 8 x 3 + 27 x2 + 4x 5 g lim h lim i lim h2 h 2 x 3 x + 3 x 5 x+5
lim
x2 9 3 x+3
c f i
x2 + x 6 x2 x2 lim
x 2
x3 + 4 x 1 x + 2 x 2 + 3x g lim x3 x 1 d lim
h3 64 h4 h 4 x3 + 1 h lim x 1 x 1 e lim
lim ( x 3 + x 2 6) lim
x 2 + 7 x + 12 4 x+4
Questions 4 and 5 refer to the following diagram. Consider the chord PQ drawn to the curve f (x) as shown. 4 WE 7 Find the gradient of the chord PQ drawn to the curve f (x) = x2 + 1 in the diagram at right. 5 MC The gradient of the tangent at P in the diagram is: a h b 4+h c 4h e 4 d 4 + h2 6 a Find the gradient of the chord PQ to the function f (x) = x(x + 2) if the x-coordinates of P and Q are 1 and 1 + h respectively. b Hence, find the gradient of the function at P.
y f(x) = x2+1 Q (2+h, f(2+h))
1 0 2
P (2, f(2)) x
7 If the gradient of the chord joining two points on the curve f (x) = x2 + 2x + 3 is find the gradient of the curve at the point where x = 1. 8 WE 8 Find the gradient of g (x) = 4 x2 at the point where x = 2 by: a sketching a graph and finding the gradient of the tangent at x = 2 b differentiating using first principles. 9 Find the gradient of h (x) = 2x2 6x at x = 1 by using: a a sketch graph to find the gradient of the tangent at x = 1 b differentiation from first principles.
f (1 + h) f (1) , h
10 MC The gradient of a function f (x) at the point where x = 3 is: f ( x + h) f ( x ) f (3 + h) f ( x ) f (3 + h) f (3) a lim b lim c lim h0 h0 h0 h h h f (3 + h) f (3) f ( x + h) f ( x ) d e h h 11 WE9 Use first principles to differentiate f (x) if: a f (x) = 3x + 5 b f (x) = x2 3 d f (x) = (x 4)(x + 2) e f (x) = 8 3x2 dy 12 Use first principles to find if: dx a y = 9 4x b y = x2 + 3x 3 d y = x 4x e y = 5x 2x3 c f f (x) = x2 + 6x f (x) = x3 + 2
c f
y = 3x2 + 8x 5 y = x2 2x
Chapter 7
Differentiation
337
7C
The derivative of xn
Instead of using the procedure of differentiating from first principles, rules can be applied to find derivatives. These rules can be derived from first principles and have been looked at in detail in Maths Quest 11 Mathematical Methods CAS. If f (x) = axn then f (x) = naxn 1, where a and n are constants and n is rational. If f (x) = c then f (x) = 0, where c is a constant. (This is because c = x0 and, using the rule, the derivative of x0 is 0 x 1 or 0.) dy For example, if y = x7 then = 7 x 6 . If f (x) = 5x4 then f (x) = 20x3. dx If f (x) = g(x) + h(x) then f (x) = g(x) + h(x), that is, differentiate each term of a function separately. If f (x) = a g(x), where a is a constant, then f (x) = a g(x).
WORKED EXAMPLE 10
Differentiate y = x 4
THINK
1 2
3 2 x + 7. 2
WRITE
y = x4 3 x2 + 7 2 dy = 4 x4 1 3 (2) x 2 1 + 0 2 dx = 4x3 3x
WORKED EXAMPLE 11
b f ( x) =
x+ x . x2
WRITE
f ( x) =
1 1 + x x
1 2
f ( x ) = x 1 + x f ( x ) = x =
1 1 1 1 1 2 x 2 3 2 x x 2
= f ( x) =
1 1 x 2 2 x3
x+ x x2
1
x + x2 = x2
338
Separate the function into two terms expressed in index form. Simplify each term. Differentiate each term.
x x2 = 2+ 2 x x =x 1+x f ( x ) = 1x = x
3 2 1 3 3 x 2 2
4 5
1 1
Simplify f ( x ) .
= =
1 x2
5 3 2 x 2 3
1 x2 2 x5
2x 2 3
WORKED EXAMPLE 12
If f ( x ) = x 3 2 x 2 + a f '(x)
THINK
1
On a Calculator page, press: MENU b 4:Calculus 4 1:Derivative 1 Complete the entry lines as: 8 d 3 x 2x2 + x dx d 3 8 x 2x2 + x = 2 x dx Press ENTER after each entry. Alternatively, press / r to obtain the expression template and choose the derivative template. Write the answers using the correct notation for the derivative.
a f '( x ) = 3 x 2 4 x b f '(2) = 2
8 x2
REMEMBER
1. Rules for differentiating axn (a) If f (x) = axn then f '(x) = naxn 1, where a and n are constants. (b) If f (x) = c then f '(x) = 0, where c is a constant. (c) If f (x) = ag(x), where a is a constant then f '(x) = ag'(x). 2. If f (x) = g(x) + h(x) then f '(x) = g'(x) + h'( x). Differentiate each term of a function separately. 3. To evaluate f (a) where a is a constant, replace every x in the f (x) equation with the value of a. For example, if f (x) = 2x2 3x + 1, f (2) = 2 22 3 2 + 1 = 3.
Chapter 7
Differentiation
339
EXERCISE
7C
The derivative of xn
1 Find the derivative of each of the following. a y = x6 b y = 3x2 c y = 5x4 e y = 4x3 i y = 10 2 WE 10 x3 f y = 5x g y= 1 2 j y = 8x5 Differentiate each of the following. b g(x) = 5x2 + 6x + 1 e g(x) = 7x11 + 6x5 8 h g( x ) = 7 x 2 4 x + 2 3 d y = x20 x4 h y= 3 x3 5
a f (x) = 4x3 + 5x d h(x) = 4 3x + 6x2 + x3 g f (x) = 6x + 3x2 4x3 j f (x) = (x2 + 2x)(3x 6) 3 WE 11 a 2 x3
c h( x ) = 9 + f f ( x) =
eBook plus
Digital doc
2x 5 x3 + + 10 5 3 i h (x) = (x + 4)(x 1)
SkillSHEET 7.3
Index laws
c x3 f i l
1
d 4x 4 g x j m
1 2
e + x3 h
x 2x2
3 4x
1 3
x+3 x 2 k 5x 2
x 3
1 + x2 x x 2 + x3 x 2 + 3x 2 x
x3
4x +
x + x4 x
4 WE 12 If f (x) = 2x5 10x + 5 find: a f (x) b f (2). 5 MC If f (x) = x2 6x then f (4) is equal to: a 8 b 12 c 12 6 MC The value of f (9) if f ( x ) = x 2 + x 2 10 x is: b 18 d 8 e 0 c 12 1 2 1 7 Find g (2) if g( x ) = 2 + 3 x 8. x 5 8 Find the gradient of the curve y = 4 at the point where a x = 2 and b x = 0. x 1 9 Find the gradient of f ( x ) = 2 x 3 x 2 + at the point where x equals: x a 1 b 4 c 9. a
1 2 3
d 2
16
10 If g (x) =
x + 4 x , find:
a g (x)
b g(1)
c g (8)
d g (8).
11 Show that the derivative of y = k, where k is a constant, is zero. 12 For each of the following: i expand the brackets ii differentiate the expanded expression iii factorise. a (x + 1)2 b (x + 1)3 c (2x + 1)2 d (2x + 1)3 e (3x + 1)2 f (3x + 1)3 13 Using the results of question 12 give the derivative of (ax + b)n in factorised form. (a, b, n are constants.)
340
7D
WORKED EXAMPLE 13
eBook plus
un,
nd:
Tutorial
int-0554
Worked example 13
WRITE
Write the equation. Express y as a function of u. Differentiate y with respect to u. Express u as a function of x. Differentiate u with respect to x. Find dy using the chain rule. dx
a y = (3x 2)3
1 2
Let y = u3 where u = 3x 2 dy = 3u 2 du b u = 3x 2 du =3 dx
c
dy dy du = dx du dx = 3u2 3 = 9u2
Replace u as a function of x.
= 9(3x 2)2
WORKED EXAMPLE 14
If f ( x ) =
THINK
1
1 2 x2 3x
f ( x) =
1 2x2 3x
Chapter 7
Differentiation
341
2 3 4 5 6 7 8
Express f (x) in index form. Express y as a function of u. Differentiate y with respect to u. Express u as a function of x. Differentiate u with respect to x. Find f (x) using the chain rule. Replace u as a function of x and simplify.
y = (2 x 2 3 x )
1
1 2
3x)
3 2
2(2 x 2 3 x ) 2 3 4x 2 ( 2 x 2 3 x )3
On a Calculator page, press: MENU b 4:Calculus 4 1:Derivative 1 Complete the entry line as: d 1 2 dx 2 x 3 x Press ENTER .
10
Note the answer from the CAS is not expressed in the same format obtained previously.
f '( x) =
(4 x 3)
2 x (2 x 3) x (2 x 3)
A quicker way to apply the chain rule when a function can be expressed in index form is as follows. If f (x) = [g(x)]n then f (x) = n[g(x)]n 1 g (x). That is, differentiate the bracket and then what is inside the bracket; outside then inside.
WORKED EXAMPLE 15
WRITE
Write the equation. Let g(x) equal what is inside the bracket. Find g (x).
342
Use the rule f (x) = n[g(x)]n 1 g(x) to differentiate f (x). Simplify f (x) as far as possible.
f (x) = 3(x2 2x)3 1 (2x 2) = 3(x2 2x)2 [2(x 1)] = 6(x 1)(x2 2x)2
= 6(x 1)[x(x 2)x(x 2)] = 6x2(x 1)(x 2)2
REMEMBER
1. A composite function is a function composed of two (or more) functions. 2. Composite functions can be differentiated using the chain rule, dy dy du = . dx du dx 3. A short way of applying the chain rule is: If f (x) = [g(x)]n then f (x) = n[g(x)]n 1 g(x). EXERCISE
7D
3 WE 13 If each of the following composite functions are expressed as y = un, find: du dy dy i ii and hence iii . dx du dx 1 b y = (7 x)3 c y= a y = (3x + 2)2 2x 5 3 1 d y= e y = 5x + 2 f y= 4 (4 2 x ) 3x 2 g y = 3(2x2 + 5x)5 j y = 4(5 6x)
4
h y = (4x 3x2)
1 y = x+ x
dy is equal to: du b u
1 2
1 2 u
3 1 2 u 2
1 1 2 u 2
du 5 MC is equal to: dx a 2x 3 b x2 3x + 2 c x2 3x d
1 2
x2 2 x + 1
e x3
Chapter 7
Differentiation
343
x 2 3x + 2 2 u
3)
1 (2 x 2
1 3)( x 2 3 x + 2) 2
Use the chain rule to find the derivative of the following. a y = (8x + 3)4 c f (x) = (4 3x)5 e f ( x) = ( x 2 4 x) 3
6 1
1 g g( x ) = x x 8 WE 14 If f ( x ) =
9 Use the chain rule to find the derivative of the following. (Hint: Simplify first using index notation and the laws of indices.) a y= 6x 5 6x 5 b f ( x) = ( x 2 + 2)2 x2 + 2
d y = (2 x 4 3 x 2 + 1) 2
11 If f (x) = (2x 1)6, find f (3). 12 If g (x) = (x2 3x) 2, find g(2). 13 If f ( x ) = x 2 2 x + 1, find: a f (3) c f (3)
eBook plus
Digital doc
14 Find the gradient of the function h( x ) = 3 x 2 + 2 x at the point where x = 2. 3 15 Find the value of f (1) if f ( x ) = . 5 4x 16 If f (x) = (2x 1)5 and f (x) = 10 (2x 1)n, find the value of n. 17 If f (x) = (3x + 2)7 and f (x) = a (3x + 2)6 3, find the value of a. 18 If f (x) = (5x 3)10 and f (x) = 10m (5x 3)9, find the value of m.
WorkSHEET 7.1
7E
The derivative of e x
If f (x) = ex then using first principles f ( x + h) f ( x ) f ( x ) = lim ,h0 h0 h = lim = lim ex + h ex h0 h e x eh e x h0 h
344
e x (e h 1) h0 h h e 1 = e x lim h0 h h e 1 Note that lim can be deduced by using a calculator and substituting values of h close to h0 h zero. = lim eh 1 h 1.0050 1.000 05 1.000 000 eh 1 = 1. h0 h Therefore, f (x) = ex 1 = ex That is, lim If f (x) = ex then f (x) = ex.
WORKED EXAMPLE 16
Differentiate y = e
THINK
1 2 3 4 5
5x
.
WRITE
Write the equation. du . dx dy Express y as a function of u and find . du dy Find using the chain rule. dx Express u as a function of x and find Replace u as a function of x.
y=e
5x
Let u = 5x so y = eu so
du = 5 dx
dy = eu du
dy u = 5e du = 5e
5x
This example shows that if f (x) = ekx then f ' (x) = kekx.
WORKED EXAMPLE 17
WRITE
Write the equation. du . dx dy Express y as a function of u and find . du dy Find using the chain rule. dx Express u as a function of x and find Replace u as a function of x.
y = e2x + 1 Let u = 2x + 1 so y = eu so dy = eu du du =2 dx
dy = eu 2 dx = 2eu = 2e2x + 1
Chapter 7
Differentiation
345
WORKED EXAMPLE 18
Differentiate:
THINK a
1 2 3 4
a f (x) = ex(ex 2)
b f ( x) =
e2 x 2 e x . ex
WRITE
Write the equation. Expand. Differentiate. Factorise in order to leave the answer in the form it was given. Write the equation. Write each term in the numerator over each term in the denominator. Divide the numerator of each term by its denominator using the laws of indices. Differentiate each term. Write your answer in the form it was given.
1 2 3 4 5
f ( x) = =
e 2 x 2e x ex e 2 x 2e x x ex e
x x
= e2x x 2e = ex 2e 2x f (x) = ex + 4e 2x 4 = ex + 2x e
WORKED EXAMPLE 19
3 x
.
WRITE
Write the equation. du . dx dy Express y as a function of u and find . du dy Find using the chain rule. dx Express u as a function of x and find Replace u as a function of x.
y = ex
Let u = x3 x so y = eu so dy = eu du
du = 3x 2 1 dx
This example shows that if f (x) = eg(x) then f (x) = g (x) e g (x).
REMEMBER
1. 2. 3. 4.
If f (x) = ex, f (x) = ex. If f (x) = ekx, f (x) = ke kx. If f (x) = aekx + c, f (x) = ake kx + c. If f (x) = ae g (x), f (x) = g (x) ae g(x).
346
EXERCISE
7E
The derivative of ex
1 WE 16 Differentiate each of the following.
1x x
a y = e10x b y = e3 c y = e4 5x 2x f y = 4e g y = 6e h y = 5e0.2x 2 WE 17 Find the derivative of each of the following. a y = e6x 2 b y = e8 6x 7 2 x d y = 4e e y = 3e8x + 1 6 9 x g y = 10e h y = 5e3x + 4 j y = 2e 2
x +1
d y=e x i y = 2e 11x
e y = 2e3x
c y = 2e5x + 3 f y = 2e6 5x i y = 6e 7x l y = 4e 4
x +5
k y = 3e
2 x 3
3 MC The derivative of y = e3x + 2 is equal to: 3 x + 2 a 3e b (3x + 2)e3x + 2 c 3e3x d 3xe3x + 2 4 WE 18 Differentiate each of the following: a f (x) = 2(ex + 1) b f (x) = 3e2x(ex + 1) d f (x) = (ex + 2)(e + 3) ex e2
x
f ( x) =
3e3 x
+ ex
e 6x 3
+ 2x)
2x
4e7 x e
2e x
g f (x) = + h f (x) = + 5 WE 19 Find the derivative of each of the following: 4e5x a y = ex + 3x d f (x) = e2 5x g h(x) = 3e4x 7x j f (x) = e(4 x)
4
1 3
2x2
h y = 5e1 2x 3x
3x + 4
n h(x) = e(x2 + 3x) m f ( x ) = e( x +1) 6 MC The derivative of 6ex3 5x is equal to: a 3x2 5 b 6(3x2 5)ex3 5x 3 5x 3 x d 6(x 5x)e e 6(3x2 5)e3x2 5 9 4 x 7 If f (x) = 5e , find the exact value of f (2). 8 If g (x) = 2ex2 3x + 2, give the exact value of g(0). 9 Find the exact value of h(1) if h(x) = 5ex3 + 2x.
c (3x2 5)ex2 5x
7F
The inverse of the function f (x) = ex is f 1(x) = loge (x). If y = loge (x) then ey = x, as shown in chapter 4, Exponential and logarithmic equations. Let x = ey dx = ey dy dy 1 But = dx dx and ey = x dy dy 1 Therefore, = . dx e y 1 = x
Chapter 7
Differentiation
347
1 . x
WRITE
Write the equation. du Express u as a function of x and find . dx dy Express y as a function of u and find . du dy Find . dx
WRITE
Write the equation. Express u as a function of x. Differentiate u with respect to x. Express y as a function of u. Differentiate y with respect to u.
Find
Replace u with 3x 4.
WORKED EXAMPLE 22
WRITE
348
3 4 5 6 7
Differentiate u with respect to x. Express y as a function of u. Differentiate y with respect to u. Find dy using the chain rule. dx
du = 2x + 4 dx y = loge (u) dy 1 = du u dy 1 = (2 x + 4) dx u 2x + 4 = 2 x + 4x 1 g ( x ) . g( x )
WRITE
Write the equation. Simplify the right side by using log laws. du Express u as a function of x and find . dx dy Express y as a function of u and find . du dy Use the chain rule to find . dx
REMEMBER
1 1. If f (x) = loge (x), then f ( x ) = . x 1 2. If f (x) = loge (kx), then f ( x ) = . x g ( x ) . 3. If f (x) = loge [g(x)], then f ( x ) = g( x ) EXERCISE
7F
2 WE 20
Differentiate each of the following. b y = loge (5x) e y = 3 loge (4x) x h y = log e 3 c y = loge (x) f y = 6 loge (9x) x i y = 4 log e 5
8 1 d x x 4 MC To differentiate y = loge (3x + 7) using the chain rule: a u would be used to represent d loge (3x) a 3x + 7 b 3x c loge (x) a 8 b
1 8
e loge (8)
e x
1 1 1 1 and 3x c 3 and b and 3x + 7 d and 3 3 x u u u dy c Hence is equal to dx 3 1 1 d c a 3 b 3x + 7 3x + 7 x 5 WE 21 Find the derivative of each of the following. a y = loge (2x + 5) b y = loge (6x + 1) c y = loge (3x 4) d y = loge (8x 1) g y = loge (4 7x) j y = 4 loge (12x + 5) 6 WE 22 a y = loge (3x4) d y = loge (x2 2x3 + x4) g y = log e (5 x +
1 2) 3
3 x
2x + 1
h f ( x ) = log log e
1 (2 3 x ) 5 (2 2
3 4x
1 f ( x ) = log e x + 3 2 f ( x ) = log e 4 + 3x
7 WE 23 Differentiate each of the following. a y = loge (x2 + 1)2 c y = loge (x2 2x + 3)3 b y = loge (3 x2)2 d y = loge (x2 + 4x + 4)3
8 MC Using the chain rule the derivative of f (x) = loge (x2 5x + 2) would be: 1 5 c 2x 5 a 2 b 2 x 5x + 2 x 5x + 2 1 2x 5 d e 2 x (2 x 5) x 5x + 2 9 Find the gradient of the function f (x) = 6 loge (4 3x) when x = 1.
350 Maths Quest 12 Mathematical Methods CAS for the TI-Nspire
10 If g(x) = 3 loge (3x + 5) find the value of g(0). 11 Find the exact value of f (2) if f (x) = 3x2 + 4 loge (x2 + x). 12 If y = eloge (x), find: dy a dx b the exact gradient when i x = 1 result? 13 If f (x) = eloge (x2), find: a f ' (x) b the exact value of i f ' (1) ii f ' (5) iii f ' (2).
ii x = 2
7G
3 , 2 2 3 f '(x) < 0 when < x < 2 2 3 f '(x) > 0 when 0 < x < and < x < 2 2 2 By sketching the graph of the gradient function, we can see that it is y = cos (x).
f '(x) = 0 when x =
(3 , 1) 2
y 1 0 1
2
3 2
2 x
Similarly, by sketching the graph of the gradient function of y = cos (x), we can see that the derivative of y = cos (x) is y = sin (x). The derivative of tan (x) can be found using the quotient rule y (which appears later in this chapter). If f (x) = sin (x) then f (x) = cos (x). y = cos (x) 1 If f (x) = cos (x) then f (x) = sin (x). y = sin (x) 1 0 3 2 x If f (x) = tan (x) then f '( x ) = , which can be 2 2 2 ( x) 1 2 cos s written as sec (x).
Chapter 7
Differentiation
351
WORKED EXAMPLE 24
WRITE
Write the equation. Express u as a function of x and find Express y as a function of u and find Find dy using the chain rule. dx du . dx dy . du
y = sin (5x) Let u = 5x so y = sin (u) so dy = 5cos (u) dx = 5 cos (5x) du =5 dx dy = cos (u) du
4 5 6
Replace u with 5x. It is important to note what happens when a CAS calculator is used to answer this question. On a calculator page, complete the entry line as: d (sin (5x)) dx Press ENTER . Note: The calculator gives an incorrect answer as it is set in Degree mode.
In differentiating circular functions, the calculator needs to be set in Radian mode as the angles are given in radians. Write the answer, using the correct notation for the derivative.
dy = 5 cos (5 x ) dx
This example shows that if f (x) = sin (ax), then f (x) = a cos (ax). Similarly, if f (x) = cos (ax), then f (x) = a sin (ax).
352
WORKED EXAMPLE 25
WRITE
Write the equation. du . dx dy Express y as a function of u and find . du dy Find using the chain rule. dx Express u as a function of x and find
y = tan (3x) du =3 dx dy y = tan (u) so = sec c 2 (u) du dy 3 = 3 sec c 2 (u) or dx cos s2 (u) 3 = 3 sec 2 (3 x ) or 2 cos (3 x ) Let u = 3x so a or a sec2 (ax). cos s 2 ( ax )
eBook plus
Tutorial
WRITE
int-0555
Worked example 26
Write the equation. du . dx dy Express y as a function of u and find . du dy Find using the chain rule. dx Express u as a function of x and find Replace u with the part in brackets in the rule and simplify.
dy = sin(u) du
This example shows that the chain rule can be applied as follows. If f (x) = sin [g(x)] then f (x) = g(x) cos [g(x)]. If f (x) = cos [g(x)] then f (x) = g(x) sin [g(x)]. g'( x ) If f (x) = tan [g(x)] then f '( x ) = cos 2 [ g( x ) )] ] 2 = g(x) sec [ g(x)]
REMEMBER
1. If f (x) = sin (x) 2. If f (x) = cos (x) 3. If f (x) = tan (x) 4. If f (x) = sin (ax) 5. If f (x) = cos (ax)
then f (x) = cos (x). then f (x) = sin (x). 1 then f ( x ) = = sec c 2 ( x ). cos2 ( x ) then f (x) = a cos (ax). then f (x) = a sin (ax).
Chapter 7
Differentiation
353
6. If f (x) = tan (ax) 7. If f (x) = sin [g(x)] 8. If f (x) = cos [g(x)] 9. If f (x) = tan [g(x)]
then f ( x ) =
a cos2 (ax )
= a sec 2 (a ax ).
then f (x) = g (x) cos [g(x)]. then f (x) = g (x) sin [g(x)]. g ( x ) = g ( x ) sec c 2 [ g( x ) )] ]. then f ( x ) = cos2 [ g( x )]
EXERCISE
7G
Differentiate each of the following. a y = cos (3x) x d y = cos 4 b y = cos (2x) x e y = cos 8 b y = tan (4x) 3x d y = tan ta 4 b 6 cos (x) e
1 6
x c y = cos 3 f 2x y = cos 5
3 WE 25
4 MC a The derivative of sin (6x) is: c 6 sin (x) cos (6 x ) c 4 sin (x) c 4 cos (4x) c 8 sin (8x) d 4 cos (4x) d 4 cos (4x) d 8 sin (x) e e
4 4
b The derivative of cos (4x) is: a 4 sin (4x) b 4 sin (x) c The derivative of sin (4x) is: a 4 cos (4x) b 4 cos (x) d The derivative of cos (8x) is: a 8 cos (8x) b 8 sin (8x) e The derivative of tan (7x) is: x ta a 7 tan 7 dy du dy du b cos s2 du dx du dx 1 (7 x )
e 8 sin (x)
1 7
c 7 sec2 (7x)
d sec2 (7x)
sec ( x )
5 WE26 If y = sin (4x + 3) is expressed as y = sin (u), find: a b c dy using the chain rule. dx dy using the chain rule. dx
354
Differentiate each of the following. a y = sin (2x + 3) b y = sin (6 7x) 3x + 2 d y = sin 4 e y = 5 sin (2 x)
8 Differentiate each of the following. a y = cos (3x 2) b y = cos (4x + 7) 2x + 3 d y = cos 3 e y = 4 cos (10 x)
9 Differentiate each of the following. a y = tan (2x + 1) b y = tan (8 x) d y = tan 2(x + 1) e y = 3 tan (x) 10 Find the derivative of each of the following. a cos (x2 4x + 3) c sin (ex) e tan (4x x2) g cos [loge (x)] i 1 cos x
b sin (10 5x + x2) d cos (x2 + 7x) f tan (x2 + 3x) h sin (e4x) j sin [loge (2x 1)] l 3 cos [loge (10x)] n
8 tan ta
x 4
3x 5
11 If f (x) = 3 sin (x2 + x), find f (1) (answer correct to 3 decimal places). 12 Find the gradient of the curve g (x) = 2 cos (x3 3x) at the point where x = 0. 13 For each of the following functions find: i f (x) and ii the exact value of f . 6 a f (x) = esin (x) b f (x) = ecos (x) c f (x) = loge [sin (x)] d f (x) = loge [cos (x)]
7H
Product rule
dy dy dv dv du d u = u +v . dx d x dx dx dx dx Or if f (x) = u(x) v(x) then f (x) = u(x) v(x) + v(x) u(x). If y = uv then
355
Chapter 7
Differentiation
WORKED EXAMPLE 27
WRITE
Write the equation. Identify u and v, two functions of x which are multiplied together. Differentiate u with respect to x. Differentiate v with respect to x. Apply the product rule to find dy . dx
a y = (3x 1)(x2 + 4x + 3)
Let u = 3x 1
b
and
v = x2 + 4x + 3.
1 2
WORKED EXAMPLE 28
WRITE
Write the equation. Identify u and v. du dv Find and . dx dx dy Find using the product rule. dx Simplify wherever possible.
y = loge (4x) sin (3x 2) Let u = loge (4x) and let v = sin (3x 2). du 1 dv = = 3 cos (3 x 2) dx x dx dy 1 = log e (4 x ) 3 cos (3 x 2) + sin (3 x 2) dx x 1 = 3 log e (4 x ) cos (3 x 2) + sin (3 x 2) x
REMEMBER
dy dv du =u +v . dx dx dx 2. If f (x) = u(x) v(x) then f (x) = u(x) v(x) + v(x) u(x). 1. If y = u v then EXERCISE
7H
356
2 WE28 a y= 4x3
Find the derivative of: loge (6x) x2 b g (x) = (3x 2) loge (2x). sin (2x) is: b f (x) = 4x cos (2x) d f (x) = 2x sin (2x) + 2x2 cos (2x)
3 MC The derivative of f (x) = a f (x) = 2x cos (2x) c f (x) = 2x sin (2x) + x2 cos (2x) e f (x) = 2x sin (x) + 2x2 cos (x)
4 Use the product rule to differentiate each of the following. a y = x cos (x) b y = 3x sin (x) c y = (5x 2) ex d y = e3x (2 11x) e y = x5 cos (3x + 1) f y = 2x3 loge (7x) 2x g y = e loge (2x 5) h y = 8 tan (5x) loge (5x) 4x i y = 5 cos (2x) sin (x) n cos ( x ) j y = sin 3 4 x 3 k f (x) = e loge (6x) l f (x) = 4e 5x sin (2 x) 1 n f ( x) = x e 3 x cos (6 x ) m f ( x) = x o f (x) = 2x 3 sin (2x + 3) q f (x) = (x2 + e3x)(4 e 3x) 6 Find g(0) if g(x) = 5e2x cos (4x).
eBook plus
Digital doc
5 If f (x) = (2x + 1) loge (x + 3), find the exact value of f (1). 7 Find the value of f (2) if f (x) = (x2 + 2) sin (4 3x) (answer correct to 3 decimal places). 8 If g (x) = (6x + x2) ex 3, find the exact value of g(2). 9 Find the exact value of f ' () if f (x) = (3 x) tan (2x).
WorkSHEET 7.2
7I
Quotient rule
WORKED EXAMPLE 29
If y =
dy dy . dx d x
Chapter 7
Differentiation
357
THINK a
1 2
WRITE
Write the equation. Identify u and v. Differentiate u with respect to x. Differentiate v with respect to x. dy . dx
1 2
= = = =
x2
4 x (12 + 2 x 2 x 2 ) ( x 2 + 4 x )2 4 x 12 2 x + 2 x 2 ( x 2 + 4 x )2
x2
x 2 6 x 12 ( x 2 + 4 x )2 x 2 6 x 12 x 2 ( x + 4) 2
WORKED EXAMPLE 30
eBook plus
2e . cos ( 2 x 3)
WRITE
3x
Tutorial
int-0556
Worked example 30
Write the equation. Identify u(x) and v(x). Differentiate u(x) and v(x) with respect to x. Apply the quotient rule to obtain f (x).
f ( x) =
2e 3 x cos s( (2 2x 3)
Let u(x) = 2e3x. Let v(x) = cos (2x 3). u(x) = 6e3x v(x) = 2 sin (2x 3) v ( x )u ( x ) u( x )v ( x ) f ( x ) = [v ( x )]2 = cos s( (2 2x 3) 6e3 x 2e3 x [ 2 s sin in (2 x 3) )] ] [cos cos (2 (2 x 3) )] ]2
6e3 x cos (2x 3) + 4 e3 x sin (2 x 3) [cos cos ( (2 2x 3) )] ]2 3 x 2e [3 cos (2 x 3) + 2 sin (2 x 3)] = cos2 (2 x 3)
358
REMEMBER
EXERCISE
7I
4x 7 10 x sin (2 x ) cos (2 x ) x2 4x + 3x 2
e 3x + 8 2 cos (3 2 x ) x2
3x
5 MC If h( x ) = 9x2 8 x2 3x 2 8 d x2 a
3x 2
+8
x2
Chapter 7
Differentiation
359
sin n (4 x ) is: 4x + 1 4(4 x + 1) cos ( x ) 4 sin (4 x ) a f ( x ) = (4 x + 1)2 4(4 x + 1) cos (4x ) 4 sin (4 x ) c f ( x ) = 4x + 1 4s sin (4x ) 4(4 x + 1) cos (4x ) e f ( x ) = (4 x + 1)2 cos (3 3 x 2) 7 MC If g( x ) = then g(x) is equal to: ex 3e x sin (3 x 2) e x cos (3 x 2) a e2 x e x cos (3 x 2) + 3e x cos (3 x 2) c e2 x 3e x sin (3 x 2) e x cos (3 x 2) e e2 x 6 MC The derivative of f ( x ) = 8 If y = cos (2 x ) dy find when x = 0. dx e3 x
ex
9 Find the gradient of the function f ( x ) = 10 Find the exact value of g(5) if g( x ) =
4 log e (2 x ) . 3x
7J
int-0252
Mixed problems on differentiation
Problems on differentiation may involve any combination of chain, product and quotient rules.
WORKED EXAMPLE 31
For each of the following decide which rule of differentiation, that is, chain, product or quotient rule, would be useful to nd the derivative. log g e ( x) 2 a b (x2 5x)6 c (x2 + 2x 3) cos (2x) d ex + 3x sin ( x )
THINK a
1 2
WRITE
Write the equation. u , that is, a rational function. v Write the equation. It is of the form It is a composite function of the form u6, where u = x2 5x. Write the equation. It is of the form u v, that is, the product of two functions.
a y=
log e ( x ) sin ( x )
Quotient rule
b y = (x2 5x)6
1 2
Chain rule
c y = (x2 + 2x 3) cos (2x)
1 2
Product rule
360
1 2
Write the equation. It is a composite function of the form eu, where u = x2 + 3x.
d y = ex2 + 3x
Chain rule
WORKED EXAMPLE 32
WRITE
Write the equation. Decide which rule to use and identify u and v to apply the rule. Differentiate u with respect to x. v is a composite function, so differentiate v with respect to x using the chain rule.
y = 2x3 cos (x2 + x) Use the product rule. u = 2x3 and v = cos (x2 + x). du = 6x2 dx v = cos (x2 + x) Let w = x2 + x. dw = 2x + 1 dx v = cos (w) dv = sin ( w) dw dv dv dw = dx dw dx dv So =( s sin in ( w) )) ) (2 x + 1) dx = (2x + 1) sin (x2 + x) dy dv du =u +v dx dx dx = 2x3[(2x + 1)] sin (x2 + x) + cos (x2 + x) 6x2 = 2x3(2x + 1) sin (x2 + x) + 6x2 cos (x2 + x) = 2x2[3 cos (x2 + x) x(2x + 1) sin (x2 + x)]
3 4
dy . dx
1 if x > 0 The derivative of f (x) = x , f ( x ) = . x 1 if x < 0 In order for the derivative to be defined at x = 0 for a function f (x), the limit as x approaches 0 from the left, written as lim f '( x ), and the limit as x approaches 0 from the right, written as
x 0 x 0+
Chapter 7
Differentiation
361
This is not the case, as lim f ' ( x ) = 1 and lim f ' ( x ) = 1. Thus,
x 0 x 0+
1 the function f '(x) = x is not differentiable at x = 0 and the graph of y = f '(x) has open circles at x = 0 as shown right. x 1 The chain rule is used to differentiate the composite function f (x) = h(g(x)), to give f '(x) = g(x) h(g(x)). 1 if g( x ) > 0 Hence, for f (x) = h(g(x)), where h (x) = x, then f '( x ) = g'( x ) . 1 if g( x ) < 0 Note the derivative is a hybrid function and the domain is obtained by examining the graph of the function y = g(x). WORKED EXAMPLE 33
eBook plus
Tutorial
For the function: f (x) 4x: a nd the derivative b sketch the graphs of y = f (x) and y = f (x) on the same set of axes.
THINK a
1
= x2
int-0557
Worked example 33
WRITE
As f (x) = x2 4x is a composite function, apply the chain rule to find the derivative, f (x) where g(x) = x2 4x and h(x) = x .
To determine the domain of the derivative, consider the graph of the function g(x) = x2 4x. From the graph, x2 4x > 0 if x < 0 or x > 4 and x2 4x < 0 if 0 < x < 4.
3 4
Write the derivative with the correct domain. To differentiate f (x) = x2 4x with a CAS calculator, on a Calculator page, press: MENU b 4:Calculus 4 1:Derivative 1 Alternatively press /r to obtain the expression template and choose the derivative template. d Complete the entry line as: x2 4x dx Press ENTER .
Note: The answer from the CAS is not expressed as a hybrid function with the correct domain and hence cannot be used.
x.sign
362
1 2
Sketch the graph of f (x) = x2 4x. Sketch the graph of the derivative, 2 x 4 if x < 0 or x > 4 f '( x) = 2 x + 4 if 0 < x < 4 For the graph of y = f (x), put open circles at x = 0 and x = 4 as the derivative is not defined at these points.
y 10 8 6 4 2 f (x) =x 4x 2
f'(x) = 2x 4, x > 4
To graph f (x) = x2 4x and y = f (x) with a CAS calculator, on a Graphs page, complete the function entry lines as: f1(x) = x2 4x d f 2(x) = x2 4x dx and press ENTER after each entry. Note: The open circles at x = 0 and x = 4 are not displayed.
WORKED EXAMPLE 34
For the function f (x) = sin (x) for x [0, 2]: a nd the derivative b sketch the graphs of y = f (x) and y = f (x) on the same set of axes.
THINK a
1
WRITE
As f (x) = |sin (x)| is a composite function, apply the chain rule to find the derivative, f (x) where g(x) = sin (x) and h(x) = |x|.
f (x) = h(g(x)) f (x) = g (x) h(g(x)) sin n ( x) > 0 1 if si f ' ( x ) = cos cos ( x ) sin ( x ) < 0 1 if sin cos ( x ) if sin ( x ) > 0 f '( x) = sin in ( x ) < 0 cos ( x ) if s
y 1 0.5 0 0.5 1
To determine the domain of the derivative, consider the graph of the function g(x) = sin (x) for x [0, 2]. From the graph, sin (x) > 0 if 0 < x < and sin (x) < 0 if < x < 2. Write the derivative with the correct domain.
3 2
Chapter 7
Differentiation
363
Sketch the graph of f (x) = |sin(x)| for x [0, 2]. Sketch the graph of the derivative, cos ( x ) if 0 < x < f '( x) = cos ( x ) if < x < 2 For the graph of y = f (x), put open circles at x = 0, x = and x = 2 as the derivative is not defined at these points.
REMEMBER
0.5 0 0.5 1
2
3 2
f '(x) = cos (x), 0 < x < f '(x) = cos (x), < x < 2
1. Chain rule: dy dy du (a) = dx du dx (b) A short way to apply the chain rule is: If f (x) = [g(x)]n then f (x) = n[g(x)n 1 g(x). 2. Product rule: dy dv du (a) If y = uv then =u +v . dx dx dx (b) If f (x) = u(x) v(x) then f (x) = u(x) v(x) + v(x) u(x). 3. Quotient rule: du dv v u u dy dx dx. (a) If y = then = v dx v2 u( x ) v ( x ) u ( x ) u( x ) v ( x ) (b) If f ( x ) = then f ( x ) = . v( x) [v ( x )]2 EXERCISE
7J
g( x ) =
x2 + 9x 8 log e ( x )
g h(x) = cos (x2 4x) j f (x) = sin2 (x) m g(x) = ecos (x)
2 Using the appropriate rule find the derivative of each function in question 1. 3 WE 32 Find the derivative of each of the following. (Note that more than one rule will need to be applied in some cases.) x2 a y = e 5x cos (4x 7) b y= 3x + 1 c y = loge (x + 1)3 d y = cos (x2 6x)
364
f ( x) =
sin (2 x ) cos (2 x )
cos (4x 3)
log e
( x)
x
u f (x) = 3x5 cos (2x + 1) w y = ex sin (x) y f (x) = 3 sin (6x) + loge (5x2)
x 2 4e
4 WE 33 For the following functions: a f (x) = x2 1 b f (x) = x2 + 2x i find the derivative ii sketch the graphs of y = f (x) and y = f (x) on the same set of axes. 5 WE 34 For the following functions: a f (x) = sin (2x) for x [0, ] b f (x) = cos (x) for x [0, 2] i find the derivative ii sketch the graphs of y = f (x) and y = f (x) on the same set of axes.
Chapter 7
Differentiation
365
SUMMARY
Review gradient and rates of change
The gradient of a function exists wherever the graph of the function is smooth and continuous. If the gradient of a function, f (x), is zero at x = a, then the graph of its gradient function, f (x), will have an x-intercept at x = a. When the gradient of a function is positive, the graph of the gradient function is above the x-axis and when the gradient of a function is negative, the graph of the gradient function is below the x-axis. A polynomial function has a gradient function which is also a polynomial function, but its degree is reduced by one.
Limits and differentiation from first principles
The gradient of a chord (secant) or the average rate of change is given by: f ( x + h) f ( x ) . h A limit is the value that y approaches as x approaches a given value. A limit exists if the function is approaching the same value from both left and right. The gradient of the tangent to a curve at a point P is the gradient of the curve at P and is f ( x + h) f ( x ) given by lim . h0 h dy For a function y = f (x), its derivative is expressed as either or f (x). dx
The derivative of xn
If f (x) = axn then f (x) = naxn 1, where a and n are constants. If f (x) = c then f (x) = 0, where c is a constant. If f (x) = ag(x) where a is a constant then f (x) = ag(x). If f (x) = g(x) + h(x) then f (x) = g (x) + h (x). Differentiate each term separately.
The chain rule
If f (x) = ex then f (x) = ex. If f (x) = ekx then f (x) = kekx. If f (x) = aekx + c then f (x) = akekx + c. If f (x) = aeg(x) then f (x) = g (x) ae g(x).
The derivative of loge (x )
1 . x 1 If f (x) = loge (kx) then f (x) = . x g ( x ) If f (x) = loge [g(x)] then f (x) = . g( x )
The derivatives of sin (x ), cos (x ) and tan (x )
If f (x) = sin (x) then f (x) = cos (x). If f (x) = cos (x) then f (x) = sin (x).
366
1 = sec2 (x). cos2 ( x ) If f (x) = sin (ax) then f (x) = a cos (ax). If f (x) = cos (ax) then f (x) = a sin (ax). a If f (x) = tan (ax) then f (x) = = a sec2 (ax). 2 cos (ax ) If f (x) = sin [g(x)] then f (x) = g (x) cos [g(x)]. If f (x) = cos [g(x)] then f (x) = g (x) sin [g(x)]. g ( x ) If f (x) = tan [g(x)] then f (x) = = g (x) sec2 [g(x)]. cos2 [ g( x )]
The product rule of differentiation states: dy dv du 1. if y = u v, then =u +v dx dx dx 2. if f (x) = u(x) v (x) then f (x) = u(x) v(x) + v(x) u(x).
The quotient rule
The quotient rule of differentiation states: du dv v u u dy dx dx . 1. if y = then = v dx v2 u( x ) 2. if f ( x ) = then v( x) v ( x )u ( x ) u( x )v ( x ) f ( x ) = [v ( x )]2 Summary of derivatives: f (x) c axn [g(x)]n ex ekx eg(x) loge (x) loge (kx) loge [g(x)] sin (ax) cos (ax) tan (ax) f (x) 0 naxn 1 ng(x)[g(x)]n 1 ex kekx g(x)eg(x) 1 x 1 x g ( x ) g( x ) a cos (ax) a sin (ax) a cos2 (ax ) (= a sec2 (ax))
Chapter 7
Differentiation
367
CHAPTER REVIEW
SHORT ANSWER y
1 0
1 2 3 f(x)
2 3
Sketch the graph of its gradient function. h 3 + 2h 2 + 4 h Find lim . h0 h a Find the derivative of f (x) = x3 + 2x using first principles. b Hence find the gradient at the point where x = 1. x3 a Find the gradient function if g( x ) = 4x . 3 b Find the gradient of g (x) when x = 3. 3x 4 x3 If h( x ) = + 3 x, find: 2 4 a h (x) b i h(1) ii h(2).
3 (4 x + 1) 2 ,
a On the same set of axes, sketch the graph of the derivative function. b Write down the domain of the derivative function.
EXAM TIP
a Common errors were drawing the cusp point at x = 0 as a closed circle as well as the point at x = 3. b In this question students often gave responses that were inconsistent with the graph they had drawn in a. Union and intersection were sometimes confused as was the use of round, square or curly brackets.
[Assessment report 1 2007]
[ Vcaa 2007]
19 Find the derivative of y = f (x) where f (x) = x2 2x . 20 Find the derivative of y = f (x) where f (x) = sin (x) for x , . 2 2
MULTIPLE CHOICE
6 If y = find the gradient when a x = 2 and b x = 1. 7 Find the derivative of x 2 + 4 . 8 Differentiate f (x) = e2x 1. 9 a Find f (x) if f (x) = e . b What is the value of x when f (x) = 0? dy if y = loge (2x3 4). 10 Find dx 11 The tangent to the curve f (x) = loge (ax 1) when x = 2, has a gradient of 1. Find the value of a. 12 Find f '(x) if f (x) = 3 sin (2x) and hence find f '(2). 13 Find f '(x) if f (x) = tan (5x). 14 Find f '(x) if f (x) = tan (2x2 3). dy 15 If y = 3x2 loge (6x), find . dx cos ( x 2 ) 16 Find f '(x) if f ( x ) = . x2 17 Differentiate esin (2x). 18 The diagram (top, right) shows the graph of a function with domain R.
x2
y 0 x
368
c
0 3 x
4 (4 x 9) 2 2 4x 9
6x 3
d 4 4x 9
3 y 4 0
9 If y = 5e
x
then
2 For the function g(x) graphed below, the gradient function g(x) is defined over the domain: y a R b R \{1} c R \{4} d R \{1, 4} x e [1, 4] 0 1 4 3 The value of lim x3 x2 2x 8 is: x4 x4 a undefined b 0 c 1
x 3
b e4x + 6 d 4e4x + 7
1 x
d 4
e 6
5x is: x +1 a 22 b 22 c 6 d undefined 5 The derivative of f (x) = 4x3 x2 + 3x is: a 12x2 2x + 3 b 4x2 2x + 3 c 12x2 2x d 12x2 x + 3 e 4x2 2x 1 6 The derivative of g( x ) = 2 2 x is: x 1 2 2 2 a b 3 x x x x 2 2 1 2 c d x x3 x x 2 1 3 e x3 x2 4 lim 7 The derivative of (2x + 5)6 is: a 6(2x + 5)5 b 12x(2x + 5)5 5 d 12(2x + 5) e 12(2x + 5)4 1 8 The derivative of is: 4x 9 a 2 4x 9 b
2
12 The derivative of 2 loge (x2 + x) is: 2(2 x + 1) c 2x + 1 x x2 + x 4x e 2 x +x dy 13 If y = cos (8x) then is: dx a 8 sin (8x) b sin (8x) 2(2 x + 1) x2 + x 2x d 2 x +x a b c 8 sin (8x) e
sin
(8x)
c 6x(2x + 5)5
15 If f (x) = tan (6 5x), then f (x) is equal to: 5 5 a b 2 (6 5 x ) 2 cos s cos s (6 5 x ) c sec2 (6 5x) d 5 cos2 (6 5x) 2 e 5 cos (6 5x) 16 If f (x) = x2 e2x then f (x) is equal to: a 2xe2x + 2x2e2x c 4xe2x e 2xe2x + x2e2x b 2xe2x d 2xe2x 2x2e2x
(4 x 9)3
Chapter 7
Differentiation
369
17 If g (x) = 2x loge (3x) then g(x) must be: a 2 log e (3 x ) + 3 c 2 loge (3x) + 6x e 2 loge (3x) + 6x loge (3x) 2x + 1 18 The derivative of is: x2 4x 5 a ( x 2)2 4x 3 c ( x 2)2 5 e ( x 2)2 19 The derivative of ( x 2)e 4 x x3 2(2 x 1)e 4 x c x3 a e e4 x is: x2 b d 2(1 2 x ) x3 x 2 e 4 x 2e 4 x x4
2
( x 2)2
d 4x 5
21 The derivative of sin (x) cos (x) is: a 2 sin (x) cos (x) b sin2 (x) cos2 (x) 2 2 c sin (x) + cos (x) d cos2 (x) sin2 (x) 2 2 e sin (x) cos (x) 22 Which one of the following is not true about the function f: R R, f (x) = |2x + 4|? a The graph of f is continuous everywhere. b The graph of f is continuous everywhere. c f (x) 0 for all values of x. d f (x) = 2 for all x > 0 e f (x) = 2 for all x < 2 [ Vcaa 2007] 23 If y = |cos (x)|, the rate of change of y with respect to x at x = k, < k < 3 , is: 2 2 a sin (k) b sin (k) c cos (k) d sin (1) e sin (1) [ Vcaa 2005] 24 Let f: R R be a differentiable function. For all real values of x, the derivative of f (e2x) with respect to x will be equal to: a 2e2x f (x) b e2x f (x) c 2e2x f (e2x) d 2f (e2x) e f (e2x) [ Vcaa 2005]
2e 4 x x3 20 If g(x) = (x2 + 3x 7)5 then g(x) is equal to: a 5(x2 + 3x 7)4 b (2x + 3)(x2 + 3x 7)4 4 c 5(2x + 3) d 5(2x + 3)(x2 + 3x 7)4 2 4 e (x + 3x 7)
EXTENDED RESPONSE
1 A section of a roller-coaster ride follows part of the curve with the equation y = 200 ( x 3 + 30 x 2 ) as shown below. a For what values of x (domain) is the gradient: y i zero? ii positive? iii negative? b Sketch the gradient function. c Use the graph of the gradient function to find the value of x where the 0 28 20 gradient is steepest over the domain [25, 10]. dy d Find . dx e Find the gradient where x equals: i 25 ii 10 iii 10. f Does this verify your answer to part c? Briey explain. g What is the highest point reached by the roller-coaster? (Give your answer in metres.) 2 Consider the functions f ( x ) = 2 x and g(x) = x2 + 1. a State the domain and range for each function.
12
370
b Find the composite functions: i f (g(x)) ii g(f (x)). c State the domain and range for f (g(x)) and g(f (x)). d Find: d i ( f ( g( x ) )) ) dx d ii ( g( f ( x ) )) ) dx e Evaluate: i f (g(2)) ii g (f (2)) 4 x 2 , x 2 f ( x ) = 3 Consider the function 2 x 4, 2 < x < 5 . x 1, x 5 a Sketch the graph of f (x). b For what values of x is f (x) discontinuous? c For what values of x is f (x) not differentiable? d Find f (x). e Sketch the graph of f (x).
eBook plus
Digital doc
Test Yourself
Chapter 7
Chapter 7
Differentiation
371
eBook plus
ACTIVITIES
chapter opener
Digital doc
10 Quick Questions: Warm up with ten quick questions on differentiation. (page 324)
7a
Tutorial
SkillSHEET 7.1: Practise identifying positive negative and zero gradients. (page 328) SkillSHEET 7.2: Practise sketching the gradient function given the original function. (page 328)
7b Limits and differentiation from first principles
7H
Digital doc
eLesson eles-0093
Limits and differentiation from first principles. Watch an eLesson on related rates of change (page 332)
Tutorial
WorkSHEET 7.2: Differentiation of mixed expression involving the product, quotient and chain rules. (page 357)
7I
Tutorial
WE 30 int-0556: Watch a worked example on how to use the quotient rule. (page 358)
7J Mixed problems on differentiation
Interactivity int-0252
WE 33 int-0557: Watch a worked example on how derivatives of an absolute value function. (page 362)
chapter review
Digital doc
WE 13 int-0554: Watch a worked example on using the chain rule. (page 341)
Digital doc
WorkSHEET 7.1: Sketch gradient functions, identify where the derivative exists, evaluate limits, apply first principles and differentiation rules to determine derivatives. (page 344)
7G
Tutorial
Test Yourself: Take the end-of-chapter test to test your progress. (page 371)
To access eBookPLUS activities, log on to www.jacplus.com.au
WE 26 int-0555: Watch a worked example on using the chain rule to differentiate trigonometric functions. (page 353)
372
8
Applications of differentiation
AreAS oF STudy
8A Equations of tangents and normals 8B Sketching curves 8c Maximum and minimum problems when the function is known 8D Maximum and minimum problems when the function is unknown 8e Rates of change 8F Related rates 8G Linear approximation
Application of differentiation to curve sketching and identification of: key features of curves intervals over which a function is constant, stationary, strictly increasing or strictly decreasing the maximum rate of increase or decrease in a given application context (consideration of second derivative is not required) tangents and normals to curves
Identification of: local maximum/minimum values over an interval and application to solving problems interval end point maximum and minimum values Average and instantaneous rates of change, including formulation of expressions and solution and interpretation of problems involving rates of change and simple cases of related rates of change The relationship f ( x + h) f ( x ) + hf hf '( x ) for a small value of h and its geometric interpretation
eBook plus
8A
Digital doc
10 Quick Questions
f(x)
Tangent
1 If the gradient of the tangent to a curve is m, then the gradient of the normal is (as the m product of the gradients of two perpendicular lines equals 1).
The equation of a straight line passing through the point (x1, y1) and having a gradient of m is: y y1 = m(x x1) The gradient of the tangent at x = a is f(a). 1 Therefore the gradient of the normal is . f (a)
Chapter 8
Applications of differentiation
373
The equation of the tangent at x = a is y f (a) = f(a) (x a) and the equation of the normal is 1 y f (a)= ( x a). f (a)
f(a) 0
Worked exAmple 1
WriTe
y = x3 2x + 3 dy = 3x2 2 dx At x = 1, dy =32 dx =1 So gradient of tangent is 1. Equation of tangent at the point (1, 2) is y 2 = 1(x 1) y2=x1 y=x+1
Substitute (1, 2) for (x1, y1) and m = 1 into the rule for the equation of a straight line: yy1=m(xx1). Rearrange the rule to a simple form.
Worked exAmple 2
Find the equation of: a the tangent b the normal to the curve with the equation y = 3 loge (2x) at x = 1 c the tangent and the normal to the curve y = 3 loge (2x) at x = 1 using a CAS calculator.
Think
1 2 3
eBook plus
Tutorial
int-0558
Worked example 2
WriTe
y = 3 loge (2x) At x = 1, y = 3 loge (2) dy 3(2) = dx 2x 3 = x dy 3 a At x = 1, = dx 1 =3 So gradient of tangent is 3. Equation of tangent is y 3 loge (2) = 3(x 1) = 3x 3 y = 3x 3 + 3 loge (2)
Evaluate
374
b Gradient of normal is
1 . 3
dy dx
On a Calculator page, press: MENUb 4:Calculus4 Select either 9:Tangent Line 9 or A:Normal Line A. Complete the entry lines as: tangentLine(3ln (2x),x,1) normalLine(3ln (2x),x,1) Press ENTER after each entry.
Note the answers from the CAS are not written as equations.
y = 3 x + 3 (log e (2 1)) is the equation of the tangent. x 9 log e (2 + 1) y= is the equation + 3 3 of the normal.
rememBer
1 1. If m is the gradient of the tangent, then is the gradient of the normal. That is, m m1 m2 = 1. 2. The equation of a straight line passing through the point (x1, y1) with gradient m is y y1 = m(x x1)
8A
eBook plus
Digital doc
Spreadsheet 129
Tangent and normal
Find the equation of the normal to the curve y = 3x2 5x + 4 at the point where x = 1.
Chapter 8
Applications of differentiation
375
Find the equation of the normal to the curve y = 1 x2 + 3x 7 at the point where it crosses 2 the y-axis.
5 We2 For each of the following functions, find the equation of: i the tangent ii the normal at the given value of x. a y = x2 + 1, x = 1 b y = x36x, x =2 1 c y = , x = 2 d y = (x 1)(x2 + 2), x=1 x e g i k y = x , x = 4 y = x(x + 2)(x 1), x =1 y = 2x3 + x2 6x + 2, x = 1 y = e3x + 2, x =1 y = 2 x + 3, x = 3 y = x3 3x2 + 4x, x = 0 y = e2x, x = 0 y = loge (x), x = 2 n y = sin (2x), x = 3 p y = sin 2 x + , x = 0 4 f h j l
6 mC If y = (2x + 3)4 then at the point (1, 1) a the equation of the normal is: A y + 4x 3 = 0 B 8y + x 7 = 0 D y + 2x + 8 = 0 e 2y x = 0 A
2 3
c y 4x + 5 = 0
b the value of x where the gradient of the tangent is parallel to the x-axis is: B
1 3
3 2
1 3
2 3
7 Find the equation of the tangent to f (x) = x2 + 4x + 1 which is parallel to the line y = 2x + 3. x2 + 1 at x = 0. x2 1 9 Find the equation of the normal to y = x sin (x) at x = . 2 10 Find the equation of the normal to y = loge (x + 2) which is parallel to the line with equation y + 3x 5 = 0. 8 Find the equation of the tangent to y = 11 Find the equations of the tangent and normal for each of the following curves. a f (x) = x2 + 1 at x = a b f (x) = x at x = a c f (x) = e x at x = 2a.
2
eBook plus
Digital doc
WorkSHEET 8.1
12 Find the equation of the tangent to the curve f (x) = e4x that is perpendicular to the line x + 8y = 16. 13 The graph of y = x has a normal with equation y = 8x + b, where b is a real constant. Find the value of b.
8B
Sketching curves
When the graphs of polynomial functions are being sketched, four main characteristics should be featured: 1. the basic shape (whenever possible) 2. the y-intercept 3. the x-intercept(s) 4. the stationary points.
376
Stationary points
A stationary point is a point on a graph where the function momentarily stops rising or falling; that is, it is a point where the gradient is zero.
y y
or 0 0 x Function stops falling and rises after this point x Gradient = 0 where function stops rising momentarily, then continues to rise again after this point
The stationary point (or turning point) of a quadratic function can be found by completing a perfect square in the form y = (x + h)2 + k. In this case the stationary point is (h, k). For cubics, quartics or higher-degree polynomials there is no similar procedure. Differentiation enables stationary points to be found for any polynomial function where the rule is known. The gradient function of a function f(x) is f(x). Stationary points occur wherever the gradient is zero. f(x) has stationary points when f(x) = 0 or y has stationary points when dy = 0. dx
The solution of f(x) = 0 gives the x-value or values where stationary points occur. If f(a) = 0, a stationary point occurs when x = a and y = f(a). So the coordinate of the stationary point is (a, f(a)).
f (x)
2. A local maximum turning point at x = a. If x < a, then f(x) > 0. If x = a, then f(x) = 0. If x > a, then f(x) < 0. The two cases (1 and 2) can be called turning points because the gradients each side of the stationary point are opposite in sign (that is, the graph turns). The term local turning point at x = a implies in the vicinity ofx = a, as polynomials can have more than one stationary point.
y 0 a x
f(x)
377
3. A positive stationary point of inflection at x = a. If x < a, then f(x) > 0. If x =a, then f(x) = 0. If x > a, then f(x) > 0. That is, the gradient is positive either side of the stationary point.
y Gradient = 0
0 f'(x)
4. A negative stationary point of inflection at x = a. If x < a, then f(x) < 0. If x =a, then f(x) = 0. If x > a, then f(x) < 0. In cases 3 and 4 above the word stationary implies that the gradient is zero. Not all points of inflection are stationary points.
y y
f(x)
y Gradient = 0
or
0 x 0 x
Gradient 0
When determining the nature of stationary points it is helpful to complete a gradient table, which shows the sign of the gradient either side of any stationary points. This is known as the rst derivative test. Gradient tables are demonstrated in the examples that follow.
Worked exAmple 3 a Find the stationary points and their nature for the function b c d e
eBook plus
Tutorial
f (x) = x3 + 5x2 8x 12. Show that the curve passes through (1, 0). Find the coordinates of all other intercepts. Hence, sketch the graph of f (x). Use a CAS calculator to find the stationary points.
int-0559
Worked example 3
Think a
1 2 3
WriTe/drAW
Write the rule for f (x). Differentiate f (x) to find f(x). Find all values of x where f(x) = 0.
a f (x) = x3 + 5x2 8x 12
f(x) = 3x2 + 10x 8 For stationary points 3x2 + 10x 8 = 0 (3x 2)(x + 4) = 0 x = 2 or x =4 3
378
When x = 3 , f( 3 ) = ( 3 )3 + 5( 3 )2 8( 3 ) 12 = 14 27 so ( 2 , 14 22 ) is one stationary point. 3 27 When x = 4, f(4) = (4)3 + 5(4)2 8(4) 12 = 36 so (-4, 36) is another stationary point.
22
0 \
2 3
1 + /
+ /
Therefore (4, 36) is a local maximum stationary point and ( 2 , 14 22 ) is a local minimum stationary 27 3 point.
b f(1) = (1)3 + 5(1)2 8(1) 12
To find the x-intercepts, factorise f(x) by long division, or by another appropriate method, knowing that (x + 1) is a factor of f(x). Solve f(x) = 0.
x-intercepts: (x + 1)(x + 6)(x 2) = 0 x = 1 or 6 or 2 The x-intercepts are (1, 0), (6, 0) and (2, 0). f(0) = (0)3 + 5(0)2 8(0) 12 = 12
State the coordinates of the x-intercepts. Evaluate f(0) to determine the y-intercept. State the coordinate of the y-intercept.
d
Sketch the graph of f(x) showing all intercepts and stationary points.
(2, 0) x
, 14 22 ) (2 3 27
(0, 12)
379
To find the stationary points with a CAS calculator, on a Calculator page: define the function f(x) find f (x) solve f (x) = 0 find the y-values of the stationary points. To do this, complete the entry lines as: Define f(x) = x3 + 5x2 8x 12 d ( f ( x)) dx solve(3x2 + 10x 8 = 0,x) 2 f 4, 3 Press ENTER after each entry.
400 27
Worked Example 4
Sketch the graph of g(x) = x2(4 x2), clearly indicating all stationary points and intercepts.
Think
1 2 3 4
Write/draw
Write the rule for g(x). Expand g(x) to make it easier to differentiate. Differentiate g(x). Solve g(x) = 0.
g(x) = x2(4 x2) g(x) = 4x2 x4 g(x) = 8x 4x3 For stationary points, g(x) = 0 8x 4x3 = 0 4x(2 x2) = 0 x = 0 or x2 = 2 x = 0 or x = 2 or 2 When x = 0, g(0) = 0 When x = 2 , g( 2 ) = 4( 2 )2 ( 2 )4 =4 When x = 2, g( 2) = 4( 2)2 ( 2)4 =4 Therefore the stationary points are ( 2 , 4), (0, 0) and ( 2, 4).
2 0
0 0
1 + /
2 0
2 \
+ /
380
State the stationary points and their nature. Solve g(x) = 0 to determine the x-intercepts.
Therefore ( 2 , 4) is a local maximum stationary point. (0, 0) is a local minimum stationary point. ( 2, 4) is a local maximum stationary point. x-intercepts: When g(x) = 0, x2(4 x2) = 0 x2 = 0 or x2 = 4 x = 0 or x = 2 or 2 The x-intercepts are (2, 0), (0, 0) and (2, 0). y-intercept: When x = 0, g(0) = 02(4 02) =0 The y-intercept is (0, 0).
( 2, 4) y ( 2, 4) (2, 0)
10
(2, 0) (0, 0) 0
x g(x)
Worked Example 5
If f(x) = x3 + 4x2 3x 7: a sketch the graph of f(x) b state the values of x where f(x) is i increasing and i i decreasing.
Think a
1 2 3
Write/draw
Write the rule for f(x). Differentiate f(x) to find f(x). Solve f(x) = 0 to find the x-intercepts of f(x).
a f(x) = x3 + 4x2 3x 7
f(x) = 3x2 + 8x 3 x-intercepts: When f(x) = 0, 3x2 + 8x 3 = 0 (3x 1)(x + 3) = 0 x= 1 or 3 3 The x-intercepts of f(x) are ( 1 , 0) 3 and (3, 0).
Evaluate f(0) to find the y-intercept of f(x). Sketch the graph of f(x) (an upright parabola).
0 3
1 3
381
f(x) increases where f(x) > 0. Byinspecting the graph of f(x) deduce where f(x) is positive (that is, above the x-axis). Byinspecting the graph of f(x), deduce where f(x) is negative (that is, below the x-axis).
1 3
Worked Example 6
Consider the function f ( x ) = ( x + 3)( x a)2 where a is a positive real constant. a Find f (x). b Find the coordinates of the stationary points. c Determine the nature of the stationary points. d Find the value of a in exact form if the straight line with equation y = 5x + 15 intersects y = f(x) at the maximum turning point.
Think a
1
Write
Store the function to f(x). On a Calculator page, press: MENU b 1:Actions 1 1:Define 1 Complete the entry line as: Define f(x) = (x + 3)(x a)2 Press ENTER . On the same Calculator page, select the derivative template: Complete the entry line as: d ( f ( x)) dx Press ENTER . Write the derivative with the correct notation. Solve f (x) = 0 to find the x-values of each stationary point. On the same Calculator page, press: MENU b 3:Algebra 3 1:Solve 1 Complete the entry line as: solve((x + 3)(x a)2 = 0, x) Press ENTER .
f (x) = (x a)(3x a + 6)
b
382
Substitute each value of x into f(x) to find the y-coordinates of the stationary points. On the same Calculator page, complete the entry line as: a 6 f , a . 3 Press ENTER . Write the stationary points in coordinate form.
a 6 4(a + 3)3 and (a, 0) are the , 27 3 coordinates of the stationary points.
To determine the nature of the stationary points, let a = 1 (as a is given as a positive real constant). Substitute a = 1 into the answer found previously to obtain the stationary points.
c 1 6 4(1 + 3)3
, 3
27
and (1, 0)
x f(x) Slope
0 \
1 0
2 + /
+ /
(1, 0) is a local minimum turning point. 5 256 , is a local maximum turning point. 3 27 (a, 0) is a local minimum turning point and a 6 4(a + 3)3 is a local maximum turning point. , 27 3
d
The maximum turning point lies on the straight line y = 5x + 15. Substitute the coordinates of the turning point into y = 5x + 15 and solve for a. On a Calculator page, press: MENU b 3:Algebra 3 1:Solve 1 Complete the entry line as: 4 ( a + 3)3 5(a 6) solve = + 15, a 27 3 Press ENTER .
a=
52 2
383
REMEMBER
1. A stationary point (SP) occurs when f(x) = 0. 2. There are four types of stationary points: (a) local maximum, where the gradient is positive on the left of the SP and negative on the right (b) local minimum, where the gradient is negative on the left of the SP and positive on the right (c) positive point of inflection, where the gradient is positive on both sides of the SP (d) negative point of inflection, where the gradient is negative on both sides of the SP. Exercise
8B
Sketching curves
1 WE3 Find the stationary points and their nature for each of the following functions. a y = 8 x2 b f(x) = x3 3x c g(x) = 2x2 8x 2 3 3 4 d f(x) = 4x 2x x e g(x) = 4x 3x f y = x2(x + 3) 2 3 g y = 5 6x + x h f(x) = x + 8 i y = x2 x + 6 4 3 2 2 j y = 3x 8x + 6x + 5 k g(x) = x(x 27) l y = x3 + 4x2 3x 2 3 3 m h(x) = 12 x n g(x) = x (x 4) 2 WE3 Sketch the graph of each function in question 1 , clearly indicating all stationary points. 3 a WE3 Find the stationary points of the function f(x) = x3 2x2 7x 4 and state their nature. b Show that the graph passes through (4, 0). c Give the coordinates of all other intercepts and hence sketch the graph of f(x). 4 a Find the stationary points, and their nature, for the curve y = x3 x2 16x + 16. b Show that the graph passes through (1, 0) and give the coordinates of all other intercepts. c Sketch the graph. 5 a WE3 Find the stationary points of the function g(x) = x4 4x2 and state their nature. b Find the coordinates of all the intercepts. c Sketch the graph of g(x). 6 a b c d If y = x4 6x2 + 8x 3, find each stationary point and its nature. Show that the point (1, 0) lies on the curve. Find all other intercepts. Sketch the graph.
7 a If y = x4 + x3 5x2 6, find each stationary point and its nature. b Find the y-intercept. c Sketch the graph without finding the x-intercepts. 8 WE4 Sketch the graph of each of the following functions, clearly indicating all stationary points and intercepts. a f(x) = x4 x2 b f(x) = x3 3x2 3 4 c g(x) = x + 3x d g(x) = x3 4x2 + 4x 3 2 e h(x) = x 4x 11x + 30 f h(x) = x(x + 3)(x 5) g f(x) = x4 2x2 + 1 h f(x) = x(x2 + 1) 3 2 i g(x) = x + 9x + 24x + 20 j h(x) = (x2 1)3 9 MC If f(x) < 0 where x > 2 and f(x) > 0 where x < 2, then at x = 2, f(x) has a: A local minimum B local maximum c point of inflection D discontinuous point e gradient of 2
384
10 mC The function f (x) = x3 + x2 8x 3 has stationary points when x is equal to: A 2 and
4 3
B 3 only x4 x3
c 2 only
D 3 and
4 3
e 0 and 2
11 mC The graph of y = + has: A a local maximum where x = 0 B a local minimum where x = 0 c a local minimum where x =
3 4 3 4 4 3
12 mC A quadratic function has a turning point (2, 1) and a y-intercept of (0, 9). The equation must be: A y = (x 2)2 + 9 B y = (x 1)2 + 8 c y = (x 2)2 + 1 2 2 D y = 2(x 2) + 9 e y = 2(x 2) + 1 13 The graphs of f(x) are shown below. Find all values of x for which f (x) has stationary points and state their nature. y y y a b c
f ' (x) 2 0 3
f '(x) x
0 f'(x)
f '(x)
y f '(x)
2 f'(x)
0 1
14 Show that f (x) = x2 4x + 3 is decreasing for x < 2 and increasing for x > 2. 15 We5 For each of the following functions i sketch f(x) and, hence, state the values of x where f (x) is ii increasing and iii decreasing. a f (x) = 1 x3 + 2x2 + 2 b g(x) = x3 + 2x2 7x 5 c h(x) = x4 + 4x3 + 4x2 3 16 If y = f (x) has the following properties then sketch its graph. f(x) = 0 if x =2 and x = 3 f(x) < 0 if 2 < x < 3 f(x) > 0 for all other x 17 If f (x) = x3 + ax2 + bx has stationary points at x = 2 and x = 4 , find: 3 a the value of a and b b the nature of the stationary points.
eBook plus
Digital doc
18 If f (x) = x4 + ax2 + b has a stationary point (1, 4), find: a a and b b the other stationary points c the nature of each stationary point. 19 We6 Consider the function f ( x ) = (b x )( x + 2)2 where b is a positive real constant. a Find f (x). b Find the coordinates of the stationary points. c State the nature of the stationary points. d Find the equation of the tangent at x = 2. e If the maximum turning point occurs at x = 4, find the value of b.
385
SkillSHEET 8.1
Review of derivatives other than polynomials
Chapter 8
Applications of differentiation
20 WE6 Consider the function f ( x ) = ( x + b)2 (2 x 1) where b is a positive real constant. a Find f (x). b Find the coordinates of the stationary points. c Find the equation of the tangent to the curve when x = 2. d Find the value of b in exact form if the straight line with equation y = 4x 2 intersects y = f (x) at the minimum turning point.
8c
1 2 3 4 5
The function f(x) has a limited domain of [1, 5]. The maximum value occurs at the point where x = 4. The minimum value, however, is not at x = 2 but at the end point x = 5. This example shows that the derivative test on its own is not always reliable for finding maximum or minimum values and a graph is sometimes necessary.
386
Worked exAmple 7
The population of a colony of birds at any time, t months, after observation began can be modelled by the function: P(t) = 400 te 5 + 600, where P is the number of birds. Find: a the initial population b when the largest number of birds is reached c the maximum number of birds.
Think a
1 2
t
WriTe
Write the rule for P(t). The initial value occurs when t = 0 and is P(0).
a P(t) = 400te
t 5
+ 600
P(0) = + 600 = 0 + 600 = 600 So the initial population of birds is 600. 400(0)e0
b P(t) = 400te
t 5 t t 400 e 5 80te 5 t 80 e 5 (5 t)
+ 400t
( )
1 5
t 5
+0
= =
2
Solve P(t) = 0.
(5 t) = 0
t 5
t = 5 (as 80 e
3
cannot equal 0) 5 0 10 \
c P(5) = 400(5)e
+ 600 = 2000e 1 + 600 = 735.8 + 600 = 1335.8 Therefore the maximum number of birds is approximately 1335 (as it does not reach 1336).
5 5
Worked exAmple 8
eBook plus
Tutorial
The displacement of a particle moving in a straight line from the origin at any 3 2 time, t, is given by x(t) = 1 3 t 4t + 12 t + 1, 0 t 7. Find the maximum and minimum displacement.
int-0560
Worked example 8
Chapter 8
Applications of differentiation
387
Think
1 2 3
Write
x(t) =
t3 4t2 + 12t + 1 3
x(t) = t2 8t + 12 For maximum and/or minimum, t2 8t + 12 = 0 (t 2)(t 6) = 0 t = 2 or t = 6 Gradient table: x x(t) Slope 0 + / 2 0 4 \ 6 0 8 + /
Test for maximum and minimum using the first derivative test.
When t = 2 a local maximum occurs and when t=6 a local minimum occurs.
5
=8 16 + 24 + 1 3 = 11 3
2 2
Sketch the graph of x(t) over the domain [0, 7] to test that the maximum and minimum have been found.
This graph indicates that we have to find the value of x at the end points in case they produce larger or smaller values than the stationary points do.
x(t)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 t
Evaluate x(0) and x(7) to see if the end points give a smaller or larger value.
x(0) = 1 which is equal to the local minimum above x(7) = 1 (7)3 4(7)2 + 12(7) + 1 3 = 114 3 196 + 84 + 1
1 1
= 3 3 which is between the local maximum and minimum above. Therefore the maximum displacement is 2 11 3 units from the origin and the minimum displacement is 1 unit from the origin.
388
REMEMBER
1. To find a maximum and/or minimum, let f(x) = 0. 2. If the function has a restricted domain, f(x) may not be useful for finding maximum and/or minimum values. 3. You can prove your maximum and/or minimum value using a slope or gradient diagram. Exercise
8c
dC dx
b P = n3 + 2n2 5 n , d h = t3 + 2et, f L = t2 + dh dt
dP dn
dV dh dM e M = k loge 3k, dk
4 dL 2 cos (t), t dt
Q
Questions 2 and 3 refer to the following information. The function Q = n3 3n2 + 5, 0 n 5, is graphed at right. 2 MC The minimum value occurs where n equals: A 2 B 0 c 1 d 2 e 5 3 MC The maximum value occurs where n is equal to: A 0 b 2 c 5 d 1 e 1
4 WE7 The profit, $P per week, of a small manufacturing company is related to the number of workers, n, by: P = 1 n3 + 96n + 600 2 Find: a the number of workers needed for maximum profit per week b he maximum profit per week. 5 The cost, $C, of producing x-metre lengths of a certain tow rope is:
2 C=1 5 x 8x + 100 per rope, x > 0 What is the length of the cheapest tow rope that can be produced?
6 WE8 The number of people, P, visiting a certain beach on a particular day in January depends on the number of hours, x, that the temperature is below 30C according to the rule P = x3 12x2 + 21x + 105 where x 0. Find the value of x for the maximum and minimum number of people who visit the beach. 7 The number of rabbits, N, which feed on a particular farmland on any night can be modelled 3 as N = 1 x + 5x2 + 75x + 500 where x is the average overnight temperature in C and x 5. 3 Find: a the temperature for the minimum and maximum number of rabbits b the minimum and maximum number of rabbits that will be found on the farmland.
389
8 The velocity, v cm/s, of an engines piston t seconds after the engine is started is approximated by v = 0.8 sin (2t). a Find the minimum velocity and the time it first occurs. b Find the maximum velocity and the time it first occurs. 9 The length of a snake, L cm, at time t weeks after it is born is modelled as: t L = 12 + 6t + 2 sin , 0 t 20 4 Find: a the length at i birth and ii 20 weeks b R, the rate of growth, at any time, t c the maximum and minimum growth rate. 10 The population of cheetahs, P, in a national park in Africa since 1 January 1986 can be modelled as N = 100te 12 + 500 where t is the number of years. a When does this model predict that the maximum population will be reached? b What is the maximum population of cheetahs that will be reached? c How many cheetahs will there be on 1 January in i 2010 and ii 2070? 11 In the same park as in question 10 the number of elephants, N, since 1 January 1986 is modelled as N = 100 + 4t + 400 e 10 . Find: a the minimum number of elephants predicted b when this minimum will occur. 12 The profit, $P, per item that a store makes by selling n items of a certain type each day is P = 40 n + 25 200 2 n. a Find the number of items that need to be sold to maximise the profit on each item. b What is the maximum profit per item? c Hence, find the total profit per day by selling this number of items. 13 The weight (in kg) of a bodybuilder t months after starting a training program is W = 5t 20 loge (t + 1) + 90, 0 t 15 a Find the weight of the bodybuilder at the start of the program. b Find the minimum weight obtained and how many months it takes to reach it.
t t
8d
390
The following formulas may be useful in problem solving: Area of circle Curved surface area of a cylinder Surface area of a sphere Volume of a sphere Volume of a cylinder Volume of a cone Volume of a right pyramid Distance between two points
1
Worked Example 9
The sum of two positive numbers is 10. Find the numbers if the sum of their squares is a minimum.
Think
1 2 3 4 5 6
Write
Let one number be x and the other number be y. Form an equation. Express y in terms of x. Write an expression for S(x), the sum of thesquares of x and y, in terms of x only. Simplify the equation. Find S(x). Find x for minimum S by solving S(x) = 0.
Let x = 1st number and y = 2nd number. x + y = 10 So y = 10 x S(x) = x2 + y2 = x2 + (10 x)2 = x2 + 100 20x + x2 = 2x2 20x + 100
S(x) = 4x 20 Function has a stationary point when S(x) = 0 4x 20 = 0 4x = 20 x=5 Gradient table: x P(t) Slope 4 \ 5 0 6 + /
Find y.
When x = 5, y = 10 5 =5 Therefore, the two numbers which give a minimum of their squares are both 5.
Note: The actual sum was not asked for in this example.
391
Worked exAmple 10
eBook plus
Tutorial
A cuboid container with a base length twice its width is to be made with 48 m2 of metal. 8 2x a Show that the height is given by the expression h = , x 3 where x is the width of the base. b Express the volume, V, in terms of x. c Find the maximum volume.
Think a
1
int-0561
Worked example 10
WriTe
h x
2 3
2x
Let x be thewidth of the base and hence express length in terms of x. Calculate the total surface area (TSA) of the cuboid in terms of x and h only. Express h in terms of x.
Let x = width and h = height so length = 2x TSA = 2[2x(x) + 2x(h) + x(h)] = 2(2x2 + 3xh) = 4x2 + 6xh As TSA = 48 m2 4x2 + 6xh = 48 6xh = 48 4x2 h= = h= 48 4 x 2 6x 48 4 x 2 6x 6x 8 2x x 3
1 2
Find the volume, V, in terms of x and h. Express the volume in terms of x by substituting for h.
b V = x(2x)h
Solve V(x) = 0.
Substitute x = 2 into the rule for V(x) to obtain the maximum volume.
V(2) = 16(2) = 32
32 3
4(2)3 3
= 32 10 2 3 = 21 1 3
1
Worked Example 11
Find the minimum distance from the straight line with equation y = x 4 to the point (1, 1).
y 1 P (1, 1) y=x4 x
0 1 4 Think
1
4 Q (x, y)
Write
The minimum distance between a straight line and a point is a perpendicular line from a point on the straight line, Q (x, y) to the point P (1, 1). From the given rule for the straight line, find y in terms of x. Find the distance, d(x) between P and Q in terms of x only using the formula for the distance between 2 points.
As Q is on the line y = x 4 then Q is (x, x 4). d(x) = ( x2 x1 )2 + ( y2 y1 )2 = ( x 1)2 + ( x 4 1)2 = ( x 1)2 + ( x 5)2 = x 2 2 x + 1 + x 2 10 x + 25 = 2 x 2 12 x + 26
Differentiate d(x) using the chain rule (or differentiate the expression inside the square root only, as the smallest value of this expression will give the minimum distance when the square root is taken).
1 d (2 x 2 12 x + 26) 2 dx
1 (2 x 2 12 x + 26) 2
1
2 2 x 2 12 x + 26
393
For maximum or minimum, 4 x 12 =0 2 2 x 2 12 x + 26 4x 12 = 0 4x = 12 x=3 Gradient table: x Derivative (4x 12) Slope 2 \ 3 0 4 + /
Evaluate d(3) to obtain the minimum distance. The exact answer is 8 and 2.828 is an approximate answer.
or
REMEMBER
1. Express the quantity being maximised or minimised in terms of one variable only. 2. Find the derivative and let it equal zero to find the maximum or minimum. 3. Test for maximum and/or minimum using the first derivative test (gradient table). 4. Use exact answers where appropriate. If using an approximate answer show by use of the symbol. 5. Ensure you have answered the question asked. Exercise
8d
394
5 Cylindrical, cardboard postal tubes are made with the restriction that the sum of the length and the circular circumference are 120cm. What should the dimensions be for maximum volume?
Length
Circumference
6 The frame of a container in the shape of a cuboid is shown at right. If it is to be made with a total length of 18 metres of steel edging, find: a the value of L in terms of x 2x b the expression for the volume in terms of x only c the length of each edge for maximum volume d the maximum volume. a Show that the height, h =
7 WE10 A cuboid with a square base is to be made with 200 cm2 of material. 50 x , where x is the side length of the base. x 2 b Express the volume, V, in terms of x. c Find the maximum volume (to the nearest unit).
8 A window frame is in the shape of a semicircle joined to a rectangle. Find the maximum area of a window using 300 cm of framework. 9 A rectangular sheet of cardboard, 50 cm by 40 cm, is to have square corners cut out so it can be folded into a rectangular tray. Find the maximum volume possible for such a tray.
50 cm 40 cm
10 A bushwalker can walk at 5 km/h through clear land and 3 km/h through bushland. If she has to get from point A to point B following a route indicated at right, find the value of x so that the route is covered in a minimum time. (Note: time = distance ) speed
3 km
B Clear x
Bush
2 km
11 The cost of running a train at a constant speed of v km/h is C = 50 + a Find the time taken for an 800 km journey in terms of v. b Hence, find an expression for the cost of an 800 km journey. c Find the most economical speed for this journey. 12 Find the side length of the largest cube which can fit inside a sphere of diameter 24cm.
v2 dollars/hour. 1000
24 cm
395
13 A cylinder of cheese is to be removed from a spherical piece of cheese of radius 8 cm. What is the maximum volume of the cylinder of cheese? (Express the answer to the nearest unit.)
8 cm
14 We11 Find the minimum distance from the line y = 2x +3 to the point (1, 0).
eBook plus
Digital doc
WorkSHEET 8.2
15 Find the minimum distance from the parabola y = to the point (5, 0). (Express the answer to the nearest hundredth.) x2
(5, 0) 5 x
eBook plus
Interactivity
8e
rates of change
P (x1, f (x1)) and Q (x2, f (x2)) are two points on the function with rule y = f (x) as shown in the diagram.
y y = f(x) Q (x2, f(x2))
int-0253
Rates of change
P (x1, f(x1)) 0 x1 x2 x
The average rate of change of y with respect to x over the interval x [ x1, x2] is equal to the gradient of the straight line (or chord) PQ. Average rate of change = = change in f ( x ) change in x
f ( x2 ) f ( x1 ) x2 x1 The instantaneous rate of change is the rate of change at a specific point. dy The instantaneous rate of change of y with respect to x is given by the derivative . dx dy If > 0, then y is increasing as x increases (gradient is positive). dx dy If < 0, then y is decreasing as x increases (gradient is negative). dx
396
Note: Rates of change are often calculated with respect to time, but not always. If you are required to find the rate of change with respect to some quantity other than time then the quantity must be stated. If this quantity is not stated then the rate of change is taken as being with respect to time.
Worked exAmple 12 a Find the rate of change of the surface area of a melting ice cube with respect to its side length (x). b What is the rate of change when x = 2 cm? (Assume that the ice cube remains in the shape of
a cube.)
Think a
1
WriTe
Express the surface area, S, of the cube in terms of its side length, x. Find dS . dx
2 3
dS = 12x dx But dS = 12x because the surface area is decreasing. dx x=2 dS = 12(2) dx =24
Place a negative sign in front of the rate as the ice cube is melting (that is, the rate is decreasing). dS Substitute x = 2 into . dx
b When
Therefore, the rate of change of the surface area when x =2 cm is 24 cm2/cm (it is decreasing at a rate of 24 cm2/cm).
Worked exAmple 13
eBook plus
Tutorial
The number of mosquitoes, N, around a dam on a certain night can be modelled by the equation N = 100 loge (2t + 1) +5t + 1000
a b c d
int-0562
Worked example 13
where t equals hours after sunset. Find: the initial number of mosquitoes the average rate of change in the first 4 hours the rate of change at any time, t the rate of change when t = 4 hours.
Think a
1 2
WriTe
When t = 0, N = 100 loge (2 0 + 1) + 5 0 + 1000 = 100 loge 1 + 1000 = 100 0 + 1000 = 1000 The initial number of mosquitoes is 1000.
Chapter 8
Applications of differentiation
397
Find N when t = 4.
b When t = 4,
N = 100 loge (2 4 + 1) + 5 4 + 1000 = 100 loge (9) + 20 + 1000 = 1020 + 100 loge (9) = 1020 + 219.7 = 1239.7 that is, 1239 mosquitoes (as the number has not reached 1240). The average rate of change in the first 4 hours 1239 1000 = 40 239 4 = 59.75 mosquitoes per hour. =
dN . dt
dN 100 2 = +5 dt 2t + 1 = 200 +5 2t + 1
d Find
dN when t = 4. dt
dN 200 = +5 dt 2 4 1 =
200 9
+5
rememBer
1. The average rate of change is the gradient of a straight line between two points. f ( x2 ) f ( x1 ) . x2 x1 3. The instantaneous rate of change at any point is given by the value of the derivative at that point. 2. The average rate of change = exerCiSe
8e
rates of change
In the following exercise, use a CAS calculator to assist with any graphing. 1 Express the following in simplest mathematical notation. a The rate of change of volume, V, with respect to radius, r. b The rate of change of surface area, S, with respect to height, h. c The rate of change of area, A, with respect to time, t.
eBook plus
Digital doc
SkillSHEET 8.2
Review of rates of change
398
d The rate of change of cost, C, with respect to distance, x. e The rate of change of intensity, I, with respect to pressure p. f The rate of change of velocity.
WE12 a Find the rate of change of the area, A = r2, of an increasing circular oil spill with 2 respect to the radius, r. b What is the rate of change when r = 10 metres?
r3, of a deflating spherical balloon with 3 a Find the rate of change of the volume, V = 4 3 respect to the radius, r. b Hence, find the rate when r = 5 cm.
4 A sugar cube dissolves in a cup of tea. Find the rate of decrease of its surface area, S, when the side length, x, is 0.5 cm. 5 The height of a projectile t seconds after being fired is h = 10 + 20t 5t2 metres. a Find the rate of change of height after i 1 second and ii 3 seconds. b Explain the difference between these two answers. 6 The volume of water (in litres) which has flowed through a swimming pool filter t minutes t4 1 (30t3 ) where 0 t 90. after starting it is V = 100 4 a At what rate is water flowing through the filter at any time, t? dV over the domain [0, 90]. b Sketch a graph of dt c When is the rate of flow greatest? 7 A particle moves in a straight line so that its displacement from a point, O, at any time, t, is x = 3t 2 + 4 . Find: a the velocity as a function of time b the acceleration as a function of time c the velocity and acceleration when t = 2. 8 If a particle is moving in a straight line so that its displacement from the origin at any time, t, is x = t3 12t2 + 36t, find: a the velocity b the time and displacement when the velocity is zero c the acceleration when the velocity is zero. 9 WE13 The number of people with the flu virus, N, in a particular town t days after a vaccine is introduced is N = 3000 500 loge (8t + 1). a How many people are infected in the town before the vaccine is introduced? b Find the average rate of change over the first 5 days. c Find the rate of change of the number of people in the town infected with flu. d Find the rate of change after 5 days. 10 MC If V = t3 2t2 + 8 t , where V is in m3 and t is in hours a the rate of change of V with respect to t when t = 4 is: B 32 m3/h c 28 m3/h d 34 m3/h e 20 m3/h A 48 m3/h b the average rate of change from t = 1 to t = 4 is: m3/h B 10 1 m3/h c 3 m3/h d 10 1 m3/h e 0 m3/h A 13 2 3 3 3 11 MC Temperature, TC, is related to height, h metres, by T = h2 + 4eh. a The rate of change, C/m, at h = 0 is: A 0 b 4 c 4e d 4e e 1
Chapter 8 Applications of differentiation 399
c 8 + 4e4
c The average rate of change between h = 0 and h = 4 in C/m is: A 1 + e4 b e4 c 12 + 4e4 D 4 + e4 e 3 + e4 12 The height of water (in metres) at the entrance to a bay t hours after high tide is: t H = 10 + 2 cos 12
Find: a the rate of change of H at any time, t b the rate of change of H: i 6 hours ii 15 hours iii 20 hours after high tide c the minimum and maximum value of H and the time when they first occur after the initial high tide. 13 The value of an antique ornament t years after being purchased is A = 2000 e 0.1 t dollars. a Find the value of the antique i when purchased and ii 3 years after purchase. b Hence, find the average rate of change of value in the 3 years since purchased. c Find the rate of change of value 3 years after purchase. 20 14 The amount of chlorine in a jug of water t hours after it was filled from a tap is C = , t +1 where C is in millilitres. Find the rate of decrease of chlorine 9 hours after being poured. 15 The graph below shows the price of the shares of a particular company over a period of time.
Price () 180 170 160 150 140 130 120 0 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 t (months)
Use the graph to estimate the answers to the following questions. a Estimate the share price when t = 5. b State the time interval over which the share price was decreasing. c Find the average rate of change of the share prices over the entire period shown on the graph. d Estimate the rate of change of the share price at t = 11. e What was the maximum share price over the period shown? f When was the share price at its lowest value?
400 Maths Quest 12 Mathematical Methods CAS for the TI-Nspire
16 The graph below shows how the velocity of a car varies over a period of time.
v (m/s) 14 12 10 8 6 4 2 0 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 t (s)
Usethegraphtoestimatetheanswerstothefollowingquestions. a Estimate the velocity of the car at t = 12. b Estimate the acceleration of the car at t = 5. c State the time intervals over which the car is accelerating. d What was the average rate of change of velocity of the car over the interval [4, 8]?
8F
related rates
eBook plus
eLesson
When two variables are both functions of the third variable, we may need to Related rates use related rates to solve the problem. For example, we may need to dx dy dx dx dy find when given . In such instances we would need to use the chain rule: = . dt dt dt dy dt When solving problems involving related rates, the following steps may be helpful: 1. Draw a diagram where appropriate. Sometimes two or more diagrams may be necessary. 2. Identify the variables. 3. Identify which rate is given and which rate is required. 4.Usethechainruletoconnecttherequiredandgivenrates. 5. Find an equation, or relationship, that connects the variables if not given. 6. Differentiate the equation. 7. Substitute into the chain rule and simplify. 8. Answer the question noting correct units. Tools for finding relationships: similartriangles Pythagorastheorem right-angledtriangletrigonometry sineandcosinerules.
Worked exAmple 14
eBook plus
eles-0094
An ice cube is melting at a constant rate of 2 per hour. At what rate is the side length of the cube changing when the side length is 1.2 cm?
Think
1
cm3
Tutorial
int-0563
Worked example 14
WriTe
We are given the rate of change of volume with respect to time. Write it using appropriate notation. Since the volume is decreasing, the rate is negative.
dV = 2 dt
Chapter 8
Applications of differentiation
401
2 3
State the rate of change that needs to be found. Use the chain rule to connect the rate that we need to find with the one that is given. We do not know dx . To find it, we need the dV rule that connects x and V, that is, the rule that connects the side length of the cube with its volume. So write the formula for the volume of the cube. Differentiate. Reciprocate both sides to obtain dx . dV Substitute 1 2 for dx and (2) for dv into the dV dt 3x chain rule and simplify.
Need to find
dx when x = 1.2 dt
5 6
dV = 3x2 dx dx 1 = 2 dV 3 x dx 1 = 2 (2) dt 3 x =
2
3x 2
We now have the formula that allows us to find the rate of change of the side length for any value of x. To find the rate of change when length is 1.2 cm, simply substitute 1.2 for x into this formula and evaluate. State the answer, adding appropriate units.
25 54
Worked Example 15
An empty inverted right circular cone has a radius of 4 cm and a height of 20 cm. Water is being poured in at a constant rate of 0.1 cm3/second. Find the rate at which the depth of the water is increasing at the instant the depth is 6 cm. Give your answer correct to 2 decimal places.
Think
1
Write 4 cm
r cm h cm
20 cm
402
Use the chain rule to connect the rate that we need to find with the one that is given. Find a rule that connects volume, V with the depth of water, h. Use similar triangles to connect r and h.
Depth of the water, h cm Radius, r cm, of surface of the water Time, t seconds Volume, V cm3 dV = 0.1 cm3/second dt dh Find when h = 10 cm. dt dh dh dV = dt dV dt 1 V = r 2h 3 r 4 = h 20 h r= 5 1 h V = h 3 5 V=
2
dh by taking reciprocals of both sides. dV Substitute into the Chain Rule and simplify. Obtain
Substitute h = 6 cm to find the required rate of change. State the answer with appropriate units.
dh = 0.02 cm/second (correct to dt 2 decimal places) The depth of water is increasing at a rate of 0.02 cm/second when the depth is 6 cm.
REMEMBER
dx dx dy 1. To solve a problem involving related rates, use the chain rule, for example: = . dt dy dt 2. Show appropriate units.
403
Exercise
8F
Related rates
1 WE14 A gym fitness ball is being inflated and its volume is increasing at a constant rate of 5cm3 per second. At what rate is the radius of the ball changing when the radius is 34 cm? 2 A particle moves along a path that can be described using the Cartesian equation y = 3x3 2x + 1. If dy dx = 3 when x = 5, find at that moment. dt dt
3 The surface area of a cube is decreasing at a constant rate of 9 cm2/s. Find the rate at which the sides of the cube are decreasing when the sides are 1.5 cm long. 4 A spherical balloon is being deflated and its radius, r cm, is decreasing at a constant rate of 5 cm/min. At what rate is its volume, V cm3, decreasing when the radius of the balloon is 4 cm? 5 A bowl is being filled with water at a rate of 12 cm3/s. The volume, V cm3, of water in the bowl is given by V = 8h 2 where the depth of water in the bowl is h cm. Find the rate at which the depth of water in the bowl is increasing when the depth is 9 cm. 6 The radius of a circular puddle of water is increasing at a rate of 2.5 cm/s. Find the exact rate at which the area is increasing at the instant the radius is 12 cm. 7 MC A cylinder with radius of 4 m is being filled with water. If the rate of change of the depth 1 of the water is m/s, the rate of change of volume, in m3/s, in the cylinder is: 8 1 1 1 A B 2 c 2 d e 2 2 2 108 8 WE15 An inverted right circular cone is filled with liquid. The cone has a radius of 3 m and height of 7 m. The liquid flows from the apex of the cone at a constant rate of 0.6 m3/min. Find the rate at which the depth of the liquid is dropping, correct to 2 decimal places, when the depth of the liquid is 2 m. 9 The upper end of an 8 m ladder rests against a vertical wall with the lower end on the horizontal ground. The lower end of the ladder on the ground slips away from the wall at a rate of 6 m/s. Find the rate at which the upper end of the ladder is moving the instant the ladder is 4 m from the wall. 10 A stainless steel cylindrical tank of radius 6 m is being filled with milk at a constant rate of 1.5 m3/min. At what rate is the level of milk rising? Give your answer in terms of . 11 A sand timer consists of two cones joined at the apex. Each cone has height h, radius r and an angle at the apex of 60. a Express the radius of the top cone in terms of its height. Give your answer in exact form. b Write the volume of the top cone as a function of its height. c When the timer is turned over, the sand starts pouring from the top cone into the bottom 1 one at a constant rate of 32 cm3/s. Find the rate of change of the depth of the sand in the top cone when the depth is 0.8 cm.
5
8G
Linear approximation
It is useful to be able to find how much a small change in the independent variable affects the dependent variable. For example, how will a small increase in the radius of a circle affect the area of a circle?
404
B y A y = f(x + h) f(x)
x =h
Consider the function y = f (x) as shown with the points A (x, f (x)) and B (x + h, f (x + h)). The gradient of the chord AB = f ( x + h) f ( x ) . If h is very small, the gradient of the chord is h
very close to the gradient of the tangent at the point A (x, f (x)). f '( x ) f ( x + h) f ( x ) h
h f '( x ) f ( x + h) f ( x ) f ( x + h) f ( x ) + h f '( x ) The formula f ( x + h) f ( x ) + h f '( x ) is called the linear approximation formula. Alternatively, if a small change in y, y, corresponds to a small change in x, x, then y x dy where y f ( x + h) f ( x ). dx dy y . dx x
If y is the small change in a quantity, y, the percentage change (or error) in y is given by h f '( x ) y 100% . 100% or f ( x) y
Worked Example 16
Use the approximation formula, f(x + h) f(x) + hf'(x), with f(x) = x2 and x = 1 to find an approximate value of (1.01)2.
Think
1 2 3
Write
Write f(x), f'(x), x and h. Find x + h and hence f(x + h). Write the formula and hence find the value of 1.012.
f(x) = x2, f'(x) = 2x, x = 1 and h = 0.01 x + h = 1.01 and f(x + h) = (x + h)2 = 1.012 f(x + h) f (x) + hf'(x) 1.012 12 + 0.01 2 1.012 1.02
405
Worked Example 17
A circular metal disc is being cooled. If the radius is decreased from 10 cm to 9.8 cm, find correct to 2 decimal places: a the approximate change in the area b the percentage change in the area.
Think a
1 2 3
Write
Write the relationship between area and radius. Write A(r), r and h. Write the approximation formula and substitute.
A(r) = r2 A(r) = 2r, r = 10 cm, h = 0.2 A(r + h) A(r ) + hA'(r ) A(9.8) A(10) 0.2 A'(10) Change in A A(9.8) A(10) 0.2 20 Area decreases by 12.57 cm2 correct to 2 decimal places.
State the answer with correct units. Write the change in area as fraction of the original area, expressing as a percentage. State the answer.
1 2
REMEMBER
8G
Linear approximation
1 WE16 Use the approximation formula, f(x + h) f'(x)h + f (x), with each of the following. a For f (x) = x3 and x = 1, find 1.013. b For f (x) = x2 and x = 1, find 0.9992. c For f (x) = 5x2 and x = 1, find 5 0.992. d For f (x) = x and x = 1, find 1.001 2 If a spherical balloon has a radius of 5 cm, find the increase in volume of the balloon when the radius expands by 0.02 cm. 3 A circular disc has a radius of 10 cm. Find the percentage increase in its area if the radius is increased by 2%. 4 WE17 An isosceles triangle has its equal sides of length 10 cm with an included angle of as shown in the diagram.
10 cm 10 cm
406
If changes from 60 to 61, find, correct to 2 decimal places: a the approximate area of the triangle when = 61 b the approximate increase in the area, A, of the triangle. 5 MC If f (x) = x2 and x = 3, an approximate value of (2.9)2 is given by: A f (3) + 0.1 f '(3) B f (2.9) + 0.1 f '(2.9) C f (3) f (2.9) D f (2.9) 0.1 f '(2.9) E f (3) 0.1 f '(3) 6 The volume, V cm3, of a gas is inversely proportional to the pressure, P atmospheres, of a gas, k that is, V = where k is a constant (that depends on the mass of the gas and the P temperature). If the pressure of the gas increases from 2 atmospheres to 2.25 atmospheres, find the approximate change in the volume of the gas in terms of k. Hence find the corresponding percentage change in the volume. 2 7 Find the approximate change in x as y decreases from 2 to 1.5 if f ( x ) = . x4 8 The length of a rectangle is four times its width. If the width increases by 5%, find the corresponding percentage change in the perimeter and area of the rectangle.
407
Summary
Stationary points
A function f(x) has stationary points wherever its derivative f(x) = 0. If f(a) = 0, then f(x) has a stationary point (a, f(a)) which is: 1. a local minimum turning point if: for x < a, f(x) < 0 and x > a, f(x) > 0. 2. a local maximum turning point if: for x < a, f(x) > 0 and x > a, f(x) < 0. 3. a positive stationary point of inflection if: for x < a, f(x) > 0 and x > a, f(x) > 0. 4. a negative stationary point of inflection if: for x < a, f(x) < 0 and x > a, f(x) < 0.
Equations of tangents and normals
The gradient of the tangent at x = a to the curve y = f(x) is f(a). 1 The gradient of the normal at x = a to the curve y = f(x) is . f'(a) The equation of a straight line with gradient m and passing through the point (x1, y1) is: y y1 = m(x x1)
Maximum and minimum problems
When solving maximum or minimum problems follow these steps. 1. Draw a diagram if appropriate. 2. Identify the quantity to be maximised or minimised (say, f(x)). 3. Express the quantity in terms of one variable only (say x). 4. Solve f(x) = 0. 5. Verify it is a maximum or minimum using the first derivative test. 6. Sketch a graph to confirm the maximum or minimum found. 7. Answer the question.
Rates of change
The instantaneous rate of change of y = f(x) at x = x1 is found by evaluating f(x1) (or finding x = x1). The average rate of change of y = f(x) between x = x1 and x = x2 is: f ( x2 ) f ( x1 ) . x2 x1
dy where dx
408
Related rates
To solve a problem involving related rates, use the chain rule, for example
Linear approximation
dx dx dy = . dt dy dt
409
chapter review
Short answer
1 Determine the stationary points and their nature for the function f(x) = 2x3 + 3x2 36x + 5. 2 Sketch the graph of y = x2(4 x2), clearly indicating all stationary points and intercepts.8B 3 Find the equation of the tangent to the curve y = 6 3x + 2x2 x3 at the point where x = 1. 4 Find the equation of the tangent to the curve y = 3 loge (x2) (x 0) which is parallel to the line y 3x 7 = 0. 5 Find the equation of the normals to the curve 1 y = x + at the point where the normals are x parallel to the line 3y + 4x 10 = 0.C 6 The number of bees, N, in a hive can be modelled by the function N = 2t(50 t) + 180 where t is the number of days the hive has existed. What is the maximum number of bees in the hive? 7 The area of a certain triangular shape is: A= 2x2 ,x>6 3( x 6)
9 P is the point on the line 2x + y 10 = 0 such that the length of OP, the line segment from the origin O to P, is a minimum. Find the coordinates of P and this minimum length.
Exam tip Students failed to recognise this as a maximum/minimum question. A common, incorrect response was to find intercepts (0, 10) and (5, 0) on the line then use the distance between two points to
find the distance to be 5 5. Other common, incorrect responses involved taking P as the midpoint of the line, guessing and checking solutions without justification, incorrectly differentiating the distance equation, or using an incorrect diagram.
[Assessment report 1 2007]
[ VCAA 2007]
10 A normal to the graph of y = x has the equation y= 4x + a, where a is a real constant. Find the value of a.
Exam tip Students found this question quite challenging, and a significant number seemed to have little or no idea of what was required. Many were able to find the correct derivative but did not know how to proceed, or equated the derivative to 4 1 instead of 4 . Students who got to this point without error often did not solve correctly for x or y or both. It was not uncommon to see two values found for x and y and therefore two values for a, 18 and 14.
[Assessment report 1 2006]
where x is the length of the base of the triangle. a Find the value of x for minimum area. b Hence, find the minimum area. 8 A wine glass is being filled with wine at a rate of 8cm3/s. The volume, V cm3, of wine in the glass when the depth of wine in the glass is x cm is given by V = Find the rate at which the depth of wine in the glass is increasing when the depth is 4cm.
Exam tip Some students had difficulty deciding on how to label variables; x was sometimes interchangeable with d or h and little or no consistency was evident through the question. Most students were able to correctly differentiate V with respect to x but then either incorrectly used the chain rule or could not manage the arithmetic required. Common errors were to simply substitute 4 into V or to substitute into the derivative.
[Assessment report 1 2007]
[ VCAA 2006]
3 4x 2.
Multiple choice
1 The graph of y = (x + 2)3 has: A 1 turning point B 2 turning points C 1 point of inflection D 2 points of inflection E 0 stationary points 2 The graph of x3 + 2x2 + x 2 has: A 2 points of inflection B 1 point of inflection C 1 turning point and 1 point of inflection D 3 turning points E 2 turning points
[ VCAA 2007]
410
3 The graph of 1 x3 4x2 9x + 5 has a local 3 maximum turning point at: A (1, 9 3 ) B (9, 20) C (9, 18) d (1, 10 2 )E (1, 7 1 ) 3 3 4 If the graph of g(x) has the following properties: i g'(x) = 0 if x = 3, 1 and 4 ii g'(x) < 0 if x < 3 and 1 < x < 4 iii g'(x) > 0 for all other x then the graph of g(x) could be: A
y g(x) 3 0 1 y 4 x
2
7 The equation of the normal to the curve y = 3ex + 2 at the point where x = 2 is: A 3y + x 7 = 0 B 3y x + 7 = 0 C y 3x 9 = 0 d y 3x 3 = 0 E y + 3x 9 = 0 8 The tangent to the curve y = 2 loge (3 2x) at the point where x = 1 intercepts with the y-axis at the point where y equals: A 1 B 3 C 0 D 2 E 4 9 The graph of f(x) y shown at right f '(x) indicates that the graph of f(x) has: x A a turning point at 0 4 2 x = 2 and x = 4 B a turning point at x = 2 and point of inflection at x = 4 C a turning point at x = 4 and point of inflection at x = 2 D 3 stationary points E 2 points of inflection at x = 4 and x = 2 Questions 10 and 11 refer to the following information. The volume of liquid in a container varies with time according to the rule V = 1 + t2et, where t is in hours and V is in thousands of litres, and 0 t 40. 10 The minimum value of V occurs when t equals: A 1 hour B 2 hours C 0 hours d 3 hours E 40 hours
01
4 g(x)
y g(x) 3 0 y g(x) 3 01 4 x x
11 The maximum volume, to the nearest tens of litres,is: A 1450 B 1540 C 1390 d 1360 E 1630 Questions 12 to 16 follow from the isosceles triangle below which has a perimeter of 40 cm.
g(x) 3 01 4 x
5 The equation of a line with a gradient of 2 and passing through the point (1, 3) is: A y = 2x + 5B y = 2x C y = 2x 1 d y = 2x 5E y = x + 1 6 The equation of the tangent to the curve y = x (x + 2)(x 1) at the point where x = 1 is: A y x + 1 = 0 B y x + 3 = 0 C y + x + 3 = 0 d y + x 1 = 0 E y x 1 = 0
8D
13 The height of the triangle in terms of x is: A 400 40 x C E 400 40 x + 2 x 2 40 x B x 400 40 x + x 2 D x 400 40 x B 20 40 x D 400 40 x + x 2
17 The average rate of change of the function f(x) = x4 3x3 + 5x between x = 1 and x = 3 is: A 15 B 6 C 12 d 4 1 E 16 2 18 An iceberg in the shape of a cube is slowly melting. The rate of change of the surface area of the iceberg in m3/m when the side length is 40 metres is: A 480 B -240 C 720 d -480 E 240 19 The radius of a sphere is increasing at a rate of 3 cm/min. When the radius is 6 cm, the rate of increase of the volume, in cm3/min, in the sphere is: A 432 B 48 C 144 d 108 E 16 [ VCAA 2006] 20 Using the approximation formula f ( x + h) f ( x ) + hf '( x ) , with f(x) = x3 and x = 2, an approximate value of (1.8)3 is given by: A f (2) + 0.2 f '(2) B f (1.8) + 0.2 f '(1.8) C f (2) f (1.8) d f (2) 0.2 f '(2) E f (1.8) 0.2 f '(1.8) [ VCAA 2004]
14 The area in terms of x is: A ( 20 x ) 400 40 x C 2 x 400 40 x + x 2 E 2 x 400 40 x 15 The maximum area of the triangle is obtained if x equals: A 6 2 cm B 10 cm C 20 cm 3 d 5 cm A 50 2 cm2 d 40 3 9 e 10 2 cm 5 B 64 cm2 400 3 E 9 C 32 5 cm2 16 Therefore, the maximum area possible is:
Extended response
1 Consider the cone with a slant side of 10 cm shown at right. a Show that the height, h, is 100 r 2 . b Show that the volume of the cone is V = 1 r2 100 r 2 . 3 c Hence, find the maximum volume.
h 10 cm
r 2 The number of bacteria present in a lasagne, t minutes after it is placed in a microwave to heat up, can be modelled by N = 3000e 0.5t, where t > 0. a Find the initial number of bacteria. b Find the rate of change of bacteria after being in the microwave for 10 minutes. 3 The height above the ground of a person on a ferris wheel at any time, t, seconds after the ride has t started is h=5.4 4 cos metres. 15 a Find the initial height of the person above ground level. d (m) b Find the height after 5 seconds. 700 c Hence, find the average rate of change of height during the first 5 seconds. 600 d Find the rate of change of height at t = 5. 500 4 Lena is walking in the park. The graph at right shows her 400 displacement from the park entrance over a period of time. a Estimate Lenas displacement from the park entrance at t = 20. 300 b Find Lenas average velocity over the interval [20, 30]. 200 c What was Lenas maximum displacement from her starting 100 point? d Estimate Lenas velocity at t = 15. 0 5
10 15 20 25 30 35 t(min)
412
5 A manufacturing company is required to produce cylindrical cans (for tuna) of volume 50 cm3. Tinused to produce the cans costs 40 cents per 100cm2. a Find the area of tin required, A, in terms of the radius, r. b Find the radius of the can (to the nearest tenth) for minimum area. c Hence, find the minimum area (to the nearest tenth). d What is the cost of tin to produce 10 000 such cans? 6 A small manufacturing company needs to order new cardboard boxes for packaging their product. Each box is to be in the shape of a prism with a square end w and is to have a volume of 27 000 cm3. To hold each box together, tape is used all around the box as shown in the diagram at right. w l a Express the length of the box (l) in terms of its width (w). b Write the formula for the total area of cardboard (A) in terms of w. c Find the dimensions of the box which uses the least amount of cardboard. d Write the formula for the total length of the tape (L) in terms of w. (Ignore the width of the tape and any overlaps.) e Find the dimensions of the box that uses the least amount of tape. f The cardboard used to make the boxes costs 0.01 cents per square centimetre, and the tape can be purchased at $0.50 per metre. Write the formula for the total cost (in cents) of the package (that is, the cost of the cardboard and tape) in terms of w. g Find the dimensions of the box with the minimum total cost. h Find the minimum total cost to the nearest cent. 7 The cross-section of a pencil head when it is first placed in a sharpening device is shown at right. The gradient of the tangent at point A is 4. The equation of the pencil head is y = 4x2. If the x- and y-axes are as indicated and all distances are in centimetres, find: a the coordinates of points A and B b the equation of the tangent to the curve y = 4x2 at point A c the coordinate of point C d the minimum distance from the pencil head to point C e the length of the pencil head if it starts at the point where the normal at point A meets the y-axis.
y Pencil head B 0 C A Tangent x y = 4x2
8 The population of rabbits on a particular island t weeks after a virus is introduced is modelled by P= 1200e 0.1t, where P is the number of rabbits. Find: a the time taken for the population to halve (to the nearest week) b the rate of decrease of the population after: i 2 weeks and ii 10 weeks. After 15 weeks the virus has become ineffective and the population of rabbits starts to increase again according to the model P = P0 + 10(t 15) loge (2t 29) where t is the number of weeks since the virus was first introduced. Find: c the value of P0 d the population after 30 weeks e the rate of change of the population after i 20 weeks and ii 30 weeks f how many weeks the population takes to get back to its original number.
413
9 After washing the kitchen floor, Alex put his favourite mop flat against the wall and left it there. A few minutes later, the mop starts to slide down the wall. Let h be the height of the top end of the mop above the floor and let y be the horizontal distance of h the bottom end of the mop from the wall at any time, t. a If the mop is 1.2 m tall, express y in terms of x. b If the top end of the mop slides down with a constant speed of 5 cm per second, find the speed (in terms of h) with which the bottom end of the mop moves away y from the wall. c Find the speed with which the bottom end of the mop moves away from the wall when the top of the mop: i is 0.8 m from the floor ii has slid down by 20 cm. d Find the speed with which the bottom end of the mop moves away from the wall 6 seconds after the top of the mop started sliding down. 10 Consider the function f ( x ) = ( x 3)( x + 2a)2 where a is a positive real constant. a Find f (x). b Find the coordinates of the stationary points. c Determine the nature of the stationary points. d Find the equation of the tangent at x = 2. e Find the x-intercept of the tangent. 11 Consider the function y = (x2 a)2 where a R. dy a Find at x = 2. dx b Find the equation of the tangent to the curve at x = 2 in terms of a. c Hence find the x-intercept of the tangent line in terms of a. d A straight line with equation y = 2x + 1 passes through the x-intercept of the tangent line. Find the value of a. e Usingthevalueofa found previously, what is the equation of the tangent line?
eBook plus
Digital doc
Test Yourself
Chapter 8
414
eBook plus
ACTiviTieS
chapter opener
Digital doc
10 Quick Questions: Warm up with ten quick questions on applications of differentiation. (page 373)
8A
Tutorial
We 2 int-0558: Watch a worked example on finding equations of tangents and normals. (page 374)
Digital docs
Spreadsheet 129: Investigate tangents and normals. (page 375) WorkSHEET 8.1: Find stationary points and their nature and equations of normals and tangents. (page 376)
8B
Tutorial
Tutorial
Sketching curves
We 13 int-0562: Watch a worked example on application of rates of change and average rates of change. (page 397)
Digital doc
We 3 int-0559: Watch a worked example on sketching curves and finding stationary points. (page 378)
Digital doc
SkillSHEET 8.1: Practise differentiating expressions other than polynomials. (page 385)
8c
Tutorial
Related rates: Learn about using differentiation for related rates. (page 401)
Tutorial
We 8 int-0560: Watch a worked example on applications of maximum and minimum problems. (page 387)
8D
Tutorial
We 14 int-0563: Watch a worked example on using related rates to determine an instantaneous rate of change. (page 401)
8G Linear approximation
chapter review
Digital doc
Test Yourself: Take the end-of-chapter test to test your progress. (page 414)
To access eBookPLUS activities, log on to www.jacplus.com.au
Rates of change: Consolidate your understanding of applying differentiation techniques by riding and rolling. (page 396)
Chapter 8
Applications of differentiation
415
9
Integration
areaS of STudy
9A 9B 9C 9D 9E 9F 9G 9H 9I 9J
Antidifferentiation Integration of ex, sin (x) and cos (x) Integration by recognition Approximating areas enclosed by functions The fundamental theorem of integral calculus Signed areas Further areas Areas between two curves Average value of a function Further applications of integration
Antiderivatives of polynomial functions and of f (ax + b), where f is xn for n Q, ex, sin (x), cos (x) or linear combinations of these Definition of the definite integral as the limiting value of a sum f ( x ) dx = lim
a b
f ( xi* ) xi, x0
i =1
where the interval [a, b] is partitioned into n subintervals, with the ith subinterval of length xi and containing xi*, and x = max{xi: i = 1, 2, n} and evaluation of numerical approximations based on this definition Informal approximation using areas under curves by left and right rectangles Examples of the definite integral as a limiting value of a sum involving quantities such as area under a curve, distance travelled in a straight line and cumulative effects of growth such as inflation Antidifferentiation by recognition that F ( x ) = f ( x ) implies f ( x ) dx = F ( x ) + c
a a a
f ( x ) dx + f ( x ) dx =
b f ( x) dx = a f ( x) dx
f ( x ) dx
f ( x ) dx = 0
Application of integration to problems involving calculation of the area of a region under a curve and simple cases of areas between curves, such as distance travelled in a straight line; average value of a function; other situations modelled by the use of the definite integral as a limiting value of a sum over an interval; and finding a function from a known rate of change
eBoo k plus eBook
Digital doc
9a
antidifferentiation
10 Quick Questions
As we have seen, the process of differentiation enables us to find the gradient of a function. The reverse process, antidifferentiation (or integration), will find the function for a particular gradient. Integration has wider applications including calculation of areas, volumes, energy, probability and many more quantities in science and business. Note that d f ( x ) means differentiate f (x) with respect to x; that is, d f ( x ) = f ( x ). dx dx
416
So f(x) is the antiderivative of f'(x), denoted as f ( x ) = f '( x ) dx where means antidifferentiate, or integrate, or find an indefinite integral and dx indicates that the integration of the function is with respect to x. Since then Since then d (ax + c) = a, where a and c are constants dx
a dx = ax + c
d ax n + 1 = ax n dx n +1 ax n + 1 + c, n 1 n +1
ax n dx =
In the expression above, the term c is used to denote a constant. In the antiderivative of a function, there are an infinite number of possibilities for c. However, when we are finding an antiderivative, we set c to zero. That is, finding an antiderivative means let c = 0, or do not add on the c. For example, the antiderivative of 3x2 + 4x + 5 is x3 + 2x2 + 5x + c. An antiderivative of 2 3x + 4x + 5 is x3 + 2x2 + 5x.
Properties of integrals
Since d is a linear operator, so too is ..Therefore, dx [ f ( x) g( x)] dx = f ( x) dx g( x) dx That is, each term can be integrated separately, and
k f ( x) dx = k f ( x) dx
That is, a constant factor of the function can be taken to the front of the integral. So [af ( x) bg( x)]dx = a f ( x )dx b g( x )dx
Worked Example 1
Antidifferentiate each of the following, expressing answers with positive indices. 3 a 2x7 b 4x 3 c x
Think a
1 2
Write
Integrate by rule; that is, add 1 to the index and divide by the new index. Simplify. Integrate by rule. Simplify. Express the answer with a positive index. When a square root is involved, replace it with a fractional index.
2 x 7 dx =
=
2 x8 +c 8
1 2 3
4x
x8 +c 4 4x 2 dx = + c 2
= 2x 2 + c 2 = 2 x 3 3 dx = 1 dx x x2
Chapter 9 Integration
417
Bring the x to the numerator and change the sign of the index. Integrate by rule. Simplify. Write the answer in the form it was given.
= 3 x = 3x 2
1 2 1 1
1 2 dx
+c
4 5
= 6x 2 + c =6 x +c
Worked Example 2
Write
Expand the expression. Collect like terms. Integrate each term separately. Simplify each term.
( x 1)(3x + 5) dx = (3x 2 3x + 5x 5) dx = (3 x 2 + 2 x 5) dx
= 3x3 2 x 2 + 5x + c 3 2 = x3 + x 2 5x + c
(ax + b)n dx =
(ax + b) n + 1 +c a( n + 1)
Worked Example 3
n+1
+ c.
Write
Express as an integral and take 4 out as a factor. Apply the rule where a = 5 and n = 3. Simplify the antiderivative by cancelling the fraction.
= 5(5x 2)4 + c
418
1 dx
= log e x + c.
Antidifferentiate 4 . 7x
Think
1
Write
dx 7 x dx = 7 x =
4 7
x dx
Integrate by rule.
=4 log e x + c 7
Integration of (ax + b)
-1
This can be done by applying the chain rule for differentiation: d a log e (ax + b) = , where a and b are constants. dx ax + b Multiplying both sides by 1 gives a 1 d a 1 log e (ax + b) = a dx ax + b a So so 1 ax + b 1 1 d log e ax + b dx dx = ax + b a dx =
1
( ax + b)
dx =
1 Note that the a in the fraction a is the derivative of the linear function ax + b.
Worked Example 5
1 log e ax + b + c a
Antidifferentiate
Think
5 . 2x + 3
Write
Method 1: Technology-free
1 2
2 x + 3 dx = 5 2 x + 3 dx
= 5 log e 2 x + 3 + c 2
Chapter 9 Integration
419
Method 2: Technology-enabled
1
On a Calculator page, press: MENU b 4:Calculus 4 3:Integral 3 Alternatively, select the indefinite integral template from the Maths expression template and fill in the required fields. Complete the entry line as: 5 dx 2x + 3 Press ENTER .
Write the answer and put in the constant of integration, as the CAS calculator omits it. Also note that the CAS uses ln instead of loge.
5 5 dx = log e 2 x + 3 + c 2 2x + 3
Worked Example 6
Find
6x + 5 dx . x2
Write
Think
1 2 3 4
Express as separate fractions. Simplify each fraction. Integrate each term separately by rule. Simplify leaving the answer with positive indices.
6x + 5 6x 5 dx = 2 + 2 dx 2 x x x = (6 x
1
+ 5 x 2 ) dx 5x
1 1 1
= 6 log e x +
+c
= 6 log e x 5 x + c 5 = 6 log e x + c x
Worked Example 7
Find the equation of the curve g(x) given that g(x) = 3 x + 2 and the curve passes through (1, 2).
Think
1 2 3 4
Write
Write the rule for g(x). Rewrite g(x) in index form. Express g(x) in integral notation. Antidifferentiate to obtain a general rule for g(x).
= 3x 2 3 + 2 x + c 2
420
Simplify.
= 3x 2 + 2 x + c 3 1 g(x) = 2 x 2 + 2 x + c
3 3
3 2
6 7
Substitute coordinates of the given point into g(x). Find the constant of antidifferentiation, c. State the rule for g(x) in the form that it is given.
Worked Example 8
If a curve has a stationary point (2, 3), and a gradient of 2x k, where k is a constant, find: a the value of k b y when x = 1.
Think a
1
Write
The gradient is dy so write the rule for the dx gradient. Let dy = 0 (as stationary points occur when dx the derivative is zero) and substitute the value of x into this equation. Solve for k. Rewrite the rule for the gradient function, using the value of k found in a above. Integrate to obtain the general rule for y.
1 2
dy = 2x 4 dx y = (2 x 4)dx = x2 4x + c Since curve passes through (2, 3), 3 = 22 4(2) + c 3=48+c c=7 So y = x2 4x + 7 When x = 1, y = (1)2 4(1) + 7 =4
Substitute the coordinates of the given point on the curve to find the value of c.
4 5
State the rule for y. Substitute the given value of x and calculate y.
The relationship between the graph of an antiderivative function and the graph of the original function f(x) is the antiderivative of f(x) and is written as f ( x ) = f ( x )dx.
f(x) is the gradient function of the antiderivative function f(x).
Chapter 9 Integration 421
The graph of the antiderivative function f(x) can be derived from the graph of f(x) and results in a family of curves. For example if f(x) = 1 then the antiderivative function is f(x) = x + c, where c can take any real value.
Sketching the antiderivative function from the graph of the original function
1. The general shape of the graph of the antiderivative function can be determined from the graph of a polynomial function by increasing the degree by one. For example, if f(x) is a quadratic function, then f(x) is a cubic function. 2. The x-intercepts of f(x) become the turning points on the graph of f(x). 3. When f(x) is above the x-axis, the gradient of f(x) is positive. 4. When f(x) is below the x-axis, the gradient of f(x) is negative.
Worked Example 9
Sketch the graph of the antiderivative function from the graph of the gradient function f(x) shown.
f (x)
(2, 0)
(1, 0) 0 (0, 1)
Think
1 2
Write
State the shape of the antiderivative function. Find the x-intercepts of the gradient function, f(x), and hence find the x-coordinates of the turning points. Find when the given graph, f(x), is above the x-axis and hence find when f(x) has a positive gradient. Find when the given graph, f(x), is below the x-axis and hence find when f(x) has a negative gradient. Sketch the curve.
The antiderivative function will be a positive cubic function. There are x-intercepts when x = 2 and when x = 1, so f(x) has turning points when x = 2 and x = 1. f(x) is above the x-axis when x < 2 and when x > 1, so f(x) has a positive gradient when x < 2 and when x > 1. f(x) is below the x-axis when 2 < x < 1, so f(x) has a negative gradient when 2 < x < 1. The graph could be any of the family of graphs formed by vertical translations of the graph shown.
f(x)
422
REMEMBER
1.
d f ( x ) = f ( x ) dx
2. f ( x ) = f ( x ) dx 3. a dx = ax + c 4. ax n dx = ax n + 1 + c, n 1 n +1
5. [ f ( x ) g( x )] dx =
f ( x) dx g( x) dx
6. k f ( x ) dx = k f ( x ) dx 7. (ax + b) n dx = 8. 9. (ax + b) n + 1 + c, n 1 a( n + 1)
1 dx = log e x + c, x 0 or x 1 dx = log e x + c x
1 1 1 dx = log e ax + b + c or (ax + b)1 dx = log e ax + b + c ax + b a a 10. Write the answer in the same form as the question unless otherwise stated. 11. To draw the graph of the antiderivative function f(x) from the graph of the gradient function f(x), use the x-intercepts as the x-coordinates of the turning points, and make the gradient positive when f(x) is above the x-axis and negative when f(x) is below the x-axis. 12. For a polynomial function, the graph of f(x) is one degree greater than the graph of f(x).
Exercise
9a
Antidifferentiation
1 WE1 a x e 5x 2 x4 i 5 m x 3 q 9 x2
2
Antidifferentiate each of the following, giving answers with positive indices. c x7 d 3x5 b x4 f x3 j 2
3 2x4
g 6x 4 x 4 k 3 o x s
3 7
h 2 x l p t x 5 x3
6
n 4 x 4 r
10
8 x
x6
(x x )
2 WE2
a (2 x + 5) dx d ( 4 x 5 + x 3 6 x 2 + 2 x ) dx g 5( x 2 + 2 x 1) dx
( x3 + 12 x 2 ) dx
h ( x 2 + 4)( x 7) dx
3 MC
( x 2 + x + 2) dx is equal to:
B x 2 dx + x dx + 2 dx D x 2 + ( x + 2) dx
A x 2 dx + x + 2 C ( x 2 + x ) dx + 2 E x 2 + x + 2 dx 4 MC
x( x + 3) dx is equal to:
B x ( x + 3) dx D x dx + ( x + 3) dx (ax + b) n + 1 + c. a( n + 1)
A x dx ( x + 3) dx C ( x + 1) x dx E
( x 2 + 3x) dx
b d f h j l n p (x 5)3 2(3x 4)5 3(4x 1)2 (7 x)4 3(8 9x)10 (6x + 5) 3 (3x 8) 6 10(7 5x)4
5 WE3 Antidifferentiate each of the following by using (ax + b) n dx = a (x + 3)2 c 2(2x + 1)4 e (6x + 5)4 g (4 x)3 i 4(8 3x)4 k (2x + 3) 2 m 6(4x 7) 4 o (6 5x) 3 6 MC
x dx 3x dx x + 3 dx 3x + 2 dx 3 + 2x
5
b e h k n q
x dx 7 x dx x + 4 dx 5x + 6 dx 6 + 7 x dx 4 3x
2 2 2
c f i l o r
5x dx x + 3 dx x + 5 dx 2 x 5 dx 5 x dx 5 2 x dx
8 6
dx
3 6 11x dx
dx
424
8 mC A 6 D
x + 5 dx is equal to:
1 dx x+5 B E
6dx x + 5 dx
6
6dx + x + 5 dx
( x + 5) dx
(2 x + 7) dx. x
6dx
( x + 5) dx
9 We6 Find
c f i l
3x 2 + 2 x 1 dx x2
4(2 x 5)5 dx
( x 5)( x + 3) dx x3 x2 + x4 dx x
3(4 x + 1)
x+
dx
2 dx 3 x dx
( x + 4) 2 dx 2x 1 3 k 5 x 2 2 x + 3 x 3 dx
x2 + 2x 1 x
10 x + 2 x 4 dx x3
SkillSHEET 9.1
Substitution and evaluation
11 We7 Find the equation of the curve f (x) given that: a f (x) = 4x + 1 and the curve passes through (0, 2) b f (x) = 5 2x and the curve passes through (1, 1) c f (x) = x 2 + 3 and the curve passes through (1, 4) d f (x) = x + x and f (4) = 10 e f (x) = x 3 3 x 2 + 50 and f (8) = 100 1 f f (x) = 2 x and f (1) = 5 x g f (x) = (x + 4)3 and the curve passes through (2, 5) h f (x) = 8(1 2x) 5 and f (1) = 3 1 i f (x) = (x + 5) and the curve passes through (4, 2) 8 j f ( x) = and f (3) = 7 7 2x 12 We8 If a curve has a stationary point (1, 5), and a gradient of 8x + k, where k is a constant, find: a the value of k b y when x = 2. 13 A curve g(x) has g ( x ) = kx +2 x , where k is a constant, and a stationary point (1, 2). Find: x a the value of k b g(x) c g(4). 14 We9 Sketch the graph of the antiderivative functions from each of the following graphs. a b c f (x) f (x) f (x)
(0, 2) (1, 0) 0 (0, 1) (1, 0) x (2, 0) 0 x
1
(0, 3)
Chapter 9
Integration
425
f (x)
f (x)
f (x)
, 0) (1 2
f (x)
(2, 0) (0, 0)
(1, 0)
9B
Therefore,
Worked examPle 10
WrITe
Integrate by rule where k = 4. Simplify. Rewrite the function to be integrated so that the coefficient of the e term is clear. Integrate by rule where k = 5.
dx x= 3e4 x d e
5 x
3e 4 x +c 4 3 = 4 e4 x + c dx 4 e 5x d
1 4 1
dx = =
5 x
+c
426
1 = 4e
5 x
1 = 20 e
5 x
1 5
+c
+c
1 2
(e x 1)2 dx = (e2 x 2e x + 1) dx
e 2 x 2e x + x + c =1 2
it follows that
sin ( ax) dx =
1 cos ( ax ) + c a
x 2
WrITe a b
Integrate by rule.
1 2
Integrate by rule. Simplify the result. Integrate by rule. Simplify the result.
3 sin
x dx = 2
3 1 2
x cos + c 2
x = 6 cos + c 2
Worked examPle 12
Method 1: Technology-free
1
cos (2 x ) + 4 x2 + c 2
5 =1 e4 x + 2 cos (2 x ) + 2 x 2 + c 2
Chapter 9
Integration
427
Method 2: Technology-enabled
1
On a Calculator page, press: MENU b 4:Calculus 4 2:Integral 2 Complete the entry line as:
(2e4 x 5 sin (2 x) + 4 x) dx
Press ENTER . Note: When integrating trigonometric functions, ensure the CAS is set to radian mode. (2e 4 x 5 sin (2 x ) + 4 x ) dx =
e 4 x 5 cos (2 x ) + + 2x2 + c 2 2
REMEMBER
1. 2.
1 sin (ax ) + c a
Exercise
9b
c ex f 7e4x i
3e6x x
l 0.1e 4 o e x + ex
m 3e 2 e x e x p 2
2 Find an antiderivative of (1 + ex)2. 3 Find an antiderivative of (ex 1)3. 4 Find an antiderivative of x3 3x2 + 6e3x. 5 MC If f(x) = e2x + k and f(x) has a stationary point (0, 2), where k is a constant, then: a k is equal to: A e B e2 C 1 D 1 E e b f(1) is equal to: e2 + 1 A e2 1 B e 2 + 1 C 1 D e4 E 1 1 2 2 2 2
428
6 WE11 Antidifferentiate the following. a sin (3x) b sin (4x) cos ( 2 x ) d e sin (2x) 3 4 sin (6 x ) g h 8 cos (4x) 3 x j 2 cos (x) k sin 3 x x m 3 sin n 2 sin 5 4 x p 6 cos 2 s
2 sin
2x q 4 sin 3 t
3 cos
5x 2
7x 4
x w 2 cos 3
) cos (2x) dx
) + 2 cos ( 3x ) dx
h [3e6 x 4 sin (8 x ) + 7] dx
8 Find the antiderivative of e4x + sin (2x) + x3. 9 Find an antiderivative of 3x2 2 cos (2x) + 6e3x. 10 Antidifferentiate each of the following. 1 a x 3 b x2 + 4 cos (2x) ex + e2 x 2x + 3
x x c sin + e 2 (3 x 1)4 3 x x x e 3 sin 2 cos e 5 3 2
d f
1 x + e 4 x + cos 5 3x 2 x x + 2 x 2 sin + 5 3
11 In each of the following, find f(x) if: a f(x) = cos (x) and f = 5 b f(x) = 4 sin (2x) and f(0) = 1 2 x x x c f ( x ) = 3 cos and f ( ) = 9 2 d f ( x ) = cos sin and f(2) = 2. 2 4 4 dy x 12 If = sin + k, where k is a constant, and y has a stationary point (3, 4), find: 6 dx a the value of k b the equation of the curve c y when x = 6. 13 A curve has a gradient function f(x) = 4 cos (2x) + kex, where k is a constant, and a stationary point (0, 1). Find: a the value of k b the equation of the curve f(x) c f correct to 2 decimal places. 6
Chapter 9 Integration
429
9C
Integration by recognition
As we have seen, if d [ f ( x )] = g( x ) dx then
This result can be used to determine integrals of functions that are too difficult to antidifferentiate, via differentiation of a related function.
Worked examPle 13 a Find the derivative of the function y = (5x + 1)3. b Use this result to deduce the antiderivative of 3(5x + 1)2. ThInk a
1 2
eBook plus
Tutorial
int-0564
WrITe
Worked example 13
Write the function and recognise that the chain rule can be used. Let u equal the function inside the brackets. du Find . dx Express y in terms of u. Find dy . du
a y = (5x + 1)3
3 4 5 6 7 8
Replace u with the expression inside the brackets and simplify where applicable. du dx = y + c1, express the relationship dx in integral notation. dy Remove a factor from so that it resembles dx the integral required. Since Divide both sides by the factor in order to obtain the integral required.
dx x = (5 x + 1)3 + c1 15(5x + 1)2 d 5 3(5 x + 1)2 dx = (5 x + 1)3 + c1 (5 x + 1)3 + c, 3(5x + 1)2 dx = 1 5 where c = c1 5
Note that the shorter form of the chain rule below can be used to differentiate. If f ( x ) = [ g( x ) )] ]n then f ( x ) = ng ( x )[ g( x ) )] ]n 1 .
430
ThInk a
1 2 3 4 5 6
WrITe
Write the equation and apply the chain rule to differentiate y. Let u equal the index of e. Find du . dx
y = ex Let u = x3
du = 3x 2 dx y = eu dy = eu du dy = 3 x 2 eu dx = 3x 2 e x
b
3
Express y in terms of u. dy . du dy Find using the chain rule and dx replace u. Find Express dy in integral notation. dx
1 2
3x 2 e x dx = e x
3 3
+ c1
3
2 3 x 2 e x dx = 2e x + 2c1
6 x 2 e x dx = 2e x
+ c, where c = 2c1.
3 3
Therefore, the antiderivative of 6 x 2 e x is 2e x + c . Note that the shorter form of the chain rule below can be used to differentiate. If y = e f ( x ) then
Worked examPle 15 a Find the derivative of sin (2 x + 1) and use this result to deduce the antiderivative of 8 cos (2 x + 1). b Differentiate loge(5x2 2) and hence antidifferentiate ThInk a
1 2 3 4 5
dy = f ( x)e f ( x ) . dx
x . 5 x2 2
WrITe a f (x) = sin (2x + 1)
Define f (x). Differentiate using f (x) = g(x) cos [g(x)] where f (x) = sin [g(x)]. Express f (x) using integral notation. Multiply both sides by whatever is necessary for it to resemble the integral required. Write the integral in the form in which the question is asked.
Define f (x).
Chapter 9
Integration
431
g ( x ) g( x )
f ( x ) =
10 x 5x 2 2 5 x 2 2 + c1
3 4
Express f (x) using integral notation. Take out a factor so that f (x) resembles the integral required. Divide both sides by the factor to obtain the required integral.
5x 2 2 dx = loge
10 5x 2 x
10x
x dx = log e 5 x 2 2 + c1 2 5x 2 2 + c
1 log e 5x 2 2 dx = 10
Worked examPle 16
WrITe
Write the rule. Apply the product rule to differentiate x cos (x).
Let y = x cos (x) dy = x [sin (x)] + [cos (x)](1) dx = x sin (x) + cos (x) = cos (x) x sin (x) [cos ( x ) x sin sin ( x )] d dx x = x cos ( x ) cos ( x ) dx x s sin in ( x ) d dx x = x cos ( x ) cos sin ( x ) x s sin in ( x ) d dx x = x cos ( x ) x sin ( x ) dx = x cos ( x ) sin ( x ) sin in ( x ) x cos ( x ) x sin ( x) dx = s Therefore, an antiderivative of x sin (x) is sin (x) x cos (x).
3 4 5 6
Express the result in integral notation. (Do not add c, as an antiderivative is required.) Express the integral as two separate integrals. Simplify by integrating. (Do not add c.) Make the expression to be integrated the subject of the equation. Simplify.
5x + 1 4 = 5 . x+1 x+1
b Hence, find
5x + 1 dx. x+1
WrITe a x + 1 5x + 1
5 So
5x + 5 4
5x + 1 4 = 5 x +1 x +1
432
Write the expression using integral notation. Express as two separate integrals. Antidifferentiate each part.
5x + 1 4 dx = 5 x +1 x + 1 = 5 dx 4 dx x +1
2 3
= 5 x 4 log e x + 1 + c
rememBer
1. To differentiate using the chain rule, use one of the following rules. (a) If f (x) = [g(x)]n then f (x) = ng(x)[g(x)]n 1 (b) If y = e f (x), (c) dy = f ( x )e f ( x ) dx
dy dy du = dx du dx (d) f (x) = g(x) cos [g(x)] where f (x) = sin [g(x)] f (x) = g(x) sin [g(x)] where f (x) = cos [g(x)] (e) f ( x ) = g ( x) where f ( x ) = log g e g( x ) . g( x )
exerCISe
9C
Integration by recognition
1 We13 For each of the following find the derivative of the function in i and use this result to deduce the antiderivative of the function in ii. a i (3x 2)8 ii 12(3x 2)7 2 5 b i (x + 1) ii 5x(x2 + 1)4 1 c i 2x 5 ii 2x 5 d i e i 4x + 3 (x2 7)4 ii 2 4x + 3
+ 3x 1 f i 2 x 1
2 mC The derivative of (x + 7)4 is 4(x + 7)3. a Therefore, the antiderivative of 4(x + 7)3 is: A (x + 7)4 + c B 1 (x + 7)4 + c 4 D 3(x + 7)4 + c E 12(x + 7)4 + c 3 b The antiderivative of (x + 7) is: A (x + 7)4 + c B 1 (x + 7)4 + c 4 D 3(x + 7)4 + c E 12(x + 7)4 + c
C 4(x + 7)4 + c
C 4(x + 7)4 + c
Chapter 9
Integration
433
3 mC If the derivative of (2x 3)6 is 12(2x 3)5, then 6(2 x 3)5 dx is: A 2(2x 3)6 + c B 4(2x 3)6 + c C (2x 3)6 + c 1 6 6 D 6(2x 3) + c E 2 (2x 3) + c 4 We14 a i c i ex e4x 5
2
For each of the following differentiate i and hence antidifferentiate ii. ii 2e4x 5 ii x e x
2
b i e6 5x d i ex x
2
ii 10e6 5x ii (1 2 x )e x x
5 We15 For each of the following find the derivative of the function in i and use this result to deduce the antiderivative of the function in ii. a i sin (x 5) ii cos (x 5) b i sin (3x + 2) ii 6 cos (3x + 2) c i cos (4x 7) ii sin (4x 7) d i cos (6x 3) ii 3 sin (6x 3) e i sin (2 5x) ii 10 cos (2 5x) f i cos (3 4x) ii 2 sin (3 4x) 12 x 20 g i loge (5x + 2) ii h i loge (x2 + 3) ii 2 5x + 2 x +3 i i loge (x2 4x) ii 6 We16 x2 x2 4x
Differentiate i and hence find an antiderivative of ii. 2[ x cos cos ( x ) sin ( x )] sin ( x ) a i x cos (x) + 2 sin (x) ii x sin (x) b i ii x x2 c i e x sin (x) ii 3e x [sin (x) + cos (x)] d i x sin (x) ii x cos (x) e i x ex ii x ex
7 For each of the following differentiate i and use this result to antidifferentiate ii. a i (2x 3x2)6 ii 6x5(1 3x)(2 3x)5 b i 8 We17 x3 + 2x a Show that ii 3x 2 + 2 x3 + 2x b Hence, find b Hence, find b Hence, find b Hence, find 3x 2 dx. x 1 5x + 8 dx. x+2 8x 7 dx. 2x 3 6x 5 dx. 3 2x
3x 2 1 =3+ . x 1 x 1
9 a Show that 10
a Show that
11 a Show that 12
6x 5 4 = 3+ . 3 2x 3 2x
If y = loge[cos (x)]: a find dy . dx b Hence, find ta tan ( x ) dx. cos ( x ) 1 and hence find an antiderivative of 2 . sin ( x ) sin n ( x) 3x 2 x . 4
13 Differentiate 14
15 Differentiate sin (ax + b) and hence find an antiderivative of cos (ax + b). (Here, a and b are constants.) 16 Differentiate cos (ax + b) and hence find an antiderivative of sin (ax + b). (Here, a and b are constants.)
434
17 Differentiate eax + b and hence find an antiderivative of eax + b. (Here, a and b are constants.) 18 Antidifferentiate each of the following. a sin (3 x + 1) b cos (1 4 x) x x d sin n 2 + e 3 cos + 5 2 3 c e x + 3 f cos (x)esin (x)
eBook plus
Digital doc
WorkSHEET 9.1
9d
eBook plus
Interactivity
int-0254
Approximating areas enclosed by functions
Find an approximation for the area between the curve f (x) shown and the x-axis from x = 1 to x = 3 using left rectangles of width 0.5 units. The graph shown has the equation f (x) = 0.2x2 + 3.
eBook plus
f(x)
Tutorial
int-0565
Worked example 18
Method 1: Technology-free
1
Chapter 9
Integration
435
Find the height of each rectangle (left) by substituting the appropriate x-value into the f(x) equation. Area equals the width multiplied by the sum of the heights. Calculate this area. State the solution. Store the function to f(x). On a Calculator page, press: MENU b 1:Actions 1 1:Define 1 Complete the entry line as: Define f(x) = 0.2x2 + 3 Press ENTER . To find the approximate area, complete the entry line as: 0.5(f(1) + f(1.5) + f(2) + f(2.5)) Press ENTER . Write the answer with the correct units for area.
h1 = f(1) = 0.2(1)2 + 3 = 3.2 h2 = f(1.5) = 0.2(1.5)2 + 3 = 3.45 h3 = f(2) = 0.2(2)2 + 3 = 3.8 h4 = f(2.5) = 0.2(2.5)2 + 3 = 4.25 Area = width (sum of heights of 4 rectangles) = 0.5(3.2 + 3.45 + 3.8 + 4.25) = 0.5(14.7) = 7.35 The approximate area is 7.35 square units.
4 5
Method 2: Technology-enabled
1
For an increasing function, left rectangle approximation actual area right rectangle approximation. For a decreasing function, left rectangle approximation actual area right rectangle approximation.
436
Worked Example 19
Find an approximation for the area in the diagram in worked example 18 using right rectangles of width 0.5 units. f(x) = 0.2x2 + 3
Think
1
Write
Find the number of rectangles and the height of each one (from left to right).
There are 4 rectangles: h1 = f(1.5) = 0.2(1.5)2 + 3 = 3.45 h2 = f(2) = 0.2(2)2 + 3 = 3.8 h3 = f(2.5) = 0.2(2.5)2 + 3 = 4.25 h4 = f(3) = 0.2(3)2 + 3 = 4.8 Area = 0.5(3.45 + 3.8 + 4.25 + 4.8) = 0.5(16.3) = 8.15
2 3 4
Area is the width of the interval multiplied by the sum of the heights. Calculate the area. State the solution.
It can be seen that the left rectangle approximation (7.35 units) is less than the right rectangle approximation (8.15 units). If the area is divided into narrower strips, the estimate of the area would be closer to the true value.
Worked Example 20
With width intervals of 1 unit, calculate an approximation for the area between the graph of f(x) = x2 + 2 and the x-axis from x = 2 to x = 3 using: a left rectangles b right rectangles c averaging of the left and right rectangle areas.
Think
1 2
Write y y = x2 + 2
Sketch the graph of f(x) over a domain which exceeds the width of the required area Draw the left and right rectangles.
Calculate the height of the left rectangles by substituting the appropriate values of x into the equation for f(x). Note the two rectangles to the right and left of the origin have the same height and are equal in area. Find the area by multiplying the width by the sum of the heights.
Area = 1(6 + 3 + 2 + 3 + 6) = 20 Using left rectangles, the approximate area is 20 square units.
Chapter 9 Integration
437
Calculate the height of the right rectangles by substituting the appropriate values of x into the equation for f (x).
Find the area by multiplying the width by the sum of the heights.
Area = 1(3 + 2 + 3 + 6 + 11) = 25 Usingrightrectangles,theapproximateareais 25 square units. 20 + 25 c Average of the areas = 2 = 22.5 The approximate area is 22.5 square units when averaging the left and right rectangle areas and using widths of 1 unit.
Note that this average is between the area of the left rectangles and the area of the right rectangles and is closer to the actual area.
rememBer
1. An approximation to the area between a curve and the x-axis can be found by dividing the area into a series of rectangles that are all the same width. The approximation is found by finding the sum of all the areas of the rectangles. 2. For an increasing function, left rectangle approximation actual area right rectangle approximation. 3. For a decreasing function, left rectangle approximation actual area right rectangle approximation. exerCISe
9d
(3, 3) 3 (1, 2) 2 0 1 x
7 (2, 7) 4 (1, 4) 3 0 1 2 3 4 5x
438
3 MC Consider the graph of y = x2 from x = 0 to x = 4 at right. a The width of each rectangle is: A 1 unit B 2 units C 3 units D 4 units E varying b The height of the right-most rectangle is: A 9 units B 4 units C 16 units D 12 units E 1 unit c The area between the curve y = x2 and the x-axis from x = 0 to x = 4 can be approximated by the area of the left rectangles as: A 20 sq. units B 14 sq. units C 18 sq. units D 15 sq. units E 30 sq. units 4 WE19 a Find an approximation for the area in the diagram at right using right rectangles of width 1 unit. b A better approximation for the area under this curve can be found by averaging the right and left rectangle areas. State this approximate value. 5 Find an approximation for the area between the curves below and the x-axis, from x=1 to x=5, by calculating the area of the shaded rectangles. b y c a y
8 6 (1, 8) 8 7 (1, 8) (3, 8)
y = x2
1 2 3 4
y = x2
0 y 11 10 8 7 (2, 11)
5 f(x)
0 1 3
f(x) x
f y
4 2 f(x)
0 1
x 0 (4, 7) 2 3 4 5 x
y 7 5 4 (1, 7) (2, 5)
f(x) x
y y = x2 + 4
6 WE20 With width intervals of 1 unit calculate an approximation for the area between the graph of f(x) = x2 + 4 and the x-axis from x = 1 to x = 4 using: a left rectangles b right rectangles c averaging of the left and right rectangle areas.
2 3 4
Chapter 9 Integration
439
7 Find the approximate area between the curves below and the x-axis, over the interval indicated, by calculating the area of the shaded rectangles. Give exact answers. y a y b y = ex
y = x2 + 3x + 8
1 2 3 4 x = 1 to x = 4
x 1 0 1 2 x = 1 to x = 2
c y
y = loge(x)
d y
y = (x 4)2
0 1 2 3 4 5 x x = 1 to x = 5
1 2 3 4 5 6 x = 2 to x = 6 y
e y
f(x) =
1 x3 3
3 x2 + 8 x
f(x) = x2 4 x
0 1 2 3 4 5 x = 1 to x = 5
3 2.5 2 1.5 1
x = 3 to x = 1
y 0
x = 2 to x = 6 2 3 4 5 6 x
y = x3 6 x2
8 Calculate an approximation for the area between the graph of y = x(4 x), the x-axis and the lines x = 1 and x = 4, using interval widths of 1 unit and: a left rectangles b right rectangles c averaging the left and right rectangle areas. 9 Calculate an approximation for the area under the graph of y = x2 4x + 5 to the x-axis between x=0 and x = 3, using interval widths of 0.5 units and: a left rectangles b right rectangles c averaging the left and right rectangle areas. 10 Find an approximation for the area under the graph of y = 2x between x= 0 and x = 3, using interval widths of 1 unit, by averaging the left and right rectangle areas.
440
9e
lim
F ( x ) = f ( x ) dx
f ( x) dx = F ( x) + c f ( x) dx = F (a) + c
= 0 (as the area defined is zero at x = a)
c = F (a).
That is, the area under the graph of f (x) between x = a and x = b is F (b) F (a). being integrated. This is the fundamental theorem of integral calculus and it enables areas under graphs to be calculated exactly. It applies only to functions that are smooth and continuous over the interval [a, b]. It can be stated as area = a f ( x ) dx = [ F ( x )]b a [do not add c as F (x) is an antiderivative of f (x)] = F (b) F (a) a and b are called the terminals of this definite integral and indicate the domain over which the integral is taken.
b
f ( x) dx is the indefinite integral, which represents the general antiderivative of the function
Chapter 9
Integration
441
f ( x ) dx is called the definite integral because it can be expressed in terms of its terminals a and b, which are usually real numbers. In this case the value of the definite integral is a real number and not a function. The function being integrated, f (x), is called the integrand.
eBook plus
Digital doc
a a
Investigation
Denite integrals
a k f ( x) dx = k a
b
f ( x ) dx
b
a [ f ( x) + g( x)] dx = a a
b
f ( x ) dx + g( x ) dx
a
f ( x ) dx =
f ( x ) dx
Worked examPle 21
eBook plus
Tutorial
( 3 x 2 + 4 x 1) dx 4
int-0566
Worked example 21
1 (2 x + 1)3 dx
ThInk WrITe
Method 1: Technology-free
a
1
Antidifferentiate each term of the integrand and write in the form [ F ( x )]b a. Substitute values of a and b into F (b) F (a). Evaluate the integral. Express the integrand with a negative power. Antidifferentiate by rule.
0 (3x 2 + 4 x 1) dx
= [ x 3 + 2 x 2 x ]3 0 = [33 + 2(3)2 3] [0 3 + 2(0)2 0] = = 42 0 = 42
2 3
1 = 2 (2 x + 1) 1
442
Substitute the values of a and b into F(b) F(a) where a = 1 and b = 2. Evaluate the definite integral.
1 = 2 (2 x + 1) 1
1 1 = 2 2 5 3 1 1 = + 25 9 16 = 225
Method 2: Technology-enabled
1
On a Calculator page, press: MENU b 4:Calculus 4 3:Integral 3 Alternatively, select the definite integral template from the expression template and fill in the required fields. Complete the entry lines as:
0 (3x 2 + 4 x 1) dx
dx 1 (2 x + 1)3 Press ENTER after each entry.
2
2
a b
0 (3x 2 + 4 x 1) dx = 42
dx = 1 (2 x + 1)3 225
2
16
Worked Example 22
x sin dx 6
0 ( e 3 x e
1
3x
) dx
Write
2
Think a
1
Antidifferentiate the integrand, writing it in the form [ F ( x )]b a. Substitute values of a and b into F(b) F(a).
x x sin dx = 6 cos 6 6
Chapter 9 Integration
443
1 3 = 6 6 2 2 = [ 3] [ 3 3 ] = 3+ 3 3
0 (e3 x e
3 x
) dx
1
3 x 1 3 x e + 3e = 1 0 3 e3 + 1 e 3 1 e 0 + 1 e 0 = 1 3 3 3 3 =1 e3 + 1 e 3 3
3
( e3 + e =1 3
Worked Example 23
2 3
2)
If
0 8 x dx = 36, find k.
Write
k
Think
Method 1: Technology-free
1
Antidifferentiate the integrand, using [ F ( x )]b a. Substitute the values of a and b into F(a) F(b). Simplify the integral.
k 0 8x dx = [4 x 2 ]0
2 3
Method 2: Technology-enabled 1 On a Calculator page, press: MENU b 3:Algebra 3 1:Solve 1 MENU b 4:Calculus 4 3:Integral 3 Complete the entry line as:
k solve (8 x ) dx = 36, k 0
Press ENTER .
2
444
Sigma notation
An alternative notation for the definite integral of f(x) for x [a, b] is the sigma notation (meaning the sum of).
(xi, f(xi))
y = f(x)
Divide the interval [a, b] into n equal subintervals with the ith subinterval of width xi and height f(xi), i [1, n]. The area of the rectangle formed by the ith subinterval is Ai = f(xi) xi. As n , xi 0 and Ai f ( x ) dx .
1 a n b
So
f ( x ) dx = lim
f ( xi ) xi x0
i =1
Worked Example 24
The interval [1, 3] is divided into n equal subintervals by the points x0, x1, . . . xn 1, xn, where 1 = x0 < x1 < . . . < xn 1 < xn = 3. Let x = xi xi 1 for i = 1, 2, . . . n. Rewrite as a definite integral and thus evaluate lim
Think
1
( 6 x i 2 x ) . x 0
i=1
Write
(6 xi 2 x) = 1 6 x 2 dx x0
lim
3 3 i =1 3 1 6 x 2 dx = 2x 1 3
= 2 27 2 1 = 54 2 = 52
REMEMBER
1. The fundamental theorem of calculus is where F(x) is an antiderivative of f(x). 2. The expression
terminals and represent the upper and lower values of x. 3. Properties of definite integrals (a) f ( x ) dx = 0
a a
Chapter 9 Integration
445
a k f ( x) dx = k a
b b a
f ( x ) dx
b
a [ f ( x) + g( x)] dx = a a
f ( x ) dx =
f ( x )dx + g( x ) dx
a
b
n
f ( x ) dx
f ( x ) dx = lim
xi 0
f ( xi ) xi
i =1
exerCISe
9e
eBook plus
Digital doc
0 x 2 dx 2 x 2 dx 1
2 1 6
0 x3 dx 0
2
c f i l o r
3 ( x 2 2 x) dx 1 (3x 2 + 2 x 2 ) dx 4 3
2
SkillSHEET 9.2
Subtracting function values
( x 3 + 3 x 2 2 x ) dx
(6 2 x + x 2 ) dx
4 ( x3 + x 4) dx 0 2( x + 4)4 dx 0
3 3
x dx
1 (4 x 2 + 2 x 6) dx 2 1
0 4 ( 2 3 x )3
1 3(5x 2)4 dx
2 x 2 3x 1
4 3 1
dx
5 dx (2 x 7)3 3
dx
3 2x3
+ 5x 2 dx x 6 dx
1 5x dx
1 2x 5
dx
2 0
2
8 3x
2 We22 a d g j m p e 4 x dx
2
4
e 3 dx 5
x
c f i l o r
1 4e 2 x dx 3 (e2 x e 2 x ) dx 0 5 sin
2 1
1 x + e 2 dx
3 sin (4 x ) dx 2
( 4x ) dx
cos (3 x ) dx
( 3x ) dx ( 4x ) dx
cos (2 x) dx
dx 2 7 cos 2
0
2 8 cos (4 x) dx
2 4
x 3 cos dx 6
2 + sin 0
1 [ x 2 + 3 6 sin (3x)] dx
+ 3 cos 1 x
( 2x ) dx
446
3 If
1 3 f ( x) dx.
4 MC Given that a
5
1 f ( x) dx = 6,
B 10 C 11 D 19 E 22
1 [ f ( x) + 1] dx is equal to:
A 16
5 f ( x) dx is equal to:
A 6 B 5 C 5 D 6 E 0
2 0
(t 2 4t ) dt sin x dx 5 t dt
k
b e h
2 cos (3t ) dt
x
c f
3
3 ( p 3) 2
dp
10
e 4 cos (2 x ) dx 0
1 4m 3 dm
1 t
k
4 3
1 [3 sin (2 x) e
3x
] dx
6 WE23 If (2 x + 3) dx = 4, find k.
0
7 If 3 x 2 dx = 8, find k.
0 k 1 a
8 If
10 If cos (2 x) dx =
k 6 2
2 2 f ( x) dx
n
f ( x ) dx c
[3 f ( x ) 3] dx d
2 [ f ( x) + 2 x] dx
12 WE24 MC The interval [1, 3] is divided into n equal subintervals by the points x0, x1, . . . xn 1, xn, where 1 = x0 < x1 < . . . < xn 1 < xn = 3. Let x = xi xi 1 for i = 1, 2, . . . n. Then lim A
x0
x 3 dx b
13 MC The interval [0, 3] is divided into n equal subintervals by the points x0, x1, . . . xn 1, xn, where 0 = x0 < x1 < . . . < xn 1 < xn = 3. Let x = xi xi 1 for i = 1, 2, . . . n. Then lim
( xi 2 x) is equal to: x0
i =1
A 9b
3 x3 x3 D dx c 0 3
3 x 2 dx
E 27
Chapter 9 Integration
447
9f
Signed areas
When calculating areas between the graph of a function f(x) and the x-axis using the definite integral
f ( x ) dx, the area is signed; that is, it is positive or negative. If f(x) > 0, the region is
above the x-axis; if f(x) < 0 it is below the axis. We shall now examine these two situations and look at how we calculate the area of regions that include both.
y = f(x)
f ( x ) dx > 0, so the value of the definite integral is positive. For example, if f(x) > 0, then the area =
f ( x ) dx.
0 a b x
y a 0
y = f(x) b x
Therefore, for areas below the x-axis, ensure that the area has a positive value. (Areas cannot be negative.)
Combining regions
For regions that are combinations of areas above and below the x-axis, each area has to be calculated by separate integrals one for each area above and one for each area below the x-axis. For example, from the diagram, Area = A1 + A2 However, f ( x ) dx = A1 A2 , because the areas are signed.
a b
y = f(x)
A1 a 0 A 2 c b x
or = f ( x ) dx +
c b c
a f ( x) dx
a c
or = f ( x ) dx + f ( x ) dx Note: When calculating the area between a curve and the x-axis it is essential that the x-intercepts are determined and a graph of the curve is sketched over the interval required. The term |x| means that we should make the value of x positive even if it is negative.
448
Worked Example 25 a Express the shaded area as a definite integral. b Evaluate the definite integral to find the shaded area, giving your y
1 y= x
0 Think a b Write
Area = a
1 dx x
4
b Area = log e x 1
= [loge (4)] [loge (1)] = loge (4) 0 = loge (4) The area is loge (4) square units.
Worked Example 26
y = x2 4x 1 3 4 x
Think
1
Write
Express the area in definite integral notation, with a negative sign in front of the integral as the region is below the x-axis. Antidifferentiate the integrand. Evaluate.
Area = ( x 2 4 x ) dx
1
2 3
3 = [ 1 x 3 2 x 2 ]1 3
] = [ 9 + 1 2 3 ) = ( 7 1 3 = 71 3
1
Chapter 9 Integration
449
Worked examPle 27 a Express the shaded area as a definite integral. b Calculate the area. c Calculate the area using a CAS calculator. 2 ThInk a WrITe a Area = y y = x3 4x 2 x
Express the area above the x-axis as an integral and the area below the x-axis as an integral. For the area below the x-axis, take the negative of the integral from 0 to 2.
1 2
2 ( x3 4 x ) dx 0 ( x3 4 x ) dx
0 2
1 4 1 4 2 2 b = 4 x 2x 2 4 x 2x 0
Simplify.
State the solution. On a Calculator page, press: MENU b 4:Calculus 4 3:Integral 3 Complete the entry line as:
2 ( x3 4 x) dx 0 ( x3 4 x) dx
Press ENTER . Alternatively, take the absolute value for the area below the x-axis as shown. The area is 8 square units.
Worked examPle 28 a Sketch the graph of y = ex 2 showing all intercepts and using exact values
eBook plus
Tutorial
for all key features. b Find the area between the curve and the x-axis from x = 0 to x = 2.
ThInk a
1
int-0567
Worked example 28
WrITe
a When y = 0, ex 2 = 0
ex = 2
450
loge (ex) = loge (2) x = loge (2) (or approximately 0.69) so the x-intercept is loge (2). When x = 0, y = e0 2 =12 = 1 so the y-intercept is 1.
y y = ex 2 0 1 2
2
Note the vertical translation and hence sketch the graph showing the appropriate horizontal asymptote and intercept. Shade the region required.
2
loge2
x 2 y=2
log e ( 2)
2 3
Express the area above the x-axis as an integral and the area below the x-axis as an integral. Subtract the area below the x-axis from the area above the x-axis. Antidifferentiate the integrands. Evaluate. (Remember: eloge (a) = a) Simplify. State the solution.
b Area =
loge (2) (e x 2) dx - 0
(e x 2) dx
= [e x 2 x ]2 log
e ( 2)
[e x 2 x ]0
log e ( 2)
4 5
= [e2 2(2)] [eloge (2) 2 loge (2)] [[eloge (2) 2 (loge (2)] [e0 2(0)]] = [e2 4] [2 2 loge (2)] [[2 2 loge (2)] [1 0]] = e2 4 2 + 2 loge (2) 2 + 2 loge (2) + 1 = e2 7 + 4 loge (2) The area is [e2 7 + 4 loge (2)] or approximately 3.162 square units.
REMEMBER
f ( x ) dx .
a
a b
f ( x ) dx , or
3. Check if the required area lies above and below the x-axis. 4. Area =
c
c
f ( x ) dx f ( x ) dx (= A1 A2 = A1 + A2)
a
or= f ( x ) dx + 5. e
log e ( a )
a f ( x) dx
A1 a 0 A 2 c b x
=a
Chapter 9 Integration
451
Exercise
9f
Signed areas
1 Find the area of the triangle at right. a geometrically b using integration
y y=x
y 3 0 x
3 y=3x
y = x2
01
3 y
x y=4x
1 2 y
y = 3x2
y = x3 9x2 + 20x
1 0 y
2 y 2
y = x3 4x2 4x
y = ex
h y
y=e
2x
y = 2 sin (2x)
1 1 y 1 0
3 2
0 4 x
x y = cos ( 3)
4 WE25b Evaluate each of the definite integrals in question 3 to find the shaded area. Give your answer as an exact value. 5 For each of the following, sketch a graph to illustrate the region for which the definite integral gives the area. a d g
0 4 x dx
1
b e h
1 (6 x) dx 1
4
c f
1 x 2 dx 3 2e x dx
0
1 (4 x 2 ) dx 2 loge
4
x dx
( 2x ) dx
2 3 sin (2 x ) dx 0
452
y y = x2 4
d
2 1
0 x
e
2
y = x3 0 x
f
1
y 0 1 x
y = 1 x2
y = x3 + 2x2 x 2
g
1
y 0 1 x
y 0
1 2
1 x
y y = sin (x) 0
y = ex
y=
e2x
3 2
x) y = 2 cos ( 2
7 MC a The area between the graph, the x-axis and the lines x = 2 and x = 1 is equal to: A C
2 0
f ( x ) dx
B D
2 f ( x) dx 2 f ( x) dx
1
1 f ( x) dx
1 2
3 y = f(x)
E f ( x ) dx 2 b The area between the graph, the x-axis and the lines x = 2 and x = 3 is equal to: A C E
0 f ( x) dx + 0
1 0
f ( x) dx f ( x) dx
B D
2 f ( x) dx 3
2
2 f ( x) dx + 1
f ( x ) dx
2 f ( x) dx 0 f ( x) dx
f(x) 0 2 5 x 0 1 x 0 2 x h(x)
8 WE27a Express the following shaded areas as definite integrals which give the correct area. b c a y y y g(x)
Chapter 9 Integration
453
g(x)
5 4 2
f(x)
3 2
2 3
y = x3 2x2 5x + 6
a The area between the curve and the x-axis from x = 2 and x = 1 is equal to: A 1712 sq. units D 154 sq. units
3 1
b The area between the curve and the x-axis from x = 1 and x = 3 is equal to: A 6 2 sq. units B 2 sq. units C 51 sq. units 3
3
E 6 2 sq. units
3
c The area between the curve and the x-axis from x = 2 and x = 3 is equal to: B 114 sq. units E 2112 sq. units
1 3
10 We28 Sketch the graph of the curve y = x2 4, showing all intercepts and using exact values for all key features. Find the area between the curve and the x-axis: a from x = 0 to x = 2 b from x = 2 to x = 4 c from x = 0 to x = 4. 11 Sketch the graph of the curve y = x3 + x2 2x, showing all intercepts. Find the area between the curve and the x-axis between the lines: a x = 2 and x = 0 b x = 0 and x = 1 c x = 2 and x = 1. 12 Sketch the graph of the curve y = 1 + 3 cos (2x) over [0, ]. Find the exact area between the curve and the x-axis from: a x = 0 to x = 4 3 b x= to x = . 4
eBook plus
Digital doc
WorkSHEET 9.2
13 Sketch the graph of f (x) = x 1 and find the area between the curve and the x-axis and the lines x = 2 and x = 3. Give both an exact answer and an approximation to 3 decimal places. 14 Find the exact area between the curve y = 1 , the x-axis and the lines x = 1 and x = 2. 2 x x 15 Find the exact area bounded by the curve g(x) = e + 2, the x-axis and the lines x = 1 and x = 3.
454
9g
Further areas
Areas bound by a curve and the x-axis
For graphs with two or more x-intercepts, there is an enclosed region (or regions) between the graph and the x-axis. The area bound by the graph of f(x) and the x-axis is:
y = f(x)
or
f ( x ) dx .
y
The area bound by the graph of g(x) and the x-axis is:
c g( x) dx a g( x) dx
or That is, if the graph has two x-intercepts then one integrand is y = g(x) required. If the graph has three x-intercepts then two integrands are required, and so on. Note: Wherever possible it is good practice to use sketch graphs to assist in any problems involving the calculation of areas under curves.
Worked Example 29 a Sketch the graph of the function g(x) = (3 x)(2 + x). b Find the area bound by the x-axis and the graph of the function. Think a
1
a g( x) dx + c g( x) dx
Write
Determine the type of graph by looking at the number of brackets and the sign of the x-terms. Solve g(x) = 0 to find the x-intercepts. Sketch the graph. Shade the region bound by g(x) and the x-axis.
2 0
x 3 y = g(x)
3
2 3
Area =
2 (6 + x x 2 ) dx
1 1
Chapter 9 Integration
455
= (18 + 2 9) (12 + 2 + 3 ) = 13 2 (7 3 ) = 13 2 + 7 3 = 20 6
5 5 1 1 1 1
=3
As areas cannot be negative, taking the absolute value of the integrands involved in a problem will ensure that all areas are made positive. y For example, The shaded area at right = =
c c
f ( x ) dx + f ( x ) dx +
a f ( x) dx a f ( x) dx
c
y = f(x) a c 0 b x
or
Worked Example 30 a Find the x-intercepts of y = sin (2x) over the domain [0, 2]. b Calculate the area between the curve, the x-axis and x = 0 and x = . Think a
1 2
Write
To find the x-intercepts, let y = 0. Solve for x over the given domain.
a For x-intercepts, y = 0
Pick the x-intercepts that are between the given end points of the area. State the regions for which it is necessary to calculate the area.
b x=
Area =
456
[ 1 2
cos
( ) ( 1 2
cos (0))]
4 5
Add the result to give the total area. State the solution.
x . 1 x c Find the area between the graph of 2 , the x-axis, x = 2 and x = 3, giving your answer correct x 1 to 2 decimal places.
b Hence, find an antiderivative of
x2
Think a
1 2
Write
Let y equal the expression to be differentiated. Express u as a function of x in order to apply the chain rule for differentiation. (Let u equal the function inside the brackets.) Find du . dx dy . du dy using the chain rule. dx
Let u = x2 1
3 4 5
So
du = 2x dx y = loge (u) dy 1 = du u dy 1 = 2x dx u = 2x x2 2x 1 x2 1 + c
Since
relationship in integral notation. dy Remove a factor from so that it dx resembles the integral required.
dx dx = y + c, express the
dy
x 2 1 dx = loge
2 x2
x dx = log e x 2 1 + c 1
Chapter 9 Integration
457
Divide both sides by the factor in order to obtain the required integral.
x log e x 2 1 + c dx = 1 2 x2 1 x2 x 1 is 2 logx2 1. 1
An antiderivative of
c
1
Find the x-intercepts. x (For 2 = 0, the numerator = 0.) x 1 If the x-intercepts are not between the terminals of the area, find the area by evaluating the integrand.
c For x-intercepts,
x =0 x2 1 x=0
Area =
2 x 2 1 dx
3
= =
() log e ( 8 = 1 2 3)
1 log e 8 2 3
1 2
( 83 ) or approximately 0.49
REMEMBER
1. For graphs with two or more intercepts, there is an enclosed region (or regions) between the graph and the x-axis. 2. The number of regions is one less than the number of intercepts. 3. Where possible, sketch graphs to make it easier to calculate the areas under curves. 4. As areas cannot be negative, take the absolute values of the integrals. 5. When graphs are not easily drawn, areas can be calculated by finding the x-intercepts and determining whether they are within the bounds of the required area. Exercise
9G
Further areas
In the following exercise give all answers correct to 2 decimal places where appropriate, unless otherwise stated. 1 WE29 iSketch the graph of each of the following functions. iiFind the area bound by the x-axis and the graph of each function. a f(x) = x2 3x b g(x) = (2 x)(4 + x) 2 Find the area bound by the x-axis and the graph of each of the following functions. a h(x) = (x + 3)(5 x) b h(x) = x2 + 5x 6 2 c g(x) = 8 x d g(x) = x3 4x2 e f(x) = x(x 2)(x 3) f f(x) = x3 4x2 4x + 16 3 2 g g(x) = x + 3x x 3 h h(x) = (x 1)(x + 2)(x + 5) 3 MC The area bound by the curve with equation y = x2 6x + 8 and the x-axis is equal to: A 1 1 square units B 6 2 square units C 12 square units 3 3 D 3 square units square units E 1 1 3
458
4 MC The area between the curve at right, the x-axis and the lines x = 3 and x = 4 is equal to: A C E
y 0 2 x y = f(x)
3 f ( x) dx 4
3
B
4
3 f ( x) dx + 2 2
4 2
f ( x) dx
f ( x ) dx
D f ( x) dx
f ( x) dx f ( x ) dx
3
3 f ( x) dx 2
5 MC The area between the curve y = x2 x 6, the x-axis and the lines x = 2 and x = 4 is equal to:
5 square units A 2 6 3 square units D 2 4
2 3
square units
C 5 square units
E 4 1 square units 2
6 For each of the following: i sketch the graph of the curve over an appropriate domain, clearly labelling any x-intercepts in the interval required. ii find the area between the curve, the x-axis and the lines indicated below. 2 a y = 3 3x2, x = 0 and x = 2 b y = , x = 1 and x = 3 x 1 c y = , x = 1 and x = 2 d y = x3 4x, x = 2 and x = 1 x2 e y = e2x, x = 2 and x = 0 g y = 2 sin (x), x = i y = sin (3x), x = f y = ex, x = 0 and x = 2
and x = 6 3
and x = 2 6
x h y = cos , x = and x = 2 2 2
j y = x x , x 0, x = 0 and x = 4
7 WE30 For each of the following functions: i find the x-intercepts over the given domain ii calculate the area between the curve, the x-axis and the given lines. Use sketch graphs to assist your workings. a y = x 4x 1, x 0, x = 1 and x = 3 b y = sin (x) cos (x), x [0, ], x = 0 and x = c y = ex e, x = 0 and x = 3 1 d y = x 2 , x 0, x = 1 and x = 2 2 x e y = e 2 , x = 2 and x = 2 f y = x4 3x2 4, x = 1 and x = 4 g y = (x 2)4, x = 1 and x = 3 8 Find the exact area of the region enclosed by the x-axis, y = e3x and the lines x = 1 and x = 2. 9 Find the exact area of the region enclosed by the x-axis, y = cos (x) and the lines x= and 3 5 x= . 6 10 Find the area bound by y = (x 1)3, the x-axis and the y-axis. 1 11 a Sketch the graph of y = showing all asymptotes and intercepts. ( x 3)2 b Find the area under the curve between x = 1 and x = 1.
459
x
Chapter 9 Integration
12 a Give the equation of the asymptotes for the function f(x) = (x + 2) 3. b Find the area between the curve, the x-axis, x = 1 and x = 1. 13 Find the area bound by the curve y = 3 e2x, the x-axis, x = 2 and x = 0. (Find the x-intercepts first.) 14 Find the area bound by the curve y = 4 sin (2x), the x-axis, x = and x = . (Check the 2 x-intercepts first.) 15 WE31 a Differentiate x loge (x). (x > 0) b Hence, find an antiderivative of loge (x). c Find the area bound by the graph of loge (x), the x-axis, x = 1 and x = 4 giving exact answers. x 16 a Differentiate loge (x2 + 2). b Hence, find an antiderivative of 2 . x +2 x c Find the area between , the x-axis, x = 1 and x = 1. 2 +2 x 17 aFind the area between the graph of y = x2, the x-axis, x = 0 and x = 2. y b Use this result to calculate the area between the graph, the y-axis y = e2x and the line y=4.
0 2
18 Find the exact area of the shaded region on the graph y = e2x below.
y y = x2 (2, 4)
19 Find the shaded area below. (Hint: It is easier if you use symmetry.)
y
y = 2 sin (x)
20
a The area of the region bounded by the y-axis, the x-axis, the curve y = 2e-x and the 3 line x = k, where k is a positive real constant, is square units. Find k. 2 b The area of the region bounded by the y-axis, the x-axis, the curve y = sin (2x) and the line x = k, where k is a positive real constant, is 1 square unit. Find k.
9H
If the two curves f(x) and g(x) do not intersect over the interval [a, b]
Here, we may look at three circumstances: when the region is above the x-axis, when it is below the x-axis, and when it crosses the x-axis.
460
f(x) g(x) 0 a b x
f ( x ) dx g( x ) dx
a
a [ f ( x) g( x)] dx.
Note: The lower function is subtracted from the higher function to ensure a positive answer.
y a 0 b f(x) x g(x)
f(x) g(x) x
a [ f ( x) g( x)] dx
Worked Example 32
a State the definite integral that describes the shaded area on the
y = 2x + 1 y=x
graph at right.
Think a
1 2
Write
State the two functions f(x) and g(x). Subtract the equation of the lower function from the equation of the upper function and simplify. Write as a definite integral between the given values of x. Antidifferentiate. Evaluate the integral.
0 [ f ( x) g( x)] 0 ( x + 1) dx
2
1 2
x 2 + x ]2 b Area = [ 1 0 2
Worked Example 33
a Find the values of x where the functions y = x and y = x2 2 intersect. b Sketch the graphs on the same axes. Write/draw
a y = x and y = x2 2
Chapter 9 Integration
461
2 3
1 2
Define f(x) and g(x). Write the area as a definite integral between the values of x at the points of intersection. Antidifferentiate. Evaluate the integral.
Area = [ f ( x ) g( x )] dx
1
= [ x ( x 2 2)] dx
1
= ( x x 2 + 2) dx
1
3 4
= (2 8 + 4) ( 1 + 3 2 = (3 1 ) (-1 1 ) 3 6 = 31 + 11 3 6 = 41 2
1 3
2)
g(x)
a c1 0
c2
x f(x)
a [ g( x) f ( x)] dx + c
c1
c2
1
[ f ( x ) g( x )] dx + [ g( x ) f ( x )] dx
c2
Therefore, when finding areas between two curves over an interval, it must be determined whether the curves intersect within that interval. If they do, the area is broken into sub-intervals as shown above. As with areas under curves, sketch graphs should be used to assist in finding areas between curves.
462
If sketch graphs are not used, the absolute value of each integral, for each sub-interval, should be taken to ensure the correct value is obtained.
Worked examPle 34 a Find the values of x where the graph of the functions f (x) =
eBook plus
int-0568 g(x) = x intersect. Worked example 34 b Sketch the graphs on the same axes. Shade the region between the two curves and x = 1 and x = 3. c Find the exact area between f (x) and g(x) from x = 1 to x = 3 using a CAS calculator.
4 and x
Tutorial
ThInk a
1 2 3
WrITe/draW
State the two functions. Let f (x) = g(x) to find the values of x where the graphs intersect. Solve for x.
a f (x) = 4 , g (x) = x
4 x
01 2 3
State the area as the sum of two integrals for the two sub-intervals. On a Calculator page, press: MENUb 4:Calculus4 3:Integral3 Complete the entry line as:
c Area =
1 ( x x
2
) dx + ( x 4x ) dx
3 2
( 4x x ) dx + ( x 4x ) dx
3 2
Press ENTER .
Chapter 9
Integration
463
rememBer
1. If two curves f (x) and g(x) do not intersect over the interval [a, b] and f (x) > g(x), then the area enclosed by the two curves and the lines x = a and x = b is found by using the formula: b b b f ( x) dx g( x) dx = [ f ( x) g( x)] dx
a a a
2. If two curves f (x) and g(x) intersect over the interval [a, b], it is necessary to find the points of intersection and hence find the area of each section, because sometimes f (x) > g(x) and sometimes g(x) > f (x). 3. If sketch graphs are not used to determine which is the upper curve, then it is necessary to take the absolute value or positive value of each integral. exerCISe
9h
y = x3
0 y
2 x y = 8 x2 y=x
3 y = x2 5 1
x 1 y = 9 x2
01
1 0
x y = 4
y=e
2 We32b Find each of the areas in question 1. 3 mC Which one of the following does not equal the shaded area? A C E
y
1
f(x) g(x)
1 g( x) dx 1 1
5 1
f ( x ) dx
B D
1 g( x) dx + 5 f ( x) dx 1 [g( x) f ( x)] dx
5
f ( x ) dx g( x ) dx
1
0 1 y
5 [ f ( x) g( x)] dx 1
3
g(x) f(x) 4 0 x
4 mC The area bound by the curves f (x), g(x) and the lines x = 3 and x = 1 at right is equal to: A [ f ( x ) g( x )] dx B
3 [ f ( x) + g( x)] dx
3 1
464
C E
[ g( x ) f ( x )] dx
1 [ f ( x) + g( x)] dx
y
3 [ f ( x) g( x)] dx
g(x) f(x)
0 [ f ( x) g( x)] dx 0 [g( x) f ( x)] dx + 3 [ f ( x) g( x)] dx 0 [g( x) f ( x)] dx 0 [ f ( x) g( x)] dx 0 [ f ( x) g( x)] dx + 3 [g( x) f ( x)]
3 4 3 4 3 4
3 4
6 WE33 In each of the following: i find the values of x where the functions intersect ii sketch the graphs on the same axes iii hence, find the area bound by the curves. a y = 4x and y = x2 by = 2x and y = 3 x2 2 2 c y = x 1 and y = 1 x dy = x2 4 and y = 4 x2 2 2 e y = (x + 1) and y = 1 x fy = x and y = x2 7 WE34 iFind the values of x where the functions intersect. ii Sketch the graphs on the same axes. iii Find the area between f(x) and g(x) giving an exact answer. a y = x3 and y = x b y = 3x2 and y = x3 + 2x 8 Find the area between the pairs of curves below, over the given interval. a y = x3, y = x2, x [1, 1] b y = sin (x), y = cos (x), x [0, ] c y = (x 1)2, y = (x + 1)2, x [1, 1] d y = x3 5x, y = 6 2x2, x [0, 3] 1 e y = , y = 4x, x [ 1 , 1] 4 x x x f y = e , y = e , x [0, 1]
2 f(x) = 4 4x
x 0 x2 g(x) = 3 1 3
Chapter 9 Integration
465
15 The diagram below shows the outline of a window frame. If all measurements are in metres, what is the area of glass which fits into the frame?
y
2x2 y=21 2
y = 2x2
1 2
1 2
x y 5
x y = 4 100
2
16 The diagram at right shows the side view of a concrete bridge. (All measurements are in metres.) Find: a the x-intercepts of the curve b the length of the bridge c the area of the side of the bridge d the volume of concrete used to build the bridge if the bridge is 9 metres wide. 17 The cross-section of a road tunnel entrance is shown at right. (All measurements are in metres.) The shaded area is to be concreted. Find: a the exact area, above the entrance, which is to be concreted b the exact volume of concrete required to build this tunnel if it is 200 metres long.
y
x f(x) = 5 sin ( 30 )
9I
y = f(x)
yav a b x
Geometrically, the average value of the function is the height, yav, of the rectangle of width (b a) that has the same area as the area under the graph of y = f(x) for the interval [a, b].
Worked Example 35
Find the average value of f(x) = 2x2 for the interval [1, 4]. Find the value of x that corresponds to the average value.
Think
1
Write
yav =
b 1 f ( x ) dx b a a
466
Identify f(x) = 2x2 and substitute in the values for a and b. Antidifferentiate.
yav =
4 1 2 x 2 dx 1 4 1 4
1 2x3 yav = 3 3 1
1 2 43 2 13 yav = 3 3 3 = = 1 128 2 3 3 3
x2 = 14 2 x2 = 7 x= 7 x = 7 as x [1, 4].
Worked Example 36
Find the average value of f(x) = loge (2x) for the interval [2, 4]. Give your answer in exact form.
Think
1
Write
Write the relationship for the average value and substitute the values for a and b. The integral of loge (2x) is not covered in this course. The average value can only be evaluated using a CAS Calculator. On a Calculator page, press: MENU b 4:Calculus 4 3:Integral 3 Complete the entry line as: 1 4 ( ln (2 x)) dx 2 2 Press ENTER .
yav =
4 1 log e (2 x ) dx 2 42
The average value f(x) = loge (2x) for the interval [2, 4] is 4 loge (2) 1.
Chapter 9 Integration
467
rememBer
The average value, yav, for the function y = f (x) over the interval [a, b] is given by yav =
b 1 f ( x ) dx . ba a
exerCISe
9I
Find the average value, in exact form, of the function for the given interval. b y = sin (x), x 0, 6 d y = e3x, x [0, 2] b y = tan (2x), x 0, 6 d y = x x + 1, x [1, 7]
a y = x3 x, x [1, 3] c y = x , x [1, 4] 2
We36 Find the average value of the function, in exact form, for the given interval.
3 For the function y = e 2x for x [1, 0], find: a the average value of the function b the corresponding x-value in exact form. 4
mC The average value of the function f (x) = loge (2x + 1) over the interval [0, 4] is:
A 5
log e (9) 4
B loge (9)
1 [ 9 log e (3) 4 ] 4
D 9 loge (3) 4
mC The average value of the function y = sin (2x) over the interval 0,
B 2
1 2
is: 4
log e (3) + 4 4
9J
Worked examPle 37
The rate of change of position, velocity, of a particle travelling in a straight line is dx given by = 40 10 e 0.4 t m/s, t 0, where x is measured in metres and t in dt seconds. a Find the velocity: i initially ii after 10 seconds, correct to 2 decimal places. b Find the time taken to reach a velocity of 35 m/s. dx c Sketch the graph of against t. dt d Find the total distance travelled by the particle in the first 10 seconds.
468 maths Quest 12 mathematical methods CaS for the TI-nspire
int-0569
Worked example 37
Think a i
1
write
ii
Solve for t.
= 10 e
Answer the question correct to 2 decimal places. To graph dx = 40 10 e 0.4 t , on a dt Graphs page, complete the function entry line as: f1(x) = 40 10 e 0.4 x Press ENTER . Note the viewing window settings: Xmin:0, Xmax:15, Ymin:0 and Ymax:55 When drawing your graph, label the axes with the given variables. Note the horizontal asymptote dx = 40 is not displayed. The dt asymptotic behaviour of the function, however, is clearly visible. Distance travelled = area under the graph State the distance as a definite integral.
c
d dx = 40 10 e 0.4 t
dt
x=
10
(40 10 e
0.4 t )dt
Chapter 9 Integration
469
2 3
10
= (40 10 + 25e 0.4 10 ) (40 0 + 25e = (400 + 25e 4 ) (25e 0 ) 4 = 400 + 25e 25 = 375 + 25e 4 = 375.46
0.4 0
Worked Example 38
The rate of change of pressure, P atmospheres, of a given mass of gas with respect to its volume, dP k , k > 0. = dV V 2 a If d P = 5 when V = 10, find k. dV b Find the pressure, P, as a function of V given that when P = 10 atmospheres, V = 50 cm3. c Find the volume when the pressure is 20 atmospheres. V cm3, is given by
Think a
1
Write
dP k = dV V 2
5
= =
k
2
(10)
2 3
Simplify. Solve for k. Write the rate with the value of k found previously. Antidifferentiate.
P=
500 V
2
dV
2
= 500 V =
dV
470
Substitute P = 20.
2 3
Exercise
9J
a What is the deflection when x = 0? b Determine the equation that measures the deflection. c Hence, find the maximum deflection. 4 On any day the cost per item for a machine producing n items is given by dC = 40 2e 0.01n, where n [0, 200] and C is the cost in dollars. dn a Use the rate to find the cost of producing the 100th item. b Express C as a function of n. c What is the total cost of producing the first 100 items? d Find the average cost of production for: i the first 100 items ii the second 100 items. 5 WE37 The rate of change of position (velocity) of a racing car travelling down a straight dx stretch of road is given by = t (16 t ), where x is measured in metres and t in seconds. dt a Find the velocity when: i t = 0 ii t = 4. b Determine: i when the maximum velocity occurs ii the maximum velocity. dx c Sketch the graph of against t for 0 t 16. dt
Chapter 9 Integration
471
d Find the area under the graph between t = 0 and t = 10. e What does this area represent?
6 WE38 The rate at which water is pumped out of a dam, in L/min, t minutes after the pump is dV t = 5 + cos . started is 40 dt a How much water is pumped out in the 40th minute? b Find the volume of water pumped out at any time, t, after the pump is started. c How much water is pumped out after 40 minutes? d Find the average rate at which water is pumped in the first hour. e How long would it take to fill a tank holding 1600 litres? 7 The rate of flow of water into a hot water system during a 12-hour period is thought to be dV t = 10 + cos , where V is in litres and t is the number of hours after 8 am. 2 dt dV a Sketch the graph of against t. dt b Find the length of time for which the rate is above 10.5 L/h. c Find the volume of water that has flowed into the system between: i 8 am and 2 pm ii 3 pm and 8 pm. 8 The roof of a stadium has the shape given by the function f : [25, 25] R, f(x) = 20 0.024x2. The stadium is 75 metres long and its cross-section is shown at right. a Find the volume of the stadium. b The stadium is to have several airconditioners strategically placed around it. Each can service a volume of 11 250 m3. How many airconditioners are required? 9 The cross-section of a channel is parabolic. It is 3 metres wide at the top and 2 metres deep. Find the depth of water, to the nearest cm, when the channel is half full. 10 For any point P on the curve y = x3, prove that the area under the curve is one quarter of the area of the rectangle.
y (metres) 20 5 25 0 (metres) x 25
y = x3 P
472
11 The arch of a concrete bridge has the shape of a parabola. It is 6 metres high and 8 metres long. a Find the rule for the function corresponding to the arch of the bridge. b Find the area of the shaded region. c If the bridge is 10 metres wide, find the volume of concrete in the bridge. 12 In the figure at right f(x) and g(x) intersect at O and B. a Show that the coordinate of B is (loge (2), 1). b Find the exact area of the region bound by f(x) andg(x). c Show that the sum of the areas under f(x) and g(x), from x = 0 to x = loge (2), is equal to the area of the rectangle OABC.
y (metres) 7 6 (metres) x
4 y C
4 5
Chapter 9 Integration
473
Summary
Antidifferentiation rules
The relationships between f(x) and f ( x ) dx are: f(x) a axn (ax + b)n 1 x 1 ax + b ex ekx sin (ax) cos (ax) [ f ( x ) g( x )] dx =
Definite integrals
f ( x) dx
ax + c ax n + 1 +c n +1 (ax + b) n + 1 +c a( n + 1) loge |x| + c 1 log |ax + b| + c a ex + c 1 kx e +c k 1 cos (ax) + c a 1 sin (ax) + c a
f ( x) dx g( x) dx
The fundamental theorem of integral calculus: f ( x ) dx = [ F ( x )]b a = F (b) F (a) where F(x) is an antiderivative of f(x). f ( x ) dx is the definite integral
c b
a kf ( x) dx = k a
f ( x ) dx
a f ( x) dx = a f ( x) dx + c a [ f ( x) g( x)] dx = a a
b b b
f ( x ) dx g( x ) dx
f ( x ) dx =
f ( x ) dx
For a polynomial function, the graph of f(x) is one degree higher than the graph of f(x). The x-intercepts of f(x) are the x-coordinates of the turning points of f(x). When f(x) is above the x-axis, the gradient of f(x) is positive. When f(x) is below the x-axis, the gradient of f(x) is negative.
474
An approximation to the area between a curve and the x-axis can be found by dividing the area into a series of rectangles that are all the same width. The approximation is found by finding the sum of all the areas of the rectangles. For an increasing function, left rectangle approximation actual area right rectangle approximation. For a decreasing function, left rectangle approximation actual area right rectangle approximation.
Area under curves
b b
y = f(x)
a
c a
x y y = f(x)
Area =
f ( x ) dx f ( x ) dx
= f ( x ) dx +
c
a f ( x) dx , if
A1 b x
Area = [ g( x ) f ( x )] dx + [ f ( x ) g( x )] dx,
a c
if g(x) > f(x) for x [a, c] and f(x) > g(x) for x [c, b]
a 0 Limiting value of a sum c b
f ( x )dx = lim
f ( xi ) xi x0
i =1 b
yav =
1 ba
f ( x )dx
Chapter 9 Integration
475
chapter review
Short answer
1 Find the equation of the curve f(x) if it passes 3x3 2 x 2 through (1, 3) and f ( x ) = . x dy x = cos + k, where 2 A particular curve has 4 dx k is a constant, and it has a stationary point (2, 1). Find: a the value of k b the equation of the curve c the value of y when x = 6. dy 3 If y = sin (x2 + 2x), find and hence dx antidifferentiate (x + 1) cos (x2 + 2x). 4 A curve has a gradient function f(x) = 2ex + k. It has a stationary point at (0, 3). Find: a the value of k b the equation of the curve f(x). 5 Calculate the exact area between the curve y = ex 4 and the lines y = x, x = 1 and x = 2. (Hint: y = ex 4 and y = x do not intersect between x = 1 and x = 2.) 6 Evaluate each of the following definite integrals. 0 9 a dx 1 (2 x + 3) 4 b
12 The graph of f: R R, f ( x ) = e 2 + 1 is shown. The normal to the graph of f where it crosses the y-axis is also shown.
y
a Find the equation of the normal to the graph of f where it crosses the y-axis. b Find the exact area of the shaded region.
Exam tip a Students often had difficulty correctly finding the y-intercept; (0, 1) was a common answer, leading to the normal being y = 2x + 1. Quite a few students differentiated but then did not find the value of the derivative at x = 0 and simply substituted the expression for the derivative into the equation of the normal, which led to incorrect attempts at algebraic manipulation and nonlinear normals. Some students found a tangent instead. b Most students correctly set up an area expression but some were unable to proceed due to their normal not being a linear expression. Many had the correct terminals, although 2 instead of 1 was a popular incorrect value. Arithmetic errors appeared frequently and subtraction mistakes in the integrand were also common. Some students also lost 1 from the equation of the curve. The use of dx was surprisingly good. A few students used the area under the curve minus the triangle with some success.
[Assessment report 1 2007]
2 3 3
cos (2 x ) dx
7 Given that
0 (4 x 5) dx = 2, find two
possible values for k. 8 a Sketch the graph of the function f ( x ) = 1 . x2 b Find the exact area between the graph of f(x), the x-axis and the lines x = 3 and x = 6.
[ VCAA 2007]
Multiple choice
9 Find the area bound by the x-axis and the curve g(x) = (4 x)(6 + x). 10 Calculate the area between the curve y = 2 cos (x) and the lines y = x, x = 0 and x = . 2 11 Use the method of left rectangles to approximate the area under the curve y = x2 + 1, from x = 1 to x = 4, using interval widths of 1 unit.
476
1 is: 1 x
2 The indefinite integral (5 x 4)4 dx is equal to: A 25(5x 4)5 + c C (5x 4)5 + c E
1 (5 x 4) 5 25
9 If the derivative of e x A
3 3e x + 3 x
+3x
is 3( x 2 + 1)e x (x2 B D
3
+3x
B 5(5x 4)5 + c D
1 (5 x 4) 5 5
+ 1)e x + 3 x 1 3( x 2 + 1)
1 x3 +3 x e 3
is:
+c
+c
+c
C e3 x
+3
+c
+c
(3x + 4) + 4)
D
3x
2 9
(3x + 4)
8(3x
x 2 10 If the derivative of loge (5 x2) is then the 5 x2 x antiderivative of is: 5 x2 A 1 loge (5 x2) + c B 2 loge (5 x2) + c 2
E undefined
is: B 3e 3x + c D 2e 3x +1 + c
3x
+c
x 5 The indefinite integral cos 3 sin ( 3 x ) dx 3 is equal to: x A sin + cos (3x) + c 3
() x B sin ( ) + 3 cos (3x) + c 3 x C 3 sin ( ) + cos (3x) + c 3 x D 3 sin ( ) + cos (3x) + c 3 x E 3 sin ( ) cos (3x) + c 3
1 3 1 4
6 An antiderivative of x3 + sin (4x) + e4x is: A 4[x4 cos (4x) + e4x] B C D E x 4 + cos (4 x ) + 1 e4 x 4 4 cos (4x) + 1 e4x 4 e4x]
1 4 x 4 1 4 1 4
C 1 loge (5 x2) + c D 2 loge (5 x2) + c 2 E undefined 11 The approximation for the y (3.5, 9) area under the graph at (3, 6) right from x = 2 to x = 4, (2.5, 4) using the lower (2, 3) rectangles is: A 22 sq. units B 14 sq. units x 0 3 2 4 C 11 sq. units D 10 sq. units E 20 sq. units 12 The area under the graph y at right from x = 5 to (5, 8) x = 1 can be (4, 6) approximated by the area (3, 5) (2, 4) of the upper rectangles and is equal to: A 20 sq. units x 5 1 0 B 21 sq. units C 23 sq. units D 11 1 sq. units 2 E 10 sq. units 13 The interval [0, 4] is divided into n equal subintervals by the points x0, x1, . . . xn 1, xn, where 0 = x0 < x1 < . . . < xn 1 < xn = 4. Let x = xi xi 1 for i = 1, 2, . . . n. Then lim A
0
( xi x) is equal to: x0
i =1
7 If f (x) has a stationary point at (0, 3) and f (x) = ex + k, where k is a constant, then f (x) is: A ex 2x + 2 B ex x + 2 C ex x + 2 x x D e +x+2 E e + 2x + 1 8 If the derivative of (x x2)8 is 8(1 2x)(x x2)7 then an antiderivative of 24(1 2x)(x x2)7 is: A 2(x x2)8 B 3(x x2)8 C 1 (x x2)8 2 1 2 8 2 8 D 3 (x x ) E 8(x x )
4 x dx
x2 dx 2
C 0
D 4 E 8
exam TIP The definition of the definite integral as the limiting value of a sum, and its corresponding representation in integral form, is a fundamental property of integral calculus and must be understood.
[Assessment report 1 2003]
[ VCAA 2003]
Chapter 9
Integration
477
A 2 B 8 C 2 1 2 D 20 E 16
2
Questions 20 to 22 apply to the curve with equation f(x) = ex 1. 20 The graph of f(x) is best represented by: y y A B f(x) f(x)
2 0 x y 1 0 0 x
2 (4e2 x 2e 2 x ) dx is:
A e B 2e4 e 4 4 C e 2e 4 4 4 D e + e E e4 e 4 3e4
4
f(x)
f(x) x
()
1 y 1 0 1
f(x) x
D 3 3 E 3 2 1 7 The shaded area on the graph at right is equal to: A 12 sq. units B 16 sq. units C 10 sq. units D 4 sq. units E 8 sq. units 1 8 The shaded area on the graph at right is: A 20 sq. units B 20 sq. units C 16 sq. units D 16 sq. units E 18 sq. units 19 The area bound by the curve on the graph at right and the x-axis is equal to: A
5 20 12 1
21 The area bound by the graph of f(x), the x-axis and the line x = 2 is equal to: A e2 1 B e2 2 C e2 + 1 D e2 + 2 E e2 3
y = (x 2)3
4 x
22 The area bound by the graph of f(x), the y-axis and the line y = e2 1 is equal to: A e2 5 B e2 3 C e2 + 2 D e2 + 1 E 5 e2 Use the graph below to answer questions 23 and 24.
y y = x2
y 2 1 y = 1 3x2 0 2 x y = 2x + 3 0
2 3 The two graphs intersect where x is equal to: A 1 and 3 B 1 and 3 C 1 and 2 D 1 and 2 E 1 and 3 24 The area bound by the two graphs is equal to: 2 1 A 10 3 sq. units B 7 3 sq. units C 7 3 sq. units
1
y = x(x + 2)(x 3)
sq. units
0 x
D 11 3 sq. units
E 6 3 sq. units 25 The average value of the function y = cos (2x) over the interval 0, is: 4 4 2 A B c 8 1 d E 2 2
B 21 12 sq. units C
5 1012 5
sq. units
478
Extended response
1 From past records it has been found that the cost rate of maintaining a certain car is dC = 75t 2 + 50t + 800, where C is the accumulated cost in dollars and t is the time in years since the car dt was first used. Find: a the initial maintenance cost b C as a function of t c the total maintenance cost during the first 5 years of use of the car d the total maintenance cost from 3 to 5 years e the maintenance cost for the second year. 2 Over a 24-hour period on a particular autumn day, starting at 12 midnight, the rate of change of the temperature for Melbourne was approximately dT 5 t cos , where T is the temperature = 12 dt 12 in C and t is the number of hours since midnight when the temperature was 10C. Find: a the temperature at any time, t b whether the temperature reaches 17C at any time during the day c the maximum temperature and the time at which it occurs d the minimum temperature and the time at which it occurs e the temperature at i 2 am i i 3 pm f the time when the temperature first reaches 14.33C.
3 The diagram at right shows part of the curve with equation y = e 2 . Find: a the coordinate of point A b the equation of the normal to the curve at point A c the coordinate of point B d the coordinate of point C e the area bound by the curve and the lines AB and BC. 4 a Find the derivative of x loge (x). b Hence, find an antiderivative of loge (x). The cross-section of a platform is shown at right. (All measurements are in metres.) c Find the height of the platform. d Find the cross-sectional area of the platform. e Find the volume of concrete required to build this platform if it is 20 metres long.
Chapter 9 Integration
479
5 A thick metal pipe is filled with boiling water and is kept boiling. The temperature, T C, of the metal in the pipe decreases relative to its distance, x cm, from the centre of the pipe. dT 20 It is known that and 4 x 8. = dx x a Find the rate of change of the temperature in the metal on the outside of the pipe. b Express T as a function of x. c Find the temperature of the metal, correct to 2 decimal places: i when x = 6 cm ii on the outside of the pipe.
eBook plus
Digital doc
Test Yourself
Chapter 9
480
eBook plus
aCTIvITIeS
Chapter opener
Digital doc
10 Quick Questions: Warm up with ten quick questions on integration. (page 416)
9A Antidifferentiation
Digital doc
Integration by recognition 9H
Tutorial
We 34 int-0568: Watch a worked example on calculating the area between two curves using CAS. (page 463)
9J
Tutorial
Approximating areas enclosed by functions: Consolidate your understanding of varying approximations to areas enclosed by functions. (page 435)
Tutorial
We 18 int-0565: Watch a worked example on the approximation of the area under a curve. (page 435)
9E
Tutorial
Test Yourself: Take the end-of-chapter test to test your progress. (page 480)
To access eBookPLUS activities, log on to www.jacplus.com.au
Definite integrals: Investigate the properties of definite integrals. (page 442) SkillSHEET 9.2: Practise subtracting function values. (page 446)
9F
Tutorial
Signed areas
We 28 int-0567: Watch a worked example on finding the area bound by an exponential curve above and below the x-axis. (page 450)
Digital doc
WorkSHEET 9.2: Approximate areas between curves and calculate areas between curves using integrals. (page 454)
Chapter 9
Integration
481
EXAM PRACTICE 3
Short answer
Chapters 1 TO 9
40 minutes
y 4 3 2 1 1 0 1 2 3 x
a By selecting approximate values from the graph, determine a left-rectangle approximation to the area bounded by the graph, the x-axis and the lines x = 1 and x = 5 by dividing the area into four strips of equal width. dy b If y = (x + 1)ex, find . dx c Hence determine an exact value for the shaded area. 3 marks
a Find the equation of the tangent to the graph of f where it crosses the x-axis. b Find the exact area of the shaded region.
4 marks 8 minutes
Multiple choice
Each question is worth 1 mark. 1 Which integral could be evaluated in order to calculate the area enclosed between the graphs of y = f(x) and y = g(x) and the vertical lines x = a and x = b?
y f x=b x=a g x
3 A is (0, 2), a point on the y-axis. P is a point on the parabola y = x2 such that the length of AP, the line segment from the A to P is a minimum. a Find the coordinates of P. b Find the minimum length of AP. 2 marks 4 The area of the region bound by the curve with x equation y = a cos , the x-axis and the line 3 with equation x = is 3. Find a.
2 marks
A ( f ( x) g( x )) dx
b b a a b a
B ( f ( x) + g( x )) dx
a a b
C ( f ( x) g( x )) dx E
D ( f ( x) + g( x )) dx
(g( x) f ( x)) dx
5 A spa is being filled with water at the rate of 30 litres per minute. The volume (V litres) of water in the spa is related to its depth (x cm) by V = 250 loge (x). At what rate (cm per min) is the depth of the spa increasing?
2 marks
6 The graph of f : R R, f(x) = (x - 1)(5 - x) is shown. The tangent to the graph of f where it crosses the x-axis is also shown.
2 The average value of the function y = 3 sin (2 x + ) 3 over the interval [0, ] is: 3 3 3 A 0 B 4 1 3 3 C 2 D 4 2
E 27 4
482
of (3 f ( x ) 1) dx? A D 14
2 16
B 14 E 16
C 12
Which of these rules could correspond to the second sketch? A y = f (x) B y = f 1(x) C y = f (x) D y = f (x) 1 E y= f ( x) 5 If f (x) = (2x + 1)2 and f (0) = 1 then the antiderivative of f (x) will be equal to: A (2 x + 1)3 2 + 3 3 1 C ((2 x + 1)3 + 5) 6 E 4x3 + 4x2 + x + 1 B 4x + 1 D 2(2x + 1) + 1
4 A function with the rule y = f (x) is shown in the first sketch below.
y y
exTended reSPonSe
30 minutes
r
The volume of a cylindrical soft drink can is 250 mL. The volume of a cylinder can be calculated using V = r2h, the area of a circle is given by A = r2 and its perimeter is given by P = 2 r. Also 1 mL = 1 cm3. a Create an expression for the total surface area of the can, S, in terms of r and h. b Usethefactthatthevolumeis250mLtoshowthatS can be expressed in terms of r 500 only as S = 2 r 2 + . 1 mark r 500 y c The graphs at right are of y = 2 r2 and y = for 0 r 10.Usethesegraphs r 700 600 500 to create a sketch of S = 2 r 2 + on the same axes. 500 r 1 mark d Hence obtain an estimate, to 1 decimal place, of the radius corresponding to the minimum total surface area.
400 300 200 100 4 6
1 mark
e Usingcalculusdetermineanexact value for the radius corresponding to the 0 2 minimum surface area. f i Write down a decimal approximation to 2 decimal places for the radius corresponding to the minimum total surface area. ii Confirm using the sign of gradient test that the stationary point located is in fact a minimum. iii Write down the value of the minimum surface area to the nearest cm2.
1 mark
8 10 x
g If the cost of the material for the bottom and top of the can is twice the cost for the sides determine the radius of the can for minimum total cost. h The actual radius for a can of soft drink is 3.0 cm. Determine to 2 decimal places the ratio cost of material for top and bottom which would be consistent with this can having the minimum cost of material for the sides cost of materials.
1 + 1 = 2 marks
2 marks
2 marks
eBook plus
Digital doc
Solutions
Exam practice 3
exam practice 3
483
10
Discrete random variables
areaS oF STuDy
10A Probability revision 10B Discrete random variables 10C Measures of centre of discrete random distributions 10D Measures of variability of discrete random distributions
Random variables, including: the concept of discrete and continuous random variables calculation and interpretation of the expected value, variance and standard deviation of a random variable calculation and interpretation of central measures (mean, median, mode) the property that, for many random variables, approximately 95% of their probability distribution is within 2 standard deviations of the mean
Discrete random variables, including: specification of probability distributions for discrete random variables using graphs, tables and probability functions interpretation and use of mean (), median, mode, variance ( 2) and standard deviation of a discrete random variable probabilities for specific values of a random variable and intervals defined in terms of a random variable, including conditional probability
eBook plus
Digital doc
10a
Probability revision
Terminology
10 Quick Questions
To introduce this chapter we shall revise important concepts and skills that were covered in Mathematical Methods (CAS) Units 1 and 2.
The circular spinner at right is divided into 8 equal sectors. When the 2 1 spinner is spun, the possible outcomes are 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8. These outcomes may be listed as the elements of a set. The set of all possible 3 8 outcomes of an experiment is called the sample space (or the universal set) and is denoted by , and each possible outcome is called a sample 7 4 point. Therefore, spinning the spinner gives = {1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8}. A subset of the sample space is known as an event. For the example 5 6 above, if event A is defined as an odd number when the spinner is spun, then A = {1, 3, 5, 7}. If event B is defined as a number less than 5 when the spinner is spun, then B = {1, 2, 3, 4}. The union (symbol ) of the two events A and B above implies a combined event, that is, either event A or event B or both occurring. Therefore the set A B = {1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 7}. (Note: Common elements are written only once.)
484
The intersection (symbol ) of the two events A and B above is represented by the common sample points of the two events. Therefore the set A B = {1, 3}.
Venn diagrams
Venn diagrams involve drawing a rectangle that represents the sample space and a series of circles that represent subsets of the sample space. They provide a visual representation of the information at hand and clearly display the relationships between sets. The Venn diagrams below illustrate an alternative way of presenting information regarding the circular spinner shown on the previous page.
A 5 7 1 3 2 4
B 6 8
A 5 7 1 3 2 4
B 6 8
A 5 7 1 3 2 4
B 6 8
AB
AB
Note: Sample points not belonging to either set are placed outside the circles but remain inside the rectangle. Venn diagrams can also assist in determining whether or not two sets are equal, that is, whether they contain the same elements. As the examples below show, the equality of two sets may not be obvious from the set notation but is often easier to see in a diagram.
A A
A B = (A B)
A B = (A B)
Probability
Probability deals with the likelihood or chance of some event occurring. The probability of a specific event, say A, occurring is defined by the rule: Pr(A) = number of favourable outcomes total number of possible outcomes
Its probability lies within the restricted interval 0 Pr(A) 1. A probability of zero implies that the event cannot occur, while a probability of 1 implies that the event will most certainly occur. The individual probabilities of a particular experiment will sum to a value of 1 and can be denoted as follows.
p( x) = 1
If Pr(A) is defined as the probability of an event occurring, then its complement, Pr(A), is defined as the probability of an event not occurring. Therefore, it can be stated that Pr(A) + Pr(A) = 1 which can be transposed to Pr(A) = 1 Pr(A).
485
Worked Example 1
Two fair dice are rolled simultaneously and the sum of the two numbers appearing uppermost is recorded as shown below. (1, 1) (2, 1) (3, 1) (4, 1) (5, 1) (6, 1) (1, 2) (2, 2) (3, 2) (4, 2) (5, 2) (6, 2) (1, 3) (2, 3) (3, 3) (4, 3) (5, 3) (6, 3) (1, 4) (2, 4) (3, 4) (4, 4) (5, 4) (6, 4) (1, 5) (2, 5) (3, 5) (4, 5) (5, 5) (6, 5) (1, 6) (2, 6) (3, 6) (4, 6) (5, 6) (6, 6)
Find the probability that the sum will be: a 6 b 10 c a number less than 5 d at least 9 e an odd number.
Think a
1 2 3
Write
List all the possible outcomes. Define the event. Substitute the values into the probability rule.
Let A = the sum of 6. number of favourable outcomes Pr(A) = total number of possible outcomes = 5 36
b (6, 4) (5, 5) (4, 6)
1 2 3
List all the possible outcomes. Define the event. Substitute the values into the probability rule.
Simplify. List all the possible outcomes. Define the event. Substitute the values into the probability rule.
c
Let A = the sum of 10. number of favourable outcomes Pr(A) = total number of possible outcomes = 3 36 1 = 12 (1, 1) (2, 1) (3, 1) (1, 2) (2, 2) (1, 3) Let A = a number less than 5. number of favourable outcomes Pr(A) = total number of possible outcomes 6 = 36 1 = 6
d (6, 3) (5, 4) (6, 4) (4, 5) (5, 5)
1 2 3
Simplify. List all the possible outcomes. Define the event. Substitute the values into the probability rule.
1 2 3
(6, 5) (3, 6) (4, 6) (5, 6) (6, 6) Let A = at least 9. number of favourable outcomes Pr(A) = total number of possible outcomes 10 = 36
486
5 18
(2, 3) (4, 3) (6, 3) (1, 4) (3, 4) (5, 4) (2, 5) (4, 5) (6, 5) (1, 6) (3, 6) (5, 6)
2 3
Define the event. Substitute the values into the probability rule.
Simplify.
Let A = an odd number. number of favourable outcomes Pr(A) = total number of possible outcomes 18 = 36 1 = 2
Worked Example 2
A bag contains 15 marbles comprising 5 black, 3 red, 4 blue, 2 white and 1 green. One marble is drawn randomly from the bag. a Determine the probability of each of the coloured marbles being drawn: i black ii red iii blue iv white v green. b Show that the probabilities sum to 1. c What is the probability that the marble drawn is: i not black? ii either black or white? iii neither blue nor green?
Think a i
1 2
Write
Define the event. Substitute the values into the probability rule.
Pr(B) =
Simplify. Define the event. Substitute the values into the probability rule.
ii
1 2
Simplify. Define the event. Substitute the values into the probability rule.
iii
1 2
total number of possible outcomes 3 = 15 1 = 5 i i i Let Bl = a blue marble. total number of possible outcomes 4 = 15 i v Let W = a white marble. Pr(Bl) = number of favourable outcomes
Pr(R) =
iv
487
Pr(W) =
1 2
Define the event. Substitute the values into the probability rule.
Pr(G) =
+ 15 + 15 + 15
=1
c
Write the appropriate rule: Pr(A) = 1 Pr(A). Substitute the known values into the rule. Evaluate. Add each of the probabilities together. Substitute the known values into the rule. Evaluate. Write the appropriate rule. Substitute the known values into the rule. Evaluate.
i Pr(B) = 1 Pr(B)
=13 =
2 3
ii
1 2 3
= 3 + 15 = 15
i i i Pr(Bl G) = 1 [Pr(Bl) + Pr(G)]
7
iii
1 2 3
= 1
4 15 5
+ 15
= 1 15 = 15
10 2
Simplify.
=3
Worked Example 3
a If Pr(A) = 0.4, Pr(B) = 0.7 and Pr(A B) = 0.2, find Pr(A B). b If Pr(A) = 0.6, Pr(B) = 0.8 and Pr(A B) = 0.9, find Pr(A B).
Think a
1 2 3
Write
Write the addition rule. Substitute the known values into the rule. Evaluate.
488
1 2 3 4
Write the addition rule. Substitute the known values into the rule. Transpose the equation to make Pr(A B) the subject. Evaluate.
0.9 = 0.6 + 0.8 Pr(A B) 0.9 = 1.4 Pr(A B) Pr(A B) = 1.4 0.9 = 0.5
Venn diagrams may also be used to display the probabilities rather than just the outcomes, as shown in the diagram below.
Note: Pr(A B) is represented by the shaded section. The probabilities given and calculated in worked example 3(a) and 3(b) can be displayed as follows.
0.1
0.1
Independent events
Two events A and B are independent if one event does not influence the other event from occurring. The mathematical definition of independence is given by: Pr(A B) = Pr(A) Pr(B)
Worked Example 4
Two fair dice are rolled with S representing the event of obtaining a number less than 4 on the first die and T the event of obtaining a number greater than 4 on the second die. Find: a Pr(S) b Pr(T) c if events S and T are mutually exclusive d if events S and T are independent.
489
Think a
1 2 3 4
Write
Refer to the dice results recorded in the question in worked example 1. Define the event. Determine the probability. Simplify. Define the event. Determine the probability. Simplify.
1 2 3
Pr(T) = =
c
12 36 1 3
Events S and T are not mutually exclusive since they have common points; that is, (1,5) (1, 6) (2, 5) (2, 6) (3, 5) (3, 6). in worked example 1, Pr(S T) = 6 =
36 1 6
=1 6 Since both methods give the same answer, Sand T are independent events.
Worked Example 5
Two fair dice are rolled with U representing the event of obtaining a 5 on the first die and V the event of the sum of numbers on the two dice exceeding 10. Find: a Pr(U) b Pr(V) c if events U and V are independent.
Think a
1 2 3 4
Write
Refer to the dice results recorded in the question in worked example 1. Define the event. Determine the probability. Simplify. Define the event. Determine the probability. Simplify.
1 2 3
Pr(V) = 36 = 12
490
1 2
Answer the question using the dice results. Check with answer obtained using the rule.
1 36
Using rule Pr(U V) = Pr(U) Pr(V) = 6 12 = 72 Since the two methods do not give the same answer, U and V are not independent events.
1 1 1
Karnaugh map
Probability table
Worked Example 6
For the probability table shown, A is the event Column 1 Column 2 Column 3 not more than 17 years of age and B is the B B event has a learner permit. a Complete the probability table at right. Row 1 A 0.12 b What do the following probabilities Row 2 A 0.5 represent? Row 3 0.63 1 i Pr(AB) ii Pr(AB) c What is the probability that: i a person over the age of 17 does not have a learner permit? ii a person has a learner permit and is older than 17? iii a person over the age of 17 has a learner permit or a person at or under the age of 17 does not have a learner permit?
Think a
1
Write
Calculate the values of the cells in row 1, column 3 and row 3, column 1. Enter the values into the appropriate cells.
a Pr(A) = 1 Pr(A)
= 1 0.5 = 0.5
Pr(B) = 1 Pr(B) = 1 0.63 = 0.37 Column 1 B Column 2 B 0.5 0.5 0.37 0.63 1 Column 3
A A
0.12
Enter the value into the appropriate cell. Row 1 Row 2 Row 3 A A
Calculate the value of the cell in row 2, column 1. Enter the value into the appropriate cell.
Pr(AB) = Pr(B) Pr(AB) = 0.37 0.12 = 0.25 Column 1 B Row 1 Row 2 Row 3 A A 0.12 0.25 0.37 0.63 Column 2 B 0.38 0.5 0.5 1 Column 3
Calculate the value of the cell in row 2, column 2. Enter the value into the appropriate cell.
Pr(AB) = Pr(B) Pr(AB) = 0.63 0.38 = 0.25 Column 1 B Row 1 Row 2 Row 3 A A 0.12 0.25 0.37 Column 2 B 0.38 0.25 0.63 0.5 0.5 1 Column 3
at or under the age of 17 having a learner permit. In this case the probability of the given event occurring is 0.12. over the age of 17 not having a learner permit. In this case the probability of the given event occurring is 0.25.
in this example.
ii State the appropriate probability from iii State the appropriate probabilities
= 0.63
Conditional probability
Conditional probability deals with an event which has previously occurred and has an effect on an event we are interested in. Due to the initial condition (or restriction) imposed, the number of Pr ( A B) possible events is reduced. Conditional probability is defined by the rule Pr ( A | B) = ,, Pr(B) where Pr(B) 0, and can be transposed to Pr(A B) = Pr(A | B) Pr(B). The latter is called the multiplication rule. Pr(A | B) is read as the probability of A given B.
492 Maths Quest 12 Mathematical Methods CAS for the TI-Nspire
WorkeD examPle 7
If Pr(A) = 1 , Pr(B) = 1 and Pr(A B) = 1 , find: 5 10 20 a Pr(A B) b Pr(A | B) c Pr(B | A) d if events A and B are mutually exclusive e if events A and B are independent.
Think a
1 2 3 4
eBook plus
Tutorial
int-0570
Worked example 7
WriTe
Write the addition rule. Substitute the known values into the rule. Evaluate. Simplify. Write the appropriate rule. Substitute the known values into the rule. Evaluate.
= =
b Pr(A | B) =
5 20 1 4
1 2
Pr( A B) Pr( B)
1 20 1 10 1 20 1 20 10 20 1 2 1 10
= = = =
10 1
Simplify. Write the appropriate rule. Substitute the known values into the rule.
=
c Pr(B | A) =
1 2
Pr( B A) Pr( A)
1 20 1 5 1 20 1 20 5 20 1 4
= = = =
Evaluate.
1 5 5 1
Simplify.
Compare the given value with the answer obtained using the rule.
e Pr(A B) =
Since the two methods do not give the same answer, A and B are not independent events. From worked example 7(b) and 7(c) it can be seen that Pr(A | B) Pr(B | A).
493
Chapter 10
Tree diagrams
Tree diagrams are a useful tool in solving probability tasks as they display each of the possible outcomes along with their respective probabilities.
Worked Example 8
Nadia knows that if her car starts, she has an 80% chance of getting to work on time. However, if her car doesnt start, her chance of arriving on time is 50%. If Nadias car starts only 70% of the time, what is the probability that: a her car starts and she gets to work on time? b she arrives at work late? c she arrives at work on time? d her car starts, given that she arrives at work on time?
Think a
1
Write
Let C = car doesnt start Let O = Nadia arrives at work on time Let L = Nadia arrives at work late
7 = 10
80
=2
1
Draw a tree diagram with each branch assigned the appropriate probability.
O
1 2 1 2
C C
7 10 28 50 14 25
1 5
L O L
Pr(CO) = = =
Simplify.
494
= = = = = = = =
7 10 7 50 14 100 29 100
1 + +
5 3 20 15 100
3 10
d
1
Write the appropriate rule. Note: Given implies conditional probability. Substitute the known values into the rule. Evaluate and simplify.
d Pr(C|O) =
Pr(CO) Pr(O)
14 25 71 100 14 71 25 100
= =
= 14 100 25 71 = 56
71
Worked Example 9
A fair coin is tossed three times. Find the probability of obtaining two heads given the first toss resulted in a tail.
Think
1
Write
H H T H T T
H T H T H T H T
495
1 8 1 2 1 1
=82 =12 =
8 2 8 4 1
Simplify.
=1
Combinations
In mathematics, a combination deals with the number of ways items may be selected from a set of elements where the order is not important. For example, in how many ways can 3 numbers be selected from the set {1, 2, 3, 4}, taking into account that order is not important? The following selections can be made: 1, 2, 3 1, 2, 4 2, 3, 4 3, 4, 1 Hence 4 selections could be made. If order was important, there would be a greater number of possibilities since each of the above selections could be arranged in 6 ways. For example, the selection (1, 2, 3) could be arranged as: 1, 2, 3 2, 1, 3 2, 3, 1 3, 1, 2 3, 2, 1 1, 3, 2. A combination is also referred to as a selection or choice, and is defined by the rule nCr. nC = the number of selections of n different objects taken r at a time r n! = n ( r )!r !
nC r
()
WorkeD examPle 10
eBook plus
Tutorial
A drawer contains 7 T-shirts of which 3 are white and the rest are black. If 2 T-shirts are randomly selected from the drawer simultaneously, find the probability that they are: a both black b both white c different colours d the same colour.
Think a
1 2 3
int-0571
Worked example 10
WriTe
Calculate the number of selections of taking 2 black T-shirts from a total of 4. Calculate the number of selections of taking 2 T-shirts from a total of 7. Calculate the probability using the rule. Substitute the known values into the rule. Simplify. Calculate the number of selections of taking 2 white T-shirts from a total of 3.
2 = 6; that is, there are 6 ways of selecting 2 black T-shirts from a total of 4. 4C 7C 2 = 21; that is, there are 21 ways of selecting 2 T-shirts from a total of 7.
Pr(both black) =
4 5
6 = 21 2 = 7
b
2 = 3; that is, there are 3 ways of selecting 2 white T-shirts from a total of 3. 3C
496
Calculate the number of selections of taking 2 T-shirts from a total of 7. Calculate the probability using the rule. Substitute the known values into the rule. Simplify. Calculate the number of selections of taking 1 black T-shirt from a total of 4. Calculate the number of selections of taking 1 white T-shirt from a total of 3. Calculate the number of selections of taking 2 T-shirts from a total of 7. Calculate the probability using the rule. Substitute the known values into the rule. Evaluate. Simplify. Calculate the probability using the rule. Substitute the known values into the rule. Evaluate.
c
7C = 21; that is, there are 21 ways of selecting 2 2 T-shirts from a total of 7.
Pr(both white) = =
4 5
4C 1 3C 1 7C 2
3 21 1 = 7
1 2 3
= 4; that is, there are 4 ways of selecting 1black T-shirt from a total of 4. = 3; that is, there are 3 ways of selecting 1white T-shirt from a total of 3. = 21; that is, there are 21 ways of selecting 2 T-shirts from a total of 7. 1 black 1 white Pr(different colours) = 2 T-shirts from 7 43 = 21 12 = 21 4 = 7
4 5 6 7
1 2 3
+ Pr(both white)
7 3 7 7
=2+1 =
REMEMBER
1. Outcomes are results of experiments. 2. The set of all possible outcomes of an experiment is called the sample space and is denoted by , and each possible outcome is called a sample point. 3. A subset of the sample space is known as an event. 4. The union (symbol ) of two events A and B implies a combined event, that is, either event A or event B or both occurring. Common elements are written only once. 5. The intersection (symbol ) of two events is represented by the common sample points of the two events. 6. Venn diagrams involve drawing a rectangle that represents the sample space and a series of circles that represent subsets of the sample space. They provide a visual representation of the information at hand and clearly display the relationship between sets. 7. The probability of an event occurring is defined by the rule Pr(A) = number of favourable outcomes total number of possible outcomes
497
8. The probability of an event occurring lies within the restricted interval 0 Pr(A) 1 9. The individual probabilities of a particular experiment will sum to 1; that is,
p( x) = 1
10. The addition rule of probability is defined by the rule Pr(A B) = Pr(A) + Pr(B) Pr(A B) 11. If two events, A and B, are mutually exclusive then Pr(A B) = 0, and therefore the addition rule becomes Pr(A B) = Pr(A) + Pr(B). 12. If two events, A and B, are independent then Pr(A B) = Pr(A) Pr(B). 13. Karnaugh maps and probability tables summarise all combinations of two events (for example A and B) and their complements (for example A and B). 14. Conditional probability is defined by the rule Pr(A|B) = Pr(A B) , where Pr(B) 0. Pr ( B)
This can be transposed to Pr(A B) = Pr(A|B) Pr(B). 15. Tree diagrams are useful tools in solving probability tasks because they display each of the possible outcomes along with their respective probabilities. 16. A combination is defined by nCr; that is, the number of selections of n different objects taken r at a time.
Exercise
10A
Probability revision
1 WE1 Two fair dice are rolled simultaneously and the sum of the two numbers appearing uppermost is recorded. Find the probability that the sum will be: a 3 b 12 c 7 d greater than 4 e at least 7 f an even number g a prime number. 2 WE2 A bag contains 12 marbles comprising 3 black, 5 red and 4 green. One marble is drawn randomly from the bag. a Determine the probability of each of the coloured marbles being drawn: i black ii red iii green. b Show that the probabilities sum to 1. c What is the probability that the marble drawn is: i not green? ii either black or red? iii neither red nor green? iv either black, red or green? 3 A fair coin is tossed three times. Find the probability of obtaining: a three heads b two heads c one head d no heads e at least two heads. 4 A circular spinner is divided into 8 equal sectors and numbered as shown in the diagram at right. If the spinner is spun once, find the probability of obtaining: a a one b a two c a three or a four or a five d a one or a two.
1 1 5 4
1 2 2 3
498
5 WE3a If Pr(A) = 0.3, Pr(B) = 0.6 and Pr(A B) = 0.2, find Pr(A B). 6 WE3b If Pr(A) = 0.5, Pr(B) = 0.4 and Pr(A B) = 0.8, find Pr(A B). 7 If Pr(A) = 4 Pr(B), Pr(A B) = 0.8 and Pr(A B) = 0.2, find: a Pr(B) b Pr(A). 8 Of the 200 students studying VCE at Merlynston Secondary College, 80 study Maths Methods, while there are 65 Physics students. If there are 85 students who dont take either Maths Methods or Physics, find the probability that a randomly selected student: a studies Maths Methods b studies Physics c studies neither Maths Methods nor Physics d studies Maths Methods and Physics e studies Physics, given that the student studies Maths Methods. 9 WE4,5 Two fair dice are rolled, with F representing the event of obtaining a number greater than 4 on the first die and G the event of obtaining an even number on the second. Find: a Pr(F) b Pr(G) c if events F and G are mutually exclusive d if events F and G are independent. 10 For two events P and Q, Pr(P) = 0.72, Pr(Q) = 0.25 and Pr(P Q) = 0.91. Are P and Q mutually exclusive events? 11 For two events X and Y, Pr(X) = 0.4, Pr(Y) = 0.5 and Pr(X Y) = 0.2. Are X and Y independent events? 12 WE6 For the probability table shown, A is the event is unfit and B is the event is a smoker. a Complete the probability table at right. Column 1 B Row 1 Row 2 Row 3 b c What do the following probabilities represent? i Pr(A B) ii Pr(A B) What is the probability that: i a person is unfit and a non-smoker? ii a person is a smoker and fit? iii a person is unfit and a smoker or is unfit and a non-smoker? iv a person is a non-smoker?
1 6
Column 2 B 0.60
Column 3
A A
0.22 0.68 1
13 WE7
If Pr(A) = 1 , Pr(B) = 1 and Pr(A B) = 2 3 a Pr(A B) b Pr(A | B) d if events A and B are mutually exclusive e if events A and B are independent.
find: c Pr(B | A)
14
If Pr(A) = 0.4, Pr(B) = 0.5 and Pr(A B) = 0.2 find: a Pr(A B) b Pr(A | B)
c Pr(B | A).
15 WE8 A recent study has shown that 60% of people who dont wear glasses get regular headaches, while only 30% of people who wear glasses are headache sufferers. If 35% of people wear glasses, find the probability that a randomly selected person: a wears glasses and gets headaches b does not wear glasses and suffers from headaches c suffers from headaches d wears glasses, given that the person suffers from headaches.
499
16
Jemma knows that if her alarm goes off, she has a 90% chance of getting to school on time. However, if the alarm does not ring, her chance of arriving on time is only 40%. If Jemmas alarm clock works only 60% of the time, what is the probability that: a she gets to school on time b she arrives late to school c her alarm rang, given that she arrived on time? A bag contains 5 red marbles and 3 green marbles. A marble is selected at random, its colour is observed and it is then replaced. A second selection is then made. Find the probability that the two marbles chosen were: a both red b both green c different colours d the same colour.
17
18 MC Two fair dice are rolled. The probability of the numbers showing uppermost on both dice being the same is: A
1 36
19 MC If Pr(S) = 0.2, Pr(T) = 0.5 and Pr(S T) = 0.6, which one of the following is not true? A Pr(S T) = 0.1 B Pr(S | T) = 0.2 C Pr(T | S) = 0.5 D S and T are mutually exclusive. E S and T are independent. 20 MC The probability of picking a red picture card from a standard pack of playing cards is: A 1 B 3 C 2 D 3 E 1 21 MC If Pr(M) = 0.3, Pr(N) = 0.4 and Pr(M | N) = 0.5 then Pr(M N) is equal to: A 0.15 B 0.2 C 0.6 D 0.75 E 0.8 22 WE9 A fair coin is tossed three times. Find the probability of obtaining three tails, given that the first toss resulted in a tail. 23 If Pr(A) = 0.6, Pr(B) = 0.5 and Pr(A B) = 0.36, find: a Pr(A) b Pr(B) d Pr(A B) e Pr(A B) g Pr(B | A) h Pr(A | B) c Pr(A B) f Pr(A | B) i Pr(B | A).
2 13 13 26 26
1 18
C 1
6
D 3
1 2
24 WE10 A drawer contains 6 T-shirts, of which 2 are white and the rest are black. If 2 T-shirts are randomly selected from the drawer simultaneously, find the probability that they are: a both black b both white c different colours d the same colour. 25 A box contains one dozen chocolates, of which 4 are strawberry creams, 3 are orange creams and 5 are peppermint creams. Two chocolates are selected at random. Find the probability that they are both the same type if: a the first chocolate is replaced before the second is drawn b the first chocolate is not replaced before the second is drawn. 26 MC A fair die has its 4-spot changed to a 5-spot and its 2-spot changed to a 3-spot. The probability of getting an even number when the altered die is rolled is: A 1 B 1 C 1 D 2 E 5 27 MC A box contains 3 red balls and 2 green balls. Two balls are chosen simultaneously. The probability that they are the same colour is: A 8 B 2 C 13 D 3 E 13 28 A bag contains 5 red cubes and 3 black cubes. Three cubes are chosen at random. Find the probability of at least 2 reds being chosen, given that the first cube was red: a if the cubes are replaced after each draw b if the cubes are not replaced after each draw.
500
25 5 25 5 20 6 3 2 3 6
29 Jo-anne knows that her chance of winning each tennis match she plays is 0.8. A knockout tournament requires players to win five matches to win the championship. What is the probability that Jo-anne: a wins the tournament? Give your answer to 4 decimal places. b wins the tournament given that she wins her first three matches? 30 In a particular suburb the chances of a woman owning her own home is 0.4, while the probability of a woman owning her own home and being employed is 0.2. Find the probability that a woman who owns her own home is also employed. The probability of Vanessas car starting on a cold morning is 0.6, while on a normal morning the chance of it starting is 0.9. The probability of any morning being a cold one is 0.3. If Vanessas car starts tomorrow morning, find the probability that the morning is cold.
31
32 The Roosters know that they will win 80% of their home matches and 40% of their away matches. This seasons fixture has the Roosters playing 55% of their games at home. Given that the Roosters won their last game, what was the probability that it was played at home? 33 Tatiana is trying out for a place on the high jump team. In order to qualify she must clear three of the four heights. She knows that she has a 70% chance of clearing the first height and a 65% chance of clearing any subsequent height. What is the probability, to 4 decimal places, that Tatiana: a clears the first, third and fourth heights only? b clears three heights? c clears three heights, given she did not clear the first height?
10B
Worked Example 11
Which of the following represent discrete random variables? a The number of goals scored at a football match b The height of students in a Maths Methods class c Shoe sizes d The number of girls in a five-child family e The time taken, in minutes, to run a distance of 10 kilometres
Think Write
501
c The number of shoe sizes can be counted. d The number of girls can be counted. e Time must be measured.
Let X represent the number of tails obtained in three tosses. Draw up a table that displays the values the discrete random variable can assume and the corresponding probabilities.
Think
1
Write
H T H T T
H T H T H T H T
Draw a table with two columns: one labelled number of tails, the other probability. Enter the information into the table.
Probability Pr(x)
1 8 3 8 3 8 1 8
The table above displays the probability distribution of the total number of tails obtained in three tosses of a fair coin. Since the variable in this case is discrete, the table displays a discrete probability distribution. In worked example 12, X denoted the random variable and x the value that the random variable could take. Thus the probability can be denoted by p(x) or Pr (X = x). Hence the table in worked example 12 could be presented as shown below. x Pr(X = x) 0
1 8
1
3 8
2
3 8
3
1 8
Close inspection of this table shows important characteristics that satisfy all discrete probability distributions. 1. Each probability lies in a restricted interval 0 Pr(X = x) 1. 2. The probabilities of a particular experiment sum to 1, that is,
Pr (x = x) = 1
If these two characteristics are not satisfied, then there is no discrete probability distribution.
502
Worked Example 13
Write Pr(X = x)
3 8 2 8 1 8
Draw a set of axes in the first quadrant only. Label the horizontal axis x and the vertical axis Pr(X = x). Mark graduations evenly along the horizontal and vertical axes, and label with appropriate values. Draw a straight line from each x-value to its corresponding probability.
Pr(X = x)
3 8 2 8 1 8
A column graph
Worked Example 14
A dot graph
Which of the following tables represent a discrete probability distribution? a b x 0 1 2 3 x 0 2 4 Pr(X = x) c x Pr(X = x)
Think a
1
6 0.1 7 0.4
0.2
1
0.5 0 0.1
0.2 1 0.3
0.1 2 0.3 d
Pr(X = x) x Pr(X = x)
0.5
2 0.2
0.3 0 0.3
0.1 5 0.5
0.2
Write
Check whether each of the probabilities lie within the restricted interval 0 Pr(X = x) 1. Check that the probabilities sum to 1. Answer the question. Check whether each of the probabilities lie within the restricted interval 0 Pr(X = x) 1. Check that the probabilities sum to 1. Answer the question.
inclusive. 0.2 + 0.5 + 0.2 + 0.1 = 1 Yes, this is a discrete probability distribution since both requirements have been met.
b All probabilities lie between 0 and 1
2 3
inclusive. 0.5 + 0.3 + 0.1 + 0.1 = 1 Yes, this is a discrete probability distribution since both requirements have been met.
2 3
503
Check whether each of the probabilities lie within the restricted interval 0 Pr(X = x) 1. Check that the probabilities sum to 1. Answer the question.
All probabilities lie between 0 and 1 inclusive. 0.2 + 0.1 + 0.3 + 0.3 1 (totals to 0.9) No, this is not a discrete probability distribution since both requirements have not been met.
2 3
Check whether each of the probabilities lie within the restricted interval 0 Pr(X = x) 1. Check that the probabilities sum to 1. Answer the question.
The first probability is a negative value, so not all probabilities lie between 0 and 1 inclusive.
0.2
2 3
No, this is not a discrete probability distribution since both requirements have not been met.
WorkeD examPle 15
Find the value of k for each of the following discrete probability distributions. a x 1 3 5 7 Pr(X = x) b x Pr(X = x)
Think a
1 2 3
9 0.1 4 2k
0.2 0 5k
k 1 6k
0.2 2 4k
WriTe
0.3 3 3k
Add up each of the given probabilities. They should sum to 1. Simplify. Solve to find k. Add up each of the given probabilities. They should sum to 1. Simplify. Solve to find k.
1 2 3
WorkeD examPle 16
eBook plus
1 42 (5x Tutorial
a Show that the function p(x) = + 3), where x = 0, 1, 2, 3 is a probability function. 1 b Show that the function p(x) = 100 x2 (6 x), where x = 2, 3, 4, 5 is a probability function.
Think a
1
int-0572
Worked example 16
WriTe
Substitute each of the x-values into the equation and obtain the corresponding probability.
When x = 0, p(x) = =
3 42 1 14
504
When x = 1, p(x) =
=
8 42 4 21 13 42 18 42 3 7
Check whether each of the probabilities lie within the restricted interval 0 Pr(X = x) 1. Check whether the probabilities sum to 1. State whether the function is a probability function. Substitute each of the x-values into the equation and obtain the corresponding probability. Simplify where possible.
4 5
+ 42 + 7 = 1
13
Yes, this is a probability function since both requirements have been met.
b When x = 2, p(x) = 16 100
= 25
27 32 8
= 25
25
=4
3 4 5
Check whether each of the probabilities lie within the restricted interval 0 Pr(X = x) 1. Check whether the probabilities sum to 1. State whether the function is a probability function.
+ 100 + 25 + 4 = 1
27
Yes, this is a probability function since both requirements have been met.
Worked Example 17
Three balls are selected from a box containing 6 blue balls and 4 yellow balls. If the ball chosen after each selection is replaced before the next selection, find: a the probability distribution for the number of blue balls drawn: i 0 blue balls ii 1 blue ball iii 2 blue balls iv 3 blue balls b the probability that 3 blue balls are chosen, given that at least one ball was blue.
Think a i
1
Write/draw
Draw a tree diagram and list all the possible outcomes with their respective probabilities.
i
6 10 6 10
6 10
Probability
6 6 = 10 10 6 4 10 10 4 6 10 10 4 4 10 10 6 6 10 10 6 4 10 10 4 6 10 10 4 4 10 10
216 1000 = 144 1000 = 144 1000 96 = 1000 = 144 1000 96 = 1000 96 = 1000 64 = 1000
B
4 10 6 10
4 10
Y B
6 10
4 6 10 10 4 10
4 10
Y
4 10
6 10
4 10
505
Obtain the probability required. List the required probabilities from the tree diagram obtained in part i . Note: Three outcomes correspond to 1 blue ball. Evaluate and simplify.
ii
+ Pr(YYB)
iii
List the required probabilities from the tree diagram obtained in part i . Note: Three outcomes correspond to 2 blue balls. Evaluate and simplify.
+ Pr(YBB)
iv
1 2
Obtain the probability required. Place all of the information in a table. Check that the probabilities sum to 1.
b
x Pr(X = x)
0 0.064
1 2
Pr(X = x) = 0.064 + 0.288 + 0.432 + 0.216 =1 Pr ( X = 3 X > 1) Pr ( X = 3 | X > 1) = Pr ( X > 1) Pr(X = 3 X > 1) = Pr(X = 3) = 0.216 Pr(X > 1) = 0.432 + 0.216 = 0.648 0.216 Pr(X = 3 | X > 1) = 0.648 1 = 3
REMEMBER
1. Discrete random variables generally deal with number or size and are able to be counted. 2. A discrete probability distribution exists only if the following two characteristics are satisfied. (a) Each probability lies in a restricted interval 0 Pr(X = x) 1. (b) The probabilities of a particular experiment sum to 1, that is, Pr(X = x) = 1.
506
exerCiSe
10B
eBook plus
Digital doc
Spreadsheet 100
Probability distribution
5 We14 Which of the following tables represent a discrete probability distribution? a x Pr(X = x) b x Pr(X = x) c x Pr(X = x) d x Pr(X = x) 1 0.2 1 0.1 3 0.3
4
9 0.1 5 0.1 15
0.1
2 0.2
0.1
0.1
0.4
Chapter 10
507
6 WE15 Find the value of k for each of the following discrete probability distributions. a x Pr(X = x) b x Pr(X = x) c x Pr(X = x) d x Pr(X = x) 7 1 0.3 2 0.1 0 k
2
2 0.2 4 0.1 1 2k
1
3 0.2 6 0.1 2 3k 0 3k
4 k 8 0.1 3 4k 1 0.3
5 0.1 10 k 4 k 2 0.1
0.2
Find the value of k for the following discrete probability distribution. a x Pr(X = x) 1 3k 13 2 k2 13 3 5k 4 13 4 k2 13 5 7 13
b Explain why one of the values of k had to be discarded. 8 Two fair dice are rolled simultaneously, and X, the sum of the two numbers appearing uppermost, is recorded. a Draw up a table that displays the probability distribution of X, and find: b Pr(X > 9) c Pr(X < 6) d Pr(4 X < 6) e Pr(3 X 9) f Pr(X < 12) g Pr(6 X < 10).
9 A spinner is numbered from 1 to 5, with each number being equally likely to come up. If X is the random variable representing the number showing on the spinner, find: b the probability of getting an even number a the probability distribution of X c Pr(X > 2). 10 A fair die is rolled and X is the square of the number appearing uppermost. a Draw up a table that displays the probability distribution of X, and find: b Pr(X < 30) c Pr(X > 10). 11 A fair die is altered so that the 1 is changed to a 5. If X is the random variable representing the number uppermost on the die, find: a the probability distribution of X b the probability of a number bigger than 2 appearing uppermost c Pr(X = 5 | X > 2). Show that the function p(x) =
1 160 1 90
12 WE16a function.
14 WE17 Three balls are selected from a box containing 4 red balls and 5 blue balls. If the ball chosen after each selection is replaced before the next selection, find, correct to 4 decimal places: a the probability distribution for the number of red balls drawn: i 0 red balls ii 1 red ball iii 2 red balls iv 3 red balls b the probability that three reds are chosen, given that at least one ball is red.
508
15
A circular spinner, divided into five equal sectors numbered 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, is spun twice, and the sum of the numbers the pointer lands on is recorded. The following events are then defined. A = an odd number on the first spin B = an even number on the second spin C = the sum of the two numbers is odd D = the sum of the two numbers is at most 7 a List each of the possible outcomes. b Find: i Pr(A) ii Pr(B) iii Pr(C) iv Pr(D) c Find: i Pr(A | B)ii Pr(B | C)iii Pr(C | D) A biased coin is tossed twice. If the probability of obtaining a head is 3: 5 a find the probability distribution of the number of heads in 2 tosses b show that the sum of the probabilities is 1. A discrete random variable has the following probability distribution: x Pr(X = x) 1 0.2 2 0.11 3 0.15 4 0.09 5 0.17 6 0.13 7 0.15
16
17
18 MC Which one of the following random variables is not discrete? A The price, in cents, of a loaf of bread at the local supermarket B The number of runs scored by a batsman in each innings over a season C The weight of a baby as he grows over a one-year period D The number of houses sold by a real estate agent each month for a year E The number of newspapers recycled by a family each month. 19 MC What is the value of k which will make this table a probability distribution table? x Pr(X = x) A 0 x Pr(X = x) 1 2k B 1 4 0.16 9 0.21 2 3k 3 4k C 0.1 16 0.35 C 0.35 4 k D 1
9
25 0.08 D 0.28
21 MC The following table represents a discrete probability distribution for a random variable, Y. x Pr(X = x) The value of d is: B A 1
9
4 d
1 10
7 4d C
10 5d
1 11
13 2k D
1 12
1 13
509
22 mC A coin is biased so that the probability of obtaining a head is 3 . If the coin is tossed 7 3 times the probability of obtaining exactly 2 heads is: 27 108 144 135 A B C D E 64
343 343 343 343 343
23 mC Which of the following is a probability function? 1 A p(x) = 0.1, 0.3, 0.4, 0.2, 0.1, x = 0, 1, 2, 3, 4 B p(x) = 66 (3x + 7), x = 0, 1, 2, 3, 4 C p(x) = 40 (5x 1), x = 1, 2, 3, 4 E p(x) = 24
x2 20 1
D p(x) = 20 x2 (4 x), x = 1, 2, 3
eBook plus
Digital doc
(3x 1), x = 1, 2, 3
If the random variable X represents the number of boys in a four-child family: a write the values that X may take b assuming that the Pr(boy) = 1 , find the probability distribution of X.
2
WorkSHEET 10.1
10C
WorkeD examPle 18
Find the expected value of a random variable that has the following probability distribution. x Pr(X = x)
Think
1 2 3
1
2 5
2
1 10
3
3 10
4
1 10
5
1 10
WriTe
Write the rule for the expected value. Substitute the values into the rule. Evaluate.
E(X) = x Pr ( X = x )
all x
E(X) = 1 5 + 2 10 + 3 10 + 4 10 + 5 10 = 5 + 10 + 10 + 10 + 10 = 25
2 2 2 9 4 5
WorkeD examPle 19
Find the unknown probability, a, and hence determine the expected value of a random variable that has the following probability distribution. x Pr(X = x) 2 0.2 4 0.4 6 a 8 0.1 10 0.1
510
Think
1
Write
Determine the unknown value of a using the knowledge that the sum of the probabilities must total 1. Write the rule for the expected value. Substitute the values into the rule. Evaluate.
2 3 4
E(X) = 2 0.2 + 4 0.4 + 6 0.2 + 8 0.1 + 10 0.1 = 0.4 + 1.6 + 1.2 + 0.8 + 1 = 5
Worked Example 20
Find the values of a and b of the following probability distribution if E(X) = 4.29. x Pr(X = x)
Think
1
1 0.1
2 0.1
3 a
4 0.3
Write
5 0.2
6 b
7 0.2
Write an equation for the values of a and b using the knowledge that the sum of the probabilities must total 1. Call this equation [1]. Write the rule for the expected value. Substitute the values into the rule. Evaluate and call this equation [2].
0.1 + 0.1 + a + 0.3 + 0.2 + b + 0.2 = 1 0.9 + a + b = 1 a + b = 1 0.9 a + b = 0.1 [1] E(X) = x Pr(X = x )
all x
2 3
4.29 = 1 0.1 + 2 0.1 + 3 a + 4 0.3 + 5 0.2 + 6 b + 7 0.2 = 0.1 + 0.2 + 3a + 1.2 + 1 + 6b + 1.4 4. 29 3.9 = 3a + 6b 3a + 6b = 0.39[2] a + b = 0.1[1] 3a + 6b = 0.39[2] 3 (a + b = 0.1) 3a + 3b = 0.3[3] [2] [3]: 3b = 0.09 b = 0.03 a + 0.03 = 0.1 a = 0.1 0.03 = 0.07 a = 0.07 and b = 0.03
Solve the equations simultaneously. Multiply equation [1] by 3 and call it equation [3]. Subtract equation [3] from equation [2]. Solve for b. Substitute b = 0.03 into equation [1]. Solve for a.
Worked Example 21
Niki and Melanie devise a gambling game based on tossing three coins simultaneously. If three heads or three tails are obtained, the player wins $20. Otherwise the player loses $5. In order to make a profit they charge each person $2 to play. a What is the expected gain to the player? b Do Niki and Melanie make a profit? c Is this a fair game?
511
Think a
1
WriTe
List the possible outcomes and place all of the information in a table.
S = {HHH, HHT, HTH, HTT, THH, THT, TTH, TTT} x Pr(X = x) Gain ($) 0
1 8
1
3 8 5
2
3 8 5
3
1 8
20
20
2 3 4
Write the rule for the expected value. Substitute the values into the rule. Evaluate.
E(X) =
all x
x Pr( X = x)
8 8 8 8
= 20 1 + 5 3 + 5 3 + 20 1 = 20 15 15 + 20 = = $1.25
8 10 8 8 8 8
The players expected gain per game is $1.25; however, as each game incurs a cost of $2, the player in fact loses 75c per game.
b c
b Answer the question using the results from a . c Answer the question using the results from a .
The girls make a profit of 75c per game. No, this is not a fair game, since the cost to play each game does not equal the expected gain of each game.
It is important to understand that the expected value signifies the average outcome of an experiment and can be used to determine the feasibility of a situation. The previous worked example illustrates that, in the long run, the player will lose on average 75 cents per game; it does not mean the player will lose 75 cents each time the game is played.
expectation theorems
WorkeD examPle 22
eBook plus
Tutorial
3 0.14
4 0.35
int-0573
Worked example 22
WriTe
Write the rule for the expected value. Substitute the values into the rule. Evaluate.
E(X) = x Pr(X = x )
all x
E(X) = 1 0.25 + 2 0.26 + 3 0.14 + 4 0.35 = 0.25 + 0.52 + 0.42 + 1.4 = 2.59
512
Write the rule for the expected value. Substitute the values into the rule. Evaluate. Note: 1. The probability remains the same. 2. Each x-value is multiplied by 3 because of the new function, 3x. Write the rule for the expected value. Substitute the values into the rule.
b E(3X) =
all x
3x Pr(X = x)
E(3X) = (3 1) 0.25 + (3 2) 0.26 + (3 3) 0.14 + (3 4) 0.35 = 3 0.25 + 6 0.26 + 9 0.14 + 12 0.35 = 0.75 + 1.56 + 1.26 + 4.2 = 7.77
c E(2X 4) =
1 2
all x
(2 x 4) Pr(X = x)
= (2 1 4) 0.25 + (2 2 4) 0.26 + (2 3 4) 0.14 + (2 4 4) 0.35 = 2 0.25 + 0 0.26 + 2 0.14 + 4 0.35 = 0.5 + 0 + 0.28 + 1.4 = 1.18
Evaluate. Note: 1. The probability remains the same. 2. Each x-value is multiplied by 2 and then 4 is subtracted from the result, because of the new function, 2x 4. Write the rule for the expected value. Substitute the values into the rule. Evaluate. Note: 1. The probability remains the same. 2. Each x-value is squared because of the new function, x2.
1 2 3
d E(X2) =
all x
x 2 Pr(X = x)
= (12) 0.25 + (22) 0.26 + (32) 0.14 +(42) 0.35 = 1 0.25 + 4 0.26 + 9 0.14 + 16 0.35 = 0.25 + 1.04 + 1.26 + 5.6 = 8.15
The above worked example displays some important points that shall be investigated. For this example, E(X) = 2.59 from part (b) E(3X) = 7.77 note that 3E(X) = 3 2.59 = 7.77 from part (c) E(2X 4) = 1.18 note that 2E(X) 4 = 2 2.59 4 = 1.18 Hence if X is a random variable and a is a constant, its expected value is defined by E(aX) = aE(X). Furthermore, if X is a random variable where a and b are constants, then the expected value of a linear function in the form f(X) = aX + b is defined by E(aX + b) = aE(X) + b If a = 0 then E(aX + b) = aE(X) + b becomes E(0X + b) = 0E(X) + b =b These rules are called expectation theorems and are summarised below. E(aX) = aE(X) where X is a random variable and a is a constant. E(aX + b) = aE(X) + b where X is a random variable and a and b are constants. E(b) = b where b is a constant. E(X + Y) = E(X) + E(Y) where X and Y are both random variables.
513
These theorems make it easier to calculate the expected values. Finally, from part (d) of the above example it can be seen that E(X2) [E(X)]2
Worked Example 23
Casey decides to apply for a job selling mobile phones. She receives a base salary of $200 per month and $15 for every mobile phone sold. The following table shows the probability of a particular number of mobile phones, x, being sold per month. What would be the expected salary Casey would receive each month? x Pr(X = x)
Think
50 0.48
100 0.32
150 0.1
200 0.06
Write
250 0.04
Method 1
1
Define a random variable. Write the rule for the expected salary. Substitute the values into the rule.
Let X = the number of mobile phones sold by Casey in a month. E(15X + 200) =
all x
2 3
(15x + 200)Pr(X = x)
= (15 50 + 200) 0.48 + (15 100 + 200) 0.32 + (15 150 + 200) 0.1 + (15 200 + 200) 0.06 + (15 250 + 200) 0.04 = 950 0.48 + 1700 0.32 + 2450 0.1 + 3200 0.06 + 3950 0.04 = 456 + 544 + 245 + 192 + 158 = 1595
Evaluate.
The expected salary Casey would receive each month would be $1595.
Write the rule for the expected salary. Substitute the values into the rule. Evaluate. Using the fact that E(aX + b) = aE(X) + b find E(15X + 200).
E(X) = x Pr (X = x )
all x
Note: Using the expectation theorem is quicker because it is easier to evaluate aE(X) + b than E(aX + b).
514
For the following probability distributions, calculate: i the median ii the mode.
a
x Pr(X = x)
3 0.25 5 0.18
5 0.4 8 0.32
6 0.15 11 0.2
8 0.2 14 0.3
WRITE
b x
Pr(X = x)
Think a i
1
To calculate the median, work from the left of the data. Add up the probabilities until the total is 0.5 or greater. Write the answer. To calculate the mode, identify the highest probability in the table. Write the answer. To calculate the median, work from the left of the data. Add up the probabilities until the total is 0.5 or greater.
ii
1 2
Pr(X 8) = 0.18 + 0.32 = 0.5 Similarly Pr(X 11) = 0.2 + 0.3 = 0.5 Median = 8 + 11 2 = 9.5
Calculate the median by calculating the mean of 8 and 11. Write the answer. To calculate the mode, identify the highest probability in the table. Write the answer.
ii
1 2
REMEMBER
1. The expected value of a discrete random variable, X, is defined by the rule E(X) =
all x
2. A game is considered fair if the cost to play the game is equal to the expected gain. 3. A fair game is one in which E(X) = 0.
515
4. The expected value of a linear function can be calculated using the expectation theorems: E(aX) = aE(X) E(aX + b) = aE(X) + b E(b) = b E(X + Y) = E(X) + E(Y) 5. E(X2) [E(X)]2 6. The median is the middle value of a distribution. 7. The mode is the variable with the highest probability.
Exercise
10c
Find the expected value of a random variable that has the following probability distribution. x Pr(X = x)
-2 1 18 -1 1 3
0
1 18
1
2 9
2
1 6
3
1 18
4
1 9
3 WE19 Find the unknown probability, a, and hence determine the expected value of a random variable that has the following probability distribution. x Pr(X = x) 1 0.11 3 0.3 5 0.15 7 0.25 9 a 11 0.1
4 Find the unknown probability, a, and hence determine the expected value of a random variable that has the following probability distribution. x Pr(X = x)
-2 5 18
1 a
4
1 9
7
5 18
10
1 18
13
2 9
5 Find the unknown probability, b, and hence determine the expected value of a random variable that has the following probability distribution. x Pr(X = x) 0 b 1 0.2 2 0.02 3 3b 4 0.1 5 0.08
6 Find the value of k, and hence determine the expected value of a random variable that has the following probability distribution. x Pr(X = x) 7 4 6k 8 2k 12 k 16 3k 20 8k
If X represents the outcome of a fair die being rolled, find: a the probability distribution of each outcome
b E(X).
516
8 Two fair dice are rolled simultaneously. If X represents the sum of the two numbers appearing uppermost, find: a the probability distribution of each outcome b E(X). 9 A fair coin is tossed 4 times. If X represents the number of tails obtained, find: a the probability distribution of each outcome b E(X). 10 We20 x Pr(X = x) 11 x Pr(X = x) Find the values of a and b of the following distribution if E(X) = 1.91. 0 0.2 1 0.32 2 a 3 0.18 4 b 5 0.05 6 0.05
Find the values of a and b of the following distribution if E(X) = 2.41. 0 0.2 1 a 2 0.23 3 0.15 4 b 5 0.12
12 We21 Lucas contemplates playing a new game which involves tossing three coins simultaneously. He will receive $15 if he obtains 3 heads, $10 if he obtains 2 heads and $5 if he obtains 1 head. However, if he obtains no heads he must pay $30. He must also pay $5 for each game he plays. a What is Lucass expected gain? b Should he play the game? Why? c Is this a fair game? Why? 13 Angie plays a game based on tossing three coins simultaneously. She will receive $10 if she obtains 3 tails, $5 if she obtains 2 tails and $5 if she obtains 1 tail. However, if she obtains no tails she must pay $40. a What is Angies expected gain? b Should she play the game? Why? c Is this a fair game? Why? X is a discrete random variable with the following probability distribution. x Pr(X = x) 2 0.3 4 0.2 7 0.4 k 0.1
14
Find the value of k if the mean is 5.3. 15 X is a discrete random variable with the following probability distribution. x Pr(X = x)
2
3 0.08
8 0.07
10 0.27
14 0.16
k 0.32
0.1
Find the value of k if the mean is 10.98. 16 A coin is biased such that the probability of obtaining a tail is 0.6. If X represents the number of tails in three tosses of the coin, find: a the probability distribution of X b E(X) c the mode. 17 We22 x Pr(X = x) Find: a E(X) A random variable has the following probability distribution. 1
2 15
eBook plus
Digital doc
SkillSHEET 10.1
Expected value of a function of a random variable
2
7 15
3
1 3
4
1 15
b E(4X)
c E(2X + 1)
d E(X2).
517
Chapter 10
18 A random variable has the following probability distribution. x Pr(X = x) Find: a E(X) 1 0.33 2 0.25 3 0.27 4 0.15 d E(3X 2).
b E(4X 6)
c E(X 2 + 1)
19 We23 Christian decides to apply for a job selling mobile phones. He receives a base salary of $180 per month and $12 for every mobile phone sold. The following table shows the probability of a particular number of mobile phones, x, being sold per month. What would be the expected salary Christian would receive each month? x Pr(X = x) 50 0.32 100 0.38 150 0.2 200 0.06 250 0.04
20 We24 For the following probability distributions, calculate: i the median ii the mode.
eBook plus
Digital doc
a b c
1 0.25 4 0.06
2 1 4
2 0.15 8 0.36
1 1 16
3 0.1 9 0.17 0
3 16
4 0.1 13 0.29 1
1 8
5 0.4 17 0.12 2
1 8
WorkSHEET 10.2
3
1 16
4
3 16
10D
eBook plus
Interactivity
int-0255
Variance is an important feature of probability distributions as it provides information about the spread of the distribution with respect to the mean. If the variance is large, it implies that the possible values are spread (or deviate) quite a distance from the mean. A small variance implies that the possible values are close to the mean. Variance is also called a measure of spread or dispersion. The variance is written as Var(X) and denoted by the symbol 2 (sigma squared). It is defined as the expected value (or average) of the squares of the spreads (deviations) from the mean. The rule for variance is given by: Var(X) = E(X )2 = (X )2 Pr(X = x) Although this rule clearly demonstrates how to obtain the variance, performing the calculation is quite a lengthy process. Hence an alternative rule is used for calculating the variance: Var(X) = E(X )2 = E(X2 2X + 2) = E(X2) E(2X) + E(2) = E(X2) 2E(X) + E(2) = E(X2) 22 + 2 since E(X) = (the mean) = E(X2) 2 = E(X2) [E(X)]2
518
Worked Example 25
Find the expected value and variance of the following probability distribution table. x Pr(X = x)
Think
1 0.15
2 0.12
3 0.24
4 0.37
5 0.12
Write
Write the rule for the expected value. Substitute the values into the rule. Evaluate. Calculate E(X2).
E(X) = x Pr(X = x )
all x
2 3
= 1 0.15 + 2 0.12 + 3 0.24 + 4 0.37 + 5 0.12 = 0.15 + 0.24 + 0.72 + 1.48 + 0.6 = 3.19
all x
E(X2) =
x 2 Pr(X = x)
= (12) 0.15 + (22) 0.12 + (32) 0.24 + (42) 0.37 + (52) 0.12 = 1 0.15 + 4 0.12 + 9 0.24 + 16 0.37 +25 0.12 = 0.15 + 0.48 + 2.16 + 5.92 + 3 = 11.71
5 6
Open a Lists & Spreadsheet page. Label column A as x and column B as probx. Enter the data into the relevant columns. Press: MENU b 4:Statistics 4 1:Stat Calculations 1 1:One-Variable Statistics 1 The number of lists is 1. The X1 List is x and the frequency is probx.
The expected value and the variance (SSD) can be read from the screen. You will need to scroll down to get the value of the variance.
519
WorkeD examPle 26
eBook plus
Tutorial
Find the variance of 2Y + 1 for the following probability distribution table. y Pr(Y = y)
Think
1 2 3
0 0.25
1 0.35
2 0.2
3 0.2
WriTe
int-0574
Worked example 26
Write the rule for the expected value. Substitute the values into the rule. Evaluate.
E(2Y + 1) = (2 y + 1) Pr(Y = y )
all x
= (2 0 + 1) 0.25 + (2 1 + 1) 0.35 + (2 2 + 1) 0.2 + (2 3 + 1) 0.2 = 1 0.25 + 3 0.35 + 5 0.2 + 7 0.2 = 0.25 + 1.05 + 1 + 1.4 = 3.7 [E(2Y + 1)]2 = 3.72 = 13.69 E(2Y + 1)2 = 12 0.25 + 32 0.35 + 52 0.2 + 72 0.2 = 0.25 + 3.15 + 5 + 9.8 = 18.2 Var(2Y + 1) = E(2Y + 1)2 [E(2Y + 1)]2 = 18.2 13.69 = 4.51
4 5
The variance of a linear function can also be calculated by the following rule: Var (aX + b) = a2Var (X) For worked example 26, given that Var(Y) = 1.1275, Var(2Y + 1) can be determined using the above rule: Var(2Y + 1) = 22Var(Y) = 4 1.1275 = 4.51 as before.
WorkeD examPle 27
X is a discrete random variable with the following probability distribution. x Pr(X = x) 3 0.15 4 0.3 6 0.45 k 0.1
WriTe
Write the rule for the expected value. Substitute the values into the rule. Evaluate.
E(X) = x Pr(X = x )
all x
= 3 0.15 + 4 0.3 + 6 0.45 + k 0.1 = 0.45 + 1.2 + 2.7 + 0.1k = 4.35 + 0.1k
520
Calculate E(X2).
E(X2) =
all x
x 2 Pr(X = x)
= (32) 0.15 + (42) 0.3 + (62) 0.45 + (k2) 0.1 = 9 0.15 + 16 0.3 + 36 0.45 + k2 0.1 = 1.35 + 4.8 + 16.2 + 0.1k2 = 22.35 + 0.1k2
5 6
Calculate [E(X)]2. Calculate Var(X) using the rule and equate it to the given value of the variance; that is, 2 = 1.7475. Solve for k.
[E(X)]2 = (4.35 + 0.1k)2 = 0.01k2 + 0.87k + 18.9225 Var(X) = E(X2) [E(X)]2 1.7475 = 22.35 + 0.1k2 (0.01k2 + 0.87k + 18.9225) 1.7475 = 0.09k2 0.87k + 3.4275 0.09k2 0.87k + 3.4275 1.7475 = 0 0.09k2 0.87k + 1.68 = 0 (9k 24)(k 7) = 0 k=
24 9
(or 2 3 ) or k = 7
Standard deviation
Another important measure of spread is the standard deviation. It is written as SD(X) or denoted by the symbol (sigma). The standard deviation is the positive square root of the variance. It is defined by the rule: SD(X) = Var ( X )
= 2 = Variation and standard deviation are used extensively in many real-life applications involving statistics. Analysis of data would be useless without any information about the spread of the data.
Worked Example 28
1
3 8
2
1 8
3
1 4
Calculate the expected value, the variance and the standard deviation.
Think Write
E(X) = 0 4 + 1 8 + 2 8 + 3 4 =0+8+8 +4 = 18
3 3 2 3
Calculate [E(X)]2.
3 [E(X)]2 = 1 8
( )
57
521
Calculate E(X2).
E(X2) = 02 4 + 12 8 + 22 8 + 32 4 =0+8+8 +4 = 38
1 3 4 9
Calculate Var(X).
5 6
Open a Lists & Spreadsheet page. Label column A as x and column B as probx. Enter the data into the relevant columns. Press: MENU b 4:Statistics 4 1:Stat Calculations 1 1:One-Variable Statistics 1 The number of lists is 1. The X1 List is x and the frequency is probx.
The expected value and the variance (SSD) and the standard deviation can be read from the screen. You will need to scroll down to get the value of the variance.
Worked Example 29
In order to encourage car pooling, a new toll is to be introduced on the Eastgate Bridge. If the car has no passengers, a toll of $2 applies. Cars with one passenger pay a $1.50 toll, cars with two passengers pay a $1 toll and cars with 3 or more passengers pay no toll. Long-term statistics show that the number of passengers (X) follows the probability distribution given below. x (no. of passengers) Pr(X = x) 0 0.4 1 0.35 2 0.2 3 0.05
a Construct a probability distribution of the toll paid. b Find the mean toll paid per car. c Find the standard deviation of tolls paid.
Think a Construct a table of values of toll information. Write a Let Y = toll to be paid.
y Pr(Y = y)
2 0.4
1.5 0.35
1 0.2
0 0.05
522
1 2 3 4 5
Write the rule for the expected value. Substitute the values into the rule. Evaluate. Round the answer to 2 decimal places. Answer the question. Calculate E(Y2).
b E(Y) =
all y
y Pr(Y = y)
= 2 0.4 + 1.5 0.35 + 1 0.2 + 0 0.05 = 0.8 + 0.525 + 0.2 + 0 = 1.525 = 1.53
y 2 Pr (Y = y)
= (22) 0.4 + (1.52) 0.35 + (12) 0.2 + (02) 0.05 = 4 0.4 + 2.25 0.35 + 1 0.2 + 0 = 1.6 + 0.7875 + 0.2 = 2.5875
2 3
[E(Y)]2 = 1.5252 = 2.325 625 Var(Y) = E(Y2) [E(Y)]2 = 2.5875 2.325 625 = 0.261 875 SD(Y) = 0.261 875
4 5 6
Calculate the standard deviation. Round the answer to 2 decimal places. Answer the question.
= 0.51
A probability distribution is shown below. Given that = 3.38 and = 0.946, calculate Pr( - 2 X + 2). x Pr(X = x)
Think
1
2 0.14
3 0.5
4 0.23
5 0.1
6 0.03
Write
Calculate - 2
523
Calculate + 2.
Substitute the values obtained in steps 1 and 2 into the given interval. Since X represents discrete values, Pr(1.488 X 5.272) becomes Pr(2 X 5).
WorkeD examPle 31
The table below represents the probability distribution of the number of accidents per week in a factory. x Pr(X = x)
Think
1
1 0.02
2 0.22
3 0.18
4 0.16
5 0.14
6 0.07
WriTe
7 0.13
8 0.03
9 0.05
Calculate 2.
2 = 4.36 2 2.105 = 4.36 4.21 = 0.15 + 2 = 4.36 + 2 2.105 = 4.36 + 4.21 = 8.57
Pr( 2 X + 2) = Pr(0.15 X 8.57) = Pr(1 X 8) = Pr(X = 1) + Pr(X = 2) + Pr(X = 3) + Pr(X = 4) + Pr(X = 5) + Pr(X = 6) + Pr(X = 7) + Pr(X = 8) = 1 Pr(X = 9) = 1 0.05 = 0.95 Note: The answer is the estimated one of 95%. In this case, 95% of the distribution lies within 2 standard deviations of the mean.
Calculate + 2.
Substitute the values obtained in steps 1 and 2 into the given interval. Since X represents discrete values, Pr(0.15 X 8.57) becomes Pr(1 X 8). Note: In this example, Pr(1 X 8) = 1 Pr(X = 9).
WorkeD examPle 32
eBook plus
Tutorial
The probability distribution of X is given by the formula: x2 Pr(X = x) = where x = 2, 3, 4, 5. 54 Find: a the probability distribution of X as a table b the expected value of X, correct to 4 decimal places c the standard deviation of X, correct to 4 decimal places d Pr( 2 X + 2), correct to 3 decimal places.
524
int-0575
Worked example 32
Think a
1
WriTe
Substitute each of the x-values into the equation and obtain the corresponding probability.
a When x = 2, p(x) =
4 54 2 27 9 54 1 6 16 54 8 27 25 54
x Pr(X = x)
2
2 27
3
1 6
4
8 27
5
25 54
b E(X) = 2
= =
2
2 +31+ 27 6 4 + 3 + 32 + 125 27 6 27 54 4 4 27
8 27
+5
25 54
= 4.1481
c [E(X)]2 = (4 4 )2 27
= 17 729 ( 17.2071)
2
151 2
Calculate E(X2).
E(X2) = 22 27 + 32 6 + 42 27 + 52 54 = 27 + 6 +
1 8 9 128 27
25
625 54
= 18 9 ( 18.1111)
3
Calculate Var(X).
( 0.9040)
4 5
Calculate the standard deviation. Round the answer to 4 decimal places. Calculate 2.
Calculate + 2.
Substitute the values obtained in steps 1 and 2 into the given interval. Since X represents discrete values, Pr(2.2465 X 6.0497) becomes Pr(3 X 6).
+ 2 = 4.1481 + 2 0.9508 = 4.1481 + 1.9016 = 6.0497 Pr( 2 X + 2) = Pr(2.2465 X 6.0497) = Pr(3 X 6) = 1 Pr(X = 2) =1 2
27
= 25
27
Chapter 10
525
= 0.926 Note: In this example, 92.6% of the distribution lies within 2 standard deviations of the mean, which is close to the estimated value of 95%.
rememBer
1. The variance, Var(X) or 2 is defined by the rule: Var(X) = E(X2) [E(X)]2 2. The variance of a linear function can also be calculated by the following rule: Var (aX + b) = a2Var(X). 3. The standard deviation, SD(X) or , is defined by the rule: SD(X) = Var ( X ) = 2 4. Approximately 95% of the spread of the population in many distributions lies between 2 standard deviations of the mean; that is, Pr ( 2 x + 2) 0.95. exerCiSe
10D
eBook plus
Digital doc
2 0.4 4
3 16
3 0.3 6
9 16
4 0.1 8
1 8
Spreadsheet 100
Probability distribution
3 The cost of a loaf of bread is known to vary on any day according to the following probability distribution. x Pr(Y = y) $1.20 0.05 $1.25 0.2 $1.30 0.1 $1.35 0.25 $1.60 0.4
Find: a the expected cost of a loaf of bread x Pr(Y = y) x Pr(X = x) Find: a Var(X)
526
b the variance of the cost. 2 0.3 6 0.42 3 0.2 8 0.13 d Var(5X + 7).
4 We26 Find the variance of 2Y 1 for the following probability distribution table. 0 0.3 2 0.15 b Var(2X) 1 0.2 4 0.3
c Var(3X + 1)
Find the value of k, a positive integer, if the variance is 5.8. 8 Let X be a discrete random variable with the following probability distribution. x Pr(X = x) 1 0.1 k 0.2 7 0.3 10 0.4
Find the value of k, a positive integer, if the variance is 7.96. 9 WE28 A random variable has the following probability distribution. x Pr(X = x) 1
1 4
2
1 3
3
1 4
4
1 6
Calculate the expected value, the variance and the standard deviation. 0 A random variable has the following probability distribution. 1 x Pr(X = x) 6 0.3 7 0.3 10 0.2 12 0.2 b the variance of X, Var(X)
Find: a the expected value, E(X) c the standard deviation of X, SD(X), to 2 decimal places. For a random variable, X, E(X) = 12 and E(X2) = 340. Find the standard deviation of X. 12 For a random variable, X, E(X) = 20 and E(X2) = 529. Find the standard deviation of X, to 2 decimal places. 13 WE29 In order to encourage car pooling, a new toll is to be introduced on the International Gateway. If the car has no passengers, a toll of $2 applies. Cars with one passenger pay a $1.50 toll, cars with two passengers pay a $1 toll and cars with 3 or more passengers pay no toll. Long-term statistics show that the number of passengers follows the probability distribution given below. x Pr(X = x) 0 0.5 1 0.3 2 0.15 3 0.05 11
a Construct a probability distribution of the toll paid. b Find the mean toll paid per car. c Find the standard deviation of tolls paid. 14 WE31 The table below represents the probability distribution of the number of accidents per week in afactory. x Pr(X = x) 1 0.03 2 0.21 3 0.16 4 0.18 5 0.14 6 0.07 7 0.15 8 0.01 9 0.05
x2 15 WE32 The probability distribution of X is given by the formula, Pr(X = x) = where 35 x = 1,3, 5. Find: a the probability distribution of X as a table b the expected value of X c the standard deviation of X, to 4 decimal places d Pr( 2 X + 2). 16 The probability distribution of X is given by the formula, Pr(X = x) = Find: a the probability distribution of X as a table c the standard deviation of X x Pr(X = x) 1 0.4 2 0.2 x2 1 where x = 2, 3, 4, 5. 50
b the expected value of X d Pr( 2 X + 2). 3 0.2 4 k b the most likely value of X d Var(X), the variance of X f Pr( 2 X + 2).
Find: a the value of the constant k c E(X), the mean of X e SD(X), the standard deviation of X, to 4 decimal places
18 Calculate the values between which 95% of the distribution would be expected to lie where: a = 4, = 2 b = 10, = 3 c = 35, = 7 1 1 d = 21.6, = 5.2 e = 9.7, = 0.7 f = 17 2 , = 23. 19 Two fair dice are rolled and the outcomes are noted. If X represents the sum of the two numbers showing, find: a the expected value of X b the variance of X, to 2 decimal places c Pr( 2 X + 2), to 2 decimal places.
2 1 1 2 3 3 4 2
20 For the spinner shown, X represents the number obtained. Find: a the probability distribution of X b the expected value of X c the standard deviation of X, to 2 decimal places d the probability that the number is 4, given that it is not 1. 21 MC The following table represents a discrete probability distribution for a random variable, X. x Pr(X = x) 0 k 1 2k 2 3k 3 4k
The standard deviation of x is: A 1.0 B 1.2 c 1.8 d 2.0 e 2.2 Questions 22 and 23 refer to the following information. The probability distribution of X is given in the table below. x Pr(X = x) A 3.9, 15.21 A 91.26 0 0.4 B 26.1, 3.3 B 541.56 3 0.3 6 0.1 9 0.2 d 26.1, 5.11 d 939.6 e 11.61, 3.41 e 140.4
22 MC The variance and standard deviation of X, respectively, are: c 26.1, 3.9 c 417.96 23 MC Var (6X 3) is equal to:
528
Summary
Probability revision
Outcomes are results of experiments. The set of all possible outcomes of an experiment is called the sample space and is denoted by , and each possible outcome is called a sample point. A subset of the sample space is known as an event. The union (symbol ) of two events A and B implies a combined event, that is, either event A or event B or both occurring. Common elements are written only once. The intersection (symbol ) of two events A and B is represented by the common sample points of the two events. Venn diagrams involve drawing a rectangle that represents the sample space and a series of circles that represent subsets of the sample space. They provide a visual representation of the information at hand and clearly display the relationships between sets. The probability of an event occurring is defined by the rule Pr(A) = number of favourable outcomes total number of possible outcomes .
The probability of an event occurring lies within the restricted interval 0 Pr(A) 1. The individual probabilities of a particular experiment will sum to 1; that is, p(x) = 1. The addition rule of probability is defined by the rule Pr(A B) = Pr(A) + Pr(B) Pr (A B). If two events A and B are mutually exclusive, then Pr(A B) = 0 and therefore the addition rule becomes Pr(A B) = Pr(A) + Pr(B). If two events A and B are independent, then Pr (A B) = Pr(A) Pr(B). Karnaugh maps and probability tables summarise all combinations of two events (for example A and B) and their complements (for example A and B). Pr ( A B) , where Pr(B) 0. This can be transposed Conditional probability is defined by the rule Pr(A|B) = Pr ( B) to Pr(A B) = Pr (A|B) Pr(B).
Tree diagrams are useful tools in solving probability tasks as they display each of the possible outcomes along with their respective probabilities. A combination is defined by nCr, that is, the number of selections of n different objects taken r at a time.
Discrete random variables
A random variable is one whose value is determined by the outcome of an experiment. Discrete random variables generally deal with number or size and are able to be counted. Two important characteristics satisfy all discrete probability distributions: 1. Each probability lies in a restricted interval 0 Pr(X = x) 1. 2. The probabilities of a particular experiment sum to 1; that is,
Pr( X = x) = 1
If these two characteristics are not satisfied, then there is no discrete probability distribution.
Measures of centre of discrete random distributions
The expected value of a discrete random variable, X, is denoted by E(X) or the symbol (mu). It is defined by the rule: E(X) = A fair game is one in which E(X) = 0.
all x
x Pr (X = x)
529
The expected value of a linear function can be calculated using the expectation theorems: E(aX) = aE(X) E(aX + b) = aE(X) + b E(b) = b E(X + Y) = E(X) + E(Y) Note: E(X2) [E(X)]2 The median is the middle value of a distribution. The mode is the variable with the highest probability.
Measures of variability of discrete random distributions
The variance is denoted by Var(X) or the symbol 2 (sigma squared). It is defined by the rule: Var(X) = E(X2) [E(X)]2. The variance of a linear function can also be calculated by the following rule: Var(aX + b) = a2Var(X) The standard deviation is written as SD(X) or denoted by the symbol . It is defined by the rule: SD(X) = Var( X ) = 2 Approximately 95% of the spread of the population in many distributions lies between 2 standard deviations of the mean, that is, Pr( 2 X + 2) 0.95
530
chapter review
Short answer
1 The Santaroos have 3 soccer teams, A, B of and C, entered in the interschool championships. Each team is entered in a separate division. The probability of each team winning their particular final is given as follows: 1 1 Pr(Team A wins) = 2 Pr(Team B wins) = 3 Pr(Team C wins) = 4 . Find the probability that: a none of the Santaroos teams win b one of the Santaroos teams wins c two of the Santaroos teams win d each of the Santaroos teams win their particular final. 2 The probability of event A occurring is 0.25 and the probability of event B occurring is 0.5. a Calculate Pr(A B) when Pr(A B) = 0.1. b Calculate Pr(A B) when events A and B are mutually exclusive.
Exam tip Many students confuse independent 3
a What is the probability that the service time for a customer is: i 2 minutes? ii 2 minutes or less? iii more than 2 minutes? iv not more than 4 minutes, given it is more than 1 minute? b What is the expected value for the service time? c If 50 customers were served at the bakery in a morning, how many of these would you expect to take 4 minutes to be served? 5 A LUCKYDIPZ is a toy that is packaged inside an egg-shaped chocolate. A certain manufacturer produces 4 different types of LUCKYDIPZ toy car, ship, plane and ring, in the proportions given in the table below. Car Ship Plane Ring 4k2 + 4k 5k2 + 2k k2 + k 2k
[ VCAA 2007] 3 Thirty students were required to complete a logic puzzle. The time taken to complete the puzzle was recorded in the table below. Time taken (whole number of minutes) Number of students 3 4 5 6 7
a Show that k must be a solution of the quadratic equation 10k2 + 9k 1 = 0. b Find the exact value of k. [ VCAA 2004] 6 The probability distribution of X is given by the x2 formula, Pr(X = x) = , where x = 1, 2, 3, 4. Find: 30 a the probability distribution of X as a table b the expected value of X. 7 A player rolls a fair die. If the player gets a 1 on the first roll, she rolls again and her score is the sum of the two results, otherwise her score is the result of the first roll. The die cannot be thrown more than twice. Find: a the probability distribution b the expected score c Pr(X < ). 8 Tayah and Sandy are playing a game where a biased die is rolled. The probabilities of rolling each number are Pr(1) = 0.2, Pr(2) = Pr(3) = Pr(5) = 0.1, Pr(4) = 0.3 and Pr(6) = 0.2. They have to pay $1.00 to play. If a 2, 3 or 5 is rolled, they win $3. If a 1 or 6 is rolled, they get
10
For the information given: a what proportion of students completed the puzzle in less than 5 minutes? b what proportion of students took more than 5minutes to complete the puzzle? 4 The probability distribution for the service time at a bakery is given below. Service time (whole number of minutes) Probability 1 0.2 2 0.3 3 0.2 4 0.2 5 0.1
531
their money back, and if a 4 is rolled, they do not receive any money. Is this a fair game to play? 9 A game of three-up is played where three coins are tossed simultaneously. A player must pay $2 to play the game. If three heads come up, the player collects $6. If two heads come up, the player collects $3. Is it a fair game? 10 Kylie is about to 2 points 30 cm compete in her clubs archery 5 points finals. If she is 10 cm equally likely to 11 points hit any point on the board and 20 cm never misses the target, find: a her expected score from i 1 shot at the target shown ii 5 shots at the target shown b her probability of getting five points on every one of her 5 shots. 11 For the following probability distributions, calculate: i the median ii the mode. a x Pr(X = x) b x Pr(X = x) 3 0.1 1
1 5
14 Five thousand scratch-and-match tickets are to be sold for $2 each. The tickets offer the following prizes: 1 prize of $5000 2 prizes of $500 20 prizes of $50 100 prizes of $10. Find: a the expected loss per ticket b the profit made by organisers, that is, the house c the house percentage. 15 A raffle is to be drawn from 500 tickets. Each ticket was purchased for $1, with first prize being $200, second prize $150 and third prize $100. Find: a the expected loss per ticket b the profit made by organisers, that is, the house c the house percentage. 16 Pr(X = x) = x ( x + 1) for 0 x n 40 a Find the value of n. b Find the probability distribution for X as a table. c Find the expected value of X.
Multiple choice
4 0.45 4
1 5
5 0.09 6
1 10
6 0.26 8
2 5
7 0.1 11
1 10
1 If Pr(A) = 0.65, Pr(B) = 0.37 and Pr (A B) = 0.28, then Pr(A B) is equal to: A 0.93 B 0.56 C 0.09 D 0.74 E 1.02 2 If Pr(A) = 0.47, Pr(B) = 0.27 and Pr (A B) = 0.19, then Pr(A|B) is equal to: A 0.57 B 0.40 C 0.70 D 0.43 E 0.30 3 The probability that Fiona attends an aerobics class is 0.60, and the probability that Kath attends an aerobics class is 0.85. If these two events are independent, the probability of one of these two people attending an aerobics class is: A 0.60 B 0.85 C 0.51 D 0.34 E 0.43 4 A bag contains 3 white balls and 7 yellow balls. Three balls are drawn one at a time from the bag without replacement. The probability that they are all yellow is: A 3 B 27 c 21 D
500 7 24
12 At Fast Eddys Drive-In Theatre the cost is $5 per car, plus $1 per occupant. The variable X represents the number of people in any car and is known to follow the probability distribution below. x Pr(X = x) 2 0.4 3 0.2 4 0.3 5 0.1
Find: a the expected cost per car b Fast Eddys expected profit if 100 cars enter and costs for wages, electricity, etc. are $300 c the mode. 13 Let X be a discrete random variable with the following probability distribution. x Pr(X = x) 1 0.1 3 0.25 5 0.35 n 0.3
100
Exam tip Students need to be reminded that material from Units 1 and 2 of the study can be drawn on for the end of year exams.
[Assessment report 1 2006]
[ VCAA 2006]
532
5 Which of the following random variables is discrete? A The number of runs scored by Sir Donald Bradman in his cricketing career B The weight of people in an elevator C The life span of a fly D The volume, in litres, of water in the Yarra River E The time, in hours, for a student to complete a Mathematical Methods test 6 Which of the following does not represent a probability distribution? A x Pr(X = x) B x Pr(X = x) C x Pr(X = x) D x Pr(X = x) E x Pr(X = x) 2 0.2 1 0.1 3 0.36
4 0.1 7
0.2
5
0.4
3
or equal to 4 comes up. The expected result for the player for each roll is: A a loss of 80c B a loss of $1.40 C a win of 80c d a loss of $1.40 E a win of $1.20 10 Gertrudes Gambling House offers patrons a card game which uses a deck comprising four aces, three kings, two queens and one jack. A player draws a card at random. If a jack is drawn the player wins $5, while a queen results in a win of $2. However, if the player draws an ace, a loss of $1 is incurred. On average, Gertrudes Gambling House wins 40c each time the game is played. If a king is drawn, a player must pay: A $1.00 B $3.00 c $1.50 D $2.00 e $2.50 11 Sams chance of getting a bullseye while playing darts is 0.1 and his chance of missing the board altogether is 0.2. Sam collects $2 for a bullseye or 20c for hitting any other part of the board. If the game is to be fair, missing the board altogether means Sam must pay: A $1.70 B $2.70 c $2.20 D $1.50 e $1.85 12 The toll for a new freeway is $2 per car and 50cperoccupant. Long-term surveys show that X, the number of occupants per car, is distributed as follows. x Pr(X = x) 1 0.3 2 0.3 3 0.2 4 0.1 5 0.1
0.09
0.12
0.41
0.18
7 X is a discrete random variable with the following probability distribution. x Pr(X = x) 0 0.1 1 0.2 2 0.3 3 0.1 4 0.2 5 0.1
The expected toll for each car is: A $3.20 B $3 c $3.50 D $2.95 e $3.65 Questions 13 and 14 refer to the following probability distribution. x Pr(X = x) 1 0.3 2 0.3 3 0.2 4 0.1 5 0.1
The probability that the variable is an odd number, given that it is less than 4 is: A 1 B 7 c 4
2 10 1 3 5
d 3
7
8 The value of k for the following probability distribution is: x Pr(X = x) A 0.15 D 0.4 1 0.3 2 5k B 0.05 e 1 3 0.2 4 3k 5 0.1
c 0.25
13 E(X) is equal to: A 2.5 B 3.1 c 5.2 D 2.4 e 2.6 14 E(5X 8) is equal to: A 18 B 4.5 c 4 D 7.5 e 5 Questions 15, 16 and 17 refer to the following probability distribution. x Pr(X = x)
2 1
9 A die is biased so that Pr(X = 1) = Pr(X = 2) = 0.1 and Pr(X = 3) = Pr(X = 4) = Pr(X = 5) = Pr(X = 6) = 0.2. A game is played where a player rolls the die. The player receives $5 if a number greater than 4 is obtained but must pay $2 if a number less than
0 0.2
1 0.15 c 1.4
2 0.3
0.1
0.25
533
16 Var(X) is equal to: A 2 B 1.7 D 0.61 e 2.11 17 Var(3X + 2) is equal to: A 8 B 17.19 D 15.3 e 2.7
c 1.91
C = 7.6 and = 3.3 D = 7.5 and = 3.3 E = 6 and = 10.89 19 Let X be a random variable with the following probability distribution. x Pr(X = x) 12 0.27 1 0.2 2 0.2 3 0.4 4 0.2
c 7.73
18 Let X be a discrete random variable with the following probability distribution. x Pr(X = x) 3 0.21 6 0.35 9 0.17
The mean and standard deviation are: A = 6 and = 3.3 B = 7.5 and = 10.89
The values between which 95% of the distribution lie for the discrete random variable X are: A (1, 3) B (1, 4) c (2, 4) D (1, 2) e (2, 3)
Extended Response
1 Bobs Bakery makes four different types of doughnut, each at a different price, depending on the ingredients used. A school canteen buys all its doughnuts from Bob and is currently estimating budgets for the upcoming financial year. Types of doughnut and their prices are listed below, along with their popularity (expressed as a probability). Doughnut type Jam Iced Cinnamon Iced jam Cost per box (2 dozen) $14.40 $15.60 $12.00 $18.00 Probability
1 4 1 4 3 10 1 5
2 Amina plays roulette, a game where a wheel containing 37 slots numbered 036 is spun and the winning number is the one in which a ball lodges when the wheel stops spinning. Amina plays three different games: a First she bets $20 on her favourite number coming up at Casinonominated odds of 35:1 against. i How much would Amina collect if her number came up? ii Find her expected win or loss for the game. iii Is this game fair? b In the second game Amina bets $20 on an even number coming up at Casino-nominated odds of 1:1 (even money chance). i How much would Amina collect if an even number came up? ii Find her expected win or loss for the game. iii Is this game fair?
20
14 3
1 9 22 18 29
Find: a the mean price per box b the standard deviation per box c the average price per doughnut. The canteen wants to make a 14% profit on costs. Find: d the cost of a doughnut at the canteen, if all doughnuts are to be sold for the same amount e the average profit per box.
28
12
35
3 26 0 32 15 1
4
21
5 17 34 6 27 1 22 33
534
3 11
23 10 5 24 1 63 0 8 3
c In game number three, Amina bets $20 on a line of 12; that is, if numbers 112 come up, she wins. The Casino-nominated odds for this game are 2:1 against. i How much would Amina collect if one of her numbers came up? ii Find her expected win or loss for the game. iii Is this game fair? d What is the house percentage for these games? 3 A door-to-door telecommunications representative has recorded her day-by-day sales figures over a period of time. She knows that her probability of selling X packages on any one day follows the probability distribution shown in the table. x Pr(X = y) a b c d e f g 0 2t2 1 3t 2 2t2 3 2t 4 4t2 + t 5 t >5 0
Find the value of t. Find the probability that she sells at least 2 packages on any one day. Find the probability that she sells at most 4 packages on any one day. Find the number of packages she can expect to sell each day. Calculate the Var(X) and standard deviation of X, correct to 4 decimal places. Find Pr( 2 X + 2). If the representative receives a commission of $25 per package sold and a bonus of $200 if she sells 4 or more packages in one day, find her expected daily earnings from commissions and bonuses. h Given that the representative will sell at least two packages tomorrow, find the probability that she will get her $200 bonus.
eBook plus
Digital doc
Test Yourself
Chapter 10
Chapter 10
535
eBook plus
aCTiViTieS
Chapter opener
Digital doc
10 Quick Questions: Warm up with ten quick questions on applications of discrete random variables. (page 484)
10A Probability revision
Tutorials
We 7 int-0570: Watch a worked example on calculating conditional probability. (page 493) We 10 int-0571: Watch a worked example on considering combinations when conducting probability experiments. (page 496)
10 B
Tutorial
10D
Spreadsheet 100: Investigate probability distributions. (page 507) WorkSHEET 10.1: Determine probabilities given discrete data and distributions including conditional probability and graphs. (page 510)
10C
Tutorial
Measures of variability of discrete random distributions: Consolidate your understanding of measures of centre and variability. (page 518)
Tutorials
Interactivity int-0255
We 26 int-0574: Watch a worked example on calculating variance. (page 520) We 32 int-0575: Watching a worked example on constructing a probability distribution table. (page 524)
Digital doc
SkillSHEET 10.1: Practise finding the expected value of a function of a random variable. (page 517) WorkSHEET 10.2: Calculate probabilities, expected values and variance for discrete probability distributions. (page 518)
Test Yourself: Take the end-of-chapter test to test your progress. (page 535)
To access eBookPLUS activities, log on to www.jacplus.com.au
536
11
The binomial distribution
areaS oF STudy
11A The binomial distribution 11B Problems involving the binomial distribution for multiple probabilities 11C Markov chains and transition matrices 11D Expected value, variance and standard deviation of the binomial distribution
Random variables, including: calculation and interpretation of the expected value, variance and standard deviation of a random variable Bernoulli trials and two-state Markov chains, including the length of run in a sequence, steady values for a Markov chain (familiarity with the use of transition matrices to compute values of a Markov chain will be assumed) Discrete random variables, including: specification of probability distributions for discrete random variables using graphs, tables and probability functions
interpretation and use of mean (), median, mode, variance ( 2) and standard deviation of a discrete random variable the binomial distribution, Bi(n, p), as an example of a probability distribution for a discrete random variable (students are expected to be familiar with the binomial theorem and related binomial expansions) the effect of variation in the value(s) of defining parameters on the graph of a given probability function for a discrete random variable probabilities for specific values of a random variable and intervals defined in terms of a random variable, including conditional probability
eBook plus
11a
Digital doc
10 Quick Questions
The binomial distribution is an example of a particular type of discrete probability distribution. It has relevance and importance in many real-life everyday applications. This particular branch of mathematics moves away from the textbook and the classroom and into the areas of medical research, simulation activities and business applications such as quality control. The binomial distribution may be referred to as a Bernoulli distribution, and the trials conducted are known as Bernoulli trials. They were named in honour of the Swiss mathematician Jakob Bernoulli (16541705).
Chapter 11
537
Worked Example 1
Determine which of the following sequences can be defined as Bernoulli sequences. a Rolling an 8-sided die numbered 1 to 8 forty times and recording the number of 6s obtained b Drawing a card from a fair deck with replacement and recording the number of aces c Rolling a die 60 times and recording the number that is obtained
Think a Check that all the characteristics have been a Write
Yes, this is an example of a Bernoulli sequence, as there are two possible outcomes for each trial (success is obtaining a 6 and failure is not obtaining a 6), the outcome of each trial is independent of the outcome of previous trials, and the probability of success is the same for each trial. Yes, this is an example of a Bernoulli sequence, as there are two possible outcomes for each trial (success is obtaining an ace and failure is not obtaining an ace), the outcome of each trial is independent of the outcome of previous trials, and the probability of success is the same for each trial (as each time a card is drawn it is replaced). This is not an example of a Bernoulli sequence, since success has not been defined.
If X represents a random variable that has a binomial distribution, then it can be expressed as: X Bi(n, p) or X B(n, p) Translated into words, X Bi(n, p) means that X follows a binomial distribution with parameters n (the number of trials) and p (the probability of success). Consider the experiment where a fair die is rolled four times. If X represents the number of times a 3 appears uppermost, then X is a binomial variable. Obtaining a 3 will represent a success and all other values will represent a failure. The die is rolled four times so the number of trials, n, equals 4 and the probability, p, of obtaining a 3 is equal to 1 . Using the shorthand 6 notation, X Bi(n, p) becomes X ~ Bi(4, 1 ). 6 We will now determine the probability of a 3 appearing uppermost 0, 1, 2, 3 and 4 times. Obtaining 3 is defined as a success and is denoted by S. All other numbers are defined as a failure and are denoted by F. The possible outcomes are listed in the table below.
Occurrence of 3 0 1
Probability
( 65 )
3
625 = 1296
q4 4q3p
= 500 ( 65 ) ( 1 6 ) 1296
538
Occurrence of 3 2 3 4
Possible outcomes SSFF SFSF SFFS FSSF FSFS FFSS SSSF SSFS SFSS FSSS SSSS 6 6
Probability
( 65 ) ( 1 6)
2
150 = 1296
6q2p2 4qp3 p4
( 65 )( 1 6) (1 6)
4
20 = 1296
1 = 1296
It is interesting to note that the binomial probability distribution is closely related to the binomial theorem (see far right-hand column). Furthermore, if we examine the coefficients of the terms that is, 1, 4, 6, 4, 1 it is evident that they are the entries of Pascals triangle. This procedure for determining the individual probabilities can become tedious, particularly once the number of trials increases. Hence if X is a binomial random variable, its probability is defined as follows. Pr(X = x) = nCx pxqn x where x = 0, 1, 2, . . . n. That is: x = the occurrence of the successful outcome. The formula may also be written as Pr(X = x) = nCx px(1 p)n x where x = 0, 1, 2, . . . n Here, the probability of failure, q, is replaced by 1 p. nC represents the number of ways that x different outcomes can be obtained from n trials. It can x n n! also be written as and has the formula nCx = . x !( n x )! x Since this is a probability distribution, we would expect that the sum of the probabilities is 1. Therefore, for the previous example: Pr(X = x) = Pr(X = 0) + Pr(X = 1) + Pr(X = 2) + Pr(X = 3) + Pr(X = 4)
625 500 150 20 1 = 1296 + 1296 + 1296 + 1296 + 1296
=1
Worked example 2
eBook plus
Tutorial
A binomial variable, X, has the probability function Pr(X = x) = 6Cx(0.4)x(0.6)6 x where x = 0, 1, . . . 6. Find: a n, the number of trials b p, the probability of success c the probability distribution for x as a table.
Think WriTe
int-0576
Worked example 2
the given function. The number of trials, n, is the value of the number located at the top left-hand corner of C.
b Obtain the relevant information
a n=6
from the given function. The probability of success, p, is the value in the first bracket.
b p = 0.4
Chapter 11
539
Write the rule of the given probability function. Substitute x = 0 into the rule. Evaluate. Substitute x = 1 into the rule. Evaluate. Substitute x = 2 into the rule. Evaluate. Substitute x = 3 into the rule. Evaluate. Substitute x = 4 into the rule. Evaluate. Substitute x = 5 into the rule. Evaluate. Substitute x = 6 into the rule. Evaluate. Place values in a table. Note: The table at right clearly displays the probability distribution of the given function. It also shows that the individual probabilities sum to 1.
Pr(X = x) = 6Cx(0.4)x(0.6)6 x Pr(X = 0) = 6C0(0.4)0(0.6)6 = 1 1 0.046 656 = 0.046 656 = 6 0.4 0.077 76 = 0.186 624 = 15 0.16 0.1296 = 0.311 04 = 20 0.064 0.216 = 0.276 48 = 15 0.0256 0.36 = 0.138 24 = 6 0.010 24 0.6 = 0.036 864 = 1 0.004 096 1 = 0.004 096
x 0 1 2 3 4 5 6
2 3
4 5
Pr(X = 1) = 6C1(0.4)(0.6)5
6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15
Pr(X = 2) = 6C2(0.4)2(0.6)4
Pr(X = 3) = 6C3(0.4)3(0.6)3
Pr(X = 4) = 6C4(0.4)4(0.6)2
Pr(X = 5) = 6C5(0.4)5(0.6)
Pr(X = 6) = 6C6(0.4)6(0.6)0
16
A CAS calculator can also be used to find the probability distribution. n=6 p = 0.4 X ~ Bi(6, 0.4) On a Calculator page, press: MENU b 5:Probability 5 5:Distributions 5 D:BinomialPdf D Enter values of n and p, using Tab e to move between fields.
540
Pr(X = x) 0.046 656 0.186 624 0.311 04 0.276 48 0.138 24 0.036 864 0.004 096
Worked Example 3
A fair die is rolled five times. Find the probability of obtaining: a exactly four 5s b exactly two even numbers c all results greater than 3 d a 5 on the first roll only e a 5 on the second and third roll only.
Think a
1 2 3
Write
Check that all the characteristics have been satisfied for a binomial distribution. Write the rule for the binomial probability distribution. Define and assign values to variables. The number of 5s obtained is exactly four.
and two outcomes, fixed p and q. Pr(X = x) = nCxpxqn x n=5 Let X = the number of 5s obtained. That is, x = 4 p = probability of a 5 = 1 6 5 q= 6 Pr( X = 4) = 5C4
5 (1 6) (6) 4 5 6
4 5
1 = 5 1296
25 7776
541
Define and assign values to variables. Two even numbers means we have x = 2.
b n = 5
Let X = the number of even numbers. That is, x = 2 p = probability of an even number = 1 2 q=
1 2 1 (1 2) (2) 2 1 4 3
2 3
Pr( X = 2) = 5C2
c n = 5
= 10 = 10 32
5 = 16
1 8
Simplify. Define and assign values to variables. We require 5 occasions when results are greater than 3.
Let X = values greater than 3. That is, x = 5 Three outcomes 4, 5, 6 out of six are greater than 3. p = probability of number greater than 3= 1 2
1 2 1 (1 2) (2) 5 0
q=
2 3
d Since a specific order is required here, the
= Pr(SFFFF)
625 7776
5 5 5 =1 6 6 6 6
5 6
=
e Since a specific order is required here, the
= Pr(FSSFF) =
125 7776
5 5 =6 1 1 6 6 6
5 6
Note: If the rule for the binomial probability distribution were to be used in part d, it would 625 provide an answer of 5 7776 = 3125 . This answer gives the probability of obtaining a 5 once on 7776 any of the five trials, not necessarily on the first roll only. Hence, if a specific order is required the rule for the binomial probability distribution should not be used. Similarly in part e the rule would produce an answer of 10 of obtaining a 5 twice on any of the five trials.
125 7776
542
Worked Example 4
A new drug for hay fever is known to be successful in 40% of cases. Ten hay fever sufferers take part in the testing of the drug. Find the probability, correct to 4 decimal places, that: a four people are cured b no people are cured c all 10 are cured.
Think a
1 2 3
Write a This is a binomial distribution with n independent Check that all the characteristics have been satisfied for a binomial distribution. trials and two outcomes, p and q.
Write the rule for the binomial probability distribution. Define and assign values to variables.
Pr(X = x) = nCxpxqn x n = 10 Let X = the number of people cured, therefore x = 4 p = 0.4 q = 0.6 Pr(X = 4) = 10C4(0.4)4 (0.6)6 = 210 0.0256 0.046 656 = 0.250 822 656 0.2508
4 5 6 7
Substitute the values into the rule. Evaluate. Round the answer to 4 decimal places. Note: A CAS calculator can also be used to calculate the probability for a particular x-value. Find the number of trials, n, the probability of success, p, and the x-value you want to find the probability of. On a Calculator page, press: MENU b 5:Probability 5 5:Distributions 5 D:Binomial Pdf D Enter values of n, p and x, using Tab e to move between fields.
Press ENTER .
543
9 10
Write the solution. Answer the question and round to 4 decimal places. Define and assign values to variables. Repeat as above using the CAS calculator to find Pr(X = 0). Answer the question and round to 4 decimal places. Define and assign values to variables. Repeat as above using the CAS calculator to find Pr(X = 10). Answer the question and round to 4 decimal places.
Pr(X = 4) = binomPdf(10, 0.4, 4) = 0.250 823 The probability that 4 people are cured is 0.2508.
b X ~ Bi(10, 0.4)
1 2 3
As X = the number of people cured, therefore x = 0. Pr(X = 0) = binomPdf(10, 0.4, 0) = 0.006 046 6 The probability that no people are cured is 0.0060.
1 2 3
c X ~ Bi(10, 0.4)
As X = the number of people cured, therefore x = 10. Pr(X = 10) = binomPdf(10, 0.4, 10) = 0.000 104 86 The probability that no people are cured is 0.0001.
Worked example 5
eBook plus
Grant is a keen darts player and knows that his chance of scoring a bullseye on any Tutorial one throw is 0.3. int-0577 a If Grant takes 6 shots at the target, find the probability, correct to 4 decimal Worked example 5 places, that he: i misses the bullseye each time ii hits the bullseye at least once. b Find the number of throws Grant would need to ensure a probability of more than 0.8 of scoring at least one bullseye.
Think a i
1
WriTe
2 3
Check that all the characteristics have been satisfied for a binomial distribution. Write the rule for the binomial probability distribution. Define and assign values to variables.
4 5
Substitute the values into the rule. Evaluate and round answer to 4 decimal places. Note: Check the answer using binomPdf(6,0.3,0). Answer the question.
n=6 Let X = the number of bullseyes, therefore x = 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6 p = 0.3 q = 0.7 Pr(X = x) = nCx pxqn x Pr(X = 0) = 6C0(0.3)0(0.7)6 = 1 1 0.117 649 = 0.117 649 0.1176 The probability that Grant misses the bullseye each time is 0.1176.
544
ii
Define and assign values to variables. Note: Pr(X 1) would involve adding probabilities from Pr(X = 1) to Pr(X = 6). Using the fact that Pr(X 1) = 1 Pr(X = 0) allows us to solve the problem using fewer terms. Substitute the values into the rule.
ii n = 6 Let X = the number of bullseyes, therefore x = 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6 p = 0.3 q = 0.7 Pr(X 1) = Pr(X = 1) + Pr(X = 2) + . . . + Pr(X = 6) = 1 Pr(X = 0) = 1 6C0(0.3)0(0.7)6 = 1 0.117 649 = 0.882 351 0.8824
Evaluate and round answer to 4 decimal places. Note: Check the answer using 1 binomPdf(6,0.3,0). Answer the question. Define and assign values to variables.
b
The probability that Grant hits the bullseye at least once is 0.8824. n=? Let X = the number of bullseyes, therefore x = 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6 p = 0.3 q = 0.7 Pr(X 1) > 0.8 Pr(X 1) = Pr(X = 1) + Pr(X = 2) + . . . + Pr(X = 6) = 1 Pr(X = 0) 1 Pr(X = 0) > 0.8 1 nC0(0.3)0(0.7)n > 0.8 1 0.7n > 0.8 1 0.8 > 0.7n 0.2 > 0.7n loge (0.2) > loge (0.7n) loge (0.2) > n loge (0.7) log e (0.2) <n log e (0.7) n > 4.512 338 026 Grant would need to take 5 shots to ensure a probability of 0.8 of scoring at least one bullseye.
3 4
5 6
Interpret the results and answer the question. Alternatively, a CAS calculator can be used to solve the inequation. On a Calculator page, press: MENU b 3:Algebra 3 1:Solve 1 Complete the entry line as: solve(1 0.7n > 0.8,n) Then press ENTER .
545
7 8
Write the solution. Interpret the results and answer the question.
Solving 1 0.7n > 0.8 for n implies n > 4.51234 Grant would need to take 5 shots to ensure a probability of 0.8 of scoring at least one bullseye.
The graph is symmetrical. It is also called a normal distribution curve. Pr(X = x) 0.34 0.32 0.30 0.28 0.26 0.24 0.22 0.20 0.18 0.16 0.14 0.12 0.10 0.08 0.06 0.04 0.02 0.00
012 34 5
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 101112131415
546
Pr(X = x) 0.34 0.32 0.30 0.28 0.26 0.24 0.22 0.20 0.18 0.16 0.14 0.12 0.10 0.08 0.06 0.04 0.02 0.00
X ~ Bi(25, 0.5)
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10111213141516171819202122232425
From the preceding graphs it can be seen that: 1. when p = 0.5, the graph is symmetrical 2. as n increases, and the interval between the vertical columns decreases, the graph approximates a smooth hump or bell shape. The effects that the parameters n and p have on the binomial probability distribution curve can be summarised in the following way. If p < 0.5, the graph is positively skewed.
Pr(X = x)
When n is large and p = 0.5, the vertical columns are closer together and the line graph becomes a bell-shaped curve or a normal distribution curve.
REMEMBER
1. The binomial distribution is an example of a discrete probability distribution. 2. The binomial distribution may be referred to as a Bernoulli distribution, and the trials conducted are known as Bernoulli trials. 3. For a sequence to be defined as a Bernoulli sequence, each of the following characteristics must be satisfied. (a) Each trial in the sequence must be a Bernoulli trial, that is, there must be only two possible outcomes for each trial (success and failure). (b) The probability of success, p, is the same for each trial, and is independent of the outcome of previous trials. (The probability of failure, q, is equal to 1 p.) 4. X ~ Bi(n, p) denotes that X follows a binomial distribution with parameters n (the number of independent trials) and p (the probability of success). 5. If X is a binomial random variable, its probability is defined as Pr(X = x) = nCx pxqn x where x = 0, 1, 2, . . . n. Note: x represents the occurrence of the successful outcomes.
547
6. The parameters n and p affect the binomial probability distribution curve as follows: (a) If p < 0.5, the graph is positively skewed. (b) If p = 0.5, the graph is symmetrical or is a normal distribution curve. (c) If p > 0.5, the graph is negatively skewed. (d) When n is large and p = 0.5, the interval between the vertical columns decreases and the graph approximates a smooth hump or bell shape. exerCiSe
11a
eBook plus
Digital doc
Spreadsheet 003
Binomial distribution
3 We2 A binomial variable, X, has the probability function Pr(X = where x = 0, 1, . . ., 5. Find: a n, the number of trials b p, the probability of success c the probability distribution for x as a table. 4 Twenty per cent of items made by a certain machine are defective. The items are packed and sold in boxes of 5. What is the probability of 4 items being defective in a box?
exam Tip
nC n1
( ) (2 3)
7
c f
Students should know that nCn = 1 and = n. Similarly nC0 = 1 and nC1 = n.
5 6
Alex lives so close to where she works that she only has a 0.1 chance of being late. What is the probability that she is late on 3 out of 4 days? Ange has four chances to knock an empty can off a stand by throwing a ball. On each 1 throw, the probability of success is . Find the probability that she will knock the empty can 3 off the stand: a once b twice c at least once.
7 We3 A fair coin is tossed four times. Find the probability of obtaining: a heads on the first two tosses and tails on the second two b heads on every roll c two heads and two tails. 8 Peter is quite poor at doing crossword puzzles and the probability of him completing one is 0.2. Find the probability that: a of the next three crossword puzzles that he attempts, he is successful in completing two b he successfully completes the first three crossword puzzles that he tries, but has no luck on the next one
548
c he successfully completes the first three crossword puzzles that he tries d he successfully completes the first three puzzles that he tries given that he was successful in completing his first two. 9 A weighted coin is biased such that a tail comes up 60% of the time. The coin is tossed five times. Find the probability of obtaining: a tails on the first four tosses only b four tails. 10 WE4 Fifty-five per cent of the local municipality support the local council. If eight people are selected at random, find the probability, correct to 4 decimal places, that: a half support the council b all eight support the council c five support the council d three oppose the council. 11 The probability of Colin beating Maria at golf is 0.4. If they play once a week throughout the entire year and the outcome of each game is independent of any other, find the probability that they will have won the same number of matches, correct to 4 decimal places. 12 It is known that 5 out of every 8 people eat Superflakes for breakfast. Find the probability that half of a random sample of 20 people surveyed eat Superflakes, correct to 4 decimal places. 13 On a certain evening, during a ratings period, two television stations put their best shows on against each other. The ratings showed that 39% of people watched Channel6, while only 30% of people watched Channel 8. The rest watched other channels. A random sample of 10 people were surveyed the next day. Find the probability, correct to 4 decimal places, that exactly: a six watched Channel 6 b four watched Channel 8. 14 Three per cent of items produced by a certain machine are defective. A random sample of 10 items is taken. Find the probability that exactly 10% are defective, correct to 4 decimal places. 15 A new drug being trialled gives 8% of the patients a violent reaction. If 200 patients trial the drug, find the probability that 12 patients have a violent reaction to the drug, correct to 4 decimal places. 16 A pen company produces 30 000 pens per week. However, of these 30 000 pens, 600 are defective. Pens are sold in boxes of 20. Find the probability, correct to 4 decimal places, that: a two defective pens are found in one box b a box is free from defective pens. 17 A box contains 5 red marbles, 3 blue marbles and 2 yellow marbles. A marble is chosen at random and replaced. This selection process is completed eight times. Find the probability, correct to 4 decimal places, that: a exactly 4 reds are selected b exactly 2 blues are selected c no yellows are selected. 18 MC Claires position in the netball team is goal shooter. The probability of her shooting a goal is 78%. If Claire has 10 attempts at scoring, the probability she will score fewer than 3 goals is: A 10C3 (0.78)3(0.22)7 B 10C3 (0.78)3(0.22)7 + 10C4 (0.78)4(0.22)6 + . . . + (0.78)10 C 10C2 (0.78)2(0.22)8 + 10C1 (0.78)1(0.22)9 + (0.22)10 D 10C2 (0.78)2(0.22)8 + 10C1 (0.78)1(0.22)9 + (0.78)10 E 10C2 (0.22)2(0.78)8 + 10C1 (0.22)1(0.78)9 + (0.78)10
549
19 mC The probability that the temperature in Melbourne will rise above 25 C on any given summer day, independent of any other summer day, is 0.6. The probability that four days in a week reach in excess of 25 C is: A 0.64 0.43 B 7 0.64 0.43 C 4 0.43 7 D 0.64 E 35 0.64 0.43 20 mC Rachel sits a multiple-choice test containing 20 questions, each with four possible answers. If she guesses every answer, the probability of Rachel getting 11 questions correct is: A D
3 ( ) (4 ) 9 11 1 3 20 C 11 ( 4 ) ( 4 ) 1 20 C 11 4 20 9
B E
3 ( ) (4 ) 9 11 1 3 20 C 10 ( 4 ) ( 4 ) 1 20 C 11 4 11 9
1 20 C 10 4
3 ( ) (4 ) 11
21 mC A smoke detector has a probability of failing 2% of the time. If a shopping complex has installed 40 of these smoke detectors, the probability that at least one fails is given by: A 1 40C1 (0.98)1(0.02)39 B 1 40C1 (0.02)1(0.98)39 C 1 (0.02)40 D 1 (0.98)40 E (0.98)40 22 mC It is found that 3 out of every 10 cars are unroadworthy. Ten cars are selected at random. The probability that 3 are unroadworthy is: A 0.009 B 0.2601 C 0.2668 D 0.5 E 1 23 We5 Grant is a keen darts player and knows that his chance of scoring a bullseye on any one throw is 0.6. a If Grant takes 5 shots at the target find the probability that he: i misses the bullseye each time ii hits the bullseye at least once. b Find the number of throws Grant would need to ensure a probability of more than 0.7 of scoring at least one bullseye.
eBook plus
Digital doc
SkillSHEET 11.1
Solving indicial equations
24 The chance of winning a major prize in a raffle is 0.05. Find the number of tickets required to ensure a probability of more than 0.6 of winning a major prize at least once. 25 A darts player knows that her chance of scoring a bullseye on any one throw is 0.1. Find the number of turns she would need to ensure a probability of 0.9 of scoring at least one bullseye. 26 In Tattslotto, your chance of winning first division is 1 . Find:
8 145 060
a the number of games you would need to play if you wanted to ensure a more than 50% chance of winning first division at least once b the number of tickets you would need to buy for part a if there are 16 games on each ticket c the cost of buying these tickets, if they cost $4.10 each.
550
Spreadsheet 003
Binomial distribution
28 From the following binomial distribution tables: i draw a graph of the probability distribution ii describe the skewness of each graph. a X Bi(10, 0.3) b X Bi(10, 0.5) x 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 29 Pr(X = x) 0.028 25 0.121 06 0.233 47 0.266 83 0.200 12 0.102 92 0.036 76 0.009 00 0.001 45 0.000 01 5.9 106 x 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 Pr(X = x) 0.000 98 0.009 77 0.043 95 0.117 19 0.205 08 0.246 09 0.205 08 0.117 19 0.043 95 0.009 77 0.000 98
c X Bi(10, 0.8) x 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 Pr(X = x) 1 107 4.1 106 0.000 07 0.000 79 0.005 51 0.026 42 0.088 08 0.201 33 0.301 99 0.268 44 0.107 37
a Describe the plots of the following binomial probability distributions, without drawing the graphs. i n = 25, p = 0.1 ii n = 50, p = 0.5 iii n = 30, p = 0.9 b What effect does p have on the graph of a binomial probability distribution? a Describe the plot of the binomial probability distribution, X Bi(60, 0.5), without drawing the graph. b Suggest how the graph might look for a binomial probability distribution with the same p, but double the value of n. a Describe the plot of the binomial probability distribution, X Bi(100, 0.4), without drawing the graph. b Suggest how the graph might look for a binomial probability distribution with the same n, but double the value of p.
30
31
Chapter 11
551
32 Describe the skewness of the graphs of the following binomial probability distributions.
eBook plus
Digital doc
a Pr(X = x)
0.4 0.2 0.0 x
WorkSHEET 11.1
1 2 3 4 5
0.0
5 10 15 20 x
d Pr(X = x)
0.4 0.2 0.0 x
2 4 6 8 10
1 2 3 4
11B
Worked example 6
0 0.2311
1 0.3147
2 0.3321
3 0.1061
4 0.0112
5 0.0048
Pr (X > 3) means Pr(X = 4) or Pr(X = 5). Add these probabilities. Evaluate. Pr(X 4) would involve adding the probabilities from Pr(X = 0) to Pr(X = 4). Using the fact that Pr(X 4) = 1 Pr(X > 4) allows us to solve the problem using fewer terms. Substitute the value into the rule. Evaluate.
Pr(X > 3) = Pr(X = 4) + Pr(X = 5) = 0.0112 + 0.0048 = 0.0160 Pr(X 4) = Pr(X = 0) + . . . + Pr(X = 4) = 1 Pr(X = 5)
2 3
= 1 0.0048 = 0.9952
552
Worked example 7
Find Pr(X 3) if X has a binomial distribution with the probability of success, p, and the number of trials, n, given by p = 0.3, n = 5.
Think
1 2 3 4
WriTe
State the probability distribution. Write what is required. Substitute the values for n, p and q into the rule Pr(X = x) = nCx pxqn x. Evaluate.
X i(n, p) X i(5, 0.3) Pr(X 3) = Pr(X = 3) + Pr(X = 4) + Pr(X = 5) = 5C3(0.3)3(0.7)2 + 5C4(0.3)4(0.7) + 5C5(0.3)5(0.7)0 = 10 0.027 0.49 + 5 0.0081 0.7 + 1 0.002 43 1 = 0.1323 + 0.028 35 + 0.002 43 = 0.163 08
Worked example 8
eBook plus
Tutorial
So Jung has a bag containing 4 red and 3 blue marbles. She selects a marble at random and then replaces it. She does this 7 times. Find the probability, correct to 4 decimal places, that: a at least 5 marbles are red b greater than 3 are red c no more than 2 are red.
Think a
1
int-0578
Worked example 8
WriTe
State the probability distribution and define and assign values to variables.
n=7 p= 4 7
X ~ Bi(7, 4 ) 7 As X = number of red marbles selected, therefore x = 5. We want at least 5 red marbles, Pr(X 5)
2
On a Calculator page, press: MENUb 5:Probability5 5:Distributions5 E:BinomialCdfE Enter values of n and p, using Tab e to move between fields. Enter lower bound as 5 and upper bound as 7, as the number of trials is 7.
Chapter 11
553
Press ENTER .
Write the solution. Answer the question and round to 4 decimal places. Repeat as above, using the CAS calculator to find Pr(X > 3). Note: Only inclusive values can be entered into the CAS calculator, Pr(X > 3) = Pr(X 4) Remember that only discrete values are possible for a binomial distribution. Answer the question and round to 4 decimal places. Repeat as above, using the CAS calculator to find Pr(X 2). Note: this time the upper bound will be 2 and the lower bound will be 0.
c
Pr(X 5) = binomCdf(7, 4 , 5, 7) 7 = 0.359 345 The probability that at least 5 red marbles are chosen is 0.3593.
b Pr(X > 3) = binomCdf(7, 4 , 4, 7) 7
= 0.653 100 08
Pr(X 2) = binomCdf(7, 4 , 0, 2) 7 = 0.126584 The probability that no more than 2 marbles are chosen is 0.1266.
554
Worked Example 9
X follows a binomial distribution with n = 9, p = 0.4. Find, correct to 4 decimal places: a Pr(X 7) b the probability that X is greater than 7 given it is greater than 5; that is, Pr(X > 7X > 5).
Think a
1
write
State the probability distribution. Write what is required. Substitute the values for n, p and q into the rule Pr(X = x) = nCx pxqn x. Evaluate and round the answer to 4 decimal places.
a X ~ Bi(n, p)
2 3
Part a can also be solved with a CAS calculator. (Refer to worked example 8).
b
1
= 36 1.6384 103 0.36 + 9 6.5536 104 0.6 + 1 2.621 44 104 1 = 0.021 23 + 0.003 54 + 2.621 44 104 = 0.025 034 752 0.0250 Pr(X 7) = binomCdf(9, 0.4, 7, 9) = 0.0250 Pr(( X > 7) ( X > 5)) Pr( X > 5) Pr( X > 7) = Pr( X > 5)
Evaluate each probability individually. Pr(X > 7) can be obtained from results in a.
Pr(X > 7) = Pr(X = 8) + Pr(X = 9) = 3.801 088 103 Pr(X > 5) = Pr(X = 6) + Pr(X = 7) + Pr(X = 8) + Pr(X = 9) = 9C6(0.4)6(0.6)3 + 0.025 034 752 = 84 4.096 103 0.216 + 0.025 034 752 = 0.993 525 76 Pr( X > 7) 3.801 088 10 3 = Pr( X > 5) 0.993 525 76 = 0.038 258 75 0.0383 Pr( X > 7) Pr( X > 5) binomCdf(9, 0.4, 7, 9) binomCdf(9, 0.4, 7, 9 )
Evaluate
Round the answer to 4 decimal places. Part b can also be solved with a CAS calculator.
= 0.0383
555
Worked example 10
eBook plus
Seventy per cent of all scheduled trains through Westbourne station arrive on time. Tutorial If 10 trains go through the station every day, find, correct to 4 decimal places: int-0579 a the probability that at least 8 trains are on time Worked example 10 b the probability that at least 8 trains are on time for 9 out of the next 10 days.
Think a
1 2 3
WriTe
State the probability distribution. Write what is required. Substitute the values of n, p and q into the rule Pr(X = x) = nCx pxqn x. Evaluate and round the answer to 4 decimal places.
a X i(n, p)
X i(10, 0.7)
Part a can also be solved with a CAS calculator. (Refer to worked example 8). 5 Answer the question. b 1 State the probability distribution. 2 Write what is required.
3
Pr(X 8) = Pr(X = 8) + Pr(X = 9) + Pr(X = 10) = 10C8(0.7)8(0.3)2 + 10C9(0.7)9(0.3) + 10C10(0.7)10(0.3)0 = 45 0.057 648 01 0.09 + 10 0.040 353 607 0.3 + 1 0.028 247 524 9 1 = 0.233 474 440 5 + 0.121 060 821 + 0.028 247 524 9 = 0.382 782 786 4 0.3828 Pr(X 8) = binomCdf(10, 0.7, 8, 10) = 0.3828 The probability that at least 8 trains are on time is 0.3828.
b X i(n, p)
Substitute the values of n, p and q into the rule Pr(X = x) = nCx pxqn x. Evaluate and round the answer to 4 decimal places. Part b can also be solved with a CAS calculator. = 10 0.000 176 501 08 0.6172 = 0.001 089 364 7 0.0011 Pr(X = 9) = binomPdf(10, 0.3828, 9) = 0.0011 The probability that at least 8 trains are on time for 9 out of the next 10 days is 0.0011.
rememBer
When solving problems dealing with the binomial distribution for multiple probabilities always: 1. define the distribution 2. write what is required 3. write the rule for the binomial probability distribution 4. substitute the values into the given rule and evaluate.
556
exerCiSe
11B
eBook plus
Digital doc
Find: a Pr(X 4)
SkillSHEET 11.2
Multiple probabilities
3 A binomial variable, X, has the probability function Pr(X = x) = the probability of success and x = 0, 1, . . ., 5. Find: a Pr(X 2) b Pr(X < 4).
(0.7)5 x, where x is
4 We7 Find Pr(X 4), correct to 4 decimal places, if X has a binomial distribution with the probability of success, p, and the number of trials, n, given by: a p = 0.6, n = 5 b p = 0.5, n = 6 c p = 0.2, n = 7. 5 A fair coin is tossed 5 times. Calculate the probability of obtaining: a at least one tail b greater than three tails c greater than three tails, given that at least one tail was obtained.
1 Marco has a faulty alarm clock and the probability that it sounds in the morning is . 3 Calculate the probability, for the next 4 mornings, that his alarm clock: a works at least 3 times b works fewer than 2 times c works at least 3 times, given that it works at least once. Generally, 10% of people who enter a modelling contest are male. For a particular competition, three winners were chosen. What is the probability that less than two females were chosen?
8 We8 A bag contains 4 red and 2 blue marbles. A marble is selected at random and replaced. The experiment is repeated 6 times. Find the probability that: a all 6 selections are red b at least 2 are red c not more than 1 is red. 9 It is known that 40% of Victorians play sport regularly. Ten people are selected at random. Calculate the probability, correct to 4 decimal places, that: a at least half play sport regularly b at least nine dont play sport regularly. 10 Surveys have shown that 8 out of 10 VCE students study every night. Six VCE students are selected at random. Find the probability, correct to 4 decimal places, that, on any one day: a at least 50% of these students study every night b less than 3 students study every night. , Pr ( X = 2) = Pr ( X = 4) = 1 11 A die is weighted such that Pr ( X = 6) = 1 2 6 and Pr (X = 1) = 1 Pr ( X = 3) = Pr ( X = 5) = 18 . The die is rolled five times. Calculate the probability, correct to 4 decimal places, of obtaining: a at least three 6s b at least two even numbers c a maximum of two odd numbers.
557
Chapter 11
12 WE9 If X is binomially distributed with n = 8 and p = 0.7, find, correct to 4 decimal places: a Pr(X 7) b Pr(X > 7 | X > 5). 13 A survey shows that 49% of the public support the current government. Twelve people are selected at random. Calculate, correct to 4 decimal places: a the probability that at least 8 support the government b the probability that at least 10 support the government, given that at least 8 do. 14 MC When Graeme kicks for goal, the probability of his kicking a goal is 0.7. If he has five kicks at goal, the probability that he will score fewer than two goals is: A 5C1(0.7)1 (0.3)4 + (0.3)5 B 5C2(0.7)2 (0.3)3 C 5C2(0.7)2 (0.3)3 + 5C1(0.7)1 (0.3)4 D 5C2(0.7)2 (0.3)3 + 5C1(0.7)1 (0.3)4 + (0.3)5 E 1 5C2(0.7)2 (0.3)3 15 MC The proportion of patients who suffer a violent reaction from a new drug being trialled is p. If 80 patients trial the drug, the probability that one-quarter of the patients have a violent reaction is: A 80C25 (p)25(1 p)55 B 80C20 (1 p)20(p)60 C 80C25 (1 p)25(p)55 D 80C20 (p)20(1 p)60 E 80C20 (p)20 16 MC If X is a random variable, binomially distributed with n = 10 and p = k, Pr(X 1) is: A 1 (1 k)10 B (1 k)10 C 10(k)(1 k)9 D (k)10 E 1 (k)10 17 MC Three per cent of items made by a certain machine are defective. The items are packed and sold in boxes of 10. If 3 or more are defective, the box can be returned and money refunded. The chance of being eligible for a refund is: A 0 B 0.0002 C 0.0036 D 0.0028 E 0.9972 18 MC Long-term statistics show that Silvana wins 60% of her tennis matches. The probability that she will win at least 80% of her next 10 matches is: A 0.0061 B 0.0464 C 0.1673 D 0.8327 E 0.9536 19 MC Nineteen out of every 20 cricketers prefer Boundary cricket gear. A squad of 12 cricketers train together. The probability that at least 11 use Boundary gear, given that at least 10 use it, is: A 0.5404 B 0.6129 C 0.8816 D 0.8992 E 0.9804 20 A school council, comprising 15 members of the school community, requires a minimum twothirds majority to pass a motion. It is known that 50% of the school community favour a new uniform. Calculate the probability that the school council will pass a motion in favour of a new uniform, correct to 4 decimal places. 21 A car insurance salesman knows that he has a good chance of finding customers in the age group from 18 to 20, as people often buy their first car at this age. Five per cent of all people in this age group are looking to purchase a car. The salesman questions 30 people in this age group. Calculate the probability, correct to 4 decimal places, that he will get: a no more than 3 sales b at least 3 sales. 22 Police radar camera tests have shown that 1% of all cars drive at over 30km/h above the speed limit, 2% between 10 km/h and 30 km/h above the limit and 4% below 10km/h over the limit. In one particular hour, a radar camera tests 50 cars. Caculate the probability, correct to 4 decimal places, that: a at most, one car is over 30 km/h above the limit b at most, two cars are between 10 km/h and 30 km/h above the limit c at most, two cars are below 10 km/h above the limit d at most, three cars are above the limit.
558
23 An Australian cricketer scores 50 or more in one-third of all his test match innings. The Australian selectors are aiming to predict his next 10 innings. Calculate, correct to 4 decimal places, the probability that he will score 50 or more on: a no occasions b exactly four occasions c at least two occasions. 24 Two dice are rolled simultaneously and their difference is recorded. Find the probability, correct to 4 decimal places, that in 5 rolls: a a difference of zero occurs at least once b a difference of 1 occurs at least twice c a difference of 5 occurs at least once. 25 We10 Eighty per cent of all scheduled trains through Westbourne station arrive on time. If 10 trains go through the station every day, find: a the probability that at least 8 trains are on time b the probability that at least 8 trains are on time for 9 out of the next 10 days. 26 Seventy-five per cent of all scheduled trains through Westbourne station arrive on time. If 15 trains go through the station every day, find, correct to 4 decimal places: a the probability that at least 10 trains are on time b the probability that at least 10 trains are on time for 8 out of the next 10 days. 27 An experiment involves rolling a die 6 times. Calculate, correct to 4 decimal places: a the probability of obtaining at least four prime numbers b the probability of obtaining at least four prime numbers on 5 occasions if the experiment is repeated 8 times. 28 Tennis balls are packed in cans of 6. Five per cent of all balls are made too flat (that is, they dont bounce high enough). The cans are then packed in boxes of two dozen. Calculate the probability, correct to 4 decimal places, that: a a can contains, at most, one flat ball b a box contains at least 22 cans with a maximum of one flat ball.
eBook plus
11C
Interactivity
int-0256
Markov chains and transition matrices
Andrei Markov was a Russian mathematician whose name is given to a technique that calculates probability associated with the state of various transitions. It answers questions such as, What is the probability that James will be late to work today given that he was late yesterday? or What can be said about the long-term behaviour of James punctuality?. A Markov chain is a sequence of repetitions of an experiment in which: 1. The probability of a particular outcome in an experiment is conditional only on the outcome of the experiment immediately before it. 2. The conditional probabilities of each outcome in a particular experiment are the same every single time. A two-state Markov chain is one in which there are only two possible outcomes for each experiment.
Chapter 11
559
Consider a leisure centre that offers aerobics classes and has a gym. Records show that 20% of the members who use the gym on a particular day will participate in an aerobics class the next day and 70% of the members who participate in an aerobics class on a particular day will use the gym the next day. It is also known that 200 members use the leisure centre each day and they all participate in aerobics classes or use the gym, but not both. On a particular day 150 members use the gym and 50 members attend an aerobics class. The possible outcomes may be illustrated on a tree diagram as shown below. Day 1
Gym Day 2 0.8 0.2 0.7 0.3 Gym Aerobics Gym Aerobics
Aerobics
Outcome Interpretation GG The member uses the gym on day 2 given the member used the gym on day 1. GA The member attends an aerobics class on day 2 given the member used the gym on day 1. AG The member uses the gym on day 2 given the member attended an aerobics class on day 1. AA The member attends an aerobics class on day 2 given the member attended an aerobics class on day 1.
The tree diagram can also be used to calculate how many members use the gym or attend an aerobics class. From the tree diagram below, it can be seen that on the second day 155 members use the gym and 45 attend an aerobics class. Day 1 Gym Aerobics
Day 2 0.8 0.2 0.7 0.3 Gym Aerobics Gym Aerobics
Outcome Number of members GG 150 0.8 = 120 GA 150 0.2 = 30 AG 50 0.7 = 35 AA 50 0.3 = 15
The tree diagram may be extended to display the possible outcomes and their respective probabilities for the third day. Day 1
Gym Day 2 0.8 0.2 Gym 0.8 0.2 Aerobics 0.7 0.3 0.7 0.3 Gym 0.8 0.2 Aerobics 0.7 0.3 Day 3 Gym Aerobics Gym Aerobics Gym Aerobics Gym Aerobics
Probability 0.8 0.8 = 0.64 0.8 0.2 = 0.16 0.2 0.7 = 0.14 0.2 0.3 = 0.06 0.7 0.8 = 0.56 0.7 0.2 = 0.14 0.3 0.7 = 0.21 0.3 0.3 = 0.09
Aerobics
GGG represents the member using the gym on all three days; Pr(GGG) = 0.64. If you want to find out the probability of the member using the gym on two out of three days, three outcomes need to be considered: GGA, GAG and AGG. Pr(gym 2 out of 3 days) = Pr(GGA) + Pr(GAG) + Pr(AGG) = 0.16 + 0.14 + 0.56 = 0.86 The tree diagram may be further extended to display the possible outcomes and their respective probabilities on the fourth day.
560
Gym Aerobics
1 Day
Day 2 Gym 0.8 0.2 0.7 0.3 0.8 0.2 0.7 0.3
0.8
0.2
Aerobics
Day 4 Gym Aerobics Gym Aerobics Gym Aerobics Gym Aerobics Gym Aerobics Gym Aerobics Gym Aerobics Gym Aerobics
0.7
Gym
0.2
0.8
0.3
Aerobics
0.2
Outcome GGGG GGGA GGAG GGAA GAGG GAGA GAAG GAAA AGGG AGGA AGAG AGAA AAGG AAGA AAAG AAAA
Probability 0.8 0.8 0.8 = 0.512 0.8 0.8 0.2 = 0.128 0.8 0.2 0.7 = 0.112 0.8 0.2 0.3 = 0.048 0.2 0.7 0.8 = 0.112 0.2 0.7 0.2 = 0.028 0.2 0.3 0.7 = 0.042 0.2 0.3 0.3 = 0.018 0.7 0.8 0.8 = 0.448 0.7 0.8 0.2 = 0.112 0.7 0.2 0.7 = 0.098 0.7 0.2 0.3 = 0.042 0.3 0.7 0.8 = 0.168 0.3 0.7 0.2 = 0.042 0.3 0.3 0.7 = 0.063 0.3 0.3 0.3 = 0.027
As we extend the analysis to cover a greater number of days, setting up the tree diagram becomes very messy and time consuming. The original information can be set up as a pair of recurrence relationships. That is, if 20% of the members using the gym attend an aerobics class the next day, 80% will use the gym the next day. Furthermore, if 70% of the members attending an aerobics class use the gym the next day, 30% will attend an aerobics class the next day. Let gi = the number of members who use the gym on day i. Let ai = the number of members who attend an aerobics class on day i. gi + 1 = 0.8gi + 0.7ai and ai + 1 = 0.2gi + 0.3ai Number of gym users Day i gi = 150 Day i + 1 gi + 1 = 0.8gi + 0.7ai = 0.8 150 + 0.7 50 = 155 Day i + 2 gi + 2 = 0.8gi + 1 + 0.7ai + 1 = 0.8 155 + 0.7 45 = 155.5 Day i + 3 gi + 3 = 0.8gi + 2 + 0.7ai + 2 = 0.8 155.5 + 0.7 44.5 = 155.55 Number of aerobics participants Day i ai = 50 Day i + 1 ai + 1 = 0.2gi + 0.3ai = 0.2 150 + 0.3 50 = 45 Day i + 2 ai + 2 = 0.2gi + 1 + 0.3ai + 1 = 0.2 155 + 0.3 45 = 44.5 Day i + 3 ai + 3 = 0.2gi + 2 + 0.3ai + 2 = 0.2 155.5 + 0.3 44.5 = 44.45
561
This method allows us to clearly see how many members (when rounded to integer values) are using the gym or attending an aerobics class each day. Often we are interested in the long-term behaviour (or the steady state, as it is often called) of a particular situation, in this case how many members will use the gym or attend an aerobics class. We can determine this by using the following information. Let g = the number of members who use the gym. Let a = the number of members who attend an aerobics class. Total number of members = 200 This gives the equation g + a = 200 which when rearranged is equal to a = 200 g [1] Also g = 0.8g + 0.7a [2] and a = 0.2g + 0.3a [3] Rearranging equation [2] g 0.8g = 0.7a 0.2g = 0.7a Substituting [4] into [2] and solving gives 0.2 g 0.7a = 0.2 0.2 g = 3.5a a = 200 3.5a a + 3.5a = 200 4.5a = 200 400 a= 9
[4]
a = 44.4444 (correct to 4 decimal places) Substituting a = 44.4444 gives g = 155.5556. In the long term, 156 members will use the gym and 44 members will attend an aerobics class.
Worked Example 11
The Nee Islands are very wet. If it is raining on a particular day, the chance that it will rain the next day is 60%. If it is not raining on a particular day, the chance that it will rain on the following day is 45%. a If it is raining on Tuesday, draw a tree diagram to represent the next two days. b Extending the tree diagram, calculate the probability that, if it is raining on Tuesday, it will also be raining on Friday of the same week.
Think a Draw a tree diagram labelling each a 0.60 Tuesday 0.40 Dry Write Wednesday Rain 0.60 0.40 0.45 0.55 Thursday Rain Dry Rain Dry
branch and place the appropriate probability along the relevant branch.
562
Draw a tree diagram labelling each branch and place the appropriate probability along the relevant branch. Note: The tree diagram will start at Tuesday and extend to Friday. List each of the outcomes and calculate the probability for each individual outcome.
Wednesday Rain
Probability 0.6 0.6 0.6 = 0.216 0.6 0.6 0.4 = 0.144 0.6 0.4 0.45 = 0.108 0.6 0.4 0.55 = 0.132 0.4 0.45 0.6 = 0.108 0.4 0.45 0.4 = 0.072 0.4 0.55 0.45 = 0.099 0.4 0.55 0.45 = 0.121
3 4
0.216 + 0.108 + 0.108 + 0.099 = 0.531 The probability that it will be raining on Friday if it is raining on Tuesday is 0.531. That is, there is a 53.1% chance of raining on Friday given it will rain on Tuesday.
Worked example 12
eBook plus
Commuters travelling into the centre of Trenchtown use either the bus or the train. Tutorial Research has shown that each month 20% of those using the bus switch to train int-0580 travel and 30% of those using the train switch to bus travel. Worked example 12 If, at the beginning of January, 4800 people were using the bus and 3600 were using the train to get into the city, calculate: a the number of people using the train at the beginning of May b the number of people using the bus and train in the long term.
Think a
1
WriTe
travel and 80% will not switch. Each month 30% of train commuters switch to bus travel and 70% will not switch.
2
Let ti = the number of people using the train at the beginning of month i. Let bi = the number of people using the bus at the beginning of month i. ti + 1 = 0.7ti + 0.2bi and bi + 1 = 0.3ti + 0.8bi
3 4
Set up a pair of recurrence relationships. Substitute the given values of bus and train commuters into the recurrence relationships.
Chapter 11
563
Train travellers January (month i) ti = 3600 February (month i + 1) ti + 1 = 0.7ti + 0.2bi = 0.7 3600 + 0.2 4800 = 3480 March (month i + 2) ti + 2 = 0.7ti + 1 + 0.2bi + 1 = 0.7 3480 + 0.2 4920 = 3420 April (month i + 3) ti + 3 = 0.7ti + 2 + 0.2bi + 2 = 0.7 3420 + 0.2 4980 = 3390 May (month i + 4) ti + 4 = 0.7ti + 3 + 0.2bi + 3 = 0.7 3390 + 0.2 5010 = 3375
5
Bus travellers January (month i) bi = 4800 February (month i + 1) bi + 1 = 0.3ti + 0.8bi = 0.3 3600 + 0.8 4800 = 4920 March (month i + 2) bi + 2 = 0.3ti + 1 + 0.8bi + 1 = 0.3 3480 + 0.8 4920 = 4980 April (month i + 3) bi + 3 = 0.3ti + 2 + 0.8bi + 2 = 0.3 3420 + 0.8 4980 = 5010 May (month i + 4) bi + 4 = 0.3ti + 3 + 0.8bi + 3 = 0.3 3390 + 0.8 5010 = 5025
Evaluate the number of bus and train commuters at the beginning of February. Use the values obtained in step 5 to calculate the number of bus and train commuters at the beginning of March. Repeat the processes involved in step 5 and 6 until the number of bus and train commuters at the beginning of May is obtained. Answer the question. Set up and number equations that relate to: (i) the number of train commuters (ii) the number of bus commuters (iii) the total number of commuters. Note: Maintain the variables defined in part a . Rearrange equation [1] so that t is the subject. Note: Either variable may be the subject. Rearrange equation [3] so that b can be expressed in terms of t. Note: Again either variable may be transposed. At the beginning of May, the number of people using the bus and train respectively is 5025 and 3375.
b Let t = number of people using the train.
Let b = number of people using the bus. Total = 3600 + 4800 t + b = 8400 [1] t = 0.7t + 0.2b [2] b = 0.3t + 0.8b [3] t + b = 8400 t = 8400 b b = 0.3t + 0.8b b 0.8b = 0.3t 0.2b = 0.3t 0.2b 0.3t = 0.2 0.2 b = 1.5t
[4]
[5]
564
t = 8400 b t = 8400 1.5t t + 1.5t = 8400 2.5t = 8400 2.5t 8400 = 2.5 2.5 t = 3360 b = 1.5t b = 1.5 3360 = 5040 In the long term, 3360 commuters will travel by train and 5040 will travel by bus.
Substitute t into equation [5] and solve for b. Answer the question.
Transition matrices
Transition matrices are another technique for solving some Markov chain problems. Transition matrices are specifically used for problems where you are only interested in the probability of the final outcome (for example, the probability that a person goes to the gym on the seventh day). Tree diagrams must still be used to solve problems that take into account the number of different ways of reaching the final outcome (e.g. the probability that a person goes to the gym 4out of the next 7 days). Consider again the previous scenario, from page 560, of the probability of using the gym or attending an aerobics class.
Day 1 Gym 0.8 0.2 0.7 0.3 Day 2 Gym Aerobics Gym Aerobics
Aerobics
This can also be described in a transition probability table: Gym today Gym tomorrow Aerobics tomorrow 0.8 0.2 Aerobics today 0.7 0.3 or Aerobics tomorrow Gym tomorrow Aerobics today 0.3 0.7 Gym today 0.2 0.8
Note: Each column should add up to one, as do the pairs of branches in the given tree diagram. A transition matrix can be used to simplify calculations involving Markov chains. As its name suggests, the matrix assists in the calculation of the transition from one state to the next. We can convert the above transition probability tables into a transition matrix, T, as shown below. A1 G1 G1 A1 G 0.8 0.7 A 0.3 0.2 T = 2 or T = 2 A 2 0.2 0.3 G 2 0.7 0.8
565
The proportion of the population that use the gym or attend the aerobics class is called the state of the system, S. It can either relate to specific populations, or the probabilities associated with the different outcomes. For our example, the initial system, S0 is given by: n( using the gym on day 1) 150 n(doing aerobics on day 1) 50 = or = n day 1) 50 n day 1) 150 n(doing aerobics on n( using the gym on n(G 0 ) n( A 0 ) At any time, the state is represented by the column matrix or , where n(G) is n(A 0 ) n(G 0 ) the number of gym users and n(A) is the number of aerobics participants. There are two different transition and initial state matrices for this problem, so which one should we choose to use? It does not matter which one we choose, as long as the correct pairing of T and S0 is selected. 150 0.8 0.7 For example, if we choose T = . , S0 must be 50 0.2 0.3 The element in the 1st row 1st column of S0 must represent the initial value for the element in the 1st row, 1st column of the transition matrix.
These elements must match (i.e. the probability about gym users matches with the initial number of gym users).
Similarly, these elements must match (i.e. the probability about aerobics participants matches with the initial number of aerobics participants).
n(G1 ) 0.8 0.7 150 Hence, the state after 1 day, S1 is = n( A1 ) 0.2 0.3 50 0.8 150 + 0.7 50 = 0.2 150 + 0.3 50 155 = 45
Note: these are the same values as we calculated earlier. From the above calculation, we can see that S1 = T S0. If the conditional probabilities remain the same, then a similar equation will express the transition from any particular state to the next.
566
Therefore, in general, Sn + 1 = T Sn Also, as, S1 = T S0 and, S2 = T S1, then, S2 = T T S0 = T2 S0 and, S3 = T T T S0 = T3 S0 In general, Sn = Tn S0 To find the long-term behaviour, or steady state, choose n to be a large number, for example n= 50, and find S50. T can be written from the generalised transition probability table below: Event A1 Event A2 Event A2 Pr(A2 | A1) Pr(A2 | A1) Event A1 Pr(A2 | A1) Pr(A2 | A1)
Worked Example 13
Using the above data for attending the gym or aerobics class, find: a the proportion of people attending the gym and aerobics class on the 5th day b the number of people attending the gym or aerobics class in the long term.
Think a
1
Write
a T=
Write down a suitable initial state matrix. In this case, it is the initial numbers of people attending the gym and aerobics class. Identify which state matrix is required. On a Calculator page, complete the entry lines as: 0.8 0.7 t 0.2 0.3 150 s0 50 Press ENTER after each entry.
150 S0 = 50
3 4
567
Calculate the proportion of people attending the gym or aerobics on the 5th day. That is, S4 = T4 S0.
Answer the question (rounding to the nearest whole number). Repeat as above using the CAS calculator to find the long-term proportion. Choose n = 50. S50 = T50 S0
b
On the 5th day, there will be 156 people at the gym and 44 people attending the aerobics class.
150 50
In the long-term, 156 people attend the gym and 44 people go to aerobics class.
568
Worked Example 14
The chance of Jos netball team winning a given game depends on how the team performs in the previous game. If her team wins, then the chance that it will win the next game is 0.75. If her team loses, there is only a 0.4 chance that they will win the next match. Given the team wins their first match, find the probability, that: a they win two out of their first three games b they win the 7th game they play, correct to 4 decimal places.
Think a
1
Write
Draw a tree diagram labelling each branch and place the appropriate probability along the relevant branch. List the outcomes.
a 0.75 0.25
Won game 1
Select the appropriate outcomes for the required probability. Calculate the probabilities by multiplying along the branches. Write down the transition matrix, T.
Pr(win 2 out of 3 games) = Pr(WWL) + Pr(WLW) Pr(win 2 out of 3 games) = 0.75 0.25 + 0.25 0.4 = 0.1875 + 0.1 = 0.2875
b
Write down a suitable initial state matrix, S0. As the value of the 1st row, 1st column of T is the probability associated with winning consecutive games, the first element of S0 will be the probability that the team has won. We know for certain that Jos team won the first match, so the probability must be 1. Therefore, the probability of the second element must be 0. Identify which state matrix is required.
Pr( Jos team wins 1st game) S0 = Pr( Jos team loses 1st game) 1 S0 = 0
569
On a Calculator page, complete the entry lines as: 0.75 0.4 t 0.25 0.6 1 s0 0 t 6 s0 Press ENTER after each entry.
Pr(winning the 7th game) = T6 S0 0.75 0.4 1 = 0.25 0.6 0 0.616 092 = 0.383 908
6
As the answer required is the probability of winning the 7th game, we need the first element of the state matrix. Round the answer to 4 decimal places.
REMEMBER
1. A Markov chain is a sequence of repetitions of an experiment in which: (a) the probability of a particular outcome in an experiment is conditional only on the result of the outcome immediately before it (b) the conditional probabilities of each outcome in a particular experiment are the same every single time. 2. A two-state Markov chain is where there are only two possible outcomes for each experiment. 3. Problems involving two-state Markov chains can be solved using: (a) tree diagrams where the probabilities are multiplied along the branches (b) recurrence relationships Pr( A 2 | A1 ) Pr( A 2 | A1 ) (c) transition matrices where T = , Pr( A 2 | A1 ) Pr( A 2 | A1 ) S0 = the initial state, n( A1 )0 n( A 2 ) 0 Pr ( A ) 1 0 or Pr ( A 2 )0
Sn = Tn S0 To find the long-term proportion or steady state, let n = a large number, relative to the problem, and solve for Sn.
570
Exercise
11C
571
7 WE12 Commuters travelling into the centre of Trenchtown use either the bus or train. Research has shown that each month 30% of those using the bus switch to train travel and 60% of those using the train revert to bus travel. If, at the beginning of January, 5600 people were using the bus and 4900 were using the train to get into the city, calculate: a the number of people using the train at the beginning of May b the number of people using the bus and train in the long term. 8 WE13 Residents of Trenchtown purchase their petrol from either Petes Premium Petrol or Slick Sams Servo. Research has shown that each month 10% of Petes customers switch to Slick Sams Servo and 20% of Sams customers switch to Petes Premium Petrol. If, at the beginning of June, 2800 customers purchased their petrol from Pete and 3100 customers purchased their petrol from Sam, calculate: a the number of people purchasing petrol from Pete at the beginning of October b the number of people purchasing petrol from Pete and Sam in the long term. 9 A leisure centre offers aerobics classes and has a gym. Records show that 10% of the members who use the gym on a particular day will participate in an aerobics class the next day, and 70% of the members who participate in an aerobics class on a particular day will use the gym the next day. It is also known that 300 members use the leisure centre each day and they all participate in aerobics classes or use the gym, but not both. On a particular day 200 members use the gym and 100 members attend an aerobics class. a In the long term, how many people will use the gym? b In the long term, how many people will attend an aerobics class? 10 MC Records show that if a local football team make the top eight in a particular year, the chance that they make the top eight in the following year is 70%. If they dont make the top eight in a particular year, the chance that they make the top eight in the following year is 40%. The tree diagram that best represents this situation is: A B 0.3 Make 0.7 Make
Make top 8 , Don t make top 8 0.7 0.4 0.6 0.7 0.3 , Don t make top 8 0.4 0.6 0.6 0.4 , Don t make top 8 0.3 0.7 top 8 , Don t make top 8 Make top 8 , Don t make top 8 0.3 0.6 0.4 0.4 0.6 , Don t make top 8 0.7 0.3 top 8 , Don t make top 8
Make top 8 , Don t make top 8 Make top 8 , Don t make top 8 Make top 8 , Don t make top 8 Make top 8 , Don t make top 8 Make top 8 , Don t make top 8
Make top 8 , Don t make top 8 Make top 8 , Don t make top 8 Make top 8 , Don t make top 8
C
Make top 8
D
Make top 8
E
Make top 8
572
11 Miya prefers to shop at either Southland or Chadstone each weekend. The place she shops at depends only on where she shopped the previous time. If she visited Southland one weekend, the next weekend she goes shopping, the probability of her returning to Southland is 1 . The
4
transition matrix for the probabilities of Miya visiting either Chadstone or Southland given 1 2 the shopping centre she visited the weekend before is 4 5 . 3 3 4 5 a If Miya shops at Chadstone one weekend, what is the probability she shops at Southland the following weekend? b Miya does visit Chadstone on a particular weekend. What is the probability, correct to 3 decimal places, that she will be at Chadstone again in four weekends time? c In the long term, what proportion of weekends, correct to 3 decimal places, does Miya spend at Chadstone?
eBook plus
Digital doc
WorkSHEET 11.2
12 We 14 The chance of Paul hitting a bullseye in darts is dependent on the success of his previous throw. If he hits a bullseye, then the chance that his next throw will also be a bullseye is 0.65. If he misses, though, there is only a 0.15 chance that he will get a bullseye on his next throw. Given that Pauls first throw is a bullseye, find the probability, correct to 4 decimal places, that: a he hits the bullseye on his next two throws, but misses on the third b on his tenth throw, he gets a bullseye.
11d
x Pr(X = x)
In chapter 10 we saw that the expected value, E(X) was defined as E( X ) = x Pr( X = x ). Hence, the expected value for the above table is: E( X ) = x Pr( X = x ). = 0 0.057 65 + 1 0.197 65 + 2 0.296 48 + 3 0.254 12 + 4 0.136 14 + 5 0.046 68 + 6 0.010 00 + 7 0.001 22 + 8 0.000 07 = 0 + 0.197 65 + 0.592 96 + 0.762 36 + 0.544 56 + 0.233 400 + 0.060 00 + 0.008 54 + 0.000 56 = 2.4 The variance was defined by the rule Var(X) = E(X2) [E(X)]2. Hence, the variance for the above table is: Var(X) = E(X2) [E(X)]2 = 02 0.057 65 + 12 0.197 65 + 22 0.296 48 + 32 0.254 12 + 42 0.136 14 + 52 0.046 68 + 62 0.010 00 + 72 0.001 22 + 82 0.000 07 (2.4)2 = 0 + 0.197 65 + 1.185 92 + 2.287 08 + 2.178 24 + 1.167 00 + 0.360 00 + 0.059 78 + 0.004 48 (2.4)2 = 7.440 15 (2.4)2 = 1.68
573
Chapter 11
The standard deviation was defined by the rule SD( X ) = Var ( X ). Hence the standard deviation for the above table is: SD( X ) = Var ( X ) = 1.68 = 1.30 Since the above method for obtaining the expected value, variance and the standard deviation is tedious and time consuming, a quicker method has been developed to calculate these terms. It can be shown that if X Bi(n, p) then: E ( X ) = np Var ( X ) = npq SD( X ) = npq To check that these agree with the previous example, we will substitute the values into the given rules. When X Bi(8, 0.3), we obtain the following. The expected value: E(X) = np = 8 0.3 = 2.4 The variance: Var(X) = npq = 8 0.3 0.7 = 1.68 The standard deviation: SD( X ) = npq = 1.68 = 1.30 As can be seen, these values correspond to those obtained earlier. A great deal of time is saved using these rules and the margin for making mistakes is reduced. Hence, if X is a random variable and X Bi(n, p) then: E(X) = np Var(X) = npq Note: The distribution must be binomial for these rules to apply.
Worked Example 15
SD( X ) = npq
The random variable X follows a binomial distribution such that X Bi(40, 0.25). Determine the: a expected value b variance and standard deviation.
Think a
1 2 3 4
Write
Write the rule for the expected value. List the values for n and p. Substitute the values into the rule. Evaluate. Write the rule for the variance. Write the values for n, p and q. Substitute the values into the rule. Evaluate. Write the rule for the standard deviation. Substitute the value obtained for the variance and take the square root. Evaluate.
a E(X) = np
1 2 3 4 5
n = 10, p = 0.25, q = 0.75 Var(X) = 40 0.25 0.75 = 7.5 SD(X) = npq = 7.5 = 2.74
6 7
574
Worked Example 16
A fair die is rolled 15 times. Find: a the expected number of 3s rolled b the probability of obtaining more than the expected number of 3s.
Think a
1
Write
Write the rule for the expected value. List the values for n and p. Substitute the values into the rule. Evaluate. State the probability distribution.
a E(X) = np
2 3 4
n = 15, p =
1 6
E(X) = 15 1 6 = 2.5
b X ~ Bi(n, p)
1 X ~ Bi 15, 6 Pr(X > 2.5) = Pr(X 3) = 1 Pr(X < 3) = 1 [Pr(X = 0) + Pr(X = 1) + Pr(X = 2)]
14 2 13 0 15 1 1 5 1 5 1 5 = 1 15 C0 + 15C1 + 15C2 6 6 6 6 6 6
Write what is required. Note: Since X represents the number of 3s, X can have only whole number values. Write the rule for the binomial probability distribution. Then substitute the values of n, p and q into the rule. Evaluate and round the answer to 4 decimal places.
= 1 (0.064 905 471 5 + 0.194 716 414 6 + 0.272 602 980 4) = 1 0.532 224 866 5 = 0.467 775 133 5 0.4678 Pr(X > 2.5) = Pr(X 3) = binomCdf(15, 1 , 3, 15) = 0.4678
6
Worked Example 17
A binomial random variable has an expected value of 14.4 and a variance of 8.64. Find: a the probability of success, p b the number of trials, n.
Think a
1
Write
Write what is known and what is required. Substitute the value of np into the variance equation.
a E(X) = 14.4
575
3 4 5
Transpose the equation to make q the subject. Evaluate. Solve for p using the relationship q = 1 p. Write what is known and what is required. Substitute the values into the equation. Transpose the equation to make n the subject.
q=
8.64 14.4
1 2
n=?
where p = 0.4
Worked example 18
eBook plus
A new test designed to assess the reading ability of students entering high school Tutorial showed that 10% of the students displayed a reading level that was inadequate to int-0581 cope with high school. Worked example 18 a If 400 students are selected at random, find the expected number of students whose reading level is inadequate to cope with high school. b Determine the standard deviation of students whose reading level is inadequate to cope with high school and hence calculate 2. c Discuss the results obtained in part b.
Think a
1 2 3 4 5
WriTe
Write the rule for the expected value. Write the values for n and p. Substitute the values into the rule. Evaluate. Interpret the answer. Write the rule for the variance. Write the values for n, p and q. Substitute the values into the rule. Evaluate. Write the rule for the standard deviation. Substitute the value obtained for the variance and take the square root. Evaluate. Calculate 2.
a E(X) = np
n = 400, p = 0.1 E(X) = 400 0.1 = 40 It is expected that 40 students will have a reading level that is inadequate to cope with high school.
b Var(X) = npq
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8
2 = 40 2 6 = 28
576
Calculate + 2.
+ 2 = 40 + 2 6 = 52
There is a probability of 0.95 that between 28 to 52 students (inclusive) will have a reading level that is inadequate to cope with high school.
Interpret the results obtained in part b. Note: Recall that for many random variables, approximately 0.95 of the probability distribution lies within two standard deviations of the mean.
rememBer
If X is a random variable and X Bi(n, p) then: E(X) = np Var(X) = npq where q = 1 p SD(X) = npq exerCiSe
11d
eBook plus
Digital doc
Spreadsheet 003
Binomial distribution
3 We15b Determine the standard deviation if: a n = 10 and p = 0.2 b n = 30 and p = 0.5 c n = 50 and p = 0.7
d n = 72 and p =
2 5
4 A fair coin is tossed 10 times. Find: a the expected number of heads b the variance for the number of heads c the standard deviation for the number of heads. 5 A card is selected at random from a standard playing pack of 52 and then replaced. This procedure is completed 20 times. Find: a the expected number of picture cards b the variance for the number of picture cards c the standard deviation for the number of picture cards. 6 Six out of every 10 cars manufactured are white. Twenty cars are randomly selected. Find: a the expected number of white cars b the variance for the number of white cars c the standard deviation for the number of white cars.
577
Chapter 11
7 WE16 A fair die is rolled 10 times. Find: a the expected number of 2s rolled b the probability of obtaining more than the expected number of 2s. 8 A fair die is rolled 15 times. Find: a the expected number of prime values b the probability of obtaining more than the expected number of prime values. 9 A mathematics exam contains 27 multiple-choice questions, each with 5 possible answers. Find: a the expected number of correct answers if a student guessed each question b the probability of obtaining more than the expected number of correct answers. 10 A new drug that is being trialled has a success rate of 35%. Of the next 80 patients who trial the drug, find: a the expected number of patients who will be cured b the probability that more than the expected number of patients will be cured. 11 Eighty per cent of rabbits that contract a certain disease will die. If a group of 120 rabbits contract the disease, how many would you expect to: a die? b live?
12 WE17 A binomial random variable has a mean of 10 and a variance of 5. Find: a the probability of success, p b the number of trials, n. 13 A binomial random variable has a mean of 12 and a variance of 3. Find: a the probability of success, p b the number of trials, n.
14 X is a binomial random variable with a mean of 9 and a variance of 6. Find: a the probability of success, p b the number of trials, n c Pr(X = 10). 15 If X is a binomial random variable with E(X) = 3 and Var(X) = 2.4, find: a the probability of success, p b the number of trials, n c Pr(X = 10) d Pr(X 2). 16 MC The expected number of heads in 20 tosses of a fair coin is: A
1 2
B 5
C 10
D 15
E 20
17 MC Jenny is a billiards player who knows from experience that 7 out of every 10 shots she plays will result in a ball being potted. If she has 40 shots, the number of balls she expects to pot is: A 7 B 14 c 21 d 25 e 28 18 MC The variance of the number of balls that Jenny pots from her 40 shots in question 17 is: A 2.898 B 7.3 c 8.4 d 22.2
e 28
19 MC Eighty per cent of children are immunised against a certain disease. A sample of 200 children is taken. The mean and variance of the number of immunised children is: A 80 and 5.66 respectively B 80 and 32 respectively C 100 and 50 respectively d 160 and 5.66 respectively E 160 and 32 respectively 20 MC A binomial random variable has a mean of 10 and a variance of 6. The values of n and p respectively are: A 5 and 2 5 B 5 and 3 5 C 20 and 3 5 D 25 and 2 5 E 25 and
3 5
578
21 MC A Bernoulli trial has a probability of success, p. If 5 trials are conducted, the probability of three successes is: A p3q2 B p2q3 C 10p2q3 D 10p3(1 p)2 E p3 22 A binomial experiment is completed 20 times, with the expected number of successes being 16. Find: a the probability of success, p b the variance c the standard deviation. 23 A multiple-choice test has 20 questions with five different choices of answer for each question. If the answers to each question are guessed, find: a the probability of getting 50% of the questions correct b the probability of getting at least three correct. 24 Four per cent of pens made at a certain factory do not work. If pens are sold in boxes of 25, find the probability that a box contains more than the expected number of faulty pens. 25 A biased coin is tossed 10 times. Let X be the random variable representing the number of tails obtained. If X has an expectation of 3, find: a the probability of obtaining exactly two tails b the probability of obtaining no more than two tails. 26 Eighty per cent of Melbourne households have DVD players. A random sample of 500 households is taken. How many would you expect to have DVD players?
27 The executive committee of a certain company contains 15 members. Find the probability that more females than males will hold positions if: a males and females are equally likely to fill any position b females have a 55% chance of holding any position c females have a 45% chance of holding any position. 28 A statistician estimates the probability that a spectator at a Carlton versus Collingwood AFL match barracks for Carlton is 1 . At an AFL grand final between these two teams there 2 are 10000 spectators. Find: a the expected number of Carlton supporters b the variance of the number of Carlton supporters c the standard deviation of the number of Carlton supporters. Thirty children are given five different yoghurts to try. The yoghurts are marked A to E, and each child has to select his or her preferred yoghurt. Each child is equally likely to select any brand. The company running the tests manufactures yoghurt B. a How many children would the company expect to pick yoghurt B? b The tests showed that half of the children selected yoghurt B as their favourite. What does this tell the company manufacturing this product?
29
30 The proportion of defective fuses made by a certain company is 0.02. A sample of 30 fuses is taken for quality control inspection. a Find the probability that there are no defective fuses in the sample. b Find the probability that there is only one defective fuse in the sample. c How many defective fuses would you expect in the sample? d The hardware chain that sells the fuses will accept the latest batch for sale only if, upon inspection, there is at most one defective fuse in the sample of 30. What is the probability that they accept the batch? e Ten quality control inspections are conducted monthly for the hardware chain. Find the probability that all of these inspections will result in acceptable batches.
579
eBook plus
Digital doc
Investigation
Winning at racquetball!
31 We18 A new test designed to assess the reading ability of students entering high school showed that 10% of the students displayed a reading level that was inadequate to cope with high school. a If 1600 students are selected at random, find the expected number of students whose reading level is inadequate to cope with high school. b Determine the standard deviation of students whose reading level is inadequate to cope with high school, and hence calculate 2. c Discuss the results obtained in part b. 32 The success rate of a new drug that is being trialled is 70%. a If 1800 patients are selected at random, find the expected number of patients cured. b Determine the standard deviation of patients cured, and hence calculate 2. c Discuss the results obtained in part b.
580
Summary
The binomial distribution
The binomial distribution is an example of a discrete probability distribution. The binomial distribution may be referred to as a Bernoulli distribution, and the trials conducted are known as Bernoulli trials. For a sequence to be defined as a Bernoulli sequence, each of the following characteristics must be satisfied. 1. n independent trials must be conducted. 2. Only two possible outcomes must exist for each trial, that is, success (p) and failure (q). 3. The probability of success, p, is fixed for each trial. If X represents a random variable that has a binomial distribution, then it can be expressed as X ~ Bi(n, p) or X ~ B(n, p). This means that X follows a binomial distribution with parameters n (the number of trials) and p (the probability of success). If X is a binomial random variable its probability is defined as: . .n Pr(X = x) = nCxpxqn x where x = 0, 1, 2, .
The effects of n and p on binomial distribution graphs
The parameters n and p affect the binomial probability distribution curve as follows. 1. If p < 0.5, the graph is positively skewed. 2. If p = 0.5, the graph is symmetrical or is a normal distribution curve. 3. If p > 0.5, the graph is negatively skewed. 4. When n is large and p = 0.5, the interval between the vertical columns decreases and the graph approximates a smooth hump or bell shape.
Problems involving the binomial distribution for multiple probabilities
When solving problems dealing with the binomial distribution for multiple probabilities, always: 1. define the distribution 2. write what is required 3. write the rule for the binomial probability distribution 4. substitute the values into the given rule and evaluate.
Markov chains and transition matrices
A Markov chain is a sequence of repetitions of an experiment in which: 1. The probability of a particular outcome in an experiment is conditional only on the result of the outcome immediately before it. 2. The conditional probabilities of each outcome in a particular experiment are the same every single time. A two-state Markov chain is where there are only two possible outcomes for each experiment. Problems involving two-state Markov chains can be solved using: 1. tree diagrams where the probabilities are multiplied along the branches 2. recurrence relationships Pr( A 2 | A1 ) Pr( A 2 | A1 ) 3. transition matrices where T = , Pr( A 2 | A1 ) Pr( A 2 | A1 ) n( A ) 1 0 S0 = the initial state, n( A 2 ) 0 Pr ( A ) 1 0 or Pr ( A 2 )0
Sn = Tn S0 To find the long-term proportion or steady state, let n = a large number, relative to the problem, and solve forSn.
581
If X is a random variable and X Bi(n, p) then: E(X) = np Var(X) = npq SD( X ) = npq This applies only to a binomial distribution.
582
chapter review
Short answer
1 Zoe tosses a fair coin 5 times. Calculate: a the probability of obtaining 3 heads b the probability of obtaining at least 1 head c the probability of obtaining 4 heads then a tail. 2 Matt is a dedicated football player and knows that his chance of scoring a goal on any one kick is 0.9. If he has three shots at goal in a row, calculate the probability that: a he scores two goals b all of his shots miss c after missing the first, he scores a goal on each of his next two shots. 3 Nisha is pulling marbles out of a bag containing 3 green and 9 red ones. After each selection she replaces the marble. In total she selects four marbles. What is the probability she selects: a two red marbles? b two red marbles, given that at least one red marble was selected? 4 One out of three people read the Bugle newspaper, while one out of five read the Headline. If four people are sampled, what is the probability that: a one of them reads the Headline? b at least three of them read the Bugle? 5 A barrel contains 100 balls, some of which are rainbow-coloured. Four balls are randomly selected from the barrel, with replacement (that is, a ball is selected, its colour noted, and the ball replaced before the next ball is selected). Let p be the proportion of rainbow-coloured balls in the barrel. a Write down an expression for the probability that exactly one of the four balls selected is rainbow-coloured. b Use calculus to find the exact value of p for which this probability will be a maximum.
Exam tip Only 44% of students scored the mark for part a, and 75% of students received 0/2 for part b. Students who used q in part a failed to define it. In part b, sometimes the instruction to use calculus was not followed.
[Assessment report Mathematical Methods 1 2004]
four customers enter the bookstore, what is the probability that less than two of these customers buy a crime novel?
Exam tip This was not well answered. Some students put their probability expressions equal to one (for example) and tried to solve for p. A method mark was awarded for indicating that the derivative of the probability expression was to be found, set to zero, and solved for p. Some students simply wrote down an answer (correct or otherwise) and failed to obtain full marks, as the question required working to be shown.
[Assessment report 1 2004 VCAA]
7 A cafe prepares its macchiatos with either skinny or regular milk. It is known that 20% of customers who have a regular macchiato on a particular day will have a skinny macchiato the next day. Also, 70% of customers who have a skinny macchiato on a particular day will have a regular macchiato the next day. Given a particular customer has a skinny macchiato on Monday, calculate the probability: a they had a regular macchiato on Tuesday and a skinny macchiato on Wednesday b they had a skinny macchiato on Wednesday. 8 Hilary loves going to the movies every Friday night, and prefers either comedy or action films. If she watches a comedy one week, the probability that she sees a comedy the following week is 0.1. If she sees an action movie on a particular Friday, there is a probability of 0.4 that she will see an action movie the following Friday. Given that Hilary saw a comedy on the first Friday in March, calculate the probability: a she sees an action film on the third Friday of the month b she saw a comedy on the 2nd Friday, given that she saw an action film on the third Friday of the month. 9 Maria and Patrick love to play a game of tennis each week. The probability of Maria beating Patrick if she wins the previous week is 0.7; however, if she loses a match, the chance of her beating him the following week is only 0.2. Given that Maria beats Patrick in their first match of the year, calculate the probability that she will beat him exactly one more time in the next three weeks.
[ VCAA 2004]
6 Statistics gathered at a local bookstore have found that 50% of customers purchase crime novels. If
583
10 Calculate: i the mean ii the variance for the binomial random variables with n and p given by: a n = 100 and p = 0.5 b n = 50 and p = 0.8. 11 A binomial random variable has a mean of 10 and variance of 8. Calculate: a the probability of success, p b the number of trials, n. 12 A mathematics exam contains 40 multiple-choice questions, each with 5 possible answers. Calculate: a the expected number of correct answers if a student guessed each question b the variance of the number of correct answers if a student guessed each question.
Multiple choice
6 If the same die from question 5 is rolled 10 times, the probability of obtaining at least 8 even numbers is: A 0.0107 B 0.0390 C 0.0547 D 0.9453 E 0.9893 7 The probability of Sam beating Abby in a game of cards is 0.36. Abby and Sam decide to play a game every day for n days. What is the fewest number of games they need to play to ensure the probability of Sam winning at least once is greater than 0.85? A 3 B 4 C 5 D 6 E 7 8 One in every 50 apples sold at Grubby Grannys Greengrocers has worms in it. If I buy a box of 100 apples, the probability of at least three apples containing worms is: A 0.3233 B 0.3781 C 0.5 D 0.6219 E 0.6867 9 X is a random variable, binomially distributed with n = 20 and p = 3 . Pr(X 1) is: 7 A 1 D
1 Three out of every 7 students ride bikes to school. Twenty students are randomly selected. The probability that 8 of these rode to school today is: A 0.0951 B 0.1426 C 0.1738 D 0.3178 E 0.4916 2 An unbiased 8-sided die is rolled 12 times. The probability of obtaining three results greater than 5 is: A 0.1135 B 0.1688 C 0.2188 D 0.2279 E 0.2824 3 Which of the following does not represent a Bernoulli sequence? A Rolling a die 10 times and recording the number of 5s B Rolling a die 50 times and recording the results C Spinning a 7-sided spinner and recording the number of 4s obtained D Surveying 100 people and asking them if they eat Superflakes cereal E Drawing a card with replacement and recording the number of red cards obtained 4 The probability that the temperature in Melbourne will rise above 25 C on any given summer day, independent of any other summer day, is 0.65. The probability that 3 days in a week reach in excess of 25 C is: A 0.653 B 3 0.354 7 C 7 0.653 0.44 E 0.653 0.354 D 35 0.653 0.354
(4 7)
20
20
B 1 E
(3 7)
20
20
C 20
4 (3 7 )( 7 )
19
(3 7)
(4 7)
10 Claires position in the netball team is goal shooter. The probability of her shooting a goal is 67%. If she has 15 attempts at scoring, the probability she will score at least 7 goals is: A 15C7 (0.67)7(0.33)8 B 15C7 (0.33)7(0.67)8 + 15C8 (0.33)8(0.67)7 + + (0.33)15 C 15C8 (0.67)8(0.33)7 + 15C9 (0.67)9(0.33)6 + + (0.67)15 D 15C7 (0.67)7(0.33)8 + 15C8 (0.67)8(0.33)7 + + (0.67)15 E (0.33)15 + 15C1 (0.67)(0.33)14 + + 15C7 (0.67)7(0.33)8 11 The proportion of patients that suffer a violent reaction from a new drug being trialled is k. If 60 patients trial the drug, the probability that one-fifth of the patients have a violent reaction is: A 60C5 (1 k)5(k)55 B 60C12 (k)12 C 60C5 (k)5(1 k)55 D 60C12 (1 k)12(k)48 E 60C12 (k)12(1 k)48 12 Theo passes three sets of traffic lights on his way to school each morning. The lights at each intersection operate independently of each other. The probability of him having to stop for a red light is 2 and the probability of passing through 3 the intersection without stopping is 1 . If Theo 3
5 A fair die is rolled 10 times. The probability of obtaining 4 even numbers is: A 0.0004 B 0.2051 C 0.0009 D 0.7949 E 0.2461
584
encountered a red light at least once during a particular trip to school, what is the probability that he had to stop at exactly two intersections? A
2 13
A 0.4225 D 0.6620
B 0.4820 E 0.6500
C 0.0595
6 19
C 3
5
6 13
2 9
13 Consider a Markov chain where the nth state is given by Sn = Tn S0. Which one of the following could represent the transition matrix, T, and the initial state matrix, S0, respectively? 0.1 0.9 1 A and 0.6 0.4 0 0.6 0.1 0.3 B and 0.4 0.9 0.7 15 0.6 0.1 C and 30 0.4 0.9 1 0.25 0.75 D and 0 0.4 0.6 0.25 0.45 E and 0.85 0.65 10 20
15 Two fair coins are tossed simultaneously 60 times. The number of times that they both show heads is expected to be: A 10 B 15 C 20 d 30 E 45 16 The variance in the number of heads obtained from 50 tosses of a fair coin is: A
1 50
17 The expected number of heads in 50 tosses of a fair coin is: A 18 A variance of 1.35 occurs when: A n = 20 and p = 0.6 B n = 15 and p = 0.9 C n = 25 and p = 0.4 D n = 20 and p = 1 4 E n = 50 and p = 0.3 19 The number of defective computer parts in a box of computer parts ready for sale is a random variable with a binomial distribution with mean 10 and standard deviation 3. If a computer part is drawn at random from the box, the probability that it is defective is: A 0.1 B 0.3 C 0.5 D 0.7 E 0.9
Exam tip Only 40% of students answered this question correctly.
[Assessment report 1 2002]
2 25
1 4
25 2
E 3.53
1 2
B 6.25 C 10 d 2.5E 25
14 Kelly has developed a method for predicting whether or not the surf will be good on a particular day. If it is good today, there is an 83% chance it will be good tomorrow. If it is poor today, there is a 65% chance it will be poor tomorrow. The probability that the surf will be poor on Thursday given it was poor on Tuesday is:
[ VCAA 2002]
Extended response
1 Speedy Saverios Pizza House claims to cook and deliver 90% of pizzas within 15minutes of the order being placed. If your pizza is not delivered within this time, it is free. On one busy Saturday night, Saverio has to make 150 deliveries. a How many deliveries are expected to be made within 15 minutes of placing the order? b What is the probability of receiving a free pizza on this night? c If Saverio loses an average of $4 for every late delivery, how much would he expect to lose on late deliveries this night? 2 Ten per cent of all Olympic athletes are tested for drugs at the conclusion of their event. One per cent of all athletes use performance enhancing drugs. Of the 1000 Olympic wrestlers competing from all over the world, Australia sends 10. Find: a the expected number of Australian wrestlers who are tested for drugs b the probability that half the Australian wrestlers are tested for drugs c the probability that at least two Australian wrestlers are tested for drugs d the expected number of drug users among all wrestlers.
585
3 Five per cent of watches made at a certain factory are defective. Watches are sold to retailers in boxes of 20. Find: a the expected number of defective watches in each box b the probability that a box contains more than the expected number of defective watches per box c the probability of a bad batch, if a bad batch entails more than a quarter of the box being defective. 4 Aiko is a keen basketball player and knows that her chance of scoring a goal on any one throw is 0.65. a If Aiko takes 6 shots for a goal, find the probability, correct to 4 decimal places, that she: i misses each time ii scores a goal at least three times iii scores a goal five times, given that she scored a goal at least three times. b Find the number of throws Aiko would need to ensure a probability of more than 0.9 of scoring at least one goal. 5 Sixty-eight percent of all scheduled trains through Westbourne station arrive on time. If 20 trains go through the station every day, calculate the probability, correct to 4 decimal places, that: a no more than 10 trains are on time b at least 12 trains are on time c at least 12 trains are on time for 9 out of the next 10 days. 6 The success rate of a new drug being trialled is 60%. a If 2400 patients are selected at random, find the expected number of patients cured. b Determine the standard deviation of patients cured and hence calculate 2. c Interpret the results found in part b. 7 Phil is running a stall at the local Primary School Fair involving lucky dips. It costs $2 to have a go, and contained in a large box are 80 lucky dips from which to choose. Phil claims that one in 5 lucky dips contains a prize. By the end of the day, all 80 have been sold. Calculate the probability, correct to 4 decimal places, that: a the first four people to select a lucky dip dont win a prize, but the next two do b there are at least 10 winners c there are no more than 18 prize winners, given that at least 10 people won a prize. 8 Sharelle is the goal shooter for her netball team. During her matches, she has many attempts at scoring a goal. Assume each attempt at scoring a goal is independent of any other attempt. In the long term, her scoring rate has been shown to be 80% (that is, 8 out of 10 attempts to score a goal are successful). a i What is the probability, correct to 4 decimal places, that her first 8 attempts at scoring a goal in a match are successful? ii What is the probability, correct to 4 decimal places, that exactly 6 of her first 8 attempts at scoring a goal in a match are successful? iii What is the probability, correct to 3 decimal places, that her first 4 attempts at scoring a goal are successful, given that exactly 6 of her first 8 attempts at scoring a goal in a match are successful? Assume instead that the success of an attempt to score a goal depends only on the success or otherwise of her previous attempt at scoring a goal. If an attempt at scoring a goal in a match is successful, then the probability that her next attempt at scoring a goal in the match is successful is 0.84. However, if an attempt at scoring a goal in a match is unsuccessful, then the probability that her next attempt at scoring a goal in the match is successful is 0.64. Her first attempt at scoring a goal in a match is successful. b i What is the probability, correct to 4 decimal places, that her next 7 attempts at scoring a goal in the match will be successful? ii What is the probability, correct to 4 decimal places, that exactly 2 of her next 3 attempts at scoring a goal in the match will be successful? [ VCAA 2008] 9 Every afternoon Anna either goes for a run or a walk. If she goes for a walk one afternoon, the probability that she goes for a run the next is 0.45, and if she decides to run one afternoon, then the probability of her going for a walk the next afternoon is 0.8. On Wednesday, Anna decides to go for a walk around the park. a What is the probability that she goes for a run on each of the next three afternoons? b What is the probability, correct to 4 decimal places, that over the next three afternoons, she goes for a run at least once?
586
c What is the probability, correct to 4 decimal places, that on the following Wednesday Anna will decide to go for a run? d In the long term, on what proportion of afternoons will she choose to go for a run? 10 A small town has two restaurants Kazs Kitchen and Als Fine Dining. Records show that 30% of customers who eat at Kazs Kitchen one week will visit Als Fine Dining the next. Also, 40% of customers who eat at Als Fine Dining during the week will dine at Kazs Kitchen the following week. There are 400 members of the town who regularly dine out once a week. During the first week of July, 300 people visit Kazs Kitchen and Al has 100 customers at his restaurant. a How many customers will visit each restaurant in the first week of August? b In the long run, how many customers will Kaz and Al each get per week? 11 Two companies are competing for the mobile phone market. At the end of January, market research revealed the following patterns in the subscriptions of mobile phone users. Of the 400 Tellya customers who were interviewed, 340 were staying with Tellya and 60 were changing to Yodacall. Of the 100 Yodacall customers who were interviewed, 90 were staying with Yodacall and 10 were changing to Tellya. a Set up a pair of recurrence relationships that describes the given patterns. b What is the original state of the companies in terms of market share? c What is the state of each company at the end of the next month (February)? d What is the state, in terms of market share, of each company 4 months later (May)? e What is the state, in terms of market share, of each company 7 months later (August)? f What is the state, in terms of market share, of each company at the end of the following January? g A company will fail to be viable if its market share falls below 25%. Which, if either, of these companies will not achieve this market share in the long run?
eBook plus
Digital doc
Test Yourself
Chapter 11
Chapter 11
587
eBook plus
aCTiviTieS
Chapter opener
Digital doc
10 Quick Questions: Warm up with ten quick questions on applications of the binomial distribution. (page 537)
11A The binomial distribution
Tutorials
We 2 int-0576: Watch a worked example on indentifying the number of trials in an experiment. (page 539) We 5 int-0577: Watch a worked example on constructing a probability distribution table. (page 544)
Digital docs
Tutorial
Spreadsheet 003: Investigate the binomial distribution. (pages 548 and 551) SkillSHEET 11.1: Practise solving indicial equations. (page 550) WorkSHEET 11.1: Recognise Bernoulli sequences and calculate cumulative and non-cumulative probabilities. (page 552)
11B Problems involving the binomial distribution for multiple probabilities
WorkSHEET 11.2: Identify and perform appropriate techniques to calculate probabilities. (page 573)
11D
Tutorial
We 18 int-0581: Watch a worked example on calculating the mean, median and mode of a probability density function. (page 576)
Digital docs
Tutorials
We 8 int-0578: Watch a worked example on calculating probabilities using a CAS calculator. (page 553) We 10 int-0579: Watch a worked example on calculating probabilities using the cumulative binomial distribution. (page 556)
Digital doc
Spreadsheet 003: Investigate the binomial distribution. (page 577) Investigation: Winning at racquetball (page 580)
Chapter review
Digital doc
Test Yourself: Take the end-of-chapter test to test your progress. (page 587)
To access eBookPLUS activities, log on to www.jacplus.com.au
The binomial distribution: Consolidate your understanding of the binomial distribution. (page 559)
588
12
Continuous distributions
AREAS OF STUDY
12A Continuous random variables 12B Using a probability density function to nd probabilities of continuous random variables 12C Measures of central tendency and spread 12D Applications to problem solving 12E The normal distribution 12F The standard normal distribution 12G The inverse cumulative normal distribution
Random variables, including: the concept of discrete and continuous random variables calculation and interpretation of the expected value, variance and standard deviation of a random variable (for discrete and continuous random variables, including consideration of the connection between these) calculation and interpretation of central measures (mean, median, mode) the property that, for many random variables, approximately 95% of their probability distribution is within 2 standard deviations of the mean Continuous random variables, including: the construction of probability density functions from non-negative continuous functions of a real variable the specication of probability distributions for continuous random variables using probability density functions
calculation using technology, interpretation and use of mean (), median, mode, variance ( 2) and standard deviation of a continuous random variable standard normal distribution, N(0, 1), and transformed normal distributions, N(, 2), as examples of a probability distribution for a continuous random variable (use as an approximation to the binomial distribution is not required) the effect of variation in the value(s) of dening parameters on the graph of a given probability density function for a continuous random variable probabilities for intervals dened in terms of a random variable, including conditional probability (students should be familiar with the use of denite integrals, evaluated by hand or using technology, for a probability density function to calculate probabilities; teachers may also choose to relate this to the notion of a cumulative distribution function, although this is not required)
eBook plus
Digital doc
12A
10 Quick Questions
In previous chapters we worked with discrete random variables and the probability distributions associated with them. We will now focus on continuous random variables and an important distribution associated with them the normal distribution. Continuous random variables represent quantities that can be measured and thus may assume any value in a given range. They include such variables as time, height and weight.
Chapter 12
Continuous distributions
589
The weights of 50 Year 12 students are displayed in the table below, alongside a histogram. Weight (kg) x 40 < 50 50 < 60 60 < 70 70 < 80 80 < 90 90 < 100 Frequencies f 10 19 15 3 1 Total = 50
Number of students (f)
b a
f 20 18 16 14 12 10 8 6 4 2 0
The frequency of individual weights cannot be determined because the weights have been grouped into class intervals. This limits the information we are able to extract from the histogram. For example, to determine the number of students weighing less than 60 kg we simply add the frequency of the 40 < 50 and 50 < 60 class intervals, that is, 10 + 2 = 12 students. However, we would not be able to determine the weight of students below 75 kg as this value lies within the class interval rather than being an end point. Since the value that a continuous random variable can assume is measured in some way, the exact value cannot be obtained. Hence a weight of 60 kg, if we measure in whole numbers, is actually between 59.5 and 60.5 kg. Therefore, the probability of a continuous random variable assuming an exact value is zero. In order to determine the probability of continuous random variables, a new method must be employed. If we were to increase the size of the sample of students weights and make the class intervals very small, then the histogram would become a smooth frequency curve as shown below. A special scaled version of a smooth frequency curve is the f(x) probability density function or pdf. The scale is such that the probability of the random variable lying between certain values is given by the area between the pdf and the horizontal axis. Hence, sections such as the shaded region between x = a and x = b, as shown below right may be regarded as x 0 probabilities. The curve is positioned above the x-axis since it represents a probability distribution in which individual probabilities f(x) assume a value between 0 and 1. Hence, the probability of X, a continuous variable, falling between x = a and x = b is represented by the shaded area between a probability density function y = f (x), the x-axis and the lines x = a and x = b. The area is determined by integrating x 0 a b f (x) from x = a to x = b. Using mathematical notation, this may be summarised as Pr(a < x < b) = f ( x ) dx.
590
Continuous distributions
Probability density functions
The domain of a probability density function (pdf) is usually R, that is, the variable is continuous and can assume any real value (at least in theory). If we need our function to be non-zero over a particular interval only, say, over (a, b), then we need to specify that the function is equal to zero everywhere else. In such case, the area under the curve between x = a and x = b must be equal to one. That is, f ( x ) dx = 1.
a b
WORKED EXAMPLE 1
Sketch the graph of each of the following and state whether each function may be a probability density function (pdf).
a f (x) = b f (x) = c f (x) = THINK a
1
int-0582
Worked example 1
4 x, 1 x 2 0, elsewhere 10 x 4, 0 x 1 elsewhere 0, e
0 . 5, 1 x 1 0, elsewhere
WRITE
The graph of f (x) is a straight line with gradient 4 over the domain [1, 2]. When x = 1, y = 4 1 = 4, and when x = 2, y = 4 2 = 8. So the end points of the line are (1, 4) and (2, 8). Everywhere else, the function is zero.
y 8 4 (1, 4) (2, 8)
0
2
For a function to be a pdf, it has to be positive or zero over the entire domain. State whether this condition is satised by inspecting the graph of f (x). The total area under the graph of a pdf must be equal to one. Check whether this condition is observed by nding the area under f (x), and comment on the result. (This can be done by integration.)
A = 4 xdx xd
1
4x2 = 2 1
2 = 2x 2 1
Although the rst condition for the function to be a pdf is observed, the second one is not. State your conclusion.
Chapter 12
Continuous distributions
591
The graph of f (x) is a straight line over the domain [0, 1]. Its gradient is 10 and its y-intercept is at y = 4. When x = 0, y = 4, and when x = 1, y = 10 1 4 = 6. So the end points of the line are (0, 4) and (1, 6). Everywhere else, the function is zero.
y 6 (1, 6)
0 (0, 4)
For a function to be a pdf, it has to be positive or zero over the entire domain. State whether this condition is satised by inspecting the graph of f (x). As the rst condition is not observed, there is no need to check the area under the curve. State your conclusion. The graph of f (x) is a horizontal line through y = 0.5 over the domain [1, 1]. Everywhere else, the function is zero.
c
f (x) is not positive or zero for all x, as part of the graph is below the x-axis. f (x) does not represent a probability density function.
y (0, 0.5) 1 0 1 x
For a function to be a pdf, it has to be positive or zero over the entire domain. State whether this condition is satised by inspecting the graph of f (x). The total area under the graph of the pdf must equal 1. Check whether this condition is observed by nding the area under f (x), and comment on the result.
A = 0.5 dx
1
= 0.5 x 1 = 0.5 (1) 0.5 (1) =1 Area under the curve = 1 f (x) could be a probability density function.
Both conditions for the function to be a pdf are satised. State your conclusion.
WORKED EXAMPLE 2
Find the value of a so that the given function may be a probability density function (pdf). f: [2, 4] R, f (x) = a(12 3x)
THINK
1
WRITE
For the function to be a pdf, the area under its graph must be 1. Area is found by evaluating the denite integral with terminals being the end points of the domain. Write the appropriate statement, equating area to 1.
2 a(12 3x)dx = 1
592
a (12 3 x )dx = 1
2
Substitute the terminals in and simplify the left-hand side of the equation.
Solve for a. Sketch the graph of the resultant function and check whether f (x) 0 for all x.
y 1 0 2 (2, 1) 4 x
REMEMBER
1. If X is a continuous random variable, then the probability of it falling between certain values is given by the area under a frequency curve, known as a probability density function or pdf. 2. A pdf must be greater than or equal to zero for all values of x, and the total area under the curve must be equal to one. That is, f (x) 0 for all x, and 3. The domain of a pdf is usually R, that is, the variable is continuous and can assume any real value (at least in theory). 4. If we need our function to be non-zero over a particular interval only, say, over (a, b), then we need to specify that the function is equal to zero everywhere else. For example, 2 x, 1 x 2 f ( x) = 3 er ere 0, elsewhere 5. If a pdf is only non-zero over a particular interval (a, b), the area under the curve between x = a and x = b must be equal to one. That is, f ( x )dx = 1.
a b
f ( x)dx = 1.
Chapter 12
Continuous distributions
593
EXERCISE
12A
3x 2 , 1 x 1 d f (x) = 2 0, elsewhere
3 2 sin (x ), 2 x f f (x) = 2 0, elsewhere er ere
2 WE2 For each of the following functions, find the value of a so that the given function may be a pdf. a f: [1, 2] R, f (x) = a(2x 1) b f: [1, 1] R, f (x) = a(10 3x2) c f: [0, ] R, f (x) = e f: [0, 2] R, f (x) = a sin (x) 2 d f: [2, 3] R, f (x) = aex 2 f f: [7, 2] R, f (x) = a 2 x h f: [3, 4] R, f (x) = ax(x 1)
ax 3 4 4, 1] R, f (x) = ax 2 + a
Find the value of a, such that the function may be a probability density function. Sketch the graph of the resultant function. a, 0 x 1 f (x) = ax, 1 < x 2 0, elsewhere er ere
4 Find the value of a, such that the function may be a probability density function. Sketch the graph of the resultant function. a( x + 2), ), 1 x 0 1 f (x) = a x + 2 , 0 < x 2 2 0, elsewher er re 5 Find the value of m, such that the function may be a probability density function. Sketch the graph of the resultant function. mx 2 , 1 x 3 f (x) = m(12 x ), 3 x 4 0, elsewhere er ere
594
y
1 _ 2
(k, k)
7 8 9 10
Find the value of k such that the function may be a probability density function. Give your answer in exact form. x2 The function f: [1, n] R, f (x) = is a probability density function. Find the value of n. 4 (Give the answer in surd form.) k sin (2 x ), 0 x 0 . 5 The function f ( x ) = is a probability density function. Find er ere 0 , elsewhere the value of k. ke x , 0 x l log og e (3) The function f ( x ) = is a probability density function. Find the 0, elsewhere value of k. The diagram at right is a graph of rectangular or uniform distribution. y a Specify the probability density function of this distribution in terms of a and b. b Hence, or otherwise, nd the value of p if the probability density function is dened as 1 , p x 30 f (x) = 25 . 0 , elsewhere
0 a b x
12B
f ( x ) dx = 0, so Pr(X = a) = 0.
If X is a continuous random variable with the probability density function dened as 1 x 4, 8 x 10 f (x) = 2 0, elsewhere nd: a Pr(X > 9)
b Pr(8.5 < X < 9) c Pr(X > 9 X > 8.5).
Chapter 12
Continuous distributions
595
THINK a
1
WRITE
Draw the graph of f (x) and shade the required region. (It is the area under the curve to the right of x = 9.)
y 1 (10, 1)
(8, 0)
10
To nd the required probability (that is, to nd the shaded area under the curve), integrate f (x) between x = 9 and x = 10. Antidifferentiate and simplify.
10 1 Pr(X > 9) = x 4 d dx x 9 2
1 x2 4x = 2 2 9 x2 = 4x 4 9
10
10
Show the required region on the diagram. (It is the area under the curve between x = 8.5 and x = 9.)
0
2
(8, 0) 8.5 9
1 8.5 2 9
10
To nd the required probability, integrate f (x) between x = 8.5 and x = 9. Antidifferentiate. (Use the result from part a.) Substitute the terminals in and evaluate to obtain the required probability.
x 4 dx
The rule for conditional probability Pr ( A B) is Pr(A | B) = . Write the Pr ( B) appropriate statement.
Pr[( X > 9) ( X > 8.5) )] Pr( ( X > 8.5) Pr ( X > 9) = Pr ( X > 8.5) =
596
The expression in the denominator can be found by adding the probability of X being between 8.5 and 9 and the probability of X being greater than 9. The required probabilities are already found in parts a and b. Substitute the numbers in and evaluate.
= =
The required probabilities can also be obtained with the aid of a CAS calculator. Where exact answers are not required, it is appropriate to use the CAS.
WORKED EXAMPLE 4
g e (0.5 x) log , 2 x 2e A random variable, X, has its frequency curve dened as f ( x ) = 2 0, elsewhere Calculate the probability, correct to 4 decimal places, that X is: a less than 4 b between 2.5 and 3.5.
THINK a
1
WRITE
The required probability can be obtained by evaluating the denite integral of f (x) over the interval [2, 4]. Note: Remember Pr(X < 4) = Pr(X 4) because Pr(X = 4) = 0 On a Calculator page, press: MENU b 4:Calculus 4 3:Integral 3 Complete the entry line as:
2
2
Find the required probability as shown above, this time using the interval [2.5, 3.5]. Write the solution, rounding to 4 decimal places.
b Pr(2.5 X 3.5) =
2.5
dx
= 0.2004
Chapter 12
Continuous distributions
597
In many instances we need to integrate over intervals involving innity. In such cases, the limits are evaluated as shown at right.
Interval (, ) (, a) (a, )
k
Limit lim
k f ( x)dx
k k k a
lim
f ( x )dx f ( x )dx
lim
When evaluating limits involving innity, it is useful to remember that as a number tends to innity, its reciprocal tends to zero. For example, lim 1 = 0 and lim 1 = 0. This concept is x x x e x illustrated in the worked example that follows.
WORKED EXAMPLE 5
eBoo k plus eBook
1 Tutorial
1 x 2 , x>0 A random variable, X, has its frequency curve dened as f (x) = 2 e . a Draw the graph of f (x). 0, elsewhere b Show that f (x) is a probability density function. c Find the probability, correct to 4 decimal places, that X is: i smaller than 3 ii greater than 2.5 iii greater than 2.5, given that it is smaller than 3.
THINK a Draw the graph of f (x). It is a decreasing WRITE/DRAW a
1
int-0583
Worked example 5
y (0, 2)
0 b
1
A pdf must be greater than or equal to 0 for all values of x. Check whether this condition is observed by inspecting the graph of f (x). Find the total area under the curve by evaluating the denite integral of f (x). Note that the interval over which the integral needs to be evaluated is [0, ). So, in this case, evaluate k lim f ( x )dx .
k 0
A = lim
k 0
1 e 2
1 x 2 d dx x
1 = lim e k 2 = lim [ e
k
1 2
x k ]0 k
1 = lim 1 k x e 2 0
3
Substitute the terminals in and evaluate the limit. Remember that lim 1 = 0. k k e2
lim 1 1 = k k e0 e2 1 =0+ 1 =1
598
Both conditions required for the function to be a pdf are observed. State your conclusion.
i The required probability can be
Since f (x) 0 for all x and the total area under the curve is 1, f (x) is a pdf.
obtained by evaluating the denite integral of f (x) over the interval [0, 3]. Use the expression for the antiderivative found in part b to speed up your calculations. Give your answer correct to 4 decimal places.
c i Pr(X < 3) =
0 2
1 2
31
1 x 2
dx d x
1 = x e 0 1 1 = 3 0 e e2 = 0.7769
ii Pr(X > 2.5) = 1 Pr(X < 2.5)
2.5 1
ii
To nd Pr(X > 2.5), evaluate the integral of f (x) over the interval [2.5, ]. Alternatively, nd Pr(X < 2.5) and subtract it from 1. This method avoids nding limits, as the interval over which the integral needs to be evaluated is [0, 2.5], that is, it does not involve .
=1
1 x 2
dx d x
1 = 1 1x 2 e 0
2.5
The required probability can also be obtained by using the CAS over the interval [2.5, ) On a Calculator page, press: MENU b 4:Calculus 4 3:Integral 3 Complete the entry line as: e2 2.5 2
dx x d
Press ENTER
3
Write the solution, rounding to 4 decimal places. Note: The answer is the same as above. Write the appropriate statement for the conditional probability.
e 2.5 1 2
1 2
dx d x
= 0.2865
iii Pr( ( X > 2.5X < 3) =
iii
Pr[( X > 2.5) ( X < 3) )] Pr( ( X < 3) Pr( (2.5 < X < 3) Pr( ( X < 3)
Chapter 12
Continuous distributions
599
Using the CAS as shown above, nd Pr(2.5 < X < 3), with your interval as [2.5, 3]. Fill in the required values into the conditional probability statement. Answer to 4 decimal places.
WORKED EXAMPLE 6
If X is a continuous random variable with a probability density function given by 4 2 x, 1 x 2 f (x) = , nd the value of a such that Pr(X a) = 0.75, where 1 a 2. 0, elsewhere
THINK
1
WRITE y
Pr(X a) = 0.75 means that the area under the curve of f (x) to the left of a is 0.75, where 1 a 2. Draw a diagram to illustrate the given information.
(1, 2)
0.75
0
2
(2, 0) x
Copy down the probability statement as given in the question. The required probability can be found by integrating f (x) over the interval [1, a]. So replace Pr(X a) with the appropriate integral. Antidifferentiate and simplify.
2x2 75 4 x = 0.7 2 1
2 4 x x 1 = 0.75 a
5 6
Substitute the terminals in. The result is a quadratic equation. Use the quadratic formula to solve for a.
600
Since a must be within the interval [1, 2], discard the rst solution.
Since 1 a 2, a = 3 .
2
Note that in worked example 6, we found a such that Pr(X < a) = 0.75. In effect, we were nding the 0.75 quantile, or the 75th percentile.
REMEMBER
1. If X is a continuous random variable, then the probability of it falling between x = a and x = b is given by the area bounded by the probability density function, the x-axis and the lines x = a and x = b. That is, b Pr(a X b) = f ( x )dx .
a
y Pr(a x b) 0 a b x
2. Pr(X = a) = 0 Pr(X > a) = Pr(X a) 3. The required probabilities can be calculated by using a CAS calculator and selecting the integral function from the maths expression template, where f (x) is the function that needs to be integrated and a and b are the terminals. 4. To integrate over intervals involving innity, the limits are evaluated as shown. Interval (, ) (, a) (a, ) lim Limit
f ( x)dx k k
k k
lim
f ( x )dx f ( x )dx
k a
lim
5. As a number tends to innity, its reciprocal tends to zero. For example, 1 1 lim = 0 and lim x = 0. x e x x 6. Quantiles and percentiles both dene the value of the random variable, X, below which a given proportion of the distribution falls. 7. A quantile is a probability value expressed as a decimal, while a percentile is a probability value expressed as a percentage.
Chapter 12
Continuous distributions
601
EXERCISE
12B
ax ( x 2), 0 x 2 3 A random variable, X, has a pdf given by f (x) = . er ere 0, elsewhere a Find the value of a. b Find the probability, correct to 4 decimal places, that X is: i greater than 1.5 ii less than 0.4 iii greater than 0.4 but less than 1.5 iv greater than 0.4, given that it is less than 1.5. 4 WE4 A continuous random variable, X, has probability density function defined by 1 x co s ( x ), 2 x 3 2 f (x) = 5 . Calculate, correct to 4 decimal places: 0 , elsewhere er ere 0 . 25 2 5e 0.25 x , x 0 5 WE5 A random variable, X, has its frequency curve defined as f (x) = . er ere 0, elsewhere a Draw the graph of f (x). b Show that it is a probability density function. c Find the probability that X is: i smaller than 2 ii greater than 1 iii greater than 1, given that it is smaller than 2. 1 , x 1 6 A random variable, X, has its frequency curve defined as f (x) = x 2 . 0, elsewhere er ere a Draw the graph of f (x). b Show that it is a probability density function. c Find: i Pr(X > 2) ii Pr(X < 3) iii Pr(2 < X < 3) iv Pr(2 < X < 3 | X > 2) v Pr(X < 3 | X > 2).
7 WE6 If X is a continuous random variable with a probability density function given by 1 1 x+ 2, 1 x 2 f (x) = 3 , nd the value of a such that Pr(X a) = 0.36, where 1 a 2. 0 , elsewhere er ere
602
If X is a continuous random variable with a probability density function given by 4 , 2x4 1 f (x) = x 2 , and Pr(X b) = 3, nd the value of b, where 2 b 4. 0, elsewhere er ere 9 If X is a random variable with a probability density function given by 2 (3 x ), 0 x 1 f (x) = 5 , nd: er ere 0, elsewhere a the 0.4 quantile b the 0.85 quantile c the 70th percentile.
1 2 cos ( ), 10 If f () = 2 2 is the probability density function of the 0, elsewhere er ere random variable : a sketch the graph of the probability density function and shade the region corresponding to the equation Pr(a a) = 1 2 b nd the exact value of a.
The random variable, X, has a probability density function defined as , 1 x 1 ax 2 2 f (x) = 0, elsewhere er ere a Sketch the probability density function. b Hence, or otherwise, nd the value of a. c Calculate: i Pr(0.5 < X < 0) ii Pr(X 0.5) Pr(0.5 < X < 0 | X 0.25)
The random variable, X, has a probability density function dened as 1 ( x 2) ), , 2x6 16 1 f (x) = (10 x ), ), 6 < x 1 10 16 0, elsewhere er ere a Sketch the probability density function. b Calculate: i Pr(X < 4) ii Pr(3 < X 8)
EXAM TIP On previous exams, students have chosen a y-scale that was too large, drawn curved graphs where straight lines were required, drawn an unsymmetrical graph, or omitted the horizontal lines. Greater care needs to be taken.
[Authors' advice]
13 The random variable, X, has a probability density function defined as 3 x + 1 , 10 2 x 0 8 3 256 f (x) = 1 . 4 x, 0 x 4 16 0, elsewhere ere ere a Draw the graph of f (x). b Show that the total area under the graph is 1.
Chapter 12
Continuous distributions
603
a Draw the graph of the probability density function. b Show that the area under the graph is 1. c Calculate each of the following (giving answers in exact form). i Pr(X < ) 12 ii Pr(X < ) 6 iii Pr(X < | X < 0) 6 A random variable, X, has its frequency function given by x n , 0 x a sin 2 f (x) = . 0, elsewhere er ere a Find the value of a such that f (x) is a probability density function. b Draw the graph of the probability density function. c Find, in exact form, the probability that X is: i smaller than 2 ii greater than 3 2 iii between and 3 3 2 iv less than , given that it is greater than . 3 2 16 A Cauchy distribution is defined as f (x) = 1 a for x R and a > 0. 2 a + x2 a Sketch the graph of f (x) for a = 1, 2 and 3 on the same set of axes. Comment on the effect of varying a in the shape of the graph. b For a = 1, use a CAS calculator to nd the following probabilities to 4 decimal places. i Pr(X < 1) ii Pr(1 < X < 1) iii Pr(1 < X < 1 | X > 1) 1 2 b Find the area bounded by the curve and the x-axis. c Use your answers to a and b to dene the probability density function f (x) whose rule is the same as the rule of g(x). d If X is a random variable whose probability density function is given by f (x), nd, correct to 4 decimal places: i Pr(X > 0.5) ii Pr(X < 1) iii Pr(X > 0.32) iv Pr(0.5 < X < 1.09). e x , x R.
2
604
12C
However, if f (x) has a certain rule for a X b and is zero elsewhere, then the mean can be
b
obtained by using the formula = E(x) = xf ( x )d dx . In the worked examples below and the
a
exercise that follows, we will mostly deal with the latter case. In general, E[g(x)] = g( x ) f ( x ) dx. Median The median value, m, of the continuous random variable, X, is a value such that Pr(X m) = 1 . 2 (It follows that Pr(X m) = 1 as well.) In other words, m is a value of X such that there is a 50% 2 chance that X will be less than or equal to m and a 50% chance that it will be greater than or equal to m. Since Pr(X m) is given by f ( x )dx, to nd the median, solve the equation a m 1 a f ( x)dx = 2 . The solution of equations of this type was discussed in detail in the previous section of this chapter. Mode The mode is a value of X for which f (x) has its maximum. To nd the mode of the continuous random variable, it is best to sketch the graph of its probability density function rst. If the probability density function has a maximum turning point in the interval [a, b], the mode is given by the x-coordinate of the turning point. It can be easily obtained by nding the derivative of f (x), making it equal to zero, and solving for x. If the probability density function continuously increases or decreases over the interval [a, b], or if it has a minimum turning point, the mode is then given by the end point of the interval. That is, the mode is either a or b (whichever one corresponds to the maximum value of f (x)). Note that it is possible to have more than one mode.
y f(x) y f(x) y f(x) Mode 0 x
m
Mode
Mode x
WORKED EXAMPLE 7
Find the mean, median and mode for the following probability density function. 2 x, 0 x 1 f (x) = 0, elsewhere
THINK
1
int-0584
Worked example 7
WRITE
Write the formula for nding the mean of the continuous random variable.
dx = E(x) = x f ( x )d
a
Chapter 12
Continuous distributions
605
Substitute 0 for a and 1 for b and replace f (x) with 2x. Simplify the integrand.
0 x (2 x)dx
1 0 1
= 2x2 d dx x
3
=2 3
5 6 7
State the value of the mean. Write the formula for nding the median, m. Substitute 0 for a and replace f (x) with 2x. Antidifferentiate and simplify.
The mean is 2 . 3
f ( x )dx =
m
1 2 1 2
2x d dx =
m
2x2 = 2 0
2 = x 0 m
1 2 1 2 1 2 1 2 1 2
(m)2 (0)2 = m2 =
10
Evaluate the median and rationalise the denominator. (Note that only the positive square root is required, as 0 x 1.) State the value of the median. Sketch the graph of the pdf.
m=
2 2
11 12
The median is
y 2
2 . 2
(1, 2)
0
13
The mode is the value of X for which f (x) has its maximum. As seen from the graph, the largest value of f (x) is at the right-handside end point of the domain. So this point represents the mode.
The mode is 1.
Note: In the worked example above, the value of the mode was obtained directly from the graph. In other cases differentiation may be required.
606
Consider the random variable, X, with the probability density function given by
1 ( x 2 2 x 3), 0 x 3 f (x) = 9 . er ere 0, elsewhere
y
) (0, 1 3
(3, 0) 1 2 3 x
As can be seen from the graph, the probability density function has a maximum turning point. The x-coordinate of this point represents the mode of X. To nd the x-coordinate of the turning point, we need to differentiate, make the derivative equal to zero, and solve for x. f (x) =
1 9 1 9
(2x 2)
Measures of spread
Variance If X is a continuous random variable with the probability distribution function f (x) over the domain R, the variance of X can be found using the formula Var(X) = E(x )2 = dx x. ( x )2 f ( x) d
However, if f (x) has a certain rule for a X b and is zero elsewhere, then the variance can be obtained by using the formula Var(X) = E(x )2 = This formula may prove to be rather hard to use when f (x) is complicated. The alternative formula for variance is Var(X) = E(X2) 2. This can also be expressed as Var(X) = dx x dx x x f ( x) d a ( x ) 2 f ( x ) d a
b
dx x. a ( x ) 2 f ( x ) d
Note that both formulas require us to nd the mean of X rst. Standard deviation The standard deviation of X can be easily found by taking a positive square root from the Va X ) . variance of X. That is, SD(X) = Var( Note: Standard deviation is often denoted as and variance as 2. The calculations of both variance and standard deviation are shown in detail in the worked example below.
WORKED EXAMPLE 8
Find the variance and standard deviation for the following probability density function.
1 x 2 , 1 x 2 f (x) = . 0 , elsewhere
THINK
1
WRITE
Var(X) = E(X2) 2
Chapter 12
Continuous distributions
607
2 3
Find the value of the mean. Write down the appropriate formula. Substitute 1 and 2 for a and b respectively, and replace f (x) with x
1 . 2
dx = E(x) = x f ( x ) d
a
= x x
1
( ) dx
1 2
= x2
1
x dx 2
2
x3 x 2 = 4 1 3
23 22 13 12 = 4 3 4 3 8 1 1 5 1 = 1 = 3 3 4 3 12 = 19
12 b
Find the value of E(X2). Write the appropriate formula. Make all necessary substitutions and simplify the integrand.
E(x2) = x 2 f ( x ) d dx
a
E(x2) = x 2 x
1
( ) dx
1 2 2
2 x2 = x 3 dx 1 2
x 4 x3 = 6 1 4
24 23 14 13 = 6 4 6 4 4 1 1 = 4 3 4 6 = 8 1 3 12
31 = 12
10
Substitute the values of E(X2) and into the variance formula and evaluate.
Var(X) = 12
31
31
( )
19 12 361
= 12 144 =
11 12
11 144
State the value of the variance. Write the formula for the standard deviation.
11 Variance = 144
SD(X) = Var( Va X )
608
13
Substitute the value of the variance into the formula and evaluate.
= =
11 144 11 12 11 12
14
Standard deviation =
WORKED EXAMPLE 9
g ( x ), 1 < x < e log . The probability density function for X is given by f ( x ) = e 0, elsewhere Calculate, correct to 3 decimal places:
a the mean c the standard deviation THINK a
1 2
int-0585
Worked example 9
Write the formula for nding the mean of the continuous random variable. We need to use the CAS calculator to integrate and nd the probability. On a Calculator page, complete the entry line as: n( x )) dx 1 ( x lln( Then press ENTER .
e
a = E( X ) =
dx x 0 x loge ( x) d
Write the solution and round to 3 decimal places. Write the formula for nding the median. On a Calculator page, press: MENU b 3:Algebra 3 1:Solve 1 Complete the entry line as: m 1 solve e (l ln( x ) ) dx = , m 2 1 Then press ENTER .
b
= E( X ) =
= 2.097
dx x 1 x loge ( x) d
1 2
log g e ( x) d dx x=
Chapter 12
Continuous distributions
609
Write the solution. As 1 m e, so m must be the bigger of the two possible solutions. Answer the question and round to 3 decimal places. We rst need to nd the variance. On a Calculator page, complete the entry line as:
Solving log g e ( x) d dx x=
1
1 2
for m implies
m = 0.1866 or m = 2.1555.
3
c Var(X) =
1 x 2 loge ( x) dx 2 .
log g e ( x) d dx x
= 0.969 Note that in this example, 96.9% of the data lies within 2 standard deviations of the mean, which is close to the estimated value of 95%.
Interquartile range The interquartile range (IQR) is the middle 50% of the distribution. In the previous section we discussed percentiles and quantiles. IQR = 75th percentile 25th percentile. = Q3 Q1
610
REMEMBER
1. If X is a continuous random variable with a probability distribution function f (x) over the domain R, the mean of X can be found using the formula 2. If f (x) has a certain rule for a X b and is zero elsewhere, then the mean can be dx . obtained by using the formula = E(x) = xf ( x )d
a b
dx. = E(x) = xf ( x )d
3. The median value, m, of the continuous random variable, X, is a value such that Pr(X m) = 1 . 2 4. To nd the median of X we need to solve for m the equation f ( x )dx = 1 . 2 a 5. The mode is a value of X for which f (x) has its maximum. 6. To nd the mode of the continuous random variable, it is best to sketch the graph of its probability density function rst. 7. If the probability density function of X has a maximum turning point in the interval [a, b], the mode is given by the x-coordinate of the turning point. It can be obtained by nding the derivative of f (x), making it equal to zero, and solving for x. 8. If the probability density function continuously increases or decreases over the interval [a, b], or if it has a minimum turning point, the mode is then given by the end point of the interval (a or b) that corresponds to the maximum value of f (x). 9. It is possible to have more than one mode. 10. If X is a continuous random variable with the probability distribution function f (x) over the domain R, the variance of X can be found using the formula 11. If f (x) has a certain rule for a X b and is zero elsewhere, then the variance can be 12. The alternative formula for variance is given by Var(X) = E(X2) 2. This can also be dx x ( xf ( x )dx )2 . expressed as Var(X) = ( x )2 f ( x )d a
a b b m
dx x. Var(X) = E(x )2 = ( x )2 f ( x )d
13. The standard deviation of X can be found by taking the positive square root of the variance of X. That is, SD(X) = Var( Va X ) . 14. The interquartile range (IQR) is the middle 50% of the distribution. IQR = 75th percentile 25th percentile. = Q3 Q1 EXERCISE
12C
Chapter 12
Continuous distributions
611
2 Find the mean, median and mode for each of the following probability density functions.
51 x, 11 x 1 a f (x) = 0, elsewhere 3 (2 x ) 2 , 2 x 4 b f (x) = 8 er ere 0, elsewhere
6 x ( x 1), 1 x 2 c f (x) = 5 er ere 0, elsewhere 3 WE8 Find the variance and standard deviation for each of the following probability density functions.
1 , 2x6 a f (x) = 4 er ere 0, elsewhere 1 (3 x ), 0 x 2 b f (x) = 4 er ere 0, elsewhere
4 Find the variance and standard deviation for each of the following probability density functions. 3 ( x + 1)2 , 0 x 1 2( x 2), 2 x 3 a f (x) = b f (x)= 7 er ere er ere 0, elsewhere 0, elsewhere
1 sin ( x ), 2 x c f (x) = 2 er ere 0, elsewhere 5 A continuous random variable, X, has a probability density function defined by 0 . 3e 0.3 x , x 0 f (x) = . Calculate: er ere 0, elsewhere a the mean of X b the median of X c the mode of X d the variance of X e the standard deviation of X. a , 2x3 2 6 WE9 For f (x) = ( x 1) , find: er ere 0, elsewhere a the value of a, such that f (x) would represent the probability density function of a random variable, X b the mean of X, correct to 4 decimal places. c the standard deviation of X, correct to 4 decimal places. d Pr( 2 X + 2), that is, the probability that X is within 2 standard deviations from the mean, correct to 4 decimal places.
7 X is a continuous random variable with a probability density function given by a co s x , 0 x 2 f (x) = . 0, elsewhere er ere a Calculate the value of a. b Sketch the graph of the probability density function. c Calculate the exact mean and the variance, correct to 4 decimal places. d Find Pr X . e Find Pr X X . 2 2 4 x a sin 2 x + , For f (x) = 4 4 4: 0, elsewhere er ere
612
a calculate the value of a such that f (x) could be a probability density function b sketch the graph of the probability density function c nd the mean, median and mode explain the result obtained in part c. 9 The probability density function of a random variable, X, is given by k ( x + 2)3 , 2 x 0 f (x) = . er ere 0, elsewhere a Find the value of k. b Calculate the median. c Calculate the 0.25 quantile. d Calculate the 0.75 quantile. e Use the answers to parts c and d to nd the IQR (interquartile range). 10 The probability density function of a random variable, X, is given by ere e x [0, 1] 1 cos ( x ) , wh er f (x) = 2 er ere 0, elsewhere a Sketch the probability distribution function. Calculate: b the mean c the median d the mode. 11 The probability density function of a random variable, X, is given by 5 mx 2 + nx, 1 x 0 f (x) = . If the mean of X is 7 , nd the values of m and n. 0, elsewhere (Hint: Use simultaneous equations.)
12D
WORKED EXAMPLE 10
The local milk bar sells a particular brand of chocolate bar. The number sold per day is given by the probability distribution function x , 0 x 10 f ( x ) = 50 0, elsewhere Calculate: a the maximum number of chocolate bars that are sold each day b the expected number of chocolate bars sold each day c the probability that fewer than 4 chocolate bars are sold each day d the probability that more than 8 chocolate bars are sold each day.
THINK a The maximum number of chocolate bars that could WRITE a The maximum number of chocolate bars
Chapter 12
Continuous distributions
613
Write the formula for nding the expected number of chocolate bars sold. Substitute for f (x) and the appropriate interval [0, 10] for a and b.
b = E( X ) =
dx a x f ( x )d
= =
0 0
10
x x dx 50 x 2 dx 50
10
10
x3 = 150 0 = =
1000 0 150
20 3
Sketch the graph of the pdf curve. Shade the required section on the graph. State the probability that needs to be found.
y _) (10, 1 5
10
As the shaded region forms a triangle, it is more efcient to nd the area by a geometric method, rather than integrating.
bh 2 The base of the triangle = 4. The height of the triangle is f (4). 2 4 f (4) = = 50 25 A= A= = 4 25 2
4 25 2
The probability that less than 4 chocolate bars are sold is 25.
4
Shade the required section on the graph. State the probability that needs to be found.
y _) (10, 1 5
10
614
This time, we will integrate to nd the area under the curve. State the integral that needs to be evaluated to nd the probability. Note: Instead of integrating, the area of the trapezium could be found.
Pr(X > 8) =
10
8
2
x dx 50
10
x =
100 8
= 100 64 = =
The probability that more than 8 9 chocolate bars are sold is 25.
WORKED EXAMPLE 11
The length of time (in minutes) between the successive incoming calls to a certain national helpline is a continuous random variable with a probability density function given by 0.6 e 0.6 x , x 0 f (x) = . 0, elsewhere Find, correct to 4 decimal places, the probability that the next call will come: a within 30 seconds of the previous call b between 2 and 3 minutes after the previous call c more than 7 minutes after the last call.
THINK a
1
WRITE
Sketch the graph of the pdf curve. If X represents time (in minutes) between the successive calls, then getting a call within 30 seconds from the previous one would mean that X must be between 0 and 0.5 (as 30 seconds = 0.5 minutes). Shade the required section on the graph. State the probability that needs to be found and the integral that needs to be evaluated in order to nd that probability. Evaluate by rst antidifferentiating and then substituting terminals in for x. Give the answer correct to 4 decimal places as required.
y (0, 0.6)
0.5 1
0.5 0
Pr(0 X 0.5) =
0.6e
0.6 x
dx d x
0.5
0.6 x
0.5
X is anywhere between 2 and 3. Show the required section on the graph. State the probability that needs to be found and the integral that needs to be evaluated in order to nd that probability.
0.6 0 )
y (0, 0.6)
1
3
3
0.6 x
Pr(2 X 3) = 0.6e
2
dx d x
Chapter 12
Continuous distributions
615
Evaluate.
= e
0.6 x
The probability that X will exceed 7 can be obtained by nding the area under the pdf curve to the right of 7. This is equivalent to nding the area to the left of 7 and subtracting it from the total area under the curve (that is, from 1).
y (0, 0.6)
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
0.6 x
dx d x
7
Evaluate.
=1 e
0.6 x
7 0.6 .6 0 )]
REMEMBER
1. Always sketch diagrams to represent the required probability. 2. Find probabilities by integrating the probability density function between the required values. EXERCISE
12D
(t 2 + 1), 0 t 2 f ( x ) = 14 0, elsewhere Calculate: a the maximum number of hours that Kathryn could watch television each day b the mean number of hours of television she watches each day, correct to 2 decimal places. c the probability that she watches more than 1.5 hours of television d the probability that she watches up to 1 hour of television each day, correct to 4 decimal places.
616
2 The lifespan (in days) of freshly cut roses is a random variable X with the probability density function given by 1 x 1 , 2 x 4, 4 2 1 f ( x ) = x + 3 , 4 x 6, 2 4 0 , e lsewhere re e. a What is the probability that a freshly cut rose will last for: i over 5 days? ii between 3 and 5 days? iii less than 4 days and 6 hours, correct to 3 decimal places? b Leos girlfriend Elly likes white roses. For their three-month anniversary Leo bought her a bunch. If the orist said that the freshly cut owers were delivered to the shop 1.5 days ago, what is the probability that the roses will last for at least 3 more days? 3
WE11 The length (in minutes) of waiting time at the dentist is a continuous random variable
0 . 15 1 5e 0.15 x , x 0 with probability density function given by f (x) = . Find, correct to er ere 0, elsewhere
4 decimal places, the probability that: a a patient will be admitted within 10 minutes of arrival b a patient will have to wait anywhere between 10 and 20 minutes from arrival c the waiting time will exceed half an hour. 4 The weight (in grams) of rainbow trout caught on a fish farm is a random variable, X, with ke kx , x 0 probability density function given by f (x) = , where k = 10 9 . 000 0, elsewhere
a Find, correct to 4 decimal places, the probability that a randomly caught trout will weigh: i less than 800 g ii between 1 kg and 2 kg iii over 2 kg. b Calculate the mean weight of trout on this farm. Give your answer to the nearest gram. c What proportion of trout on this farm weighs below the mean weight? 5 The life (in hours) of a particular brand of batteries is a random variable with probability
x 1 1000 , x 0 density function given by f (x) = 1000 e . 0, elsewhere
a Find, correct to 4 decimal places, the probability that a randomly selected battery of this brand will last: i less than 100 hours ii no more than 180 hours iii more than 200 hours. b If after 180 hours of operation a battery is still working, what is the probability, correct to 4 decimal places, that it will last at least another 50 hours? c A manufacturer of the batteries claims that 90% of their batteries will work for at least n hours. Find the largest possible value of n. A group of students is given a maths quiz. The time (in minutes) taken by a student to complete the task is a continuous random variable with probability density function given by 0 . 1, 30 x 40 f (x) = . er ere 0, elsewhere
Chapter 12
Continuous distributions
617
a State the time limits within which the quiz must be done. b Find the probability that a student will: i complete the task in under 33 minutes ii take between 36 and 38 minutes to nish. c Calculate the mean time taken to complete the quiz. d The fastest 10% of the class will receive a bonus question and thus will have an opportunity to earn extra marks. Find the longest time a student can take to nish the quiz and still qualify for a bonus question. 7 Rachel is buying silk fabric for her formal dress. The dressmaker estimates that she will need 3.9 metres of silk. To be on the safe side, Rachel asks a salesperson to cut off 4 metres from the selected roll. The difference (in centimetres) between the ordered length (4 metres) and the actual length of material cut by the salesperson is a continuous random variable with 0.1 probability density function given by f (x) = . (0.0 01 + x 2 ) a Find the probability, correct to 4 decimal places, that the actual length of the material will be: i within 2 centimetres of the ordered length ii within 5 centimetres of the ordered length. b Find the probability that the actual length of the material is at least 4.07 metres, correct to 4 decimal places. c What is the probability that the purchased material will not be long enough to make a dress (that is, will be shorter than 3.9 metres)? Answer to 4 decimal places. 8 An Australian Chamber Orchestra concert is to be broadcasted live on Classic FM. It is scheduled to begin at 7 pm sharp. Although every effort is made to ensure the concert will start on time (due to the live broadcast), it may still start anywhere between 6.55 pm and 7.05 pm. The difference (in minutes) between the advertised starting time and the actual starting time is a continuous random variable with probability density function given by x cos , 5 x 5 20 f (x) = 20 2 . 0, elsewhere er ere a What is the probability that the concert will start within 30 seconds of the scheduled time? Answer correct to 4 decimal places. b Maya is listening to the concert at home. She turns on her radio at 6.58 pm. What is the probability that Maya will miss the beginning, correct to 4 decimal places? c Patrons who arrive after the concert has started will not be admitted until the interval. Lena and Alex are caught in a trafc jam and estimate that they will arrive at the concert hall at 7.03 pm. Assuming that the couple will indeed arrive at their estimated time, what is the probability that they will be admitted, correct to 4 decimal places? 9 In a certain bank, the time (in minutes) the customer has to wait to be served is a random variable with a probability density function defined as kx, 0 x 10 f (x) = k ( x 20) ), , 10 < x 20, fo r k > 0. 0, else wh ere er elsewh a Sketch the graph of the probability density function. b Hence, or otherwise, nd the value of k. c Find the probability that a customer had to wait more than 10 minutes, if it is known that he was waiting for at least 7 minutes, correct to 4 decimal places. eBoo k plus eBook d Nathan parked his car in a 15-minute parking zone just outside the bank. He needs to deposit a cheque, which usually takes Digital doc 3 minutes. What is the probability that Nathan will return to his WorkSHEET 12.1 Work car on time (that is, within 15 minutes)?
618
12E
Interactivity The normal distribution is an important tool when dealing with the int-0257 probability distribution of a continuous random variable. The frequency The normal distribution curve of the normal distribution is characterised by the symmetrical bell shape called the normal distribution curve or normal curve. The normal curve fairly realistically models many observed frequency distributions such as heights and weights of infants, Mathematical Methods examination results, the intelligence quotient of children in a particular age group, the lengths of battery lives, the diameters of steel cans, etc. If X is a continuous random variable that follows a normal distribution with mean, , and variance, 2, it is written as X N(, 2).
f(x)
1 2
is obtained when x = .
4. For a normal distribution: (a) the mean, mode and median are the same (b) many of the frequencies are situated near the mean (c) the graph extends indenitely to the right and left of the mean, but never touches or goes below the x-axis (d) the area between the normal curve and the x-axis is equal to 1 square unit, that is,
1 2
1 x2
=1
1 x 2
. 2 The standard deviation, , and the mean, , represent the transformations of the graph. The most basic form of the normal distribution function is when the mean is 0 and the standard 1 x 1 deviation is 1. In this case the equation would be: f ( x ) = e 2 . 2 The effect of the mean and the standard deviation on the normal distribution curve is: 1 dilation factor of from the x-axis dilation factor of from the y-axis translation of units in the positive x direction (for > 0).
2
Chapter 12
Continuous distributions
619
2. Approximately 95% of the observations lie within two standard deviations of the mean. This may be written as Pr( 2 X + 2) 95%. We can also say that a value of x will most probably lie within two standard deviations of the mean. 3. Approximately 99.7% of the observations lie within three standard deviations of the mean. This may be written as Pr( 3 X + 3) 99.7%. We can also say that a value of x will almost certainly lie within three standard deviations of the mean.
2
95%
+ 2 x
99.7% x
3 + 3 The mean, , and the standard deviation, , are used when dealing with a population and are thus called population parameters. If these values are unknown then the sample mean, x , and sample standard deviation, s, are used.
WORKED EXAMPLE 12
Draw a curve of the normal distribution, showing an appropriate scale, for = 25 and = 5.
THINK
1 2 3 4 5
WRITE
Calculate . Calculate 2. Calculate 3. Rule up a set of axes. Label the axes, class intervals, frequency values and the , , 2, 3 values. Draw the normal distribution curve. 1 Remember to add the maximum point: , 2
= 25 5 = 20 + = 25 + 5 = 30 2 = 25 2 5 = 15 + 2 = 25 + 2 5 = 35 3 = 25 3 5 = 10 + 3 = 25 + 3 5 = 40
(25, 5 12 )
10 15 20 25 30 35 40
WORKED EXAMPLE 13
Scores from a certain test are normally distributed with mean, = 84 and standard deviation = 4. Find the percentage of scores which are: a between 80 and 88 b between 72 and 96 c above 88 d above 96.
THINK a
1
int-0586
Worked example 13
WRITE
As the values 80 and 88 are symmetrical about the mean, determine the difference between the mean and the extreme value. Divide the difference by the standard deviation. Note: This gives us the number of standard deviations by which the extreme value differs from the mean.
Difference = 88 84 =4 Difference 4 = 4 =1
620
3 4
Match the number of standard deviations with the appropriate percentage. Answer the question. Determine the difference between the mean and the extreme value. Divide the difference by the standard deviation. Match the number of standard deviations with the appropriate percentage. Answer the question. Relate the score with the corresponding mean and standard deviation difference. Use part a to assist. Draw a diagram representing the situation.
c b
68%
Approximately 68% of the observations lie between the scores of 80 and 88. Difference = 96 84 = 12 Difference 12 = 4 =3
1 2
3 4
3 99.7%
Approximately 99.7% of the observations lie between the scores of 72 and 96.
+ 88
16% 68% 80 84 88
16%
3 4
Relate the percentage with the corresponding mean and standard deviation difference. Answer the question. Note: Since we are looking at values beyond the extreme, we halve the percentage. Relate the score with the corresponding mean and standard deviation difference. Use part b to assist. Draw a diagram representing the situation.
d
+ 3 96
0.15% 99.7% 72
0.15%
96 x
Relate the percentage with the corresponding mean and standard deviation difference. Answer the question. Note: Since we are looking at values beyond the extreme, we halve the percentage.
In parts a and b of the above worked example, each end point was symmetric about the mean. Hence, when determining the difference between the mean and extreme value, only one value was required.
Chapter 12
Continuous distributions
621
WORKED EXAMPLE 14
For a normally distributed variable with mean = 70 and standard deviation = 18, nd: a the range between which 68% of the values lie b the range between which 95% of the values lie c the value which has 2.5% of all values below it.
THINK a
1 2 3 4
WRITE
Relate the given percentage with the appropriate and . Calculate . Calculate + . Answer the question. Relate the given percentage with the appropriate and . Calculate 2. Calculate + 2. Answer the question. Draw the normal distribution curve and relate the given percentage with the appropriate mean and standard deviation difference. Answer the question.
68% = 70 18 = 52 + = 70 + 18 = 88
68% of the observations lie between 52 and 88.
1 2 3 4
2 95% 2 = 70 2 18 = 34 + 2 = 70 + 2 18 = 106
95% of the observations lie between 34 and 106.
2.5% 95% 34 70
2.5%
106
2 95%. Therefore, 5% of the observations lie outside of this interval. Furthermore, 2.5% lie above the range and 2.5% lie below the range. 2.5% of the observed values will lie below 34.
REMEMBER
1. If X is a continuous random variable that follows a normal distribution with mean, , and variance, 2, it is written as X N(, 2) 2. The equation of the normal curve is given by the probability distribution function (pdf) where x R. 2 3. For a normal distribution, the mean, median and mode are the same. 1 4. The maximum value of the graph is when x = . 2 e
f(x)
1 2
f ( x) =
1 x 2
622
5. The area between the normal curve and the x-axis is equal to 1 square unit, that is,
1 2
1 x 2
2 b
dx d x =1
6. Pr(a < x < b) = a f ( x ) dx 7. The effect of the mean and the standard deviation on the normal distribution curve is: 1 dilation factor of from the x-axis dilation factor of from the y-axis translation of units in the positive x direction (for > 0). 8. The common probabilities associated with the normal distribution are: (a) Approximately 68% of the observations lie within one standard deviation of the mean. (b) Approximately 95% of the observations lie within two standard deviations of the mean, or we say that a value of x will most probably lie within two standard deviations of the mean. (c) Approximately 99.7% of the observations lie within three standard deviations of the mean, or we say that a value of x will almost certainly lie within three standard deviations of the mean. EXERCISE
12E
The three curves on the scale below show three normal distributions.
ii i iii
Spreadsheet 079
Normal curves
0 a b c d
10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60 x
State the mean for each curve. Estimate the standard deviation for each curve. Which two curves have the same mean? Which two curves have the same standard deviation?
a Draw normal curves for the following on the one graph.
i = 60 and = 10 ii = 60 and = 20 iii = 80 and = 10 b How does an increase in affect the graph? c How does an increase in affect the graph? 4 Draw graphs of the following distributions. a X N(0, 1) b X N(20, 25) c X N(50, 100)
EXAM TIP Axes and a scale must be clearly shown as part of the sketch.
[Authors' advice]
Chapter 12
Continuous distributions
623
5 A large number of azalea bushes are planted, with heights following a normal distribution. Their heights are recorded after 3 months, 6 months and 9 months. These records are shown on the three curves below. a Which curve represents the i 3-month readings? ii b What can be said about iii the mean heights as time progresses? c What can be said about the x standard deviation as time progresses? 1 x 65 1 6 The pdf of a normal random variable is given by f ( x ) = e 2 5 . 5 2 a State the mean and the standard deviation of X. b Sketch the graph of the normal distribution.
2
a If a particular normally distributed variable has a mean of 20 and a standard deviation of 2, state what effect (in terms of transformations) the mean and standard deviation has on the graph of the distribution. b A normal distribution is given by X ~ N(9, 0.52). State what effect (in terms of transformations), the mean and standard deviation have on the graph of the distribution. 8 WE13 Scores on a certain test are normally distributed with mean = 65 and standard deviation 10. Find the percentage of scores which are: a between 55 and 75 b between 45 and 85 c between 35 and 95 d above 75 e below 45 f above 95. 9 The random variable, X, is normally distributed with mean = 30 and standard deviation = 5. Find the percentage of values which are: a above 35 b above 40 c above 45. If X N(42, 169), find the percentage of values which are: between 29 and 55 b between 16 and 68 d below 29 e above 55 c between 3 and 81 f below 3.
11 WE14 A normally distributed variable has = 40 and = 12. Find: a the range between which 68% of the values lie b the range between which 95% of the values lie c the range between which 99.7% of the values lie. 12 a b c d e A normally distributed variable has = 27.2 and = 1.4. Find: the range between which 68% of the values lie the range between which 95% of the values lie the range between which 99.7% of the values lie the value which has 16% of all values above it the value which has 2.5% of all values above it the value which has 0.15% of all values above it. A normally distributed variable has = 16.6 and = 0.6. Find: the range between which 68% of the values lie the range between which 95% of the values lie the range between which 99.7% of the values lie the value which has 16% of all values below it the value which has 2.5% of all values below it the value which has 0.15% of all values below it.
a b c d e f
624
a A normally distributed variable has = 102.3 and = 21.4. Draw a normal curve marking the positions of , , 2, 3. Find the percentage of values between: 102.3 and 123.7 ii 59.5 and 102.3 iii 102.3 and 166.5 iv 80.9 and 145.1. A normally distributed variable has = 24 and = 3. Find the percentage of values between: a 18 and 27 b 30 and 33. 16 Weights of babies are normally distributed with a mean of 3 kg and a variance of 0.36 kg. Find the weight range over which: a 68% of babies weights lie b 95% of babies weights lie c 99.7% of babies weights lie.
17 MC Scores from a certain test are known to be normally distributed. Approximately 95% of the scores attained were between 36 and 60. The mean and standard deviation respectively are: A 48 and 4 B 48 and 6 C 48 and 12 D 50 and 5 E 60 and 12 18 MC Which of the following is not true for all normal distributions? A The median is equal to the mean. B 95% of the values lie within 2 standard deviations of the mean. C Pr(X > + ) 0.16. D The mean is greater than the standard deviation. E 68% of the values lie within 1 standard deviation of the mean. 19 MC For the normal distribution below, the shaded area is approximately equal to 0.997.
19
61 x
C = 40, = 7
20 MC If X N(9, 9), then approximately 95% of the values would lie in the range: A 9 X 27 B 0 X 18 C 3 X 15 D 5.5 X 12.5 E 9 X 18 21 MC The heights of a class of 7-year-old girls are normally distributed with a mean of 100 cm and a standard deviation of 9 cm. In this class, 95% of the girls would be between approximately: A 73 cm and 127 cm B 82 cm and 118 cm C 91 cm and 109 cm D 94 cm and 106 cm E 97 cm and 103 cm 22 MC Which one of the following would represent a continuous random variable? A The number of people watching a netball match B The time taken to read this question C The number of 6s obtained in ten rolls of a die D The cost of a new car E The number of heads obtained in twenty tosses of a coin 23 If X is normally distributed with a mean of 12 and a variance of 2, find the range, correct to 2 decimal places, between which: a 68% of the values lie b 95% of the values lie c 99.7% of the values lie.
625
Chapter 12
Continuous distributions
12F
1 x 2
x where z = and g( z ) = f ( x ) . 2 The standard normal distribution is written as Z N(0, 12). The graph of the standard normal distribution is shown below. e
2 z2
y
1 2
3 2 1
To convert a normal distribution into a standard normal distribution, the mean, , is subtracted from the observed value, x, and the result is divided by the standard deviation, .
Calculating probabilities
A CAS calculator can be used to calculate the probabilities associated with the normal distribution for any value of or , using normCdf (x1, x2, , ). x1 and x2 are the lower and upper limits, respectively, of the interval for which you want to nd the probability.
WORKED EXAMPLE 15
Calculate the value of the following probabilities, correct to 4 decimal places. a Pr(Z < 2) b Pr(Z 0.728) c Pr(2.02 < Z < 1.59)
THINK a
1
WRITE
626
On a Calculator page, press: MENU b 5:Probability 5 5:Distributions 5 2:Normal Cdf 2 Enter the values as shown. Note: As we are dealing with a Z variable, = 0 and = 1. The lower limit is as there is no end point for the function.
Press ENTER .
Write the solution and round the answer to 4 decimal places. Draw a diagram and shade the region required.
b
0.728 0
2
For Pr(Z 0.728), repeat as above on the CAS calculator, this time the lower limit is 0.728 and the upper limit is . Remember: Pr(X = a) = 0 Pr(X > a) = Pr(X a)
Chapter 12
Continuous distributions
627
Write the solution and round the answer to 4 decimal places. Draw a diagram and shade the region required.
c
2.02
2
0 1.59
For Pr(2.02 < Z < 1.59), repeat as above on the CAS calculator. This time the lower limit is 2.02 and the upper limit is 1.59.
WORKED EXAMPLE 16
If X is normally distributed with = 50 and = 8, calculate, correct to 4 decimal places: a Pr(X > 55) b Pr(28 < X < 65) c Pr(X < 40 | X < 70).
THINK a
1
WRITE
50 55
2
For Pr(X > 55) repeat as shown in worked example 15. Note: As we are dealing with an X variable, the mean and standard deviation have changed and are now 50 and 8, respectively.
628
Press ENTER .
Write the solution and round the answer to 4 decimal places. Draw a diagram and shade the region required.
b
28
50
65
For Pr(28 < X < 65), repeat as above on the CAS. This time the lower limit is 28 and the upper limit is 65. Write the solution and round the answer to 4 decimal places. Write the rule for conditional probability. Note: Pr(X < 40 | X < 70) = Pr(X < 40). This is given by the overlapping region in the diagram below.
Pr (X < 40) Pr (X < 70) Region required c
Pr[( X < 40) ( X < 70)] Pr( ( X < 70) Pr( ( X < 40) Pr( ( X < 70)
40 50 70
2
Find the individual probabilities of the fraction using the CAS, as seen previously in the example.
Pr( ( X < 40) Pr( ( X < 70) nor df ( , 40, 50,8 normC , ) nor df ( , 70, 50,8 normC , )
0.105650 = 0.993790
Chapter 12
Continuous distributions
629
Pr( ( X < 40) Pr( ( X < 70) nor df ( , 40, 50,8 normC , ) nor df ( , 70, 50,8 normC , )
= 0.1063
Symmetry properties
The symmetrical nature of the normal distribution curve can sometimes be used to work out probabilities.
As an example, Pr(Z > z) is shown above on the left. Because of the symmetry of the curve, Pr(Z > z) = Pr(Z < z) as shown in the graph on the right. Comparing the unshaded regions above reveals another property: Pr(Z > z) = Pr(Z < z). As the area under the curve adds to 1, Pr(Z > z) + Pr(Z < z) = 1. Therefore, Pr(Z < z) = 1 Pr(Z > z), as demonstrated by the graph below.
It is also important to be able to nd the probability of z falling between two values, say a and b. A diagram is essential as it allows us to see the situation clearly and hence solve the problem. Consider the equation Pr(a < Z < b) = Pr(Z < b) Pr(Z < a). The gure below clearly demonstrates the above situation.
y y y
= a 0 b x a 0 b y x
a 0 x
= a 0 b x
630
i Pr(Z > p) ii Pr(Z > p) b If Pr(Z < b) = 0.8 and Pr(Z a) = 0.25, calculate: i Pr(a < Z < b) ii Pr(Z < a | Z < b)
THINK a i
1
WRITE
To calculate Pr(Z > p), draw a diagram and shade the region required.
a i
p0
2
ii
1 2
A property of normal distribution curves is: Pr(Z < p) + Pr(Z > p) = 1 Remember: Pr(Z > p) = Pr(Z p) as Pr(Z = p) = 0 Write the answer. By symmetry: Pr(Z < p) = Pr(Z > p) Write the answer. To calculate Pr(a < Z < b), draw a diagram and shade the region required.
a0b
2
State the probability you want to nd and the rule you will use. Pr(a < Z < b) = Pr(Z < b) Pr(Z < a). State the answer. State the probability you want to nd and the rule you will use.
ii
Pr(a < Z < b) = Pr(Z < b) Pr(Z < a). = 0.8 0.25 = 0.55 Pr(a < Z < b) = 0.55 Pr(Z < a | Z < b) = = Pr(( Z < a) ( Z < b)) Pr( ( Z < b) Pr( ( Z < a) Pr( ( Z < b) Pr( ( Z < a) Pr( ( Z < b)
ii
Chapter 12
Continuous distributions
631
WORKED EXAMPLE 18
X is a normal random variable with mean 16 and standard deviation 2, and Z is the standard normal variable. a Find m if Pr(X > 18) = Pr(Z > m). b Find m if Pr(X < 11) = Pr(Z > m).
THINK a
1
WRITE
As the probability of the X variable, Pr(X > 18), is in the same form as the probability of the Z variable, Pr(Z > m), m must directly relate to 18. To convert a normal variable to a standard normal variable, we use the x rule z = . Answer the question. This time the probability of the X variable, Pr(X < 11), is not in the same form as the probability of the Z variable, Pr(Z > m); however, we can x . still link the two via the rule z =
x 18 16 = 2 2 = 2 =1 Pr(X > 18) = Pr(Z > 1) m=1 z= x . 11 16 = 2 5 = 2 = 2.5 Pr(X < 11) = Pr(Z < 2.5) z= Pr(Z > z) = Pr(Z < z). Pr(Z < 2.5) = Pr(Z > 2.5) Pr(X < 11) = Pr(Z > 2.5) m = 2.5
Use the symmetry properties of the normal distribution to nd m. Answer the question.
WORKED EXAMPLE 19
The lengths of matches made at a certain factory are normally distributed with mean 4.1 cm and standard deviation 0.05 cm. Find the probability, correct to 4 decimal places, that a randomly selected match is: a greater than 4.1 cm b less than 4.13 cm c between 4.08 cm and 4.14 cm.
THINK a
1
WRITE
4.1
2
632
4.14.13
2
Pr(X < 4.13) can be found using the CAS as shown in previous examples. Write the solution and round to 4 decimal places. Draw a diagram and shade the region required.
c
4.08 4.14.14
Pr(4.08 < X < 4.14) can be found using the CAS as shown in previous examples. Write the solution and round to 4 decimal places.
Pr(4.08 < X < 4.14) = normCdf (4.08, 4.14, 4.1, 0.05) = 0.4436
REMEMBER
1. A CAS calculator can be used to calculate the probabilities associated with the normal distribution for any value of or using normCdf (x1, x2, , ). x1 and x2 are the lower and upper limits, respectively, of the interval for which you want to nd the probability. 2. Using the symmetrical nature of the standard normal curve, it can be seen that: Pr(Z > z) = 1 Pr(Z < z) Pr(Z > z) = Pr(Z < z). 3. To convert a given normal variable, x, to the standard normal variable, z, use x the rule z = . 4. With all normal distribution problems, > is equivalent to and < is equivalent to , since Pr(Z = z) = 0. EXERCISE
12F
Standardise the following X-values to Z-values: 40 if X N(25, 25) b X = 12 if X N(17, 9) 15 if X N(12, 6.25)
Chapter 12
Continuous distributions
633
3 The variable X is normally distributed with mean = 9 and standard deviation = 3. Standardise the following X-values: a X = 10 b X = 7.5 c X = 12.4 4 WE16 If X is normally distributed with = 40 and = 7, find, correct to 4 decimal places: a Pr(X > 42) b Pr(X 30) c Pr(X < 45) d Pr(X 27) e Pr(25 X 45) 5 If X N(20, 25), find, correct to 4 decimal places: a Pr(X > 27) b Pr(X 18) d Pr(7 X 12) e Pr(X < 17 | X 25) 6 WE17a a Pr( If Pr(Z > m) = 0.25, calculate: b Pr(Z > m) c Pr(X 8) f Pr(X < 17 | X < ) c Pr(Z < m)
7 WE17b If Pr(Z b) = 0.62 and Pr(Z < a) = 0.16, calculate: a Pr(a < Z < b) b Pr(Z < a | Z < b) If Pr(Z b) = 0.58 and Pr(a < Z < b) = 0.44, find Pr(Z < a). b) = 0.12 and Pr(a < Z < b) = 0.60, find Pr(Z > a). X is a normal random variable with mean 36 and standard deviation 4, and Z is the standard normal variable. a Find m if Pr(X < 30) = Pr(Z < m). b Find m if Pr(X > 43) = Pr(Z < m). 11 WE19 Light bulbs have a mean life of 125 hours and a standard deviation of 11 hours. Find the probability, correct to 4 decimal places, that a randomly selected light bulb lasts: a longer than 140 hours b less than 100 hours c between 100 and 140 hours. 12 The heights jumped by Year 9 high-jump contestants follow a normal distribution with a mean jump height of 152 cm and a variance of 49 cm. Find the probability, correct to 4 decimal places, that a competitor jumps: a at least 159 cm b less than 150 cm c between 145 cm and 159 cm d between 140 cm and 160 cm e between 145 cm and 150 cm, given that she jumped over 140 cm. 13 MC If Z has a standard normal distribution, then Pr(Z > 1.251) is: A 0.1054 B 0.3945 C 0.6055 D 0.6623 14 MC If Z N(0, 1), then Pr(Z < A 0.0987 B 0.4013
0.25)
E 0.8945 E 0.9013
is: C 0.5987
D 0.7124
15 MC The variable X is normally distributed with mean = 20 and standard deviation = 6. The standardised value of Z, for X = 29 is: A 1.5 B 1.15 C 0.483 D 1.15 E 1.5 16 MC Tennis balls are dropped from a height of 2 metres. The rebound height of the balls is normally distributed with a mean of 1.4 metres and a standard deviation of 0.1 metres. The probability that a ball rebounds more than 1.25 metres is: A 0.0668 B 0.2826 C 0.4332 D 0.7174 E 0.9332 17 MC The variable X is normally distributed with mean 70 and variance 12. The probability that X is greater than 77 is: A 0.0217 B 0.0429 C 0.0909 D 0.9091 E 0.9783
634 Maths Quest 12 Mathematical Methods CAS for the TI-Nspire
18 MC The life span of dogs is normally distributed with a mean of 12 years and a standard deviation of 2 years. The probability that a dog lives for less than 9 years is: A 0.0668 B 0.2826 C 0.2926 D 0.4332 E 0.9332 19 MC If X N(16, 4), then Pr(X > 11.5) equals: A 0.0122 B 0.0836 C 0.7217 D 0.9164 E 0.9878
20 The volume of milk in a 1-litre carton is normally distributed with a mean of 1.000 litres and a standard deviation of 0.006 litres. A randomly selected carton is known to have more than 1.004 litres. Find the probability, correct to 4 decimal places, that it has less than 1.011 litres. 21 Eye fillet steaks are cut with a mean weight of 82 grams and a standard deviation of 5 grams. Steaks are sold at different prices according to their weights, as shown in the table below. Weight (g) Cost ($) < 70 1.40 7080 1.60 8090 1.80 > 90 2.00
a Find the probability that a randomly selected steak weighs between 80 grams and 90 grams. Give your answer correct to 4 decimal places. b Find the probability that a randomly selected steak costs $2, correct to 4 decimal places. c Copy and complete the following table. Cost ($) Probability d Using your answers from part c, nd the average price of an eye llet steak. 22 The length of 6-cm nails is actually normally distributed with a mean length of 6 cm and a standard deviation of 0.03 cm. Only nails which are between 5.93 cm and 6.07 cm are acceptable and packaged accordingly. Find: a the probability of a randomly selected nail being an acceptable length, correct to 4 decimal places b the expected number of acceptable nails in a batch of 1000. 23 The length of fish caught in a certain river follows a normal distribution, with mean 32 cm and standard deviation 4 cm. Fish which are less than 27 cm are considered to be undersized and must be returned to the river. Find: a the probability that a sh is undersize, correct to 4 decimal places b the expected number of sh that a sherman could take home if he catches 20 sh in one afternoon and follows the rules for undersize sh. 24 The heights of students in Year 12 class were found to be normally distributed with mean of 171.2 cm and standard deviation of 5.2 cm. a What is the probability, correct to 4 decimal places, that a student has a height of: i greater than 168 cm? ii between 164 cm and 174 cm? iii greater than 179 cm, given that they are taller than 168 cm? b If a random sample of 10 students was chosen, what is the probability, correct to 4 decimal places, that 6 of the students would have a height greater than 168 cm? 25 Amy is a keen tennis player. The amount of time, in hours, she spends training each week is normally distributed with a mean of 8.4 hours and standard deviation of 1.8 hours. a Find, correct to 4 decimal places, the probability that: i she spends more than 10 hours training per week ii she spends more than 5 hours training per week, given that she spent less than 10.5 hours training per week. b What is the probability, correct to 4 decimal places, that of the next 5 weeks, Amy will spend at least 1 of them training more than 10 hours a week? 1.40 1.60 1.80 2.00
Chapter 12
Continuous distributions
635
12G
WORKED EXAMPLE 20
Find the value of c, correct to 3 decimal places, in the following. a Pr(Z < c) = 0.57 b Pr(Z c) = 0.91
THINK a
1
int-0587
Worked example 20
WRITE
To calculate Pr(Z < c) = 0.57, draw a diagram and shade the region required.
a 57%
0 c
2
As the shaded area is to the left of the unknown value, we can use invNorm straight away. On a Calculator page, press: MENU b 5:Probability 5 5:Distributions 5 3:Inverse Normal 3 Enter the values as shown. Note: As we are dealing with a Z variable, = 0 and = 1. Press ENTER .
c = invNorm(0.57, 0, 1) = 0.176
636
To calculate Pr(Z c) = 0.91, draw a diagram and shade the region required.
b 91%
c
2
For this example, the shaded area is to the right of the unknown value, so we subtract the given area from 1. Find the value of c using the CAS as shown above.
c = invNorm(0.09, 0, 1) = 1.341
WORKED EXAMPLE 21
Find the value of c in Pr(c < Z < c) = 0.9544. Give your answer correct to 3 decimal places.
THINK
1
WRITE
Draw a diagram of the situation. Label the unknown values as c1 and c2. Note: c1 = c2.
0.0228 0.9544 c1 0
0.0228
c2
Determine the probability of each of the unshaded areas by subtracting the given probability from 1 and dividing the result by 2.
Unshaded area =
3 4
Find Pr(Z < c2) by adding the probabilities. Find the value of c2 using the CAS as shown previously. Answer the question.
Therefore Pr(Z < c2) = 0.9544 + 0.0228 = 0.9772 c2 = invNorm(0.9772, 0, 1) = 1.999 Pr(1.999 < Z < 1.999) = 0.9554 c = 1.999
Chapter 12
Continuous distributions
637
If Z N(0, 12), nd, correct to 3 decimal places: a the 0.30 quantile b the 80th percentile.
THINK a
1
WRITE
a 0.30
c
2 3
Find the value of c using the CAS as shown previously. Write the solution. Answer the question, correct to 3 decimal places. Draw a diagram of the situation.
0.80
0
2 3
Find the value of c using the CAS as shown previously. Write the solution. Answer the question, correct to 3 decimal places.
WORKED EXAMPLE 23
X is normally distributed with a mean of 10 and a standard deviation of 2. Calculate x1, correct to 3 decimal places, if: a Pr(X x1) = 0.65 b Pr(X > x1) = 0.85.
THINK a
1
WRITE
0.65
10 x1
638
As the shaded area is to the left of the unknown value, we can use invNorm straight away. Note: This time we are dealing with an X variable, so the mean and standard deviation have changed from 0 and 1, respectively. From the information, = 10 and = 2. Enter the values as shown.
Press ENTER .
Write the solution and round to 3 decimal places. Draw a diagram and shade the region required.
b
x1
2
10
For this example, the shaded area is to the right of the unknown value, so we subtract the given area from 1. Find the value of c using the CAS as shown previously. Write the solution and round to 3 decimal places.
Pr(Z < x1) = 1 Pr(Z > x1) = 1 0.85 = 0.15 x1 = invNorm(0.15, 10, 2) = 7.927
WORKED EXAMPLE 24
If X is normally distributed with a mean of 52.3 and Pr(X < 48) = 0.229, calculate the standard deviation, correct to 2 decimal places.
Chapter 12
Continuous distributions
639
THINK
1
WRITE
We need to nd the standardised Z-value for the X-value of 48. As we know and for Z, we can use the invNorm function to nd the standardised value. Note: Even though z is rounded to 3 decimal places on the page, be sure to use the maximum number of decimal places in your subsequent working. Now we link the z-value to the x-value by x . the rule z =
z=
x =
REMEMBER
1. A CAS calculator can be used to calculate the value associated with a given probability for any value of or , by invNorm(A, , ). A must be the area to the left of the required value. 2. A percentile is a probability value expressed as a percentage while a quantile is a probability value expressed as a decimal. 3. When the standard deviation or mean is unknown, the standardised value, z, must be x found. The mean or standard deviation is then calculated using the rule z = . EXERCISE
12G
4 WE23 X is normally distributed with a mean of 10 and a standard deviation of 2. Find x1 if: a Pr(X x1) = 0.72 b Pr(X < x1) = 0.4 c Pr(X > x1) = 0.63 d Pr(X x1) = 0.2. 5 X is normally distributed with a mean of 34 and a standard deviation of 16. Find c if: a Pr(X > c) = 0.31 b Pr(X c) = 0.75 c Pr(X < c) = 0.21 d Pr(X c) = 0.55.
640
6 Let X N(22, 25). Find k if: a Pr(22 k X 22 + k) = 0.7 b Pr(22 k < X < 22 + k) = 0.24 c Pr(X < k | X < 23) = 0.32. 7 MC If Pr(Z c) = 0.8, then c equals: A 0.842 B 0.253 C 0.253 8 MC If Pr(Z > c) = 0.7, then c equals: A 0.524 B 0.496 C 0.496 9 MC If A 0.885 Pr(1.2 < Z < k) = 0.4, then k equals: B 0.253 C 0.038 D 0.524 D 0.524 D 0.253 D 0.385 D 0.253 E 0.842 E 0.553 E 0.885 E 0.675 E 0.215
10 MC If Z N(0, 1), then the 0.35 quantile is: A 0.675 B 0.385 C 0.350 11 MC If Pr(Z < k | Z < 0.5) = 0.6, then k equals: A 0.215 B 0.253 C 0
12 MC If X is normally distributed with a mean of 20 and a standard deviation of 4 and Pr(X < k) = 0.6, then k equals: A 18.99 B 19.49 C 20.51 D 21.01 E 21.79 13 MC If X N(12, 4) and Pr(X > k) = 0.82, then k equals: A 8.34 B 10.17 C 13.83 D 14.27 E 15.66
14 The height of Year 9 students is known to be normally distributed with a mean of 160 cm and a standard deviation of 8 cm. Answer the following; correct to 2 decimal places. a How tall is Theo if he is taller than 95% of Year 9 students? b How tall is Luisa if she is shorter than 80% of Year 9 students? 15 The length of nails manufactured as 45 mm are actually normally distributed with a mean of 45 mm and a standard deviation of 0.5 mm. The shortest 20% and longest 20% of nails manufactured are discarded before packaging and sold as seconds. Find correct to 2 decimal places: a the minimum length of packaged nails b the maximum length of packaged nails. 16 At a qualifying meeting, the time taken for runners to complete 400 metres follows a normal distribution, with a mean time of 50 seconds and a standard deviation of 2 seconds. If the fastest 25% of runners qualify for the next meeting, how fast would you need to run to qualify? Give your answer correct to 2 decimal places. 17 WE24 If X N(20, 2) and Pr(X 19) = 0.7, find the standard deviation, . 18 X is normally distributed with a mean of 50 and a standard deviation of . Forty per cent of X-values are less than 48. Find . 19 Weights of packaged rice are normally distributed with a mean of 500 grams. Ten per cent of packages are under 485 grams. Find the standard deviation. 20 If X N(, 16) and Pr(X 17) = 0.99, find the mean, . 21 X is normally distributed with a mean of and a standard deviation of 3. If 35% of X-values are at least 27, find the mean. 22 The time taken for grade 4 students to complete a small jigsaw puzzle follows a normal distribution with a standard deviation of 30 seconds. If 70% of grade 4 students complete the puzzle in 4 minutes or less, find the mean completion time for grade 4 students correct to 2 decimal places. 23 Bridget owns a fruit and vegetable shop. Being a keen mathematician as well, she knows that the weights of the watermelon she sells are normally distributed with a mean weight of 1.5 kg
Chapter 12
Continuous distributions
641
and a standard deviation of 0.2 kg. She classifies her watermelons as either large, medium or small. The heaviest 15% are classified as large, the lightest 15% are classified as small and the rest as medium. Find the range of weights, correct to 1 decimal place, for which: a a large watermelon is classied b a medium watermelon is classied.
eBoo k plus eBook
Digital doc
WorkSHEET 12.2
24 Mr Lim, a physics teacher, sets a particularly hard test for his students. He finds that the average mark is 54 and the standard deviation is 8. He decides to award the top 10% an A, and fail the bottom 10%. Find, correct to the nearest whole number: eBoo k plus eBook a the lowest mark required to achieve an A b the range of marks that a student who fails the test could have achieved. Digital doc
Investigation
Sunower stems
642
SUMMARY
Continuous random variables
Continuous random variables represent quantities that can be measured and thus may assume any value in a given range.
Probability density functions
If X is a continuous random variable, then the probability of it falling between certain values is given by the area under a frequency curve known as the probability density function or pdf. The probability density function must be greater than or equal to zero for all values of x, and the total area under the curve must be 1. That is, f(x) 0 for all x and f ( x )dx = 1. The domain of a probability density function is usually R, that is, the variable is continuous and can assume any real value (at least in theory). If we need our function to be non-zero over a particular interval only, say, over (a, b), then we need to specify that the function is equal to zero everywhere else. If a probability density function is only non-zero over a particular interval (a, b), the area under the curve between x = a and x = b must be 1. That is, a f ( x )dx = 1.
Finding probabilities using a probability density function
b
If X is a continuous random variable, then the probability of it falling between x = a and x = b is given by the area bounded by the probability density function, the x-axis and the lines x = a and x = b. That is, Pr (a X b) = Pr(x = a) = 0 Pr(x > a) = Pr(x a) To integrate over intervals involving innity, the limits are evaluated as follows. Interval (, ) (, a) (a, )
k
a f ( x)dx .
Limit lim
k f ( x) dx
k k k a
lim
f ( x ) dx f ( x ) dx
lim
1 1 = 0 and lim x = 0. x x e Quantiles and percentiles both dene the value of the random variable, X, below which a given proportion of the distribution falls. A quantile is a probability value expressed as a decimal, while a percentile is a probability value expressed as a percentage. As a number tends to innity, its reciprocal tends to zero. For example, lim
x
If X is a continuous random variable with a probability distribution function f (x) over the domain R, the mean of X can be found using the formula
= E (x) =
dx . xf ( x)d
Chapter 12
Continuous distributions
643
In general, E[g(x)] =
a g( x) f ( x)dx.
b
If f (x) has a certain rule for a X b and is zero elsewhere, then the mean can be obtained by using the formula = E(x) = xf ( x )d dx . a 1 The median value, m, of the continuous random variable, X, is a value such that Pr(X m) = 2 . To nd the median of X, solve for m the equation
f ( x )dx = 2 .
The mode is a value of X for which f (x) has its maximum. It is possible to have more than one mode. To nd the mode of a continuous random variable: sketch the graph of the probability density function rst if the probability density function of X has a maximum turning point in the interval [a, b], the mode is given by the x-coordinate of the turning point. It can be obtained by nding the derivative of f (x), making it equal to zero, and solving for x. if the probability density function continuously increases or decreases over the interval [a, b], or if it has a minimum turning point, the mode is then given by the end point of the interval (a or b) that corresponds to the maximum value of f (x).
Measures of spread
If X is a continuous random variable with a probability distribution function f(x) over the domain R, the variance of X can be found using the formula If f (x) has a certain rule for a X b and is zero elsewhere, then the variance can be obtained by using the formula Var(X) = E(x )2 =
b 2
dx x. Var(X) = E(x )2 = ( x )2 f ( x )d
The alternative formula for variance is Var(X) = E(X2) ()2. This can also be expressed as
b dx x xf ( x )d dx . a ( x)2 f ( x)d a The standard deviation of X can be found by taking the positive square root of the variance of
dx x. a ( x )2 f ( x)d
Var(X) =
Va X ) . X, that is, SD(X) = Var( The interquartile range (IQR) is the middle 50% of the distribution. IQR = 75th percentile 25th percentile.
Applications to problem solving
Always sketch diagrams to represent the required probability. Find probabilities by integrating the probability density function between the required values. This can be done manually or by using a CAS calculator.
The normal distribution
The normal distribution is the most important distribution associated with continuous random variables. The normal probability distribution is characterised by a bell-shaped curve which is symmetrical about the mean. The equation of the normal curve is given by the probability distribution function f ( x ) = when x = . 2 For the normal distribution, the same rules apply as for all other probability density functions: 1. f (x) 0 for all x, where x R. It has a maximum value of 2. 1
f(x)
x 2
f ( x)dx = 1, and
a b
f ( x )dx .
644
The normal distribution with mean, , and variance, 2, is written as X N(, 2). The common probabilities associated with the normal distribution are as follows: 1. Approximately 68% of the observations lie within one standard deviation of the mean.
68% x
2. Approximately 95% of the observations lie within two standard deviations of the mean, or we say that a value of x will most probably lie within two standard deviations of the mean.
2
95%
+ 2 x
3. Approximately 99.7% of the observations lie within three standard deviations of the mean, or we say that a value of x will almost certainly lie within three standard deviations of the mean.
99.7%
The parameters and have an effect on the normal distribution 3 + 3 x curve as follows: The mean, , controls the position of the curve. The standard deviation, , controls the width of the curve. Specically, the effect of the mean and the standard deviation on the normal distribution curve is: 1 1. dilation factor of from the x-axis 2. dilation factor of from the y-axis 3. translation of units in the positive x direction (for > 0).
The standard normal distribution is written as Z N(0, 12). x To convert a given normal variable, x, to the standard normal variable, z, use the rule z = . A CAS calculator can be used to calculate the probabilities associated with the normal distribution for any value of or using normCdf(x1, x2, , ). x1 and x2 are the lower and upper limits, respectively, of the interval for which you want to nd the probability. Using the symmetrical nature of the standard normal curve, it can be seen that: Pr(Z > z) = 1 Pr(Z < z)
0 z z
With all normal distribution problems, > is equivalent to and < is equivalent to , since Pr(Z = z) = 0.
The inverse cumulative normal distribution
A CAS calculator can be used to calculate the value associated with a given probability for any value of or , using invNorm(A, , ). A must be the area to the left of the required value. A percentile is a probability value expressed as a percentage while a quantile is a probability value expressed as a decimal. When the standard deviation or mean is unknown, the standardised value, z, must be found. The mean or x . standard deviation is then calculated using the rule z =
Chapter 12 Continuous distributions 645
CHAPTER REVIEW
SHORT ANSWER
1 2 ( 2 4 x ) , 0 x 2 1 a Sketch the graph of f (x) = . er ere 0, elsewhere
b State whether or not f (x) could be a probability density function. x, 0 x 4 2 a Sketch the graph of f (x) = er ere 0, elsewhere and explain why it is not a probability density function. b Adjust the function so that it could be a probability density function by adding a dilation coefcient, that is, by changing the rule to f (x) = a x and retaining the given domain. c Now adjust the left-hand-side end point of the domain so that f (x) could be a probability density function. That is, keep the rule unchanged, but replace 0 with an appropriate number in 0 x 4. 3 If X is a random variable with a probability density sin (2 x ), 0 < x < 2. function given by f (x) = 0 , elsewhere er ere Calculate: a Pr(X < 6 )
6
6 The cooking time (in minutes) of a single portion of rice in a particular microwave is a random variable, X, with a probability density function given by 1 , 4 x 6 f(x) = 2 . er ere 0, elsewhere a Lenas cookbook recommends to cook one portion of rice for 5.5 minutes. If Lena follows the instructions in her cookbook, what is the probability that the rice will not be ready? b What is the probability that it will take anywhere between 4 minutes and 36 seconds and 5 minutes and 15 seconds for the rice to cook? c If Lena wants to be 90% sure that her rice will be ready, what is the minimum cooking time she has to set on the microwave? 7 Draw a curve of the following normal distributions, showing an appropriate scale for each. a = 8 and = 1 b = 25 and = 8 c = 0 and = 3 8 Draw graphs of the following distributions. a X N(30, 64) b X N(8, 4) c X N(100, 100) 9 A normal distribution is given by X ~ N(22, 9). State what effect (in terms of transformations) the mean and standard deviation have on the graph of the distribution. 10 Weights of wooden sleepers are normally distributed with mean = 60 kg and standard deviation = 9 kg. Find the percentage of sleepers that are: a between 51 kg and 69 kg b between 42 kg and 78 kg c between 33 kg and 87 kg. 11 A normally distributed variable has = 19.6 and = 3.1. Find: a the range between which 68% of the values lie b the range between which 95% of the values lie
b Pr(X < X < 3 ). 4 Consider the random variable, X, with probability density function given by x 1, 1 x 2 f (x) = x + 3, 2 < x 3. 0, elsewhere Calculate: a Pr(1.5 < X < 2) b Pr(X < 2.5) c the mode d the median. 5 If X is a random variable with a probability density function given by kx, 0 < x < 4 f (x) = . er ere 0, elsewhere
646
c d e f
the range between which 99.7% of the values lie the value which has 16% of all values above it the value which has 2.5% of all values above it the value which has 0.15% of all values above it.
C III only
12 Standardise the following X-values to Z-values. a X = 26 if X N(22, 36) b X = 18 if X N(16, 16) c X = 56 if X N(50.9, 100) 13 If Pr(Z > p) = 0.72, calculate: a Pr(Z < p) b Pr(Z > p). 14 a If Pr(Z b) = 0.81 and Pr(a < Z < b) = 0.44, find Pr(Z < a). b If Pr(Z > b) = 0.36 and Pr(a < Z < b) = 0.24, nd Pr(Z < a). 15 X is a normal random variable with mean 27 and standard deviation 3, and Z is the standard normal variable. a Find m if Pr(X < 33) = Pr(Z < m). b Find m if Pr(X > 22.5) = Pr(Z < m). 16 Let X be a normally distributed random variable with a mean of 72 and a standard deviation of 8. Let Z be the standard normal random variable. Use the result that Pr(Z < 1) = 0.84, correct to 2 decimal places, to find: a the probability that X is greater than 80 b the probability that 64 < X < 72 c the probability that X < 64 given that X < 72.
EXAM TIP Some students did not clearly understand the relationship between the random variables X and Z. In part c, 47% of students scored 0/2. Most realised that conditional probability was required but were not able to apply it correctly.
[Assessment report 1 2006]
2 X is a random variable with probability density n( (4 x ), a x b 2 sin function dened as f (x) = . er ere 0, elsewhere The values of a and b respectively are: A 0, D
4 3 , 2 4
, 4 2
C 0,
E 0,
a , 1 x 2 3 The value of a such that f (x) = x 2 0, elsewhere er ere could be a probability density function is: A
1 2
B 1 E 4
C 2
D 3
4 If X is a random variable with a probability density 2 (4 x ) ), , 1 x 2 function dened by f (x) = 5 , er ere 0, elsewhere then Pr(X > 1.2) can be obtained by evaluating: A
1.2
2 (4 5
x )d dx x x )d dx x
1.2 2 (4 5 2
x )d dx x x )d dx x
C 1 E
1.2 2 (4 5 1
D 1
2 (4 1.2 5
[ VCAA 2006]
5 If X is a random variable with a probability density 1 , 0x4 function dened by f(x) = 4 and er ere 0, elsewhere Pr (X < a) = 0.625, the value of a is: A 1.5 B 2 C 2.5 D 3 E 3.5 Questions 6 to 9 refer to the random variable, X, with the probability density function given by
4 x 2, 1 x 4 f (x) = 3 . er ere 0, elsewhere
2 2 (4 5 1
x )d dx x
MULTIPLE CHOICE
1 Which of the following could be a probability density function? 3, 0 x 1 3 i f (x) = 0 , elsewhere er ere
1 2, 2 x 0 ii f (x) = 0, elsewhere
6 The mean of X correct to 4 decimal places is: A 1.8484 B 2.0000 C 2.5000 D 2.8484 E 3.8484 7 The median of X is: A D A
4 3 15 8 1 12
B E B
8 5 8 15 1 12 4 3
5 8
D 1
E 4
647
Chapter 12
Continuous distributions
X1 ~ N( 1, 12) X2 ~ N( 2, 22)
1 3x dx ( 5 )
4
1 3x dx ( 8 )
4
O
2
4 dx 3x 2
4 4 3
()
8 5
4 x D 3 1 4 x E 3 1
4 3
A B C D E
1 > 2 and 1 = 2. 1 > 2 and 1 > 2 1 = 2 and 1 > 2 1 = 2 and 1 < 2 1 < 2 and 1 = 2
[ VCAA 2003]
Questions 10 to 11 refer to the following information. The length of time (in minutes) of a gentlemans haircut at the hairdressers is a continuous random variable with a probability density function given 0 . 3e 0.3 x , x 0 by f (x) = . er ere 0, elsewhere
15 The random variable X has a normal distribution with mean 20 and standard deviation 4. If the random variable Z has the standard normal distribution, then the probability that X is more than 24 is equal to: A Pr(Z < 1) B 1 Pr(Z > 1) C Pr(Z < 1) D Pr(Z > 1) E 1 Pr(Z < 1) 16 If Z has a standard normal distribution, then Pr(Z > 1.111) is: A 0.1333 B 0.1335 C 0.1357 D 0.8665 E 0.8667 17 X is normally distributed with mean = 16 and standard deviation = 5. The standardised value for X = 22 is: A 1.2 B 1.0625 C 1.0625 D 1.2 E 1.5 18 The standing long jump distances of NBL basketballers is known to follow a normal distribution with a mean of 1.4 metres and a standard deviation of 0.25 metres. The probability that an NBL player has a standing long jump of at least 1.6 metres is: A 0.0013 B 0.0228 C 0.2119 D 0.3446 E 0.4207 19 If X N(8, 4), then Pr(X < 9.25) equals: A 0.5311 B 0.6228 C 0.7340 D 0.9223 E 0.9991 20 If X is normally distributed with a mean of 13 and a standard deviation of 4 and Pr(x < k) = 0.71, then k equals: A 9.18 B 10.79 C 15.21 D 16.81 E 18.11
10 The probability that Alexs haircut will take longer than a quarter of an hour is: A 0.0521 B 0.0498 C 0.9502 D 0.0111 E 0.9889 11 The probability that Alexs haircut will take longer than a quarter of an hour, given that it has already taken 10 minutes is: A 0.2231 B 0.0117 C 0.0524 D 0.0112 E 0.0504 12 Scores on a certain test are known to be normally distributed. Approximately 95% of the scores attained are between 26 and 74. The mean and standard deviation respectively are: A 48 and 6 B 48 and 8 C 48 and 12 D 50 and 6 E 50 and 12 13 If X N(27, 16), then approximately 95% of the values would lie in the range: A 5 X 59 B 9 X 39 C 0 X 54 D 19 X 35 E 23 X 31 14 The diagram below shows the graphs of two normal distribution curves with means 1 and 2 and standard deviations 1 and 2 respectively.
648
EXTENDED RESPONSE
1 Maya lives in Melbourne, and her sister Rosa lives in Perth. Every Saturday evening they talk on the phone. The length of their conversations (in minutes) is a continuous random variable, X, with a probability density function given by 0 . 09 0 9e 0 . 0 9 x , x 0 f(x) = . er ere 0, elsewhere a What is the probability, correct to 4 decimal places, that next Saturday the two sisters will talk for: i more than 10 minutes? EXAM TIP Students should take care in writing an ii more than 20 minutes? integral that will yield the correct answer as part of iii more than half an hour? their working. Students often do not gain full marks
on questions if they do not show any working.
[Assessment report 2 2005 VCAA]
b What is the probability that the sisters will talk for less than three-quarters of an hour, given that they have been talking for at least 20 minutes? Give your answer correct to 4 decimal places. c Mayas son Michael lives in London. He always calls Maya every Saturday at 7 pm. What is the latest time that Maya should call her sister Rosa to be at least 95% certain that they will have enough time to chat (i.e. that they will nish by 7 pm)? Give your answer to the nearest minute. d Mayas phone company charges 60 cents per call for all calls to Perth under 10 minutes duration, $1.40 per call for calls over 10 minutes and under 20 minutes duration, and $2 per call for calls between 20 minutes and 30 minutes duration. All calls with duration of over 30 minutes are capped at $2.50. (That is, a call of any length above 30 minutes will cost $2.50.) Find the expected cost of Mayas call to the nearest cent. 2 Shoelaces sold as 50 cm are manufactured at a certain factory. However, the lengths actually follow a normal distribution with a mean of 50 cm. Quality control managers at the shoelace factory check the lengths of all laces manufactured and follow the rules below: i If a lace is greater than 53 cm, it is classed as oversize and sold as a 55 cm lace. ii If a lace is smaller than 47 cm, it is classed as undersize and sold as a 45 cm lace. iii If a lace is between 47 cm and 53 cm, it is classed as adequate and sold as a 50 cm lace. If 90% of laces are adequate, nd: a the standard deviation, correct to 2 decimal places b the percentage of oversize laces c the percentage of undersize laces d the probability of a lace being adequate, given that it is not undersize, correct to 4 decimal places. 3 The time taken for Year 7 students to read a certain page of writing follows a normal distribution with standard deviation of 20 seconds. If 80% of students read the page in less than 3 minutes, find: a the mean time taken to read the page, correct to 1 decimal place b the probability that a student will take longer than 3.5 minutes to read the page, correct to 4 decimal places c the probability that a student will take between 2.5 and 3.5 minutes to read the page, correct to 4 decimal places d the speed with which 90% of students exceed in reading the page, correct to 2 decimal places. 4 A jeweller knows that the diameter of wedding rings follows a normal distribution, with a mean of 18 mm and a standard deviation of 1 mm. Find the probability that a customer requires a ring with a diameter that is: a greater than 20.5 mm b less than 19 mm c greater than 19 mm, given that it is less than 20.5 mm.
649
Chapter 12
Continuous distributions
5 The lengths of fish caught in a particular river are normally distributed with a mean of 28 cm. Ninety per cent of fish caught are longer than 25 cm. Find: a the standard deviation for the length of sh caught in the river b the probability of catching a sh that is longer than 30 cm from this river c the maximum length of sh that must be thrown back, if the shortest 30% must be returned to the river. 6 The amount of time, in hours, that Emily spends training for the Ironwoman Championships is a continuous random variable, with probability density function given by 4 ( x 1)3 , 1 < x < 4 f ( x ) = 81 . 0, elsewhere a What is the probability that she spends less than 2.5 hours training per week? b What is the mean number of hours she trains each week? c What is the median time, correct to the nearest minute, she spends training each week? 7 Each night Kim goes to the gym or the pool. a When she goes to the pool, the time she spends swimming is normally distributed with a mean of 60 minutes. Twenty per cent of the time she swims for less than 50 minutes. Find the standard deviation in minutes, correct to 1 decimal place, of the time she spends swimming. When Kim goes to the gym, the time, T hours, that she spends working out is a continuous random variable with probability density function given by 4t 3 2 4t 2 + 4 4t 2 4, if 1 t 2 f (t ) = . er ere 0, elsewhere b Sketch the graph of y = f (t). Label any stationary points with their coordinates, correct to 2 decimal places. c What is the probability, correct to 3 decimal places, that she spends less than 75 minutes working out when she goes to the gym? d What is the probability, correct to 2 decimal places, that she spends more than 75 minutes working out on 4 out of the 5 next times she goes to the gym? e Find the median time, to the nearest minute, that she spends working out in the gym.
[ VCAA 2006] [
Test Yourself
Chapter 12
650
eBook plus
ACTIVITIES
Chapter opener
Digital doc
10 Quick Questions: Warm up with ten quick questions on continuous distributions. (page 589)
12A
Tutorial
WE1 int-0582: Watch a worked example on verifying density functions. (page 591)
12B Using a probability density function to find probabilities of continuous random variables
Digital doc
Tutorial
WE 5 int-0583: Watch a worked example on sketching density functions and calculating probabilities. (page 598)
12C Measures of central tendency and spread
Tutorials
WE 7 int-0584: Watch a worked example on calculating the mean, median and mode of a probability density function. (page 605) WE 9 int-0585: Watch a worked example on nding the mean median and standard deviation of a probability distribution using a CAS calculator. (page 609)
12D Applications to problem solving
Digital doc
WE 20 int-0587: Watch a worked example on inverse normal calculations using a CAS calculator. (page 636)
Digital docs
WorkSHEET 12.2: For normal distributions calculate standard deviations, means and probabilities. (page 642) Investigation: Sunower stems (page 642)
Chapter review
Digital doc
WorkSHEET 12.1: Using the cumulative normal distribution table. (page 618)
12E The normal distribution
Interactivity int-0257
Test Yourself: Take the end-of-chapter test to test your progress. (page 650)
To access eBookPLUS activities, log on to www.jacplus.com.au
The normal distribution: Consolidate your understanding of the normal distribution. (page 619)
Tutorial
WE 13 int-0586: Watch a worked example on using condence intervals to determine probabilities. (page 620)
Chapter 12
Continuous distributions
651
EXAM PRACTICE 4
SHORT ANSWER
25 minutes
CHAPTERS 1 TO 12
1 Student scores in an exam are standardised so that the mean is 30 and the standard deviation is 7. Students are awarded a C if their standardised score lies between 30 and 37. Assuming that the student results are normally distributed, estimate to the nearest 5% the percentage of students who would receive a C.
1 mark
c What is the probability that a patron will purchase a coffee on Tuesday? d Write down a matrix expression that could be used to calculate the probability that a patron will purchase a coffee on Friday.
4 marks
MULTIPLE CHOICE
10 minutes
2 Two events A and B from a given event space have 1 1 probabilities Pr(A) = and Pr(B) = . 6 4 1 a Calculate Pr(A B ) if Pr(A B) = . 10 1 b Calculate Pr(A | B ) if Pr(A B) = . 10 c Calculate Pr(A B ) if A and B are mutually exclusive events. d Calculate Pr(A B ) if A and B are independent events.
4 marks
Each question is worth 1 mark. 1 One normally distributed variable has a variance of 4. Another has a variance of 0.25. Which of the graphs below would best represent these variables? A
0 2 4 6 8 10
B
0 2 4 6 8 10
C
0 2 4 6 8 10
3 The probability of Karen Gouch shooting a basket from the free throw line is 0.8, given her team is winning the game, and 0.6, given her team is losing. The team wins 7 out of 10 games. a What is Karen Gouchs overall percentage of baskets from the free throw line? b If Karen throws a basket from the free throw line, what is the probability that her team is winning?
2 marks
D
0 2 4 6 8 10
E
0 2 4 6 8 10
4 Claude has a coffee shop. He sells coffee and biscotti. He realises that if a person buys a coffee on a particular day, there is a 75% probability that the person will return and buy coffee the next day and a 20% probability that they will buy biscotti the next day. In addition, if a person buys biscotti one day, there is a 60% probability that they will purchase biscotti the next day and a 30% probability that they will buy coffee the next day. On Monday, 90% of Claudes patrons bought coffee and 40% bought biscotti. a Determine a transition matrix, T, that models this situation. b Determine the initial state matrix, S.
652
2 Paddy Beam averages one ace in every 5 serves, but each serve is independent of any other. In one particular game Paddy serves 7 times. What is the probability that 3 of the serves are aces? 1 A 5
3
7 1 4 B 3 5 5
3 4
7 3 4 C 3 7 7 5 7 3 1 12 4
7 5 3 1 12 4
3 A discrete random variable X has the following probability distribution. x Pr(X = x) 0 0.1 1 0.1 2 0.4 3 0.3 4 0.1
The standard deviation of X correct to 2 decimal places is: A 0.80 B 1.04 C 1.08 D 1.16 E 1.35 4 If a random variable X has a probability density ax 2 3 if x [ 1,3 , ] function f ( x ) = 0, elsewhere then a is:
EXTENDED RESPONSE
39 1 C 28 10 1 18 D E 8 26 5 A random variable X has a normal distribution with mean 12 and standard deviation 0.25. If the random variable Z has the standard normal distribution, then the probability that X is less than 12.5 is equal to: A Pr(Z > 2) B 1 Pr(Z < 2) C Pr(Z > 2) D 1 Pr(Z > 2) E Pr(Z < 2) A 1.29 B
25 minutes
The graph of the probability density function for the standard normal distribution (mean = 0, variance = 1) is plotted below. y x 1 e 2 It has the rule f: R R, where f ( x ) = . 0.5 2 a Evaluate: 2.5 2 1.5 1 0.5 0 0.5 1 1.5 2 2.5 i f (2) 0.5 ii f (1) to an accuracy of 3 decimal places.
2
1 + 1 = 2 marks 1 mark
c Exact integration of f is not possible. However, it is possible to obtain an approximate value by using a rectangular approximation. By using four intervals of equal width, determine a rectangular approximation to the area bound by the graph of f, the y-axis, the x-axis and the line x = 1.
d The area under a probability density function represents the probability. Use your answer to part c to determine an approximate value for the probability that a value of x lies within 1 standard deviation from the mean (that is, that x lies in the interval [1, 1]). e Use your CAS calculator to determine an approximation for the area dened in part c to an accuracy of 3 decimal places. f The innite series approximation to ex is e x 1 + x + 1 2 x 2 x 4 x 6 x8 + + ) 2 8 48 384 . + + K 2 6 24 Use this approximation to show that f (x) can be approximated by g(x) where g( x ) (1 x2 x3 x4
2 marks
1 mark
1 mark
g Sketch the graph of g for 2 x 2 onto the graph of f provided at the start of this question. h Determine an approximation for
3 marks 2 marks
g( x) dx.
eBook plus
Digital doc
Solutions
Exam practice 4
Exam practice 4
653
Answers
CHAPTER 1
4 a C b B 5 a (x 2)(x + 3)2 b (3x 1)(x + 2)(x 6) c (x + 2)(x 2)(x + 3)(x 1) d 4x(x + 1)(x + 4)(x 2) 6 a x = 3, 0 or 2 b x = 4, 3, 0 or 2 c x = 2, 3 or 2 d x = 1 2 7 a = 2 8 a = 5 9 a = 7 10 a = 10, b = 26 11 a = 9, b = 11 Exercise 1D Linear graphs y y 1 a b
5 4 0 6 x
2 0 x
y 0
1 2
2 3 4 5 6 7 8
a a D a c a d a d a
b 2x + y + 5 = 0 b y - x + 2 = 0 b y 3x + 7 = 0 v i (5, ) R b c f c f iv ii [2, 3) (, 6)
5 x
ii 8 b e b e
y 0 2
6 0 8 x (12, 3)
iv iv iv iv
1 14 7 19
i (, 5) ii (, 0)
0 2
3 2
d
3 20 27
14 i [2, 5) ii [ 2 3, 3 )
654
Answers
2 a
y 8
y 1 2 1 2 3 4 x
4 0 2 4 x 0 1 y 4 x
1 , 3 ) 4 ( 2 4 6
y = x2 x 1, x R
y 10
d
1 1 3
i R+ c (
10, 128)
11 2
ii (,
y 100
3 4]
5 x
12
3 a (3, 1)
1 c (1 1 2 , 12 4 )
b d ii ii ii ii ii ii ii
5 9 (2 , 4 ) 1 1 (12 , 12 24 )
f(x) x2 3x 2 10 8 6 4 2 0
1, ) 4 1 50 (1 2 4 (6, 16)
2 4 6 x
iii iii iii iii iii iii iii y 2 y0 y 0 y 6 [2, ) [3, ) [16, 9]
x
21 2
i [10, 6]
y
ii [4 1 4 , 128]
(1, 8)
4 5 6
a b c d a b c a
i i i i i i i
R R R R R [1, ) [4, 4) b
11 2
y 1 2
12 a 13 a c 14 a d e
i [5, 3) ii [-100, 8] 8 m3 b 80 m3 48 m b 6 s Domain = [0, 6], range = [0, 48] 12 m b 6 s c 48 m Domain = [0, 11], range = [12, 48]
h 48 (0, 48) 36 24 12 (11, 37)
15
1 0.09 1.5 8
(6, 12) 6 11 t
2.91 x
7 a B 8 D 9 A 10 a
b C
y x
b
4
( 4, 9)
1 0 7
(2, 4)
y 3
y 1 0 6 (1, 8) 3 x
y 24
y 18
Answers 1a 1f
10
2 3
3 ( 2, 1)
1 0 y 10
11 a
(
2, 10)
4 a B 5 C 6 A 10 a
7 B
b E 8 D
9 E
2 5 y = x 2x 2 (2, 2) 2 (1, 1)
8 4 0 1 2 x
2 1 0
i [2, 2]
ii [1, 10]
i [2, )
ii [0, )
Answers
655
y 4 (
1, 0)
1 0 (
2,
32)
2 3
c
2 x
2
y 4
0 0 y 36 2 x
5 2
i [2, 1] y c
3 0
ii [32, 0]
4 3
(1, 8)
3 x
0 3 2
2 3
36 (0, 36)
2 a ii (36, 8]
i (0, 1] y d
(
1, 4) 0 x
(1.15, 2.08)
(2, 0)
(3, 0) x
i [1, 2) y e
ii (14, 4]
(3, 33)
(2.59, 1.62)
b
(
1, 0)
(1, 0) 0 (0, 1) x
( 1, 3) ( 2, 12)
i [2, 1) (0, 3] y f
(
1, 3) 0 (1,
3) (2,
18) (3,
57) x
i 1) [2, 3) ii (57, 18] (3, 3) 24 11 a = 6, b = 12 a = 7, b = 4 13 a a = 3, b = 3, c = 3 and f (x) = 3(x 3)3 + 3 b g(x) = 3(x + 3)3 + 3, domain = [4, 2], range = [0, 6] c 7 cm 14 a a = 1 4, b = 5 (5 t ) , domain = [0, 5] b d (t ) = t 2 4 c d (km) d(t) = t2 5
t
4
(1,
5 4 3 (2, 3) 2 1 0 1 2 3 4 5 t (h)
( 2, 0)
(1, 0)
3 1 0
2 0 1 2
3 4
a c e a b
656
Answers
5 a
3
2
y 0 2 x
( 2, 400)
24
i [2, 3] ii
[30,
y
0] i
2 x
(2, 1]
2 1
Multiple choice 1 E 2 5 C 6 9 E 10 13 E 14 17 A 18 21 C
B C D B E
3 7 11 15 19
A C A C D
4 8 12 16 20
D B D B A
ii [36, 400)
0 1 4
Extended response 1 a y = 2.24 (x + 2.5)2 + 4 b Domain [5, 0], range [4, 18] c (1.83, 5) d f : [3.17, 1.83] R, f(x) = 5 2 a 0 km b d (1000 km)
( 3, 45)
(1, 4)
(2, 16) 0
i (, 2] ii (, 16]i [3, 2] ii [45, 0] 6 a = 4, b = 19 7 a = 1, b = 7 8 a = 3, b = 1 Chapter review Short answer 1 a 32y5 240y4x + 720y3x2 1080y2x3 + 810yx4 243x5 x8 x6 7 x 4 224 448 + 14 x 2 + 70 2 + 4 b 256 8 4 x x 512 256 + 8 x6 x 2 a = 15, b = 2 3 a (x 9)(x + 2)(x 5) b (2x 3)(x + 1)(x + 6)(x 2) 4 a 7x + 6y 1 = 0 b x + 2y 9 = 0 y 5
(
1, 9) 8
(3, 0) t (days)
3 4
3 6t 2 + 9t c d = t d The satellite by 40 000 km e 10 days f Domain = [0, 10], range = [0, 490] a y = 3 0.75x2 b y = 1.3125, so cannot fit. c Reduce the height by 0.4 m.
x (m) 10
Domain = R, range = (, 9] y 6
3 0
1 3
, 25 ) ( 4 3 3
Range = [ 25 , 0] 3 7 a a = 9, b = 2 y b
3 0 2 3 x
Liney: Starts 2.4 m in front of start line moving forwards at a constant 0.75 m/min. Passed by Cubric after 0.3 min and 2.6 m from the start line, meets Cubric coming back towards Liney at 3.8 min and 5.24 m from the start line. Quadder: Starts at start line, travelling 1.3 m the wrong way for 2.55 min, stopping momentarily then moving forward with increasing speed. Meets Cubric at the start line after 5.1 min. Cubric: Starts at start line moving very fast towards the finish passing Liney at (0.3, 2.6), then slowing, stopping momentarily at (2.1, 8.8), then moving back towards the start. Meets Liney at (3.8, 5.24) and Quadder at the start line at 5.1 min. Slows down, stopping at (7.37, 5.8) and then speeding for the finish.
x (m) 10.2 Q (10.1, 10.1) (10.07, 10) (10.092, 10) (10.0899, 9.97) (10.04, 9.9) 10 C 10.15 t (min) L (10.13, 10)
Answers 1g 1G
18
y 1 0 2 4 x
10.1 10 9.9
16
Answers
657
The Finish: Quadder overtakes Limey at (10.04, 9.9). Cubric overtakes Limey at (10.0899, 9.97). Quadder finishes the race in 10.07 min, Cubric in 10.09 min, Liney in 10.13 min. Quadder wins by 1.2 s, Cubric second by 2.4 s to Liney. 5 a C is (3, 0) and D is (2.25, 8.54) b y = x4 3x3 c 2 km d Yes, because a straight route from O to D to C is approximately 17.4 km and the river course is longer than this. 6 a y = 1 4 (x + 3)(x + 1)(x 1)(x 3) 7 8
1 b (4, 26 1 4 ) and ( 4, 26 4 ) c Domain [4, 4] d (2.236, 4) and (2.236, 4); range [4, 26 1 4] 2 2 ( x 2.236) ( x + 2.236) e y = 1 4 f Domain [4, 4], range = [0, 30 1 4] Teacher to check the model 2( x x 75) a y = 6250 b 46.72 m c Seems to be extremely low 2 km from touchdown. Not very accurate. 3( x 4)2 ( x + 4)2 a y = 256 3(
4 a c 5 E 6 a c e 7 a b c 8 9 d e f a b c d a b c d e
b y = c i
x 4)2 ( x + 2) 32
x2 3 4 ( x 4)2 y= ii ; the gradients are 1 and 2, 2 respectively, so not smooth. iii Teacher to check d Cubic is the closest, 1.6875 m.
CHAPTER 2
2 y= 1 2 (x 2) + 2 2+6 y = 3(x 1) y = 4(x + 2)2 + 8 y = 2x2 y = 2x2 y = 2(x + 1)2 y = 2(x + 1)2 + 3 (x, y) (x, y) (x, 3y) (2x, y) x ( , y) 3 f (x + 2, y) g (x, y 1) 10 a z = 3 or z = 15 2 b y = 2(x 3)2 8 or y = 25 (x 15)2 8 11 a 3 2 b y = 1 3 (x + 4) + 3 7, x = 1 c x = 12 1. f(x + 2) 3, 4 x 0 2. f(x 2) 3, 0 x 4 3. f(x + 4), 6 x 2 4. f(x 4), 2 x 6 5. f(x + 4) + 6, 6 x 2 6. f(x) + 6, 2 x 2 7. f(x 4) + 6, 2 x 6 8. f(x + 2) + 9, 4 x 0 9. f(x 2) + 9, 0 x 4 Exercise 2B The cubic function in power form 1 a Dilation from the x-axis by the factor of 7 b Dilation from the x-axis by the factor of 2 3 , reflection in the x-axis c Translation by 4 units up d Reflection in the x-axis, translation by 6 units up e Translation by 1 unit to the right f Reflection in the x-axis, translation by 3 units to the left g Dilation from the x-axis by the factor of 4, reflection in the y-axis, translation by 2 units to the right h Dilation from the x-axis by the factor of 6, reflection in the x-axis, reflection in the y-axis, translation by 7 units to the right i Dilation from the x-axis by the factor of 3, translation by 3 units to the left, translation by 2units down j Dilation from the x-axis by the factor of 1 2 , reflection in the x-axis, translation by 1 unit to the right, translation by 6 units up k Dilation from the x-axis by the factor of 2, translation 5 by 2 units to the left l Dilation from the x-axis by the factor of 1 4 , reflection in the x-axis, translation by 8 units to the left, translation by 3 units up 2 a i, iv b iii, v c ii d i, ii, iv e ii, v f iii, iv
658
Answers
3 a i (0, 0) ii (0, 0) iii There are no translations, but there is a dilation of 3 4. b i (0, 1) ii (0.8, 0), (0, 1) iii There is a reflection in the x-axis, a translation of 1 unit up, and a dilation of 2. c i (0, 6) ii (2.08, 0), (0, 6) iii There is a translation of 6 down and a dilation of 2 3. d i (4, 0) ii (4, 0), (0, 128) iii There is a translation of 4 right and a dilation of 2. e i (2, 0) ii (2, 0), (0, 4) iii There is a reflection in the x-axis, a translation of 2 right, and a dilation of 1 2. f i (1, 0) ii (1, 0), (0, 4) iii There is a reflection in the y-axis, a translation of 1 right, and a dilation of 4. g i (1, 2) ii (0.3, 0), (0, 1) iii There is a translation of 1 right and 2 up. h i (2, 3) ii (0.6, 0), (0, 5) iii There is a reflection in the x-axis and a translation of 2 left and 3 up. i i (1, 6) ii (0.4, 0), (0, 4) iii There is a translation of 1 left and 6 down, and a dilation of 2. y y 3 a iv b iv
1 x 0.8 x
4 E 7 a y = 8 c e a c
1 2
x3
5 C
9 a y =
x3 + 4
(x 3)3
y (x 1)3 27 4 3 1 x
c iv
d iv
y 4 x
2.08
128
e iv
y 4
f iv
y 4
g iv
y 2 1 0.3 1
h iv
y 3
2 0.6 5
i iv
1
y x
0.4 4 6
Exercise 2CThe power function (the hyperbola) 1 a Dilation from the x-axis by the factor of 2 b Dilation from the x-axis by the factor of 3, reflection in the x-axis c Translation by 6 units to the right d Dilation from the x-axis by the factor of 2, translation by 4 units to the left e Translation by 7 units up f Dilation from the x-axis by the factor of 2, translation by 5 units down g Translation by 4 units to the left, translation by 3units down h Dilation from the x-axis by the factor of 2, translation by 3 units to the right, translation by 6 units up i Dilation from the x-axis by the factor of 4, reflection in the x-axis, translation by 1 unit to the right, translation by 4 units down 2 a v b iii c i d v, iii e v, ii, iii f i, iii g v, i, iv h ii, iv 3 a i x = 0, y = 0 ii Domain: R \ {0} iii Range: R \ {0} b i x = 6, y = 0 ii Domain: R \ {6} iii Range: R \ {0} c i x = 2, y = 0 ii Domain: R \ {2} iii Range: R \ {0} d i x = 3, y = 0 ii Domain: R \ {3} iii Range: R \ {0} e i x = 0, y = 4 ii Domain: R \ {0} iii Range: R \ {4} f i x = 0, y = 5 ii Domain: R \ {0} iii Range: R \ {5} g i x = 6, y = 2 ii Domain: R \ {6} iii Range: R \ {2} h i x = 2, y = 1 ii Domain: R \ {2} iii Range: R \ {1} i i x = n, y = m ii Domain: R \ {n} iii Range: R \ {m} 4 a i x = 4, y = 0 ii Domain: R \ {4} iii Range: R \ {0} b i x = 0, y = 2 ii Domain: R \ {0} iii Range: R \ {2} c i x = 3, y = 2 ii Domain: R \ {3} iii Range: R \ {2}
Answers
659
Answers 2A 2C
l
y4
y 10 8 6 4 2
(2, 11)
0 2 4 6 4 2 (0, 3) x1
4 3x
7 E 2 9 a y = x2 c y = 3 x+4 2 e y = + 2 x4 y 10 a
x
1
2
1 2
8 C b y = d y =
x
4x 3
3 +1 x
6 a
3
y
1 3
b
x
y
1
2
4 1 x 6 f y = 1 x +1 y b
1 x
1 x
2 1
c
5
2
5
y
1
2
y 3 2
3 4 3 3 4
1 5
x
1 1 1 2
y 3 1 3
y
1 7 2
6 x 2
1 2 2
g
1
y 4
2 5 2 5
2 1
1 (0, 1 ) 2
1 2
11 1
x 0
y1 x
(3, 0)
y
1 4 3
j
1
3
y x 2
1 3 4 4
5 1 8
3 2
11
3 y 10 8 6 4 2
1 3
y
x3 x 2
y 1
Exercise 2DThe power function (the truncus) 1 a Dilation from the x-axis by a factor of 2 b Dilation from the x-axis by a factor of 3, reflection in the x-axis c Translation by 2 units to the left d Dilation from the x-axis by a factor of 2, translation by 3 units to the right
660
Answers
e Dilation from the x-axis by a factor of 5, reflection in the x-axis, translation by 4 units to the left f Dilation from the x-axis by a factor of 2, translation by 6 units up g Reflection in the x-axis, translation by 3 units up h Dilation from the x-axis by a factor of 4, translation by 3 units to the right, translation by 1 unit up i Reflection in the x-axis, translation by 2 units to the left, translation by 5 units up 2 D 3 C 4 a i x = 0, y = 0 ii Domain R \ {0} iii Range: y > 0 b i x = 0, y = 0 ii Domain R \ {0} iii Range: y < 0 c i x = 2, y = 0 ii Domain R \ {2} iii Range: y > 0 d i x = 1, y = 0 ii Domain R \ {1} iii Range: y > 0 e i x = 4, y = 0 ii Domain R \ {4} iii Range: y < 0 f i x = 0, y = 3 ii Domain R \ {0} iii Range: y > 3 ii Domain R \ {0} g i x = 0, y = 4 5 iii Range: y > iii Range: y <
4 5
y
1 3 4
3 2 x 1 1 2 3 x
9 a y =
1 + n ( x m) 2 1 c y = ( x r )2
1 b y = ( x + q)2 + p d y = f y = 1 +t x2 1 e ( x g)2
1 b ( x + a)2 1 g y = 2 k x 2 10 a y = 2 2 x e y = c y = e y = 11 y =
h y =
9 + 1 ( x + 2)2
8 3 ( x 4)2
f y =
h i x = 0, y = 1 2
1 2
ii Domain R \ {0}
3 3 ( x + 2)2
y
1 8
y x
e
2
y 1 2 x
f
0.4
0.4
y 4
2 1 2
7 3 9
3.7 3 2.3
y
11 12 2 3
Exercise 2EThe square root function in power form 1 a Dilated from the x-axis by a factor of 2 b Dilated from the x-axis by a factor of 1 3 , reflected in the x-axis c Dilated from the x-axis by a factor of 3, translated 1 unit to the right d Dilated from the x-axis by a factor of 2, reflected in the x-axis, translated 4 units to the left e Translated 1 unit down f Dilated from the x-axis by a factor of 3, reflected in the x-axis, translated 2 units up g Translated 4 units to the right, translated 3 units up h Dilated from the x-axis by a factor of 2, reflected in the x-axis, translated 3 units to the left, translated 6 units up i Dilated from the x-axis by a factor of 1 2 , reflected in the x-axis, reflected in the y-axis, translated 2 units to the right and 2 3 units up 2 a (0, 0) b (0, 0) c (1, 0) d (4, 0) e (0, 1) f (0, 2) g (4, 3) h (3, 6) i (2, 2 3) 3 E 4 D 5 a Domain: x 1, range: y 0 b Domain: x 3, range: y 0 c Domain: x 0, range: y 3 d Domain: x 0, range: y 4 e Domain: x 0, range: y 5 f Domain: x 1, range: y 3 g Domain: x 2, range: y 1 , range: y 4 h Domain: x 1 2 i j k l Domain: x 4 3 , range: y 2 Domain: x 3, range: y 7 Domain: x 2, range: y 6 Domain: x 2, range: y 1
Answers 2D 2E
2.7
1
1
4
1 2
0.7
Answers
661
6 D 8 a
y 1.4 2 x
7 D b
y 3 x
y 7 1
y 2 4 x
i
(6, 1) x
2 1
2 1 x
y 3.7 2 3 x
f
4
y
1 2 3
3 4 1
1 2
y x
3 2
y 4.4 2 2 x
2 3 4
C a b c d e f a
Domain: R, range: y 0 Domain: R, range: y 1 Domain: R, range: y 4 Domain: R, range: y 2 Domain: R \ {1}, range: y > 1 Domain: R \ {0}, range: y 0 y b
x
11
y 5 1 1 6 x
y 0.4 1 1 2 x
y 7 1 3
y 2
9 E 10 a m = 1 11
y 9 (4, 3) x
b y = 2 x 1 4 y = 3 4x + 3 e
x y 2
( 1, 1)
(1, 1) x y
f
2
1
2.7
0.7 1 2
12 a p = 8 c x = 3 e y 8
b y = 4 x + 1 + 8 d x 1 y f
(
1, 8) 4 3
g
4
3
y
4 3
y
1 3 3 3
3 4
i
1
4
y
1 4
j
1
1
y 1 x
y 3 x y 4 2 2
y 6
y 5 3.6 3
y 2 5 x
35 63
1 2
2 x
( 1, 6)
99
y 5 4
1 3 x 1, x 3 5 a f ( x ) = 1 3 x + 1, x < 3
x 1 3 5
662
Answers
y 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 3 2 1 0 1
f (x) |3x 1| 2 3 x
ii y = x 2 2 6 a i y = x 3 + 2 b i y = x 2 9 x + 20 ii y = x 2 7 x + 8 7 C 8 a Reflection in the y-axis, dilation by a factor of 2 from the x-axis, translation horizontally by +6, translation vertically by +1 2 +2 f ( x ) = ( x + 6) b Dilation by a factor of 2 from the y-axis, dilation by a factor of 1 2 from the x-axis, reflection in the x-axis, horizontal translation by +3, vertical translation by 1 1 y = 1 x3 c Horizontal translation by +1, vertical translation by 2, 1 3 dilation from the y-axis, reflection in the x-axis 1 +2 y = 3x + 1 0 x 1 + y 3 10 a y = 2 x 3 + 8 x 1 b (2, 1); point lies on the curve 11 Dilation by a factor of 3 from the x-axis, reflection in the x-axis, translation by 2 units in the positive direction of the x-axis, translation by 1 unit in the positive direction of the y-axis
1 x 9 T = 4 y 0 1
f (x) |x 3x| 2
7 a y =
x , 2 x 2
3 2
x , 2 x 2;
x 6, 2 x 2; x , 2 x 2
c Teacher to check Exercise 2G Transformations with matrices 1 i Reflection in the y-axis, dilation by a factor of 2 from the x-axis ii Dilation by a factor of 1 2 from the y-axis, dilation by a factor of 4 from the x-axis, reflection in the x-axis iii Reflection in the y-axis, dilation by a factor of 3 from the x-axis, dilation by a factor of 2 from the y-axis iv Dilation by a factor of 1 2 from the x-axis, reflection in the x-axis 2 i (3, 10) ii ( 3 2 , 20 ) 3 a i y = 2 x2 1 ii y = x2 b i y = 2 x 3 10 ii y =
32 x 3 x
x 1 T = y 0
3 y
0 x
2 + 1
12 a, b g(2( x + 1)) + 1 = 2( x + 1) + 1 13 a, b f(x) = 2x2 10x + 6 14 h(x) = x3 5 Exercise 2H Sum, difference and product functions 1 a f(x) = x2 + x
y 3 2 1
3
2
1 0
1 1 2 3 x
iv (3,
5 ) 2
+ 20
c i y = 2
ii y = 4 2 x 4 i Translation of 3 units in the positive direction of the x-axis, translation of 2 units in the positive direction of the y-axis. ii Translation of 2 units in the positive direction of the x-axis, translation of 2 units in the negative direction of the y-axis. iii Translation of 1 units in the negative direction of the 5 x-axis. 5 i (4, 0) ii (3, 4) iii ( 4 5 , 2)
dom f: R x3 + x b f ( x ) = 2
y 3 2 1
3
2
1 0
1 1 2 3 x
Answers 2F 2H
dom f: [0, )
Answers
663
c f ( x ) = 3 x 2 + x
y
f
2 1
y 1 1 1 0 2 3 ( 2, 4) 4 y 8 6 4 2 0 2 4 6 8 1 2 1
1.5 1 0.5 0
0.5
1.5
6 a
( 2, 8) ( 2, 2) 3 2 1
dom f: R 1 x
y 6 4 2
6
4
2
2 0 2 4 6 x
d f ( x ) = x + 2 +
(2, 2) 3 x
(2, 8)
dom f: R\{0}
2 a g( x ) h( x ) =
x +1 x
y 4 ( 1, 1) 6 4 2 2 0 2 4 2 4 6 x
b c d e f g
f(2) = 8, g(2) = 2, h(2) = 10 f(0) = 0, g(0) = 0, h(0) = 0 f(1) = 1, g(1) = 1, h(1) = 0 f(2) = 8, g(2) = 2, h(2) = 6 ran h: [6, 10]
y (
2, 10) (
2, 8) (
2, 2)
3
2 10 8 6 4 2
1
20
4
6
8 1
b g( x ) h( x ) = x x + 1 + 2
y (
1, 3) 4 2
6
4
2 0 (
1,
2)
2 2 4 6 x
7 a dom h: [0, ) b
3 a (, 3] c [0, 1] e [2, ) 4
y 4 2
4
2
2
4
6
b R d R
(4, 4.5)
1.5 1 0.5 0 2 4
f ran h: [ 2, ) g
( 4, 4.5)
5 a
2
y 1 0
1
1
2
3
4 1 (2, 2 ) 2 x
0.5
1.5 1 0.5 0 2 4
f (x)g (x)
x + x + 5 , x [ 5, 8] 8 h( x ) = 8 y
(2,
4) 5 4 3 2 1
( 2, 4)
b c d e
a=0 f(0) = 0, g(0) = 0, h(0) = 0 f(1) = 1, g(1) = 1, h(1) = 0 f(2) = 4, g(2) = 2 , h(2) = 4 + 2
6 5 4 3 2 10 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 x
664
Answers
9
h(x) (
2, 2) (
2.5, 1.38)
8 dom w: ( 3, ), ran w: (0, ), dom v: R+, ran v: (2, ) w v(x) = x + 1 , where x R+; v w(x) = x + 3 2, where x (3, ) 9 Teacher to check 10 Teacher to check 11 x = 4.4305 or 0.902832, maximum 4.23 when x = 4.43 12 Reflection in the y-axis, translated +1 parallel to the x-axis Exercise 2J Modelling 1 a iii b ii c iv d i e v 2 a y = ax3, a = 0.3 b y = ax2, a = 6 a d y = a x , a = 1.6 c y = 2 , a = 2 x a f y = ax3, a = 1.5 e y = , a = 5 x 3 D y y 4 a b
50 40 30 20 10 0
10 1 2 3 4 5 x 50 40 30 20 10
5 4 3 2 1 0 2 4
Exercise 2I Composite functions and functional equations 1 a ii f(g(x)) = 2 x + 3 1, domain [3, ) 1 b ii f(g(x)) = , domain R |x|+3 c ii f(g(x)) = 3(x2 2)3, domain R d ii f(g(x)) = x 3 , domain R e ii f(g(x)) = (x2 + 1)(x2 + 3), domain R 2 Teacher to check 3 Teacher to check 4 a i f(x y) f(x) f(y) ii f(x y) f(x) f(y) iii f(x) + f(y) (x2 + y2) f(xy) x f ( x) iv f( )) = y f ( y) v f(xy) = f(x) f(y) b i f(x y) f(x) f(y) ii f(x y) f(x) f(y) iii f(x) + f(y) (x2 + y2) f(xy) x f ( x) iv f( )) = y f ( y) v f(xy) = f(x) f(y) c i f(x y) f(x ) f(y) ii f(x y) f(x) f(y) iii f(x) + f(y) (x2 + y2) f(xy) x f ( x) iv f( )) = y f ( y) v f(xy) = f(x) f(y) d i f(x y) f(x) f(y) ii f(x y ) f(x) f(y) iii f(x) + f(y) = (x2 + y2)f(xy) x f ( x) iv f( )) = y f ( y) v f(xy) = f(x)f(y) e i f(x y) f(x) f(y) ii f(x y) f(x) f(y) iii f(x) + f(y) (x2 + y2) f(xy) x f ( x) iv f( )) = y f ( y) v f(xy) = f(x)f(y) f i f(x y) f(x) f(y) ii f(x y) = f(x) f(y) iii f(x) + f(y) (x2 + y2)f(xy) f ( x) x iv f( )) f ( y) y v f(xy) f(x) f(y) 5 a > 0 1 6 f g does not exist; g f(x) = +2 x 2 +1 7 Restricted domain of g(x) = R\(1, 1)
0 10
5 10 15 20 25 x
c f =
340
7 a
b I =
270 d2
4d
Answers 2i 2J
8 y = 3 x + 4 9 a $
11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Price
8 10 Month
b p = 2 m + 4
c 10.63, 10.93
Answers
665
12 a a = 8, b = 1 b i y = 2 1 x +2 8 (1 x )3 1 x ii y = + +2 512 8 13 a x =
3 1.6 4 4.4
x y 4 x2 2x ,y = b y = 2 a 2 a a 2 c a = 2, y = x - x 14 g:( 2, 1) R, g( x ) = x 3 + 2 x 2 + 1 ( f + g)( x ) = 2 x 3 + 4 x 2 + 1
y 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 (1, 7) ( f g)(x) (1, 4) (1, 3) f (x) 1 x
2 a b = 2, c = 1 b m = 7 3 c y = +3 x4 7 3 f ( x ) = 2 3x + 1 Dilation 1 3 from the y-axis, dilation from the x-axis by a factor of 7, reflection in the x-axis, translation
1 3
g(x) ( 2, 1) 2 1
parallel
to the x-axis in the negative direction, translation + 2 parallel to the y-axis 4 y = 1 3(x 1)3 5 a x = 2, y = 1 b Domain: R \ {2}, range: R \ {1} 4 c y = 1 x+2 y d
6
2
1
3 x
15 g( x) = x + 1, ( fg)( x ) = x y
2 1
2
1 0
1
2 1
( x )+1
f 2 g x
fg
6 a Reflection in the x-axis, translation by 2 units to the left and 1 unit down, dilation by the factor of 2 along the y-axis 2 b y = 1 ( x + 2)2 1 7 y = 2 ( x 1)2 8 4 units to the right and 3 units up; y = 3 y 9 a
(
3, 2)
2.7
2 (
1, 2) 2
1 2
4x
d No
1.3
D'(4, 6)
x C'( 2, 3) A 2
C(2, 3) A' x 2
666
Answers
iii
f(x) D'(6, 6)
C'(4, 3) B'(2, 2) x
A 2
A'( 2, 3)
C(2, 3) x
f(x) 3 A 2 f(x)
4 a 55 m b Maximum height is 30.01 m above ground and maximum depth is 5.38 m. c i Minimum depths and maximum heights would be greater. ii No change iii Would be greater 5 a y = a(x b)2 + c b b = 9 c Straight line (negative gradient) d a = 0.55, c = 275 e y = 0.55(x 9)2 + 275 f No, the prices started going down. g $266 000, $261 000 h About 4 months 6 a a = 40 b i The eagle is 48 m above the ground. ii The eagle is 42 m above the ground. c It takes 24.2 s to reach the ground. d The speed is slow to start but increases rapidly as the eagle approaches the ground. e h
50 (0, 48.4) (5, 48) 40 30 20 10 0 5 10 15 20 (24.2, 0) 25 t (20, 42)
B'(1, 1)
D'(3, 5)
1), C(1, 2), D(3, 5) b Add multiples of 2, for example, f (x) + 2, f (x) + 4, f (x) + 6, f (x) 2 etc. and keep the domain fixed at [3, 7].
5 2 a a = 1, b = 3
A(3,
B(1, 1),
b p > 1, p <
25 27
c i Dilation of k from the y-axis, translation of 1 in the negative direction of the y-axis ii x = k, x = 2k d h [1, 2) 3 a Dilation from the y-axis by a factor of 1 2 , vertical translation of +1 1 b 2 0 , 0 1 0 1
c ( 1 , (1, 1.25),( 1 2 , 2), ( 1, 1.25) 2 , 2)
y 3 2 1 2 1 0 1 2 x
x 3 or x 3 a Minimum value of -1 3 b x = 2 a Let P(x) = x3 - 7x - 6. P(-2) = -8 +14 - 6 = 0 so x - (-2) is a factor. Hence x + 2 is a factor. b Q(x) = x2 - 2x - 4 1 5 c < 4 2 3 4 6
y 30 20 10
1.5
1
0.5 0
10 0.5 1 1.5 2 2.5 3 3.5 4 4.5 x
Answers 2j 2j
1 e y = 2 + 1 4x
Answers
667
Multiple choice 1 B 2 C 3 E 4 B 5 D 6 C Extended response 1 a v = 100t - 100 b 2:11 pm c 3:42 pm d It predicts that the wind speed will increase indefinitely. It also predicts a negative speed at noon. These problems could be avoided, for example, simply by restricting the domain to be [1, 3.69]. e i If the wind peaked at 5 pm, then (5, 256) would be a turning point. In turning point form the rule for the quadratic model would be v(t) = a(t - 5)2 + 256. 256 Since v(1) = 0, 0 = a(1 - 5)2 + 256 a = = 16 16 so the model is v(t) = -16(t - 5)2 + 256. Using this model, v(3) = -16 (-2)2 + 256 = 192 km/hour. This is reasonably close to the recorded value of 200 km/hour. ii The predicted value is v(12) = -16 72 + 256 = -528 km/hour. Clearly the model is inadequate. f i v2(t) = -8(x - 1)(x - 13) ii Check at t = 3. v2(3) = -8(3 - 1)(3 - 13) = 8 2 -10 = 160 km/hour. Compared with the actual value of 200 km/hour, this model is not adequate. Maximum wind speed predicted at t = 7 is v2(7) = -8(7 - 1)(7 - 13) = -8 6 -6 = 288 km/hour, which is later and faster than the actual data. g v3(t) = x3 - 27x2 + 195x - 169 h i x = 250 1 875 000 ii v (t ) = ( x 250)2 625 000 iii P (t ) = + 1020 ( x 250)2
d 1 c 5x = 125
c 5 f 3
log2 (x)
b log3 (x)
6 a 1 b 1 d 1 e 9 7 a 4 b 3 d 2 e 1 2 8 a 0.477 b 0.861 d 0.322 e 2.161 9 a 0 b log2 (x) d 0 e 3 log10 (x) g log5 (x + 1)3 or 3 log5 (x + 1) 10 C 11 E 12 31.623
CHAPTER 3
Exercise 3C Exponential equations 1 a 4 b 3 c 5 d 2 e 1 5 2 a 4 b 5 c 1 d 3 3 a 3 b 1 c 2 d 1 4 a 2, 0 b 2, 1 c 1, 0 d 3 e 1 5 a 0 b 1, 2 6 a 2.322 b 0.912 c 3.325 d 1.365 e 0.827 f 0.672 7 a x > 1.465 b x 1.404 c x < 0.683 d x 0.356 e x < 1.756 8 D 9 E Exercise 3D Logarithmic equations using any base 1 a i 25 ii 1 iii 100 iv 26 8 v 2 vi ii vi
1 32 1 16 1 9
b x5 f 5x4y3 b e
1 125 8 27
c x10 10 x 4 y 2 g 3 c 3 c 216
5 2 c 243 x y2
1 x6
b i 81 v 0 3 2 3 1 2 2 5 4 2 128 5 3 2 3 2 a i b i 3 a i v b i v 4 a i v b i v 5 a i v b i v 6 B
iv 127 iv 6 iv 4 iv 0 iv 0 iv 8 iv 500 iv 2 iv 4
3 a x6 d 3 7 3 4 a 11 2 x y 5 a x6 y4
b 8 27 e 64 b b
5 5 6x 4 y 3
d d
3 a 9b3
15 7 2a 2 b 2
ii 125 ii 625 ii 1 ii 2 ii 6 ii 9 ii 6 ii 8
20 x
1 y4
3 8y 8
iii 10 iii
2 5
b 36n + 1 d 2 3 b 1 2x c 1 x2
iii 1 iii 5 7 D
1 d x+y
668
Answers
1 8 a 10, 100
b 1000, f 25, 5 j 2, 5
1 10
c 16,
1 4
d 2,
1 16
g 1, 16
h 1, 27
Exercise 3H Literal equations a 1 1 x = 2 log e , a > 0 5 2 D = Z 3cy log e (3k ) n 3 x = m 9 p 4 q = 5 5 Proof: z2x5 x2y4 y log10 3 5 log10 3 4 log10 4 z x z y z x z2x5 x2y4 y = log10 3 5 log10 3 4 + log10 4 z x z y z x x2y4 z2x5y = log10 3 5 log10 7 4 y z x z x xy xy = log10 5 log10 5 z z = log10 (1) = 0 4 9a 6 a x = 2b 7 b x = 3 log e 20 + 2b log e 2 7 x = 4 log e 2 8 x = a log e ( 3) + log e ( 2 ) 2 log e 3
Exponential equations (base e ) b 54.598 c 1.649 d 1.396 f 1.221 g 1.386 h 1.609 j 1.281 b 2 c 6 d 1 2 f 0 g
11 6
h 1 1 4 d 1.386 h 1.386 0.405, 0.693 0.693, 1.609 1.099 0, 0.693 x < 0.693 x 1.303 (base e ) 1 e d e h 0.432 d 4 d d 6
3 a 0.693 b 1.609 c 0.693 e 0.262 f 0.956 g 1.099 4 a 0 b 0.693, 0.549 c d 0 e 1 f g 0.405, 1.099 h 0.251, 0.693 5 a 0.693 b 1.609 c d 0.405, 1.099 e 0.288, 0.693 f 6 a x > 0 b x < 1 c d x 0.693 e x 0.792 f g x < 0.288 7 20.00, 0.01 8 0.04 Exercise 3F Equations with natural logarithms 1 1 a e b e2 c 2 e 2 a 3.695 b 0.906 c e e 1.221 f 1.350 g 1.368 3 a 2 b 5 c 3 e 10 f 2.207 4 a 6 b 2 c 2.5 3 e 1 5 B 7 ex2 9 2 10 a 2.5 f 1.5 6 A 8 y = x =
1 2
b e
kt
c t =
9 x = 10 a =
11 x =
12 x = 9 y 6 13 b = 14 15 16 a2 e2 a x = 1.512 or x = 0.691 b 0.443 c 1.058 a x = 1.557 b x = 2.159 and x = 5.146 c x = 0.191 and x = 1.433 log ( p ) x = 7 log ( 4 )
5
e e
( ) e y = 2 + log ( 3 x ) 2
x e2
Answers 3a 3i
( )
3 a f ( x ) = d f ( x ) =
b f(x) = e x 1
e +1 e f(x) = 2 ex 2
x
4 a y = ex 2
b y = e2 x
x2 e 3
d f(x) = e2 x + 1 e y 5 C
x3 = 1+ e 2
f f ( x ) = e 7 D
Exercise 3I Exponential and logarithmic modelling 1 a 200 b y = 200e 0.6t c 110 g 1 d 2 4 hours 2 a 10 g d 13 days b y = 10e
0.18t
6 E
c 8 g
Answers
669
3 a 3, 2 b y = 3 + 2 loge (x) c 5.197 d 10 4 a 1000, 0.05 b A = 1000e0.05t c 1051, 1649 d 14 5 a 500 b 0.03 c P = 500e0.03t d 2240 e 1896 6 a 15 C, 90 C, 0.05 b T = 15 + 75e 0.05t c 60 C d 22 e 17 7 a 50, 0.09 b D = 50e0.09t c 78 cm d 8 years 8 a 100 b 0.002 c M = 100e 0.002t d 90 g e 347 years 9 a 0.23 b N = N0e0.23t c 1000 d N = 1000e0.23t e 6000 10 a 0.1386 b I = I0e 0.1386d c 25% d 16.6 metres Chapter review Short answer 1
33 x5 14 y 15
CHAPTER 4
f (x) =
2x
2 0.849 4 1 2 3 6 2 5 ln (2)
3 3 5 8 7 4 8 y =
2 1
0 1
2 x
f (x) = 3 f
2x
loge x + a 3 9 y = 1 e(x 3) 2e 2 5 10 x = 3
1 2
( )
k R+ 8 b 13 ,a 0 a 14 z 2y, x, z R+ Multiple choice 1 E 2 A 3 D 4 B 5 A 6 D 7 B 8 C 9 B 10 E 11 B 12 D 13 B 14 C 15 E 16 B 17 E Extended response 1 0.41 x 4 x 5 x6 2 a + + 4! 5! 6! 1 1 1 1 1 b e = 1 + 1 + + + + + 2 6 24 120 720 3 4.75 4 7.8 5 a 2.5 b e kt = 0.5 ln (2) d 139 days c t = k 6 a 30, 0.4055 b N = 30e0.4055t c 228 d 9 years e 1000, 0.1054 f E = 1000e 0.1054t g 590 h 7 years i 485 1 7 x = ln 2 + 4 + k k
k 11 6 b + ln (2k ) 12 , a R \{0} a bR
1 ln 3
f (x) = 0.3
2x
f (x) = 0.5
10x
(0, 1) 0 0.5
f (x) = 5
32x l
f (x) = 4
23x
(3, 4)
f (x) = 2
x 10 2
f (x) = 2
670
Answers
f (x) = 2x 3
3 2 1 0 1 2 3
3 2 1 (0, 1 ) 8 0 1
(3, 1) 2 3
-6,
(1, 5) (0, 3) y 2 01 2 3
f (x) =
3x
+2
y 8
4 x
3 2 1 0 1 2 3 x
Answers 4A 4A
y = 0, domain R, range R+
y 1 0.5 (0, (4, 1)
f (x) =
3x 4
1 81 )
(1, 2) 2 3 4 x 2 1
0 1
(0, 1) 0 1 2 x
Answers
671
5
2
1
y 0 1 2 x ) (0, 11 2 (1, 3)
f (x) = 3 21 x
2 4
f y-intercept is 9, x-intercept is 1, horizontal asymptote y = 10, domain R, range (, 10) f (x) = 10 10x y
10 5
2
1 (1, 0) 0 1 2 x (0, 9) y 10
y-intercept is 1 1 2 , no x-intercepts. Horizontal asymptote is the x-axis, domain is R, range is (, 0). f (x) = 5 4 31 x 6 y y5
5 0
5 1 (0.8, 0) 2 3 4 x
(0, 7)
y-intercept is 7, x-intercept is 0.8. Horizontal asymptote is y = 5, domain is R, range is (, 5). 7 a Dilation by factor 1 3 from the y-axis b Dilation by factor
1 4
y2 x
0 1
2 2 1
y1 x
0 1
f (x) = 1 32 x
c Dilation by factor 2 from the x-axis d Dilation by factor 3 from the x-axis e Reflection in x-axis f Reflection in y-axis g Translation of 1 unit up h Translation of 3 units down i Translation of 1 unit right j Translation of 5 units left 8 a 4 units up b 2 units down c 2 units to the left d 3 units to the right e 3 units down f 2 units up g 1 unit to the right h 2 units to the left i 5 units up and 1 unit to the left j 2 units up and 4 units to the right k 3 units to the right and 4 units down l 2 units to the left and 3 units down 9 a R, R+, y = 0 b R, (1, ), y = 1 c R, (3, ), y = 3 d R, (, 1), y = 1 e R, (2, ), y = 2 f R, (, 1), y = 1 10 f (x) = 1 2x 11 f (x) = 1 3 2x + 1 12 E 13 B 14 C 15 a 50 b 400 c Asymptote y = 0 p
400 200
2
1 (0, 50) 0 1 2 3 t (3, 400)
y 6 (0, 6) 4 2 0 1 (1, 2) 2 3 4 x
f (x) = 2
31 x
Exercise 4B Logarithmic graphs to any base 1 a y-axis b y-axis c y-axis d y-axis e y-axis f y-axis g y-axis h y-axis
672
Answers
2 a
y 2 (2, 1) (1, 0) 0 1 2 3 4 5 x
y 1 (1, 0) 2 4 6
(10, 1)
y 1
y 2 1 0
8 10 x
0 1
(2, 5) (1, 0) x
(1, 3)
2 2 2
(0, 3) 0 1 2 3 4 x
, 0) (
7 8
0 (1 , 0) 1 3
2 x
0 1
2 3
4 5 x
1 2 3 4 (3, 0)
2 (0, 2)
(5, 3)
2)
2 3
4 5 x
4 a
b
(0, 1)
x 1 y 1
(1, 1) x
Asymptote x = 0 R, R, in y-axis e
y 2 1 0 (1, 1) 2 4 6 (10, 0) x 8 10
2 1 0 1 2 3 4 x
1 0 1 1
Asymptote x = 0 R, R, in y-axis
y 2 (0.1, 0) 0
2 1 2 3 4 x
Answers 4B 4B
h
(
10, 1)1
y 2 ( 100, 0)
2 1 0 x
5 4 3 2 1
100 80 60 40 20 0
Asymptote x = 0 R, R, in y-axis
Answers
673
y 2 1
x 2 (1.5, 1) 2 3 (1, 0) 4 x
1 0 1 2 3
Domain ( 1 , ), range R, dilation by factor 1 from the 2 2 y-axis, horizontal translation of 1 unit to the right 2 7 a
y 2 0 (1, 3) x
h 2, dilation by factor 4 from the x-axis, translation 2 units to the right and 1 unit down i 2, dilation by factor 2 from the x-axis, and by factor 1 from the y-axis, translation 1 unit up 3 j 2, dilation by factor 4 from the x-axis and by factor 1 2 from the y-axis, translation of 3 units up and reflection in the x-axis y 9 x2
4 (0, 4) 2 (1.2, 0) 0 1
y 2 1 (1, 1) 1 12 3 (10 3 , 0) 4 x 1
13 (2 2, 0)
Asymptote x = 0 R+, R c
y 2 x1 (0, 0)
3
2
1 0 1 2
2 x
Asymptote x = 0 R+, R
y 2 (0, log103) x3
(, 2), R 10 y
2 (3.6, 0) 0 2 4
2 (0,
2) (10, 1.1) 6 8 10 x
(, 1), R
y 2 ( 2, 0)
2 0 1 2 (2,
1) 3 4 x
(, 3), R
y 4 2 (1, 2) 2 (105 , 0) 0 1 2 3 4
Asymptote x = 0 11 B Exercise 4C Graphs of exponential functions with base e 1 a Dilation by factor 1 from the y-axis 3
Asymptote x = 0 R+, R g
x
1 y 2 (3.6, 0)
2 0 1 (0,
2) 2 3 4 x
Asymptote x = 0 R+, R
y 5 x2 (3.2, 0) 0 1 2 3 4 (3,
1) x
from the y-axis b Dilation by factor 1 2 c Dilation by factor 4 from the x-axis and by factor 2 from the y-axis d Dilation by factor 2 from the x-axis and by factor 3 from the y-axis e Translation of 2 units to the right and 1 unit up f Translation of 5 units to the left and 2 units up g Dilation by factor 1 from the y-axis, reflection in the 2 x-axis, translation of 3 units up from the y-axis, reflection in the h Dilation by factor 1 3 x-axis, translation of 1 unit up i Dilation by factor 3 from the x-axis, translation of 2 units to the left and 1 unit down 2 a b y f(x) ex y f(x) ex
4
(1, ), R
y 5 0
5 ( 2 , 3)
3
(2, ), R j
x
2 0 2 y 4 2 6 8 (2.8, 0) 4 6 (5,
1) 8 x
f(x) ex 1
(0.24, 0)
Asymptote x = 0 Asymptote x = 0 R+, R R+, R a 2, dilation by factor 2 from the x-axis, translation of 3 units up b 10, dilation by factor 3 from the x-axis, translation of 1 unit up c 10, reflection in the y-axis, translation of 1 unit to the right d 10, reflection in the y-axis, translation of 3 units to the right e 2, reflection in the x-axis, dilation by factor 2 parallel to the y-axis, translation of 1 unit up f 10, reflection in the x-axis, dilation by factor 5 from the x-axis, translation 2 units up g 10, dilation by factor 3 from the x-axis, translation 1 unit to the left, translation 2 units down
(1, 1) (0, 1 e) x 3 2 1 0 1 2 3
2 (0, 1)
(0, 2) (0, 1) x 3 2 1 0 1 2 3
674
Answers
4 (0, 2) 3 2 1
y 4
f(x) ex f(x) ex 2
y 2 (0, 2) 1
y 4 (0, 3) 2
2 (0, 1) 3 2 1 0 (0, 1) 2 1 2 3 x 1
y 2
1.5 1 0.5
Asymptote y = 0 Dilation by factor 2 from the x-axis and by factor 1 3 from the y-axis, + R, R 4 a
y 20 (0, 20.09) 10
3
2
1 0 1 x
Asymptote y = 0 Dilation by factor 3 from the x-axis and by factor 1 4 from the y-axis, R, R+ b
y 2 1 (0, 0.05) 0 1 2 (3, 1) 3 4 x
(0, 1) 0 1
2 1
(0, 1) 2 1
2 (0, 2)
y=1
x 3 2 1 0 1 2 3
x 3 2 1 0 1 2 3
(0.5, e1.5)
f
y2
1 0.5
1
1 2
x 3 2 1 0 1 2 3
y=1 x 3 2 1 0 1 2 3
y3 01 2 3 x
3 2 1
Answers 4C 4C
1 1 (0, 4) 1 0 1 x ( 2, 0) 3 2 1
Asymptote y = 0 Dilation by factor 1 2 from the x-axis 1 And by factor 4 from the y-axis, R, R+
2 0 x
Asymptote y = 0 Dilation by factor 1 4 from the x-axis and by factor 1 from 2 the y-axis, R, R+
y 1
Answers
675
5 a
y 4 ( 1, e) 2 2 1 (0, 1) 0 1 2 x
y 1 (0, 1) 2 4 0 1 x
8 a
y 2 (0, 2) y1 2 x
b
2
1 (0,
1)
y (0.69, 0) 0 1 2 x 2 y 1 y 2
(1, e)
2 1
0 1 y 4 2 (0, 2)
(0, 2) 1 0 1 x
0 2
1 (1, 1 e)
y2
x 3 2 1 0 1 2 3
Asymptote y = 0 e
y 2
Asymptote y = 0 f
y 2 (0, 1)
1 0 y 2 1
1 (0, e
2) 0 1 y 2 (0, 2) 1 0 y1 1 x x y2 (0.69, 0) x 1
y1 1 x
1 0
y1 x 1
(0, 2) y1 0 1 2 x
y 4 2 (0, e)
x 3 2 1 0 1 2 3
Asymptote y = 0
y 2 1 (0, 1)
Asymptote y = 0
( ln3, 0) 1
(0, 2) 0 1 x
x 1
Asymptote y = 0 9 D 10 E 11 a 1, 3 b y = e x Exercise 4D Logarithmic graphs to base e 1 a Dilation by factor 5 from the x-axis and by factor 1 2 from the y-axis b Dilation by factor 2 from the x-axis and by factor 1 4 from the y-axis c Translation of 1 unit to the left and 3 units down d Translation of 2 units to the right and 1 unit up e Reflection in the x-axis and in the y-axis f Reflection in the x-axis and dilation by factor 1 from 2 the y-axis g Translation of 2 units to the right and 1 unit up, reflection in the x-axis h Translation of 3 units to the left and 2 units up, reflection in the x-axis i Translation of 4 units to the left and 1 unit down, dilation by factor 3 from the x-axis j Translation of 4 units to the right and 1 unit up, reflection in the x-axis k Translation of 1 unit to the right and 3 units up, dilation by factor 2 from the x-axis, reflection in the y-axis l Translation of 2 units to the right and 1 unit down, dilation by factor 3 from the x-axis, reflection in the y-axis
2 (0, 2)
Asymptote y = 0 Reflection in the y-axis, reflection in the x-axis, dilation by factor 2 from the x-axis, R, R 6
2
1
1 y (1 2 , 0) 0 1 2 (0,
0.95)
1
x y 1
R, (1, ) y 7
1
1 (2, 0) 0 1 2 (0,
0.86) x y
1
[0, ), [0.86, )
676
Answers
2 a
y 2 (1, 0) 0 1 2
y 2 1 ( 2 , 0)
Asymptote x = 0 R+, R
y 1 (1, 0) x
1.5
1
0.5 00.5 1 1.5 2
1
Asymptote x = 0 R+, R d
y 1 (1, 0) x
1.5
1
0.5 00.5 1 1.5 2
1
Asymptote x = 0 R+, R
y 5 (
2, 0)
2
1
1
Asymptote x = 0 R, R f
x
2 y 5 1 (
4 , 0) 0
1
5
Asymptote x = 0 R+, R
y
0.5 0.5 1 1.5 2 2.5 3
1
2 0 (3, 0) x
Asymptote x = 0 R+, R
y (0.5, 0) x 0
0.5 0.5 1 1.5 2 2.5 3
5
Asymptote x = 0 R, R
2 y x1 0 1 2 3 x
Asymptote x = 0 R, R h
y 2 x2
3 2 1 2
3 a
Asymptote x = 0 R+, R
y (e
1, 0) x 0
0.5 0.5 1 1.5 2 2.5 3
5
Asymptote x = 0 R+, R
y (e
2, 0)
(,
1), R
y 2 (1, 0)
x2
j
x
(, 2), R
y 2
x3
2 1 0 (0, 0.69) 2
Asymptote x = 0
y x1 (2, 0)
1 0 1 y 2 (0, loge2) 0 2 x 2 3 4 x 1
Asymptote x = 0
y 2 x2 (3, 0)
0 12 3 4 5 6 7x 2
x 2
x 3 y 2 ( 2, 0) 2 2 (0, loge3) 0 2 4 x
( 1, 0) 2 2
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 (1, 2)
y 4 2 2 0
x3 (3.1, 0) 2 4 6 8
y 4 x1 2 (1.4, 0) 0 2 2 4 6 8
(1, ), R
x
Asymptote x = 0 R+, R
(3, 0) 0 0.5 1 1.5 2 2.5 3 x
2
4 y
x 3 y
x 3 2 1 0 1 2 3 4 5 1 (0, 0.9) 2
(4.4, 0)
y x 1 1 2
(6.4, 0) 01 2 3 4 5 6 7 x (0, 2)
Answers 4D 4d
Asymptote x = 0 R+, R
y 2
Asymptote x = 0 R+, R f
y 2 (1, 0) x 0
2.5
2
1.5
1
0.5 0.5
2
4
4 a
y 2 (1, 0) 0 1 2 3 4 x
Asymptote x = 0 (, 0), R
Asymptote x = 0 R+, R
Asymptote x = 0 R+, R
Asymptote x = 0 R, R
Answers
677
x 3
y 2
( 2, 0) 2 1 0 (0, 1.10) 2
( 1, 9.3) ( 1, 8.2)
(3, ), R
y 2 x 0
2 0.5 1 1.5 2 2.5 3
4
6 (0.22, 0)
R+, R
Asymptote y = 0 c (
2, 7.4) y
y1 e
x 8 6 4 (
2, 5.4) y x 2 2 (
2,
2)
f(x) (1, 9.3) 8 (0, 6) (1, 8.2) 6 y1 3ex y2 3e x 4 (0, 3) 2 (1, 1.1) ( 1, 1.1) x 1 0.5 0 0.5 1
f(x) 1
Asymptote x = 0 R+, R 7 Dilation by factor 2 from the x-axis, translation of 2 units to the left and 1 unit down
x
2 y 2 (0, 2.58)
2 0
2 y
1
2
4 0 2 4 6 (
1.45, 0) (1, 0) 1 x
1 2 0
Asymptote y = 0 d
y (2, 9.4) f(x) (2, 7.4) 8 y1 ex 6 4 (0, 1) y x 2 ( 2, 0.14) 2 (2, 2) ( 2, 1.9) x 1 2 0 1 2 ( 2, 2) y 10 (2, 11.4) f(x) (2, e2) y1 y2 1 0 1 2 (2, 4) x
e
x (
2, 4.14) (
2, 4) (
2, 0.14)
(0, 2.08)
9 D 10 B 11 C 12 a f: (2, ), g(x) = a b loge (x 2) b Domain is (2, ) and range is R. c h(x) = 4a 4b loge (x 2) or 4a + 4b loge (x + 2) Exercise 4E Finding equations for graphs of exponential and logarithmic functions 1 0.58, 2.42, f(x) = 0.58ex + 2.42, y = 2.42 2 0.84, 0.33 3 1.60, 0.92 19 32 4 A = 15 ,B= 15 5
1 2,
Asymptote y = 0 f (
2, 11.4) y
10 (
2, 7.4) (
2, 4)
2
1 5 (3, 9.05) f(x) (3, 9) y2 x2 y1 e
x (3, e
3) 0 1 2 3 x
Asymptote y = 0 4 a y
2 0
2 (1, 1) 0.5 1 1.5 (1, 0)
1, f(x) =
1 2
2x + 1
6 E 7 2, 3 8 4, 1 9 2.9, 2.0, 2.0, y = 2.9 loge (x + 2.0) + 2.0 10 2.0959, 3 11 1.5, 2, 3 Exercise 4F Addition of ordinates 1 a R\{0} b [0, ) c [0, ) d [2, ) e R f R\{3} g R\{1} h (, 1] i R\{0} j [1, 3] 2 C (
1, 6.2) y (1, 6.2) 3 a
f(x) (
1, 5.4) (1, 5.4) 4 (0, 4) y1 2ex y2 2e
x 2 (1, 0.74) (
1, 0.74) (0, 2) 0 0.5 1 x
1
0.5 6
h(x) g(x) 2x
Asymptote y = 0
678
Answers
y 2 1 2
y y = x2 5x 6 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
f(x) x
(1, 1) x g(x)
6 5 4 3 2 1 0 1 2 g(x) h(x) x
y 3 2 1 3 2 f(x) 2 g(x)
y = x3 x2 1
f(x) loge(x)
g(x)
h(x) f(x)
10 a
y 2
x
y 2 1
y x 2 x y x
y ( 2, 3.76) 4 2
x y y x 3 x
b
(0, 1) 0 1 2 x
y 2x
y 2x
x
1 4
x y x y x2 y x 3 x2
d
y 5
x
5
y 2 5 y x5 5 x y x5 5 x
11 E
x f(x) g(x) h(x)
12 d
g(x) y f(x) h(x) x
y 4 3 2 1 1 2 1
y loge(x) x y x y loge(x) 2 3 4 5 x
Domain x > 0
Answers 4e 4f
13 f
y
y 2 1 f(x) g(x) 1 2 3 x
1 1 2 3 4
h(x)
Answers
679
14 a
x 3 4 1 (2 e , 0)
( 1 e 1 2 , 0) 1 2 x
15 a
x3
1 (2.9, 0) 0 1 2 3 (3.1, 0) 4 5 x
2 (3, 0) 4 x2
680
Answers
y 5 4 3 (0, 2) 1 2 1 1 0 1 2 3
y3
3 a
Domain R, range [2, ) Exercise 4H Exponential and logarithmic modelling using graphs 1 a 50 koalas b 54 koalas, 75 koalas c d 92 koalas K
80 (15, 92) (10, 75) 60 (0, 50) (2, 54) 40 20
(1, 5)
0 4
12 16
(4, 2)
x (4 ln (3), 0)
(4 ln (3), 0)
e 9 years b $530.90
4 a
Domain R, range (, 1]
y
8 t
e $810 4 a 0.18 c E
y3 200 (1, 167) 100 (5, 81) (10, 33) 0 2 4 6 8 10121416 t
b 167, 81
Answers 4g 4H
y2 x
d e f a c e
7 days No, because the graph approaches the line E = 0. 4 days T = 80e kt + 18 b 0.277 d 9 minutes T = 80e 0.277t + 18 f 19C T
80 60 40 20 0 4 8 12 16 t (5, 38) (9, 25) T 18
Domain R, range
(,
4]
Answers
681
g The egg will never reach 18C because the line T = 18 is an asymptote. 6 a A = 1242.67, B = 10 000 b 7139 c 279 weeks d P
10 000 6300 5000 0 (1, 10 000) (5, 8000) (10, 7139)
(10, 2) 6 8 10 x
12 16 18 20 t
7 8
b Teacher to check
6 120 e 7 a
g(x) 2e x 1 4 (0, 2e 4) 0 x
y 4
e f g h i
Teacher to check. P = 2000 (1 e 0.1n) 20n 23 jackets, profit $1339 100 No. Not enough jackets are made before profits begin to decrease.
y = h(x) 0 (0.33, 0) x
y 4 2 0
1 ( 2
(5, 3)
, 0) 2 3 4 x
Domain = R+, range = R 9 Dilation by a factor of 2 from the x-axis, reflection through the y-axis, a translation of 3 units right and a translation of 5 units up 10 a On 1 January 2006, there are 50 tigers and 400 elephants. b On 1 April 2007, there are 3200 tigers and 50 elephants. c The numbers of tigers and elephants is equal on 1 June 2006 (there are 100 of each). d The elephant population is at risk from 1 September 2007, as the model predicts their population will reach 25 on this date. 11 y
(
2, 0)
3 1 1 2 3 4 5 x
1 0
2
3
4 x
3
b
(f g) (x) g(x) f(x)
682
Answers
12 a R\{3} c
x
3
b x-intercepts: x = 3 + e ( 3 + e
1 2
1 2
, x = 3 e
1 2
, 0),
( 3 e
1 2
, 0)
y-intercept:
y = 2 log e (3) + 1
y 4 3 2 1
6 a a = 1 because it is where the horizontal asymptote cuts the y-axis. (0, 0) satisfies the equation, so 0 = 1 + be0 b = 1. b Range of h: y [0, 1 e 2] 1 2 c h : [0, 1 e ] R, where h 1(x) = loge (1 x) y 7 a
3 2 1 0
2
1
1
2
3 (0, loge (5) 1)
1 2 3 4 5 6 x
(5 e , 0)
x 5
6
5
4
3
2
1
1 0 1 1
2 (
3
e
2, 0)
3
4 (
3 e
1 2,
0)
8 9 10 11
B 3 A C 6 D B 9 E D 12 D A 15 B B 18 B A 21 D B
b a $5000 b $5256.35 c $6420.15 d $6410.20 e 13.95 years f The first investment, because the interest is compounded continuously. g $9.95 h About $20 a 1 b 0.52, 516 metres c 16 metres d 3.6 kilometres a P = 101.3e 0.125x b 76.7 kPa a b = 5, c = 6 b x = loge (2) and loge (3) c (0.92, 0.25) d x = (loge (5), 6) e g: R R, g(x) = e2x + 5ex 6 2x f h: R R, h(x) = e 5e x + 6 g (log (2), 0) y
e
f 1 ( x) =
5 ex 1
(loge(3), 0) 0 (0, 2)
3 2 1
y 6
CHAPTER 5
Domain 3 y
(,
2), range R
f(x) y log 2x y log x x 3 4
Inverse functions
Exercise 5A Relations and their inverses y y b 1 a
5 4 3 2 1 0 123 x
8
5 7
b 15 000 c
2 1 2 0 1 1
Answers 5a 5A
1 1 2 x 0 1
(1, 1) x 5
(loge (5), 0)
Domain R, range (, 4]
R, R
R, R
Answers
683
y 2x 4y 8 4 x
y y x2 4x 4 0 x
c y=x
y
d y= 1 2x +
5 2
2 0
y
5 2
(1, 1) 0 x 5
( 2, 4)
R, R
R, [4, )
y
R, R e
2x
R, R f
y
+4
y= x+42
y 0 (
4,
2) x
1
1 0
1 1 yx
1
2
y (x 1)2 x
1 0
4 0 2 x
R, [1, )
y 2 x2 y2 4
R, [0, )
R, R
3 (1, 3) x
x
[4, ), R h y = 1 x
y 0
1 1 x
g y = x +1
y 1
1
1 0 x
0 2
2 x
1 0 ( 1, 3) 3
1
3 y
R\{0}, R\{0}
y x
4
[1, ), R i x2 + y2 = 4
y 2
[0, ), R j y= 3 x
y (3, 1)
R, {2}
y y 2x3
2 0 1 (1, 2) x
{4}, R
0 2
( 3, 1)
[2,
2], [2, 2] l
y
R\{0}, R\{0} y = 4
y 0 x
k x=2
x 4
{2}, R m y=
3
R, {4}
{1, 2, 5}, {0, 1, 3} b {(7, 8), (2, 5), (1, 2), (1, 1)}
y 1
1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 x
2
5
8
x 2
y 1 0 (2, 1) 2 x
R, R 3 A 4 C
684
Answers
5 a
x 2
yx
2 2 y
x y 2 yx
Exercise 5B Functions and their inverses 1 a Function b Function c Function d Function e Not a function f Function g Function h Function 2 a y
6 4 (0, 1)
4 (
2, 0) 0 2 (
4,
2) 2 3 x (3, 6) (2, 4)
(1, 3) (3, 1)
0 yx
4 yx 4 y 2
0 2
f
(1, 1)
y 5
yx
2 yx
2 6
(4, 0)
h
2 (1, 1)
5 2
R, R d
3 y 0 3 x
R, R e
y 4
1 1 2
yx
yx (1, 1)
y 4
yx 9
( 1, 1)
4 4
R, [9, ) f
y 4 (1, 4)
R, [0, ) g
8 x y
k
(
3, 3)
y yx 3 3 0 3 3 (3, 3) x
y yx
1 0 0 x (1, 4) 4
( 4, 16)
y 2 0 2 yx x
y yx 3 0 3 x
R\{0}, R\{0} h
y
1 2 1 (1, ) 2
R, [16, ) i
y
0 1
2 0 x
Answers 5B 5B
y 2 4 2 4
yx x
y 2
R, R
yx 1
R, R+
y
j
x
y 2
0 2
4 2 0 2 4
2 3
1 0 2
R+, R
Answers
685
3 a
y 3 2
(6, 3) (4, 2) 6 x
y
1 , 1) (
i
x
2
(
2,
4)
4
0 (1, 0) 4 (0, 2)
0 1
2
x
x
y y
) (0, 1 2
2x
y loge ( 2 )
k
ex y 1 2
R+, R
y 2
0 2
0 0
R, R d
y 3
R, R
+ R, R
4 a i
y o x9 0 x [
9, c), R
y yx 2 1 0 1 2 x
yx x
9 3
y= x+9 [9, ), R e
y
ii R, R iii R, R y c i
4 0 4
yx
ii R, R+ iii R+, R y d i
3 x 0 3 x
0 2
x y o x 2 [0, c), R
ii R, R+ iii R+, R i
y yx
y= x 2 [0, ), R f
y
0 3
x 0
y1 x x1
1 4 ( 4, 1) 0 1
(4, 1) 4
4 y x
yx 3 x
y 1 0 1 4
yx
R\{0}, R\{0}
y
(1, 4)
( 16, 4)
x y = o x 16 4 [ 16, c), R
ii R, R iii R, R i
y 5 yx 5 x
ii iii ii iii
8 5 0 5
y = x + 16 4 [16, ), R
686
Answers
y 6 yx
2 2 0 2 2 6 x
iii iv v c i d i e i f i ii
(0, 0) R, R R, R f 1 does not exist f 1 does not exist f 1 does not exist one-to-one, f 1 exists
y y (x 1)3 yx
k i
x 3
y 2
yx
ii ), R iii R, (3, )
(3,
(0, 1) ( 1, 0)
y (1, 0) (0, 1)
x 1 x
3 2
0 2 3
y 4 3 2 3 2 0 2
(3, 4)
yx (4, 3)
iii iv v g i ii
1 2 3 4 5
5 6 7 8 9
D A E B a f 1 : [3, ) R, f 1 (x) =
1
b f
: (2, ) R, f
= loge x 2 + 1 3
( )
yx
( x + 3) + 2
iii iv v h i i i j i ii None R\{0}, R\{0} R\{0}, R\{0} f 1 does not exist f 1 does not exist one-to-one, f 1 exists
x
2 y y e4x
2 yx (0, 0.17) (
1, 0) (0.17, 0) (0,
1) y
2 x
(1, 0) (0, )
1 4
y x 4 x
iii (
1, 1 3 3)
iv R, R v R, R b i one-to-one, f 1 exists y 6x y ii
(1, 6) yx
iii iv v k i ii
Answers 5c 5c
x1
y e0.5x 1 yx
y1 x (2, 0) x
y 2 loge (x 1)
Answers
687
iii None iv (1, ), R v R, (1, ) 2 i a, e, g, i, j, k, l, m, n, o ii a f 1(x) = x 4 3 e f 1(x) = 3 2 x g f 1(x) = x2 + 2, where x [0, ) i f 1(x) = loge x 1 2 j f 1(x) = 2 + loge (5 x)
h f 1 : [0, 1] R, f 1 (x) = 1 x 2 i f 1 : [0, ) R, f 1 (x) = x2 + 4 j f 1 : [4, ) R, f 1 (x) = 1 + x 4 k f 1 : R+ R, f 1 (x) = 2 + loge (x) l f 1 : R R, f 1 (x) = e 2 + 5 3 a B b C c D 4 a y
6 5 0 yx 5 6 f(x) x
x
( )
d A
m f 1(x) =
1
x e2
+4
n f (x) = 3 x 3) o f 1(x) = 1 2 (e Function Domain a b c d e f g h R [1, ) [3, 3] R R R [5, 5] R+ Range R R [0, 3] R+ [10, ) (0, ) [0, 8] R b b b b d f h Inverse of function Domain R R [0, 3] R+ [10, ) (0, ) [0, 8] R Range R [1, ) [3, 3] R R R [5, 5] R+ c
( x 1) e 2
f 1(x) (3, 0) x
( 1, 0) yx
0 (0, 1)
f(x)
4 a B 5 a C 6 a D 7 a (, 0] or [0, ) c [1, ) e R g [1, 5] or [5, 9] i (, 5) or (5, ) Exercise 5D Restricting 1 a [0, ) or (, 0] c [3, ) e (, 4) or (4, ) g [5, 0] or [0, 5] i [4, ) k R 2 a f b f c f d f e f f f g f
1 1 1 1 1
0 yx f 1(x)
y 3 f 1(x) 0 yx 3 x
: [3, ) R, f
(x) = (x) =
1 1 1
(x) = (x) =
1 1
1 1
: [5, 0] R, f
(x) = 25 x 2
688
Answers
g
y4 f
1(x)
10 g 1 : [3, 5] R, g 1 (x) =
4 ( x 3)2 or
1 0 x
1 f(x) x4
4 x (4, 4)
yx
h
f
1(x)
y 5 3 (2, 5) (5, 2)
2 a
6
y 0 6 6 x
2 0 2 x
4 yx 4
0 1
3 f(x)
y 0 1 x
f
1(x) 1 0
( 4, 4) 4
4 0 x
yx
(4,
c R or R+
1 y x 2
0 5
10
x (31, 2)
2 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 2 4 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 x
7 a f
: R R, f
y
1 2
b x 8 a
c x
(x) = 12 x
Answers 5d 5d
f(x) 0 x
y
1 2
1(x)
y
f(x) 0 yx
1 2
0.4 0.2 0 2
Answers
689
c i Many-to-one ii x 0 iii y = x + 1 1, x 0 iv
y 1.5 1 0.5
0.8
0.6
0.4
0.2 0
0.5 y |(x
2x
6 a
x2
b f 1(x) = ex 1 + 2 c m = 1
0 )|
2 2.4
(2, ), R y d
y x 1
1 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 1 1.2 1.4 1.6 1.8 x 2.4 0 (1, 3) 2.4 x yx
R, (2, )
e (3, 1)
e i One-to-one iv
y 3e 1
x
iii y = log e x 1 3
( )
5 2
y 4 3 2 1 1 2 3 4 x y ln
x
1 3
8 a b = 1 c d
y 0 1
h 1 :[0,
1 1 ] R, e2
y h
h 1 ( x) =
0 3 2 1 1 2 3
f i One-to-one 2 +2 iii y = 3( x + 1) iv y
8 6 2 y (3(x 1)) 2 4 2
9 a f b
1 :( 1, )
R, f 1 ( x ) = 1 2 log e ( x + 1)
y x
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 x y (3(x
2))
1
2
5 4 3 2 120 4 6 8
( 1, 1)
2x 2x + 1 E A D A 3 7 11 15 C C D D 4 8 12 16 C A C A
g i Many-to-one iii y = 1 3 x 1 y iv
y
1
2
(x 3)
4 1 1 2
y
1
(.5)
(x 1)
3
3 2 1 0 2
1 2 3 4
852 000 x + 3 079 777 1127 426 b The inverse is not a function because it is a one-tomany relation (does not pass the vertical line test).
690
Answers
2 a 36 c 13 d 8 3 4 5 6 7 g j a d g j a d g j a d g a b
8 15
b 12 e 1.12c
2 c 3 f 1.38c
y 4 yx
4 A ( , 4) 3 3
( 2, 2)
4 x
e Heart-shaped f i [2, 3 ) ii f : [ 2, g i [4 3, 4]
1 4 3) 4 1 2( x 4)
4.10c h 4.54c i 5.41c 6.11c 0.389 b 0.717 c 0.170 0.129 e 0.246 f 0.916 0.966 h 0.927 i 0.940 0.996 k 11.430 l 1.732 0 b 0 c 1 1 e Undefined f Undefined 1 h 0 i 1 1 k Undefined l 0 1 b 1 c 1 1 e 1 f 1 2 h 5 sin (240), sin (150), sin (35), sin (120), sin (70) cos (3.34), cos (1.5), cos (5.3), cos (0.2), cos (6.3)
3 5
R, where f (x) = 2( x 4) 3
8
f(x) exx2 yx
3 4
9 D 11
10 B
13.5 C, 15.8 C
3 2 2 2 2 2 3 2 2 2
2 2 1 2
3 3 3 3
e h k
f i 1 l c f i l c
g j 2 a d
d e f g a
1 2 2 2 3 2 2 2
3 3 3 3
1
1 2 1 2 2 2
e h k
g j
1 2 1 2 3 2 3 2
Answers 6a 6B
b a = 3 c x = 5.50 d a = 4.97
3 3
2.4
3 a 0.3 d 91 10 91 10
b 0.5 e
CHAPTER 6
f 2.4 i
2.4
g 0.3 j
h 0.5 k
l 2.4 o 2.4
m 0.3
n 0.5
Answers
691
5 a
5 a c 6 a d g j
1 2
3 3 , 2 3 , 3 b
b d 2 2 3 2 3 2 2 2 3 2 3 2
1 2
or
2 ,1 2
3 1 , 2 2 c
1 2 3 2 2 2 3 2 3 2 3 2 2 2
f 1 i l
h k n
3 3
m 7 2 8 a
o 1
b e
c f i l
d g j
3 2 2 2 1 2
3 3
1 2 1 2
2
h k
5 3 , b , 6 6 2 2 4 5 7 c , d , 3 3 4 4 6 a 0, 180, 360 b 105, 165, 285, 345 c 45, 75, 165, 195, 285, 315 d 20, 40, 140, 160, 260, 280 e 62.40, 117.60, 182.40, 237.60, 302.40, 357.60 f 39.44, 140.56, 219.44, 320.56 g 26.39, 333.61 h 101.22, 258.78 7 a b 0, 2 c 2.7184 2 5 13 17 25 29 , , , , , d 0.9772 e 18 18 18 18 18 18 7 9 15 17 23 , , , , , f 12 12 12 12 12 12 5 7 17 19 g , , , h 1.2579, 5.0253 12 12 12 12 3 7 b 8 a 2 2 16 11 c d 3 3 e 19.7766 f 6.9266 9 a The particle is 3 metres from O. b It takes the particle 1.99 seconds to reach O for the first time. 11 11 10 a x = , , , 6 6 6 6
b x = c x = 11 5 7 , , , 6 6 6 6
7 5
2 1 1 1 1 9 + = + =1 2 2 2 2 10 a 0.7 b 0.3 d 0.3 e 0.7 g 0.7 h 0.3 j 0.3 k 0.7 11 C 12 D 13 a 10 cm/s b 11 cm/s 14 a 0.9 m b 0.3 m
3 , , 4 4
11 x = 12 x =
11 7 5 , , , 12 12 12 12 9 ,
5
5 7 , , 9 9 9
13 a x = b x = c x =
7 , 6 6 5 9 13 , , , 8 8 8 8
3 5 7 , b , 4 4 2 2 3 5 7 e , 2 6 6 90 b 60, 300 180 e 45, 135 2.2904, 3.9928, 8.5736, 10.2760 1.1442, 1.9973, 7.4274, 8.2805 1.0701, 5.2130, 7.3533, 11.4962 3.5217, 5.9031, 9.8049, 12.1863 15.58, 164.42 137.91, 222.09 212.90, 327.10 78.83, 281.17
7 c , 4 4
c 60, 120
692
Answers
2 a
2 2 2 , 2, to 3 3 3
6 a 1, 2, 0 to 2 y
2 1 0 1 2
P 2
3P 2
2P x
3P 2
2P Q
b 1, 2, 2 to 0 y
0.5 0
0.5
1
1.5
2
P
b 4, 2, 4 to 4 y
4 2 0
2
4
P 2
c 3, , 3 to 3
y 3 2 1 0 1 2 3
P 4
P 2
2P x
3P 2
c 2, 2, 4 to 0 y
3P 4
PQ
d 2,
y 2 1 0
1
2
2 , 2 to 2 3
0 1 2 3 4
2P x
d 2, 2, 1 to 5 y
5 4 3 2 1
P 6
P 3
P 2
2P Q 3
e 1,
1 2
2 1 , to 3 2
2 , 2 to 0 3
P 2
3P 2
2P x
1 2
f
y 0.4 0.2
1 3,
1 3
to
1 3
2P x 3
2P Q 3
0 0.2 0.4
P 4
P 2
3P 4
P Q
f 1, , 0 to 2 y
2.5 2 1.5 1 0.5
g 4, 4, 4 to 4 y
4 2 0
2
4
P 2P
h 3, 6, 3 to 3
y 3 2 1 0
1 2 3
P 2P 3P 4P 5P 6P Q
0.5
0 P
4
P 2
3P 4
3P
4P Q
g 3,
2 , 5 to 1 3
y
3 4,
2 3 , 4
1
1
2
3
4
5
P x
Answers 6c 6d
to 4
4 2, , 2 to 2
y 2 1
P P 0
P
2
1 2
0 P
6
P 3
P 2
2P x 3
y 4 2 0
2
4
P 2
3P P 2
2P Q
1 , 2
, 2.5 to 3.5
y 3 2 1 0
P 4
P 2
5 a to the left, up 3 b to the right, up 1 3 2 to the right, down 2 d to the left, down 1 c 4 3
3P 4
P x
Answers
693
i 3, 4, 1 to 7 y
6 4 2 0
P
2 g ,1 3 y
2.5 2 1.5 1
1 0
1.5
2
2.5
P 2
2P
3P
4P x
j 2, 6, 3 to 1 y
1 0 P 2P 3P 4P 5P 6P x
1
2
3
3P 2
2P Q
h , 2 y
1
1
2
3
4
0 P P 3P P 5P 3P 7P 2P Q 4 2 4 4 2 4
7 a 2, 1 y
1.5 1 0.5 0P P 3P P 5P 3P 7P 2P Q
0.5 4 2 4 4 2 4
1
1.5
i 2, 2 y
1
1
2
3 0 P P 3P P 5P 3P 7P 2P Q 4 2 4 4 2 4
b 2, 1 y
1.5 1 0.5 0
0.5
1
1.5
j 4, 1 y
P
P 2
3P 2
2P Q
2.5 2 1.5 1
c 2, 3 y
3 2 1
1 0 1.5 2 2.5
2P Q
0 1 2 3
P P P P 2P 4P 5P P 7P 4P 9P 5P11 6 3 2 6 6 6 3 6 3 6
8 a 4, , 4 to 4 2 c 2, , 2 to 2 3 e 3, , 2 to 4 9 g a d g
b 3, 4, 3 to 3
d 2, 2 y
3 2 1
d 1, 6, 1 to 1 f 5, , 7 to 3 2 1, 2, 1 to 1 h 1, 2, 1 to 1 1, 1 b 1, 1 c 3, 3 2, 2 e 2, 2 f 3, 3 5, 3 h 1, 3 i 1, 5
1 k 2 1 2, 12
1 2 3
P 2
3P 2
2P Q
j 5, 3 10 a 2, 1, 1 to 1 y
1.5 1 0.5
0.5
1
1.5 0
P 2
3 2 , 4 1 3 3
e , 2 y
3 2 1
3P 2
2P x
2 ,3 3
y 3 2 1 0
1
2
3
P 2
0 1 2 3
P 2
3P 2P Q 2
b 2, 1, 1 to 1 y
1.5 1 0.5 0
0.5 1 1.5
P 2
3P 2
2P x
c 2, 2, 2 to 2 y
P
3P 2
2P Q
2 1
0 1 2
P 2
3P 2
2P x
694
Answers
d 2, 3, 3 to 3 y
3 2 1 1 2 3 0
P 2
3P 2
2P x
e , 3, 3 to 3 y
3 2 1
b Period =
0 2 4 y 2 1 0 1 2 y 2 1 0 1 2 y 2 1 0 1 2
P x
P
4
P
2
0 P P 3P P 5P 3P 7P 2P x 1 4 2 4 4 2 4 2 3
c Period =
2 , 1, 1 to 1 3
y 1
P
6
x P
3
d Period =
0 1
P 2
3P 2
2P
P
8
P
4
e Period = 4
g 2, 4, 3 to 5 y
4 2 0
2
P 2
y 2 1 0
1
2
2P 4P x
f Period = 3
P
3P 2
2P x
y 2 1 0
1
2
3P 2 3P
h , 2, 4 to 0 y
0
1
2
3
4
P 2
3P 2
2P x
g Period = 2
y 3 2 1 0 1 2 3 y 5 0
P 4 P 2
2 1 1 i , , to 1 1 2 3 2 2 y
1.5 1 0.5 0
0.5
P 2P P 3 3
2P x
h Period =
4P 5P 2P x 3 3
j 2, 1, 1 to 3 y
3 2 1
i Period = 4
5 y 2 1 0 1 2
Answers 6e 6e
) + 1 12 y = 2 cos 3 (x ) + 1 3 4 2 )2 13 y = 3 sin (x 3 4 a 1 1 b 12 c 3 metres d 1 metre e 3.00 am and 3.00 pm x f 9.00 am and 9.00 pm g y = sin + 2 6
11 y = sin (x +
P 2
3P 2
2P x
P 8
x P 4
j Period = 2
y 1
1 3
1 3
2P x
Answers
695
3 ii Dilated by factor of 2 from the x-axis and by factor of 1 3 from the y-axis b ii Period = 4 ii Dilated by factor of 1 4 from the y-axis; reflected in the x-axis; translated 1 unit up c i Period = 2 ii Dilated by factor of 3 from the x-axis and by factor of 1 2 from the y-axis; translated 4 units down d i Period = 2 ii Dilated by factor of 2 from the y-axis; reflected in the x-axis; translated 2 units down e i Period = ii Dilated by factor of 5 from the x-axis; reflected in the x-axis; translated units to the left 2 f i Period = 2 ii Dilated by factor of 1 2 from the y-axis; translated units to the right 4 g i Period = 3 ii Dilated by factor of 1 4 from the x-axis and by factor 1 of 3 from the y-axis; translated units to the left 6 h i Period = 3 1 ii Dilated by factor of 2 from the x-axis and by factor of 3 from the y-axis; reflected in the x-axis; translated 6 units up i i Period = 4 ii Dilated by factor of 1 4 from the y-axis; translated 12 units to the right and 1 3 units down j i Period = ii Dilated by factor of 2 from the x-axis; translated 3 units to the left and 5 units up y 3 a Period =
2 a i Period =
2 1 0
1
2
P
2
d Period =
y 2 1 0 1 2
P 2 P
x =P
e Period = 4
y 1 0
P 2
P x
f Period = 6
y 1 0
P 2
2.78 P x
g Period = 2
y 1 0 1
P 2
h Period =
y 4 3 2 1
2.21 P x x P
i Period =
0 P P 7P P x 3P P 5P 3
1 P 8 4 8 2 8 4 8
2
3
4 y 3 2 1 0 P
1 24
2
3 y 3 2 1 0
1
2
3
P 7 24 P 13 24 PP 19 24
j Period = 2
P 2
P x
P x
b Period =
y 2 1 0
1
2
3
P 4 P 2
3 P 4
P x
c Period =
y 2 1 0
1
2
P 4 P 2 P 3 4
P x
Exercise 6F Finding equations of trigonometric graphs 1 a 3, 2, y = 3 sin (2x) b 2, , y = 2 sin ( x) 6 6 2 a 2, 4, y = 2 cos (4x) b 2, , y = 2 cos ( x) 3 3 1 3 a 1 2 , 1, 1, y = 2 sin (x) + 1 b 3, , 2, y = 3 sin ( x) 2 4 4 4 a 4, 2, , y = 4 cos 2(x ) 2 2 b 5, 2, , y = 5 cos 2(x ) 4 4 5 a 2, 1, , 1, y = 2 sin (x + ) 1 3 3 b 3, 1, , 2, y = 3 sin (x + ) + 2 2 2 6 a 1, , 3, y = 3 cos ( x) 6 6
696
Answers
3P 2
2P x
0 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 t
3P 2
c
t
2 4 to 6 85.00 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 d 1.00 am am Saturday, 1.00 pm to 5.00 pm Saturday, 1.00 am to 5.00 am Sunday morning e 3.00 am to 5.00 am Sunday 3 a 18C, 14.5C b 25C, January, December c 21.5C d 8 months 4 a 0.9, , 0.9, h = 0.9 sin ( t) + 0.9 b c 1.3 seconds h
y 2 1 0
1
2 y 2 1
1
2 y 2 1
1
2 0
P 2
3P 2
2P x
P 2
3P 2
2P x
0 P 2
3P 2
5 a 2, 1
2 6 a 18, 16, 3
b 8 m, 8 f 2 t) 3 d 2 m f 26 m
y 2 1
1
2 0 P
2
3P 2P x 2
2 g h(t) = 18 16 cos (t + 1) 3 h y
30 25 20 15 10 5 0 0.5 1 1.5 2 2.5 3 3.5 4 4.5 5 5.5 x
y 2 1
1
2 0 P
2 3P P 2
2P x
y 2 1
1
2 0 P 2
3P 2P x P 2
7 a 10 d 20
b 24
Answers 6f 6h
2 a
y 2P P 0
2P x
y 1 0 1 2 3 4 5
P 2
P 3 2
2P
h 13C
Answers
697
y 0 2 4 6 8 10 12 y 10 8 6 4 2 2 0 y 0 5 15 20 25 30 35
P 2
P 3 2
2P x
P 2
P 3 2
2P x
y 6 4 2 0
P 2
P 2 P 2
P 3 2
3 P 2
2P
P 3 2
2P x
2P x
y 3 2 1 0
P 2
P 3 2
2P x
f
y 0
P 2
h
P
P 3 2
2P
y 5 4 3 2 1 0 P P 3P P 5P 3P 7P 2P x 4 2
4 4 2 4
y 5 0
5
10
15
20
P 2
4 a
P
3 P 2
2P
y 3 2 1 0
P 2
P 3 2
2P x
y 3 2 1 10 2 3 4 5
P 2
y 3 2 1 0
1
P 2
P 3 2
2P x
P 3 2
2P
3 a
y 1 0
1
P 2
y 3 2 1 0
P 2
P 3 2
2P x
P 3 2
2P x
5 a Domain: R y
3 2 1 (2.03, 0.91)
P 2
y 2 1 0
P 2
P 3 2
2P x
y 1 0
1
P 2
0 1 2
P 3 2
2P x
(4.91, 2.41)
b Domain: R
P
P 2P x 3 2
y 3 2 1 0
1
P 2
y 5 4 3 2 (2.03, 0.91) 1 0
1
P 2
P 3 2
2P x
P 3 2
2P x
(3.52, 2.34)
698
Answers
c Domain: R+
y 3 2 1 0 1 2 3 4 5
P 2
(2.13, 1.92)
P 3 2
2P x
0 (1, 0)
x0
(4.84, 4.69)
d Domain: R+ {0}
y 3 2 1 0
1
2
3
4
5 (
1, 0) 0 (1, 0) x (
0.58,
0.38) (0.58,
0.38) 2P x
(1.65, 1.28)
P 2
P 3 2
y ( 1.7, 2.7) ( 2, 0)
(3.29, 3.59)
e Domain: R y
4 2 0
2
4
P 2
P 3 2
2P x
y (0, 1) 0 (1, 0) x
f Domain: R y
0 2 4 6
P 3 2
2P x
(4.05, 3.98) 0
g Domain: R y
3 2 (.18, 1.02) 1 0
1
2
P 2
(2P, 3.14)
(3.32, 1.8)
P 3 2
h Domain: R (, 2] y
1 (1.27, .51) 2 x
0 P P P 2P 3 2 1 2 2 ( 3.5, 2.3)
Answers 6h 6h
P 3 2
2P x
6 a
( 2, 0)
0 0 x
(0,
2)
0 1 2
P 3 2
2P x
(5.55, 1)
( 11 , 1.09) 3
c ii f (g(x)) = 2 sin (
x2 ); domain f (g(x)) = R 4
Answers
699
iii
y 2 (2.51, 2) 1 0
1
2
P 2
(5.6, 2)
P 3 2
2P x
(4.34, 2)
b i ii iii
Both f (g(x)) and g( f (x)) are defined. f (g(x)) = x 2 1 g( f(x)) = x 2 1 Domain is R Domain is R Range is [0, ) Range is [ 1, )
y f (g(x))
(0, 1)
P 3 2
2P x
( 1, 0) 0
(1, 0)
x g(f(x))
P 3 2
2P x
(
1, 0) 0 (1, 0) (0,
1)
f ii f (g(x)) = iii y
2 1 0
1
P 2
2cos (2x);
domain f (g(x)) = R
P 3 2
2P x
c i ii iii
Both f (g(x)) and g( f (x)) are defined. f (g(x)) = 1 e2x g( f (x)) = e(1 x Domain is R Domain is R Range is ( , 1) Range is (0, e)
y
y1
x2
(0, 0) x
(5.01, 1)
P 3 2
2P x
P 3 2
2P x
8 a i Both f(g(x)) and g( f (x)) are defined. ii f(g(x)) = ex 2 g( f (x)) = ex 2 Domain is R Domain is R Range is (2, ) Range is (0, ) iii y
f (g(x))
d i Only g( f (x)) is defined. ii g( f (x)) = sin ( x ) Domain is [0, ), Range is [1, 1] iii y
(2.47, 1) g(f(x)) ( 2, 0) 0 x
(0.69, 0) 0 (0, 1) y 2 x
e i Both f (g(x)) and g( f (x)) are defined. g( f (x)) = cos (ex) ii f (g(x)) = ecos (x) Domain is R Domain is R Range is [ 1, e] Range is [1, 1] e y iii
(
, 1 ) e
2 (0, e) (2 , e) f(g(x)) 1) ( , e x 0 2 g(f(x)) x
g(f(x))
(0, 0.14) 0
y 1 0 1
700
Answers
f i Only g( f(x)) is defined. ii g( f (x)) = sin (loge (x)) Domain is (0, ), Range is [1, 1] iii y (4.8, 1)
1 g(f(x)) 0
1 5 10 15 20 x
b Amplitude = 3, period = 2 c y
5 4 3 2 1 0
1
P 2
P 3 2
2P
y 4
2 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 m
b 20.9C 2 a 100 b M
25000 20000 15000 10000 5000
c December 2008
0 P P 3P 4 2 4 2
10
20
30
40
50
60 t
c d a c
2 x 8 a = 3, n = 1 1 2 , c = 1; y = 3 sin 2 9 a y
Period =
8
5 2 0 6 12 18 24 x
c f i l c f i
e 2 5 3 7 k 6 h b 2 2
4 3 2 5 4 7 4
3 3 3 2 2 2
b 10 am, 2 pm, 10 pm, 2 am c Water sports may run between 10 am and 2 pm. 10 y
2 1 0
P 2
3 P
2
2P
11
y 12 10 8 6 4 2 0
2 y sin (x)
P
1 2 2 2 2 2
y 2x y sin (x) 2x
e 0 h 3 3 b 0.85 d 0.85
2P
Answers 6i 6i
12
y 6 4 2 0
2
4
6
P
yx y sin x 2P x
(6 n + 1) 7 13 19 ,x=, , , , 12 12 12 12 12
6 a y = sin (x) is dilated 3 units from the x-axis, and translated 4 units to the right and 2 units up.
y x sin x
Answers
701
13 a b c 14 a b
Teacher to check. Show that range g domain f . f (g(x)) = sin (x2 + 2) Domain f(g(x)) = R, range f(g(x)) = [1, 1] amp = 5 period = p
y 5 4 3 2 1
5
4
3
2
1 0
1
2
3
4
5 1 2 3 4 5 x
Exam practice 2 Short answer 1 x = 4 1 2 2 x = -2 3 a f(x) = e-x - 2 + 3 1 b ( 2 + 3, 4) e 1 4 a Dilation of 2 vertically and 2 horizontally, translation of left 3 1 b y = sin 2( x + ) 2 3 5 9 3 or 5 x = , 4 12 12 12
6 [3, ) 7 x = loge (2) 8 a y
2 1
0.8
0.4 0
1
2 f(x) x sin (x) y sin (x) 0.4 0.8 1.2 1.6 2 2.4 2.8 x
Multiple choice 1 E 3 D 5 B 7 C 9 E 11 A 13 C
2 4 6 8 10 12 14
A C D B D E B
y x
Extended response 1 a 5, 5, 6 and , D(t) = 5 5 sin (t + 6) 12 12 b 5, 1.46 c 8.30 am and 3.30 pm. 8.30 am the next day. d 8.27 am or 8.46 hours after midnight and 3.32 pm or 15.54 hours after midnight. Differences occur due to inaccuracy of graphical methods. e D(t) = 10 5 sin (t + 6) 12 2 a 1.5 m b 19.5 m c 18 m d 60 s 3 e i m/s ii 0.94 m/s 10 f f (m)
19.5 10.5 1.5
b 0 c 1.8 Multiple choice 1 E 2 C 3 C 4 B 5 D 6 B 7 E Extended response a 200 birds b 12 months c 300 birds d 7 months e a = 200, b = , c = 2, d = 300 6 f 473g A = 500, k = 0.005 018 P ( x )Q( x ) h Consider the graph of . 500
CHAPTER 7
Differentiation
Exercise 7A Review gradient and rates of change y y 1 a b
1 0 f ' (x) 0 x
3 f ' (x) x
0 1 2
30
60
y 0 1
2
d
x f ' (x)
y f ' (x)
5 2
y f ' (x) 0 x
702
Answers
2 a B 3 a
g'(x) x
b C b
i i n/a j i n/a 8 a
x g'(x)
y 1 0
iv x = 0 iv x = 0
x f'(x)
g'(x) x
g'(x) 3 x
d
x g'(x)
g'(x) 4 x
e
2 0 g'(x) x
y 0 x
2 0
x f '(x)
4 a B 5 a
b A b
g
x
f '(x)
g'(x)
x f ' (x)
2 y
1 0
d
x f ' (x)
f ' (x)
f '(x) 0 x
y 1 0 1 x f '(x)
y 0 x
3 f '(x)
x f '(x)
a d g j
c R f R\{0} i R\{5}
f '(x)
6 a 7 a b c d e f g h
D b C i Not applicable (n/a) iii n/a i n/a ii n/a i x = 1 ii ( , 1) i x = 4 ii (4, ) i x = 0 ii n/a i x = 2 and x = 3 iii ( , 2) (3, ) i x = 2 ii R\{2} i x = 1 and x = 2 iii (1, 2) iv n/a
Answers
703
Answers 7a 7B
8 a 9 a 10 C 11 a d 12 a d
b 4 b 10 2x 6x 2x + 3 5 6x2 c 2x + 6 f 3x2 c 6x + 8 f 2x 2
d i 8x3 + 12x2 + 6x + 1 ii iii 6(2x + 1)2 e i 9x2 + 6x + 1 ii iii 6(3x + 1) f i 27x3 + 27x2 + 9x + 1 ii iii 9(3x + 1)2 13 na(ax + b)n 1 Exercise 7D The chain rule 1 a i 5x 4 ii b i 3x + 1 ii c i 2x + 3 ii d i 7 4x ii e i 5x + 3 ii f i 4 3x ii 2 B 3 a i 2u ii iii 6(3x + 2) b i 3u2 ii iii 3(7 x)2 1 c i 2 ii u d i e i f g h i
4 u5
1 2 4 6 4 3
2 (2 x 5)2
ii 2 ii 5 ii 3
8 (4 2 x )5 5 2 5x + 2
1 2 u
4x
2
3 2u 2
9
3
2(3 x 2) 2
1 2 x
1
2 + x 3 3
i 1 + 2 x
4 5x3
4
m x 2 4 3 x 4 a 5 D 7 3 4 8 a 9 a
1 5 8 1 3 2
10x4
10
1 + 2x f x2 3 h x 2 3 j 4 x 2 1 6 3 l 3 x x2 1 1 5 n 2 x 4x 4 b 150 6 C
b Undefined b 1
2 15 8716
c 467 54 b d
1 43 1 412
53
ii 4x + 5 i 15u4 iii 15(4x + 5)(2x2 + 5x)4 i 2u 3 ii 4 6x iii 4(2 3x)(4x 3x2) 3 x2 1 i i 6u5 ii x2 5 1 6( x 2 1) x + x iii 2 x j i 16u 5 ii 6 iii 96(5 6x) 5 4 C 5 A 6 B 7 a 32(8x + 3)3 b 6(2x 5)2 3x c 15(4 3x)4 d 3x 2 4 2 2 e ( x 2)( x 2 4 x ) 3 f 2(6x2 + 1)(2x3 + x) 3 3 1 1 g 6 1 + 2 x x x 8
2 5
10 a g ( x) = c 12 a b c
1 412
+ 4
3x 3 11 Teacher to check i iii i iii i iii x2 + 2x + 1 2(x + 1) x3 + 3x2 + 3x + 1 3(x + 1)2 4x2 + 4x + 1 4(2x + 1)
ii 2x + 2 ii 3x2 + 6x + 3 ii 8x + 4
2x2
704
Answers
11 37 500 13 a 2 c 1 7 14 4 16 4 15 9 17 7
2
12 b d 1 18 5
x 1 3 3e 6e3x
7 500
or 0.014 x 1
6 a d g
4 x
x2
2x +3
c f i l
3x 2 + 4 x 7 x3 + 2x 2 7x 2 4x 3 1 x+3 3 4 + 3x
x2 2x + 1
a d g a d g j A a d g a
10e10x
ex 2x
b e h b e h k
x 1 4 4e 20e5x 11x
j 7 a c
e2
+1
8 E
2ex b 9e3x + 6e2x c 20e 4x + 10 3ex 2e x e 6e2x 7e 7x f 36e9x 2ex ex h 20e5x + 4x (2 x + 3)e x +3 x b (2 x 3)e x 3 x 1
2 2 2
c 2( x 1)e x
2 x
5e 2 5 x
2
f 3( x 2 + 1)e x
+3 x 2
2
7 x
h 10(1 + 3 x )e1 2 x 3 x j l
4 ( 4 x )3 e ( 4 x )
3x + 4
3e
Exercise 7G The derivatives of sin ( x ), cos ( x ) and tan ( x ) 1 a 8 cos (8x) b 6 cos (6x) c cos (x) d
2
2 3x + 4
1 3
+ 3 x )2
x cos 3 2x cos 3
1 2
x cos 2
2 3
log e ( x )
1 x 1 d x 1 h x
2 a 3 sin (3x) d
b 2 sin (2x)
1 8
c f
1 3
x sin 3 2x sin 5
x e 4 sin 4
x sin 8
2 5
c C c 3 3x 4
5 5 or 3 5x 5x 3
4 5 6 7
a d a a a
b e b b
Answers 7c 7g
c 5 cos (5x 4) e 102 cos (2 x) h 30 5x + 2 8 a 3 sin (3x 2) c 5 sin (6 5x) e 402 sin (10 x)
3x + 2 cos 4 3x cos 8
3 2
16 i 2x 1
48 j 12 x + 5
63 k 8 9x
Answers
705
1 2
cos (8 x ) 2 d cos2 ( x + 1)
10 a b c d
2(2 x) sin (x2 4x + 3) (2x 5) cos (10 5x + x2) ex cos (ex) (2x + 7) sin (x2 + 7x) 4 2x e cos2 (4 x x 2 ) 2x + 3 f cos 2 ( x 2 + 3 x ) g 1 sin (loge (x)) x h 4e4x cos (e4x) 1 1 i sin x x2 2 j cos (loge (2x 1)) 2x 1 3x k 6e sin (2e3x) 3 l sin (loge (10x)) x 4 x (3 x + 4) m cos2 ( x 3 + 2 x 2 ) 24 n 3x 5 cos2 5
1 2
33xe3x 5x cos (3x + 1) 3x5 sin (3x + 1) 6x2 loge (7x) + 2x2 2e 2 x 2x 2e loge (2x 5) + 2x 5 40 log e (5 x ) 8 tan (5 x ) h + x cos2 (5 x ) i 5 cos (2x) cos (x) 10 sin (2x) sin (x) d e f g
4 4 3
5e3x
e4 x 3 x l 20e 5x sin (2 x) 4e 5x cos (2 x) cos (6 x ) 6 sin (6x ) m x 2 x3 n o 3 xe 3 x 2 x 4 6x sin (2x + 3) + 4x 3 cos (2x + 3) 6 xe 2 x 2x 2e loge (3x2 + 5) + 2 3x + 5 3x 3x 8x + 12e 2xe + 3 x 2 e 3 x 3 4x + 9x2 + 16x 18 e
3x
p q r 5
3 4
+ 2 loge (4)
x sin 4
p 2(x + 1) sin (x2 + 2x) + 3 cos (3x 9) 11 3.745 2 0 1 13 a i cos (x) esin (x) b i sin (x) ecos (x) c i ii ii
1 3e 3 2 e or 2 2
cos ( x ) or cot (x) ii 3 sin ( x ) 1 sin ( x ) d i or tan (x) ii cos ( x ) 3 Exercise 7H The product rule 1 a u = x + 3, v = 2x2 5x du dv b =1, = 4x 5 dx dx c 6x2 + 2x 15 2 a 4x2 + 12x2 loge (6x) or 4x2 (1 + 3 loge (6x)) 3x 2 + 3 loge (2x) b x 3 D 4 a cos (x) x sin (x) b 3 sin (x) + 3x cos (x) c 3ex + 5xex
1 e 2
3 2
( x ) + cos ( x )) ex
d f
e 2 x (2 x 1) x2 2 g cos2 (2 x ) h i
706
Answers
j k l m n o
+ 2) ( x 2 + 3 x 2)2
10 x 3
4( x 2
3 a e b c d e f g h
5x
+ 6 x 2 35 x + 7 e5 x
2 (3 x + 1)3 3 x +1 2(3 x) sin (x2 6x) ex (cos (2x) 2 sin (2x)) 2 cos2 (2 x ) cos ( x ) sin 2 ( x ) 3 cos (3 x ) sin (3 x )
2
3x 2 + 5 2 x3
9( x + 3)e 3 x
(3 x
+ 8)2
4[ x 2 2( x 1) log e (8 x )] x 2 ( x 2)2
i 4(6 x 5) e3 x 5 x + 2 j 3x2 + 8x 2 k ex (x2 + 2x + 3) (4 x 3 9 x 2 50)(2 x + 3)4 l ( x 3 5)2 4x m 4e [cos (4x 3) + sin (4x 3)] n 6 cos (3x) sin (3x) 3 sin (3 x ) o cos (3 x ) 2(2 x 4 cos ( x 4 ) sin ( x 4 )) x3 2 q sin 2 (2 x ) p r s 20 [log e (5 x 1)]3 5x 1
15 0
Exercise 7J Mixed problems on differentiation 1 a C b P c Q d Q e P f Q g C h P i C j C k Q l C m C n Q 1 2 a x b 3 (sin (x) + x cos (x)) 3 x 14 c 4 x3 4 (cos ( x ) + x sin ( x )) d cos2 ( x ) e e5x (5 sin (x) + cos (x)) x (2 x + 9) log e ( x ) x 2 9 x + 8 x (log e ( x ))2 g 2(2 x) sin (x2 4x) 1 h e x ( loge (5x)) x cos ( x ) i or cot (x) sin ( x ) f j 2 sin (x) cos (x) k l 3x ex
1 2 log e ( x ) 2x2 5 x+3 t cos x2 ( x 2)2 u 3x4 [5 cos (2x + 1) 2x sin (2x + 1)] v 3 4 log e x 3 2 3 2x w (sin (x) + x cos (x)) ex sin (x) x 6 cos (x) sin (x) 7e 7x 3x2 2 2e 2 x z 3 sin (x) cos2 (x) y 18 cos (6x ) + 2 x, x < 1 or x > 1 4 a i 2 x, 1 < x < 1 ii
f (x) {x2
1{ y 6 5 4 3 2 1 1 2 f '(x) 2x, x > 1
x
( )
Answers 7H 7j
2 x log e ( x )
0 5 4 3 2 1 1 2 3 4
Answers
707
7 6 f '(x) = 2x 2, 5 f (x) {x2 2x{ x>0 4 3 2 1 x 1 2 3 5 4 3 2 1 10 2 f '(x) 2x 2, 3 2 < x < 0 4 5 f '(x) 2x 2, x < 2
4x or 4x sec2 (2x2 3) cos2 (2 x 2 3) 15 3x + 6x loge (6x) 2 x 2 sin ( x 2 ) cos ( x 2 ) 16 x2 17 2 cos (2x) esin (2x) y 18 a 14 f (x) =
3
P 4 P 2
3P 4
P x
f '(x) 2 cos (2x), 0 x P 2 f '(x) 2 cos (2x), P x P 2
P 2
3P 2
2P
3 7 11 15 19 23
E D E A C B
4 8 12 16 20 24
C B A A D C
2 3 4 5
4 a 3x2 + 2 a x2 4 3 2 a 6x3 + 4 x 3
28 20
25
0 1012 x
b 5 b 5
b i 8 1 4 ii 48 6 a 18 x 7 x2 + 4 b 6 5
dy 3x = ( x + 20) dx 200 e i 1.875 ii 1.5 iii 4.5 f Yes, the largest absolute value of the gradient is 4.5, that is, the steepest section. g 30.24 m (at x = 12) 2 a Domain f(x) = [0, ), range f(x) = [0, ) Domain g(x) = R, range g(x) = [1, ) c x = 10 d b i 2 x 2 + 1 ii 4x + 1
708
Answers
c Domain f(g(x)) = R, range f(g(x)) = [2, ) Domain g(f(x)) = [0, ), range g(f(x)) = [1, ) 2x d i ii 4 x2 + 1 4 e i ii 4 5 y 3 a
7 6 5 4 3 2 1
3
2
1 10 1 2 3 4 5 6 x
3x + y = 3 + loge (3) x + a2 + 3 11 a ytangent = 2ax + 1, ynormal = 2 2a x a + b ytangent = , ynormal = 2 ax + a (2a + 1) 2 a 2 10 a2 c ytangent = 4 ae 4 a x + e 4 a (1 8a 2 ), x 1 4 a2 2 + e4 a 2 + e 2 4 ae 4 a 12 y = 8x + 2(1 loge (2)) 13 b = 124 Exercise 8B Sketching curves 1 a (0, 8) a local max. b (1, 2) a local max., (1, 2) a local min. c (2, 8) a local min. ynormal =
13 d (2, 8) a local min., ( 2 3 , 1 27 ) a local max. 2 2
9 x + y =
c x = 2 and x = 5
e f g h
(0, 0) a positive point of inflection, (1, 1) a local max. (2, 4) a local max., (0, 0) a local min. (3, 4) a local min. (0, 8) a positive point of inflection
1 i ( 1 2 , 6 4 ) a local max.
j (0, 5) a local min., (1, 6) a positive point of inflection k (3, 54) a local max., (3, 54) a local min.
14 l (3, 16) a local max., ( 1 3 , 2 27 ) a local min.
1 2 3 4 5 6
m (0, 12) a negative point of inflection n (0, 0) a negative point of inflection, (3, 27) a local min. y y 2 a b f (x)
(8, 0) (
1, 2) 2 x (1,
2)
CHAPTER 8
Applications of differentiation
Exercise 8A Equations of tangents and normals 1 y = 5x 4 2 At (6, 0) y + 7x + 42 = 0 and at (1, 0) y = 7x 7 3 x + y = 3 4 x + 3y + 21 = 0 5 a i y = 2x ii x + 2y = 5 b i y = 6x + 16 ii x + 6y = 22 c i x + 4y = 4 ii 2y = 8x 15 d i y = 7x + 1 ii x + 7y + 43 = 0 e i 4y = x + 4 ii 4x + y = 18 f i 3y = x + 6 ii y + 3x = 12 g i x + y = 1 ii y = x + 3 h i y = 4x ii x + 4y = 0 i i y = 2x 3 ii x + 2y + 1 = 0 j i y = 2x + 1 ii x + 2y = 2 k i y = 3e 1x + 4e 1 ii ex + 3y = 3e 1 e l i 2y = x 2 + 2 loge (2) ii y + 2x = 4 + loge (2) m i 3y = 2x + 3 loge (3) ii 3x + 2y = 2 loge (3) 3 3 ii y = x + n i x + y = + 3 3 2 2 o i 3x + 2y = 3 ii 3y = 2x 2 2 p i y = 2 x + ii x + 2 y = 1 2 6 a B b C 7 y = 2x 8 y = 1 c
x y 8 x2
1 0 2 y
y g(x)
, 1 13 ) (2 3 27
0 0 (2, 8) x ( 2, 8)
f (x) y
f
(
2, 4)
y x2 (x 3)
Answers 8a 8b
0 (0, 0)
y 5 6x x2
f (x)
(0, 8) 0 (3, 4) x x
Answers
709
, 6 1 ) ( 1 2 4
5 a ( 2 , 4) a local min., (0, 0) a local max., ( 2 , 4) alocal min. b (2, 0), (0, 0) and (2, 0) c y
g(x) (0, 0)
2 (
2, 4) 0
x y x2 x 6
2 x ( 2, 4)
k
(
3, 54)
g (x)
0 (3, 54)
y ( 3, 16)
y x3 4x2
3x
2 (
2,
27) 0
,
2 14 ) (1 3 27
107 7 a (2, 18) a local min., (0, 6) a local max., (1 1 4 , 9 256 ) a local min. b (0, 6) c y y x4 x3 5x2 6
y 0 (0, 6) x
( 2, 18)
, 9107 ) (1 1 4 256
8 a
f(x)
y (0, 0)
f(x) 3 x
g(x) 1 (0, 0)
(0, 0) 0
,
1 ) (1 4 2
1 x
, 1 ) ( 1 4 2
(2, 4)
(3,
27)
14 3 a (1, 0) a local max., (2 1 3 , 18 27 ) a local min. c ( 1, 0), (0, 4)
y g(x) (0, 0) 0
1
) 256
y
5 , 1 (2 ) 3 27
g(x)
1 3 , ( 1 4
(2, 0)
y ( 1, 0) 1 0 4
f (x) 4 x
e
(
1, 36)
y h (x)
f
, (
12 3
y
) 1422 27
h (x)
, 18 14 ) (2 1 3 27
22 4 a (2, 36) a local max. and (2 2 3 , 14 27 ) a local min. b ( 4, 0), (1, 0), (4, 0) and (0, 16)
, 14 22 ) (3 2 3 27
(3, 36)
( 2, 36) y y 16 4 0 1 4 x x3 x2 16x 16
f(x)
1 (0, 1)
, 14 22 ) (2 2 3 27
( 1, 0) (1, 0)
710
Answers
y 2 0 1
f(x) (1, 2) x
ii 2 < x < 1 and x > 0 iii x < 2 and 1 < x < 0 y 16 f(x)
( 1, 2) 2
y 20 ( 2, 0) 2 0
g(x)
2 h(x)
( 4, 4) 5
1 x
( 1, 0) 0
(1, 0) 1 x
(0, 1) 1
9 B 10 A 11 C 12 E 13 a x = 3 a local min., x = 0 a local max. b x = 2 a local max., x = 1 a local min., x = 4 a local max. c x = 2 a negative point of inflection, x = 3 a local min. d x = 5 a local min., x = 2 a positive point of inflection e x = 3 a local max., x = 0 a local min., x = 2 a local max. f x = 1 a local max., x = 5 a local min. y 14 f ' (x) 2x
4
0 2 x
An example of the answer. 17 a a = 1 and b = 8 b At x = 4 3 a local max. and at x = 2 a local min. 18 a a = 2 and b = 5 b (1, 4) and (0, 5) c (1, 4) a local min., (0, 5) a local max. and (1, 4) alocal min. 19 a (x + 2)(3x 2b + 2)
2(b 1) 4(b + 2)3 b , and (2, 0) 27 3 c (2, 0) is a minimum turning point. 2(b 1) 4(b + 2)3 , is a maximum turning point. 3 3
1 b (2b + 1)3 b , and (b, 0) 27 3 c y = 2(b + 2)(b + 5)x (b + 2)(b + 14) d b = 3 2 1 as b > 0 2 Exercise 8C Maximum and minimum problems when the function is known dC dP 5 = 5 4x 1 a b = 3n 2 + 4 n dx dn 2 n dV = h 3 2h 2 dh dM = 1 + log e (3k ) dk d f dh = 3t 2 2e t dt dL 4 = 2t 2 + 2 sin ( t ) dt t
c e
2 1 3
2 1
2 D 3 C 4 a 8 workers b $1112 5 20 metres 6 x = 1 hour for max. and x = 7 hours for min. 7 a x = 5 C for min. and x = 15 C for max. b Minimum is N = 291 rabbits (round down) and maximum is N = 1625 rabbits. 3 8 a Minimum v = 0.8 cm/s when t = 4 b Maximum v = 0.8 cm/s when t = 4 9 a i 12 cm ii 132 cm t b R = 6 + 2 cos 4 c Max. =
Answers 8c 8c
+ 12 12 , min. = 2 2
Answers
711
10 a b c 11 a b 12 a 13 a b
1 January 1998 941 cheetahs i 824 ii 507 (round down) 232 elephants Approx. 1 January 2009 75 b $50 c $3750 90 kg Approx. 77.3 kg after 3 months
7 a v =
3t
1 (3t 2 + 4) 2
3t 3t 2 + 4 9t 2 = 12 (3t 2 + 4) 2
3
b a =
3 3t 2 + 4
( 3t 2 + 4 )3
3 c v = 1.5, a = 16
Exercise 8D Maximum and minimum problems when the function is unknown 1 Both numbers are 5. 2 2 and 6 3 b A = 60x x2 c Length and width are each 30 cm. d Max. area is 900 cm2. 4 10 000 m2 40 5 Radius = cm (or 12.73 cm), length = 40 cm, circumference = 80 cm 6 a L = 4.5 3x b V = 9x2 6x3 c Edges are 1 m, 1.5 m and 2 m, for max. d V = 3 m3
3 7 b V = 50x 1 2x
8 9
a b c a b
c d 10 a 11 a 12 a
2 v = 3t 24t + 36 t = 6 x = 0 and t = 2 x = 32 a = 12 and 12 3000 371.4 people/day dN 4000 = dt 8t + 1 97.56 people/day D b A B b C dH t = sin dt 6 12
c E
c 192 cm3
8 6301.1 cm2 9 Approx. 6564 cm3 10 x = 1.5 km 800 hours v c 223.61 km/h 12 Approx. 13.86 cm 13 1239 cm3 11 a b C = 40 000 v 1 + 0.8 v
2 3 m/h ii m/h iii m/h 12 6 12 c Min. H = 8 m at t = 12 hours and max. H = 12 m at t = 24 hours 13 a i $2000 ii $2378.22 b 126.07 $/year c 68.65 $/year 14 0.2 mL/h 15 a 150 cents b (8, 13)
b i c 2 d 15 cents/month 3 e 175 cents f t = 13 16 a 7 m/s b 0.4 m/s2 c (0, 6) and (9, 16) d 0.2 m/s2 Exercise 8F Related rates 5 cm/s 1 4624 3 2 223 3 0.5 cm/s 4 320 cm3/min 1 5 45 cm/s 6 60 cm2/s 7 B 8 0.26 m/min
4 5 units 1 15 4.06 units Exercise 8E Rates of change dV dS dA b c 1 a dr dh dt dC dI dv d e f dx dp dt 2 a dA = 2 r b 20 m2/m dr b 100 cm3/cm 3 a dV = 4 r 2 dr 4 6 cm2/cm 5 a i 10 m/s ii 10 m/s b When t = 1 the projectile is rising but when t = 3 it is falling. dv 1 6 a = (90t2 t3) dt 100 b V
9 2 3 m/s 1 m/min 10 24 h 11 a r = 3
b V =
h3 9
75 cm /s cm/s 512
60
90
c t = 60 min
Exercise 8G Linear approximation 1 a 1.03 b 0.998 c 4.9 d 1.0005 2 2 cm3 or about 6 cm3 3 4% 4 a 43.74 cm2 b 0.44 cm2
712
Answers
8 5% increase in perimeter, 10% increase in area Chapter review Short answer 1 (3, 86) a local max. and (2, 39) a local min. 2 y
(
2, 4) 4 ( 2, 4)
7 8
a b d a b c d e f
A is (0.5, 1) and B is (0.5, 1) y = 4x 1 c (0, 1) 1 cm e 1.125 cm 7 weeks i 98.25 rabbits/week ii 44.15 rabbits/week P0 = 267 (round down) 782 rabbits i 33 rabbits/week ii 44 rabbits/week 39 weeks 5h dy = cm/s 14 400 h 2 dt i 4.47 cm/s ii 7.54 cm/s 5.67 cm/s f (x) = (x + 2a)(3x + 2a 6) 2(a 3) 4(2a + 3)3 , and (2a, 0) 3 27
9 a y = 14 400 h 2 b c d 10 a b
(0, 0) 0
2 x
y = x2 (4 x2)
3 4 5 6 7 8
cm/min
E D C D D
3 7 11 15 19
A A B A A
4 8 12 16 20
D E B E D
4 500 c (2, 0) is a local minimum turning point. , 3 27 is a local maximum turning point. Therefore (2a, 0) is a local minimum turning point and 2(a 3) 4(a + 3)3 , 3 27 is a local maximum turning point. d y = 4(a 6)(a 1)x + 4(a 1)(3a + 7) 3a + 7 e , 0 , a 1 a6 dy = 8(4 a) dx a + 12 c x = 8 11 a b y = 8(4 a)x (4 a)( a + 12) d a = 8 e y = 96x 48
100 r 2 c
2000 3 3 cm 27
CHAPTER 9
2 a 3000 b Approx. 10.11 bacteria/min 3 a 1.4 m b 3.4 m c 0.4 m/s 2 3 d m/s 15 4 a 300 m b 40 m/min c 700 m d 20 m/min 100 5 a A = 2r 2 + b r = 2 cm r 2 c A = 75.1 cm d $3005 27000 6 a l = w2 108000 b A = 2w2 + w c w = l = 30 cm (that is, a cube with side length of 30 cm) 54 000 d L = 10w + w2 e w = 22.10 cm; l = 55.26 cm 1080 27000 f C = 0.02w2 + + 5w + w w2 g w = 23.74 cm; l = 47.91 cm h 223 cents
Integration
Exercise 9A Antidifferentiation 2 1 a 1 b 1 x5 + c 2 x + c 5 d g j
1 6 2x
c f i l o
1 8 8x
+c +c +c
+ c
e h k n q t
x
4 3
+ c
3
2 5 5x 1 5 25 x 2 3 7 4 3
2 + c x3
1 4 8x
x 2 + c 1 + c 9x3 + c
+ c
x2 + c
4
3 + c m 3 5x 5 + c p 2x2
7 16 4 7 x 9
Answers 8D 9a
s 16 x + c x2
x 12 x
+ c +c
x7 + c 2 r 5 + c x
2 a + 5x + c b x3 + 2x2 10x + c
4 c 2x5 + 3 2 x + 2x + c
d e
2 6 3x 1 4 4x
4 3 2 +1 4 x 2x + x + c
3 + 12x 1 3x + c
Answers
713
f g h
1 x3 3 5 3 3x 1 4 4x
4 3 2 i 1 4 x + x 2x + c 3 B
f (x)
4 E b d f h j l n p c c
1 0 1 x
2 f (x) 0 x
5 a c e g i k m o
1 3 1 5
f (x)
9x)11 + c + 5) 2 + c 8) 5 + c 5x) 3 + c e
f (x)
x (1, 3)
1 2
6 C 7 a 3 loge |x| + c c e i k m o
6 5 4 7
b 8 loge |x| + c d
7 3
f
(0, 0)
f (x)
loge |x| + c
f loge |x + 3| + c h 2 loge |x + 4| + c j l n p
4 3
(1, 1) (0, 0)
g 3 loge |x + 3| + c
6 8 5 loge |5x 5 2 loge |3
loge |3x + 2| + c
g
(
2.77, 0)
loge |5 x| + c
2 1
+ x2 + loge |x| + c b
1
1 18 3 2 1 3
+ c
b 1 e4x + c 4 d f h
1 3x 3e 7 4x 4e 2 3x 9e
e + c
+c
c 3x + 2 loge |x| + x + c d e g
1 2
e e5x + c g i k m
1 e6x + c 12 1 6x 2 e + c x 3e 3 + c x 6e 2
+c +c +c +c
3 8
1 2 4x 3 2 2 3x 1 2 2x
j 4e l
2x
2 i loge |x| + 2x 1 + 15 2 x + c j 3 k 2 x 2 x2 + 9 2 x + c l 5 3 1 5 2
x 0.4 e 4 x
+ c
4 2 2 2 1 2 2 m 2 5 x + 3 x 2 x + c n 5x + x + x + c
o ex ex + c
2x 2 x + 2ex + 1 2e 3 2x 3x x 3 1 3 e 2 e + 3e x 4 3 3x 4 1 4 x x + 2e 5 a D
n 9e 3 + c e x + e x +c p 2
f f(x) = 2 x x 2 6 g f(x) =
1 4
6 a c e g
1 3 1 7
b C b d f
cos (3x) + c
1 4
cos (4x) + c c +c
(x + 4)4 + 1
4
sin (7x) + c + c + c
h 2 sin (4x) + c
714
Answers
13 a k = 4 b f(x) = 2 sin (2x) 4ex + 3 c f = 2.02 6 Exercise 9C Integration by recognition 1 a i 24(3x 2)7 b i 10x(x2 + 1)4 1 c i 2x 5 d i 2 4x + 3
ii ii ii ii
1 2 (3x 1 2 2 (x
2)8 + c + 1)5 + c
2x cos + c 3
2x 5 + c 4x + 3 + c
1 (x2 4
5 x + c cos 2
7x + c sin 4
cos ( x) + c
x 6 sin + c 2
+ 3x 7)4 + c
x + c sin x cos 4 x + c 4 3 7 a sin (x) cos (x) + c b 1 cos (2x) sin (x) + c 2
2 +c x2 1
2 a A 3 E 4 a i 4e4x 5 b i 5e
6 5x
2
1 4x 5 2e
+c +c
1 4
1 2
ii 2e
6 5x
1 x2 2e
2
+c
2 cos (x) + c
x x g 6 sin +c cos 2 3
h 8
1 6x 2e 1 2
c i 4 sin (4x 7) d i 6 sin (6x 3) e i 5 cos (2 5x) f g h i 6 a b c d e 7 a b 8 a 9 a 10 a 11 a i 4 sin (3 4x) 5 i 5x + 2 2x i x2 + 3 2x 4 i x2 4 x i 3 cos (x) x sin (x) x cos ( x ) sin ( x ) i x2 i [ex (sin (x) + cos (x)] i sin (x) + x cos (x) i ex + xex
cos (4x 7) + c
+1 2 cos (8x) + 7x + c
1 4 4x
1 4x 4e
cos (2x) +
+c
cos (3 4x) + c
sin (2x) + e + c
x
+c
x 6 cos + 5x + c 3 f(x) = 4 + sin (x) f(x) = 1 2 cos (2x) x f(x) = 3 2 + 12 sin 4 x x f(x) = 4 sin + 2 cos 4 4 2 k = 1 6 x y= cos x + 7 6 6 y=1+ x 2 + x2 +
ii sin (x) x cos (x) 2 sin ( x ) ii x ii 3ex sin (x) ii x sin (x) + cos (x) ii xex ex x6 i 12x5(1 3x)(2 3x)5 ii (2 3x)6 + c 2 3x 2 + 2 i ii 2 x 3 + 2 x + c 2 x3 + 2x 1 b 3x + loge |x 1| + c 3+ x 1 2 b 5x 2 loge |x + 2| + c 5 x2 5 5 4+ b 4x + 2 loge |2x 3| + c 2x 3 4 3+ b 3x 2 loge |3 2x| + c 3 2x
Answers
715
Answers 9b 9c
(e 2 + e2 e 6 e6) h 0 j 6 l 0 n 0 p (2 2 2 + 4) 23.4
loge |3x2 4|
g 1 i 20 10 2 k 0 m 9 3 9 o
4 3
5 a 9 d 10
b e
2 3
c 3 4
3 3
4e 4
1 3
f 2 loge (5)
f esin (x) + c Exercise 9D Approximating areas enclosed by functions All answers for areas in questions 1 to 15 are in square units. 1 10 2 a 8 b 42 3 a A b A c B 4 a 30 b 22 5 a 32 b 32 c 39 d 16 e 29 f 12 g 26 6 a 26 7 a 28 e 23 1 3 8 a 10 9 a 6.875 10 10.5 b 41
g 3 h 6 k = 1 or 4 7 k = 2 8 k = 3 9 a = 2 loge (3) 10 k = 6 11 a 16 b 8 12 D 13 A
(e e )
c 12
d 40
Exercise 9F Signed areas The answers to all area questions are in square units. 1 a 8 b 8 2 a 4.5 b 4.5 3 a c e g i
1 2 x dx 1 x 2 dx
3 2
b d
0 (4 x) dx 3 3x 2 dx
0 1
1 ( x3 9 x 2 + 20 x) dx f 2 ( x3 4 x 2 4 x) dx 1 e x dx 02 2 sin (2 x) dx
b 8 g e e
y 12 x 0 1 2 y6
x
h j
7 3
1 e 2 x dx
dx 0 2 cos 3 d 26 e 22 j 3
3
4 a 8 f 5 a 11 3
c
1
1 2
20 1 4
51 3
(e e ) i 2
y
e 8 h 74 k 6313.2
f 56 i 38 l 5949
y 4x
g 12 2 3 j 1
y x2
c 2(e e2)
(e12 + 15 e6)
01 y 4 x2
716
Answers
y x
y 2ex
0 1
x 3
2 0 y 3 x
y
x y loge ( 2)
h
x
y 3 sin (2x)
P 2
5 8 + e3 e 1 1 Exercise 9G Further areas All answers for areas are exact and in square units unless stated otherwise. 1 a 4 1 b 36 2 64 2 1 b 57 1 c d 21 1 e 312 2 a 85 1 3 6 3 3 f 49 1 3 3 A 6 a i
0 3
g 8
y 3
1 0 1
h 40 1 2 4 D ii 6 5 C
6 a 2 e 4 i 1 7 a E 8 a b c d e
b 1 f 2 2 3
c 5 1 3 g e e j 4 b A
1
d h
4 3 1 2
(e 1 e 2) b i
y 3
3x2 y 2 0 1 3
2 y x
0 f ( x) dx 2 f ( x) dx 1 g( x) dx 3 g( x) dx 1 h( x) dx 3 h( x) dx 4 f ( x) dx 5 f ( x) dx 2 g( x) dx 2 g( x) dx + 3 g( x) dx
c E
y x2
4 2 x
3 2 2 2 4 2 1 3 1
ii 2 loge (3)
x
c i
y 12 0
1 y
x2
ii
x
1 2
9 a B b D y 10
2
4 0
d i
y x3 4x
3 ii 5 4
2 0 1 2
e i
y 1 2 0 y 1 y e x 0 2 x y e2x x
ii
1 2
(1 e 4)
a 5 1 3 b c 16 y 11 10 2 3
y x3 x2 2x
ii 1 e
2 0
a 2 2 3 12
y 4 1 0 P
4
b
y 1 3 cos (2x)
5 12
1 c 312
g i
y 2 1 0 P P P P
632
ii
x
3 1
Answers 9d 9g
P 2
3P P 4
y 2 sin (x)
h i b
y 1 0 P P
2
a 13
3 + 4 2
y 0
1 1 y x
1 3 x
+ 4
3 2
x) y cos ( 2 2P
ii 4 2
x
i
P 6
y 1 y sin (3x) 0 P
6
ii
2 3
P
P
2 3
Answers
717
y yx x 8 6 4 2 1 x 0 1234
ii 12 4 5
2 a 1 6
f 17 1 e + e (approx. 14.98) 3
2 g 1 1 2 + e e (or approx. 6.17)
1 2 1
c 2 1 6
d 21 1 3
e 2 1 4
7 a i x = 2 and 2 b i x = 4 c i x = 1 d i x = 1
ii 1 4 loge ii 2 2
()
3 4
h 4 3 3 C 4 D 5 E y 6 a i x = 0 and 4 ii 2
yx
iii 10 2 3
y 4x
b i x = 3 and 1
ii
y y 2x 3 0 1 y x y 3 x2 y x2 1 0 1 x
iii 10 2 3
ii
2 5
3 3 9 2 10
1 4
ii
iii 2 2 3
11 a
x3
1 y (x
3)2
y 1 x2
1 0 1
d i x = 2 and 2
ii
y x2 4 0 x
iii 21 1 3
1 4 4 9 4
2 y 4 x2
12 a x = 2 and y = 0 b
1 2
11 + e 13 x-intercept is loge (3) (or 0.55), area is 2 14 No x-intercepts, area is 6 + 1. 15 a 1 + loge (x) b x loge (x) x c 4 loge (4) 3 (or approx. 2.55) 2x 16 a 2 x +2 b
1 2
e i x = 0 and 1
ii
y y (x 1)2 1 1 0 1 y 1 x2 x
iii
1 3
i x = 0 and 1
ii
y x2 y x
iii
1 3
c loge (1.5) (or approx. 0.41) 17 a 2 2 b 5 1 3 3 (3e 4 + 1) (or approx. 82.40) 2 9 2 4 (or approx. 2.28) 1 18
0 y
1 y x3 yx 0 1
iii
x
1 2
2 Exercise 9H Areas between two curves All answers are in square units unless stated otherwise.
20 a loge (4) b 1 a c e g
b i x = 0, 1 and 2
ii
y y x3 2x y 3x2
iii
1 2
0 ( x x 2 ) dx 0 (4 x 2 3x) dx 0 1
2 3 1
b d
1 ( x 1) dx 2 (8 2 x 2 ) dx 1 1
1 1 2
(3 x x 3 ) dx f dx h
(9 x 2 e x ) dx (1 x2 ) dx
8 a
(x + ex )
2 3
b 2 2 e 1 1 8
c 4
1 d 2312
718
Answers
f e e 1 2 (or approx. 1.09) 2 (or approx. 3.23) g 2 + 8 h 2e 2e 2 (or approx. 5.17) 3 9 e e 4 (or approx. 13.37) 10 3 1 2 11
1 2
6 a 4 L b V = 5t +
40 t sin 40
Hours
12
b 40 m d 840 m3
300 ) m2 60 000 b (30 000 ) m3 17 a (150 Exercise 9I Average value of a function 3(2 3 ) c 14 9 1 2 a 12 [50 loge (5) 8 loge (2) 21] 3 log e (2) b 4 c 1 4 (3e + 1) 1 a 8 b d 3 a b 302 2 45
1 2
b 4 h c i 60 L ii 50.6 L 8 a 56 250 m3 b 5 9 1.26 m 3 2 11 a y = 8 x + 6 b 38 m2 12 b 3 loge (2) 2 Chapter review Short answer 1 f(x) = x3 x2 3 2 a k = 0 4 4 x b sin + 1 4 c 1 3 8
c 380 m3
e6 1 6
(e2 1) e 2 1 log e 2
1 2
4 C 5 E Exercise 9J Further applications of integration ( 2 x )3 1 f ( x ) = +4 3 2 1 + 12 3 a 0 m b y = 0.01(x + 1)3 + 0.03x + 0.01 or y = 0.01x3 0.03x2 c 54 cm 4 a $34.56 b C = 40n 200e0.01n + 200 c $3656.34 d i $36.56 ii $30.66 5 a i 0 m/s ii 48 m/s b i t = 8 ii 64 m/s c dx (m/s)
dt
dy = 2(x + 1) cos (x2 + 2x) and antiderivative is dx 2 1 2 sin (x + 2x) 4 a 2 b 2ex 2x + 1 5 (5.5 e2 + e) sq. units 3 6 a 1 4 b 9 2 7 k = 1 or 2 2 8 a
y
1 y x
2
b loge (4) 9 166 2 3 sq. units 2 + 2 sq. units (or approx. 3.23) 10 8 1 17 sq. units 1 12 a y = 2x + 2 b (2 e 2) sq. units Multiple choice 1 B 2 5 D 6 9 D 10 13 E 14 17 D 18 21 E 22 25 B E E A B A D 3 7 11 15 19 23 C C C E B B 4 8 12 16 20 24 A B C C C A
Answers 9h 9j
64
8 16
Seconds
Answers
719
Extended response 1 a $0 b C = 25t3 + 25t2 + 800t c $7750 d $4450 e $1050 t 2 a T = 10 5 sin b No 12 c 15C at 6 pm d 5C at 6 am e i 7.5C ii Approx. 13.5C f 4 pm 3 a (2, e) b y = (2e 1)x + e + 4e 1 1 c (0, e + 4e ) d (0, 1) e (2 + 4e 1) sq. units 4 a 1 + loge (x) b x loge (x) x c 3 m d (e e 2) m2 (or approx. 2.58 m2) e 20(e e 2) m3 (or approx. 51.66 m3) 5 a 5 2 C/cm b T = 180 40 x c i 82.02 C ii 66.86 C
d r 3.4 125 fi r 3.414 cm ii Define g(x) = the gradient function on a CAS calculator and determine sign of gradient close to 3.414 (for example, use r = 3.4 and r = 3.5). The gradient sequence in the vicinity of r = 3.414 is negativezeropositive, which corresponds to a local minimum. iii 220 cm2 g r 2.710 cm h 1.47 e r =
3
Exam practice 3 Short answer 1 a x f(x) 1 3.4 2 2.7 3 1.5 4 0.7 5 0.3 Total
dy = ( x + 1)e x + e x = xe x dx c -20e-1(2e-4 - 1) ex 2 a y dx = x 4 2 sin ( x ) + 2 2x x 3 b y dx = 2 3 2x b
CHAPTER 10
Area 3.4 2.7 1.5 0.7 8.3
b f ii
1 36 1 2 5 12
c g iii
1 6 5 12 1 3
5 6
2 a i b
1 4
5 + 12 +1 3 =1
c i 2 3 3 a 1 8 e
1 2 3 4 a 8
ii
2 3
iii c
1 4 3 8
iv 1 d
1 8
3 b 8
1 4
3 8
5 8
3 3 , ). 2 2
b 0.8 b b
13 40 1 2
17 40
3 20
c No 11 Yes
d Yes
10 No
Column 1 Column 2 Column 3 B Row 1 Row 2 Row 3 A A 0.22 0.08 0.30 B 0.10 0.60 0.70 0.32 0.68 1
500 r 500 = 2 r 2 + r r2
250 , r2
b i Pr(A B) represents an unfit smoker, Pr(A B) = 0.22. ii Pr(A B) represents a fit non-smoker, Pr(A B) = 0.60. c i 0.10 ii 0.08 iii 0.32 iv 0.70
720
Answers
1 3 a e 14 a 15 a 16 a 17 a
2 3
1 2
1 3
d No
7 33
17 32 1 4
5 a, d 6 a 0.2 7 a x
b 0.6 1
3 13
c 2
1 13
1 11
d 0.1 3
1 13
c 0.5 c 0.495 c 27 35 c
15 32
d d
4
1 13
5
7 13
Pr(X = x)
b b b
1 15 19 66
8 15
7 15
c g
7 36
26 A
55 64
27 B
6 7
x Pr(X = x)
1
1 5
2
1 5
3
1 5 3 5
4
1 5
5
1 5
29 a 0.3277 0 0.5 3 32
22 31
b 0.64
31
2 9
b 10 a
2 5
x Pr(X = x) 1
1 6
c 4
1 6
3 a 0.1035 (4 d.p.) 3 b 0.3929 (4 d.p.) c 0.2746 (4 d.p.) Exercise 10B Discrete 1 a Discrete c Continuous e Continuous g Continuous 2 a x 0 Pr(X = x) b
Pr(X x)
3 4 1 2 1 4
9
1 6 1 2
16
1 6
25
1 6
36
1 6
b 11 a
5 6
x Pr(X = x) 2
1 6
c 3
1 6
4
1 6 2 5
5
1 3
6
1 6
2
1 4
1 4
5 b 6
12
x Pr(X = x)
0
1 45
1
1 9
2
1 5
3
13 45
4
17 45
13 x Pr(X = x)
0 1 2 x
1
3 160
2
1 10
3
9 32
4
3 5
14 a
x Pr(X = x)
0 0.1715
1 0.4115
2 0.3292
3 0.0878
Pr(X x) 0.5 0.4 0.3 0.2 0.1 x Pr(X x) 0.4 0.3 0.2 0.1 2 4 6 8 10 x
b 0.1060 5 a 1 (1, 1), (2, 1), (3, 1), (4, 1), (5, 1), (1, 2), (2, 2), (3, 2), (4, 2), (5, 2), (1, 3), (2, 3), (3, 3), (4, 3), (5, 3), (1, 4), (2, 4), (3, 4), (4, 4), (5, 4), (1, 5), (2, 5), (3, 5), (4, 5), (5, 5) b i Pr(A) =
3 5
ii Pr(B) =
2 5
iv Pr(D) = 19 25 ii Pr(B | C) =
1 2
x Pr(X = x)
0
4 25
1
12 25
2
9 25
4 25
+ 12 25 +
9 25
=1
Answers
721
17 a 0.54 e
31 55
b 0.55 f 4
c 0.54 g 4
d 0.24
8 C 1 19 C 20 E 21 D 22 B 23 D 24 a x = 0, 1, 2, 3, 4 b x Pr(X = x) 0
1 16
18 a 2.24 b 2.96 9 $1452 1 20 a i 3.5 b i 9 c i 0.5 Exercise 10D Measures random distributions 1 2.3, 0.81
3 2 a 5 8 55 b 2 64
c 7.16
d 18.48
ii 5 ii 8 ii 2 of variability of discrete
1
1 4
2
3 8
3
1 4
4
1 16
3 a $1.42 4 4.96 5 a 3.2364 d 80.91 6 a 8.7899 d 219.7475 7 10 8 5 9 2 1 3 , 1.0556, 1.0274 10 a 8.3 11 14 12 11.36 13 a y Pr(Y = y) b $1.60 c $0.51 14 0.95 15 a x Pr(X = x) b 4 13 25 16 a x Pr(X = x) b 4 1 5
b 5.41
c 2.33
2 0.5
1.5 0.3
1 0.15
0 0.05
2
1 6
3
1 6
4
1 6
5
1 6
6
1 6
1
1 35
3
9 35
5
5 7
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
1 1 1 36 18 12 1 9 5 36 1 6 5 36 1 9 1 12 1 18 1 36
c 1.0443 2
3 50
d 3
4 25
34 35
1
1 4
2
3 8
3
1 4
4
1 16
4
3 10
5
12 25
b 2 0 a = 0.15, b = 0.05 1 11 a = 0.1, b = 0.2 12 a $3.75 b No, because although his expected gain is $3.75 per game, he must pay $5 to play each game. Therefore his loss per game will be $1.25. c No, because the expected gain is not equal to the initial cost of the game. 13 a $0 b No, because even though her expected gain (that is, her average gain per game in the long run) is $0, she could still lose $40 in one single game. c Yes, because E(X) = 0. 14 11 15 17 16 a x Pr(X = x) b 1 4 5 17 a 21 3 b 91 3 0
8 125
21 ( 0.9165) 5 d Pr(2.3669 X 6.0330) = Pr(3 X 6) = 0.94 17 a 0.2 b 1 c 2.2 d 1.36 e 1.1662 f 1 18 a 0 X 8 b 4 X 16 c 21 X 49 d 11.2 X 32 c e 8.3 X 11.1 19 a 7 20 a x Pr(X = x) b 2.25 1 A 2 22 E 23 C
5 f 12 6 X 22 1 6
b 5.83 1
1 4
c 0.94 2
3 8
3
1 4
4
1 8
1
36 125
2
54 125
3
27 125
c 0.97
1 6
c 2 c 52 3 d
1 615
722
Answers
CHAPTER 11
b b
9 24 4 15
5 12
1 8
2 a 0.15
iv
5 8
(0.625)
2
2 15
3
3 10
4
8 15
4 625
5 0.0036 6 a 32 81 2
7 36
b b
8 27 1 16
c c
3
7 36
4
7 36 7 12
5
7 36
6
7 36
7
1 36
7 a
1 16
65 81 3 8
ii 4 ii 4
c 2 c 20% c 10% 2
3 20
3
3 10
4
1 2
c 3 1 4 Multiple choice 1 D 2 4 D 5 7 D 8 10 B 11 3 D 14 16 C 17 19 B C A B A C B 3 6 9 12 15 18 E D C A E D
8 a 0.096 b 0.0064 c 0.008 d 0.2 9 a 0.0518 b 0.2592 10 a 0.2627 b 0.0084 c 0.2568 d 0.2568 11 0.0381 12 0.0924 13 a 0.1023 b 0.2001 14 0.2281 15 0.0653 16 a 0.0528 b 0.6676 17 a 0.2734 b 0.2965 c 0.1678 18 C 19 E 20 B 21 D 22 C 23 a i 0.0102 ii 0.9898 b 2 24 18 tickets 25 22 26 a 5 645 726 b 352 858 c $1 446 717.80 27 a 2 b Positively skewed Pr(X x) 28 a i
0.3 0.2 0.1 0.0 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 910 x
ii Positively skewed
Pr(X x) 0.3
b i
Extended response 1 a $14.70 c 61.25 cents e $2.10 2 a i $720 ii b i $40 ii c i $60 ii d 2.7% 3 a 1 8 c
7 8
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 910 x
c i
d 2.5625 packages
ii Negatively skewed
Answers
723
29 a i Positively skewed ii Symmetrical or normally distributed iii Negatively skewed b Controls skewness 30 a Symmetrical or normally distributed b The curve would resemble more of a bell shape that is tall and narrow. 31 a Positively skewed b Negatively skewed 32 a Symmetrical or normally distributed b Positively skewed c Symmetrical or normally distributed d Negatively skewed Exercise 11B Problems involving the binomial distribution for multiple probabilities 1 a 0.1792 b 0.6826 2 a 0.23 b 0.85 c 0.92 d 0.45 3 a 0.4718 b 0.9692 4 a 0.3370 b 0.3438 c 0.0333 31 3 6 5 a 32 b 16 c 31 6 a
1 9
3 a 0.3
Kingfisher
0.80 0.20
Best Match
0.70 0.30
b 0.25 b 3500 (train), 7000 (bus) b 3933 (Pete), 1967 (Sam) b 35 b 0.652 b 0.3014 c 0.652
Exercise 11D Expected value, variance and standard deviation of the binomial distribution 1 a 6 b 1.6 c 50 2 a 4.8 c 6 3 a c 4 a 5 a 6 a 7 a 8 a 9 a 10 a 11 a 12 a 13 a 1.26 3.24 5 4.62 12 1.67 7.5 5.4 28 96 1 2
3 4
48 81
c c b b b b b 16 19 b b d b
9 65
d 37 1 2 b 1.35
3 d 3 4
7 0.028 8 a 0.0878 b 0.9822 9 a 0.3669 10 a 0.9830 11 a 0.5000 c 0.9645 12 a 0.2553 13 a 0.1751 14 A 15 D 17 D 18 C 20 0.1509 21 a 0.9392 22 a 0.9106 c 0.6767 23 a 0.0173 c 0.8960 24 a 0.5981 c 0.2486 25 a 0.6778 26 a 0.8516 27 a 0.3438 28 a 0.9672
14 a 1 3 15 a 6 C 1 19 E 22 a
4 5 1 5
b 3.2
b 0.6115
0.65 Thursday 0.35 Good
2 a 0.6525 b 0.6652
3 a 0.0020 2 b 0.7939 24 0.2642 25 a 0.2335 b 0.3828 26 400 27 a 0.5000 b 0.6535 c 0.3465 28 a 5000 b 2500 c 50 29 a 6 b The company has an extremely popular product. 30 a 0.5455 b 0.3340 c 0.6 d 0.8795 e 0.2769 31 a 160 students b SD(X) = 12, 2 = 136, + 2 = 184 c There is a probability of 0.95 that between 136 to 184 students (inclusive) will have a reading level that is inadequate to cope with high school. 32 a 1260 patients b SD(X) = 19.44, 2 = 1221.12, + 2 = 1298.88 c There is a probability of 0.95 that between 1222 to 1298 patients (inclusive) will be cured.
724
Answers
3 a 4 a 6
5 16
b b
54 255 1 9 1 4
e Tellya has 45.4% of the market, Yodacall has 54.6% of the market. f Tellya has 41.2% of the market, Yodacall has 58.8% of the market. g Tellya has 40% of the market, Yodacall has 60% of the market. Both companies will be viable, but in the long term Tellyas market share will drop by half, while Yodacalls share will increase (in fact, will triple).
b p =
CHAPTER 12
Continuous distributions
Exercise 12A Continuous random variables y 1 a A pdf
(0, 2) (1 , 2) 2
Multiple choice 1 C 2 B 3 5 B 6 C 7 9 A 10 D 11 13 B 14 B 15 17 E 18 B 19
1 2 y
Not a pdf
0 (0, 2)
(1 , 0) 2
Extended response 1 a 135 b 0.1 c $60 2 a 1 b 0.0015 c 0.2639 d 10 3 a 1 b 0.2642 c 0.0003 4 a i 0.0018 ii 0.8826 iii 0.2761 b 3 5 a 0.0719 b 0.8432 c 0.3378 6 a 1440 b = 24, - 2 = 1392, + 2 = 1488 c This means that there is a probability of about 0.95 that between 1392 and 1488 of the 2400 people selected will be cured by the drug. 7 X ~ Bi(80, 1 5) a 0.0164 b 0.9713 c 0.7550 8 a X ~ Bi(8, 0.8) i 0.1678 ii 0.2936 iii 0.214 b i 0.2951 ii 0.2849 9 a 0.018 b 0.8336 c 0.3600 d 0.36 10 a In the first week of August, 229 customers will visit Kazs Kitchen and 171 people will visit Als fine dining. b In the long run, 229 people will dine at Kazs Kitchen each week and Al will get 171 customers each week. 11 a Let ti = the number of Tellya customers at the end of January month i. Let yi = the number of Yodacall customers at the end of January month i. ti + 1 = 0.85ti + 0.1yi and yi + 1 = 0.15ti + 0.9yi b Tellya has 400 customers or 80% of the market; Yodacall has 100 customers or 20% of the market. c Tellya has 350 customers or 70% of the market, Yodacall has 150 customers or 30% of the market. d Tellya has 52.6% of the market, Yodacall has 47.4% of the market.
y (
1, 2) 1
1 0 y
) (
1, 3 2 3 2 ) (1, 3 2
Not a pdf
(1, 0)
A pdf
0 y 1
A pdf
P 4
P 4
y
P , 2) ( 3 2
Not a pdf
2 P
P P 3 2
P 2
y 1 1 e 0 1 e 1) (e, e x
A pdf
Answers
725
y 2 0 (2, 2) (1, 0) 2 x
Not a pdf
c 10 a
6 22 , or 0.6548 2
f (Q ) 1) (0, 2 0.5 a
a 0 y
a 2
2 a
1 2
1 18
c 1 e 1 g 3 4 5 6
2 5 2 13 6 103 7 2 4 15
1 d e 1 f h
3 38 6 53
( P , 0) 2
(P , 0) 2
11 a
1 2
1 2
7 3 11 8 k = 9 k =
3 2
b c 12 a
1 ,axb 10 a f(x) = b a 0, elsewhere b p = 5 Exercise 12B Using a probability density function to find probabilities of continuous random variables 1 a 0.5625 b 0.543 125 c 0.6696 2 a 0.9630 b 0.2963 c 0.2593 d 0.2693 e 0.2693 3 a b 4 a b 5 a
3 4
1 4
10
27 32
b i 1 8 13 a
ii
y 1) (0, 8
2 , 0) ( 10 3
(4, 0)
c i 0.3935 ii 0.7788 y 6 a
1 (1, 1)
iii 0.4378
3 c i 4
0 ( P , 0) 4
(P , 0) 4
ii
2 3 2 3 iii 2 4 b
y 1 2 0 1) (P, 2
15 a
0 1 x
1 2
9 a 3 7 , or 0.3542 b 6 19 , or 0.8206 2
c i iii
2 2 2 3 1 2
ii iv
3 2 2 2 2
726
Answers
16 a
8 a 1 b
a1 a2 a3 x
y (0,1)
P , 0) 0 ( 4
(P , 0) 4
b i 0.75 17 a
(0,
ii 0.5
y 1 ) 2P
iii
2 3
b 4 8 2 e 4 12 4 4
42
12 2
y
P
2
b = 0.5 c As the graph is symmetrical, the median is 0.5. d The mode is equal to the maximum of the graph. In this case we have two points where the maximum is the same. Therefore the mode = 0, 1. 11 m = 12 7 n=
6 7
1 2
Exercise 12C Measures of central tendency and spread 1 a Mean 1.75, median 1.75, no mode b Mean
2 3,
median 2 2, mode 0
Exercise 12D Applications to problem solving 1 a 2 hours b = 1.29 hours c 0.4375 d 0.2857 3 ii 4 iii 0.617 2 a i 1 8 b 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
9 32
, mode 1 c Mean 0.75, median 3 1 2 2 a Mean 2.37, median 6 , mode 11 b Mean 3.5, median 2 3 4 , mode 4 c Mean 1.7, median 1.746, mode 2 3 a Variance 4 3 , standard deviation b Variance c Variance
11 36 , 2 3 11 6 11 15 2 6
11 225 ,
a 0.7769 b 0.1733 a i 0.5132 ii 0.2413 b 1111 g c 0.6321 a i 0.0952 ii 0.1647 b 0.9512 c 105.36 h a Between 30 and 40 minutes b i 0.3 ii 0.2 c 35 minutes d 31 minutes a i 0.9682 ii 0.9873 b 0.0045 c 0.0032 a 0.1110 b 0.2815 a y
10k 0 (10, 10k) 10 (20, 0) x
c 0.1790
b Variance 0.0742, standard deviation 0.2725 c Variance 0.4674, standard deviation 0.6837 5 a 10 b 10 loge (2) 3 3 6 7 c 0 e 10 3 a 2 a 0.5 b d b 2.3863
y 1 2 0
100 9
b c 0.2796 d 0.9720
1 100
c 0.6623
d 0.68
P, 1 ( ) 2 2 P 2
(P , 0) x
8 10 12 14 16
c
3
2
1 0 1 2 3
c Mean = d 0.5
2 a i 15 b i 1 2 3 c i and ii
iii 45 iii 5
Answers
727
3 a
i ii
iii
0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90100110120
b It widens the graph and increases the range. c It moves the graph to the right. 4 a b
3
2
1 0 1 2 3 5 10 15 20 25 30 35
4 5 6
a d a d a
b e b e b b
3 2
20 30 40 50 60 70 80
5 6
a b c a b
i The mean increases as time goes on. The standard deviation also increases as time goes on. = 65, = 5
(65, 1 )
5 2P
1 a 0.0863 1 b 0.0115 12 a 0.1587 b 0.3874 d 0.8302 e 0.2391 13 A 14 B 15 E 17 A 18 A 19 E 20 0.8676 21 a 0.6006 b 0.0548 c Cost ($) 1.40 1.60 Probability d 2 a 2 23 a 24 a b 25 a b 0.0082 0.3364 $1.74 0.9804 b 980 0.1056 b 17 i 0.7309 ii 0.6218 iii 0.0914 0.1679 i 0.1870 ii 0.9665 0.6449
1.80 0.6006
2.00 0.0548
7 a Mean: translation of 20 units in the positive x direction; standard deviation: dilation factor of 1 2 from the x-axis, dilation factor of 2 from the y-axis b Mean: translation of 9 units in the positive x direction; standard deviation: dilation factor of 2 from the x-axis, dilation factor of 1 2 from the y-axis 8 a 68% b 95% c 99.7% d 16% e 2.5% f 0.15% 9 a 16% b 2.5% c 0.15% 10 a 68% b 95% c 99.7% d 16% e 16% f 0.15% 11 a 28 X 52 b 16 X 64 c 4 X 76 12 a 25.8 X 28.6 b 24.4 X 30 c 23 X 31.4 d 28.6 e 30 f 31.4 13 a 16 X 17.2 b 15.4 X 17.8 c 14.8 X 18.4 d 16 e 15.4 f 14.8 14 a 1 (102.3,
21.4 2P
50 55 60 65 70 75 80 x
M 3S M S 2 M S M M S M S 2 M S 3 38.1 59.5 80.9 102.3 123.7 145.1 166.5
b i 34% ii 47.5% iii 49.85% iv 81.5% 15 a 81.5% b 2.35% 16 a 2.4 kg X 3.6 kg b 1.8 kg X 4.2 kg c 1.2 kg X 4.8 kg 17 B 18 D 19 C 20 C 21 B 22 B 23 a 10.59 X 13.41 b 9.17 X 14.83 c 7.76 X 16.24 Exercise 12F The standard normal distribution 1 a 0.8413 b 0.0668 c 0.0401 d 0.9966 e 0.2721 f 0.8644 2 a 3 3 a 1 3 b
5 3
Exercise 12G The inverse cumulative normal distribution 1 a 1.282 b 0.842 c 0.100 d 0.126 2 a 1 b 0.675 c 0.253 d 0.496 3 a 0.675 b 0.253 c 0.583 d 2.576 4 a 11.166 b 9.493 c 9.336 d 11.683 5 a 35.984 b 36.698 c 30.774 d 33.497 6 a 5.182 b 1.527 c 17.525 7 E 8 A 9 C 10 B 11 A 12 D 13 B 14 a 173.16 cm b 153.27 cm 15 a 44.58 mm b 45.42 mm 16 48.65 seconds 17 1.907 18 7.896 19 11.704 grams 20 26.305 21 25.844 22 3 minutes 44.27 seconds 23 a > 1.7 kg b Between 1.3 kg and 1.7 kg 24 a 64 b 44 Chapter review Short answer 1 a y
(0, 4) (1 , 0) 2 0 x
b Yes it could.
c 1.2 c 1.133
b 0.5
728
Answers
2 a
y 2 (4, 2)
A = 16 3
x
3 ( 13 2) 1 3 7 8 2
b 3 a 4 a 5 a 6 7
3 16 1 4 3 8 1 8
c m =
b b b
4 5 6 7
a b c a b c a b c a
0.0062 0.8413 0.1535 2.34 cm 0.1963 26.77 cm 0.0625 3.4 3 hours, 31 minutes 11.9 b
(1.42, 1.54)
c 2 c 8 a 0.25 c 5 min 48 s a
5 6 7 8
d 2
8 3
d 4 b 0.325 b
9 10 11 1 9 17 25 33 41 49
c 0.191 e 88 minutes
d 0.41
b d
4 45 1 8 28
3 a 74%
9
6
3 0 3 6 9
b 37
8 a
b
2 4 6 8 10 12 14
0.75 0.20 4 a T = 0.30 0.60 b Initial proportion of coffee purchasers 0 . 9 S= = In itial proportion of biscotti purchasers 0 . 4 c 0.755 0 . 75 0 . 20 0.9 d 0 . 30 0 . 60 0.4 Multiple choice 1 E 2 B 3 C 4 B 5 D Extended response a i f(-2) = 0.054 ii f(1) = 0.242 b
(
2, 0.054)
4
6 14 22 30 38 46 54
c
70 80 90 100110120130
9 Mean: translation of 22 units in the positive x direction; standard deviation: dilation factor of 1 3 from the x-axis, dilation factor of 3 from the y-axis 10 a 68% b 95% c 99.7% 11 a 16.5 X 22.7 b 13.4 X 25.8 c 10.3 X 28.9 d 22.7 e 25.8 f 28.9 2 a 1 13 a 14 a 15 a 16 a
2 3
c 0.51
c 0.32 C D E A C
2.5 2
5 1 .5
Multiple choice 1 A 2 D 5 C 6 A 9 E 10 D 13 D 14 D 17 D 18 C Extended response 1 a i 0.4066 b 0.8946 2 a 1.82 cm c 5% 3 a 163.2 seconds c 0.7357
.5
c 0.3401 d Pr(-1 < X < 1) 0.7194 (left rectangular) 0.6410 (right rectangular) e 0.683 g
(
1, 0.2421) (
2, 0.1330)
2.5
2
5
1
.5 y 1 (0, 0.3989) 0.5 0 0.5 (1, 0.2421) 1 1.5 (2, 0.1330) 2 2.5 x
.5
h 0.6827
Answers
729
Index
absolute value function 925, 21215 graphing 3045 hybrid functions, as 945 addition of ordinates 20610, 221 addition rule of probability 4889, 498, 529 angles complementary 26970 measurement of 2589 negative 267 antidifferentiation 41623, 474 see also integration areas approximation methods 4358, 475 between graph and x-axis 4358 between two curves 4604, 475 bound by a curve and the x-axis 4556 enclosed by functions, approximating 4358 finding without sketch graphs 4568 further 4558 signed 448 average rates 325 Bernoulli trials and sequences 53746 binomial distribution 53748, 581 expected value, variance and standard deviation of 5737, 582 graphs of 5467, 581 multiple probabilities, problems involving 5526, 581 binomial expansions 1 binomial theorem 15, 47 chain rule 3413, 366 change-of-base rule 138 change, rates of 3968, 408 combinations 4967, 498, 529 complementary angles 26970 completing the square 23 composite functions 10810, 122 graphing 3079 conditional probability 4923, 498, 529 constant rates 324 continuous distributions 5913 continuous random variables 58993, 643 applications to problem solving 61316, 644 normal distribution 61923 probability density functions and 595601 standard normal distribution 62633 cosine 261 graphs 2828, 315 special cases 262 cubic function gradient function of 327 power form, in 659 cubic graphs 2934, 48 curves, sketching 37684 definite integrals 4426, 474 degrees converting radians to 25960 converting to radians 2601 finding number of degrees in one radian 259 derivatives x 344, 366 e loge (x) 3479, 366 sin (x), cos (x) and tan (x) 3514, 3667 n 3389, 366 x difference functions 1034, 122 graphing 3034 differentiation 325 chain rule 3413, 366 first principles, using 3346, 366 mixed problems on 3604 product rule 3557, 367 quotient rule 3579, 367 dilation 578, 60, 65, 71, 79, 87, 978, 1735, 1835, 283, 291 discrete random distributions measures of centre of 51016, 52930 measures of variability 51826, 530 discrete random variables 5016, 529 expectation theorems 51214 discriminant 22 division of polynomials 1114 domain and range of functions 1820 restricted 18, 33 equations absolute value 925, 121 base e 1513, 167 composite 10810, 122 exponential 1426, 1513, 167 finding, for graphs of exponential and logarithmic functions 2024 functional 10810, 122 literal 15961, 167 logarithmic 1479 natural (base e) logarithms, with 1545, 167 tangents and normals 3735, 408 trigonometric 27381, 2957, 315 Eulers number 151 events 484, 497 independent 489 mutually exclusive 489 exact values 264 expectation theorems 51214 exponential and logarithmic modelling 1624 graphs, using 21617 exponential equations 1426, 167 base e 1513 exponential functions 220 absolute values, with 21215 ex, integration of 4267 graphs of, with base e 191
730
Index
finding areas without sketch graphs 4568 functional equations 10810, 122 functions 49 absolute value 925, 121, 21215, 3045 average value of 4668 composite 10810, 122, 3079 continuous 325 cubic 2931, 659, 327 difference 1034, 122 domain and range 1820 exponential 172, 191, 21215, 220, 4267 gradient 3257 graphing 3079 hybrid 945 inverse 2403, 252 limits 3326, 366 logarithmic 21215, 2201 polynomial, characteristics of 37684 power 715, 7883 probability density functions 595601 product 1056, 3067 quadratic 22, 5960, 3267 range of 1820 restricting 2459, 252 smooth 325 square root function in power form 8690 sum 103, 122, 3034 tangent, graphs of 2915 their inverses and 2349, 252 trigonometric 31112, 316, 4278 fundamental theorem of integral calculus 4416 gradient rates of change and 3248, 366 gradient function cubic functions, of 327 graphing from the graph of a function 325 quadratic functions, of 3267 straight lines, of 326 graphs 221, 3039, 316 absolute value 21215, 221, 3045 addition of ordinates 20610, 221 antiderivative function and original function, relationship 4213, 474 binomial distribution 5467, 581 composite functions 3079 cosine 2828, 315 cubic 2934, 48 exponential and logarithmic modelling, using 21617 exponential functions with any base 17280 exponential functions with base e 1916 hyperbola 715 inverse, of 22933 linear 1520, 478 logarithmic, to any base 18290 logarithmic, to base e 197200 maximum and minimum problems, solving 38694, 408 polynomial functions, characteristics of 37684 power functions, of 120 product functions 3067 properties of straight line 1517 quadratic 227, 48 quartic 3844, 489
sine and cosine functions, of 2828, 315 stationary points 3778, 408 straight line 1517 sum function 3034 tangent function, of 2915, 31516 transformations 5762 trigonometric 2828, 315 truncus 7883 types of 11117 hybrid functions 945 hyperbola 715 index laws 1326, 167 instantaneous rates 325 integral calculus, fundamental theorem of 4416 integrals, properties of 41721 definite 4426, 474 integration ex, sin (x) and cos (x) 4268 further applications of 46871 recognition, by 4303 interquartile range 61011 intersection 485, 529 interval notation 18 inverse cumulative normal distribution 63640 inverse functions 24043, 252 inverses 1568, 167 functions and 2349, 252 relations, of 22933 Karnaugh maps and probability tables 4912, 498, 529 linear approximation 4046 linear graphs 1520, 478 literal equations 15961, 167 logarithm laws 13841, 167 logarithmic equations using any base 1479 logarithmic functions with absolute values 21215, 221 logarithmic graphs to any base 18290, 2201 Markov chains 55970, 581 transition matrices 56570, 581 mathematical model 111 matrices transformations, with 96101, 1212 transition 56570, 581 using to describe a reflection in the line y=x 22930 maximum and minimum problems where function known 3869, 408 where function unknown 3904, 408 mean 5737, 582, 605 measures of central tendency and spread 60511, 6434 median 51516, 605 mode 51516, 605 modelling 11117, 122 exponential and logarithmic 1624 trigonometric 299301 modulus functions, graphing 3045 see also absolute value function negative angles 267 negative quartics 39
Index
731
normal distribution 61923, 6445 common probabilities associated with 61920 graph 619 inverse cumulative normal distribution 63640, 645 properties 619 standard 62633, 645 symmetry properties 6303 ordinates, addition of 20610, 221 parabola and transformations 5762 Pascals triangle 2, 5, 47 percentiles 601, 638 polynomials 610, 47 division of 1114 evaluating 810 positive quartics 38 power functions hyperbola 715 truncus 7883 probability 48598 addition rule of 4889, 529 combinations 4967, 498, 529 conditional 4923, 498, 529 independent events 489 Karnaugh maps and probability tables 4912, 498, 529 mutually exclusive events 489 outcomes 484, 497, 529 terminology 4845, 497, 529 tree diagrams 4946, 498, 529 Venn diagrams 485, 497, 529 probability density function 5903, 643 using to find probabilities of continuous random variables 595601, 643 product functions 1056 graphing 3067 product rule 3557, 367 quadratic function in power form 5960 quadratic graphs 227, 48 quantiles 601, 638 quartic graphs 3844, 489 negative 39 positive 38 quotient rule 3579, 367 radians 25863, 314 converting degrees to 2601 converting to degrees 25960 finding number of degrees in one 259 random variables, discrete 5016 discrete probability distributions 5026 rates of change 3968, 408 rates, related 4013, 409
reflection 58, 60, 65, 712, 79, 87, 978, 17880, 18790, 2856, 291 related rates 4013, 409 relations and their inverses 22933 restricting function 2459, 252 sample point 484, 497, 529 sample space 484, 497, 529 sigma notation 445 signed areas 44851 sine 261 graphs 2828, 315 special cases 262 sketching curves 37684 square root function in power form 8690 standard deviation 5213, 5737, 582, 607 interpreting 5236 stationary points 3778, 408 types of 3778 straight line graphs, properties of 1517 sum functions 103, 122 graphing 3034 symmetry exact values and 26471, 314 tangent 262 graphs 2915, 31516 special cases 262 tangents and normals, equations of 3735, 408 transformations 5762 combination of 59, 61, 66, 72, 88 matrices, with 96101 transition matrices 56570, 581 translation 59, 989, 2867, 292 horizontal 60, 66, 72, 7980, 87, 1767, 1867 vertical 60, 66, 72, 80, 87, 176, 1856 tree diagrams 4946, 498, 529 trigonometric equations 27381, 2957, 315 trigonometric functions, integration of 4278 trigonometric functions with an increasing trend 31112, 316 trigonometric graphs 2828, 315 finding equations of 2957 trigonometric modelling 299301 truncus 7883 turning point form 23 union (probability) 484, 497, 529 unit circle 25863, 314 symmetry properties 2645 variability of discrete random distributions, measures of 51826, 52930 variance 51821, 5737, 582, 607 Venn diagrams 485, 497, 529
732
Index